texlive[63298] Master/texmf-dist: hyperref (14may22)
commits+karl at tug.org
commits+karl at tug.org
Sat May 14 22:32:18 CEST 2022
Revision: 63298
http://tug.org/svn/texlive?view=revision&revision=63298
Author: karl
Date: 2022-05-14 22:32:17 +0200 (Sat, 14 May 2022)
Log Message:
-----------
hyperref (14may22)
Modified Paths:
--------------
trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/hyperref/ChangeLog.txt
trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/hyperref/README.md
trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/hyperref/backref.pdf
trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/hyperref/hyperref-doc.css
trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/hyperref/hyperref-doc.html
trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/hyperref/hyperref-doc.pdf
trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/hyperref/hyperref.pdf
trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/hyperref/manifest.txt
trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/hyperref/nameref.pdf
trunk/Master/texmf-dist/source/latex/hyperref/backref.dtx
trunk/Master/texmf-dist/source/latex/hyperref/hluatex.dtx
trunk/Master/texmf-dist/source/latex/hyperref/hyperref-patches.dtx
trunk/Master/texmf-dist/source/latex/hyperref/hyperref.dtx
trunk/Master/texmf-dist/source/latex/hyperref/hyperref.ins
trunk/Master/texmf-dist/source/latex/hyperref/nameref.dtx
trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/backref.sty
trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/hdvipdfm.def
trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/hdvips.def
trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/hdvipson.def
trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/hdviwind.def
trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/hluatex.def
trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/hpdftex.def
trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/htex4ht.cfg
trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/htex4ht.def
trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/htexture.def
trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/hvtex.def
trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/hvtexhtm.def
trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/hvtexmrk.def
trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/hxetex.def
trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/hyperref-patches.sty
trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/hyperref.sty
trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/hypertex.def
trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/nameref.sty
trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/nohyperref.sty
trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/pd1enc.def
trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/pdfmark.def
trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/psdextra.def
trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/puarenc.def
trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/puenc-extra.def
trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/puenc-greekbasic.def
trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/puenc.def
trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/puvnenc.def
trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/xr-hyper.sty
Added Paths:
-----------
trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/hyperref/hyperref-doc.tex
trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/hyperref/hyperref-linktarget.pdf
trunk/Master/texmf-dist/source/latex/hyperref/hyperref-linktarget.dtx
Removed Paths:
-------------
trunk/Master/texmf-dist/source/latex/hyperref/doc/hyperref-doc.tex
Modified: trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/hyperref/ChangeLog.txt
===================================================================
--- trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/hyperref/ChangeLog.txt 2022-05-14 20:31:45 UTC (rev 63297)
+++ trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/hyperref/ChangeLog.txt 2022-05-14 20:32:17 UTC (rev 63298)
@@ -1,3 +1,33 @@
+2022-05-13 Ulrike Fischer/David Carlisle
+
+ * added new interface for package authors to create targets for internal
+ links
+ * allow to suppress sectioning and footnote patches of hyperref
+ * removed loading of memhfixc: memoir handles that now by itself.
+ * removed an old patch for KOMA before 2001
+ * removed compability code for pdftex 1.14
+ * remove a test for amsmath before 1999
+ * removed an since 2002 unneeded definition for subfigure
+ * various patches in nameref can now be disabled by package authors
+ by defining a command.
+ * the experimental option localanchorname has been deprecated
+ * LaTeX 2020-10-01 is required as hooks are used now.
+ * \refstepcounter no longer tests for the slide counter as no reason could be found
+ for that test.
+ * nameref no longer patches \ifthenelse if kernel support is detected.
+ * some support for references is done by tex4ht directly and has been removed from
+ hyperref
+ * unified reference commands, both nameref and hyperref now support
+ \ref, \pageref, \Ref, \nameref and \ref*, \pageref*, \Ref*, \nameref*
+ * removed older varioref code, a varioref newer than 2019 is now needed.
+ * improved support for showkeys.
+ * \theHequation is always defined (an not only if the section
+ counter is defined)
+ * Removed the \contentsline tests, no longer needed as \contentsline
+ has now four arguments also in latex.
+ * \MakeUppercase and \MakeLowercase work now in bookmarks if the expl3
+ support is detected.
+
2022-02-21 Ulrike Fischer/David Carlisle
* a pdftex version newer than 1.10 (from 2003) is assumed
* removed tests for numexpr/dimexpr: etex is now required
Modified: trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/hyperref/README.md
===================================================================
--- trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/hyperref/README.md 2022-05-14 20:31:45 UTC (rev 63297)
+++ trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/hyperref/README.md 2022-05-14 20:32:17 UTC (rev 63298)
@@ -1,6 +1,6 @@
# README for hyperref bundle
-Version 2022-02-21 v7.00n
+Version 2022-05-13 v7.00o
## INTRODUCTION
Modified: trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/hyperref/backref.pdf
===================================================================
(Binary files differ)
Modified: trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/hyperref/hyperref-doc.css
===================================================================
--- trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/hyperref/hyperref-doc.css 2022-05-14 20:31:45 UTC (rev 63297)
+++ trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/hyperref/hyperref-doc.css 2022-05-14 20:32:17 UTC (rev 63298)
@@ -291,6 +291,7 @@
table.longtable{border-collapse: collapse; border-spacing: 0;}
div.longtable{text-align:center;}
table.longtable{margin-left:auto; margin-right: auto;}
+caption.longtable .id{font-weight:bold;}
span.HoLogo-LaTeX span.HoLogo-a{position:relative;top:-.5ex;margin-left:-.36em;margin-right:-.15em;font-size:85%;}
span.HoLogo-TeX span.HoLogo-e{position:relative;top:.5ex;margin-left:-.1667em;margin-right:-.125em;}
a span.HoLogo-TeX span.HoLogo-e{text-decoration:none;}
Modified: trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/hyperref/hyperref-doc.html
===================================================================
--- trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/hyperref/hyperref-doc.html 2022-05-14 20:31:45 UTC (rev 63297)
+++ trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/hyperref/hyperref-doc.html 2022-05-14 20:32:17 UTC (rev 63298)
@@ -25,7 +25,7 @@
class="ec-lmvtt-10x-x-120">https://github.com/latex3/hyperref/issues</span></a><span
class="ec-lmr-12">)</span></div><br />
<div class="date" ><span
-class="ec-lmr-12">2022-02-21 v7.00n</span></div>
+class="ec-lmr-12">2022-05-13 v7.00o</span></div>
</div>
<h3 class="likesectionHead"><a
id="x1-1000"></a>Contents</h3>
@@ -44,164 +44,260 @@
href="#x1-70004.1" id="QQ2-1-7">Counters</a></span>
<br />   <span class="subsectionToc" >4.2 <a
href="#x1-80004.2" id="QQ2-1-8">Links commands</a></span>
+<br />   <span class="subsectionToc" >4.3 <a
+href="#x1-90004.3" id="QQ2-1-9">Creating targets</a></span>
+<br />   <span class="subsectionToc" >4.4 <a
+href="#x1-100004.4" id="QQ2-1-10">Patches and how to suppress them</a></span>
<br />  <span class="sectionToc" >5 <a
-href="#x1-90005" id="QQ2-1-9">Package options</a></span>
+href="#x1-110005" id="QQ2-1-11">Package options</a></span>
<br />   <span class="subsectionToc" >5.1 <a
-href="#x1-100005.1" id="QQ2-1-10">General options</a></span>
+href="#x1-120005.1" id="QQ2-1-12">General options</a></span>
<br />   <span class="subsectionToc" >5.2 <a
-href="#x1-110005.2" id="QQ2-1-11">Options for destination names</a></span>
+href="#x1-130005.2" id="QQ2-1-13">Options for destination names</a></span>
<br />   <span class="subsectionToc" >5.3 <a
-href="#x1-120005.3" id="QQ2-1-12">Configuration options</a></span>
+href="#x1-140005.3" id="QQ2-1-14">Configuration options</a></span>
<br />   <span class="subsectionToc" >5.4 <a
-href="#x1-130005.4" id="QQ2-1-13">Backend drivers</a></span>
+href="#x1-150005.4" id="QQ2-1-15">Backend drivers</a></span>
<br />   <span class="subsectionToc" >5.5 <a
-href="#x1-140005.5" id="QQ2-1-14">Extension options</a></span>
+href="#x1-160005.5" id="QQ2-1-16">Extension options</a></span>
<br />   <span class="subsectionToc" >5.6 <a
-href="#x1-150005.6" id="QQ2-1-15">PDF-specific display options</a></span>
+href="#x1-170005.6" id="QQ2-1-17">PDF-specific display options</a></span>
<br />   <span class="subsectionToc" >5.7 <a
-href="#x1-160005.7" id="QQ2-1-16">PDF display and information options</a></span>
+href="#x1-180005.7" id="QQ2-1-18">PDF display and information options</a></span>
<br />   <span class="subsectionToc" >5.8 <a
-href="#x1-170005.8" id="QQ2-1-17">Option <span
+href="#x1-190005.8" id="QQ2-1-19">Option <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">pdfinfo</span></a></span>
<br />   <span class="subsectionToc" >5.9 <a
-href="#x1-180005.9" id="QQ2-1-18">Big alphabetical list</a></span>
+href="#x1-200005.9" id="QQ2-1-20">Big alphabetical list</a></span>
<br />  <span class="sectionToc" >6 <a
-href="#x1-190006" id="QQ2-1-19">Additional user macros</a></span>
+href="#x1-210006" id="QQ2-1-21">Additional user macros</a></span>
<br />   <span class="subsectionToc" >6.1 <a
-href="#x1-200006.1" id="QQ2-1-20">Bookmark macros</a></span>
+href="#x1-220006.1" id="QQ2-1-22">Bookmark macros</a></span>
+<br />    <span class="subsubsectionToc" >6.1.1 <a
+href="#x1-230006.1.1" id="QQ2-1-23">Setting bookmarks</a></span>
+<br />    <span class="subsubsectionToc" >6.1.2 <a
+href="#x1-240006.1.2" id="QQ2-1-24">Replacement macros</a></span>
<br />   <span class="subsectionToc" >6.2 <a
-href="#x1-230006.2" id="QQ2-1-23">Pagelabels</a></span>
+href="#x1-250006.2" id="QQ2-1-25">Pagelabels</a></span>
<br />   <span class="subsectionToc" >6.3 <a
-href="#x1-240006.3" id="QQ2-1-24">Utility macros</a></span>
+href="#x1-260006.3" id="QQ2-1-26">Utility macros</a></span>
<br />  <span class="sectionToc" >7 <a
-href="#x1-250007" id="QQ2-1-25">New Features</a></span>
+href="#x1-270007" id="QQ2-1-27">New Features</a></span>
<br />   <span class="subsectionToc" >7.1 <a
-href="#x1-260007.1" id="QQ2-1-26">Option ‘pdflinkmargin’</a></span>
+href="#x1-280007.1" id="QQ2-1-28">Option ‘pdflinkmargin’</a></span>
<br />   <span class="subsectionToc" >7.2 <a
-href="#x1-270007.2" id="QQ2-1-27">Field option ‘calculatesortkey’</a></span>
+href="#x1-290007.2" id="QQ2-1-29">Field option ‘calculatesortkey’</a></span>
<br />   <span class="subsectionToc" >7.3 <a
-href="#x1-280007.3" id="QQ2-1-28">Option ‘next-anchor’</a></span>
+href="#x1-300007.3" id="QQ2-1-30">Option ‘next-anchor’</a></span>
<br />   <span class="subsectionToc" >7.4 <a
-href="#x1-290007.4" id="QQ2-1-29">Option ‘localanchorname’</a></span>
+href="#x1-310007.4" id="QQ2-1-31">Option ‘localanchorname’</a></span>
<br />   <span class="subsectionToc" >7.5 <a
-href="#x1-300007.5" id="QQ2-1-30">Option ‘customdriver’</a></span>
+href="#x1-320007.5" id="QQ2-1-32">Option ‘customdriver’</a></span>
<br />   <span class="subsectionToc" >7.6 <a
-href="#x1-310007.6" id="QQ2-1-31">Option ‘psdextra’</a></span>
+href="#x1-330007.6" id="QQ2-1-33">Option ‘psdextra’</a></span>
<br />   <span class="subsectionToc" >7.7 <a
-href="#x1-320007.7" id="QQ2-1-32">\XeTeXLinkBox</a></span>
+href="#x1-340007.7" id="QQ2-1-34">\XeTeXLinkBox</a></span>
+
+
<br />   <span class="subsectionToc" >7.8 <a
-href="#x1-330007.8" id="QQ2-1-33">\IfHyperBooleanExists and \IfHyperBoolean</a></span>
+href="#x1-350007.8" id="QQ2-1-35">\IfHyperBooleanExists and \IfHyperBoolean</a></span>
<br />   <span class="subsectionToc" >7.9 <a
-href="#x1-340007.9" id="QQ2-1-34">\unichar</a></span>
-
+href="#x1-360007.9" id="QQ2-1-36">\unichar</a></span>
<br />   <span class="subsectionToc" >7.10 <a
-href="#x1-350007.10" id="QQ2-1-35">\ifpdfstringunicode</a></span>
+href="#x1-370007.10" id="QQ2-1-37">\ifpdfstringunicode</a></span>
<br />   <span class="subsectionToc" >7.11 <a
-href="#x1-360007.11" id="QQ2-1-36">Customizing index style file with \nohyperpage</a></span>
+href="#x1-380007.11" id="QQ2-1-38">Customizing index style file with \nohyperpage</a></span>
<br />   <span class="subsectionToc" >7.12 <a
-href="#x1-370007.12" id="QQ2-1-37">Experimental option ‘ocgcolorlinks’</a></span>
+href="#x1-390007.12" id="QQ2-1-39">Experimental option ‘ocgcolorlinks’</a></span>
<br />   <span class="subsectionToc" >7.13 <a
-href="#x1-380007.13" id="QQ2-1-38">Option ‘pdfa’</a></span>
+href="#x1-400007.13" id="QQ2-1-40">Option ‘pdfa’</a></span>
<br />   <span class="subsectionToc" >7.14 <a
-href="#x1-390007.14" id="QQ2-1-39">Option ‘linktoc’ added</a></span>
+href="#x1-410007.14" id="QQ2-1-41">Option ‘linktoc’ added</a></span>
<br />   <span class="subsectionToc" >7.15 <a
-href="#x1-400007.15" id="QQ2-1-40">Option ‘pdfnewwindow’ changed</a></span>
+href="#x1-420007.15" id="QQ2-1-42">Option ‘pdfnewwindow’ changed</a></span>
<br />   <span class="subsectionToc" >7.16 <a
-href="#x1-410007.16" id="QQ2-1-41">Flag options for PDF forms</a></span>
+href="#x1-430007.16" id="QQ2-1-43">Flag options for PDF forms</a></span>
<br />   <span class="subsectionToc" >7.17 <a
-href="#x1-420007.17" id="QQ2-1-42">Option ‘pdfversion’</a></span>
+href="#x1-440007.17" id="QQ2-1-44">Option ‘pdfversion’</a></span>
<br />   <span class="subsectionToc" >7.18 <a
-href="#x1-430007.18" id="QQ2-1-43">Field option ‘name’</a></span>
+href="#x1-450007.18" id="QQ2-1-45">Field option ‘name’</a></span>
<br />   <span class="subsectionToc" >7.19 <a
-href="#x1-440007.19" id="QQ2-1-44">Option ‘pdfencoding’</a></span>
+href="#x1-460007.19" id="QQ2-1-46">Option ‘pdfencoding’</a></span>
<br />   <span class="subsectionToc" >7.20 <a
-href="#x1-450007.20" id="QQ2-1-45">Color options/package hycolor</a></span>
+href="#x1-470007.20" id="QQ2-1-47">Color options/package hycolor</a></span>
<br />   <span class="subsectionToc" >7.21 <a
-href="#x1-460007.21" id="QQ2-1-46">Option pdfusetitle</a></span>
+href="#x1-480007.21" id="QQ2-1-48">Option pdfusetitle</a></span>
<br />   <span class="subsectionToc" >7.22 <a
-href="#x1-470007.22" id="QQ2-1-47">Starred form of \autoref</a></span>
+href="#x1-490007.22" id="QQ2-1-49">Starred form of \autoref</a></span>
<br />   <span class="subsectionToc" >7.23 <a
-href="#x1-480007.23" id="QQ2-1-48">Link border style</a></span>
+href="#x1-500007.23" id="QQ2-1-50">Link border style</a></span>
<br />   <span class="subsectionToc" >7.24 <a
-href="#x1-490007.24" id="QQ2-1-49">Option <span
+href="#x1-510007.24" id="QQ2-1-51">Option <span
class="ec-lmss-10">bookmarksdepth</span></a></span>
<br />   <span class="subsectionToc" >7.25 <a
-href="#x1-500007.25" id="QQ2-1-50">Option <span
+href="#x1-520007.25" id="QQ2-1-52">Option <span
class="ec-lmss-10">pdfescapeform</span></a></span>
<br />   <span class="subsectionToc" >7.26 <a
-href="#x1-510007.26" id="QQ2-1-51">Default driver setting</a></span>
+href="#x1-530007.26" id="QQ2-1-53">Default driver setting</a></span>
<br />   <span class="subsectionToc" >7.27 <a
-href="#x1-520007.27" id="QQ2-1-52">Backref entries</a></span>
+href="#x1-540007.27" id="QQ2-1-54">Backref entries</a></span>
<br />   <span class="subsectionToc" >7.28 <a
-href="#x1-530007.28" id="QQ2-1-53">\phantomsection</a></span>
+href="#x1-550007.28" id="QQ2-1-55">\phantomsection</a></span>
<br />   <span class="subsectionToc" >7.29 <a
-href="#x1-540007.29" id="QQ2-1-54">puenc encoding, puenc-greek.def and puenc-extra.def</a></span>
+href="#x1-560007.29" id="QQ2-1-56">puenc encoding, puenc-greek.def and puenc-extra.def</a></span>
<br />  <span class="sectionToc" >8 <a
-href="#x1-550008" id="QQ2-1-55">Acrobat-specific behavior</a></span>
+href="#x1-570008" id="QQ2-1-57">Acrobat-specific behavior</a></span>
<br />  <span class="sectionToc" >9 <a
-href="#x1-560009" id="QQ2-1-56">PDF and HTML forms</a></span>
+href="#x1-580009" id="QQ2-1-58">PDF and HTML forms</a></span>
<br />   <span class="subsectionToc" >9.1 <a
-href="#x1-570009.1" id="QQ2-1-57">Forms environment parameters</a></span>
+href="#x1-590009.1" id="QQ2-1-59">Forms environment parameters</a></span>
<br />   <span class="subsectionToc" >9.2 <a
-href="#x1-580009.2" id="QQ2-1-58">Forms optional parameters</a></span>
+href="#x1-600009.2" id="QQ2-1-60">Forms optional parameters</a></span>
<br />  <span class="sectionToc" >10 <a
-href="#x1-5900010" id="QQ2-1-59">Defining a new driver</a></span>
+href="#x1-6100010" id="QQ2-1-61">Defining a new driver</a></span>
<br />  <span class="sectionToc" >11 <a
-href="#x1-6000011" id="QQ2-1-60">Special support for other packages</a></span>
+href="#x1-6200011" id="QQ2-1-62">Special support for other packages</a></span>
<br />   <span class="subsectionToc" >11.1 <a
-href="#x1-6100011.1" id="QQ2-1-61">Package Compatibility</a></span>
+href="#x1-6300011.1" id="QQ2-1-63">Package Compatibility</a></span>
+<br />    <span class="subsubsectionToc" >11.1.1 <a
+href="#x1-6400011.1.1" id="QQ2-1-64">algorithm</a></span>
+<br />    <span class="subsubsectionToc" >11.1.2 <a
+href="#x1-6500011.1.2" id="QQ2-1-65">amsmath</a></span>
+<br />    <span class="subsubsectionToc" >11.1.3 <a
+href="#x1-6600011.1.3" id="QQ2-1-66">amsrefs</a></span>
+<br />    <span class="subsubsectionToc" >11.1.4 <a
+href="#x1-6700011.1.4" id="QQ2-1-67">arydshln, longtable</a></span>
+<br />    <span class="subsubsectionToc" >11.1.5 <a
+href="#x1-6800011.1.5" id="QQ2-1-68">babel/magyar.ldf</a></span>
+<br />    <span class="subsubsectionToc" >11.1.6 <a
+href="#x1-6900011.1.6" id="QQ2-1-69">babel/spanish.ldf</a></span>
+<br />    <span class="subsubsectionToc" >11.1.7 <a
+href="#x1-7000011.1.7" id="QQ2-1-70">bibentry</a></span>
+<br />    <span class="subsubsectionToc" >11.1.8 <a
+href="#x1-7100011.1.8" id="QQ2-1-71">bigfoot</a></span>
+<br />    <span class="subsubsectionToc" >11.1.9 <a
+href="#x1-7200011.1.9" id="QQ2-1-72">chappg</a></span>
+<br />    <span class="subsubsectionToc" >11.1.10 <a
+href="#x1-7300011.1.10" id="QQ2-1-73">cite</a></span>
+<br />    <span class="subsubsectionToc" >11.1.11 <a
+href="#x1-7400011.1.11" id="QQ2-1-74">count1to</a></span>
+<br />    <span class="subsubsectionToc" >11.1.12 <a
+href="#x1-7500011.1.12" id="QQ2-1-75">dblaccnt</a></span>
+<br />    <span class="subsubsectionToc" >11.1.13 <a
+href="#x1-7600011.1.13" id="QQ2-1-76">easyeqn</a></span>
+<br />    <span class="subsubsectionToc" >11.1.14 <a
+href="#x1-7700011.1.14" id="QQ2-1-77">ellipsis</a></span>
+<br />    <span class="subsubsectionToc" >11.1.15 <a
+href="#x1-7800011.1.15" id="QQ2-1-78">float</a></span>
+<br />    <span class="subsubsectionToc" >11.1.16 <a
+href="#x1-7900011.1.16" id="QQ2-1-79">endnotes</a></span>
+<br />    <span class="subsubsectionToc" >11.1.17 <a
+href="#x1-8000011.1.17" id="QQ2-1-80">foiltex</a></span>
+<br />    <span class="subsubsectionToc" >11.1.18 <a
+href="#x1-8100011.1.18" id="QQ2-1-81">footnote</a></span>
+<br />    <span class="subsubsectionToc" >11.1.19 <a
+href="#x1-8200011.1.19" id="QQ2-1-82">geometry</a></span>
+<br />    <span class="subsubsectionToc" >11.1.20 <a
+href="#x1-8300011.1.20" id="QQ2-1-83">IEEEtran.cls</a></span>
+<br />    <span class="subsubsectionToc" >11.1.21 <a
+href="#x1-8400011.1.21" id="QQ2-1-84">index</a></span>
+<br />    <span class="subsubsectionToc" >11.1.22 <a
+href="#x1-8500011.1.22" id="QQ2-1-85">lastpage</a></span>
+<br />    <span class="subsubsectionToc" >11.1.23 <a
+href="#x1-8600011.1.23" id="QQ2-1-86">linguex</a></span>
+
+<br />    <span class="subsubsectionToc" >11.1.24 <a
+href="#x1-8700011.1.24" id="QQ2-1-87">ltabptch</a></span>
+<br />    <span class="subsubsectionToc" >11.1.25 <a
+href="#x1-8800011.1.25" id="QQ2-1-88">mathenv</a></span>
+<br />    <span class="subsubsectionToc" >11.1.26 <a
+href="#x1-8900011.1.26" id="QQ2-1-89">minitoc-hyper</a></span>
+<br />    <span class="subsubsectionToc" >11.1.27 <a
+href="#x1-9000011.1.27" id="QQ2-1-90">multind</a></span>
+<br />    <span class="subsubsectionToc" >11.1.28 <a
+href="#x1-9100011.1.28" id="QQ2-1-91">natbib</a></span>
+<br />    <span class="subsubsectionToc" >11.1.29 <a
+href="#x1-9200011.1.29" id="QQ2-1-92">nomencl</a></span>
+<br />    <span class="subsubsectionToc" >11.1.30 <a
+href="#x1-9300011.1.30" id="QQ2-1-93">ntheorem-hyper</a></span>
+<br />    <span class="subsubsectionToc" >11.1.31 <a
+href="#x1-9400011.1.31" id="QQ2-1-94">parskip</a></span>
+<br />    <span class="subsubsectionToc" >11.1.32 <a
+href="#x1-9500011.1.32" id="QQ2-1-95">prettyref</a></span>
+<br />    <span class="subsubsectionToc" >11.1.33 <a
+href="#x1-9600011.1.33" id="QQ2-1-96">setspace</a></span>
+<br />    <span class="subsubsectionToc" >11.1.34 <a
+href="#x1-9700011.1.34" id="QQ2-1-97">sidecap</a></span>
+<br />    <span class="subsubsectionToc" >11.1.35 <a
+href="#x1-9800011.1.35" id="QQ2-1-98">subfigure</a></span>
+<br />    <span class="subsubsectionToc" >11.1.36 <a
+href="#x1-9900011.1.36" id="QQ2-1-99">titleref</a></span>
+<br />    <span class="subsubsectionToc" >11.1.37 <a
+href="#x1-10000011.1.37" id="QQ2-1-100">tabularx</a></span>
+<br />    <span class="subsubsectionToc" >11.1.38 <a
+href="#x1-10100011.1.38" id="QQ2-1-101">titlesec</a></span>
+<br />    <span class="subsubsectionToc" >11.1.39 <a
+href="#x1-10200011.1.39" id="QQ2-1-102">ucs/utf8x.def</a></span>
+<br />    <span class="subsubsectionToc" >11.1.40 <a
+href="#x1-10300011.1.40" id="QQ2-1-103">varioref</a></span>
+<br />    <span class="subsubsectionToc" >11.1.41 <a
+href="#x1-10400011.1.41" id="QQ2-1-104">verse</a></span>
+<br />    <span class="subsubsectionToc" >11.1.42 <a
+href="#x1-10500011.1.42" id="QQ2-1-105">vietnam</a></span>
+<br />    <span class="subsubsectionToc" >11.1.43 <a
+href="#x1-10600011.1.43" id="QQ2-1-106">XeTeX</a></span>
<br />  <span class="sectionToc" >12 <a
-href="#x1-10500012" id="QQ2-1-105">Limitations</a></span>
+href="#x1-10700012" id="QQ2-1-107">Limitations</a></span>
<br />   <span class="subsectionToc" >12.1 <a
-href="#x1-10600012.1" id="QQ2-1-106">Wrapped/broken link support</a></span>
+href="#x1-10800012.1" id="QQ2-1-108">Wrapped/broken link support</a></span>
<br />   <span class="subsectionToc" >12.2 <a
-href="#x1-10700012.2" id="QQ2-1-107">Links across pages</a></span>
+href="#x1-10900012.2" id="QQ2-1-109">Links across pages</a></span>
<br />   <span class="subsectionToc" >12.3 <a
-href="#x1-10800012.3" id="QQ2-1-108">Footnotes</a></span>
+href="#x1-11000012.3" id="QQ2-1-110">Footnotes</a></span>
<br />  <span class="sectionToc" >13 <a
-href="#x1-10900013" id="QQ2-1-109">Hints</a></span>
+href="#x1-11100013" id="QQ2-1-111">Hints</a></span>
<br />   <span class="subsectionToc" >13.1 <a
-href="#x1-11000013.1" id="QQ2-1-110">Spaces in option values</a></span>
+href="#x1-11200013.1" id="QQ2-1-112">Spaces in option values</a></span>
<br />   <span class="subsectionToc" >13.2 <a
-href="#x1-11100013.2" id="QQ2-1-111">Index with makeindex</a></span>
+href="#x1-11300013.2" id="QQ2-1-113">Index with makeindex</a></span>
<br />   <span class="subsectionToc" >13.3 <a
-href="#x1-11200013.3" id="QQ2-1-112">Warning <span
+href="#x1-11400013.3" id="QQ2-1-114">Warning <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">"bookmark level for unknown <foobar> defaults to 0"</span></a></span>
<br />   <span class="subsectionToc" >13.4 <a
-href="#x1-11300013.4" id="QQ2-1-113">Link anchors in figures</a></span>
+href="#x1-11500013.4" id="QQ2-1-115">Link anchors in figures</a></span>
<br />   <span class="subsectionToc" >13.5 <a
-href="#x1-11400013.5" id="QQ2-1-114">Additional unicode characters in bookmarks and pdf information entries:</a></span>
+href="#x1-11600013.5" id="QQ2-1-116">Additional unicode characters in bookmarks and pdf information entries:</a></span>
<br />   <span class="subsectionToc" >13.6 <a
-href="#x1-11500013.6" id="QQ2-1-115">Footnotes</a></span>
+href="#x1-11700013.6" id="QQ2-1-117">Footnotes</a></span>
<br />   <span class="subsectionToc" >13.7 <a
-href="#x1-11600013.7" id="QQ2-1-116">Subordinate counters</a></span>
+href="#x1-11800013.7" id="QQ2-1-118">Subordinate counters</a></span>
<br />  <span class="sectionToc" >14 <a
-href="#x1-11700014" id="QQ2-1-117">History and acknowledgments</a></span>
+href="#x1-11900014" id="QQ2-1-119">History and acknowledgments</a></span>
<br />  <span class="sectionToc" >15 <a
-href="#x1-11800015" id="QQ2-1-118">GNU Free Documentation License</a></span>
+href="#x1-12000015" id="QQ2-1-120">GNU Free Documentation License</a></span>
<br />   <span class="subsectionToc" >15.1 <a
-href="#x1-12000015.1" id="QQ2-1-120">Applicability and definitions</a></span>
+href="#x1-12200015.1" id="QQ2-1-122">Applicability and definitions</a></span>
<br />   <span class="subsectionToc" >15.2 <a
-href="#x1-12100015.2" id="QQ2-1-121">Verbatim copying</a></span>
+href="#x1-12300015.2" id="QQ2-1-123">Verbatim copying</a></span>
<br />   <span class="subsectionToc" >15.3 <a
-href="#x1-12200015.3" id="QQ2-1-122">Copying in quantity</a></span>
+href="#x1-12400015.3" id="QQ2-1-124">Copying in quantity</a></span>
<br />   <span class="subsectionToc" >15.4 <a
-href="#x1-12300015.4" id="QQ2-1-123">Modifications</a></span>
+href="#x1-12500015.4" id="QQ2-1-125">Modifications</a></span>
<br />   <span class="subsectionToc" >15.5 <a
-href="#x1-12400015.5" id="QQ2-1-124">Combining documents</a></span>
+href="#x1-12600015.5" id="QQ2-1-126">Combining documents</a></span>
<br />   <span class="subsectionToc" >15.6 <a
-href="#x1-12500015.6" id="QQ2-1-125">Collections of documents</a></span>
+href="#x1-12700015.6" id="QQ2-1-127">Collections of documents</a></span>
<br />   <span class="subsectionToc" >15.7 <a
-href="#x1-12600015.7" id="QQ2-1-126">Aggregation with independent works</a></span>
+href="#x1-12800015.7" id="QQ2-1-128">Aggregation with independent works</a></span>
<br />   <span class="subsectionToc" >15.8 <a
-href="#x1-12700015.8" id="QQ2-1-127">Translation</a></span>
+href="#x1-12900015.8" id="QQ2-1-129">Translation</a></span>
<br />   <span class="subsectionToc" >15.9 <a
-href="#x1-12800015.9" id="QQ2-1-128">Termination</a></span>
+href="#x1-13000015.9" id="QQ2-1-130">Termination</a></span>
<br />   <span class="subsectionToc" >15.10 <a
-href="#x1-12900015.10" id="QQ2-1-129">Future revisions of this license</a></span>
+href="#x1-13100015.10" id="QQ2-1-131">Future revisions of this license</a></span>
+ </div>
- </div>
<!--l. 179--><p class="noindent" >
<h3 class="sectionHead"><span class="titlemark">1 </span> <a
id="x1-20001"></a>Preface—February 2022</h3>
@@ -208,7 +304,7 @@
<!--l. 180--><p class="noindent" >As can be already seen in the following introduction, <span
class="ec-lmss-10">hyperref </span>has a long history and has seen many
changes over time. The introduction mentions workflows, drivers and problems which are no
-longer relevant, or only in edge cases. The documentation reflect this varied history: changes
+longer relevant, or only in edge cases. The documentation reflects this varied history: changes
and extensions and explanations were and are spread over various papers and sources and
only incorporated later and so are not always in a coherent order and in sync which each
other.
@@ -232,8 +328,8 @@
id="x1-30001.1"></a>Restoring removed patches</h4>
<!--l. 202--><p class="noindent" ><span
class="ec-lmss-10">hyperref </span>has over time patched quite a number of packages to resolve clashes and incompabilities. Quite a
-number are either no longer needed or should be done by by the original packages. These patches are
-now slowly removed from <span
+number are either no longer needed or should be done by the original packages. Those patches are now
+slowly removed from <span
class="ec-lmss-10">hyperref</span>. It should normally not lead to problems, but in case that the patches
should be restored they can be loaded through the package <span
class="ec-lmss-10">hyperref-patches </span>which is a part of this
@@ -272,11 +368,11 @@
<!--l. 230--><p class="indent" > The Hyper<span class="HoLogo-TeX">T<span class="HoLogo-e">E</span>X</span> specification<span class="footnote-mark"><a
href="hyperref-doc3.html#fn2x0"><sup class="textsuperscript">2</sup></a></span><a
id="x1-4002f2"></a>
-
-
says that conformant viewers/translators must recognize the following set of <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\special </span>constructs:
<dl class="description"><dt class="description">
+
+
<!--l. 235--><p class="noindent" >
<span
class="ec-lmbx-10">href:</span> </dt><dd
@@ -380,8 +476,9 @@
class="ec-lmss-10">T</span><span class="HoLogo-e"><span
class="ec-lmss-10">E</span></span><span
class="ec-lmss-10">X</span></span></span>, and <span
-class="ec-lmss-10">Textures</span>)
+class="ec-lmss-10">Textures</span>)
+
</dd><dt class="description">
<!--l. 275--><p class="noindent" >
<span
@@ -549,12 +646,13 @@
<h3 class="sectionHead"><span class="titlemark">4 </span> <a
id="x1-60004"></a>Interfaces for class and package authors</h3>
<!--l. 351--><p class="noindent" >hyperlink features are nowadays a common requirement. <span
-class="ec-lmss-10">hyperref </span>patches quite a number of commands
-from the LaTeX core and from packages to add such features. But this is rather fragile and it add
-dependencies on the loading order and can break if the external packages break. It is therefore much
-better if packages add suitable support to their commands directly. Quite a lot packages actually did
-this, but due to missing documentation of the interface they often looked into the code and then used
-internal commands not meant as public command.
+class="ec-lmss-10">hyperref </span>patches quite a number of
+commands from the LaTeX core and from packages to add such features. But this is rather
+fragile and it add dependencies on the loading order and can break if the external packages
+changes. It is therefore much better if packages add suitable support to their commands
+directly. Quite a lot packages actually did this, but due to missing documentation of the
+interface they often looked into the code and then used internal commands not meant as public
+command.
<!--l. 359--><p class="indent" > The following tries to describe the existing variables and commands that can be viewed as public
interfaces or which should or can be set by packages to stay compatible with the <span
class="ec-lmss-10">hyperref </span>command.
@@ -561,19 +659,19 @@
Documented user commands are naturally interfaces too, they are not explicitly mentioned here
again.
<!--l. 364--><p class="indent" > This section is work in progress. Suggestions or comments are welcome.
-<!--l. 366--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 367--><p class="noindent" >
<h4 class="subsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">4.1 </span> <a
id="x1-70004.1"></a>Counters</h4>
-<!--l. 367--><p class="noindent" >Counters play an important part in the code. They are used to create destination names and to
+<!--l. 368--><p class="noindent" >Counters play an important part in the code. They are used to create destination names and to
define hierarchies like the bookmarks. To work correctly often they require some additional
setups.
-<!--l. 371--><p class="indent" >
+<!--l. 372--><p class="indent" >
<dl class="description"><dt class="description">
- <!--l. 373--><p class="noindent" >
+ <!--l. 374--><p class="noindent" >
<span
class="ec-lmvtk-10">\theH<counter></span> </dt><dd
class="description">
- <!--l. 373--><p class="noindent" ><span
+ <!--l. 374--><p class="noindent" ><span
class="ec-lmss-10">hyperref </span>creates destination names for link anchor typically out of the name of the counter
and the <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\the<counter> </span>value. This can fail, e.g. if <span
@@ -580,16 +678,16 @@
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\the<counter> </span>is not unique through the
document, or if it is not expandable. In such cases <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\theH<counter> </span>should be defined so
+
that it gives a unique, expandable value. It doesn’t harm to define it even if <span
class="ec-lmss-10">hyperref </span>is not
- loaded.
-
+ loaded.
</dd><dt class="description">
- <!--l. 380--><p class="noindent" >
+ <!--l. 381--><p class="noindent" >
<span
class="ec-lmvtk-10">\toclevel@<counter></span> </dt><dd
class="description">
- <!--l. 380--><p class="noindent" >This is a variable which should contain a number. It is used for the level in the bookmarks.
+ <!--l. 381--><p class="noindent" >This is a variable which should contain a number. It is used for the level in the bookmarks.
It should be defined for all counters which are used in toc like lists and <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\addcontentsline</span>.
Typical values are
@@ -605,12 +703,12 @@
\def\toclevel at subparagraph{5}
\def\toclevel at figure{0}
</pre>
- <!--l. 393--><p class="nopar" >
+ <!--l. 394--><p class="nopar" >
</dd></dl>
-<!--l. 397--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 398--><p class="noindent" >
<h4 class="subsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">4.2 </span> <a
id="x1-80004.2"></a>Links commands</h4>
-<!--l. 398--><p class="noindent" >The following commands are provided by all drivers to create links. They can be used by packages if the
+<!--l. 399--><p class="noindent" >The following commands are provided by all drivers to create links. They can be used by packages if the
user commands are not sufficient. New drivers must provide this commands with similar
arguments.
@@ -627,11 +725,161 @@
 \hyper at linklaunch{filename} {link text} {Parameters}  %Launch, only with new generic driver
 \hyper at linknamed {action}{link text}                  %Named, only with new generic driver
</pre>
-<!--l. 413--><p class="nopar" >
+<!--l. 414--><p class="nopar" >
<!--l. 416--><p class="noindent" >
+ <h4 class="subsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">4.3 </span> <a
+ id="x1-90004.3"></a>Creating targets</h4>
+<!--l. 418--><p class="noindent" >Internal links and bookmarks need something they can jump to. In a PDF this is normally called a
+<span
+class="ec-lmri-10">destination </span>(and the primitive is therefor called <span
+class="ec-lmvtt-10">\pdfdest</span>), in HTML it is more common to call this an
+<span
+class="ec-lmri-10">anchor </span>(and the <span
+class="ec-lmss-10">hyperref </span>uses therefor <span
+class="ec-lmvtt-10">\hyper at anchor</span>). History can not be undone but future
+commands and descriptions will use the generic <span
+class="ec-lmri-10">target </span>unless the PDF specific destination is
+meant.
+<!--l. 424--><p class="indent" > Targets are created automatically when <span
+class="ec-lmvtt-10">\refstepcounter </span>is used and in many cases this does the right
+thing and nothing more is needed. But there are exceptions:
+ <ul class="itemize1">
+ <li class="itemize">
+ <!--l. 428--><p class="noindent" >A needed target can be missing for example if a sectioning command doesn’t have a number
+ as the starred version is used or due to the setting of <span
+class="ec-lmvtt-10">secnumdepth</span>.
+ </li>
+ <li class="itemize">
+ <!--l. 431--><p class="noindent" >The target created by the <span
+class="ec-lmvtt-10">\refstepcounter </span>can be in the wrong place.
+ </li>
+ <li class="itemize">
+ <!--l. 432--><p class="noindent" >The target created by the <span
+class="ec-lmvtt-10">\refstepcounter </span>can affect spacing.
+ </li>
+ <li class="itemize">
+ <!--l. 433--><p class="noindent" >The target name created by the <span
+class="ec-lmvtt-10">\refstepcounter </span>is not usable, e.g. in <span
+class="ec-lmvtt-10">\bibitem </span>where you
+ need a target name bases on the bib-key.</li></ul>
+<!--l. 437--><p class="indent" > Package authors and users can use the following commands to create and manipulate targets. The
+commands are described in more detail in <span
+class="ec-lmvtt-10">hyperref-linktarget.pdf</span>.
+
+
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-4">
+ \MakeLinkTarget
+ \LinkTargetOff
+ \LinkTargetOn
+ \NextLinkTarget
+ \SetLinkTargetFilter
+</pre>
+<!--l. 446--><p class="nopar" >
+<!--l. 448--><p class="indent" > The first four commands will be defined also in LaTeX directly as no-op and so can be used even if
+<span
+class="ec-lmss-10">hyperref </span>is not loaded.
+<!--l. 451--><p class="indent" > Until LaTeX is updated package authors can also provide these definitions directly:
+
+
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-5">
+\ProvideDocumentCommand\MakeLinkTarget{sO{}m}{}
+\ProvideDocumentCommand\LinkTargetOn{}{}
+\ProvideDocumentCommand\LinkTargetOff{}{}
+\ProvideDocumentCommand\NextLinkTarget{m}{}
+</pre>
+<!--l. 458--><p class="nopar" >
+<!--l. 460--><p class="noindent" >
+ <h4 class="subsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">4.4 </span> <a
+ id="x1-100004.4"></a>Patches and how to suppress them</h4>
+<!--l. 462--><p class="noindent" >The patches to external commands made by <span
+class="ec-lmss-10">hyperref </span>can be avoided in toto by loading <span
+class="ec-lmss-10">hyperref </span>with the
+option <span
+class="ec-lmvtt-10">implicit=false</span>. But suppressing everything is often too drastic. There is a work in
+progress to classify the patches and to offer interfaces to suppress them in a more granular
+way.
+<!--l. 469--><p class="indent" >
+ <dl class="description"><dt class="description">
+ <!--l. 470--><p class="noindent" >
+<span
+class="ec-lmbx-10">sectioning commands</span> </dt><dd
+class="description">
+ <!--l. 470--><p class="noindent" >
+ <ul class="itemize1">
+ <li class="itemize">
+ <!--l. 472--><p class="noindent" >hyperref patches <span
+class="ec-lmvtt-10">\@sect</span>, <span
+class="ec-lmvtt-10">\@ssect</span>, <span
+class="ec-lmvtt-10">\@chapter</span>, <span
+class="ec-lmvtt-10">\@schapter</span>, <span
+class="ec-lmvtt-10">\@part</span>, <span
+class="ec-lmvtt-10">\@spart</span>.
+ </li>
+ <li class="itemize">
+ <!--l. 475--><p class="noindent" >It adds to the starred commands a target for a link (with the prefix <span
+class="ec-lmvtt-10">chapter* </span>for
+ chapters and <span
+class="ec-lmvtt-10">section* </span>otherwise). To the other commands it adds a target for a link if
+ the sectioning is unnumbered, e.g. because of the <span
+class="ec-lmvtt-10">secnumdepth </span>setting or in the front
+ matter.
+ </li>
+ <li class="itemize">
+ <!--l. 481--><p class="noindent" >The patch can be suppressed by defining the command <span
+class="ec-lmvtt-10">\hyper at nopatch@sectioning</span>.
+ This should normally be done only by a class or a package which provides sectioning
+ commands and adds the targets itself. Targets have a location on the page and e.g. the
+ section commands should take indents into account. Targets are needed for bookmarks
+ and the table of contents, so <span
+class="ec-lmvtt-10">\@currentHref </span>should get the correct meaning before
+ <span
+class="ec-lmvtt-10">\addcontentsline </span>is used.
+ </li>
+ <li class="itemize">
+ <!--l. 489--><p class="noindent" >Note that the <span
+class="ec-lmss-10">nameref </span>package patches these commands too to add commands to store
+ the title text in <span
+class="ec-lmvtt-10">\@currentlabelname</span>. Check the <span
+class="ec-lmss-10">nameref </span>documentation about a way
+ to suppress these patches.</li></ul>
+ </dd><dt class="description">
+ <!--l. 494--><p class="noindent" >
+<span
+class="ec-lmbx-10">footnotes</span> </dt><dd
+class="description">
+
+ <!--l. 494--><p class="noindent" >To enable (partly) the linking of footnotes hyperref redefines or patches various commands, in part
+ package dependant.
+ <ul class="itemize1">
+ <li class="itemize">
+ <!--l. 496--><p class="noindent" >hyperref redefines <span
+class="ec-lmvtt-10">\@xfootnotenext</span>, <span
+class="ec-lmvtt-10">\@xfootnotemark</span>,
+ <span
+class="ec-lmvtt-10">\@mpfootnotetext</span>, <span
+class="ec-lmvtt-10">\@footnotetext</span>, <span
+class="ec-lmvtt-10">\@footnotemark</span>. If <span
+class="ec-lmss-10">tabularx </span>is loaded it changes
+ <span
+class="ec-lmvtt-10">\TX at endtabularx</span>. If <span
+class="ec-lmss-10">longtable </span>is loaded it changes <span
+class="ec-lmvtt-10">\LT at p@ftntext</span>. If <span
+class="ec-lmss-10">fancyvfb </span>is
+ loaded it redefines <span
+class="ec-lmvtt-10">\V@@footnotetext</span>. It also redefines <span
+class="ec-lmvtt-10">\footref </span>and <span
+class="ec-lmvtt-10">\maketitle</span>.
+ </li>
+ <li class="itemize">
+ <!--l. 501--><p class="noindent" ><span
+class="ec-lmri-10">All </span>those redefinitions can be suppressed by defining <span
+class="ec-lmvtt-10">\hyper at nopatch@footnote</span>. Be
+ aware that this can suppress links but also make unwanted links appear.</li></ul>
+ </dd></dl>
+<!--l. 506--><p class="noindent" >
<h3 class="sectionHead"><span class="titlemark">5 </span> <a
- id="x1-90005"></a>Package options</h3>
-<!--l. 418--><p class="noindent" >All user-configurable aspects of <span
+ id="x1-110005"></a>Package options</h3>
+<!--l. 508--><p class="noindent" >All user-configurable aspects of <span
class="ec-lmss-10">hyperref </span>are set using a single ‘key=value’ scheme (using the <span
class="ec-lmss-10">keyval</span>
package) with the key <span
@@ -642,7 +890,7 @@
<span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">hyperref.cfg </span>is read if it can be found, and this is a convenient place to set options on a site-wide
basis.
-<!--l. 426--><p class="indent" > Note however that some options (for example <span
+<!--l. 516--><p class="indent" > Note however that some options (for example <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">unicode</span>) can only be used as package options, and not
in <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\hypersetup</span></span></span> as the option settings are processed as the package is read. The following
@@ -659,13 +907,13 @@
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-2-1-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-1-1"
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">option </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-1-2"
-class="td11"> <!--l. 433--><p class="noindent" >remark </td>
+class="td11"> <!--l. 523--><p class="noindent" >remark </td>
</tr><tr
class="hline"><td><hr></td><td><hr></td></tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-2-2-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-2-1"
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">all driver options, e.g. pdftex </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-2-2"
-class="td11"> <!--l. 434--><p class="noindent" >often
+class="td11"> <!--l. 524--><p class="noindent" >often
not
needed,
as
@@ -679,7 +927,7 @@
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-2-4-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-4-1"
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">pdfa </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-4-2"
-class="td11"> <!--l. 436--><p class="noindent" >no-op
+class="td11"> <!--l. 526--><p class="noindent" >no-op
with
new
pdfmanagement,
@@ -693,7 +941,7 @@
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-2-5-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-5-1"
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">unicode </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-5-2"
-class="td11"> <!--l. 437--><p class="noindent" >is
+class="td11"> <!--l. 527--><p class="noindent" >is
the
default
now
@@ -702,7 +950,7 @@
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-2-6-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-6-1"
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">pdfversion </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-6-2"
-class="td11"> <!--l. 438--><p class="noindent" >no-op
+class="td11"> <!--l. 528--><p class="noindent" >no-op
with
new
pdfmanagement,
@@ -716,7 +964,7 @@
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-2-7-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-7-1"
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">bookmarks </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-7-2"
-class="td11"> <!--l. 439--><p class="noindent" >this
+class="td11"> <!--l. 529--><p class="noindent" >this
will
probably
change
@@ -727,55 +975,55 @@
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-2-8-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-8-1"
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">backref </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-8-2"
-class="td11"> <!--l. 441--><p class="noindent" > </td></tr><tr
+class="td11"> <!--l. 531--><p class="noindent" > </td></tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-2-9-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-9-1"
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">pagebackref </span></td> <td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-9-2"
-class="td11"> <!--l. 442--><p class="noindent" ></td>
+class="td11"> <!--l. 532--><p class="noindent" ></td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-2-10-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-10-1"
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">destlabel </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-10-2"
-class="td11"> <!--l. 443--><p class="noindent" > </td></tr><tr
+class="td11"> <!--l. 533--><p class="noindent" > </td></tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-2-11-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-11-1"
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">pdfusetitle </span></td> <td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-11-2"
-class="td11"> <!--l. 444--><p class="noindent" ></td>
+class="td11"> <!--l. 534--><p class="noindent" ></td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-2-12-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-12-1"
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">pdfpagelabels </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-12-2"
-class="td11"> <!--l. 445--><p class="noindent" > </td>
+class="td11"> <!--l. 535--><p class="noindent" > </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-2-13-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-13-1"
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">hyperfootnotes </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-13-2"
-class="td11"> <!--l. 446--><p class="noindent" > </td>
+class="td11"> <!--l. 536--><p class="noindent" > </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-2-14-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-14-1"
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">hyperfigures </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-14-2"
-class="td11"> <!--l. 447--><p class="noindent" > </td>
+class="td11"> <!--l. 537--><p class="noindent" > </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-2-15-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-15-1"
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">hyperindex </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-15-2"
-class="td11"> <!--l. 448--><p class="noindent" > </td>
+class="td11"> <!--l. 538--><p class="noindent" > </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-2-16-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-16-1"
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">encap </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-16-2"
-class="td11"> <!--l. 449--><p class="noindent" > </td>
+class="td11"> <!--l. 539--><p class="noindent" > </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-2-17-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-17-1"
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">typexml </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-17-2"
-class="td11"> <!--l. 450--><p class="noindent" > </td>
+class="td11"> <!--l. 540--><p class="noindent" > </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-2-18-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-18-1"
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">CJKbookmarks </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-18-2"
-class="td11"> <!--l. 450--><p class="noindent" >only
+class="td11"> <!--l. 540--><p class="noindent" >only
with
the
new
@@ -794,7 +1042,7 @@
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-2-19-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-19-1"
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">psdextra </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-19-2"
-class="td11"> <!--l. 451--><p class="noindent" >only
+class="td11"> <!--l. 541--><p class="noindent" >only
with
the
new
@@ -813,7 +1061,7 @@
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-2-20-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-20-1"
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">nesting </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-20-2"
-class="td11"> <!--l. 452--><p class="noindent" >only
+class="td11"> <!--l. 542--><p class="noindent" >only
with
the
new
@@ -839,47 +1087,47 @@
use) </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-2-21-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-21-1"
-class="td11"> </td> </tr></table>
+class="td11"> </td> </tr></table> </div>
-</div>
-<!--l. 457--><p class="indent" > As an example, the behavior of a particular file could be controlled by:
+
+<!--l. 547--><p class="indent" > As an example, the behavior of a particular file could be controlled by:
<ul class="itemize1">
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 460--><p class="noindent" >a site-wide <span
+ <!--l. 550--><p class="noindent" >a site-wide <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">hyperref.cfg </span>setting up the look of links, adding backreferencing, and setting a
PDF display default:
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-4">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-6">
\hypersetup{backref,
pdfpagemode=FullScreen,
colorlinks=true}
</pre>
- <!--l. 467--><p class="nopar" >
+ <!--l. 557--><p class="nopar" >
</li>
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 469--><p class="noindent" >A global option in the file, which is passed down to <span
+ <!--l. 559--><p class="noindent" >A global option in the file, which is passed down to <span
class="ec-lmss-10">hyperref</span>:
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-5">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-7">
\documentclass[dvips]{article}
</pre>
- <!--l. 474--><p class="nopar" >
+ <!--l. 564--><p class="nopar" >
</li>
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 476--><p class="noindent" >File-specific options in the <span
+ <!--l. 566--><p class="noindent" >File-specific options in the <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\usepackage </span>commands, which override the ones set in
<span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">hyperref.cfg</span>:
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-6">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-8">
\usepackage[colorlinks=false]{hyperref}
\hypersetup{pdftitle={A Perfect Day}}
</pre>
- <!--l. 482--><p class="nopar" ></li></ul>
-<!--l. 485--><p class="indent" > As seen in the previous example, information entries (pdftitle, pdfauthor, …) should be set after the
+ <!--l. 572--><p class="nopar" ></li></ul>
+<!--l. 575--><p class="indent" > As seen in the previous example, information entries (pdftitle, pdfauthor, …) should be set after the
package is loaded. Otherwise LaTeX expands the values of these options prematurely. Also LaTeX strips
spaces in options. Especially option ‘pdfborder’ requires some care. Curly braces protect the value, if
given as package option. They are not necessary in <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
@@ -886,25 +1134,25 @@
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\hypersetup</span></span></span>.
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-7">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-9">
\usepackage[pdfborder={0 0 0}]{hyperref}
\hypersetup{pdfborder=0 0 0}
</pre>
-<!--l. 495--><p class="nopar" >
-<!--l. 497--><p class="indent" > Some options can be given at any time, but many are restricted: before <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+<!--l. 585--><p class="nopar" >
+<!--l. 587--><p class="indent" > Some options can be given at any time, but many are restricted: before <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\begin{document}</span></span></span>, only in
<span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\usepackage[...]{hyperref}</span></span></span>, before first use, etc.
-<!--l. 501--><p class="indent" > In the key descriptions that follow, many options do not need a value, as they default to the value
+<!--l. 591--><p class="indent" > In the key descriptions that follow, many options do not need a value, as they default to the value
true if used. These are the ones classed as ‘boolean’. The values true and false can always be specified,
however.
-<!--l. 505--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 595--><p class="noindent" >
<h4 class="subsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">5.1 </span> <a
- id="x1-100005.1"></a>General options</h4>
-<!--l. 507--><p class="noindent" >Firstly, the options to specify general behavior and page size.
-<!--l. 510--><p class="indent" >
+ id="x1-120005.1"></a>General options</h4>
+<!--l. 597--><p class="noindent" >Firstly, the options to specify general behavior and page size.
+<!--l. 600--><p class="indent" >
<a
- id="x1-10001r1"></a> <!--l. 511--><div class="longtable"> <table id="TBL-3" class="longtable"
+ id="x1-12001r1"></a> <!--l. 601--><div class="longtable"> <table id="TBL-3" class="longtable"
><colgroup id="TBL-3-1g"><col
id="TBL-3-1"><col
@@ -981,37 +1229,37 @@
class="td11"> </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-11-4"
class="td11"></td></tr>
</table></div>
-<!--l. 520--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 610--><p class="noindent" >
<h4 class="subsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">5.2 </span> <a
- id="x1-110005.2"></a>Options for destination names</h4>
-<!--l. 522--><p class="noindent" >Destinations names (also anchor, target or link names) are internal names that identify a position on a
+ id="x1-130005.2"></a>Options for destination names</h4>
+<!--l. 612--><p class="noindent" >Destinations names (also anchor, target or link names) are internal names that identify a position on a
page in the document. They are used in link targets for inner document links or the bookmarks, for
example.
-<!--l. 527--><p class="indent" > Usually anchor are set, if <span
+<!--l. 617--><p class="indent" > Usually anchor are set, if <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\refstepcounter </span>is called. Thus there is a counter name and value. Both are
used to construct the destination name. By default the counter value follows the counter name separated
by a dot. Example for the fourth chapter:
<blockquote class="quote">
- <!--l. 533--><p class="noindent" ><span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+ <!--l. 623--><p class="noindent" ><span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">chapter.4</span></span></span></blockquote>
-<!--l. 535--><p class="noindent" >This scheme is used by:
+<!--l. 625--><p class="noindent" >This scheme is used by:
<dl class="description"><dt class="description">
- <!--l. 537--><p class="noindent" >
+ <!--l. 627--><p class="noindent" >
<span
class="ec-lmvtk-10">\autoref</span> </dt><dd
class="description">
- <!--l. 537--><p class="noindent" >displays the description label for the reference depending on the counter name.
+ <!--l. 627--><p class="noindent" >displays the description label for the reference depending on the counter name.
</dd><dt class="description">
- <!--l. 539--><p class="noindent" >
+ <!--l. 629--><p class="noindent" >
<span
class="ec-lmvtk-10">\hyperpage</span> </dt><dd
class="description">
- <!--l. 539--><p class="noindent" >is used by the index to get page links. Page anchor setting (<span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+ <!--l. 629--><p class="noindent" >is used by the index to get page links. Page anchor setting (<span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">pageanchor</span></span></span>) must not be turned
off.</dd></dl>
-<!--l. 544--><p class="indent" > It is very important that the destination names are unique, because two destinations must not share
+<!--l. 634--><p class="indent" > It is very important that the destination names are unique, because two destinations must not share
the same name. The counter value <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\the<counter> </span>is not always unique for the counter. For example,
table and figures can be numbered inside the chapter without having the chapter number in their
@@ -1027,7 +1275,7 @@
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\theHtable </span>that gives <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">2.4</span></span></span> in this
case.
-<!--l. 557--><p class="indent" > Often the user do not need to set <span
+<!--l. 647--><p class="indent" > Often the user do not need to set <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\theH<counter></span>. Defaults for standard cases (chapter, …) are
provided. And after <span
class="ec-lmss-10">hyperref </span>is loaded, new counters with parent counters also define <span
@@ -1038,7 +1286,7 @@
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\numberwithin </span>of package <span
class="ec-lmss-10">amsmath </span>are
used.
-<!--l. 563--><p class="indent" > Usually problems with duplicate destination names can be solved by an appropriate definition of
+<!--l. 653--><p class="indent" > Usually problems with duplicate destination names can be solved by an appropriate definition of
<span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\theH<counter></span>. If option <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">hypertexnames </span>is disabled, then a unique artificial number is used instead of
@@ -1047,11 +1295,11 @@
page anchors use the arabic form. In both latter cases <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\hyperpage </span>for index links is affected and might
not work properly.
-<!--l. 571--><p class="indent" > If an unnumbered entity gets an anchor (starred forms of chapters, sections, …) or <span
+<!--l. 661--><p class="indent" > If an unnumbered entity gets an anchor (starred forms of chapters, sections, …) or <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\phantomsection </span>is
used, then the dummy counter name <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">section* </span>and an artificial unique number is used.
-<!--l. 576--><p class="indent" > If the final PDF file is going to be merged with another file, than the destination names might clash,
+<!--l. 666--><p class="indent" > If the final PDF file is going to be merged with another file, than the destination names might clash,
because both documents might contain <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">chapter.1 </span>or <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">page.1</span>. Also <span
@@ -1066,24 +1314,24 @@
<blockquote class="quote">
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-8">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-10">
\renewcommand*{\HyperDestNameFilter}[1]{\jobname-#1}
</pre>
- <!--l. 589--><p class="nopar" ></blockquote>
-<!--l. 591--><p class="noindent" >In document <span
+ <!--l. 679--><p class="nopar" ></blockquote>
+<!--l. 681--><p class="noindent" >In document <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">docA </span>the destination name <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">chapter.2 </span>becomes <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">docA-chapter.2</span>.
-<!--l. 594--><p class="indent" > Destination names can also be used from the outside in URIs(, if the driver has not removed or
+<!--l. 684--><p class="indent" > Destination names can also be used from the outside in URIs(, if the driver has not removed or
changed them), for example:
<blockquote class="quote">
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-9">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-11">
http://somewhere/path/file.pdf#nameddest=chapter.4
</pre>
- <!--l. 599--><p class="nopar" ></blockquote>
-<!--l. 601--><p class="noindent" >However using a number seems unhappy. If another chapter is added before, the number changes. But it is
+ <!--l. 689--><p class="nopar" ></blockquote>
+<!--l. 691--><p class="noindent" >However using a number seems unhappy. If another chapter is added before, the number changes. But it is
very difficult to pass a new name for the destination to the anchor setting process that is usually
deep hidden in the internals. The first name of <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\label </span>after the anchor setting seems a good
@@ -1091,12 +1339,12 @@
<blockquote class="quote">
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-10">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-12">
  \section{Introduction}
  \label{intro}
</pre>
- <!--l. 610--><p class="nopar" ></blockquote>
-<!--l. 612--><p class="noindent" >Option <span
+ <!--l. 700--><p class="nopar" ></blockquote>
+<!--l. 702--><p class="noindent" >Option <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">destlabel </span>checks for each <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\label</span>, if there is a new destination name active and replaces the
destination name by the label name. Because the destination name is already in use because of the
@@ -1113,13 +1361,13 @@
<blockquote class="quote">
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-11">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-13">
\renewcommand*{\HyperDestNameFilter}[1]{%
  \jobname-\HyperDestLabelReplace{#1}%
}
</pre>
- <!--l. 627--><p class="nopar" ></blockquote>
-<!--l. 629--><p class="noindent" >The other case that only files prefixed that do not have a corresponding <span
+ <!--l. 717--><p class="nopar" ></blockquote>
+<!--l. 719--><p class="noindent" >The other case that only files prefixed that do not have a corresponding <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\label </span>is more complicate, because
<span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\HyperDestLabelReplace </span>needs the unmodified destination name as argument. This is solved by an
@@ -1131,7 +1379,7 @@
<blockquote class="quote">
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-12">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-14">
\usepackage{pdftexcmds}
\makeatletter
\renewcommand*{\HyperDestNameFilter}[1]{%
@@ -1143,12 +1391,12 @@
}
\makeatother
</pre>
- <!--l. 647--><p class="nopar" ></blockquote>
-<!--l. 650--><p class="indent" > With option <span
+ <!--l. 737--><p class="nopar" ></blockquote>
+<!--l. 740--><p class="indent" > With option <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">destlabel </span>destinations can also named manually, if the destination is not yet
renamed:
<blockquote class="quote">
- <!--l. 653--><p class="noindent" ><span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+ <!--l. 743--><p class="noindent" ><span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\HyperDestRename{</span></span></span><span
class="lmsy-10">⟨</span><span
class="ec-lmvtto-10">destination</span><span
@@ -1158,11 +1406,11 @@
class="ec-lmvtto-10">newname</span><span
class="lmsy-10">⟩</span><span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">}</span></span></span></blockquote>
-<!--l. 656--><p class="indent" > Hint: Anchors can also be named and set by <span
+<!--l. 746--><p class="indent" > Hint: Anchors can also be named and set by <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\hypertarget</span>.
-<!--l. 659--><p class="indent" >
+<!--l. 749--><p class="indent" >
<a
- id="x1-11001r2"></a> <!--l. 660--><div class="longtable"> <table id="TBL-4" class="longtable"
+ id="x1-13001r2"></a> <!--l. 750--><div class="longtable"> <table id="TBL-4" class="longtable"
><colgroup id="TBL-4-1g"><col
id="TBL-4-1"><col
@@ -1233,12 +1481,12 @@
class="td11"> </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-4-11-4"
class="td11"></td></tr>
</table></div>
-<!--l. 668--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 758--><p class="noindent" >
<h4 class="subsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">5.3 </span> <a
- id="x1-120005.3"></a>Configuration options</h4>
-<!--l. 670--><p class="noindent" >
+ id="x1-140005.3"></a>Configuration options</h4>
+<!--l. 760--><p class="noindent" >
<a
- id="x1-12001r3"></a> <!--l. 671--><div class="longtable"> <table id="TBL-5" class="longtable"
+ id="x1-14001r3"></a> <!--l. 761--><div class="longtable"> <table id="TBL-5" class="longtable"
><colgroup id="TBL-5-1g"><col
id="TBL-5-1"><col
@@ -1253,7 +1501,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">true </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-5-1-4"
class="td11">
- <!--l. 671--><p class="noindent" >In the hypertex driver, the height of links is normally
+ <!--l. 761--><p class="noindent" >In the hypertex driver, the height of links is normally
calculated by the driver as simply the base line of contained
text; this options forces <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\special</span></span></span> commands to reflect the
@@ -1266,7 +1514,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">both </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-5-2-4"
class="td11">
- <!--l. 674--><p class="noindent" >This option is in hyperref only used in the dviwindo driver,
+ <!--l. 764--><p class="noindent" >This option is in hyperref only used in the dviwindo driver,
in all other cases it doesn’t do anything sensible—it neither
allows nor prevents links to be broken. The ocgx2 package
checks the state of the boolean. </td>
@@ -1280,7 +1528,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">true </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-5-3-4"
class="td11">
- <!--l. 676--><p class="noindent" >Determines whether every page is given an implicit anchor
+ <!--l. 766--><p class="noindent" >Determines whether every page is given an implicit anchor
at the top left corner. If this is turned off, <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\printindex</span></span></span> will
not contain valid hyperlinks. </td>
@@ -1292,7 +1540,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">false </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-5-4-4"
class="td11">
- <!--l. 679--><p class="noindent" >Allows links to be nested; no drivers currently support this. </td>
+ <!--l. 769--><p class="noindent" >Allows links to be nested; no drivers currently support this. </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-5-5-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-5-5-1"
class="td11"> </td>
@@ -1309,35 +1557,35 @@
class="td11"> </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-5-8-4"
class="td11"></td></tr>
</table></div>
-<!--l. 682--><p class="noindent" >Note for option <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+<!--l. 772--><p class="noindent" >Note for option <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">breaklinks</span></span></span>: The correct value is automatically set according to the driver features. It can
be overwritten for drivers that do not support broken links. However, at any case, the link area will be
wrong and displaced.
-<!--l. 687--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 777--><p class="noindent" >
<h4 class="subsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">5.4 </span> <a
- id="x1-130005.4"></a>Backend drivers</h4>
-<!--l. 689--><p class="noindent" >If no driver is specified, the package tries to find a driver in the following order:
+ id="x1-150005.4"></a>Backend drivers</h4>
+<!--l. 779--><p class="noindent" >If no driver is specified, the package tries to find a driver in the following order:
<ol class="enumerate1" >
<li
- class="enumerate" id="x1-13002x1">
- <!--l. 692--><p class="noindent" >Autodetection, some TeX processors can be detected at TeX macro level (pdfTeX, XeTeX,
+ class="enumerate" id="x1-15002x1">
+ <!--l. 782--><p class="noindent" >Autodetection, some TeX processors can be detected at TeX macro level (pdfTeX, XeTeX,
VTeX).
</li>
<li
- class="enumerate" id="x1-13004x2">
- <!--l. 694--><p class="noindent" >Option <span
+ class="enumerate" id="x1-15004x2">
+ <!--l. 784--><p class="noindent" >Option <span
class="ec-lmss-10">driverfallback</span>. If this option is set, its value is taken as driver option.
</li>
<li
- class="enumerate" id="x1-13006x3">
- <!--l. 696--><p class="noindent" >Macro <span
+ class="enumerate" id="x1-15006x3">
+ <!--l. 786--><p class="noindent" >Macro <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\Hy at defaultdriver</span>. The macro takes a driver file name (without file extension).
</li>
<li
- class="enumerate" id="x1-13008x4">
- <!--l. 698--><p class="noindent" >Package default is <span
+ class="enumerate" id="x1-15008x4">
+ <!--l. 788--><p class="noindent" >Package default is <span
class="ec-lmss-10">hypertex</span>.</li></ol>
-<!--l. 700--><p class="noindent" >Many distributions are using a driver file <span
+<!--l. 790--><p class="noindent" >Many distributions are using a driver file <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">hypertex.cfg </span>that define <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\Hy at defaultdriver </span>with <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">hdvips</span>. This
@@ -1345,9 +1593,9 @@
class="ec-lmss-10">dvips </span>provides much more features than <span
class="ec-lmss-10">hypertex </span>for PDF
generation.
-<!--l. 705--><p class="indent" >
+<!--l. 795--><p class="indent" >
<a
- id="x1-13009r4"></a> <!--l. 706--><div class="longtable"> <table id="TBL-6" class="longtable"
+ id="x1-15009r4"></a> <!--l. 796--><div class="longtable"> <table id="TBL-6" class="longtable"
><colgroup id="TBL-6-1g"><col
id="TBL-6-1"><col
@@ -1357,18 +1605,18 @@
class="td01"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">driverfallback </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-6-1-2"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 706--><p class="noindent" >Its value is used as driver option </td>
+ <!--l. 796--><p class="noindent" >Its value is used as driver option </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-6-2-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-6-2-1"
class="td01"> </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-6-2-2"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 707--><p class="noindent" >if the driver is not given or autodetected. </td>
+ <!--l. 797--><p class="noindent" >if the driver is not given or autodetected. </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-6-3-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-6-3-1"
class="td01"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">dvipdfm </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-6-3-2"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 708--><p class="noindent" >Sets up <span
+ <!--l. 798--><p class="noindent" >Sets up <span
class="ec-lmss-10">hyperref </span>for use with the <span
class="ec-lmss-10">dvipdfm </span>driver. </td>
</tr><tr
@@ -1376,7 +1624,7 @@
class="td01"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">dvipdfmx </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-6-4-2"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 709--><p class="noindent" >Sets up <span
+ <!--l. 799--><p class="noindent" >Sets up <span
class="ec-lmss-10">hyperref </span>for use with the <span
class="ec-lmss-10">dvipdfmx </span>driver. </td>
@@ -1386,7 +1634,7 @@
class="td01"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">dvips </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-6-5-2"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 710--><p class="noindent" >Sets up <span
+ <!--l. 800--><p class="noindent" >Sets up <span
class="ec-lmss-10">hyperref </span>for use with the <span
class="ec-lmss-10">dvips </span>driver. </td>
</tr><tr
@@ -1394,7 +1642,7 @@
class="td01"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">dvipsone </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-6-6-2"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 711--><p class="noindent" >Sets up <span
+ <!--l. 801--><p class="noindent" >Sets up <span
class="ec-lmss-10">hyperref </span>for use with the <span
class="ec-lmss-10">dvipsone </span>driver. </td>
</tr><tr
@@ -1402,7 +1650,7 @@
class="td01"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">dviwindo </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-6-7-2"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 712--><p class="noindent" >Sets up <span
+ <!--l. 802--><p class="noindent" >Sets up <span
class="ec-lmss-10">hyperref </span>for use with the <span
class="ec-lmss-10">dviwindo </span>Windows previewer. </td>
</tr><tr
@@ -1410,7 +1658,7 @@
class="td01"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">hypertex </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-6-8-2"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 713--><p class="noindent" >Sets up <span
+ <!--l. 803--><p class="noindent" >Sets up <span
class="ec-lmss-10">hyperref </span>for use with the HyperTeX-compliant drivers. </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-6-9-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-6-9-1"
@@ -1417,7 +1665,7 @@
class="td01"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">latex2html </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-6-9-2"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 714--><p class="noindent" >Redefines a few macros for compatibility with <span
+ <!--l. 804--><p class="noindent" >Redefines a few macros for compatibility with <span
class="ec-lmss-10">latex2html</span>. </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-6-10-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-6-10-1"
@@ -1424,7 +1672,7 @@
class="td01"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">nativepdf </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-6-10-2"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 715--><p class="noindent" >An alias for <span
+ <!--l. 805--><p class="noindent" >An alias for <span
class="ec-lmss-10">dvips</span> </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-6-11-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-6-11-1"
@@ -1431,7 +1679,7 @@
class="td01"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">pdfmark </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-6-11-2"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 716--><p class="noindent" >An alias for <span
+ <!--l. 806--><p class="noindent" >An alias for <span
class="ec-lmss-10">dvips</span> </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-6-12-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-6-12-1"
@@ -1438,7 +1686,7 @@
class="td01"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">pdftex </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-6-12-2"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 717--><p class="noindent" >Sets up <span
+ <!--l. 807--><p class="noindent" >Sets up <span
class="ec-lmss-10">hyperref </span>for use with the <span
class="ec-lmss-10">pdftex </span>program. </td>
</tr><tr
@@ -1446,7 +1694,7 @@
class="td01"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">ps2pdf </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-6-13-2"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 718--><p class="noindent" >Redefines a few macros for compatibility with Ghostscript’s PDF writer,
+ <!--l. 808--><p class="noindent" >Redefines a few macros for compatibility with Ghostscript’s PDF writer,
otherwise identical to <span
class="ec-lmss-10">dvips</span>. </td>
</tr><tr
@@ -1454,7 +1702,7 @@
class="td01"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">tex4ht </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-6-14-2"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 721--><p class="noindent" >For use with <span
+ <!--l. 811--><p class="noindent" >For use with <span
class="ec-lmss-10">TeX4ht</span> </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-6-15-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-6-15-1"
@@ -1461,7 +1709,7 @@
class="td01"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">textures </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-6-15-2"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 722--><p class="noindent" >For use with <span
+ <!--l. 812--><p class="noindent" >For use with <span
class="ec-lmss-10">Textures</span> </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-6-16-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-6-16-1"
@@ -1468,7 +1716,7 @@
class="td01"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">vtex </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-6-16-2"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 723--><p class="noindent" >For use with MicroPress’ <span
+ <!--l. 813--><p class="noindent" >For use with MicroPress’ <span
class="ec-lmss-10">VTeX</span>; the PDF and HTML backends are detected
automatically. </td>
</tr><tr
@@ -1476,7 +1724,7 @@
class="td01"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">vtexpdfmark </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-6-17-2"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 725--><p class="noindent" >For use with <span
+ <!--l. 815--><p class="noindent" >For use with <span
class="ec-lmss-10">VTeX</span>’s PostScript backend. </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-6-18-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-6-18-1"
@@ -1483,7 +1731,7 @@
class="td01"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">xetex </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-6-18-2"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 726--><p class="noindent" >For use with XeTeX (using backend for dvipdfm). </td>
+ <!--l. 816--><p class="noindent" >For use with XeTeX (using backend for dvipdfm). </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-6-19-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-6-19-1"
class="td01"> </td>
@@ -1498,7 +1746,7 @@
class="td01"> </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-6-22-2"
class="td10"></td></tr>
</table></div>
-<!--l. 730--><p class="indent" > If you use <span
+<!--l. 820--><p class="indent" > If you use <span
class="ec-lmss-10">dviwindo</span>, you may need to redefine the macro <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\wwwbrowser </span>(the default is
<span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
@@ -1507,18 +1755,18 @@
add something like this to hyperref.cfg:
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-13">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-15">
\renewcommand{\wwwbrowser}{C:\string\Program\space
  Files\string\Plus!\string\Microsoft\space
  Internet\string\iexplore.exe}
</pre>
-<!--l. 739--><p class="nopar" >
-<!--l. 741--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 829--><p class="nopar" >
+<!--l. 831--><p class="noindent" >
<h4 class="subsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">5.5 </span> <a
- id="x1-140005.5"></a>Extension options</h4>
-<!--l. 742--><p class="noindent" >
+ id="x1-160005.5"></a>Extension options</h4>
+<!--l. 832--><p class="noindent" >
<a
- id="x1-14001r5"></a> <!--l. 743--><div class="longtable"> <table id="TBL-7" class="longtable"
+ id="x1-16001r5"></a> <!--l. 833--><div class="longtable"> <table id="TBL-7" class="longtable"
><colgroup id="TBL-7-1g"><col
id="TBL-7-1"><col
@@ -1532,7 +1780,7 @@
class="td11"> text </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-7-1-3"
class="td11"> </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-7-1-4"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 743--><p class="noindent" >Set the file extension (e.g. <span
+ <!--l. 833--><p class="noindent" >Set the file extension (e.g. <span
class="ec-lmss-10">dvi</span>) which will be
appended to file links created if you use the <span
class="ec-lmss-10">xr</span>
@@ -1544,7 +1792,7 @@
class="td11"> boolean </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-7-2-3"
class="td11"> </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-7-2-4"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 746--><p class="noindent" > </td>
+ <!--l. 836--><p class="noindent" > </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-7-3-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-7-3-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -1553,7 +1801,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">false </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-7-3-4"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 746--><p class="noindent" >Adds ‘backlink’ text to the end of each item in the
+ <!--l. 836--><p class="noindent" >Adds ‘backlink’ text to the end of each item in the
bibliography, as a list of section numbers. This can
only work properly <span
class="ec-lmri-10">if </span>there is a blank line after each
@@ -1575,7 +1823,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">false </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-7-4-4"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 750--><p class="noindent" >Adds ‘backlink’ text to the end of each item in the
+ <!--l. 840--><p class="noindent" >Adds ‘backlink’ text to the end of each item in the
bibliography, as a list of page numbers. </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-7-5-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-7-5-1"
@@ -1585,7 +1833,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">true </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-7-5-4"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 752--><p class="noindent" >Makes the page
+ <!--l. 842--><p class="noindent" >Makes the page
numbers of index entries into hyperlinks. Relays on
unique page anchors (<span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">pageanchor</span></span></span>, …) <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
@@ -1600,7 +1848,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">true </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-7-6-4"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 755--><p class="noindent" >Makes the footnote marks into hyperlinks to the
+ <!--l. 845--><p class="noindent" >Makes the footnote marks into hyperlinks to the
footnote text. Easily broken … </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-7-7-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-7-7-1"
@@ -1609,7 +1857,7 @@
class="td11"> </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-7-7-3"
class="td11"> </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-7-7-4"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 757--><p class="noindent" >Sets encap character for hyperindex </td>
+ <!--l. 847--><p class="noindent" >Sets encap character for hyperindex </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-7-8-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-7-8-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -1618,7 +1866,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">section </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-7-8-4"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 758--><p class="noindent" >make text (<span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+ <!--l. 848--><p class="noindent" >make text (<span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">section</span></span></span>), page number (<span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">page</span></span></span>), both (<span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">all</span></span></span>)
@@ -1632,7 +1880,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">false </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-7-9-4"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 759--><p class="noindent" >make page number, not text, be link on TOC, LOF
+ <!--l. 849--><p class="noindent" >make page number, not text, be link on TOC, LOF
and LOT </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-7-10-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-7-10-1"
@@ -1642,7 +1890,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">false </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-7-10-4"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 760--><p class="noindent" >allow links to break over lines by making links over
+ <!--l. 850--><p class="noindent" >allow links to break over lines by making links over
multiple lines into PDF links to the same target </td>
@@ -1654,7 +1902,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">false </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-7-11-4"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 762--><p class="noindent" >Colors the text of links and anchors. The colors
+ <!--l. 852--><p class="noindent" >Colors the text of links and anchors. The colors
chosen depend on the the type of link. At present
the only types of link distinguished are citations,
page references, URLs, local file references, and other
@@ -1668,7 +1916,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">red </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-7-12-4"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 767--><p class="noindent" >Color for normal internal links. </td>
+ <!--l. 857--><p class="noindent" >Color for normal internal links. </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-7-13-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-7-13-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -1677,7 +1925,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">black </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-7-13-4"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 768--><p class="noindent" >Color for anchor text. Ignored by most drivers. </td>
+ <!--l. 858--><p class="noindent" >Color for anchor text. Ignored by most drivers. </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-7-14-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-7-14-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -1686,7 +1934,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">green </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-7-14-4"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 769--><p class="noindent" >Color for bibliographical citations in text. </td>
+ <!--l. 859--><p class="noindent" >Color for bibliographical citations in text. </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-7-15-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-7-15-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -1695,7 +1943,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">cyan </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-7-15-4"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 770--><p class="noindent" >Color for URLs which open local files. </td>
+ <!--l. 860--><p class="noindent" >Color for URLs which open local files. </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-7-16-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-7-16-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -1704,7 +1952,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">red </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-7-16-4"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 771--><p class="noindent" >Color for Acrobat menu items. </td>
+ <!--l. 861--><p class="noindent" >Color for Acrobat menu items. </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-7-17-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-7-17-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -1713,7 +1961,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">filecolor </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-7-17-4"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 772--><p class="noindent" >Color for run links (launch annotations). </td>
+ <!--l. 862--><p class="noindent" >Color for run links (launch annotations). </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-7-18-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-7-18-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -1722,7 +1970,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">magenta </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-7-18-4"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 773--><p class="noindent" >Color for linked URLs. </td>
+ <!--l. 863--><p class="noindent" >Color for linked URLs. </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-7-19-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-7-19-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -1730,7 +1978,7 @@
class="td11"> color </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-7-19-3"
class="td11"> </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-7-19-4"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 774--><p class="noindent" >Set all color options (without border and field
+ <!--l. 864--><p class="noindent" >Set all color options (without border and field
options). </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-7-20-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-7-20-1"
@@ -1740,7 +1988,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">false </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-7-20-4"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 775--><p class="noindent" >Use small caps instead of color for links. </td>
+ <!--l. 865--><p class="noindent" >Use small caps instead of color for links. </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-7-21-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-7-21-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -1748,7 +1996,7 @@
class="td11"> </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-7-21-3"
class="td11"> </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-7-21-4"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 776--><p class="noindent" >Hide links (removing color and border). </td>
+ <!--l. 866--><p class="noindent" >Hide links (removing color and border). </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-7-22-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-7-22-1"
class="td01"> </td>
@@ -1768,15 +2016,15 @@
class="td11"> </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-7-26-4"
class="td10"></td></tr>
</table></div>
-<!--l. 779--><p class="noindent" >Note that all color names must be defined before use, following the normal system of the standard
+<!--l. 869--><p class="noindent" >Note that all color names must be defined before use, following the normal system of the standard
LaTeX <span
class="ec-lmss-10">color </span>package.
-<!--l. 782--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 872--><p class="noindent" >
<h4 class="subsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">5.6 </span> <a
- id="x1-150005.6"></a>PDF-specific display options</h4>
-<!--l. 783--><p class="noindent" >
+ id="x1-170005.6"></a>PDF-specific display options</h4>
+<!--l. 873--><p class="noindent" >
<a
- id="x1-15001r6"></a> <!--l. 784--><div class="longtable"> <table id="TBL-8" class="longtable"
+ id="x1-17001r6"></a> <!--l. 874--><div class="longtable"> <table id="TBL-8" class="longtable"
><colgroup id="TBL-8-1g"><col
id="TBL-8-1"><col
@@ -1791,7 +2039,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">true </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-8-1-4"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 784--><p class="noindent" >A set of Acrobat bookmarks are written, in a
+ <!--l. 874--><p class="noindent" >A set of Acrobat bookmarks are written, in a
manner similar to the table of contents, requiring
two passes of LaTeX. Some postprocessing of
the bookmark file (file extension <span
@@ -1811,7 +2059,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">false </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-8-2-4"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 790--><p class="noindent" >If Acrobat bookmarks are requested, show them
+ <!--l. 880--><p class="noindent" >If Acrobat bookmarks are requested, show them
with all the subtrees expanded. </td>
@@ -1822,7 +2070,7 @@
class="td11"> parameter </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-8-3-3"
class="td11"> </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-8-3-4"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 792--><p class="noindent" >level (<span
+ <!--l. 882--><p class="noindent" >level (<span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\maxdimen</span>) to which bookmarks are open</td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-8-4-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-8-4-1"
@@ -1832,7 +2080,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">false </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-8-4-4"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 793--><p class="noindent" >If Acrobat bookmarks are requested, include
+ <!--l. 883--><p class="noindent" >If Acrobat bookmarks are requested, include
section numbers. </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-8-5-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-8-5-1"
@@ -1842,7 +2090,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">toc </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-8-5-4"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 794--><p class="noindent" >to specify which ‘toc’ file to mimic </td>
+ <!--l. 884--><p class="noindent" >to specify which ‘toc’ file to mimic </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-8-6-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-8-6-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -1851,7 +2099,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">false </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-8-6-4"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 796--><p class="noindent" >This option should be used to produce CJK
+ <!--l. 886--><p class="noindent" >This option should be used to produce CJK
bookmarks. Package <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">hyperref</span></span></span> supports both
normal and preprocessed mode of the <span
@@ -1867,7 +2115,7 @@
Acroread itself) support this. Also note that
option ‘CJKbookmarks’ cannot be used together
with option ‘unicode’.
- <!--l. 808--><p class="noindent" >No mechanism is provided to
+ <!--l. 898--><p class="noindent" >No mechanism is provided to
translate non-Unicode bookmarks to Unicode; for
portable PDF documents only Unicode encoding
should be used. </td>
@@ -1879,7 +2127,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">/I </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-8-7-4"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 811--><p class="noindent" >How link buttons behave when selected; /I is
+ <!--l. 901--><p class="noindent" >How link buttons behave when selected; /I is
for inverse (the default); the other possibilities
are /N (no effect), /O (outline), and /P (inset
highlighting). </td>
@@ -1891,7 +2139,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">0 1 0 </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-8-8-4"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 814--><p class="noindent" >The color of the box around citations </td>
+ <!--l. 904--><p class="noindent" >The color of the box around citations </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-8-9-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-8-9-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -1900,7 +2148,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">0 .5 .5 </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-8-9-4"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 815--><p class="noindent" >The color of the box around links to files </td>
+ <!--l. 905--><p class="noindent" >The color of the box around links to files </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-8-10-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-8-10-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -1909,7 +2157,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">1 0 0 </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-8-10-4"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 816--><p class="noindent" >The color of the box around normal links </td>
+ <!--l. 906--><p class="noindent" >The color of the box around normal links </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-8-11-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-8-11-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -1918,7 +2166,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">1 0 0 </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-8-11-4"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 817--><p class="noindent" >The color of the box around Acrobat menu links </td>
+ <!--l. 907--><p class="noindent" >The color of the box around Acrobat menu links </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-8-12-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-8-12-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -1927,7 +2175,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">0 1 1 </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-8-12-4"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 818--><p class="noindent" >The color of the box around links to URLs </td>
+ <!--l. 908--><p class="noindent" >The color of the box around links to URLs </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-8-13-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-8-13-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -1936,7 +2184,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">0 .7 .7 </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-8-13-4"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 819--><p class="noindent" >Color of border around ‘run’ links </td>
+ <!--l. 909--><p class="noindent" >Color of border around ‘run’ links </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-8-14-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-8-14-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -1944,7 +2192,7 @@
class="td11"> </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-8-14-3"
class="td11"> </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-8-14-4"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 820--><p class="noindent" >Set all border color options </td>
+ <!--l. 910--><p class="noindent" >Set all border color options </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-8-15-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-8-15-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -1953,7 +2201,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">0 0 1 </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-8-15-4"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 821--><p class="noindent" >The style of box around links; defaults to a box
+ <!--l. 911--><p class="noindent" >The style of box around links; defaults to a box
with lines of 1pt thickness, but the colorlinks
option resets it to produce no border. </td>
</tr><tr
@@ -1972,7 +2220,7 @@
class="td11"> </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-8-19-4"
class="td10"></td></tr>
</table></div>
-<!--l. 825--><p class="noindent" >The color of link borders used to be specified <span
+<!--l. 915--><p class="noindent" >The color of link borders used to be specified <span
class="ec-lmri-10">only </span>as 3 numbers in the range 0..1, giving an RGB color.
Since version 6.76a, the usual color specifications of package <span
class="ec-lmss-10">(x)color </span>can be used if <span
@@ -1981,7 +2229,7 @@
class="ec-lmss-10">hycolor</span>.
-<!--l. 831--><p class="indent" > The bookmark commands are stored in a file called <span
+<!--l. 921--><p class="indent" > The bookmark commands are stored in a file called <span
class="ec-lmri-10">jobname</span><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">.out</span>. The files is not processed by
LaTeX so any markup is passed through. You can postprocess this file as needed; as an aid
@@ -1990,16 +2238,16 @@
line
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-14">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-16">
\let\WriteBookmarks\relax
</pre>
-<!--l. 838--><p class="nopar" >
-<!--l. 840--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 928--><p class="nopar" >
+<!--l. 930--><p class="noindent" >
<h4 class="subsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">5.7 </span> <a
- id="x1-160005.7"></a>PDF display and information options</h4>
-<!--l. 841--><p class="noindent" >
+ id="x1-180005.7"></a>PDF display and information options</h4>
+<!--l. 931--><p class="noindent" >
<a
- id="x1-16001r7"></a> <!--l. 842--><div class="longtable"> <table id="TBL-9" class="longtable"
+ id="x1-18001r7"></a> <!--l. 932--><div class="longtable"> <table id="TBL-9" class="longtable"
><colgroup id="TBL-9-1g"><col
id="TBL-9-1"><col
@@ -2011,20 +2259,20 @@
class="td01"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">baseurl </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-1-2"
class="td11">
- <!--l. 842--><p class="noindent" >URL </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-1-3"
+ <!--l. 932--><p class="noindent" >URL </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-1-3"
class="td11"> </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-1-4"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 842--><p class="noindent" >Sets the base URL of the PDF document </td>
+ <!--l. 932--><p class="noindent" >Sets the base URL of the PDF document </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-9-2-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-2-1"
class="td01"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">pdfpagemode </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-2-2"
class="td11">
- <!--l. 843--><p class="noindent" >name </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-2-3"
+ <!--l. 933--><p class="noindent" >name </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-2-3"
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">empty </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-2-4"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 843--><p class="noindent" >Determines how the file is opening in
+ <!--l. 933--><p class="noindent" >Determines how the file is opening in
Acrobat; the possibilities are <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">UseNone</span></span></span>,
<span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
@@ -2043,46 +2291,46 @@
class="td01"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">pdftitle </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-3-2"
class="td11">
- <!--l. 848--><p class="noindent" >text </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-3-3"
+ <!--l. 938--><p class="noindent" >text </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-3-3"
class="td11"> </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-3-4"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 848--><p class="noindent" >Sets the document information Title field </td>
+ <!--l. 938--><p class="noindent" >Sets the document information Title field </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-9-4-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-4-1"
class="td01"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">pdfauthor </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-4-2"
class="td11">
- <!--l. 849--><p class="noindent" >text </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-4-3"
+ <!--l. 939--><p class="noindent" >text </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-4-3"
class="td11"> </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-4-4"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 849--><p class="noindent" >Sets the document information Author field </td>
+ <!--l. 939--><p class="noindent" >Sets the document information Author field </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-9-5-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-5-1"
class="td01"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">pdfsubject </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-5-2"
class="td11">
- <!--l. 850--><p class="noindent" >text </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-5-3"
+ <!--l. 940--><p class="noindent" >text </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-5-3"
class="td11"> </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-5-4"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 850--><p class="noindent" >Sets the document information Subject field </td>
+ <!--l. 940--><p class="noindent" >Sets the document information Subject field </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-9-6-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-6-1"
class="td01"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">pdfcreator </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-6-2"
class="td11">
- <!--l. 851--><p class="noindent" >text </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-6-3"
+ <!--l. 941--><p class="noindent" >text </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-6-3"
class="td11"> </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-6-4"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 851--><p class="noindent" >Sets the document information Creator field </td>
+ <!--l. 941--><p class="noindent" >Sets the document information Creator field </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-9-7-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-7-1"
class="td01"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">addtopdfcreator </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-7-2"
class="td11">
- <!--l. 852--><p class="noindent" >text </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-7-3"
+ <!--l. 942--><p class="noindent" >text </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-7-3"
class="td11"> </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-7-4"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 852--><p class="noindent" >Adds additional text to the document
+ <!--l. 942--><p class="noindent" >Adds additional text to the document
information Creator field </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-9-8-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-8-1"
@@ -2089,20 +2337,20 @@
class="td01"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">pdfkeywords </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-8-2"
class="td11">
- <!--l. 853--><p class="noindent" >text </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-8-3"
+ <!--l. 943--><p class="noindent" >text </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-8-3"
class="td11"> </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-8-4"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 853--><p class="noindent" >Sets the document information Keywords field</td>
+ <!--l. 943--><p class="noindent" >Sets the document information Keywords field</td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-9-9-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-9-1"
class="td01"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">pdftrapped </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-9-2"
class="td11">
- <!--l. 854--><p class="noindent" >name </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-9-3"
+ <!--l. 944--><p class="noindent" >name </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-9-3"
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">empty </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-9-4"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 854--><p class="noindent" >Sets the document information Trapped entry.
+ <!--l. 944--><p class="noindent" >Sets the document information Trapped entry.
Possible values are <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">True</span></span></span>, <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">False</span></span></span> and <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
@@ -2113,13 +2361,13 @@
class="td01"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">pdfinfo </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-10-2"
class="td11">
- <!--l. 857--><p class="noindent" >key
+ <!--l. 947--><p class="noindent" >key
value
list </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-10-3"
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">empty </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-10-4"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 857--><p class="noindent" >Alternative interface for setting the document
+ <!--l. 947--><p class="noindent" >Alternative interface for setting the document
information. </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-9-11-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-11-1"
@@ -2126,21 +2374,21 @@
class="td01"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">pdfview </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-11-2"
class="td11">
- <!--l. 859--><p class="noindent" >name </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-11-3"
+ <!--l. 949--><p class="noindent" >name </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-11-3"
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">XYZ </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-11-4"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 859--><p class="noindent" >Sets the default PDF ‘view’ for each link </td>
+ <!--l. 949--><p class="noindent" >Sets the default PDF ‘view’ for each link </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-9-12-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-12-1"
class="td01"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">pdfstartpage </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-12-2"
class="td11">
- <!--l. 860--><p class="noindent" >integer </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-12-3"
+ <!--l. 950--><p class="noindent" >integer </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-12-3"
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">1 </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-12-4"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 860--><p class="noindent" >Determines on which page the PDF file is
+ <!--l. 950--><p class="noindent" >Determines on which page the PDF file is
opened. An empty value means, the entry is
not set. </td>
</tr><tr
@@ -2148,21 +2396,21 @@
class="td01"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">pdfstartview </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-13-2"
class="td11">
- <!--l. 861--><p class="noindent" >name </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-13-3"
+ <!--l. 951--><p class="noindent" >name </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-13-3"
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">Fit </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-13-4"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 861--><p class="noindent" >Set the startup page view </td>
+ <!--l. 951--><p class="noindent" >Set the startup page view </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-9-14-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-14-1"
class="td01"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">pdfremotestartview </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-14-2"
class="td11">
- <!--l. 862--><p class="noindent" >name </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-14-3"
+ <!--l. 952--><p class="noindent" >name </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-14-3"
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">Fit </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-14-4"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 862--><p class="noindent" >Set the startup page view of remote PDF files</td>
+ <!--l. 952--><p class="noindent" >Set the startup page view of remote PDF files</td>
</tr><tr
@@ -2170,13 +2418,13 @@
class="td01"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">pdfpagescrop </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-15-2"
class="td11">
- <!--l. 863--><p class="noindent" >n
+ <!--l. 953--><p class="noindent" >n
n
n
n </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-15-3"
class="td11"> </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-15-4"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 863--><p class="noindent" >Sets the default PDF crop box for pages. This
+ <!--l. 953--><p class="noindent" >Sets the default PDF crop box for pages. This
should be a set of four numbers </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-9-16-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-16-1"
@@ -2183,11 +2431,11 @@
class="td01"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">pdfcenterwindow </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-16-2"
class="td11">
- <!--l. 864--><p class="noindent" >boolean </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-16-3"
+ <!--l. 954--><p class="noindent" >boolean </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-16-3"
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">false </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-16-4"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 864--><p class="noindent" >position the document window in the center
+ <!--l. 954--><p class="noindent" >position the document window in the center
of the screen </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-9-17-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-17-1"
@@ -2194,11 +2442,11 @@
class="td01"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">pdfdirection </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-17-2"
class="td11">
- <!--l. 865--><p class="noindent" >name </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-17-3"
+ <!--l. 955--><p class="noindent" >name </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-17-3"
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">empty </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-17-4"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 865--><p class="noindent" >direction setting. Possible values: <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+ <!--l. 955--><p class="noindent" >direction setting. Possible values: <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">L2R</span></span></span> (left to
right) and <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">R2L</span></span></span> (right to left) </td>
@@ -2207,11 +2455,11 @@
class="td01"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">pdfdisplaydoctitle </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-18-2"
class="td11">
- <!--l. 867--><p class="noindent" >boolean </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-18-3"
+ <!--l. 957--><p class="noindent" >boolean </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-18-3"
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">false </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-18-4"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 867--><p class="noindent" >display document title instead of file name in
+ <!--l. 957--><p class="noindent" >display document title instead of file name in
title bar </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-9-19-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-19-1"
@@ -2218,11 +2466,11 @@
class="td01"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">pdfduplex </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-19-2"
class="td11">
- <!--l. 868--><p class="noindent" >name </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-19-3"
+ <!--l. 958--><p class="noindent" >name </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-19-3"
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">empty </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-19-4"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 868--><p class="noindent" >paper handling option for print
+ <!--l. 958--><p class="noindent" >paper handling option for print
dialog. Possible vatues are: <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">Simplex</span></span></span> (print
single-sided), <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
@@ -2236,41 +2484,41 @@
class="td01"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">pdffitwindow </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-20-2"
class="td11">
- <!--l. 873--><p class="noindent" >boolean </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-20-3"
+ <!--l. 963--><p class="noindent" >boolean </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-20-3"
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">false </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-20-4"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 873--><p class="noindent" >resize document window to fit document size </td>
+ <!--l. 963--><p class="noindent" >resize document window to fit document size </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-9-21-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-21-1"
class="td01"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">pdflang </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-21-2"
class="td11">
- <!--l. 874--><p class="noindent" >name </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-21-3"
+ <!--l. 964--><p class="noindent" >name </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-21-3"
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">relax </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-21-4"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 874--><p class="noindent" >PDF language identifier (RFC 3066) </td>
+ <!--l. 964--><p class="noindent" >PDF language identifier (RFC 3066) </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-9-22-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-22-1"
class="td01"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">pdfmenubar </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-22-2"
class="td11">
- <!--l. 875--><p class="noindent" >boolean </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-22-3"
+ <!--l. 965--><p class="noindent" >boolean </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-22-3"
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">true </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-22-4"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 875--><p class="noindent" >make PDF viewer’s menu bar visible </td>
+ <!--l. 965--><p class="noindent" >make PDF viewer’s menu bar visible </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-9-23-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-23-1"
class="td01"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">pdfnewwindow </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-23-2"
class="td11">
- <!--l. 876--><p class="noindent" >boolean </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-23-3"
+ <!--l. 966--><p class="noindent" >boolean </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-23-3"
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">false </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-23-4"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 876--><p class="noindent" >make links that open another PDF file start a
+ <!--l. 966--><p class="noindent" >make links that open another PDF file start a
new window </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-9-24-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-24-1"
@@ -2277,11 +2525,11 @@
class="td01"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">pdfnonfullscreenpagemode </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-24-2"
class="td11">
- <!--l. 878--><p class="noindent" >name </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-24-3"
+ <!--l. 968--><p class="noindent" >name </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-24-3"
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">empty </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-24-4"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 878--><p class="noindent" >page mode setting on exiting full-screen mode.
+ <!--l. 968--><p class="noindent" >page mode setting on exiting full-screen mode.
Possible values are <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">UseNone</span></span></span>, <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">UseOutlines</span></span></span>,
@@ -2293,21 +2541,21 @@
class="td01"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">pdfnumcopies </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-25-2"
class="td11">
- <!--l. 880--><p class="noindent" >integer </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-25-3"
+ <!--l. 970--><p class="noindent" >integer </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-25-3"
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">empty </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-25-4"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 880--><p class="noindent" >number of printed copies </td>
+ <!--l. 970--><p class="noindent" >number of printed copies </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-9-26-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-26-1"
class="td01"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">pdfpagelayout </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-26-2"
class="td11">
- <!--l. 881--><p class="noindent" >name </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-26-3"
+ <!--l. 971--><p class="noindent" >name </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-26-3"
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">empty </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-26-4"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 881--><p class="noindent" >set layout of PDF pages. Possible values:
+ <!--l. 971--><p class="noindent" >set layout of PDF pages. Possible values:
<span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">SinglePage</span></span></span>, <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">OneColumn</span></span></span>, <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
@@ -2322,21 +2570,21 @@
class="td01"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">pdfpagelabels </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-27-2"
class="td11">
- <!--l. 885--><p class="noindent" >boolean </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-27-3"
+ <!--l. 975--><p class="noindent" >boolean </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-27-3"
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">true </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-27-4"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 885--><p class="noindent" >set PDF page labels </td>
+ <!--l. 975--><p class="noindent" >set PDF page labels </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-9-28-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-28-1"
class="td01"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">pdfpagetransition </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-28-2"
class="td11">
- <!--l. 886--><p class="noindent" >name </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-28-3"
+ <!--l. 976--><p class="noindent" >name </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-28-3"
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">empty </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-28-4"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 886--><p class="noindent" >set PDF page transition style. Possible values
+ <!--l. 976--><p class="noindent" >set PDF page transition style. Possible values
are <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">Split</span></span></span>, <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">Blinds</span></span></span>, <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
@@ -2360,11 +2608,11 @@
class="td01"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">pdfpicktraybypdfsize </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-29-2"
class="td11">
- <!--l. 895--><p class="noindent" >boolean </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-29-3"
+ <!--l. 985--><p class="noindent" >boolean </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-29-3"
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">false </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-29-4"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 895--><p class="noindent" >specify whether PDF page size is used to select
+ <!--l. 985--><p class="noindent" >specify whether PDF page size is used to select
input paper tray in print dialog </td>
@@ -2373,11 +2621,11 @@
class="td01"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">pdfprintarea </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-30-2"
class="td11">
- <!--l. 896--><p class="noindent" >name </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-30-3"
+ <!--l. 986--><p class="noindent" >name </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-30-3"
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">empty </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-30-4"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 896--><p class="noindent" >set /PrintArea of viewer preferences. Possible
+ <!--l. 986--><p class="noindent" >set /PrintArea of viewer preferences. Possible
values are <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">MediaBox</span></span></span>, <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">CropBox</span></span></span>, <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
@@ -2392,11 +2640,11 @@
class="td01"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">pdfprintclip </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-31-2"
class="td11">
- <!--l. 900--><p class="noindent" >name </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-31-3"
+ <!--l. 990--><p class="noindent" >name </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-31-3"
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">empty </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-31-4"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 900--><p class="noindent" >set /PrintClip of viewer preferences. Possible
+ <!--l. 990--><p class="noindent" >set /PrintClip of viewer preferences. Possible
values are <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">MediaBox</span></span></span>, <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">CropBox</span></span></span>, <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
@@ -2411,7 +2659,7 @@
class="td01"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">pdfprintpagerange </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-32-2"
class="td11">
- <!--l. 904--><p class="noindent" >n
+ <!--l. 994--><p class="noindent" >n
n
(n
n)* </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-32-3"
@@ -2418,17 +2666,17 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">empty </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-32-4"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 905--><p class="noindent" >set /PrintPageRange of viewer preferences </td>
+ <!--l. 995--><p class="noindent" >set /PrintPageRange of viewer preferences </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-9-33-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-33-1"
class="td01"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">pdfprintscaling </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-33-2"
class="td11">
- <!--l. 906--><p class="noindent" >name </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-33-3"
+ <!--l. 996--><p class="noindent" >name </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-33-3"
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">empty </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-33-4"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 906--><p class="noindent" >page scaling option for print dialog (option
+ <!--l. 996--><p class="noindent" >page scaling option for print dialog (option
/PrintScaling of viewer preferences, PDF 1.6);
valid values are <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">None</span></span></span> and <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
@@ -2438,21 +2686,21 @@
class="td01"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">pdftoolbar </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-34-2"
class="td11">
- <!--l. 911--><p class="noindent" >boolean </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-34-3"
+ <!--l. 1001--><p class="noindent" >boolean </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-34-3"
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">true </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-34-4"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 911--><p class="noindent" >make PDF toolbar visible </td>
+ <!--l. 1001--><p class="noindent" >make PDF toolbar visible </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-9-35-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-35-1"
class="td01"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">pdfviewarea </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-35-2"
class="td11">
- <!--l. 912--><p class="noindent" >name </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-35-3"
+ <!--l. 1002--><p class="noindent" >name </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-35-3"
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">empty </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-35-4"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 912--><p class="noindent" >set /ViewArea of viewer preferences. Possible
+ <!--l. 1002--><p class="noindent" >set /ViewArea of viewer preferences. Possible
values are <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">MediaBox</span></span></span>, <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">CropBox</span></span></span>, <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
@@ -2467,11 +2715,11 @@
class="td01"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">pdfviewclip </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-36-2"
class="td11">
- <!--l. 916--><p class="noindent" >name </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-36-3"
+ <!--l. 1006--><p class="noindent" >name </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-36-3"
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">empty </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-36-4"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 916--><p class="noindent" >set /ViewClip of viewer preferences Possible
+ <!--l. 1006--><p class="noindent" >set /ViewClip of viewer preferences Possible
values are <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">MediaBox</span></span></span>, <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">CropBox</span></span></span>, <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
@@ -2486,21 +2734,21 @@
class="td01"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">pdfwindowui </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-37-2"
class="td11">
- <!--l. 920--><p class="noindent" >boolean </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-37-3"
+ <!--l. 1010--><p class="noindent" >boolean </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-37-3"
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">true </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-37-4"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 920--><p class="noindent" >make PDF user interface elements visible </td>
+ <!--l. 1010--><p class="noindent" >make PDF user interface elements visible </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-9-38-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-38-1"
class="td01"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">unicode </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-38-2"
class="td11">
- <!--l. 921--><p class="noindent" >boolean </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-38-3"
+ <!--l. 1011--><p class="noindent" >boolean </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-38-3"
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">true </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-38-4"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 921--><p class="noindent" >Unicode encoded PDF strings </td>
+ <!--l. 1011--><p class="noindent" >Unicode encoded PDF strings </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-9-39-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-39-1"
class="td01"> </td>
@@ -2517,11 +2765,11 @@
class="td11"> </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-9-42-4"
class="td10"></td></tr>
</table></div>
-<!--l. 924--><p class="noindent" >Each link in Acrobat carries its own magnification level, which is set using PDF coordinate space, which
+<!--l. 1014--><p class="noindent" >Each link in Acrobat carries its own magnification level, which is set using PDF coordinate space, which
is not the same as TeX’s. The unit is bp and the origin is in the lower left corner. See also <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\hypercalcbp</span></span></span>
that is explained on page <a
-href="#x1-240006.3">54<!--tex4ht:ref: hypercalcbp --></a>. pdfTeX works by supplying default values for <span
+href="#x1-260006.3">58<!--tex4ht:ref: hypercalcbp --></a>. pdfTeX works by supplying default values for <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">XYZ </span>(horizontal <span
class="lmsy-10">×</span>
vertical <span
@@ -2535,9 +2783,9 @@
class="ec-lmvtt-10">pdfstartview </span>and <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">pdfremotestartview</span>
parameters.
-<!--l. 936--><p class="indent" >
+<!--l. 1026--><p class="indent" >
<a
- id="x1-16002r8"></a> <!--l. 937--><div class="longtable"> <table id="TBL-10" class="longtable"
+ id="x1-18002r8"></a> <!--l. 1027--><div class="longtable"> <table id="TBL-10" class="longtable"
><colgroup id="TBL-10-1g"><col
id="TBL-10-1"><col
@@ -2550,7 +2798,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">left top zoom </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-10-1-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 937--><p class="noindent" >Sets a coordinate and a zoom factor. If any one
+ <!--l. 1027--><p class="noindent" >Sets a coordinate and a zoom factor. If any one
is null, the source link value is used. <span
class="ec-lmri-10">null null</span>
<span
@@ -2564,7 +2812,7 @@
class="ec-lmvtt-10">Fit </span></td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-10-2-2"
class="td11"> </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-10-2-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 939--><p class="noindent" >Fits the page to the window. </td>
+ <!--l. 1029--><p class="noindent" >Fits the page to the window. </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-10-3-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-10-3-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -2572,7 +2820,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">top </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-10-3-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 940--><p class="noindent" >Fits the width of the page to the window. </td>
+ <!--l. 1030--><p class="noindent" >Fits the width of the page to the window. </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-10-4-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-10-4-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -2580,7 +2828,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">left </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-10-4-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 941--><p class="noindent" >Fits the height of the page to the window. </td>
+ <!--l. 1031--><p class="noindent" >Fits the height of the page to the window. </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-10-5-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-10-5-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -2588,7 +2836,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">left bottom right top </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-10-5-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 942--><p class="noindent" >Fits the rectangle specified by the four
+ <!--l. 1032--><p class="noindent" >Fits the rectangle specified by the four
coordinates to the window. </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-10-6-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-10-6-1"
@@ -2596,7 +2844,7 @@
class="ec-lmvtt-10">FitB </span></td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-10-6-2"
class="td11"> </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-10-6-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 943--><p class="noindent" >Fits the page bounding box to the window. </td>
+ <!--l. 1033--><p class="noindent" >Fits the page bounding box to the window. </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-10-7-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-10-7-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -2604,7 +2852,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">top </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-10-7-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 944--><p class="noindent" >Fits the width of the page bounding box to
+ <!--l. 1034--><p class="noindent" >Fits the width of the page bounding box to
the window. </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-10-8-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-10-8-1"
@@ -2613,7 +2861,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">left </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-10-8-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 945--><p class="noindent" >Fits the height of the page bounding box to
+ <!--l. 1035--><p class="noindent" >Fits the height of the page bounding box to
the window. </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-10-9-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-10-9-1"
@@ -2633,11 +2881,11 @@
class="td11"> </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-10-13-3"
class="td10"></td></tr>
</table></div>
-<!--l. 948--><p class="indent" > The <span
+<!--l. 1038--><p class="indent" > The <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">pdfpagelayout </span>can be one of the following values.
-<!--l. 950--><p class="indent" >
+<!--l. 1040--><p class="indent" >
<a
- id="x1-16003r9"></a> <!--l. 951--><div class="longtable"> <table id="TBL-11" class="longtable"
+ id="x1-18003r9"></a> <!--l. 1041--><div class="longtable"> <table id="TBL-11" class="longtable"
><colgroup id="TBL-11-1g"><col
id="TBL-11-1"><col
@@ -2647,19 +2895,19 @@
class="td01"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">SinglePage </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-11-1-2"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 951--><p class="noindent" >Displays a single page; advancing flips the page </td>
+ <!--l. 1041--><p class="noindent" >Displays a single page; advancing flips the page </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-11-2-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-11-2-1"
class="td01"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">OneColumn </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-11-2-2"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 952--><p class="noindent" >Displays the document in one column; continuous scrolling. </td>
+ <!--l. 1042--><p class="noindent" >Displays the document in one column; continuous scrolling. </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-11-3-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-11-3-1"
class="td01"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">TwoColumnLeft </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-11-3-2"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 953--><p class="noindent" >Displays the document in two columns, odd-numbered pages to
+ <!--l. 1043--><p class="noindent" >Displays the document in two columns, odd-numbered pages to
the left. </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-11-4-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-11-4-1"
@@ -2666,7 +2914,7 @@
class="td01"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">TwoColumnRight </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-11-4-2"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 954--><p class="noindent" >Displays the document in two columns, odd-numbered pages to
+ <!--l. 1044--><p class="noindent" >Displays the document in two columns, odd-numbered pages to
the right. </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-11-5-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-11-5-1"
@@ -2673,7 +2921,7 @@
class="td01"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">TwoPageLeft </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-11-5-2"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 955--><p class="noindent" >Displays two pages, odd-numbered pages to the left (since PDF
+ <!--l. 1045--><p class="noindent" >Displays two pages, odd-numbered pages to the left (since PDF
1.5). </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-11-6-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-11-6-1"
@@ -2680,7 +2928,7 @@
class="td01"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">TwoPageRight </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-11-6-2"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 956--><p class="noindent" >Displays two pages, odd-numbered pages to the right (since PDF
+ <!--l. 1046--><p class="noindent" >Displays two pages, odd-numbered pages to the right (since PDF
1.5). </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-11-7-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-11-7-1"
@@ -2696,7 +2944,7 @@
class="td01"> </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-11-10-2"
class="td10"></td></tr>
</table></div>
-<!--l. 959--><p class="indent" > Finally, the <span
+<!--l. 1049--><p class="indent" > Finally, the <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">pdfpagetransition </span>can be one of the following values, where <span
class="ec-lmri-10">/Di </span>stands for direction of
motion in degrees, generally in 90<sup><span
@@ -2709,9 +2957,9 @@
class="ec-lmri-10">/M </span>is for motion, either in (<span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">/I</span>) or out (<span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">/O</span>).
-<!--l. 966--><p class="indent" >
+<!--l. 1056--><p class="indent" >
<a
- id="x1-16004r10"></a> <!--l. 967--><div class="longtable"> <table id="TBL-12" class="longtable"
+ id="x1-18004r10"></a> <!--l. 1057--><div class="longtable"> <table id="TBL-12" class="longtable"
><colgroup id="TBL-12-1g"><col
id="TBL-12-1"><col
@@ -2723,7 +2971,7 @@
class="ec-lmvtt-10">Blinds </span></td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-12-1-2"
class="td11"> /Dm </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-12-1-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 967--><p class="noindent" >Multiple lines distributed evenly across the screen sweep
+ <!--l. 1057--><p class="noindent" >Multiple lines distributed evenly across the screen sweep
in the same direction to reveal the new page. </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-12-2-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-12-2-1"
@@ -2731,7 +2979,7 @@
class="ec-lmvtt-10">Box </span></td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-12-2-2"
class="td11"> /M </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-12-2-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 969--><p class="noindent" >A box sweeps in or out. </td>
+ <!--l. 1059--><p class="noindent" >A box sweeps in or out. </td>
</tr><tr
@@ -2740,7 +2988,7 @@
class="ec-lmvtt-10">Dissolve </span></td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-12-3-2"
class="td11"> </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-12-3-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 970--><p class="noindent" >The page image dissolves in a piecemeal fashion to reveal
+ <!--l. 1060--><p class="noindent" >The page image dissolves in a piecemeal fashion to reveal
the new page. </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-12-4-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-12-4-1"
@@ -2748,7 +2996,7 @@
class="ec-lmvtt-10">Glitter </span></td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-12-4-2"
class="td11"> /Di </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-12-4-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 971--><p class="noindent" >Similar to Dissolve, except the effect sweeps across the
+ <!--l. 1061--><p class="noindent" >Similar to Dissolve, except the effect sweeps across the
screen. </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-12-5-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-12-5-1"
@@ -2756,7 +3004,7 @@
class="ec-lmvtt-10">Split </span></td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-12-5-2"
class="td11"> /Dm /M </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-12-5-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 972--><p class="noindent" >Two lines sweep across the screen to reveal the new page.</td>
+ <!--l. 1062--><p class="noindent" >Two lines sweep across the screen to reveal the new page.</td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-12-6-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-12-6-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -2763,7 +3011,7 @@
class="ec-lmvtt-10">Wipe </span></td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-12-6-2"
class="td11"> /Di </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-12-6-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 973--><p class="noindent" >A single line sweeps across the screen to reveal the new
+ <!--l. 1063--><p class="noindent" >A single line sweeps across the screen to reveal the new
page. </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-12-7-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-12-7-1"
@@ -2771,7 +3019,7 @@
class="ec-lmvtt-10">R </span></td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-12-7-2"
class="td11"> </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-12-7-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 974--><p class="noindent" >Simply replaces the old page with the new one. </td>
+ <!--l. 1064--><p class="noindent" >Simply replaces the old page with the new one. </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-12-8-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-12-8-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -2778,7 +3026,7 @@
class="ec-lmvtt-10">Fly </span></td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-12-8-2"
class="td11"> /Di /M </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-12-8-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 975--><p class="noindent" >Changes are flown out or in (as specified by /M), in the
+ <!--l. 1065--><p class="noindent" >Changes are flown out or in (as specified by /M), in the
direction specified by /Di, to or from a location that is
offscreen except when /Di is None. </td>
</tr><tr
@@ -2787,7 +3035,7 @@
class="ec-lmvtt-10">Push </span></td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-12-9-2"
class="td11"> /Di </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-12-9-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 978--><p class="noindent" >The old page slides off the screen while the new page
+ <!--l. 1068--><p class="noindent" >The old page slides off the screen while the new page
slides in, pushing the old page out in the direction
specified by /Di. </td>
</tr><tr
@@ -2796,7 +3044,7 @@
class="ec-lmvtt-10">Cover </span></td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-12-10-2"
class="td11"> /Di </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-12-10-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 981--><p class="noindent" >The new page slides on to the screen in the direction
+ <!--l. 1071--><p class="noindent" >The new page slides on to the screen in the direction
specified by /Di, covering the old page. </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-12-11-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-12-11-1"
@@ -2804,7 +3052,7 @@
class="ec-lmvtt-10">Uncover </span></td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-12-11-2"
class="td11"> /Di </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-12-11-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 983--><p class="noindent" >The old page slides off the screen in the direction
+ <!--l. 1073--><p class="noindent" >The old page slides off the screen in the direction
specified by /Di, uncovering the new page in the
direction specified by /Di. </td>
</tr><tr
@@ -2813,7 +3061,7 @@
class="ec-lmvtt-10">Fade </span></td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-12-12-2"
class="td11"> </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-12-12-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 986--><p class="noindent" >The new page gradually becomes visible through the old
+ <!--l. 1076--><p class="noindent" >The new page gradually becomes visible through the old
one. </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-12-13-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-12-13-1"
@@ -2830,11 +3078,11 @@
class="td11"> </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-12-16-3"
class="td10"></td></tr>
</table></div>
-<!--l. 990--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 1080--><p class="noindent" >
<h4 class="subsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">5.8 </span> <a
- id="x1-170005.8"></a>Option <span
+ id="x1-190005.8"></a>Option <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">pdfinfo</span></h4>
-<!--l. 992--><p class="noindent" >The information entries can be set using <span
+<!--l. 1082--><p class="noindent" >The information entries can be set using <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">pdftitle</span>, <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">pdfsubject</span>, …. Option <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">pdfinfo </span>provides an alternative
@@ -2851,7 +3099,7 @@
<blockquote class="quote">
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-15">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-17">
\hypersetup{
  pdfinfo={
    Title={My Title},
@@ -2861,15 +3109,15 @@
  }
}
</pre>
- <!--l. 1011--><p class="nopar" ></blockquote>
-<!--l. 1014--><p class="noindent" >
+ <!--l. 1101--><p class="nopar" ></blockquote>
+<!--l. 1104--><p class="noindent" >
<h4 class="subsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">5.9 </span> <a
- id="x1-180005.9"></a>Big alphabetical list</h4>
-<!--l. 1016--><p class="noindent" >The following is a complete listing of available options for <span
+ id="x1-200005.9"></a>Big alphabetical list</h4>
+<!--l. 1106--><p class="noindent" >The following is a complete listing of available options for <span
class="ec-lmss-10">hyperref</span>, arranged alphabetically.
-<!--l. 1019--><p class="indent" >
+<!--l. 1109--><p class="indent" >
<a
- id="x1-18001r11"></a> <!--l. 1020--><div class="longtable"> <table id="TBL-13" class="longtable"
+ id="x1-20001r11"></a> <!--l. 1110--><div class="longtable"> <table id="TBL-13" class="longtable"
><colgroup id="TBL-13-1g"><col
id="TBL-13-1"><col
@@ -2881,7 +3129,7 @@
class="ec-lmvtt-10">allbordercolors </span></td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-1-2"
class="td11"> </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-1-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1020--><p class="noindent" >Set all border color options </td>
+ <!--l. 1110--><p class="noindent" >Set all border color options </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-2-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-2-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -2888,7 +3136,7 @@
class="ec-lmvtt-10">allcolors </span></td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-2-2"
class="td11"> </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-2-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1021--><p class="noindent" >Set all color options (without border and field
+ <!--l. 1111--><p class="noindent" >Set all color options (without border and field
options) </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-3-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-3-1"
@@ -2897,7 +3145,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">black </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-3-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1022--><p class="noindent" >set color of anchors, ignored by most drivers. </td>
+ <!--l. 1112--><p class="noindent" >set color of anchors, ignored by most drivers. </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-4-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-4-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -2905,7 +3153,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">false </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-4-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1023--><p class="noindent" >do bibliographical back references </td>
+ <!--l. 1113--><p class="noindent" >do bibliographical back references </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-5-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-5-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -2913,7 +3161,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">empty </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-5-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1024--><p class="noindent" >set base URL for document </td>
+ <!--l. 1114--><p class="noindent" >set base URL for document </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-6-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-6-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -2921,7 +3169,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">true </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-6-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1025--><p class="noindent" >make bookmarks </td>
+ <!--l. 1115--><p class="noindent" >make bookmarks </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-7-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-7-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -2929,7 +3177,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">false </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-7-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1026--><p class="noindent" >put section numbers in bookmarks </td>
+ <!--l. 1116--><p class="noindent" >put section numbers in bookmarks </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-8-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-8-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -2937,7 +3185,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">false </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-8-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1027--><p class="noindent" >open up bookmark tree </td>
+ <!--l. 1117--><p class="noindent" >open up bookmark tree </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-9-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-9-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -2945,7 +3193,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\maxdimen </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-9-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1028--><p class="noindent" >level to which bookmarks are open </td>
+ <!--l. 1118--><p class="noindent" >level to which bookmarks are open </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-10-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-10-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -2953,7 +3201,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">toc </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-10-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1029--><p class="noindent" >to specify which ‘toc’ file to mimic </td>
+ <!--l. 1119--><p class="noindent" >to specify which ‘toc’ file to mimic </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-11-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-11-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -2961,7 +3209,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">false </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-11-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1030--><p class="noindent" >allow links to break over lines </td>
+ <!--l. 1120--><p class="noindent" >allow links to break over lines </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-12-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-12-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -2969,7 +3217,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">false </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-12-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1031--><p class="noindent" >to produce CJK bookmarks </td>
+ <!--l. 1121--><p class="noindent" >to produce CJK bookmarks </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-13-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-13-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -2977,7 +3225,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">0 1 0 </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-13-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1032--><p class="noindent" >color of border around cites </td>
+ <!--l. 1122--><p class="noindent" >color of border around cites </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-14-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-14-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -2985,7 +3233,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">green </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-14-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1033--><p class="noindent" >color of citation links </td>
+ <!--l. 1123--><p class="noindent" >color of citation links </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-15-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-15-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -2993,7 +3241,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">false </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-15-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1034--><p class="noindent" >color links </td>
+ <!--l. 1124--><p class="noindent" >color links </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-16-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-16-1"
class="td01"> </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-16-2"
@@ -3000,7 +3248,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">true </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-16-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1035--><p class="noindent" >(<span
+ <!--l. 1125--><p class="noindent" >(<span
class="ec-lmss-10">tex4ht</span>, <span
class="ec-lmss-10">dviwindo</span>) </td>
</tr><tr
@@ -3010,7 +3258,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">false </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-17-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1036--><p class="noindent" >provide details of anchors defined; same as
+ <!--l. 1126--><p class="noindent" >provide details of anchors defined; same as
verbose </td>
@@ -3021,7 +3269,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">false </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-18-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1037--><p class="noindent" >destinations are named by the first <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+ <!--l. 1127--><p class="noindent" >destinations are named by the first <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\label</span></span></span>
after the anchor creation </td>
</tr><tr
@@ -3031,7 +3279,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">false </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-19-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1038--><p class="noindent" >do not do any hyperlinking </td>
+ <!--l. 1128--><p class="noindent" >do not do any hyperlinking </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-20-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-20-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -3038,7 +3286,7 @@
class="ec-lmvtt-10">driverfallback </span></td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-20-2"
class="td11"> </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-20-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1039--><p class="noindent" >default if no driver specified or detected </td>
+ <!--l. 1129--><p class="noindent" >default if no driver specified or detected </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-21-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-21-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -3045,7 +3293,7 @@
class="ec-lmvtt-10">dvipdfm </span></td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-21-2"
class="td11"> </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-21-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1040--><p class="noindent" >use <span
+ <!--l. 1130--><p class="noindent" >use <span
class="ec-lmss-10">dvipdfm </span>backend </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-22-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-22-1"
@@ -3053,7 +3301,7 @@
class="ec-lmvtt-10">dvipdfmx </span></td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-22-2"
class="td11"> </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-22-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1041--><p class="noindent" >use <span
+ <!--l. 1131--><p class="noindent" >use <span
class="ec-lmss-10">dvipdfmx </span>backend </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-23-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-23-1"
@@ -3061,7 +3309,7 @@
class="ec-lmvtt-10">dvips </span></td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-23-2"
class="td11"> </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-23-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1042--><p class="noindent" >use <span
+ <!--l. 1132--><p class="noindent" >use <span
class="ec-lmss-10">dvips </span>backend </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-24-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-24-1"
@@ -3069,7 +3317,7 @@
class="ec-lmvtt-10">dvipsone </span></td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-24-2"
class="td11"> </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-24-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1043--><p class="noindent" >use <span
+ <!--l. 1133--><p class="noindent" >use <span
class="ec-lmss-10">dvipsone </span>backend </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-25-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-25-1"
@@ -3077,7 +3325,7 @@
class="ec-lmvtt-10">dviwindo </span></td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-25-2"
class="td11"> </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-25-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1044--><p class="noindent" >use <span
+ <!--l. 1134--><p class="noindent" >use <span
class="ec-lmss-10">dviwindo </span>backend </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-26-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-26-1"
@@ -3085,7 +3333,7 @@
class="ec-lmvtt-10">encap </span></td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-26-2"
class="td11"> </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-26-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1045--><p class="noindent" >to set encap character for hyperindex </td>
+ <!--l. 1135--><p class="noindent" >to set encap character for hyperindex </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-27-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-27-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -3093,7 +3341,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">dvi </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-27-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1046--><p class="noindent" >suffix of linked files </td>
+ <!--l. 1136--><p class="noindent" >suffix of linked files </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-28-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-28-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -3101,7 +3349,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">0 .5 .5 </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-28-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1047--><p class="noindent" >color of border around file links </td>
+ <!--l. 1137--><p class="noindent" >color of border around file links </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-29-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-29-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -3109,7 +3357,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">cyan </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-29-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1048--><p class="noindent" >color of file links </td>
+ <!--l. 1138--><p class="noindent" >color of file links </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-30-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-30-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -3117,7 +3365,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">true </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-30-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1049--><p class="noindent" >opposite of option draft </td>
+ <!--l. 1139--><p class="noindent" >opposite of option draft </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-31-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-31-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -3125,7 +3373,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">false </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-31-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1050--><p class="noindent" >use small caps instead of color for links </td>
+ <!--l. 1140--><p class="noindent" >use small caps instead of color for links </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-32-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-32-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -3132,7 +3380,7 @@
class="ec-lmvtt-10">hidelinks </span></td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-32-2"
class="td11"> </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-32-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1051--><p class="noindent" >Hide links (removing color and border) </td>
+ <!--l. 1141--><p class="noindent" >Hide links (removing color and border) </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-33-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-33-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -3140,7 +3388,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">false </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-33-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1052--><p class="noindent" >make figures hyper links </td>
+ <!--l. 1142--><p class="noindent" >make figures hyper links </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-34-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-34-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -3148,7 +3396,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">true </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-34-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1053--><p class="noindent" >set up hyperlinked footnotes </td>
+ <!--l. 1143--><p class="noindent" >set up hyperlinked footnotes </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-35-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-35-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -3156,7 +3404,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">true </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-35-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1054--><p class="noindent" >set up hyperlinked indices </td>
+ <!--l. 1144--><p class="noindent" >set up hyperlinked indices </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-36-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-36-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -3163,7 +3411,7 @@
class="ec-lmvtt-10">hypertex </span></td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-36-2"
class="td11"> </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-36-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1055--><p class="noindent" >use <span
+ <!--l. 1145--><p class="noindent" >use <span
class="ec-lmss-10">HyperTeX </span>backend </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-37-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-37-1"
@@ -3172,7 +3420,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">true </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-37-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1056--><p class="noindent" >use guessable names for links </td>
+ <!--l. 1146--><p class="noindent" >use guessable names for links </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-38-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-38-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -3180,7 +3428,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">true </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-38-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1057--><p class="noindent" >redefine LaTeX internals </td>
+ <!--l. 1147--><p class="noindent" >redefine LaTeX internals </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-39-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-39-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -3187,7 +3435,7 @@
class="ec-lmvtt-10">latex2html </span></td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-39-2"
class="td11"> </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-39-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1058--><p class="noindent" >use <span
+ <!--l. 1148--><p class="noindent" >use <span
class="ec-lmss-10">LaTeX2HTML </span>backend </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-40-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-40-1"
@@ -3196,7 +3444,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">1 0 0 </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-40-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1059--><p class="noindent" >color of border around links </td>
+ <!--l. 1149--><p class="noindent" >color of border around links </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-41-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-41-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -3204,7 +3452,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">red </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-41-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1060--><p class="noindent" >color of links </td>
+ <!--l. 1150--><p class="noindent" >color of links </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-42-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-42-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -3212,7 +3460,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">section </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-42-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1061--><p class="noindent" >make text be link on TOC, LOF and LOT </td>
+ <!--l. 1151--><p class="noindent" >make text be link on TOC, LOF and LOT </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-43-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-43-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -3220,7 +3468,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">false </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-43-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1062--><p class="noindent" >make page number, not text, be link on TOC,
+ <!--l. 1152--><p class="noindent" >make page number, not text, be link on TOC,
LOF and LOT </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-44-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-44-1"
@@ -3229,7 +3477,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">1 0 0 </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-44-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1063--><p class="noindent" >color of border around menu links </td>
+ <!--l. 1153--><p class="noindent" >color of border around menu links </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-45-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-45-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -3237,7 +3485,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">red </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-45-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1064--><p class="noindent" >color for menu links </td>
+ <!--l. 1154--><p class="noindent" >color for menu links </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-46-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-46-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -3245,7 +3493,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">false </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-46-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1065--><p class="noindent" >an alias for <span
+ <!--l. 1155--><p class="noindent" >an alias for <span
class="ec-lmss-10">dvips</span> </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-47-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-47-1"
@@ -3254,7 +3502,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">false </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-47-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1066--><p class="noindent" >use LaTeX-computed names for links </td>
+ <!--l. 1156--><p class="noindent" >use LaTeX-computed names for links </td>
</tr><tr
@@ -3264,7 +3512,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">false </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-48-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1067--><p class="noindent" >allow nesting of links </td>
+ <!--l. 1157--><p class="noindent" >allow nesting of links </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-49-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-49-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -3271,7 +3519,7 @@
class="ec-lmvtt-10">next-anchor </span></td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-49-2"
class="td11"> </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-49-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1068--><p class="noindent" >allow to set the name of the next anchor </td>
+ <!--l. 1158--><p class="noindent" >allow to set the name of the next anchor </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-50-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-50-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -3279,7 +3527,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">true </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-50-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1069--><p class="noindent" >put an anchor on every page </td>
+ <!--l. 1159--><p class="noindent" >put an anchor on every page </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-51-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-51-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -3287,7 +3535,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">false </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-51-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1070--><p class="noindent" >backreference by page number </td>
+ <!--l. 1160--><p class="noindent" >backreference by page number </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-52-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-52-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -3295,7 +3543,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">empty </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-52-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1071--><p class="noindent" >text for PDF Author field </td>
+ <!--l. 1161--><p class="noindent" >text for PDF Author field </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-53-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-53-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -3303,7 +3551,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">0 0 1 </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-53-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1072--><p class="noindent" >width of PDF link border </td>
+ <!--l. 1162--><p class="noindent" >width of PDF link border </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-54-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-54-1"
class="td01"> </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-54-2"
@@ -3310,7 +3558,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">0 0 0 </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-54-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1073--><p class="noindent" >(<span
+ <!--l. 1163--><p class="noindent" >(<span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">colorlinks)</span> </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-55-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-55-1"
@@ -3318,7 +3566,7 @@
class="ec-lmvtt-10">pdfborderstyle </span></td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-55-2"
class="td11"> </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-55-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1074--><p class="noindent" >border style for links </td>
+ <!--l. 1164--><p class="noindent" >border style for links </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-56-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-56-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -3326,7 +3574,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">false </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-56-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1075--><p class="noindent" >position the document window in the center
+ <!--l. 1165--><p class="noindent" >position the document window in the center
of the screen </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-57-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-57-1"
@@ -3335,7 +3583,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">LaTeX with </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-57-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1076--><p class="noindent" >text for PDF Creator field </td>
+ <!--l. 1166--><p class="noindent" >text for PDF Creator field </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-58-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-58-1"
class="td01"> </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-58-2"
@@ -3342,7 +3590,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">hyperref </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-58-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1078--><p class="noindent" > </td>
+ <!--l. 1168--><p class="noindent" > </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-59-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-59-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -3350,7 +3598,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">empty </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-59-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1078--><p class="noindent" >direction setting </td>
+ <!--l. 1168--><p class="noindent" >direction setting </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-60-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-60-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -3358,7 +3606,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">false </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-60-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1079--><p class="noindent" >display document title instead of file name in
+ <!--l. 1169--><p class="noindent" >display document title instead of file name in
title bar </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-61-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-61-1"
@@ -3367,7 +3615,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">empty </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-61-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1081--><p class="noindent" >paper handling option for print dialog </td>
+ <!--l. 1171--><p class="noindent" >paper handling option for print dialog </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-62-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-62-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -3375,7 +3623,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">false </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-62-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1083--><p class="noindent" >resize document window to fit document size </td>
+ <!--l. 1173--><p class="noindent" >resize document window to fit document size </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-63-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-63-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -3383,7 +3631,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">/I </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-63-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1084--><p class="noindent" >set highlighting of PDF links </td>
+ <!--l. 1174--><p class="noindent" >set highlighting of PDF links </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-64-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-64-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -3391,7 +3639,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">empty </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-64-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1085--><p class="noindent" >alternative interface for setting document
+ <!--l. 1175--><p class="noindent" >alternative interface for setting document
information </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-65-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-65-1"
@@ -3400,7 +3648,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">empty </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-65-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1086--><p class="noindent" >text for PDF Keywords field </td>
+ <!--l. 1176--><p class="noindent" >text for PDF Keywords field </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-66-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-66-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -3408,7 +3656,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">relax </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-66-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1087--><p class="noindent" >PDF language identifier (RFC 3066) </td>
+ <!--l. 1177--><p class="noindent" >PDF language identifier (RFC 3066) </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-67-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-67-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -3416,7 +3664,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">false </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-67-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1088--><p class="noindent" >an alias for <span
+ <!--l. 1178--><p class="noindent" >an alias for <span
class="ec-lmss-10">dvips</span> </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-68-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-68-1"
@@ -3425,7 +3673,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">true </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-68-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1089--><p class="noindent" >make PDF viewer’s menu bar visible </td>
+ <!--l. 1179--><p class="noindent" >make PDF viewer’s menu bar visible </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-69-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-69-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -3433,13 +3681,13 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">false </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-69-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1090--><p class="noindent" >make links that open another PDF </td>
+ <!--l. 1180--><p class="noindent" >make links that open another PDF </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-70-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-70-1"
class="td01"> </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-70-2"
class="td11"> </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-70-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1091--><p class="noindent" >file start a new window </td>
+ <!--l. 1181--><p class="noindent" >file start a new window </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-71-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-71-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -3447,7 +3695,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">empty </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-71-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1093--><p class="noindent" >page mode setting on exiting full-screen mode</td>
+ <!--l. 1183--><p class="noindent" >page mode setting on exiting full-screen mode</td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-72-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-72-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -3455,7 +3703,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">empty </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-72-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1095--><p class="noindent" >number of printed copies </td>
+ <!--l. 1185--><p class="noindent" >number of printed copies </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-73-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-73-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -3463,7 +3711,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">true </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-73-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1096--><p class="noindent" >set PDF page labels </td>
+ <!--l. 1186--><p class="noindent" >set PDF page labels </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-74-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-74-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -3471,7 +3719,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">empty </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-74-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1097--><p class="noindent" >set layout of PDF pages </td>
+ <!--l. 1187--><p class="noindent" >set layout of PDF pages </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-75-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-75-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -3479,7 +3727,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">empty </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-75-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1098--><p class="noindent" >set default mode of PDF display </td>
+ <!--l. 1188--><p class="noindent" >set default mode of PDF display </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-76-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-76-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -3487,7 +3735,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">empty </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-76-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1099--><p class="noindent" >set crop size of PDF document </td>
+ <!--l. 1189--><p class="noindent" >set crop size of PDF document </td>
</tr><tr
@@ -3497,7 +3745,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">empty </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-77-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1100--><p class="noindent" >set PDF page transition style </td>
+ <!--l. 1190--><p class="noindent" >set PDF page transition style </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-78-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-78-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -3505,7 +3753,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">empty </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-78-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1102--><p class="noindent" >set option for print dialog </td>
+ <!--l. 1192--><p class="noindent" >set option for print dialog </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-79-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-79-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -3513,7 +3761,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">empty </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-79-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1103--><p class="noindent" >set /PrintArea of viewer preferences </td>
+ <!--l. 1193--><p class="noindent" >set /PrintArea of viewer preferences </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-80-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-80-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -3521,7 +3769,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">empty </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-80-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1104--><p class="noindent" >set /PrintClip of viewer preferences </td>
+ <!--l. 1194--><p class="noindent" >set /PrintClip of viewer preferences </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-81-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-81-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -3529,7 +3777,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">empty </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-81-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1105--><p class="noindent" >set /PrintPageRange of viewer preferences </td>
+ <!--l. 1195--><p class="noindent" >set /PrintPageRange of viewer preferences </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-82-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-82-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -3537,7 +3785,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">empty </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-82-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1106--><p class="noindent" >page scaling option for print dialog </td>
+ <!--l. 1196--><p class="noindent" >page scaling option for print dialog </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-83-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-83-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -3545,7 +3793,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">empty </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-83-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1107--><p class="noindent" >text for PDF Producer field </td>
+ <!--l. 1197--><p class="noindent" >text for PDF Producer field </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-84-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-84-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -3553,7 +3801,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">Fit </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-84-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1108--><p class="noindent" >starting view of remote PDF documents </td>
+ <!--l. 1198--><p class="noindent" >starting view of remote PDF documents </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-85-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-85-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -3561,7 +3809,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">1 </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-85-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1109--><p class="noindent" >page at which PDF document opens </td>
+ <!--l. 1199--><p class="noindent" >page at which PDF document opens </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-86-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-86-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -3569,7 +3817,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">Fit </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-86-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1110--><p class="noindent" >starting view of PDF document </td>
+ <!--l. 1200--><p class="noindent" >starting view of PDF document </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-87-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-87-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -3577,7 +3825,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">empty </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-87-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1111--><p class="noindent" >text for PDF Subject field </td>
+ <!--l. 1201--><p class="noindent" >text for PDF Subject field </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-88-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-88-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -3584,7 +3832,7 @@
class="ec-lmvtt-10">pdftex </span></td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-88-2"
class="td11"> </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-88-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1112--><p class="noindent" >use <span
+ <!--l. 1202--><p class="noindent" >use <span
class="ec-lmss-10">pdfTeX </span>backend </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-89-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-89-1"
@@ -3593,7 +3841,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">empty </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-89-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1113--><p class="noindent" >text for PDF Title field </td>
+ <!--l. 1203--><p class="noindent" >text for PDF Title field </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-90-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-90-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -3601,7 +3849,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">true </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-90-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1114--><p class="noindent" >make PDF toolbar visible </td>
+ <!--l. 1204--><p class="noindent" >make PDF toolbar visible </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-91-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-91-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -3609,7 +3857,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">empty </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-91-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1115--><p class="noindent" >Sets the document information Trapped entry.
+ <!--l. 1205--><p class="noindent" >Sets the document information Trapped entry.
Possible values are <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">True</span>, <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">False </span>and <span
@@ -3622,7 +3870,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">XYZ </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-92-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1118--><p class="noindent" >PDF ‘view’ when on link traversal </td>
+ <!--l. 1208--><p class="noindent" >PDF ‘view’ when on link traversal </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-93-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-93-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -3630,7 +3878,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">empty </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-93-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1119--><p class="noindent" >set /ViewArea of viewer preferences </td>
+ <!--l. 1209--><p class="noindent" >set /ViewArea of viewer preferences </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-94-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-94-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -3638,7 +3886,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">empty </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-94-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1120--><p class="noindent" >set /ViewClip of viewer preferences </td>
+ <!--l. 1210--><p class="noindent" >set /ViewClip of viewer preferences </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-95-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-95-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -3646,7 +3894,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">true </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-95-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1121--><p class="noindent" >make PDF user interface elements visible </td>
+ <!--l. 1211--><p class="noindent" >make PDF user interface elements visible </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-96-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-96-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -3654,7 +3902,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">false </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-96-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1122--><p class="noindent" >do page number anchors as plain Arabic </td>
+ <!--l. 1212--><p class="noindent" >do page number anchors as plain Arabic </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-97-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-97-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -3661,7 +3909,7 @@
class="ec-lmvtt-10">ps2pdf </span></td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-97-2"
class="td11"> </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-97-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1123--><p class="noindent" >use <span
+ <!--l. 1213--><p class="noindent" >use <span
class="ec-lmss-10">ps2pdf </span>backend </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-98-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-98-1"
@@ -3670,7 +3918,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">false </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-98-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1124--><p class="noindent" >define more short names for PDF string
+ <!--l. 1214--><p class="noindent" >define more short names for PDF string
commands </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-99-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-99-1"
@@ -3679,7 +3927,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">false </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-99-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1125--><p class="noindent" >raise up links (for <span
+ <!--l. 1215--><p class="noindent" >raise up links (for <span
class="ec-lmss-10">HyperTeX </span>backend) </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-100-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-100-1"
@@ -3688,7 +3936,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">0 .7 .7 </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-100-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1126--><p class="noindent" >color of border around ‘run’ links </td>
+ <!--l. 1216--><p class="noindent" >color of border around ‘run’ links </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-101-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-101-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -3696,7 +3944,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">filecolor </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-101-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1127--><p class="noindent" >color of ‘run’ links </td>
+ <!--l. 1217--><p class="noindent" >color of ‘run’ links </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-102-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-102-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -3704,7 +3952,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">true </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-102-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1128--><p class="noindent" >set page size by special driver commands </td>
+ <!--l. 1218--><p class="noindent" >set page size by special driver commands </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-103-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-103-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -3711,7 +3959,7 @@
class="ec-lmvtt-10">tex4ht </span></td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-103-2"
class="td11"> </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-103-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1129--><p class="noindent" >use <span
+ <!--l. 1219--><p class="noindent" >use <span
class="ec-lmss-10">TeX4ht </span>backend </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-104-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-104-1"
@@ -3719,7 +3967,7 @@
class="ec-lmvtt-10">textures </span></td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-104-2"
class="td11"> </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-104-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1130--><p class="noindent" >use <span
+ <!--l. 1220--><p class="noindent" >use <span
class="ec-lmss-10">Textures </span>backend </td>
@@ -3730,7 +3978,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">true </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-105-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1131--><p class="noindent" >Unicode encoded pdf strings, starting with
+ <!--l. 1221--><p class="noindent" >Unicode encoded pdf strings, starting with
version v7.00g set by default to true for all
engines. It will load a number of definitions in
puenc.def. It can be set to false for pdflatex,
@@ -3742,7 +3990,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">0 1 1 </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-106-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1132--><p class="noindent" >color of border around URL links </td>
+ <!--l. 1222--><p class="noindent" >color of border around URL links </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-107-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-107-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -3750,7 +3998,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">magenta </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-107-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1133--><p class="noindent" >color of URL links </td>
+ <!--l. 1223--><p class="noindent" >color of URL links </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-108-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-108-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -3758,7 +4006,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">false </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-108-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1134--><p class="noindent" >be chatty </td>
+ <!--l. 1224--><p class="noindent" >be chatty </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-109-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-109-1"
class="td01"><span
@@ -3765,7 +4013,7 @@
class="ec-lmvtt-10">vtex </span></td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-109-2"
class="td11"> </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-109-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1135--><p class="noindent" >use <span
+ <!--l. 1225--><p class="noindent" >use <span
class="ec-lmss-10">VTeX </span>backend </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-110-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-110-1"
@@ -3773,7 +4021,7 @@
class="ec-lmvtt-10">xetex </span></td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-110-2"
class="td11"> </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-110-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1136--><p class="noindent" >use <span
+ <!--l. 1226--><p class="noindent" >use <span
class="ec-lmss-10">XeTeX </span>backend </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-13-111-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-111-1"
@@ -3793,13 +4041,12 @@
class="td11"> </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-13-115-3"
class="td10"></td></tr>
</table></div>
-<!--l. 1139--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 1229--><p class="noindent" >
<h3 class="sectionHead"><span class="titlemark">6 </span> <a
- id="x1-190006"></a>Additional user macros</h3>
-<!--l. 1141--><p class="noindent" >If you need to make references to URLs, or write explicit links, the following low-level user macros are
+ id="x1-210006"></a>Additional user macros</h3>
+<!--l. 1231--><p class="noindent" >If you need to make references to URLs, or write explicit links, the following low-level user macros are
provided:
-<!--l. 1144--><p class="noindent" >
-<span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-14" class="tabular"
+<!--l. 1234--><p class="noindent" ><span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-14" class="tabular"
><colgroup id="TBL-14-1g"><col
id="TBL-14-1"></colgroup><tr
@@ -3815,46 +4062,45 @@
class="ec-lmri-10">text</span><span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">}</span></span></span> </td>
</tr></table> </div></span>
-<!--l. 1148--><p class="noindent" >The <span
+<!--l. 1238--><p class="noindent" >The <span
class="ec-lmri-10">text </span>is made a hyperlink to the <span
class="ec-lmri-10">URL</span>; this must be a full URL (relative to the base URL, if that is
defined). The special characters # and ˜ do <span
class="ec-lmri-10">not </span>need to be escaped in any way (unless the command is
used in the argument of another command).
-<!--l. 1153--><p class="indent" > The optional argument <span
+<!--l. 1243--><p class="indent" > The optional argument <span
class="ec-lmri-10">options </span>recognizes the hyperref options <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">pdfremotestartview</span>, <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">pdfnewwindow</span>
and the following key value options:
<dl class="description"><dt class="description">
- <!--l. 1157--><p class="noindent" >
+ <!--l. 1247--><p class="noindent" >
<span
class="ec-lmvtk-10">page</span><span
class="ec-lmbx-10">:</span> </dt><dd
class="description">
- <!--l. 1157--><p class="noindent" >Specifies the start page number of remote PDF documents. First page is <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+ <!--l. 1247--><p class="noindent" >Specifies the start page number of remote PDF documents. First page is <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">1</span></span></span>.
</dd><dt class="description">
- <!--l. 1159--><p class="noindent" >
+ <!--l. 1249--><p class="noindent" >
<span
class="ec-lmvtk-10">ismap</span><span
class="ec-lmbx-10">:</span> </dt><dd
class="description">
- <!--l. 1159--><p class="noindent" >Boolean key, if set to <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+ <!--l. 1249--><p class="noindent" >Boolean key, if set to <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">true</span></span></span>, the URL should appended by the coordinates as query parameters
by the PDF viewer.
</dd><dt class="description">
- <!--l. 1162--><p class="noindent" >
+ <!--l. 1252--><p class="noindent" >
<span
class="ec-lmvtk-10">nextactionraw</span><span
class="ec-lmbx-10">:</span> </dt><dd
class="description">
- <!--l. 1162--><p class="noindent" >The value of key <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+ <!--l. 1252--><p class="noindent" >The value of key <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">/Next</span></span></span> of action dictionaries, see PDF specification.</dd></dl>
-<!--l. 1166--><p class="noindent" >
-<span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-15" class="tabular"
+<!--l. 1256--><p class="noindent" ><span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-15" class="tabular"
><colgroup id="TBL-15-1g"><col
id="TBL-15-1"></colgroup><tr
@@ -3864,7 +4110,7 @@
class="ec-lmvtt-10">{</span></span></span><span
class="ec-lmri-10">URL</span><span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">}</span></span></span> </td></tr></table> </div></span>
-<!--l. 1170--><p class="noindent" >Similar to <span
+<!--l. 1260--><p class="noindent" >Similar to <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\href</span><span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">{</span></span></span><span
class="ec-lmri-10">URL</span><span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
@@ -3875,8 +4121,7 @@
class="ec-lmvtt-10">}}</span></span></span>. Depending on the driver <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\href</span></span></span> also tries to detect the link
type. Thus the result can be a url link, file link, …
-<!--l. 1175--><p class="noindent" >
-<span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-16" class="tabular"
+<!--l. 1265--><p class="noindent" ><span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-16" class="tabular"
><colgroup id="TBL-16-1g"><col
id="TBL-16-1"></colgroup><tr
@@ -3886,11 +4131,10 @@
class="ec-lmvtt-10">{</span></span></span><span
class="ec-lmri-10">URL</span><span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">}</span></span></span> </td></tr></table> </div></span>
-<!--l. 1179--><p class="noindent" >Write <span
+<!--l. 1269--><p class="noindent" >Write <span
class="ec-lmri-10">URL </span>in the same way as <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\url</span></span></span>, without creating a hyperlink.
-<!--l. 1182--><p class="noindent" >
-<span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-17" class="tabular"
+<!--l. 1272--><p class="noindent" ><span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-17" class="tabular"
><colgroup id="TBL-17-1g"><col
id="TBL-17-1"></colgroup><tr
@@ -3901,11 +4145,10 @@
class="ec-lmri-10">URL</span><span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">}</span></span></span> </td>
</tr></table> </div></span>
-<!--l. 1186--><p class="noindent" >A base <span
+<!--l. 1276--><p class="noindent" >A base <span
class="ec-lmri-10">URL </span>is established, which is prepended to other specified URLs, to make it easier to write
portable documents.
-<!--l. 1189--><p class="noindent" >
-<span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-18" class="tabular"
+<!--l. 1279--><p class="noindent" ><span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-18" class="tabular"
><colgroup id="TBL-18-1g"><col
id="TBL-18-1"></colgroup><tr
@@ -3918,13 +4161,12 @@
class="ec-lmri-10">text</span><span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">}</span></span></span> </td>
</tr></table> </div></span>
-<!--l. 1193--><p class="noindent" >The link to the image referenced by the URL is inserted, using <span
+<!--l. 1283--><p class="noindent" >The link to the image referenced by the URL is inserted, using <span
class="ec-lmri-10">text </span>as the anchor.
-<!--l. 1196--><p class="indent" > For drivers that produce HTML, the image itself is inserted by the browser, with the <span
+<!--l. 1286--><p class="indent" > For drivers that produce HTML, the image itself is inserted by the browser, with the <span
class="ec-lmri-10">text </span>being
ignored completely.
-<!--l. 1199--><p class="noindent" >
-<span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-19" class="tabular"
+<!--l. 1289--><p class="noindent" ><span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-19" class="tabular"
><colgroup id="TBL-19-1g"><col
id="TBL-19-1"></colgroup><tr
@@ -3939,11 +4181,10 @@
class="ec-lmri-10">text</span><span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">}</span></span></span> </td>
</tr></table> </div></span>
-<!--l. 1203--><p class="noindent" >A target area of the document (the <span
+<!--l. 1293--><p class="noindent" >A target area of the document (the <span
class="ec-lmri-10">text</span>) is marked, and given the name <span
class="ec-lmri-10">category.name</span>
-<!--l. 1206--><p class="noindent" >
-<span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-20" class="tabular"
+<!--l. 1296--><p class="noindent" ><span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-20" class="tabular"
><colgroup id="TBL-20-1g"><col
id="TBL-20-1"></colgroup><tr
@@ -3960,11 +4201,10 @@
class="ec-lmri-10">text</span><span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">}</span></span></span> </td>
</tr></table> </div></span>
-<!--l. 1210--><p class="noindent" ><span
+<!--l. 1300--><p class="noindent" ><span
class="ec-lmri-10">text </span>is made into a link to <span
class="ec-lmri-10">URL#category.name</span>
-<!--l. 1212--><p class="noindent" >
-<span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-21" class="tabular"
+<!--l. 1302--><p class="noindent" ><span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-21" class="tabular"
><colgroup id="TBL-21-1g"><col
id="TBL-21-1"></colgroup><tr
@@ -3977,13 +4217,12 @@
class="ec-lmri-10">text</span><span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">}</span></span></span> </td>
</tr></table> </div></span>
-<!--l. 1216--><p class="noindent" ><span
+<!--l. 1306--><p class="noindent" ><span
class="ec-lmri-10">text </span>is made into a link to the same place as <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\ref{</span></span></span><span
class="ec-lmri-10">label</span><span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">}</span></span></span> would be linked.
-<!--l. 1220--><p class="noindent" >
-<span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-22" class="tabular"
+<!--l. 1310--><p class="noindent" ><span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-22" class="tabular"
><colgroup id="TBL-22-1g"><col
id="TBL-22-1"></colgroup><tr
@@ -3996,8 +4235,7 @@
class="ec-lmri-10">text</span><span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">}</span></span></span> </td>
</tr></table> </div></span>
-<!--l. 1223--><p class="noindent" >
-<span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-23" class="tabular"
+<!--l. 1313--><p class="noindent" ><span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-23" class="tabular"
><colgroup id="TBL-23-1g"><col
id="TBL-23-1"></colgroup><tr
@@ -4010,7 +4248,7 @@
class="ec-lmri-10">text</span><span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">}</span></span></span> </td>
</tr></table> </div></span>
-<!--l. 1227--><p class="noindent" >A simple internal link is created with <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+<!--l. 1317--><p class="noindent" >A simple internal link is created with <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\hypertarget</span></span></span>, with two parameters of an anchor <span
class="ec-lmri-10">name</span>, and anchor
<span
@@ -4019,14 +4257,11 @@
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\hypertarget</span></span></span>,
and the <span
class="ec-lmri-10">text </span>which be used as the link on the page.
-
-
-<!--l. 1233--><p class="indent" > Note that in HTML parlance, the <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+<!--l. 1323--><p class="indent" > Note that in HTML parlance, the <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\hyperlink</span></span></span> command inserts a notional # in front of each link,
making it relative to the current testdocument; <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\href</span></span></span> expects a full URL.
-<!--l. 1237--><p class="noindent" >
-<span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-24" class="tabular"
+<!--l. 1327--><p class="noindent" ><span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-24" class="tabular"
><colgroup id="TBL-24-1g"><col
id="TBL-24-1"></colgroup><tr
@@ -4034,27 +4269,27 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\phantomsection </span></td>
</tr></table> </div></span>
-<!--l. 1241--><p class="noindent" >This sets an anchor at this location. It works similar to <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+<!--l. 1331--><p class="noindent" >This sets an anchor at this location. It works similar to <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\hypertarget{}{}</span></span></span> with an automatically chosen
anchor name. Often it is used in conjunction with <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\addcontentsline</span></span></span> for sectionlike things (index,
bibliography, preface). <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\addcontentsline</span></span></span> refers to the latest previous location where an anchor is set.
-Example:
+Example:
+
<blockquote class="quote">
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-16">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-18">
\cleardoublepage
\phantomsection
\addcontentsline{toc}{chapter}{\indexname}
\printindex
</pre>
- <!--l. 1254--><p class="nopar" ></blockquote>
-<!--l. 1256--><p class="noindent" >Now the entry in the table of contents (and bookmarks) for the index points to the start of the index page,
+ <!--l. 1344--><p class="nopar" ></blockquote>
+<!--l. 1346--><p class="noindent" >Now the entry in the table of contents (and bookmarks) for the index points to the start of the index page,
not to a location before this page.
-<!--l. 1260--><p class="noindent" >
-<span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-25" class="tabular"
+<!--l. 1350--><p class="noindent" ><span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-25" class="tabular"
><colgroup id="TBL-25-1g"><col
id="TBL-25-1"></colgroup><tr
@@ -4073,7 +4308,7 @@
class="ec-lmri-10">label</span><span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">}</span></span></span> </td>
</tr></table> </div></span>
-<!--l. 1265--><p class="indent" > This retrieves the anchor or the page anchor from a label in an expandable way. It takes
+<!--l. 1355--><p class="indent" > This retrieves the anchor or the page anchor from a label in an expandable way. It takes
<span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\HyperDestNameFilter</span></span></span> into account. It can e.g. be used with the <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\bookmark</span></span></span> from the bookmark
@@ -4080,16 +4315,15 @@
package to set a destination to a label:
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-17">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-19">
\bookmark[dest=\hyperget{anchor}{sec}]{section}
</pre>
-<!--l. 1271--><p class="nopar" >
-<!--l. 1273--><p class="indent" > As <span
+<!--l. 1361--><p class="nopar" >
+<!--l. 1363--><p class="indent" > As <span
class="ec-lmri-10">pageanchor </span>retrieves the page number from the label it can’t be use together with the option
<span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">plainpages</span>.
-<!--l. 1276--><p class="noindent" >
-<span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-26" class="tabular"
+<!--l. 1366--><p class="noindent" ><span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-26" class="tabular"
><colgroup id="TBL-26-1g"><col
id="TBL-26-1"></colgroup><tr
@@ -4100,11 +4334,10 @@
class="ec-lmri-10">currentanchor</span><span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">}{}</span></span></span> </td>
</tr></table> </div></span>
-<!--l. 1280--><p class="indent" > This retrieves the last anchor that has been set. It too takes <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+<!--l. 1370--><p class="indent" > This retrieves the last anchor that has been set. It too takes <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\HyperDestNameFilter</span></span></span> into
account.
-<!--l. 1284--><p class="noindent" >
-<span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-27" class="tabular"
+<!--l. 1374--><p class="noindent" ><span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-27" class="tabular"
><colgroup id="TBL-27-1g"><col
id="TBL-27-1"></colgroup><tr
@@ -4114,11 +4347,11 @@
class="ec-lmvtt-10">{</span></span></span><span
class="ec-lmri-10">label</span><span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">}</span></span></span> </td></tr></table> </div></span>
-<!--l. 1288--><p class="noindent" >This is a replacement for the usual <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+<!--l. 1378--><p class="noindent" >This is a replacement for the usual <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\ref</span></span></span> command that places a contextual label in front of the reference.
This gives your users a bigger target to click for hyperlinks (e.g. ‘section 2’ instead of merely the number
‘2’).
-<!--l. 1294--><p class="indent" > The label is worked out from the context of the original <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+<!--l. 1384--><p class="indent" > The label is worked out from the context of the original <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\label</span></span></span> command by <span
class="ec-lmss-10">hyperref </span>by using the
macros listed below (shown with their default values). The macros can be (re)defined in documents using
@@ -4126,7 +4359,7 @@
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\(re)newcommand</span></span></span>; note that some of these macros are already defined in the standard document
classes. The mixture of lowercase and uppercase initial letters is deliberate and corresponds to the
author’s practice.
-<!--l. 1302--><p class="indent" > For each macro below, <span
+<!--l. 1392--><p class="indent" > For each macro below, <span
class="ec-lmss-10">hyperref </span>checks <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\*autorefname </span>before <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\*name</span>. For instance, it looks for
@@ -4133,9 +4366,9 @@
<span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\figureautorefname </span>before <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\figurename</span>.
-<!--l. 1306--><p class="indent" >
+<!--l. 1396--><p class="indent" >
<a
- id="x1-19001r12"></a> <!--l. 1307--><div class="longtable"> <table id="TBL-28" class="longtable"
+ id="x1-21001r12"></a> <!--l. 1397--><div class="longtable"> <table id="TBL-28" class="longtable"
><colgroup id="TBL-28-1g"><col
id="TBL-28-1"><col
@@ -4145,7 +4378,7 @@
class="td01"><span
class="ec-lmri-10">Macro </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-28-1-2"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1307--><p class="noindent" ><span
+ <!--l. 1397--><p class="noindent" ><span
class="ec-lmri-10">Default</span> </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-28-2-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-28-2-1"
@@ -4152,93 +4385,93 @@
class="td01"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\figurename </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-28-2-2"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1308--><p class="noindent" >Figure </td>
+ <!--l. 1398--><p class="noindent" >Figure </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-28-3-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-28-3-1"
class="td01"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\tablename </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-28-3-2"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1309--><p class="noindent" >Table </td>
+ <!--l. 1399--><p class="noindent" >Table </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-28-4-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-28-4-1"
class="td01"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\partname </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-28-4-2"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1310--><p class="noindent" >Part </td>
+ <!--l. 1400--><p class="noindent" >Part </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-28-5-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-28-5-1"
class="td01"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\appendixname </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-28-5-2"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1311--><p class="noindent" >Appendix </td>
+ <!--l. 1401--><p class="noindent" >Appendix </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-28-6-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-28-6-1"
class="td01"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\equationname </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-28-6-2"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1312--><p class="noindent" >Equation </td>
+ <!--l. 1402--><p class="noindent" >Equation </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-28-7-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-28-7-1"
class="td01"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\Itemname </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-28-7-2"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1313--><p class="noindent" >item </td>
+ <!--l. 1403--><p class="noindent" >item </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-28-8-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-28-8-1"
class="td01"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\chaptername </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-28-8-2"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1314--><p class="noindent" >chapter </td>
+ <!--l. 1404--><p class="noindent" >chapter </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-28-9-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-28-9-1"
class="td01"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\sectionname </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-28-9-2"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1315--><p class="noindent" >section </td>
+ <!--l. 1405--><p class="noindent" >section </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-28-10-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-28-10-1"
class="td01"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\subsectionname </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-28-10-2"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1316--><p class="noindent" >subsection </td>
+ <!--l. 1406--><p class="noindent" >subsection </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-28-11-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-28-11-1"
class="td01"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\subsubsectionname </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-28-11-2"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1317--><p class="noindent" >subsubsection </td>
+ <!--l. 1407--><p class="noindent" >subsubsection </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-28-12-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-28-12-1"
class="td01"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\paragraphname </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-28-12-2"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1318--><p class="noindent" >paragraph </td>
-
-
+ <!--l. 1408--><p class="noindent" >paragraph </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-28-13-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-28-13-1"
class="td01"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\Hfootnotename </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-28-13-2"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1319--><p class="noindent" >footnote </td>
+ <!--l. 1409--><p class="noindent" >footnote </td>
+
+
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-28-14-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-28-14-1"
class="td01"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\AMSname </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-28-14-2"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1320--><p class="noindent" >Equation </td>
+ <!--l. 1410--><p class="noindent" >Equation </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-28-15-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-28-15-1"
class="td01"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\theoremname </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-28-15-2"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1321--><p class="noindent" >Theorem </td>
+ <!--l. 1411--><p class="noindent" >Theorem </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-28-16-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-28-16-1"
class="td01"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\page </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-28-16-2"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 1322--><p class="noindent" >page </td>
+ <!--l. 1412--><p class="noindent" >page </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-28-17-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-28-17-1"
class="td01"> </td>
@@ -4256,19 +4489,19 @@
class="td01"> </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-28-21-2"
class="td10"></td></tr>
</table></div>
-<!--l. 1325--><p class="indent" > Example for a redefinition if <span
+<!--l. 1415--><p class="indent" > Example for a redefinition if <span
class="ec-lmss-10">babel </span>is used:
<blockquote class="quote">
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-18">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-20">
\usepackage[ngerman]{babel}
\addto\extrasngerman{%
  \def\subsectionautorefname{Unterkapitel}%
}
</pre>
- <!--l. 1332--><p class="nopar" ></blockquote>
-<!--l. 1335--><p class="indent" > Hint: <span
+ <!--l. 1422--><p class="nopar" ></blockquote>
+<!--l. 1425--><p class="indent" > Hint: <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\autoref </span>works via the counter name that the reference is based on. Sometimes <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\autoref</span>
chooses the wrong name, if the counter is used for different things. For example, it happens with
@@ -4280,7 +4513,7 @@
<blockquote class="quote">
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-19">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-21">
\documentclass{article}
\usepackage{aliascnt}
@@ -4308,9 +4541,8 @@
\end{document}
</pre>
- <!--l. 1370--><p class="nopar" ></blockquote>
-<!--l. 1373--><p class="noindent" >
-<span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-29" class="tabular"
+ <!--l. 1460--><p class="nopar" ></blockquote>
+<!--l. 1463--><p class="noindent" ><span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-29" class="tabular"
><colgroup id="TBL-29-1g"><col
id="TBL-29-1"></colgroup><tr
@@ -4321,17 +4553,18 @@
class="ec-lmri-10">label</span><span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">}</span></span></span> </td>
</tr></table> </div></span>
-<!--l. 1377--><p class="noindent" >It replaces <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+<!--l. 1467--><p class="noindent" >It replaces <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\pageref</span></span></span> and adds the name for page in front of the page reference. First <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\pageautorefname</span>
is checked before <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\pagename</span>.
-<!--l. 1382--><p class="indent" > For instances where you want a reference to use the correct counter, but not to create a
+<!--l. 1472--><p class="indent" > For instances where you want a reference to use the correct counter, but not to create a
link, there are starred forms (these starred forms exist even if hyperref has been loaded with
<span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">implicit=false</span></span></span>):
-<!--l. 1386--><p class="noindent" >
-<span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-30" class="tabular"
+
+
+<!--l. 1476--><p class="noindent" ><span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-30" class="tabular"
><colgroup id="TBL-30-1g"><col
id="TBL-30-1"></colgroup><tr
@@ -4341,8 +4574,7 @@
class="ec-lmvtt-10">{</span></span></span><span
class="ec-lmri-10">label</span><span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">}</span></span></span> </td></tr></table> </div></span>
-<!--l. 1390--><p class="noindent" >
-<span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-31" class="tabular"
+<!--l. 1480--><p class="noindent" ><span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-31" class="tabular"
><colgroup id="TBL-31-1g"><col
id="TBL-31-1"></colgroup><tr
@@ -4353,9 +4585,7 @@
class="ec-lmri-10">label</span><span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">}</span></span></span> </td>
</tr></table> </div></span>
-<!--l. 1394--><p class="noindent" >
-
-<span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-32" class="tabular"
+<!--l. 1484--><p class="noindent" ><span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-32" class="tabular"
><colgroup id="TBL-32-1g"><col
id="TBL-32-1"></colgroup><tr
@@ -4365,8 +4595,7 @@
class="ec-lmvtt-10">{</span></span></span><span
class="ec-lmri-10">label</span><span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">}</span></span></span> </td></tr></table> </div></span>
-<!--l. 1398--><p class="noindent" >
-<span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-33" class="tabular"
+<!--l. 1488--><p class="noindent" ><span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-33" class="tabular"
><colgroup id="TBL-33-1g"><col
id="TBL-33-1"></colgroup><tr
@@ -4377,19 +4606,18 @@
class="ec-lmri-10">label</span><span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">}</span></span></span> </td>
</tr></table> </div></span>
-<!--l. 1402--><p class="indent" > A typical use would be to write
+<!--l. 1492--><p class="indent" > A typical use would be to write
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-20">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-22">
\hyperref[other]{that nice section (\ref*{other}) we read before}
</pre>
-<!--l. 1405--><p class="nopar" >
-<!--l. 1407--><p class="indent" > We want <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+<!--l. 1495--><p class="nopar" >
+<!--l. 1497--><p class="indent" > We want <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\ref*{other}</span></span></span> to generate the correct number, but not to form a link, since we do this
ourselves with <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\hyperref</span>.
-<!--l. 1410--><p class="noindent" >
-<span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-34" class="tabular"
+<!--l. 1500--><p class="noindent" ><span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-34" class="tabular"
><colgroup id="TBL-34-1g"><col
id="TBL-34-1"></colgroup><tr
@@ -4402,21 +4630,21 @@
class="ec-lmri-10">TeXstring</span><span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">}</span></span></span> </td>
</tr></table> </div></span>
-<!--l. 1414--><p class="indent" > <span
+<!--l. 1504--><p class="indent" > <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\pdfstringdef </span>returns a macro containing the PDF string. (Currently this is done globally, but do not
rely on it.) All the following tasks, definitions and redefinitions are made in a group to keep them
local:
<ul class="itemize1">
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 1419--><p class="noindent" >Switching to PD1 or PU encoding
+ <!--l. 1509--><p class="noindent" >Switching to PD1 or PU encoding
</li>
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 1420--><p class="noindent" >Defining the “octal sequence commands” (<span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+ <!--l. 1510--><p class="noindent" >Defining the “octal sequence commands” (<span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\345</span></span></span>): <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\edef\3{\string\3}</span></span></span>
</li>
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 1421--><p class="noindent" >Special glyphs of TeX: <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+ <!--l. 1511--><p class="noindent" >Special glyphs of TeX: <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\{</span></span></span>, <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\%</span></span></span>, <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\&</span></span></span>, <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
@@ -4424,18 +4652,18 @@
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\dots</span></span></span>, etc.
</li>
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 1422--><p class="noindent" >National glyphs (<span
+ <!--l. 1512--><p class="noindent" >National glyphs (<span
class="ec-lmss-10">german.sty</span>, <span
class="ec-lmss-10">french.sty</span>, etc.)
</li>
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 1423--><p class="noindent" >Logos: <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+ <!--l. 1513--><p class="noindent" >Logos: <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\TeX</span></span></span>, <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\eTeX</span></span></span>, <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\MF</span></span></span>, etc.
</li>
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 1424--><p class="noindent" >Disabling commands that do not provide useful functionality in bookmarks: <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+ <!--l. 1514--><p class="noindent" >Disabling commands that do not provide useful functionality in bookmarks: <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\label</span></span></span>, <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\index</span></span></span>,
<span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
@@ -4445,21 +4673,20 @@
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\let</span></span></span>, etc.
</li>
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 1426--><p class="noindent" >LaTeX’s font commands like <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+ <!--l. 1516--><p class="noindent" >LaTeX’s font commands like <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\textbf</span></span></span>, etc.
</li>
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 1427--><p class="noindent" >Support for <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+ <!--l. 1517--><p class="noindent" >Support for <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\xspace</span></span></span> provided by the <span
class="ec-lmss-10">xspace </span>package</li></ul>
-<!--l. 1430--><p class="indent" > In addition, parentheses are protected to avoid the danger of unsafe unbalanced parentheses in
+<!--l. 1520--><p class="indent" > In addition, parentheses are protected to avoid the danger of unsafe unbalanced parentheses in
the PDF string. For further details, see Heiko Oberdiek’s EuroTeX paper distributed with
<span
class="ec-lmss-10">hyperref</span>.
-<!--l. 1434--><p class="noindent" >
-<span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-35" class="tabular"
+<!--l. 1524--><p class="noindent" ><span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-35" class="tabular"
><colgroup id="TBL-35-1g"><col
id="TBL-35-1"></colgroup><tr
@@ -4470,23 +4697,22 @@
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\end</span><span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">{NoHyper}</span></span></span> </td>
</tr></table> </div></span>
-<!--l. 1437--><p class="indent" > Sometimes we just don’t want the wretched package interfering with us. Define an environment we
+<!--l. 1527--><p class="indent" > Sometimes we just don’t want the wretched package interfering with us. Define an environment we
can put in manually, or include in a style file, which stops the hypertext functions doing anything.
This is used, for instance, in the Elsevier classes, to stop <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">hyperref</span></span></span> playing havoc in the front
matter.
-<!--l. 1443--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 1533--><p class="noindent" >
<h4 class="subsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">6.1 </span> <a
- id="x1-200006.1"></a>Bookmark macros</h4>
-<!--l. 1445--><p class="noindent" >
+ id="x1-220006.1"></a>Bookmark macros</h4>
+<!--l. 1535--><p class="noindent" >
<h5 class="subsubsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">6.1.1 </span> <a
- id="x1-210006.1.1"></a>Setting bookmarks</h5>
-<!--l. 1447--><p class="noindent" >Usually <span
+ id="x1-230006.1.1"></a>Setting bookmarks</h5>
+<!--l. 1537--><p class="noindent" >Usually <span
class="ec-lmss-10">hyperref </span>automatically adds bookmarks for <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\section</span></span></span> and similar macros. But they can also set
manually.
-<!--l. 1450--><p class="noindent" >
-<span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-36" class="tabular"
+<!--l. 1540--><p class="noindent" ><span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-36" class="tabular"
><colgroup id="TBL-36-1g"><col
id="TBL-36-1"></colgroup><tr
@@ -4500,12 +4726,11 @@
class="ec-lmri-10">name</span><span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">}</span></span></span> </td>
</tr></table> </div></span>
-<!--l. 1453--><p class="indent" > creates a bookmark with the specified text and at the given level (default is 0). As name for the
+<!--l. 1543--><p class="indent" > creates a bookmark with the specified text and at the given level (default is 0). As name for the
internal anchor name is used (in conjunction with level). Therefore the name must be unique (similar to
<span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\label</span></span></span>).
-<!--l. 1457--><p class="noindent" >
-<span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-37" class="tabular"
+<!--l. 1547--><p class="noindent" ><span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-37" class="tabular"
><colgroup id="TBL-37-1g"><col
id="TBL-37-1"></colgroup><tr
@@ -4518,9 +4743,8 @@
class="ec-lmri-10">name</span><span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">}</span></span></span> </td>
</tr></table> </div></span>
-<!--l. 1460--><p class="indent" > creates a bookmark at the current level.
-<!--l. 1462--><p class="noindent" >
-<span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-38" class="tabular"
+<!--l. 1550--><p class="indent" > creates a bookmark at the current level.
+<!--l. 1552--><p class="noindent" ><span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-38" class="tabular"
><colgroup id="TBL-38-1g"><col
id="TBL-38-1"></colgroup><tr
@@ -4533,10 +4757,9 @@
class="ec-lmri-10">name</span><span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">}</span></span></span> </td>
</tr></table> </div></span>
-<!--l. 1465--><p class="indent" > creates a bookmark one step down in the bookmark hierarchy. Internally the current level is increased
+<!--l. 1555--><p class="indent" > creates a bookmark one step down in the bookmark hierarchy. Internally the current level is increased
by one.
-<!--l. 1468--><p class="noindent" >
-<span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-39" class="tabular"
+<!--l. 1558--><p class="noindent" ><span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-39" class="tabular"
><colgroup id="TBL-39-1g"><col
id="TBL-39-1"></colgroup><tr
@@ -4549,33 +4772,33 @@
class="ec-lmri-10">name</span><span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">}</span></span></span> </td>
</tr></table> </div></span>
-<!--l. 1471--><p class="indent" > creates a bookmark below the current bookmark level. However after the command the current
+<!--l. 1561--><p class="indent" > creates a bookmark below the current bookmark level. However after the command the current
bookmark level has not changed.
-<!--l. 1474--><p class="noindent" ><span
+<!--l. 1564--><p class="noindent" ><span
class="ec-lmbx-10">Hint: </span>Package <span
class="ec-lmss-10">bookmark </span>replaces <span
class="ec-lmss-10">hyperref</span>’s bookmark organization by a new algorithm:
<ul class="itemize1">
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 1477--><p class="noindent" >Usually only one LaTeX run is needed.
-
+ <!--l. 1567--><p class="noindent" >Usually only one LaTeX run is needed.
</li>
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 1478--><p class="noindent" >More control over the bookmark appearance (color, font).
+ <!--l. 1568--><p class="noindent" >More control over the bookmark appearance (color, font).
+
+
</li>
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 1479--><p class="noindent" >Different bookmark actions are supported (external file links, URLs, …).</li></ul>
-<!--l. 1482--><p class="noindent" >Therefore I recommend using this package.
-<!--l. 1484--><p class="noindent" >
+ <!--l. 1569--><p class="noindent" >Different bookmark actions are supported (external file links, URLs, …).</li></ul>
+<!--l. 1572--><p class="noindent" >Therefore I recommend using this package.
+<!--l. 1574--><p class="noindent" >
<h5 class="subsubsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">6.1.2 </span> <a
- id="x1-220006.1.2"></a>Replacement macros</h5>
-<!--l. 1486--><p class="noindent" ><span
+ id="x1-240006.1.2"></a>Replacement macros</h5>
+<!--l. 1576--><p class="noindent" ><span
class="ec-lmss-10">hyperref </span>takes the text for bookmarks from the arguments of commands like <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\section</span>, which can
contain things like math, colors, or font changes, none of which will display in bookmarks as
is.
-<!--l. 1490--><p class="noindent" >
-<span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-40" class="tabular"
+<!--l. 1580--><p class="noindent" ><span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-40" class="tabular"
><colgroup id="TBL-40-1g"><col
id="TBL-40-1"></colgroup><tr
@@ -4588,10 +4811,10 @@
class="ec-lmri-10">PDFstring</span><span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">}</span></span></span> </td>
</tr></table> </div></span>
-<!--l. 1494--><p class="indent" > For example,
+<!--l. 1584--><p class="indent" > For example,
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-21">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-23">
\section{Pythagoras:
  \texorpdfstring{$ a^2 + b^2 = c^2 $}{%
    a\texttwosuperior\ + b\texttwosuperior\ =
@@ -4600,13 +4823,13 @@
}
\section{\texorpdfstring{\textcolor{red}}{}{Red} Mars}
</pre>
-<!--l. 1503--><p class="nopar" >
-<!--l. 1505--><p class="indent" > <span
+<!--l. 1593--><p class="nopar" >
+<!--l. 1595--><p class="indent" > <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\pdfstringdef </span>executes the hook before it expands the string. Therefore, you can use this hook to
perform additional tasks or to disable additional commands.
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-22">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-24">
\expandafter\def\expandafter\pdfstringdefPreHook
\expandafter{%
  \pdfstringdefPreHook
@@ -4613,8 +4836,8 @@
  \renewcommand{\mycommand}[1]{}%
}
</pre>
-<!--l. 1515--><p class="nopar" >
-<!--l. 1517--><p class="indent" > However, for disabling commands, an easier way is via <span
+<!--l. 1605--><p class="nopar" >
+<!--l. 1607--><p class="indent" > However, for disabling commands, an easier way is via <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\pdfstringdefDisableCommands</span>, which adds
its argument to the definition of <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\pdfstringdefPreHook </span>(‘@’ can here be used as letter in command
@@ -4621,7 +4844,7 @@
names):
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-23">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-25">
\pdfstringdefDisableCommands{%
  \let~\textasciitilde
  \def\url{\pdfstringdefWarn\url}%
@@ -4628,12 +4851,11 @@
  \let\textcolor\@gobble
}
</pre>
-<!--l. 1528--><p class="nopar" >
-<!--l. 1530--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 1618--><p class="nopar" >
+<!--l. 1620--><p class="noindent" >
<h4 class="subsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">6.2 </span> <a
- id="x1-230006.2"></a>Pagelabels</h4>
-<!--l. 1531--><p class="noindent" >
-<span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-41" class="tabular"
+ id="x1-250006.2"></a>Pagelabels</h4>
+<!--l. 1621--><p class="noindent" ><span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-41" class="tabular"
><colgroup id="TBL-41-1g"><col
id="TBL-41-1"></colgroup><tr
@@ -4644,20 +4866,19 @@
class="ec-lmri-10">page number format</span><span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">}</span></span></span> </td>
</tr></table> </div></span>
-<!--l. 1535--><p class="noindent" >This allows to change format of the page number shown in the tool bar of a PDF viewer for a specific
+<!--l. 1625--><p class="noindent" >This allows to change format of the page number shown in the tool bar of a PDF viewer for a specific
page, for example
-<!--l. 1538--><p class="indent" > <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+<!--l. 1628--><p class="indent" > <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\thispdfpagelabel{Empty</span><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10"> Page-\roman{page}}</span></span></span>
-<!--l. 1540--><p class="indent" > The command affects the page on which it is executed, so asynchronous page breaking should be
+<!--l. 1630--><p class="indent" > The command affects the page on which it is executed, so asynchronous page breaking should be
taken into account. It should be used in places where for example <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\thispagestyle</span></span></span> can be use
too.
-<!--l. 1543--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 1633--><p class="noindent" >
<h4 class="subsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">6.3 </span> <a
- id="x1-240006.3"></a>Utility macros</h4>
-<!--l. 1546--><p class="noindent" >
-<span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-42" class="tabular"
+ id="x1-260006.3"></a>Utility macros</h4>
+<!--l. 1636--><p class="noindent" ><span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-42" class="tabular"
><colgroup id="TBL-42-1g"><col
id="TBL-42-1"></colgroup><tr
@@ -4668,7 +4889,7 @@
class="ec-lmri-10">dimen specification</span><span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">}</span></span></span> </td>
</tr></table> </div></span>
-<!--l. 1549--><p class="noindent" ><span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+<!--l. 1639--><p class="noindent" ><span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\hypercalcbp</span></span></span> takes a TeX dimen specification and converts it to bp and returns the number
without the unit. This is useful for options <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">pdfview</span></span></span>, <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
@@ -4678,15 +4899,15 @@
<blockquote class="quote">
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-24">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-26">
\hypersetup{
  pdfstartview={FitBH \hypercalcbp{\paperheight-\topmargin-1in
    -\headheight-\headsep}
}
</pre>
- <!--l. 1561--><p class="nopar" ></blockquote>
-<!--l. 1563--><p class="noindent" >The origin of the PDF coordinate system is the lower left corner.
-<!--l. 1565--><p class="indent" > Note, for calculations you need either package <span
+ <!--l. 1651--><p class="nopar" ></blockquote>
+<!--l. 1653--><p class="noindent" >The origin of the PDF coordinate system is the lower left corner.
+<!--l. 1655--><p class="indent" > Note, for calculations you need either package <span
class="ec-lmss-10">calc </span>or <span
class="lmmi-10">ε</span>-<span class="HoLogo-TeX">T<span class="HoLogo-e">E</span>X</span>. Nowadays the latter should
automatically be enabled for <span class="HoLogo-LaTeX">L<span class="HoLogo-a">A</span><span class="HoLogo-TeX">T<span class="HoLogo-e">E</span>X</span></span> formats. Users without <span
@@ -4693,7 +4914,7 @@
class="lmmi-10">ε</span>-<span class="HoLogo-TeX">T<span class="HoLogo-e">E</span>X</span>, please, look in the source
documentation <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">hyperref.dtx</span></span></span> for further limitations.
-<!--l. 1571--><p class="indent" > Also <span
+<!--l. 1661--><p class="indent" > Also <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\hypercalcbp </span>cannot be used in option specifications of <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\documentclass </span>and <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\usepackage</span>,
@@ -4700,51 +4921,51 @@
because <span class="HoLogo-LaTeX">L<span class="HoLogo-a">A</span><span class="HoLogo-TeX">T<span class="HoLogo-e">E</span>X</span></span> expands the option lists of these commands. However package <span
class="ec-lmss-10">hyperref </span>is not yet loaded
and an undefined control sequence error would arise.
-<!--l. 1578--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 1668--><p class="noindent" >
<h3 class="sectionHead"><span class="titlemark">7 </span> <a
- id="x1-250007"></a>New Features<span class="footnote-mark"><a
+ id="x1-270007"></a>New Features<span class="footnote-mark"><a
href="hyperref-doc6.html#fn5x0"><sup class="textsuperscript">5</sup></a></span><a
- id="x1-25001f5"></a> </h3>
+ id="x1-27001f5"></a> </h3>
<h4 class="subsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">7.1 </span> <a
- id="x1-260007.1"></a>Option ‘pdflinkmargin’</h4>
-<!--l. 1583--><p class="noindent" >Option ‘pdflinkmargin’ is an experimental option for specifying a link margin, if the driver supports this.
+ id="x1-280007.1"></a>Option ‘pdflinkmargin’</h4>
+<!--l. 1673--><p class="noindent" >Option ‘pdflinkmargin’ is an experimental option for specifying a link margin, if the driver supports this.
Default is 1 pt for supporting drivers.
-<!--l. 1588--><p class="indent" >
+<!--l. 1678--><p class="indent" >
<dl class="description"><dt class="description">
- <!--l. 1589--><p class="noindent" >
+ <!--l. 1679--><p class="noindent" >
<span
class="ec-lmbx-10">pdfTeX</span> </dt><dd
class="description">
- <!--l. 1589--><p class="noindent" >
+ <!--l. 1679--><p class="noindent" >
<ul class="itemize1">
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 1591--><p class="noindent" >The link area also depends on the surrounding box.
+ <!--l. 1681--><p class="noindent" >The link area also depends on the surrounding box.
</li>
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 1592--><p class="noindent" >Settings have local effect.
+ <!--l. 1682--><p class="noindent" >Settings have local effect.
</li>
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 1593--><p class="noindent" >When a page is shipped out, pdfTeX uses the current setting of the link margin for all
+ <!--l. 1683--><p class="noindent" >When a page is shipped out, pdfTeX uses the current setting of the link margin for all
links on the page.</li></ul>
</dd><dt class="description">
- <!--l. 1597--><p class="noindent" >
+ <!--l. 1687--><p class="noindent" >
<span
class="ec-lmbx-10">pdfmark</span> </dt><dd
class="description">
- <!--l. 1597--><p class="noindent" >
+ <!--l. 1687--><p class="noindent" >
<ul class="itemize1">
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 1599--><p class="noindent" >Settings have global effect.</li></ul>
+ <!--l. 1689--><p class="noindent" >Settings have global effect.</li></ul>
</dd><dt class="description">
- <!--l. 1602--><p class="noindent" >
+ <!--l. 1692--><p class="noindent" >
<span
class="ec-lmbx-10">xetex</span> </dt><dd
class="description">
- <!--l. 1602--><p class="noindent" >
+ <!--l. 1692--><p class="noindent" >
<ul class="itemize1">
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 1604--><p class="noindent" >Settings must be done in the preamble or the first page and then have global effect.
+ <!--l. 1694--><p class="noindent" >Settings must be done in the preamble or the first page and then have global effect.
The key inserts the new (x)dvipdfmx special <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\special{dvipdfmx:config</span><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10"> g</span><span
@@ -4751,67 +4972,70 @@
class="ec-lmvtt-10"> #1}</span></span></span> (with
the unit removed).</li></ul>
</dd><dt class="description">
- <!--l. 1608--><p class="noindent" >
+ <!--l. 1698--><p class="noindent" >
<span
class="ec-lmbx-10">Other drivers</span> </dt><dd
class="description">
- <!--l. 1608--><p class="noindent" >Unsupported.</dd></dl>
-<!--l. 1613--><p class="noindent" >
+ <!--l. 1698--><p class="noindent" >Unsupported.</dd></dl>
+<!--l. 1703--><p class="noindent" >
<h4 class="subsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">7.2 </span> <a
- id="x1-270007.2"></a>Field option ‘calculatesortkey’</h4>
-<!--l. 1615--><p class="noindent" >Fields with calculated values are calculated in document order by default. If calculated field values
+ id="x1-290007.2"></a>Field option ‘calculatesortkey’</h4>
+<!--l. 1705--><p class="noindent" >Fields with calculated values are calculated in document order by default. If calculated field values
depend on other calculated fields that appear later in the document, then the correct calculation order
can be specified with option ‘calculatesortkey’. Its value is used as key to lexicographically sort the
calculated fields. The sort key do not need to be unique. Fields that share the same key are sorted in
document order.
-<!--l. 1625--><p class="indent" > Currently the field option ‘calculatesortkey’ is only supported by the driver for pdfTeX.
-<!--l. 1628--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 1715--><p class="indent" > Currently the field option ‘calculatesortkey’ is only supported by the driver for pdfTeX.
+<!--l. 1718--><p class="noindent" >
<h4 class="subsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">7.3 </span> <a
- id="x1-280007.3"></a>Option ‘next-anchor’</h4>
-<!--l. 1629--><p class="noindent" >This option allows to overwrite the anchor name of the next anchor. This makes it possible to give for
+ id="x1-300007.3"></a>Option ‘next-anchor’</h4>
+<!--l. 1719--><p class="noindent" >This option allows to overwrite the anchor name of the next anchor. This makes it possible to give for
example the heading of the table of contents an anchor name which can be referenced with a bookmark
command.
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-25">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-27">
\hypersetup{next-anchor=toc}
\tableofcontents
\bookmark[dest=\HyperDestNameFilter{toc},level=section]{\contentsname}
</pre>
-<!--l. 1637--><p class="nopar" >
-<!--l. 1639--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 1727--><p class="nopar" >
+<!--l. 1729--><p class="noindent" >
<h4 class="subsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">7.4 </span> <a
- id="x1-290007.4"></a>Option ‘localanchorname’</h4>
-<!--l. 1641--><p class="noindent" >When an anchor is set (e.g. via <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
-class="ec-lmvtt-10">\refstepcounter</span></span></span>, then the anchor name is globally set to the current
-anchor name.
-<!--l. 1645--><p class="indent" > For example:
+ id="x1-310007.4"></a>Option ‘localanchorname’</h4>
+<!--l. 1731--><p class="noindent" >When<span class="marginpar">Deprecated 2022-04-27 v7.00o</span> an anchor is set (e.g. via <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+class="ec-lmvtt-10">\refstepcounter</span></span></span>, then the anchor name is
+globally set to the current anchor name.
+<!--l. 1735--><p class="indent" > For example:
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-26">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-28">
    \section{Foobar}
    \begin{equation}\end{equation}
    \label{sec:foobar}
</pre>
-<!--l. 1650--><p class="nopar" > With the default global setting (localanchorname=false) a reference to ‘sec:foobar’ jumps to the
+<!--l. 1740--><p class="nopar" > With the default global setting (localanchorname=false) a reference to ‘sec:foobar’ jumps to the
equation before. With option ‘localanchorname’ the anchor of the equation is forgotten after the
environment and the reference ‘sec:foobar’ jumps to the section title.
-<!--l. 1658--><p class="indent" > Option ‘localanchorname’ is an experimental option, there might be situations, where the anchor
+<!--l. 1748--><p class="indent" > Option ‘localanchorname’ is an experimental option, there might be situations, where the anchor
name is not available as expected.
-<!--l. 1663--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 1752--><p class="indent" > The option is deprecated: it makes it difficult for package authors to add targets for links if it is
+unclear if <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+class="ec-lmvtt-10">\@currentHref</span></span></span> is set locally or globally.
+<!--l. 1756--><p class="noindent" >
<h4 class="subsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">7.5 </span> <a
- id="x1-300007.5"></a>Option ‘customdriver’</h4>
-<!--l. 1665--><p class="noindent" >The value of option ‘customdriver’ is the name of an external driver file without extension ‘.def’. The file
+ id="x1-320007.5"></a>Option ‘customdriver’</h4>
+<!--l. 1758--><p class="noindent" >The value of option ‘customdriver’ is the name of an external driver file without extension ‘.def’. The file
must have <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\ProvidesFile</span></span></span> with a version date and number that match the date and number of ‘hyperref’,
otherwise a warning is given.
-<!--l. 1670--><p class="indent" > Because the interface, what needs to be defined in the driver, is not well defined and
+<!--l. 1763--><p class="indent" > Because the interface, what needs to be defined in the driver, is not well defined and
quite messy, the option is mainly intended to ease developing, testing, debugging the driver
part.
-<!--l. 1675--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 1768--><p class="noindent" >
<h4 class="subsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">7.6 </span> <a
- id="x1-310007.6"></a>Option ‘psdextra’</h4>
-<!--l. 1677--><p class="noindent" >LaTeX’s NFSS is used to assist the conversion of arbitrary TeX strings to PDF strings (bookmarks, PDF
+ id="x1-330007.6"></a>Option ‘psdextra’</h4>
+<!--l. 1770--><p class="noindent" >LaTeX’s NFSS is used to assist the conversion of arbitrary TeX strings to PDF strings (bookmarks, PDF
information entries). Many math command names (<span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\geq</span></span></span>, <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\notin</span></span></span>, ...) are not in control of NFSS,
@@ -4825,10 +5049,10 @@
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\geq</span></span></span> can directly be used instead of
<span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\textgeq</span></span></span>.
-<!--l. 1691--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 1784--><p class="noindent" >
<h4 class="subsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">7.7 </span> <a
- id="x1-320007.7"></a>\XeTeXLinkBox</h4>
-<!--l. 1693--><p class="noindent" >When XeTeX generates a link annotation, it does not look at the boxes (as the other drivers), but only
+ id="x1-340007.7"></a>\XeTeXLinkBox</h4>
+<!--l. 1786--><p class="noindent" >When XeTeX generates a link annotation, it does not look at the boxes (as the other drivers), but only
at the character glyphs. If there are no glyphs (images, rules, ...), then it does not generate a link
annotation. Macro <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\XeTeXLinkBox</span></span></span> puts its argument in a box and adds spaces at the lower left and
@@ -4835,10 +5059,10 @@
upper right corners. An additional margin can be specified by setting it to the dimen register
<span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\XeTeXLinkMargin</span></span></span>. The default is 2pt.
-<!--l. 1702--><p class="indent" > Example:
+<!--l. 1795--><p class="indent" > Example:
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-27">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-29">
    % xelatex
    \documentclass{article}
    \usepackage{hyperref}
@@ -4852,68 +5076,68 @@
    }
    \end{document}
</pre>
-<!--l. 1718--><p class="nopar" >
-<!--l. 1720--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 1811--><p class="nopar" >
+<!--l. 1813--><p class="noindent" >
<h4 class="subsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">7.8 </span> <a
- id="x1-330007.8"></a>\IfHyperBooleanExists and \IfHyperBoolean</h4>
+ id="x1-350007.8"></a>\IfHyperBooleanExists and \IfHyperBoolean</h4>
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-28">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-30">
 \IfHyperBooleanExists{OPTION}{YES}{NO}
</pre>
-<!--l. 1723--><p class="nopar" > If a hyperref OPTION is a boolean, that means it takes values ‘true’ or ‘false’, then <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+<!--l. 1816--><p class="nopar" > If a hyperref OPTION is a boolean, that means it takes values ‘true’ or ‘false’, then <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\IfHyperBooleanExists</span></span></span>
calls YES, otherwise NO.
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-29">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-31">
 \IfHyperBoolean{OPTION}{YES}{NO}
</pre>
-<!--l. 1730--><p class="nopar" > Macro <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+<!--l. 1823--><p class="nopar" > Macro <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\IfHyperBoolean</span></span></span> calls YES, if OPTION exists as boolean and is enabled. Otherwise NO is
executed.
-<!--l. 1736--><p class="indent" > Both macros are expandable. Additionally option ‘stoppedearly’ is available. It is enabled if
+<!--l. 1829--><p class="indent" > Both macros are expandable. Additionally option ‘stoppedearly’ is available. It is enabled if
<span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\MaybeStopEarly</span></span></span> or <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\MaybeStopNow</span></span></span> end hyperref prematurely.
-<!--l. 1741--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 1834--><p class="noindent" >
<h4 class="subsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">7.9 </span> <a
- id="x1-340007.9"></a>\unichar</h4>
-<!--l. 1743--><p class="noindent" >If a Unicode character is not supported by puenc.def, it can be given by using <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+ id="x1-360007.9"></a>\unichar</h4>
+<!--l. 1836--><p class="noindent" >If a Unicode character is not supported by puenc.def, it can be given by using <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\unichar</span></span></span>. Its name
and syntax is inherited from package ‘ucs’. However it is defined independently for use in
hyperref’s <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\pdfstringdef</span></span></span> (that converts arbitrary TeX code to PDF strings or tries to do
this).
-<!--l. 1751--><p class="indent" > Macro <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+<!--l. 1844--><p class="indent" > Macro <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\unichar</span></span></span> takes a TeX number as argument, examples for U+263A (WHITE SMILING
FACE):
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-30">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-32">
    \unichar{"263A}% hexadecimal notation
    \unichar{9786}% decimal notation
</pre>
-<!--l. 1756--><p class="nopar" > ‘"’ must not be a babel shorthand character or otherwise active. Otherwise prefix it with
+<!--l. 1849--><p class="nopar" > ‘"’ must not be a babel shorthand character or otherwise active. Otherwise prefix it with
<span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\string</span></span></span>:
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-31">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-33">
    \unichar{\string"263A}% converts ‘"’ to ‘"’ with catcode 12 (other)
</pre>
-<!--l. 1761--><p class="nopar" > Users of (n)german packages or babel options may use <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+<!--l. 1854--><p class="nopar" > Users of (n)german packages or babel options may use <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\dq</span></span></span> instead:
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-32">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-34">
    \unichar{\dq 263A}% \dq is double quote with catcode 12 (other)
</pre>
-<!--l. 1765--><p class="nopar" >
-<!--l. 1768--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 1858--><p class="nopar" >
+<!--l. 1861--><p class="noindent" >
<h4 class="subsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">7.10 </span> <a
- id="x1-350007.10"></a>\ifpdfstringunicode</h4>
-<!--l. 1770--><p class="noindent" >Some features of the PDF specification needs PDF strings. Examples are bookmarks or the entries in the
+ id="x1-370007.10"></a>\ifpdfstringunicode</h4>
+<!--l. 1863--><p class="noindent" >Some features of the PDF specification needs PDF strings. Examples are bookmarks or the entries in the
information dictionary. The PDF specification allows two encodings ‘PDFDocEncoding’ (8-bit encoding)
and ‘Unicode’ (UTF-16). The user can help using <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\texorpdfstring</span></span></span> to replace complicate TeX constructs
@@ -4924,12 +5148,12 @@
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\texorpdfstring</span></span></span> and
takes two arguments, the first allows the full range of Unicode. The second is limited to the characters
available in PDFDocEncoding.
-<!--l. 1784--><p class="indent" > As example we take a macro definition for the Vietnamese name of H\xE0n Thế Th\xE0nh. Correctly written
+<!--l. 1877--><p class="indent" > As example we take a macro definition for the Vietnamese name of H\xE0n Thế Th\xE0nh. Correctly written
it needs some accented characters, one character even with a double accent. Class ‘tugboat.cls’ defines a
macro for the typesetted name:
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-33">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-35">
    \def\Thanh{%
      H\‘an~%
      Th\^e\llap{\raise 0.5ex\hbox{\’{}}}%
@@ -4936,9 +5160,9 @@
      ~Th\‘anh%
    }
</pre>
-<!--l. 1794--><p class="nopar" > It’s not entirely correct, the second accent over the ‘e’ is not an acute, but a hook. However standard
+<!--l. 1887--><p class="nopar" > It’s not entirely correct, the second accent over the ‘e’ is not an acute, but a hook. However standard
LaTeX does not provide such an accent.
-<!--l. 1799--><p class="indent" > Now we can extend the definition to support hyperref. The first and the last word are already
+<!--l. 1892--><p class="indent" > Now we can extend the definition to support hyperref. The first and the last word are already
supported automatically. Characters with two or more accents are a difficult business in LaTeX, because
the NFSS2 macros of the LaTeX kernel do not support more than one accent. Therefore also puenc.def
misses support for them. But we can provide it using <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
@@ -4946,13 +5170,13 @@
is:
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-34">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-36">
    % U+1EC3 LATIN SMALL LETTER E WITH CIRCUMFLEX AND HOOK ABOVE
</pre>
-<!--l. 1808--><p class="nopar" > Thus we can put this together:
+<!--l. 1901--><p class="nopar" > Thus we can put this together:
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-35">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-37">
    \def\Thanh{%
      H\‘an~%
      \texorpdfstring{Th\^e\llap{\raise 0.5ex\hbox{\’{}}}}%
@@ -4960,11 +5184,11 @@
      ~Th\‘anh%
    }
</pre>
-<!--l. 1817--><p class="nopar" > For PDFDocEncoding (PD1) the variant above has dropped the second accent. Alternatively we could
+<!--l. 1910--><p class="nopar" > For PDFDocEncoding (PD1) the variant above has dropped the second accent. Alternatively we could
provide a representation without accents instead of wrong accents:
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-36">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-38">
    \def\Thanh{%
      \texorpdfstring{%
        H\‘an~%
@@ -4979,12 +5203,12 @@
      }%
    }
</pre>
-<!--l. 1835--><p class="nopar" >
-<!--l. 1837--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 1928--><p class="nopar" >
+<!--l. 1930--><p class="noindent" >
<h4 class="subsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">7.11 </span> <a
- id="x1-360007.11"></a>Customizing index style file with \nohyperpage</h4>
-<!--l. 1839--><p class="noindent" >Since version 2008/08/14 v6.78f.
-<!--l. 1843--><p class="indent" > For hyperlink support in the index, hyperref inserts <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+ id="x1-380007.11"></a>Customizing index style file with \nohyperpage</h4>
+<!--l. 1932--><p class="noindent" >Since version 2008/08/14 v6.78f.
+<!--l. 1936--><p class="indent" > For hyperlink support in the index, hyperref inserts <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\hyperpage</span></span></span> into the index macros. After
processing with Makeindex, <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\hyperpage</span></span></span> analyzes its argument to detect page ranges and page comma
@@ -4991,11 +5215,11 @@
lists. However, only the standard settings are supported directly:
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-37">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-39">
    delim_r "--"
    delim_n ", "
</pre>
-<!--l. 1850--><p class="nopar" > (See manual page/documentation of Makeindex that explains the keys that can be used in style files for
+<!--l. 1943--><p class="nopar" > (See manual page/documentation of Makeindex that explains the keys that can be used in style files for
Makeindex.) Customized versions of <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">delim_r,</span><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10"> delim_n,</span><span
@@ -5010,157 +5234,157 @@
e.g.:
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-38">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-40">
    suffix_2p "\\nohyperpage{f.}"
    suffix_3p "\\nohyperpage{ff.}"
</pre>
-<!--l. 1862--><p class="nopar" > (Depending on the typesetting tradition some space “<span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+<!--l. 1955--><p class="nopar" > (Depending on the typesetting tradition some space “<span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\\</span></span></span>,” or “<span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">~</span></span></span>” should be put before the first f inside
<span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\nohyperpage</span></span></span>.)
-<!--l. 1867--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 1960--><p class="noindent" >
<h4 class="subsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">7.12 </span> <a
- id="x1-370007.12"></a>Experimental option ‘ocgcolorlinks’</h4>
-<!--l. 1869--><p class="noindent" >The idea are colored links, when viewed, but printed without colors. This new experimental option
+ id="x1-390007.12"></a>Experimental option ‘ocgcolorlinks’</h4>
+<!--l. 1962--><p class="noindent" >The idea are colored links, when viewed, but printed without colors. This new experimental option
‘ocgcolorlinks’ uses Optional Content Groups, a feature introduced in PDF 1.5.
-<!--l. 1873--><p class="indent" > A better implementation which hasn’t the disadvantage to prevent line breaks is in the ocgx2
+<!--l. 1966--><p class="indent" > A better implementation which hasn’t the disadvantage to prevent line breaks is in the ocgx2
package. Check its documentation for details how to use it.
<ul class="itemize1">
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 1876--><p class="noindent" >The option must be given for package loading: <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+ <!--l. 1969--><p class="noindent" >The option must be given for package loading: <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\usepackage[ocgcolorlinks]{hyperref}</span></span></span>
</li>
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 1878--><p class="noindent" >Main disadvantage: Links cannot be broken across lines. PDF reference 1.7: 4.10.2 “Making
+ <!--l. 1971--><p class="noindent" >Main disadvantage: Links cannot be broken across lines. PDF reference 1.7: 4.10.2 “Making
Graphical Content Optional”: Graphics state operations, such as setting the color, ..., are
still applied. Therefore the link text is put in a box and set twice, with and without color.
</li>
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 1884--><p class="noindent" >The feature can be switched of by <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+ <!--l. 1977--><p class="noindent" >The feature can be switched of by <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\hypersetup{ocgcolorlinks=false}</span></span></span> inside the document.
</li>
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 1886--><p class="noindent" >Supported drivers: pdftex, dvipdfm
+ <!--l. 1979--><p class="noindent" >Supported drivers: pdftex, dvipdfm
</li>
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 1887--><p class="noindent" >The PDF version should be at least 1.5. It is automatically set for pdfTeX, LuaTeX and
+ <!--l. 1980--><p class="noindent" >The PDF version should be at least 1.5. It is automatically set for pdfTeX, LuaTeX and
dvipdfmx.</li></ul>
-<!--l. 1891--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 1984--><p class="noindent" >
<h4 class="subsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">7.13 </span> <a
- id="x1-380007.13"></a>Option ‘pdfa’</h4>
-<!--l. 1893--><p class="noindent" >The new option ‘pdfa’ tries to avoid violations of PDF/A in code generated by hyperref. However, the
+ id="x1-400007.13"></a>Option ‘pdfa’</h4>
+<!--l. 1986--><p class="noindent" >The new option ‘pdfa’ tries to avoid violations of PDF/A in code generated by hyperref. However, the
result is usually not in PDF/A, because many features aren’t controlled by hyperref (XMP metadata,
fonts, colors, driver dependend low level stuff, ...).
-<!--l. 1900--><p class="indent" > Currently, option ‘pdfa’ sets and disables the following items:
+<!--l. 1993--><p class="indent" > Currently, option ‘pdfa’ sets and disables the following items:
<ul class="itemize1">
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 1902--><p class="noindent" >Enabled annotation flags: Print, NoZoom, NoRotate [PDF/A 6.5.3].
+ <!--l. 1995--><p class="noindent" >Enabled annotation flags: Print, NoZoom, NoRotate [PDF/A 6.5.3].
</li>
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 1903--><p class="noindent" >Disabled annotation flags: Hidden, Invisible, NoView [PDF/A 6.5.3].
+ <!--l. 1996--><p class="noindent" >Disabled annotation flags: Hidden, Invisible, NoView [PDF/A 6.5.3].
</li>
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 1904--><p class="noindent" >Disabled: Launch action (<a
+ <!--l. 1997--><p class="noindent" >Disabled: Launch action (<a
href="run:..." >[</a>PDF/A 6.6.1].
</li>
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 1905--><p class="noindent" >Restricted: Named actions (NextPage, PrevPage, FirstPage, LastPage) [PDF/A 6.6.1].
+ <!--l. 1998--><p class="noindent" >Restricted: Named actions (NextPage, PrevPage, FirstPage, LastPage) [PDF/A 6.6.1].
</li>
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 1907--><p class="noindent" >Many things are disabled in PDF formulars:
+ <!--l. 2000--><p class="noindent" >Many things are disabled in PDF formulars:
<ul class="itemize2">
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 1909--><p class="noindent" >JavaScript actions [PDF/A 6.6.1]
+ <!--l. 2002--><p class="noindent" >JavaScript actions [PDF/A 6.6.1]
</li>
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 1910--><p class="noindent" >Trigger events (additional actions) [PDF/A 6.6.2]
+ <!--l. 2003--><p class="noindent" >Trigger events (additional actions) [PDF/A 6.6.2]
</li>
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 1911--><p class="noindent" >Push button (because of JavaScript)
+ <!--l. 2004--><p class="noindent" >Push button (because of JavaScript)
</li>
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 1912--><p class="noindent" >Interactive Forms: Flag NeedAppearances is the default ‘false’ (Because of this,
+ <!--l. 2005--><p class="noindent" >Interactive Forms: Flag NeedAppearances is the default ‘false’ (Because of this,
hyperref’s implementation of Forms looks ugly). [PDF/A 6.9]</li></ul>
</li></ul>
-<!--l. 1920--><p class="indent" > The default value of the new option ‘pdfa’ is ‘false’. It influences the loading of the package and
+<!--l. 2013--><p class="indent" > The default value of the new option ‘pdfa’ is ‘false’. It influences the loading of the package and
cannot be changed after hyperref is loaded (<span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\usepackage{hyperref}</span></span></span>).
-<!--l. 1926--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 2019--><p class="noindent" >
<h4 class="subsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">7.14 </span> <a
- id="x1-390007.14"></a>Option ‘linktoc’ added</h4>
-<!--l. 1928--><p class="noindent" >The new option ‘linktoc’ allows more control which part of an entry in the table of contents is made into
+ id="x1-410007.14"></a>Option ‘linktoc’ added</h4>
+<!--l. 2021--><p class="noindent" >The new option ‘linktoc’ allows more control which part of an entry in the table of contents is made into
a link:
<ul class="itemize1">
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 1931--><p class="noindent" >‘linktoc=none’ (no links)
+ <!--l. 2024--><p class="noindent" >‘linktoc=none’ (no links)
</li>
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 1932--><p class="noindent" >‘linktoc=section’ (default behaviour, same as ‘linktocpage=false’)
+ <!--l. 2025--><p class="noindent" >‘linktoc=section’ (default behaviour, same as ‘linktocpage=false’)
</li>
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 1933--><p class="noindent" >‘linktoc=page’ (same as ‘linktocpage=true’)
+ <!--l. 2026--><p class="noindent" >‘linktoc=page’ (same as ‘linktocpage=true’)
</li>
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 1934--><p class="noindent" >‘linktoc=all’ (both the section and page part are links)</li></ul>
-<!--l. 1937--><p class="noindent" >
+ <!--l. 2027--><p class="noindent" >‘linktoc=all’ (both the section and page part are links)</li></ul>
+<!--l. 2030--><p class="noindent" >
<h4 class="subsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">7.15 </span> <a
- id="x1-400007.15"></a>Option ‘pdfnewwindow’ changed</h4>
-<!--l. 1939--><p class="noindent" >Before 6.77b:
+ id="x1-420007.15"></a>Option ‘pdfnewwindow’ changed</h4>
+<!--l. 2032--><p class="noindent" >Before 6.77b:
<ul class="itemize1">
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 1941--><p class="noindent" >pdfnewwindow=true <span
+ <!--l. 2034--><p class="noindent" >pdfnewwindow=true <span
class="lmsy-10">→ </span>/NewWindow true
</li>
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 1942--><p class="noindent" >pdfnewwindow=false <span
+ <!--l. 2035--><p class="noindent" >pdfnewwindow=false <span
class="lmsy-10">→ </span>(absent)
</li>
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 1943--><p class="noindent" >unused pdfnewwindow <span
+ <!--l. 2036--><p class="noindent" >unused pdfnewwindow <span
class="lmsy-10">→ </span>(absent)</li></ul>
-<!--l. 1945--><p class="noindent" >Since 6.77b:
+<!--l. 2038--><p class="noindent" >Since 6.77b:
<ul class="itemize1">
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 1947--><p class="noindent" >pdfnewwindow=true <span
+ <!--l. 2040--><p class="noindent" >pdfnewwindow=true <span
class="lmsy-10">→ </span>/NewWindow true
</li>
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 1948--><p class="noindent" >pdfnewwindow=false <span
+ <!--l. 2041--><p class="noindent" >pdfnewwindow=false <span
class="lmsy-10">→ </span>/NewWindow false
</li>
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 1949--><p class="noindent" >pdfnewwindow= <span
+ <!--l. 2042--><p class="noindent" >pdfnewwindow= <span
class="lmsy-10">→ </span>(absent)
</li>
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 1950--><p class="noindent" >unused pdfnewwindow <span
+ <!--l. 2043--><p class="noindent" >unused pdfnewwindow <span
class="lmsy-10">→ </span>(absent)</li></ul>
-<!--l. 1955--><p class="indent" > Rationale: There is a difference between setting to ‘false’ and an absent entry. In the former case the
+<!--l. 2048--><p class="indent" > Rationale: There is a difference between setting to ‘false’ and an absent entry. In the former case the
new document replaces the old one, in the latter case the PDF viewer application should respect the user
preference.
-<!--l. 1961--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 2054--><p class="noindent" >
<h4 class="subsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">7.16 </span> <a
- id="x1-410007.16"></a>Flag options for PDF forms</h4>
-<!--l. 1963--><p class="noindent" >PDF form field macros (<span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+ id="x1-430007.16"></a>Flag options for PDF forms</h4>
+<!--l. 2056--><p class="noindent" >PDF form field macros (<span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\TextField</span></span></span>, <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\CheckBox</span></span></span>, ...) support boolean flag options. The option name is
the lowercase version of the names in the PDF specification (1.7):
-<!--l. 1967--><p class="indent" > <a
+<!--l. 2060--><p class="indent" > <a
href="http://www.adobe.com/devnet/pdf/pdf_reference.html" class="url" ><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">http://www.adobe.com/devnet/pdf/pdf_reference.html</span></a>
-<!--l. 1969--><p class="indent" > <a
+<!--l. 2062--><p class="indent" > <a
href="http://www.adobe.com/devnet/acrobat/pdfs/pdf_reference.pdf" class="url" ><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">http://www.adobe.com/devnet/acrobat/pdfs/pdf_reference.pdf</span></a>
-<!--l. 1971--><p class="indent" > Options (convert to lowercase) except flags in square brackets:
+<!--l. 2064--><p class="indent" > Options (convert to lowercase) except flags in square brackets:
<ul class="itemize1">
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 1974--><p class="noindent" >Table 8.16 Annotation flags (page 608):
- <!--l. 1976--><p class="noindent" ><div class="obeylines-v">
+ <!--l. 2067--><p class="noindent" >Table 8.16 Annotation flags (page 608):
+ <!--l. 2069--><p class="noindent" ><div class="obeylines-v">
1 Invisible
<br />2 Hidden (PDF 1.2)
<br />3 Print (PDF 1.2)
@@ -5173,15 +5397,15 @@
<br />10 LockedContents (PDF 1.7)</div>
</li>
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 1988--><p class="noindent" >Table 8.70 Field flags common to all field types (page 676):
- <!--l. 1990--><p class="noindent" ><div class="obeylines-v">
+ <!--l. 2081--><p class="noindent" >Table 8.70 Field flags common to all field types (page 676):
+ <!--l. 2083--><p class="noindent" ><div class="obeylines-v">
1 ReadOnly
<br />2 Required
<br />3 NoExport</div>
</li>
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 1995--><p class="noindent" >Table 8.75 Field flags specific to button fields (page 686):
- <!--l. 1997--><p class="noindent" ><div class="obeylines-v">
+ <!--l. 2088--><p class="noindent" >Table 8.75 Field flags specific to button fields (page 686):
+ <!--l. 2090--><p class="noindent" ><div class="obeylines-v">
15 NoToggleToOff (Radio buttons only)
<br />16 Radio (set: radio buttons, clear: check box, pushbutton: clear)
<br />17 Pushbutton
@@ -5188,8 +5412,8 @@
<br />26 RadiosInUniso (PDF 1.5)</div>
</li>
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 2003--><p class="noindent" >Table 8.77 Field flags specific to text fields (page 691):
- <!--l. 2005--><p class="noindent" ><div class="obeylines-v">
+ <!--l. 2096--><p class="noindent" >Table 8.77 Field flags specific to text fields (page 691):
+ <!--l. 2098--><p class="noindent" ><div class="obeylines-v">
13 Multiline
<br />14 Password
<br />21 FileSelect (PDF 1.4)
@@ -5200,8 +5424,8 @@
</li>
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 2014--><p class="noindent" >Table 8.79 Field flags specific to choice fields (page 693):
- <!--l. 2016--><p class="noindent" ><div class="obeylines-v">
+ <!--l. 2107--><p class="noindent" >Table 8.79 Field flags specific to choice fields (page 693):
+ <!--l. 2109--><p class="noindent" ><div class="obeylines-v">
18 Combo (set: combo box, clear: list box)
<br />19 Edit (only useful if Combo is set)
<br />20 (Sort) for authoring tools, not PDF viewers
@@ -5210,8 +5434,8 @@
<br />27 CommitOnSelChange (PDF 1.5)</div>
</li>
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 2024--><p class="noindent" >Table 8.86 Flags for submit-form actions (page 704):
- <!--l. 2026--><p class="noindent" ><div class="obeylines-v">
+ <!--l. 2117--><p class="noindent" >Table 8.86 Flags for submit-form actions (page 704):
+ <!--l. 2119--><p class="noindent" ><div class="obeylines-v">
[1 Include/Exclude] unsupported, use ‘noexport’ (table 8.70) instead
<br />2 IncludeNoValueFields
<br />[3 ExportFormat] handled by option ‘export’
@@ -5226,35 +5450,35 @@
<br />12 ExclFKey (PDF 1.4)
<br />14 EmbedForm (PDF 1.5)</div>
</li></ul>
-<!--l. 2043--><p class="indent" > New option ‘export’ sets the export format of a submit action. Valid values are (upper- or
+<!--l. 2136--><p class="indent" > New option ‘export’ sets the export format of a submit action. Valid values are (upper- or
lowercase):
<ul class="itemize1">
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 2046--><p class="noindent" >FDF
+ <!--l. 2139--><p class="noindent" >FDF
</li>
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 2047--><p class="noindent" >HTML
+ <!--l. 2140--><p class="noindent" >HTML
</li>
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 2048--><p class="noindent" >XFDF
+ <!--l. 2141--><p class="noindent" >XFDF
</li>
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 2049--><p class="noindent" >PDF (not supported by Acrobat Reader)</li></ul>
-<!--l. 2052--><p class="noindent" >
+ <!--l. 2142--><p class="noindent" >PDF (not supported by Acrobat Reader)</li></ul>
+<!--l. 2145--><p class="noindent" >
<h4 class="subsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">7.17 </span> <a
- id="x1-420007.17"></a>Option ‘pdfversion’</h4>
-<!--l. 2054--><p class="noindent" >This is an experimental option. It notifies ‘hyperref’ about the intended PDF version. Currently this is
+ id="x1-440007.17"></a>Option ‘pdfversion’</h4>
+<!--l. 2147--><p class="noindent" >This is an experimental option. It notifies ‘hyperref’ about the intended PDF version. Currently this is
used in code for PDF forms (implementation notes 116 and 122 of PDF spec 1.7).
-<!--l. 2060--><p class="indent" > Values: 1.2, 1.3, 1.4, 1.5, 1.6, 1.7. Values below 1.2 are not supported, because most drivers expect
+<!--l. 2153--><p class="indent" > Values: 1.2, 1.3, 1.4, 1.5, 1.6, 1.7. Values below 1.2 are not supported, because most drivers expect
higher PDF versions.
-<!--l. 2065--><p class="indent" > The option must be used early, not after <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+<!--l. 2158--><p class="indent" > The option must be used early, not after <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\usepackage{hyperref}</span></span></span>.
-<!--l. 2068--><p class="indent" > In theory this option should also set the PDF version, but this is not generally supported.
+<!--l. 2161--><p class="indent" > In theory this option should also set the PDF version, but this is not generally supported.
<ul class="itemize1">
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 2071--><p class="noindent" >pdfTeX below 1.10a: unsupported. pdfTeX <span
+ <!--l. 2164--><p class="noindent" >pdfTeX below 1.10a: unsupported. pdfTeX <span
class="lmsy-10">≥ </span>1.10a and < 1.30: <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\pdfoptionpdfminorversion</span></span></span>
pdfTeX <span
@@ -5262,69 +5486,69 @@
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\pdfminorversion</span></span></span>
</li>
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 2074--><p class="noindent" >dvipdfm: configuration file, example: TeX Live 2007, texmf/dvipdfm/config/config, entry ‘V
+ <!--l. 2167--><p class="noindent" >dvipdfm: configuration file, example: TeX Live 2007, texmf/dvipdfm/config/config, entry ‘V
2’.
</li>
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 2076--><p class="noindent" >dvipdfmx: configuration file, example: TeX Live 2007, texmf/dvipdfm/dvipdfmx.cfg, entry
+ <!--l. 2169--><p class="noindent" >dvipdfmx: configuration file, example: TeX Live 2007, texmf/dvipdfm/dvipdfmx.cfg, entry
‘V 4’.
</li>
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 2078--><p class="noindent" >Ghostscript: option -dCompatibilityLevel (this is set in ‘ps2pdf12’, ‘ps2pdf13’, ‘ps2pdf14’).</li></ul>
-<!--l. 2083--><p class="indent" > The current PDF version is used as default if this version can be detected (only pdfTeX <span
+ <!--l. 2171--><p class="noindent" >Ghostscript: option -dCompatibilityLevel (this is set in ‘ps2pdf12’, ‘ps2pdf13’, ‘ps2pdf14’).</li></ul>
+<!--l. 2176--><p class="indent" > The current PDF version is used as default if this version can be detected (only pdfTeX <span
class="lmsy-10">≥ </span>1.10a).
Otherwise the lowest version 1.2 is assumed. Thus ‘hyperref’ tries to avoid PDF code that breaks this
version, but is free to use ignorable higher PDF features.
-<!--l. 2090--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 2183--><p class="noindent" >
<h4 class="subsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">7.18 </span> <a
- id="x1-430007.18"></a>Field option ‘name’</h4>
-<!--l. 2092--><p class="noindent" >Many form objects uses the label argument for several purposes:
+ id="x1-450007.18"></a>Field option ‘name’</h4>
+<!--l. 2185--><p class="noindent" >Many form objects uses the label argument for several purposes:
<ul class="itemize1">
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 2095--><p class="noindent" >Layouted label.
+ <!--l. 2188--><p class="noindent" >Layouted label.
</li>
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 2096--><p class="noindent" >As name in HTML structures.</li></ul>
-<!--l. 2098--><p class="noindent" >Code that is suitable for layouting with TeX can break in the structures of the output format. If option
+ <!--l. 2189--><p class="noindent" >As name in HTML structures.</li></ul>
+<!--l. 2191--><p class="noindent" >Code that is suitable for layouting with TeX can break in the structures of the output format. If option
‘name’ is given, then its value is used as name in the different output structures. Thus the value should
consist of letters only.
-<!--l. 2105--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 2198--><p class="noindent" >
<h4 class="subsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">7.19 </span> <a
- id="x1-440007.19"></a>Option ‘pdfencoding’</h4>
-<!--l. 2107--><p class="noindent" >The PDF format allows two encodings for bookmarks and entries in the information dictionary:
+ id="x1-460007.19"></a>Option ‘pdfencoding’</h4>
+<!--l. 2200--><p class="noindent" >The PDF format allows two encodings for bookmarks and entries in the information dictionary:
PDFDocEncoding and Unicode as UTF-16BE. Option <span
class="ec-lmss-10">pdfencoding </span>selects between these
encodings:
<ul class="itemize1">
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 2111--><p class="noindent" ><span
+ <!--l. 2204--><p class="noindent" ><span
class="ec-lmss-10">pdfdoc </span>uses PDFDocEncoding. It uses just one byte per character, but the supported
characters are limited (244 in PDF-1.7).
</li>
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 2113--><p class="noindent" ><span
+ <!--l. 2206--><p class="noindent" ><span
class="ec-lmss-10">unicode </span>sets Unicode. It is encoded as UTF-16BE. Two bytes are used for most characters,
surrogates need four bytes.
</li>
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 2115--><p class="noindent" ><span
+ <!--l. 2208--><p class="noindent" ><span
class="ec-lmss-10">auto </span>PDFDocEncoding if the string does not contain characters outside the encoding (outside
ascii if an unicode engine is used) and Unicode otherwise. This option is not intended for
the unicode engines.</li></ul>
-<!--l. 2120--><p class="indent" > All drivers use <span
+<!--l. 2213--><p class="indent" > All drivers use <span
class="ec-lmss-10">unicode </span>by default now. If another encoding should be forced, it should be done in
<span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">hypersetup</span></span></span>.
-<!--l. 2123--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 2216--><p class="noindent" >
<h4 class="subsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">7.20 </span> <a
- id="x1-450007.20"></a>Color options/package hycolor</h4>
-<!--l. 2125--><p class="noindent" >See documentation of package ‘hycolor’.
-<!--l. 2128--><p class="noindent" >
+ id="x1-470007.20"></a>Color options/package hycolor</h4>
+<!--l. 2218--><p class="noindent" >See documentation of package ‘hycolor’.
+<!--l. 2221--><p class="noindent" >
<h4 class="subsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">7.21 </span> <a
- id="x1-460007.21"></a>Option pdfusetitle</h4>
-<!--l. 2130--><p class="noindent" >If option pdfusetitle is set then hyperref tries to derive the values for pdftitle and pdfauthor
+ id="x1-480007.21"></a>Option pdfusetitle</h4>
+<!--l. 2223--><p class="noindent" >If option pdfusetitle is set then hyperref tries to derive the values for pdftitle and pdfauthor
from <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\title</span></span></span> and <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\author</span></span></span>. An optional argument for <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
@@ -5331,28 +5555,28 @@
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\title</span></span></span> and <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\author</span></span></span> is supported (class
amsart).
-<!--l. 2136--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 2229--><p class="noindent" >
<h4 class="subsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">7.22 </span> <a
- id="x1-470007.22"></a>Starred form of \autoref</h4>
-<!--l. 2138--><p class="noindent" ><span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+ id="x1-490007.22"></a>Starred form of \autoref</h4>
+<!--l. 2231--><p class="noindent" ><span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\autoref*</span></span></span> generates a reference without link as <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\ref*</span></span></span> or <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\pageref*</span></span></span>.
-<!--l. 2141--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 2234--><p class="noindent" >
<h4 class="subsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">7.23 </span> <a
- id="x1-480007.23"></a>Link border style</h4>
-<!--l. 2143--><p class="noindent" >Links can be underlined instead of the default rectangle or options <span
+ id="x1-500007.23"></a>Link border style</h4>
+<!--l. 2236--><p class="noindent" >Links can be underlined instead of the default rectangle or options <span
class="ec-lmss-10">colorlinks</span>, <span
class="ec-lmss-10">frenchlinks</span>. This is done by
option <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">pdfborderstyle={/S/U/W</span><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10"> 1}</span></span></span>
-<!--l. 2147--><p class="indent" > Some remarks:
+<!--l. 2240--><p class="indent" > Some remarks:
<ul class="itemize1">
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 2150--><p class="noindent" >AR7/Linux seems to have a bug, that don’t use the default value <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+ <!--l. 2243--><p class="noindent" >AR7/Linux seems to have a bug, that don’t use the default value <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">1</span></span></span> for the width, but zero,
thus that the underline is not visible without <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">/W</span><span
@@ -5360,44 +5584,44 @@
pdfborderstyle=/S/D/D[3 2]/W 1
</li>
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 2156--><p class="noindent" >The syntax is described in the PDF specification, look for “border style”, eg. Table 8.13
+ <!--l. 2249--><p class="noindent" >The syntax is described in the PDF specification, look for “border style”, eg. Table 8.13
“Entries in a border style dictionary” (specification for version 1.6)
</li>
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 2161--><p class="noindent" >The border style is removed by pdfborderstyle= This is automatically done if option
+ <!--l. 2254--><p class="noindent" >The border style is removed by pdfborderstyle= This is automatically done if option
colorlinks is enabled.
</li>
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 2165--><p class="noindent" >Be aware that not all PDF viewers support this feature, not even Acrobat Reader itself:
- <!--l. 2168--><p class="noindent" >Some support:
+ <!--l. 2258--><p class="noindent" >Be aware that not all PDF viewers support this feature, not even Acrobat Reader itself:
+ <!--l. 2261--><p class="noindent" >Some support:
<ul class="itemize2">
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 2170--><p class="noindent" >AR7/Linux: <span
+ <!--l. 2263--><p class="noindent" >AR7/Linux: <span
class="ec-lmss-10">underline </span>and <span
class="ec-lmss-10">dashed</span>, but the border width must be given.
</li>
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 2172--><p class="noindent" >xpdf 3.00: <span
+ <!--l. 2265--><p class="noindent" >xpdf 3.00: <span
class="ec-lmss-10">underline </span>and <span
class="ec-lmss-10">dashed</span></li></ul>
- <!--l. 2175--><p class="noindent" >Unsupported:
+ <!--l. 2268--><p class="noindent" >Unsupported:
<ul class="itemize2">
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 2177--><p class="noindent" >AR5/Linux
+ <!--l. 2270--><p class="noindent" >AR5/Linux
</li>
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 2178--><p class="noindent" >ghostscript 8.50</li></ul>
+ <!--l. 2271--><p class="noindent" >ghostscript 8.50</li></ul>
</li></ul>
-<!--l. 2182--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 2275--><p class="noindent" >
<h4 class="subsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">7.24 </span> <a
- id="x1-490007.24"></a>Option <span
+ id="x1-510007.24"></a>Option <span
class="ec-lmss-10">bookmarksdepth</span></h4>
-<!--l. 2184--><p class="noindent" >The depth of the bookmarks can be controlled by the new option <span
+<!--l. 2277--><p class="noindent" >The depth of the bookmarks can be controlled by the new option <span
class="ec-lmss-10">bookmarksdepth</span>. The option acts
globally and distinguishes three cases:
<ul class="itemize1">
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 2188--><p class="noindent" ><span
+ <!--l. 2281--><p class="noindent" ><span
class="ec-lmss-10">bookmarksdepth </span>without value Then hyperref uses the current value of counter <span
class="ec-lmss-10">tocdepth</span>.
This is the compatible behaviour and the default.
@@ -5405,12 +5629,12 @@
</li>
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 2191--><p class="noindent" ><span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+ <!--l. 2284--><p class="noindent" ><span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">bookmarksdepth=<number></span></span></span>, the value is number (also negative): The depth for the
bookmarks are set to this number.
</li>
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 2193--><p class="noindent" ><span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+ <!--l. 2286--><p class="noindent" ><span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">bookmarksdepth=<name></span></span></span> The <name> is a document division name (part, chapter, ...). It must
not start with a digit or minus to avoid mixing up with the number case. Internally hyperref uses
the value of macro <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
@@ -5417,17 +5641,17 @@
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\toclevel@<name></span></span></span>. Examples:
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-39">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-41">
    \hypersetup{bookmarksdepth=paragraph}
    \hypersetup{bookmarksdepth=4} % same as before
    \hypersetup{bookmarksdepth} % counter "tocdepth" is used
</pre>
- <!--l. 2203--><p class="nopar" ></li></ul>
-<!--l. 2206--><p class="noindent" >
+ <!--l. 2296--><p class="nopar" ></li></ul>
+<!--l. 2299--><p class="noindent" >
<h4 class="subsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">7.25 </span> <a
- id="x1-500007.25"></a>Option <span
+ id="x1-520007.25"></a>Option <span
class="ec-lmss-10">pdfescapeform</span></h4>
-<!--l. 2208--><p class="noindent" >There are many places where arbitrary strings end up as PS or PDF strings. The PS/PDF strings in
+<!--l. 2301--><p class="noindent" >There are many places where arbitrary strings end up as PS or PDF strings. The PS/PDF strings in
parentheses form require the protection of some characters, e.g. unmatched left or right parentheses need
escaping or the escape character itself (backslash). Since 2006/02/12 v6.75a the PS/PDF driver
should do this automatically. However I assume a problem with compatibility, especially
@@ -5434,20 +5658,20 @@
regarding the form part where larger amounts of JavaScript code can be present. It would
be a pain to remove all the escaping, because an additional escaping layer can falsify the
code.
-<!--l. 2220--><p class="indent" > Therefore a new option pdfescapeform was introduced:
+<!--l. 2313--><p class="indent" > Therefore a new option pdfescapeform was introduced:
<ul class="itemize1">
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 2222--><p class="noindent" >pdfescapeform=false Escaping for the formulars are disabled, this is the compatibility
+ <!--l. 2315--><p class="noindent" >pdfescapeform=false Escaping for the formulars are disabled, this is the compatibility
behaviour, therefore this is the default.
</li>
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 2225--><p class="noindent" >pdfescapeform=true Then the PS/PDF drivers do all the necessary escaping. This is the
+ <!--l. 2318--><p class="noindent" >pdfescapeform=true Then the PS/PDF drivers do all the necessary escaping. This is the
logical choice and the recommended setting. For example, the user writes JavaScript as
JavaScript and do not care about escaping characters for PS/PDF output.</li></ul>
-<!--l. 2233--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 2326--><p class="noindent" >
<h4 class="subsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">7.26 </span> <a
- id="x1-510007.26"></a>Default driver setting</h4>
-<!--l. 2235--><p class="noindent" >(hyperref <span
+ id="x1-530007.26"></a>Default driver setting</h4>
+<!--l. 2328--><p class="noindent" >(hyperref <span
class="lmsy-10">≥ </span>6.72s) If no driver is given, hyperref tries its best to guess the most suitable
driver. Thus it loads <span
class="ec-lmss-10">hpdftex</span>, if pdfTeX is detected running in PDF mode. Or it loads the
@@ -5460,24 +5684,24 @@
class="ec-lmvtt-10">hyperref.cfg</span></span></span>:
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-40">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-42">
    \providecommand*{\Hy at defaultdriver}{hdvips}
</pre>
-<!--l. 2248--><p class="nopar" > for dvips, or
+<!--l. 2341--><p class="nopar" > for dvips, or
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-41">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-43">
    \providecommand*{\Hy at defaultdriver}{hypertex}
</pre>
-<!--l. 2252--><p class="nopar" > for the default behaviour of hyperref.
-<!--l. 2255--><p class="indent" > See also the new option ‘driverfallback’.
-<!--l. 2257--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 2345--><p class="nopar" > for the default behaviour of hyperref.
+<!--l. 2348--><p class="indent" > See also the new option ‘driverfallback’.
+<!--l. 2350--><p class="noindent" >
<h4 class="subsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">7.27 </span> <a
- id="x1-520007.27"></a>Backref entries</h4>
-<!--l. 2259--><p class="noindent" >Alternative interface for formatting of backref entries, example:
+ id="x1-540007.27"></a>Backref entries</h4>
+<!--l. 2352--><p class="noindent" >Alternative interface for formatting of backref entries, example:
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-42">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-44">
\documentclass[12pt,UKenglish]{article}
\usepackage{babel}
@@ -5567,11 +5791,11 @@
\end{document}
</pre>
-<!--l. 2348--><p class="nopar" >
-<!--l. 2350--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 2441--><p class="nopar" >
+<!--l. 2443--><p class="noindent" >
<h4 class="subsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">7.28 </span> <a
- id="x1-530007.28"></a>\phantomsection</h4>
-<!--l. 2352--><p class="noindent" >Set an anchor at this location. It is often used in conjunction with <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+ id="x1-550007.28"></a>\phantomsection</h4>
+<!--l. 2445--><p class="noindent" >Set an anchor at this location. It is often used in conjunction with <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\addcontentsline</span></span></span> for sectionlike things
(index, bibliography, preface). <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\addcontentsline</span></span></span> refers to the latest previous location where an anchor is
@@ -5578,19 +5802,19 @@
set.
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-43">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-45">
  \cleardoublepage
  \phantomsection
  \addcontentsline{toc}{chapter}{\indexname}
  \printindex
</pre>
-<!--l. 2362--><p class="nopar" >
-<!--l. 2364--><p class="indent" > Now the entry in the table of contents (and bookmarks) for the index points to the start of the index
+<!--l. 2455--><p class="nopar" >
+<!--l. 2457--><p class="indent" > Now the entry in the table of contents (and bookmarks) for the index points to the start of the index
page, not to a location before this page.
-<!--l. 2368--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 2461--><p class="noindent" >
<h4 class="subsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">7.29 </span> <a
- id="x1-540007.29"></a>puenc encoding, puenc-greek.def and puenc-extra.def</h4>
-<!--l. 2370--><p class="noindent" >The <span
+ id="x1-560007.29"></a>puenc encoding, puenc-greek.def and puenc-extra.def</h4>
+<!--l. 2463--><p class="noindent" >The <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">unicode </span>option loads for the bookmarks <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">puenc.def </span>which contains quite a lot definitions of
commands for the bookmarks. As <span
@@ -5601,27 +5825,26 @@
two strategies.
<ul class="itemize1">
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 2377--><p class="noindent" >A number of command are only defined conditionally: The commands for the cyrillic block
+ <!--l. 2470--><p class="noindent" >A number of command are only defined conditionally: The commands for the cyrillic block
if <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\CYRDZE </span>is defined, greek if <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\textBeta </span>is defined, and hebrew if <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\hebdalet </span>is defined.
- <!--l. 2381--><p class="noindent" >The greek block is in an extra file, <span
+ <!--l. 2474--><p class="noindent" >The greek block is in an extra file, <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">puenc-greek.def</span>, which can be loaded manually if needed.
</li>
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 2384--><p class="noindent" >Other commands are moved to an extra file <span
+ <!--l. 2477--><p class="noindent" >Other commands are moved to an extra file <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">puenc-extra.def </span>which is not loaded
automatically, but can be loaded in the preamble if needed. Currently this file contains all
definitions for the accent <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\G</span>.</li></ul>
-<!--l. 2391--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 2484--><p class="noindent" >
<h3 class="sectionHead"><span class="titlemark">8 </span> <a
- id="x1-550008"></a>Acrobat-specific behavior</h3>
-<!--l. 2392--><p class="noindent" >If you want to access the menu options of Acrobat Reader or Exchange, the following macro is provided
+ id="x1-570008"></a>Acrobat-specific behavior</h3>
+<!--l. 2485--><p class="noindent" >If you want to access the menu options of Acrobat Reader or Exchange, the following macro is provided
in the appropriate drivers:
-<!--l. 2395--><p class="noindent" >
-<span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-43" class="tabular"
+<!--l. 2488--><p class="noindent" ><span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-43" class="tabular"
><colgroup id="TBL-43-1g"><col
id="TBL-43-1"></colgroup><tr
@@ -5634,17 +5857,17 @@
class="ec-lmri-10">text</span><span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">}</span></span></span> </td>
</tr></table> </div></span>
-<!--l. 2399--><p class="noindent" >The <span
+<!--l. 2492--><p class="noindent" >The <span
class="ec-lmri-10">text </span>is used to create a button which activates the appropriate <span
class="ec-lmri-10">menuoption</span>. The following table lists
the option names you can use—comparison of this with the menus in Acrobat Reader or Exchange will
show what they do. Obviously some are only appropriate to Exchange.
-<!--l. 2402--><p class="indent" >
+<!--l. 2495--><p class="indent" >
<a
- id="x1-55001r13"></a>
+ id="x1-57001r13"></a>
- <!--l. 2403--><div class="longtable"> <table id="TBL-44" class="longtable"
+ <!--l. 2496--><div class="longtable"> <table id="TBL-44" class="longtable"
><colgroup id="TBL-44-1g"><col
id="TBL-44-1"><col
@@ -5653,7 +5876,7 @@
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-44-1-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-44-1-1"
class="td01">File </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-44-1-2"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 2403--><p class="noindent" >Open,
+ <!--l. 2496--><p class="noindent" >Open,
Close,
Scan,
Save,
@@ -5667,7 +5890,7 @@
class="td01">File<span
class="lmsy-10">→</span>Import </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-44-2-2"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 2404--><p class="noindent" >ImportImage,
+ <!--l. 2497--><p class="noindent" >ImportImage,
ImportNotes,
AcroForm:ImportFDF </td>
</tr><tr
@@ -5675,7 +5898,7 @@
class="td01">File<span
class="lmsy-10">→</span>Export </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-44-3-2"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 2405--><p class="noindent" >ExportNotes,
+ <!--l. 2498--><p class="noindent" >ExportNotes,
AcroForm:ExportFDF </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-44-4-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-44-4-1"
@@ -5682,7 +5905,7 @@
class="td01">File<span
class="lmsy-10">→</span>DocumentInfo </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-44-4-2"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 2406--><p class="noindent" >GeneralInfo,
+ <!--l. 2499--><p class="noindent" >GeneralInfo,
OpenInfo,
FontsInfo,
SecurityInfo,
@@ -5693,7 +5916,7 @@
class="td01">File<span
class="lmsy-10">→</span>Preferences </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-44-5-2"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 2407--><p class="noindent" >GeneralPrefs,
+ <!--l. 2500--><p class="noindent" >GeneralPrefs,
NotePrefs,
FullScreenPrefs,
Weblink:Prefs,
@@ -5705,7 +5928,7 @@
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-44-6-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-44-6-1"
class="td01">Edit </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-44-6-2"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 2409--><p class="noindent" >Undo,
+ <!--l. 2502--><p class="noindent" >Undo,
Cut,
Copy,
Paste,
@@ -5721,13 +5944,13 @@
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-44-7-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-44-7-1"
class="td01"> </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-44-7-2"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 2412--><p class="noindent" >Properties </td>
+ <!--l. 2505--><p class="noindent" >Properties </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-44-8-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-44-8-1"
class="td01">Edit<span
class="lmsy-10">→</span>Fields </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-44-8-2"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 2413--><p class="noindent" >AcroForm:Duplicate,
+ <!--l. 2506--><p class="noindent" >AcroForm:Duplicate,
AcroForm:TabOrder </td>
@@ -5735,7 +5958,7 @@
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-44-9-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-44-9-1"
class="td01">Document </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-44-9-2"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 2414--><p class="noindent" >Cpt:CapturePages,
+ <!--l. 2507--><p class="noindent" >Cpt:CapturePages,
AcroForm:Actions,
CropPages,
RotatePages,
@@ -5751,7 +5974,7 @@
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-44-10-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-44-10-1"
class="td01">View </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-44-10-2"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 2417--><p class="noindent" >ActualSize,
+ <!--l. 2510--><p class="noindent" >ActualSize,
FitVisible,
FitWidth,
FitPage,
@@ -5775,7 +5998,7 @@
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-44-11-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-44-11-1"
class="td01">Tools </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-44-11-2"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 2420--><p class="noindent" >Hand,
+ <!--l. 2513--><p class="noindent" >Hand,
ZoomIn,
ZoomOut,
SelectText,
@@ -5797,7 +6020,7 @@
class="td01">Tools<span
class="lmsy-10">→</span>Search </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-44-12-2"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 2423--><p class="noindent" >AcroSrch:Query,
+ <!--l. 2516--><p class="noindent" >AcroSrch:Query,
AcroSrch:Indexes,
AcroSrch:Results,
AcroSrch:Assist,
@@ -5809,7 +6032,7 @@
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-44-13-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-44-13-1"
class="td01">Window </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-44-13-2"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 2425--><p class="noindent" >ShowHideToolBar,
+ <!--l. 2518--><p class="noindent" >ShowHideToolBar,
ShowHideMenuBar,
ShowHideClipboard,
Cascade,
@@ -5820,7 +6043,7 @@
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-44-14-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-44-14-1"
class="td01">Help </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-44-14-2"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 2427--><p class="noindent" >HelpUserGuide,
+ <!--l. 2520--><p class="noindent" >HelpUserGuide,
HelpTutorial,
HelpExchange,
HelpScan,
@@ -5835,7 +6058,7 @@
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-44-15-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-44-15-1"
class="td01">Help(Windows) </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-44-15-2"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 2429--><p class="noindent" >About </td>
+ <!--l. 2522--><p class="noindent" >About </td>
</tr><tr
style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-44-16-"><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-44-16-1"
class="td01"> </td>
@@ -5850,17 +6073,18 @@
class="td01"> </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-44-19-2"
class="td10"></td></tr>
</table></div>
-<!--l. 2432--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 2525--><p class="noindent" >
<h3 class="sectionHead"><span class="titlemark">9 </span> <a
- id="x1-560009"></a>PDF and HTML forms</h3>
-<!--l. 2433--><p class="noindent" >You must put your fields inside a <span
+ id="x1-580009"></a>PDF and HTML forms</h3>
+<!--l. 2526--><p class="noindent" >You must put your fields inside a <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">Form </span>environment. The environment does some general setups, so
should be used only once in a document. Using simply <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\Form </span>at the begin of the document is possible
too.
-<!--l. 2437--><p class="indent" > There are six macros to prepare fields:
-<!--l. 2439--><p class="noindent" >
-<span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-45" class="tabular"
+<!--l. 2530--><p class="indent" > There are six macros to prepare fields:
+
+
+<!--l. 2532--><p class="noindent" ><span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-45" class="tabular"
><colgroup id="TBL-45-1g"><col
id="TBL-45-1"></colgroup><tr
@@ -5873,10 +6097,7 @@
class="ec-lmri-10">label</span><span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">}</span></span></span> </td>
</tr></table> </div></span>
-<!--l. 2443--><p class="noindent" >
-
-
-<span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-46" class="tabular"
+<!--l. 2536--><p class="noindent" ><span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-46" class="tabular"
><colgroup id="TBL-46-1g"><col
id="TBL-46-1"></colgroup><tr
@@ -5889,8 +6110,7 @@
class="ec-lmri-10">label</span><span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">}</span></span></span> </td>
</tr></table> </div></span>
-<!--l. 2447--><p class="noindent" >
-<span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-47" class="tabular"
+<!--l. 2540--><p class="noindent" ><span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-47" class="tabular"
><colgroup id="TBL-47-1g"><col
id="TBL-47-1"></colgroup><tr
@@ -5905,8 +6125,7 @@
class="ec-lmri-10">choices</span><span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">}</span></span></span> </td>
</tr></table> </div></span>
-<!--l. 2451--><p class="noindent" >
-<span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-48" class="tabular"
+<!--l. 2544--><p class="noindent" ><span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-48" class="tabular"
><colgroup id="TBL-48-1g"><col
id="TBL-48-1"></colgroup><tr
@@ -5919,8 +6138,7 @@
class="ec-lmri-10">label</span><span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">}</span></span></span> </td>
</tr></table> </div></span>
-<!--l. 2455--><p class="noindent" >
-<span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-49" class="tabular"
+<!--l. 2548--><p class="noindent" ><span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-49" class="tabular"
><colgroup id="TBL-49-1g"><col
id="TBL-49-1"></colgroup><tr
@@ -5933,8 +6151,7 @@
class="ec-lmri-10">label</span><span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">}</span></span></span> </td>
</tr></table> </div></span>
-<!--l. 2459--><p class="noindent" >
-<span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-50" class="tabular"
+<!--l. 2552--><p class="noindent" ><span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-50" class="tabular"
><colgroup id="TBL-50-1g"><col
id="TBL-50-1"></colgroup><tr
@@ -5947,9 +6164,8 @@
class="ec-lmri-10">label</span><span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">}</span></span></span> </td>
</tr></table> </div></span>
-<!--l. 2463--><p class="indent" > The way forms and their labels are laid out is determined by:
-<!--l. 2464--><p class="noindent" >
-<span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-51" class="tabular"
+<!--l. 2556--><p class="indent" > The way forms and their labels are laid out is determined by:
+<!--l. 2557--><p class="noindent" ><span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-51" class="tabular"
><colgroup id="TBL-51-1g"><col
id="TBL-51-1"></colgroup><tr
@@ -5962,8 +6178,7 @@
class="ec-lmri-10">field</span><span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">}</span></span></span> </td>
</tr></table> </div></span>
-<!--l. 2468--><p class="noindent" >
-<span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-52" class="tabular"
+<!--l. 2561--><p class="noindent" ><span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-52" class="tabular"
><colgroup id="TBL-52-1g"><col
id="TBL-52-1"></colgroup><tr
@@ -5976,8 +6191,7 @@
class="ec-lmri-10">field</span><span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">}</span></span></span> </td>
</tr></table> </div></span>
-<!--l. 2472--><p class="noindent" >
-<span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-53" class="tabular"
+<!--l. 2565--><p class="noindent" ><span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-53" class="tabular"
><colgroup id="TBL-53-1g"><col
id="TBL-53-1"></colgroup><tr
@@ -5990,10 +6204,9 @@
class="ec-lmri-10">field</span><span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">}</span></span></span> </td>
</tr></table> </div></span>
-<!--l. 2476--><p class="indent" > These macros default to #1 #2
-<!--l. 2478--><p class="indent" > What is actually shown in the field is determined by:
-<!--l. 2479--><p class="noindent" >
-<span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-54" class="tabular"
+<!--l. 2569--><p class="indent" > These macros default to #1 #2
+<!--l. 2571--><p class="indent" > What is actually shown in the field is determined by:
+<!--l. 2572--><p class="noindent" ><span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-54" class="tabular"
><colgroup id="TBL-54-1g"><col
id="TBL-54-1"></colgroup><tr
@@ -6006,8 +6219,7 @@
class="ec-lmri-10">height</span><span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">}</span></span></span> </td>
</tr></table> </div></span>
-<!--l. 2483--><p class="noindent" >
-<span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-55" class="tabular"
+<!--l. 2576--><p class="noindent" ><span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-55" class="tabular"
><colgroup id="TBL-55-1g"><col
id="TBL-55-1"></colgroup><tr
@@ -6020,8 +6232,7 @@
class="ec-lmri-10">height</span><span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">}</span></span></span> </td>
</tr></table> </div></span>
-<!--l. 2486--><p class="noindent" >
-<span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-56" class="tabular"
+<!--l. 2579--><p class="noindent" ><span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-56" class="tabular"
><colgroup id="TBL-56-1g"><col
id="TBL-56-1"></colgroup><tr
@@ -6034,10 +6245,7 @@
class="ec-lmri-10">height</span><span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">}</span></span></span> </td>
</tr></table> </div></span>
-<!--l. 2489--><p class="noindent" >
-
-
-<span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-57" class="tabular"
+<!--l. 2582--><p class="noindent" ><span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-57" class="tabular"
><colgroup id="TBL-57-1g"><col
id="TBL-57-1"></colgroup><tr
@@ -6050,8 +6258,7 @@
class="ec-lmri-10">height</span><span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">}</span></span></span> </td>
</tr></table> </div></span>
-<!--l. 2493--><p class="noindent" >
-<span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-58" class="tabular"
+<!--l. 2586--><p class="noindent" ><span class="fbox"><!--tex4ht:inline--><div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-58" class="tabular"
><colgroup id="TBL-58-1g"><col
id="TBL-58-1"></colgroup><tr
@@ -6061,7 +6268,7 @@
class="ec-lmvtt-10">{</span></span></span><span
class="ec-lmri-10">text</span><span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">}</span></span></span> </td></tr></table> </div></span>
-<!--l. 2497--><p class="indent" > These macros default to <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+<!--l. 2590--><p class="indent" > These macros default to <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\vbox</span><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10"> to</span><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10"> #2{\hbox</span><span
@@ -6070,10 +6277,10 @@
to #1; it is used for buttons, and the special <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\Submit </span>and <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\Reset </span>macros.
-<!--l. 2501--><p class="indent" > You may also want to redefine the following macros:
+<!--l. 2594--><p class="indent" > You may also want to redefine the following macros:
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-44">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-46">
\def\DefaultHeightofSubmit{12pt}
\def\DefaultWidthofSubmit{2cm}
\def\DefaultHeightofReset{12pt}
@@ -6086,13 +6293,13 @@
\def\DefaultHeightofTextMultiline{4\baselineskip}
\def\DefaultWidthofText{3cm}
</pre>
-<!--l. 2514--><p class="nopar" >
-<!--l. 2516--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 2607--><p class="nopar" >
+<!--l. 2609--><p class="noindent" >
<h4 class="subsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">9.1 </span> <a
- id="x1-570009.1"></a>Forms environment parameters</h4>
-<!--l. 2519--><p class="noindent" >
+ id="x1-590009.1"></a>Forms environment parameters</h4>
+<!--l. 2612--><p class="noindent" >
<a
- id="x1-57001r14"></a> <!--l. 2520--><div class="longtable"> <table id="TBL-59" class="longtable"
+ id="x1-59001r14"></a> <!--l. 2613--><div class="longtable"> <table id="TBL-59" class="longtable"
><colgroup id="TBL-59-1g"><col
id="TBL-59-1"><col
@@ -6105,7 +6312,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">URL </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-59-1-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 2520--><p class="noindent" >The URL that will receive the form data if a <span
+ <!--l. 2613--><p class="noindent" >The URL that will receive the form data if a <span
class="ec-lmss-10">Submit </span>button
is included in the form </td>
</tr><tr
@@ -6115,7 +6322,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">name </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-59-2-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 2521--><p class="noindent" >The encoding for the string set to the URL; FDF-encoding
+ <!--l. 2614--><p class="noindent" >The encoding for the string set to the URL; FDF-encoding
is usual, and <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">html </span>is the only valid value </td>
</tr><tr
@@ -6125,7 +6332,7 @@
class="td11"> <span
class="ec-lmri-10">name </span></td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-59-3-3"
class="td10">
- <!--l. 2523--><p class="noindent" >Used only when generating HTML; values can be <span
+ <!--l. 2616--><p class="noindent" >Used only when generating HTML; values can be <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">post </span>or
<span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">get</span> </td>
@@ -6147,16 +6354,16 @@
class="td11"> </td><td style="white-space:normal; text-align:left;" id="TBL-59-8-3"
class="td10"></td></tr>
</table></div>
-<!--l. 2526--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 2619--><p class="noindent" >
<h4 class="subsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">9.2 </span> <a
- id="x1-580009.2"></a>Forms optional parameters</h4>
-<!--l. 2527--><p class="noindent" >Note that all colors must be expressed as RGB triples, in the range 0..1 (i.e. <span
+ id="x1-600009.2"></a>Forms optional parameters</h4>
+<!--l. 2620--><p class="noindent" >Note that all colors must be expressed as RGB triples, in the range 0..1 (i.e. <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">color=0 0</span>
<span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">0.5</span>)
-<!--l. 2531--><p class="indent" >
+<!--l. 2624--><p class="indent" >
<a
- id="x1-58001r15"></a> <!--l. 2532--><div class="longtable"> <table id="TBL-60" class="longtable"
+ id="x1-60001r15"></a> <!--l. 2625--><div class="longtable"> <table id="TBL-60" class="longtable"
><colgroup id="TBL-60-1g"><col
id="TBL-60-1"><col
@@ -6616,31 +6823,31 @@
class="td11"> </td><td style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-60-63-4"
class="td10"></td></tr>
</table></div>
-<!--l. 2593--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 2686--><p class="noindent" >
<h3 class="sectionHead"><span class="titlemark">10 </span> <a
- id="x1-5900010"></a>Defining a new driver</h3>
-<!--l. 2594--><p class="noindent" >A hyperref driver has to provide definitions for eight macros:
-<!--l. 2597--><p class="noindent" >1. <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+ id="x1-6100010"></a>Defining a new driver</h3>
+<!--l. 2687--><p class="noindent" >A hyperref driver has to provide definitions for eight macros:
+<!--l. 2690--><p class="noindent" >1. <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\hyper at anchor</span></span></span>
-<!--l. 2599--><p class="noindent" >2. <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+<!--l. 2692--><p class="noindent" >2. <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\hyper at link</span></span></span>
-<!--l. 2601--><p class="noindent" >3. <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+<!--l. 2694--><p class="noindent" >3. <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\hyper at linkfile</span></span></span>
-<!--l. 2603--><p class="noindent" >4. <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+<!--l. 2696--><p class="noindent" >4. <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\hyper at linkurl</span></span></span>
-<!--l. 2605--><p class="noindent" >5. <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+<!--l. 2698--><p class="noindent" >5. <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\hyper at anchorstart</span></span></span>
-<!--l. 2607--><p class="noindent" >6. <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+<!--l. 2700--><p class="noindent" >6. <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\hyper at anchorend</span></span></span>
-<!--l. 2609--><p class="noindent" >7. <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+<!--l. 2702--><p class="noindent" >7. <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\hyper at linkstart</span></span></span>
-<!--l. 2611--><p class="noindent" >8. <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+<!--l. 2704--><p class="noindent" >8. <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\hyper at linkend</span></span></span>
-<!--l. 2614--><p class="indent" > The draft option defines the macros as follows
+<!--l. 2707--><p class="indent" > The draft option defines the macros as follows
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-45">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-47">
\let\hyper@@anchor\@gobble
\gdef\hyper at link##1##2##3{##3}%
\def\hyper at linkurl##1##2{##1}%
@@ -6650,16 +6857,16 @@
\let\hyper at linkstart\@gobbletwo
\let\hyper at linkend\@empty
</pre>
-<!--l. 2624--><p class="nopar" >
-<!--l. 2626--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 2717--><p class="nopar" >
+<!--l. 2719--><p class="noindent" >
<h3 class="sectionHead"><span class="titlemark">11 </span> <a
- id="x1-6000011"></a>Special support for other packages</h3>
-<!--l. 2628--><p class="noindent" >Package <span
+ id="x1-6200011"></a>Special support for other packages</h3>
+<!--l. 2721--><p class="noindent" >Package <span
class="ec-lmss-10">hyperref </span>aims to cooperate with other packages, but there are several possible sources for
conflict, such as
<ul class="itemize1">
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 2633--><p class="noindent" >Packages that manipulate the bibliographic mechanism. Peter William’s <span
+ <!--l. 2726--><p class="noindent" >Packages that manipulate the bibliographic mechanism. Peter William’s <span
class="ec-lmss-10">harvard </span>package is
supported. However, the recommended package is Patrick Daly’s <span
class="ec-lmss-10">natbib </span>package that has
@@ -6669,7 +6876,7 @@
class="ec-lmss-10">hyperref</span>.
</li>
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 2640--><p class="noindent" >Packages that typeset the contents of the <span
+ <!--l. 2733--><p class="noindent" >Packages that typeset the contents of the <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\label </span>and <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\ref </span>macros, such as <span
class="ec-lmss-10">showkeys</span>. Since the
@@ -6679,8 +6886,8 @@
to work.
</li>
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 2645--><p class="noindent" >Packages that do anything serious with the index.</li></ul>
-<!--l. 2648--><p class="indent" > The <span
+ <!--l. 2738--><p class="noindent" >Packages that do anything serious with the index.</li></ul>
+<!--l. 2741--><p class="indent" > The <span
class="ec-lmss-10">hyperref </span>package is distributed with variants on two useful packages designed to work especially
well with it. These are <span
class="ec-lmss-10">xr </span>and <span
@@ -6688,28 +6895,28 @@
<span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\label</span>/<span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\ref </span>mechanisms and per-chapter tables of contents, respectively.
-<!--l. 2655--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 2748--><p class="noindent" >
<h4 class="subsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">11.1 </span> <a
- id="x1-6100011.1"></a>Package Compatibility</h4>
-<!--l. 2657--><p class="noindent" >Currently only package loading orders are available:
-<!--l. 2661--><p class="indent" > Note: hyperref loads package <span
+ id="x1-6300011.1"></a>Package Compatibility</h4>
+<!--l. 2750--><p class="noindent" >Currently only package loading orders are available:
+<!--l. 2754--><p class="indent" > Note: hyperref loads package <span
class="ec-lmss-10">nameref </span>at <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\begin{document}</span></span></span>. Sometimes this is too late, thus this
package must be loaded earlier.
-<!--l. 2666--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 2759--><p class="noindent" >
<h5 class="subsubsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">11.1.1 </span> <a
- id="x1-6200011.1.1"></a>algorithm</h5>
+ id="x1-6400011.1.1"></a>algorithm</h5>
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-46">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-48">
 \usepackage{float}
  \usepackage{hyperref}
  \usepackage[chapter]{algorithm}% eg.
</pre>
-<!--l. 2671--><p class="nopar" >
-<!--l. 2673--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 2764--><p class="nopar" >
+<!--l. 2766--><p class="noindent" >
<h5 class="subsubsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">11.1.2 </span> <a
- id="x1-6300011.1.2"></a>amsmath</h5>
-<!--l. 2675--><p class="noindent" >The environments equation and eqnarray are not supported too well. For example, there might be
+ id="x1-6500011.1.2"></a>amsmath</h5>
+<!--l. 2768--><p class="noindent" >The environments equation and eqnarray are not supported too well. For example, there might be
spacing problems (eqnarray isn’t recommended anyway, see CTAN:info/l2tabu/, the situation for
equation is unclear, because nobody is interested in investigating). Consider using the environments that
package amsmath provide, e.g. gather for equation. The environment equation can even redefined to use
@@ -6716,45 +6923,45 @@
gather:
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-47">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-49">
  \usepackage{amsmath}
  \let\equation\gather
  \let\endequation\endgather
</pre>
-<!--l. 2686--><p class="nopar" >
-<!--l. 2688--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 2779--><p class="nopar" >
+<!--l. 2781--><p class="noindent" >
<h5 class="subsubsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">11.1.3 </span> <a
- id="x1-6400011.1.3"></a>amsrefs</h5>
-<!--l. 2690--><p class="noindent" >Package loading order:
+ id="x1-6600011.1.3"></a>amsrefs</h5>
+<!--l. 2783--><p class="noindent" >Package loading order:
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-48">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-50">
  \usepackage{hyperref}
  \usepackage{amsrefs}
</pre>
-<!--l. 2695--><p class="nopar" >
-<!--l. 2697--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 2788--><p class="nopar" >
+<!--l. 2790--><p class="noindent" >
<h5 class="subsubsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">11.1.4 </span> <a
- id="x1-6500011.1.4"></a>arydshln, longtable</h5>
-<!--l. 2699--><p class="noindent" >Package longtable must be put before hyperref and arydshln, hyperref after arydshln generates an error,
+ id="x1-6700011.1.4"></a>arydshln, longtable</h5>
+<!--l. 2792--><p class="noindent" >Package longtable must be put before hyperref and arydshln, hyperref after arydshln generates an error,
thus the resulting package order is then:
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-49">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-51">
  \usepackage{longtable}
  \usepackage{hyperref}
  \usepackage{arydshln}
</pre>
-<!--l. 2707--><p class="nopar" >
-<!--l. 2709--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 2800--><p class="nopar" >
+<!--l. 2802--><p class="noindent" >
<h5 class="subsubsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">11.1.5 </span> <a
- id="x1-6600011.1.5"></a>babel/magyar.ldf</h5>
-<!--l. 2711--><p class="noindent" >The old version 2005/03/30 v1.4j will not work. You need at least version 1.5, maintained by P\xE9ter
+ id="x1-6800011.1.5"></a>babel/magyar.ldf</h5>
+<!--l. 2804--><p class="noindent" >The old version 2005/03/30 v1.4j will not work. You need at least version 1.5, maintained by P\xE9ter
Szab\xF3, see CTAN:language/hungarian/babel/.
-<!--l. 2716--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 2809--><p class="noindent" >
<h5 class="subsubsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">11.1.6 </span> <a
- id="x1-6700011.1.6"></a>babel/spanish.ldf</h5>
-<!--l. 2718--><p class="noindent" >Babel’s spanish.ldf redefines ‘<span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+ id="x1-6900011.1.6"></a>babel/spanish.ldf</h5>
+<!--l. 2811--><p class="noindent" >Babel’s spanish.ldf redefines ‘<span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\.</span></span></span>’ to support ‘<span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\...</span></span></span>’. In bookmarks (<span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\pdfstringdef</span></span></span>) only ‘<span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
@@ -6762,13 +6969,13 @@
‘<span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\...</span></span></span>’ is needed, <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\texorpdfstring{\...}{\dots}</span></span></span> can be used instead.
-<!--l. 2725--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 2818--><p class="noindent" >
<h5 class="subsubsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">11.1.7 </span> <a
- id="x1-6800011.1.7"></a>bibentry</h5>
-<!--l. 2727--><p class="noindent" >Workaround:
+ id="x1-7000011.1.7"></a>bibentry</h5>
+<!--l. 2820--><p class="noindent" >Workaround:
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-50">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-52">
  \makeatletter
  \let\saved at bibitem\@bibitem
  \makeatother
@@ -6784,33 +6991,33 @@
    \nobibliography{database}
  \endgroup
</pre>
-<!--l. 2744--><p class="nopar" >
-<!--l. 2746--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 2837--><p class="nopar" >
+<!--l. 2839--><p class="noindent" >
<h5 class="subsubsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">11.1.8 </span> <a
- id="x1-6900011.1.8"></a>bigfoot</h5>
-<!--l. 2748--><p class="noindent" >Hyperref does not support package ‘bigfoot’. And package ‘bigfoot’ does not support hyperref’s footnotes
+ id="x1-7100011.1.8"></a>bigfoot</h5>
+<!--l. 2841--><p class="noindent" >Hyperref does not support package ‘bigfoot’. And package ‘bigfoot’ does not support hyperref’s footnotes
and disables them (hyperfootnotes=false).
-<!--l. 2753--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 2846--><p class="noindent" >
<h5 class="subsubsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">11.1.9 </span> <a
- id="x1-7000011.1.9"></a>chappg</h5>
-<!--l. 2755--><p class="noindent" >Package ‘chappg’ uses <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+ id="x1-7200011.1.9"></a>chappg</h5>
+<!--l. 2848--><p class="noindent" >Package ‘chappg’ uses <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\@addtoreset</span></span></span> that is redefined by ‘hyperref’. The package order is
therefore:
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-51">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-53">
  \usepackage{hyperref}
  \usepackage{chappg}
</pre>
-<!--l. 2761--><p class="nopar" >
-<!--l. 2763--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 2854--><p class="nopar" >
+<!--l. 2856--><p class="noindent" >
<h5 class="subsubsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">11.1.10 </span> <a
- id="x1-7100011.1.10"></a>cite</h5>
-<!--l. 2765--><p class="noindent" >This is from Mike Shell: cite.sty cannot currently be used with hyperref. However, I can do a workaround
+ id="x1-7300011.1.10"></a>cite</h5>
+<!--l. 2858--><p class="noindent" >This is from Mike Shell: cite.sty cannot currently be used with hyperref. However, I can do a workaround
via:
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-52">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-54">
 \makeatletter
 \def\NAT at parse{\typeout{This is a fake Natbib command to fool Hyperref.}}
 \makeatother
@@ -6817,20 +7024,20 @@
 \usepackage[hypertex]{hyperref}
</pre>
-<!--l. 2775--><p class="nopar" >
-<!--l. 2777--><p class="indent" > so that hyperref will not redefine any of the biblabel stuff - so cite.sty will work as normal -
+<!--l. 2868--><p class="nopar" >
+<!--l. 2870--><p class="indent" > so that hyperref will not redefine any of the biblabel stuff - so cite.sty will work as normal -
although the citations will not be hyperlinked, of course (But this may not be an issue for many
people).
-<!--l. 2782--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 2875--><p class="noindent" >
<h5 class="subsubsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">11.1.11 </span> <a
- id="x1-7200011.1.11"></a>count1to</h5>
-<!--l. 2784--><p class="noindent" >Package ‘count1to’ adds several <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+ id="x1-7400011.1.11"></a>count1to</h5>
+<!--l. 2877--><p class="noindent" >Package ‘count1to’ adds several <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\@addtoreset</span></span></span> commands that confuse ‘hyperref’. Therefore <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\theH<...></span></span></span>
has to be fixed:
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-53">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-55">
  \usepackage{count1to}
  \AtBeginDocument{% *after* \usepackage{count1to}
    \renewcommand*{\theHsection}{\theHchapter.\arabic{section}}%
@@ -6840,61 +7047,61 @@
    \renewcommand*{\theHsubparagraph}{\theHparagraph.\arabic{subparagraph}}%
  }
</pre>
-<!--l. 2796--><p class="nopar" >
-<!--l. 2798--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 2889--><p class="nopar" >
+<!--l. 2891--><p class="noindent" >
<h5 class="subsubsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">11.1.12 </span> <a
- id="x1-7300011.1.12"></a>dblaccnt</h5>
-<!--l. 2800--><p class="noindent" >pd1enc.def or puenc.def should be loaded before:
+ id="x1-7500011.1.12"></a>dblaccnt</h5>
+<!--l. 2893--><p class="noindent" >pd1enc.def or puenc.def should be loaded before:
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-54">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-56">
  \usepackage{hyperref}
  \usepackage{dblaccnt}
</pre>
-<!--l. 2804--><p class="nopar" > or see entry for <span
+<!--l. 2897--><p class="nopar" > or see entry for <span
class="ec-lmss-10">vietnam</span>.
-<!--l. 2808--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 2901--><p class="noindent" >
<h5 class="subsubsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">11.1.13 </span> <a
- id="x1-7400011.1.13"></a>easyeqn</h5>
-<!--l. 2809--><p class="noindent" >Not compatible, breaks.
-<!--l. 2812--><p class="noindent" >
+ id="x1-7600011.1.13"></a>easyeqn</h5>
+<!--l. 2902--><p class="noindent" >Not compatible, breaks.
+<!--l. 2905--><p class="noindent" >
<h5 class="subsubsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">11.1.14 </span> <a
- id="x1-7500011.1.14"></a>ellipsis</h5>
-<!--l. 2814--><p class="noindent" >This packages redefines <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+ id="x1-7700011.1.14"></a>ellipsis</h5>
+<!--l. 2907--><p class="noindent" >This packages redefines <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\textellipsis</span></span></span> after package hyperref (pd1enc.def/puenc.def should be loaded
before):
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-55">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-57">
  \usepackage{hyperref}
  \usepackage{ellipsis}
</pre>
-<!--l. 2819--><p class="nopar" >
-<!--l. 2821--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 2912--><p class="nopar" >
+<!--l. 2914--><p class="noindent" >
<h5 class="subsubsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">11.1.15 </span> <a
- id="x1-7600011.1.15"></a>float</h5>
+ id="x1-7800011.1.15"></a>float</h5>
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-56">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-58">
 \usepackage{float}
  \usepackage{hyperref}
</pre>
-<!--l. 2825--><p class="nopar" >
+<!--l. 2918--><p class="nopar" >
<ul class="itemize1">
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 2827--><p class="noindent" >Several <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+ <!--l. 2920--><p class="noindent" >Several <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\caption</span></span></span> commands are not supported inside one float object.
</li>
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 2828--><p class="noindent" >Anchor are set at top of the float object, if its style is controlled by float.sty.</li></ul>
-<!--l. 2832--><p class="noindent" >
+ <!--l. 2921--><p class="noindent" >Anchor are set at top of the float object, if its style is controlled by float.sty.</li></ul>
+<!--l. 2925--><p class="noindent" >
<h5 class="subsubsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">11.1.16 </span> <a
- id="x1-7700011.1.16"></a>endnotes</h5>
-<!--l. 2833--><p class="noindent" >Unsupported.
-<!--l. 2835--><p class="noindent" >
+ id="x1-7900011.1.16"></a>endnotes</h5>
+<!--l. 2926--><p class="noindent" >Unsupported.
+<!--l. 2928--><p class="noindent" >
<h5 class="subsubsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">11.1.17 </span> <a
- id="x1-7800011.1.17"></a>foiltex</h5>
-<!--l. 2836--><p class="noindent" >Update to version 2008/01/28 v2.1.4b: Since version 6.77a hyperref does not hack into <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+ id="x1-8000011.1.17"></a>foiltex</h5>
+<!--l. 2929--><p class="noindent" >Update to version 2008/01/28 v2.1.4b: Since version 6.77a hyperref does not hack into <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\@begindvi</span></span></span>, it
uses package ‘atbegshi’ instead, that hooks into <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\shipout</span></span></span>. Thus the patch of ‘foils.cls’ regarding hyperref
@@ -6901,22 +7108,22 @@
is now obsolete and causes an undefined error message about <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\@hyperfixhead</span></span></span>. This is fixed in FoilTeX
2.1.4b.
-<!--l. 2844--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 2937--><p class="noindent" >
<h5 class="subsubsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">11.1.18 </span> <a
- id="x1-7900011.1.18"></a>footnote</h5>
-<!--l. 2846--><p class="noindent" >This package is not supported, you have to disable hyperref’s footnote support by using option
+ id="x1-8100011.1.18"></a>footnote</h5>
+<!--l. 2939--><p class="noindent" >This package is not supported, you have to disable hyperref’s footnote support by using option
<span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">hyperfootnotes=false</span></span></span>.
-<!--l. 2850--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 2943--><p class="noindent" >
<h5 class="subsubsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">11.1.19 </span> <a
- id="x1-8000011.1.19"></a>geometry</h5>
-<!--l. 2852--><p class="noindent" >Driver ‘dvipdfm’ and program ‘dvipdfm’ might generate a warning: Sorry. Too late to change page size
+ id="x1-8200011.1.19"></a>geometry</h5>
+<!--l. 2945--><p class="noindent" >Driver ‘dvipdfm’ and program ‘dvipdfm’ might generate a warning: Sorry. Too late to change page size
Then prefer the program ‘dvipdfmx’ or use one of the following workarounds to move the <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\special</span></span></span> of
geometry to an earlier location:
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-57">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-59">
    \documentclass[dvipdfm]{article}% or other classes
    \usepackage{atbegshi}
    \AtBeginDocument{%
@@ -6943,94 +7150,94 @@
    ]{geometry}
    \usepackage{hyperref}
</pre>
-<!--l. 2884--><p class="nopar" >
-<!--l. 2886--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 2977--><p class="nopar" >
+<!--l. 2979--><p class="noindent" >
<h5 class="subsubsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">11.1.20 </span> <a
- id="x1-8100011.1.20"></a>IEEEtran.cls</h5>
-<!--l. 2888--><p class="noindent" >version <span
+ id="x1-8300011.1.20"></a>IEEEtran.cls</h5>
+<!--l. 2981--><p class="noindent" >version <span
class="lmsy-10">≥ </span>V1.6b (because of <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\@makecaption</span></span></span>, see ChangeLog)
-<!--l. 2891--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 2984--><p class="noindent" >
<h5 class="subsubsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">11.1.21 </span> <a
- id="x1-8200011.1.21"></a>index</h5>
-<!--l. 2893--><p class="noindent" >version <span
+ id="x1-8400011.1.21"></a>index</h5>
+<!--l. 2986--><p class="noindent" >version <span
class="lmsy-10">≥ </span>1995/09/28 v4.1 (because of <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\addcontentsline</span></span></span> redefinition)
-<!--l. 2896--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 2989--><p class="noindent" >
<h5 class="subsubsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">11.1.22 </span> <a
- id="x1-8300011.1.22"></a>lastpage</h5>
-<!--l. 2898--><p class="noindent" >Compatible.
-<!--l. 2901--><p class="noindent" >
+ id="x1-8500011.1.22"></a>lastpage</h5>
+<!--l. 2991--><p class="noindent" >Compatible.
+<!--l. 2994--><p class="noindent" >
<h5 class="subsubsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">11.1.23 </span> <a
- id="x1-8400011.1.23"></a>linguex</h5>
+ id="x1-8600011.1.23"></a>linguex</h5>
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-58">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-60">
 \usepackage{hyperref}
  \usepackage{linguex}
</pre>
-<!--l. 2905--><p class="nopar" >
-<!--l. 2907--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 2998--><p class="nopar" >
+<!--l. 3000--><p class="noindent" >
<h5 class="subsubsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">11.1.24 </span> <a
- id="x1-8500011.1.24"></a>ltabptch</h5>
+ id="x1-8700011.1.24"></a>ltabptch</h5>
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-59">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-61">
 \usepackage{longtable}
  \usepackage{ltabptch}
  \usepackage{hyperref}
</pre>
-<!--l. 2912--><p class="nopar" >
-<!--l. 2914--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 3005--><p class="nopar" >
+<!--l. 3007--><p class="noindent" >
<h5 class="subsubsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">11.1.25 </span> <a
- id="x1-8600011.1.25"></a>mathenv</h5>
-<!--l. 2916--><p class="noindent" >Unsupported.
-<!--l. 2920--><p class="indent" > Both ‘mathenv’ and ‘hyperref’ messes around with environment ‘eqnarray’. You can load ‘mathenv’
+ id="x1-8800011.1.25"></a>mathenv</h5>
+<!--l. 3009--><p class="noindent" >Unsupported.
+<!--l. 3013--><p class="indent" > Both ‘mathenv’ and ‘hyperref’ messes around with environment ‘eqnarray’. You can load ‘mathenv’
after ‘hyperref’ to avoid an error message. But <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\label</span></span></span> will not work inside environment ‘eqnarray’
properly, for example.
-<!--l. 2927--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 3020--><p class="noindent" >
<h5 class="subsubsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">11.1.26 </span> <a
- id="x1-8700011.1.26"></a>minitoc-hyper</h5>
-<!--l. 2929--><p class="noindent" >This package is obsolete, use the up-to-date original package minitoc instead.
-<!--l. 2934--><p class="noindent" >
+ id="x1-8900011.1.26"></a>minitoc-hyper</h5>
+<!--l. 3022--><p class="noindent" >This package is obsolete, use the up-to-date original package minitoc instead.
+<!--l. 3027--><p class="noindent" >
<h5 class="subsubsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">11.1.27 </span> <a
- id="x1-8800011.1.27"></a>multind</h5>
+ id="x1-9000011.1.27"></a>multind</h5>
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-60">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-62">
 \usepackage{multind}
  \usepackage{hyperref}
</pre>
-<!--l. 2938--><p class="nopar" >
-<!--l. 2940--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 3031--><p class="nopar" >
+<!--l. 3033--><p class="noindent" >
<h5 class="subsubsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">11.1.28 </span> <a
- id="x1-8900011.1.28"></a>natbib</h5>
+ id="x1-9100011.1.28"></a>natbib</h5>
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-61">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-63">
 \usepackage{natbib}
  \usepackage{hyperref}
</pre>
-<!--l. 2944--><p class="nopar" >
-<!--l. 2946--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 3037--><p class="nopar" >
+<!--l. 3039--><p class="noindent" >
<h5 class="subsubsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">11.1.29 </span> <a
- id="x1-9000011.1.29"></a>nomencl</h5>
-<!--l. 2947--><p class="noindent" >Example for introducing links for the page numbers:
+ id="x1-9200011.1.29"></a>nomencl</h5>
+<!--l. 3040--><p class="noindent" >Example for introducing links for the page numbers:
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-62">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-64">
      \renewcommand*{\pagedeclaration}[1]{\unskip, \hyperpage{#1}}
</pre>
-<!--l. 2950--><p class="nopar" >
-<!--l. 2953--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 3043--><p class="nopar" >
+<!--l. 3046--><p class="noindent" >
<h5 class="subsubsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">11.1.30 </span> <a
- id="x1-9100011.1.30"></a>ntheorem-hyper</h5>
-<!--l. 2954--><p class="noindent" >This package is obsolete, use the up-to-date original package ntheorem instead.
-<!--l. 2958--><p class="indent" > For equations the following might work:
+ id="x1-9300011.1.30"></a>ntheorem-hyper</h5>
+<!--l. 3047--><p class="noindent" >This package is obsolete, use the up-to-date original package ntheorem instead.
+<!--l. 3051--><p class="indent" > For equations the following might work:
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-63">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-65">
      \renewcommand*{\eqdeclaration}[1]{%
        \hyperlink{equation.#1}{(Equation~#1)}%
      }
@@ -7037,25 +7244,25 @@
    But the mapping from the equation number to the anchor name
    is not available in general.
</pre>
-<!--l. 2965--><p class="nopar" >
-<!--l. 2967--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 3058--><p class="nopar" >
+<!--l. 3060--><p class="noindent" >
<h5 class="subsubsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">11.1.31 </span> <a
- id="x1-9200011.1.31"></a>parskip</h5>
+ id="x1-9400011.1.31"></a>parskip</h5>
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-64">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-66">
 \usepackage{parskip}
  \usepackage{hyperref}[2012/08/20]
</pre>
-<!--l. 2971--><p class="nopar" >
-<!--l. 2974--><p class="indent" > Both packages want to redefine <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+<!--l. 3064--><p class="nopar" >
+<!--l. 3067--><p class="indent" > Both packages want to redefine <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\@starttoc</span></span></span>.
-<!--l. 2977--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 3070--><p class="noindent" >
<h5 class="subsubsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">11.1.32 </span> <a
- id="x1-9300011.1.32"></a>prettyref</h5>
+ id="x1-9500011.1.32"></a>prettyref</h5>
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-65">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-67">
%%% example for prettyref %%%
\documentclass{article}
\usepackage{prettyref}
@@ -7075,35 +7282,35 @@
%%% example for prettyref %%%
      
</pre>
-<!--l. 2996--><p class="nopar" >
-<!--l. 2999--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 3089--><p class="nopar" >
+<!--l. 3092--><p class="noindent" >
<h5 class="subsubsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">11.1.33 </span> <a
- id="x1-9400011.1.33"></a>setspace</h5>
+ id="x1-9600011.1.33"></a>setspace</h5>
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-66">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-68">
 \usepackage{setspace}
  \usepackage{hyperref}
</pre>
-<!--l. 3003--><p class="nopar" >
-<!--l. 3005--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 3096--><p class="nopar" >
+<!--l. 3098--><p class="noindent" >
<h5 class="subsubsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">11.1.34 </span> <a
- id="x1-9500011.1.34"></a>sidecap</h5>
+ id="x1-9700011.1.34"></a>sidecap</h5>
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-67">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-69">
 Before 2002/05/24 v1.5h:
    \usepackage{nameref}
    \usepackage{hyperref}
    \usepackage{sidecap}
</pre>
-<!--l. 3011--><p class="nopar" >
-<!--l. 3013--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 3104--><p class="nopar" >
+<!--l. 3106--><p class="noindent" >
<h5 class="subsubsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">11.1.35 </span> <a
- id="x1-9600011.1.35"></a>subfigure</h5>
+ id="x1-9800011.1.35"></a>subfigure</h5>
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-68">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-70">
 1995/03/06 v2.0:
    \usepackage{subfigure}
    \usepackage{hyperref}
@@ -7122,35 +7329,35 @@
    \usepackage{subfigure}
    or vice versa?
</pre>
-<!--l. 3032--><p class="nopar" >
-<!--l. 3034--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 3125--><p class="nopar" >
+<!--l. 3127--><p class="noindent" >
<h5 class="subsubsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">11.1.36 </span> <a
- id="x1-9700011.1.36"></a>titleref</h5>
+ id="x1-9900011.1.36"></a>titleref</h5>
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-69">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-71">
 \usepackage{nameref}
  \usepackage{titleref}% without usetoc
  \usepackage{hyperref}
</pre>
-<!--l. 3039--><p class="nopar" >
-<!--l. 3041--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 3132--><p class="nopar" >
+<!--l. 3134--><p class="noindent" >
<h5 class="subsubsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">11.1.37 </span> <a
- id="x1-9800011.1.37"></a>tabularx</h5>
-<!--l. 3043--><p class="noindent" >Linked footnotes are not supported inside environment ‘tabularx’, because they uses the optional
+ id="x1-10000011.1.37"></a>tabularx</h5>
+<!--l. 3136--><p class="noindent" >Linked footnotes are not supported inside environment ‘tabularx’, because they uses the optional
argument of <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\footnotetext</span></span></span>, see section ‘Limitations’. Before version 2011/09/28 6.82i hyperref had
disabled footnotes entirely by ‘hyperfootnotes=false’.
-<!--l. 3049--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 3142--><p class="noindent" >
<h5 class="subsubsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">11.1.38 </span> <a
- id="x1-9900011.1.38"></a>titlesec</h5>
-<!--l. 3051--><p class="noindent" ><span
+ id="x1-10100011.1.38"></a>titlesec</h5>
+<!--l. 3144--><p class="noindent" ><span
class="ec-lmss-10">nameref </span>supports titlesec, but hyperref does not (unsolved is the anchor setting, missing with
unnumbered section, perhaps problems with page breaks with numbered ones).
-<!--l. 3056--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 3149--><p class="noindent" >
<h5 class="subsubsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">11.1.39 </span> <a
- id="x1-10000011.1.39"></a>ucs/utf8x.def</h5>
-<!--l. 3058--><p class="noindent" >The first time a multibyte UTF8 sequence is called, it does some calculations and stores the result in a
+ id="x1-10200011.1.39"></a>ucs/utf8x.def</h5>
+<!--l. 3151--><p class="noindent" >The first time a multibyte UTF8 sequence is called, it does some calculations and stores the result in a
macro for speeding up the next calls of that UTF8 sequence. However this makes the first call
non-expandable and will break if used in information entries or bookmarks. Package <span
class="ec-lmss-10">ucs </span>offers
@@ -7159,7 +7366,7 @@
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\PreloadUnicodePage</span></span></span> to solve this:
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-70">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-72">
    \usepackage{ucs}
    \usepackage[utf8x]{inputenc}
    \usepackage{hyperref}% or with option unicode
@@ -7166,43 +7373,43 @@
    \PrerenderUnicode{^^c3^^b6}% or \PrerenderUnicodePage{1}
    \hypersetup{pdftitle={Umlaut example: ^^c3^^b6}}
</pre>
-<!--l. 3071--><p class="nopar" > The notation with two carets avoids trouble with 8-bit bytes for the README file, you can use the
+<!--l. 3164--><p class="nopar" > The notation with two carets avoids trouble with 8-bit bytes for the README file, you can use the
characters directly.
-<!--l. 3076--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 3169--><p class="noindent" >
<h5 class="subsubsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">11.1.40 </span> <a
- id="x1-10100011.1.40"></a>varioref</h5>
-<!--l. 3077--><p class="noindent" >There are too many problems with varioref. Nobody has time to sort them out. Therefore this package is
+ id="x1-10300011.1.40"></a>varioref</h5>
+<!--l. 3170--><p class="noindent" >There are too many problems with varioref. Nobody has time to sort them out. Therefore this package is
now unsupported.
-<!--l. 3081--><p class="indent" > Perhaps you are lucky and some of the features of varioref works with the following loading
+<!--l. 3174--><p class="indent" > Perhaps you are lucky and some of the features of varioref works with the following loading
order:
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-71">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-73">
    \usepackage{nameref}
    \usepackage{varioref}
    \usepackage{hyperref}
</pre>
-<!--l. 3087--><p class="nopar" >
-<!--l. 3090--><p class="indent" > Also some babel versions can be problematic. For example, 2005/05/21 v3.8g contains a patch for
+<!--l. 3180--><p class="nopar" >
+<!--l. 3183--><p class="indent" > Also some babel versions can be problematic. For example, 2005/05/21 v3.8g contains a patch for
varioref that breaks the hyperref support for varioref.
-<!--l. 3096--><p class="indent" > Also unsupported:
+<!--l. 3189--><p class="indent" > Also unsupported:
<ul class="itemize1">
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 3098--><p class="noindent" ><span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+ <!--l. 3191--><p class="noindent" ><span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\Ref</span></span></span>, <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\Vref</span></span></span> do not uppercase the first letter.
</li>
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 3099--><p class="noindent" ><span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+ <!--l. 3192--><p class="noindent" ><span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\vpageref[]{...}</span></span></span> On the same page a previous space is not suppressed.</li></ul>
-<!--l. 3103--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 3196--><p class="noindent" >
<h5 class="subsubsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">11.1.41 </span> <a
- id="x1-10200011.1.41"></a>verse</h5>
-<!--l. 3105--><p class="noindent" >Version 2005/08/22 v2.22 contains support for hyperref.
-<!--l. 3107--><p class="indent" > For older versions see example from de.comp.text.tex (2005/08/11, slightly modified):
+ id="x1-10400011.1.41"></a>verse</h5>
+<!--l. 3198--><p class="noindent" >Version 2005/08/22 v2.22 contains support for hyperref.
+<!--l. 3200--><p class="indent" > For older versions see example from de.comp.text.tex (2005/08/11, slightly modified):
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-72">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-74">
  \documentclass{article}
  % package order does not matter
@@ -7244,23 +7451,23 @@
  \end{document}
</pre>
-<!--l. 3151--><p class="nopar" >
-<!--l. 3153--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 3244--><p class="nopar" >
+<!--l. 3246--><p class="noindent" >
<h5 class="subsubsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">11.1.42 </span> <a
- id="x1-10300011.1.42"></a>vietnam</h5>
+ id="x1-10500011.1.42"></a>vietnam</h5>
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-73">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-75">
 % pd1enc.def should be loaded before package dblaccnt:
  \usepackage[PD1,OT1]{fontenc}
  \usepackage{vietnam}
  \usepackage{hyperref}
</pre>
-<!--l. 3159--><p class="nopar" >
-<!--l. 3161--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 3252--><p class="nopar" >
+<!--l. 3254--><p class="noindent" >
<h5 class="subsubsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">11.1.43 </span> <a
- id="x1-10400011.1.43"></a>XeTeX</h5>
-<!--l. 3163--><p class="noindent" >Default for the encoding of bookmarks is <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+ id="x1-10600011.1.43"></a>XeTeX</h5>
+<!--l. 3256--><p class="noindent" >Default for the encoding of bookmarks is <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">pdfencoding=unicode</span></span></span>. That means the strings are always
treated as unicode strings. If <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">auto</span></span></span> or <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
@@ -7267,9 +7474,9 @@
class="ec-lmvtt-10">pdfdoc</span></span></span> is forced it applies only if the string restricts to the
printable ASCII set, The reason is that the <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\special</span></span></span> does not support PDFDocEncoding.
-<!--l. 3169--><p class="indent" > In older versions hyperref contained special conversion code from UTF-16BE back to UTF-8 in a
+<!--l. 3262--><p class="indent" > In older versions hyperref contained special conversion code from UTF-16BE back to UTF-8 in a
number of places for xetex to avoid the xdvipdfmx warning
-<!--l. 3173--><p class="indent" > <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+<!--l. 3266--><p class="indent" > <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">Failed</span><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10"> to</span><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10"> convert</span><span
@@ -7277,23 +7484,23 @@
class="ec-lmvtt-10"> string</span><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10"> to</span><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10"> UTF16...</span></span></span>
-<!--l. 3175--><p class="indent" > This is no longer needed with a current xdvipdfmx, so this code has been removed.
+<!--l. 3268--><p class="indent" > This is no longer needed with a current xdvipdfmx, so this code has been removed.
<span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\csname</span><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10"> HyPsd at XeTeXBigCharstrue\endcsname</span></span></span> should no longer be used.
-<!--l. 3181--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 3274--><p class="noindent" >
<h3 class="sectionHead"><span class="titlemark">12 </span> <a
- id="x1-10500012"></a>Limitations<span class="footnote-mark"><a
+ id="x1-10700012"></a>Limitations<span class="footnote-mark"><a
href="hyperref-doc7.html#fn6x0"><sup class="textsuperscript">6</sup></a></span><a
- id="x1-105001f6"></a> </h3>
+ id="x1-107001f6"></a> </h3>
<h4 class="subsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">12.1 </span> <a
- id="x1-10600012.1"></a>Wrapped/broken link support</h4>
-<!--l. 3184--><p class="noindent" >Only few drivers support automatically wrapped/broken links, e.g. pdftex, dvipdfm, hypertex. Other
+ id="x1-10800012.1"></a>Wrapped/broken link support</h4>
+<!--l. 3277--><p class="noindent" >Only few drivers support automatically wrapped/broken links, e.g. pdftex, dvipdfm, hypertex. Other
drivers lack this feature, e.g. dvips, dvipsone.
-<!--l. 3188--><p class="indent" > Workarounds:
+<!--l. 3281--><p class="indent" > Workarounds:
<ul class="itemize1">
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 3190--><p class="noindent" >For long section or caption titles in the table of contents or list of figures/tables option
+ <!--l. 3283--><p class="noindent" >For long section or caption titles in the table of contents or list of figures/tables option
<span
class="ec-lmss-10">linktocpage </span>can be used. Then the page number will be a link, and the overlong section title
is not forced into an one line link with overfull <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
@@ -7300,36 +7507,36 @@
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\hbox</span></span></span> warning.
</li>
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 3195--><p class="noindent" >“<span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+ <!--l. 3288--><p class="noindent" >“<span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\url</span></span></span>”s are caught by package <span
class="ec-lmss-10">breakurl</span>.
</li>
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 3196--><p class="noindent" >The option <span
+ <!--l. 3289--><p class="noindent" >The option <span
class="ec-lmss-10">breaklinks </span>is intended for internal use. But it can be used to force link wrapping,
e.g. when printing a document. However, when such a document is converted to PDF and
viewed with a PDF viewer, the active link area will be misplaced.
- <!--l. 3202--><p class="noindent" >Another limitation: some penalties are “optimized” by TeX, thus there are missing break
+ <!--l. 3295--><p class="noindent" >Another limitation: some penalties are “optimized” by TeX, thus there are missing break
points, especially within <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\url</span></span></span>. (See thread “hyperref.sty, breaklinks and url.sty 3.2” in
comp.text.tex 2005-09).</li></ul>
-<!--l. 3208--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 3301--><p class="noindent" >
<h4 class="subsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">12.2 </span> <a
- id="x1-10700012.2"></a>Links across pages</h4>
-<!--l. 3210--><p class="noindent" >In general they have problems:
+ id="x1-10900012.2"></a>Links across pages</h4>
+<!--l. 3303--><p class="noindent" >In general they have problems:
<ul class="itemize1">
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 3212--><p class="noindent" >Some driver doesn’t support them at all (see above).
+ <!--l. 3305--><p class="noindent" >Some driver doesn’t support them at all (see above).
</li>
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 3213--><p class="noindent" >The driver allows it, but the link result might include the footer and/or header, or an error
+ <!--l. 3306--><p class="noindent" >The driver allows it, but the link result might include the footer and/or header, or an error
message can occur sometimes.</li></ul>
-<!--l. 3218--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 3311--><p class="noindent" >
<h4 class="subsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">12.3 </span> <a
- id="x1-10800012.3"></a>Footnotes</h4>
-<!--l. 3220--><p class="noindent" >LaTeX allows the separation of the footnote mark and the footnote text (<span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+ id="x1-11000012.3"></a>Footnotes</h4>
+<!--l. 3313--><p class="noindent" >LaTeX allows the separation of the footnote mark and the footnote text (<span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\footnotemark</span></span></span>,
<span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\footnotetext</span></span></span>). This interface might be enough for visual typesetting. But the relation between
@@ -7345,14 +7552,14 @@
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\footnotemark</span></span></span> and
<span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\footnotetext</span></span></span>.
-<!--l. 3231--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 3324--><p class="noindent" >
<h3 class="sectionHead"><span class="titlemark">13 </span> <a
- id="x1-10900013"></a>Hints<span class="footnote-mark"><a
+ id="x1-11100013"></a>Hints<span class="footnote-mark"><a
href="hyperref-doc8.html#fn7x0"><sup class="textsuperscript">7</sup></a></span><a
- id="x1-109001f7"></a> </h3>
+ id="x1-111001f7"></a> </h3>
<h4 class="subsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">13.1 </span> <a
- id="x1-11000013.1"></a>Spaces in option values</h4>
-<!--l. 3235--><p class="noindent" >Unhappily LaTeX strips spaces from options if they are given in <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+ id="x1-11200013.1"></a>Spaces in option values</h4>
+<!--l. 3328--><p class="noindent" >Unhappily LaTeX strips spaces from options if they are given in <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\documentclass</span></span></span> or <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\usepackage</span></span></span> (or
<span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
@@ -7359,43 +7566,43 @@
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\RequirePackage</span></span></span>), e.g.:
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-74">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-76">
    \usepackage[pdfborder=0 0 1]{hyperref}
</pre>
-<!--l. 3239--><p class="nopar" > Package hyperref now gets
+<!--l. 3332--><p class="nopar" > Package hyperref now gets
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-75">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-77">
    pdfborder=001
</pre>
-<!--l. 3243--><p class="nopar" > and the result is an invalid PDF file. As workaround braces can be used:
+<!--l. 3336--><p class="nopar" > and the result is an invalid PDF file. As workaround braces can be used:
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-76">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-78">
    \usepackage[pdfborder={0 0 1}]{hyperref}
</pre>
-<!--l. 3248--><p class="nopar" > Some options can also be given in <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+<!--l. 3341--><p class="nopar" > Some options can also be given in <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\hypersetup</span></span></span>
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-77">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-79">
    \hypersetup{pdfborder=0 0 1}
</pre>
-<!--l. 3252--><p class="nopar" > In <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+<!--l. 3345--><p class="nopar" > In <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\hypersetup</span></span></span> the options are directly processed as key value options (see package keyval) without
space stripping in the value part.
-<!--l. 3258--><p class="indent" > Alternatively, LaTeX’s option handling system can be adapted to key value options by one of the
+<!--l. 3351--><p class="indent" > Alternatively, LaTeX’s option handling system can be adapted to key value options by one of the
packages <span
class="ec-lmss-10">kvoptions-patch </span>(from project <span
class="ec-lmss-10">kvoptions</span>) or <span
class="ec-lmss-10">xkvltxp </span>(from project <span
class="ec-lmss-10">xsetkeys</span>).
-<!--l. 3263--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 3356--><p class="noindent" >
<h4 class="subsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">13.2 </span> <a
- id="x1-11100013.2"></a>Index with makeindex</h4>
+ id="x1-11300013.2"></a>Index with makeindex</h4>
<ul class="itemize1">
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 3265--><p class="noindent" >Package hyperref adds <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+ <!--l. 3358--><p class="noindent" >Package hyperref adds <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\hyperpage</span></span></span> commands by the encap mechanism (see documentation
of Makeindex), if option hyperindex is set (default). <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\hyperpage</span></span></span> uses the page anchors that
@@ -7408,13 +7615,13 @@
class="ec-lmvtt-10">plainpages=false</span></span></span> is recommended.
</li>
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 3275--><p class="noindent" >The encap mechanism of Makeindex allows to use one command only (see documentation of
+ <!--l. 3368--><p class="noindent" >The encap mechanism of Makeindex allows to use one command only (see documentation of
Makeindex). If the user sets such a command, hyperref suppresses its <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\hyperpage</span></span></span> command. With
logical markup this situation can easily be solved:
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-78">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-80">
      \usepackage{makeidx}
      \makeindex
      \usepackage[hyperindex]{hyperref}
@@ -7422,23 +7629,23 @@
      ...
      \index{Some example|main}
</pre>
- <!--l. 3287--><p class="nopar" >
+ <!--l. 3380--><p class="nopar" >
</li>
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 3288--><p class="noindent" >Scientic Word/Scientific WorkPlace users can use package robustindex with hyperindex=false.
+ <!--l. 3381--><p class="noindent" >Scientic Word/Scientific WorkPlace users can use package robustindex with hyperindex=false.
</li>
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 3290--><p class="noindent" >Other encap characters can be set by option <span
+ <!--l. 3383--><p class="noindent" >Other encap characters can be set by option <span
class="ec-lmss-10">encap</span>. Example for use of “?”:
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-79">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-81">
      \usepackage[encap=?]{hyperref}
</pre>
- <!--l. 3294--><p class="nopar" >
+ <!--l. 3387--><p class="nopar" >
</li>
<li class="itemize">
- <!--l. 3295--><p class="noindent" >Another possibility is the insertion of <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+ <!--l. 3388--><p class="noindent" >Another possibility is the insertion of <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\hyperpage</span></span></span> by a style file for makeindex. For this case,
hyperref’s insertion will be disabled by <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">hyperindex=false</span></span></span>. <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
@@ -7446,7 +7653,7 @@
setting of hyperindex.
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-80">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-82">
%%% cut %%% hyperindex.ist %%% cut %%%
delim_0 ", \\hyperpage{"
delim_1 ", \\hyperpage{"
@@ -7458,89 +7665,89 @@
encap_suffix "}"
%%% cut %%% hyperindex.ist %%% cut %%%
</pre>
- <!--l. 3310--><p class="nopar" ></li></ul>
-<!--l. 3313--><p class="noindent" >
+ <!--l. 3403--><p class="nopar" ></li></ul>
+<!--l. 3406--><p class="noindent" >
<h4 class="subsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">13.3 </span> <a
- id="x1-11200013.3"></a>Warning <span
+ id="x1-11400013.3"></a>Warning <span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">"bookmark level for unknown <foobar> defaults to 0"</span></h4>
-<!--l. 3315--><p class="noindent" >Getting rid of it:
+<!--l. 3408--><p class="noindent" >Getting rid of it:
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-81">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-83">
\makeatletter
\providecommand*{\toclevel@<foobar>}{0}
\makeatother
</pre>
-<!--l. 3320--><p class="nopar" >
-<!--l. 3322--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 3413--><p class="nopar" >
+<!--l. 3415--><p class="noindent" >
<h4 class="subsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">13.4 </span> <a
- id="x1-11300013.4"></a>Link anchors in figures</h4>
-<!--l. 3324--><p class="noindent" >The caption command increments the counter and here is the place where hyperref set the corresponding
+ id="x1-11500013.4"></a>Link anchors in figures</h4>
+<!--l. 3417--><p class="noindent" >The caption command increments the counter and here is the place where hyperref set the corresponding
anchor. Unhappily the caption is set below the figure, so the figure is not visible if a link jumps
to a figure. In this case, try package <span
class="ec-lmss-10">hypcap </span>that implements a method to circumvent the
problem.
-<!--l. 3332--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 3425--><p class="noindent" >
<h4 class="subsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">13.5 </span> <a
- id="x1-11400013.5"></a>Additional unicode characters in bookmarks and pdf information entries:</h4>
+ id="x1-11600013.5"></a>Additional unicode characters in bookmarks and pdf information entries:</h4>
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-82">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-84">
\documentclass[pdftex]{article}
\usepackage[unicode]{hyperref}
</pre>
-<!--l. 3336--><p class="nopar" >
-<!--l. 3338--><p class="indent" > Support for additional unicode characters:
-<!--l. 3340--><p class="indent" > Example: <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+<!--l. 3429--><p class="nopar" >
+<!--l. 3431--><p class="indent" > Support for additional unicode characters:
+<!--l. 3433--><p class="indent" > Example: <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\.{a}</span></span></span> and <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\d{a}</span></span></span>
-<!--l. 3342--><p class="indent" > 1. Get a list with unicode data, eg:
-<!--l. 3344--><p class="indent" > http://www.unicode.org/Public/UNIDATA/UnicodeData.txt
-<!--l. 3346--><p class="indent" > 2. Identify the characters (<span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+<!--l. 3435--><p class="indent" > 1. Get a list with unicode data, eg:
+<!--l. 3437--><p class="indent" > http://www.unicode.org/Public/UNIDATA/UnicodeData.txt
+<!--l. 3439--><p class="indent" > 2. Identify the characters (<span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\.{a}</span></span></span>, <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\d{a}</span></span></span>):
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-83">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-85">
    0227;LATIN SMALL LETTER A WITH DOT ABOVE;...
    1EA1;LATIN SMALL LETTER A WITH DOT BELOW;...
</pre>
-<!--l. 3350--><p class="nopar" >
-<!--l. 3352--><p class="indent" > 3. Calculate the octal code:
-<!--l. 3354--><p class="indent" > The first characters of the line in the file are hex values, convert each byte and prepend them with a
+<!--l. 3443--><p class="nopar" >
+<!--l. 3445--><p class="indent" > 3. Calculate the octal code:
+<!--l. 3447--><p class="indent" > The first characters of the line in the file are hex values, convert each byte and prepend them with a
backslash. (This will go into the PDF file.)
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-84">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-86">
    0227 -> \002\047
    1EA1 -> \036\241
</pre>
-<!--l. 3361--><p class="nopar" >
-<!--l. 3363--><p class="indent" > 4. Transform into a form understood by hyperref:
-<!--l. 3365--><p class="indent" > Hyperref must know where the first byte starts, this is marked by <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+<!--l. 3454--><p class="nopar" >
+<!--l. 3456--><p class="indent" > 4. Transform into a form understood by hyperref:
+<!--l. 3458--><p class="indent" > Hyperref must know where the first byte starts, this is marked by <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">9</span></span></span> (8 and 9 cannot occur in octal
numbers):
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-85">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-87">
    \002\047 -> \9002\047
    \036\241 -> \9036\241
</pre>
-<!--l. 3372--><p class="nopar" >
-<!--l. 3374--><p class="indent" > Optional: <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+<!--l. 3465--><p class="nopar" >
+<!--l. 3467--><p class="indent" > Optional: <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">8</span></span></span> is used for abbreviations:
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-86">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-88">
    \900 = \80, \901 = \81, \902 = \82, ...
    \9002\047 -> \82\047
</pre>
-<!--l. 3380--><p class="nopar" >
-<!--l. 3382--><p class="indent" > 5. Declare the character with LaTeX:
+<!--l. 3473--><p class="nopar" >
+<!--l. 3475--><p class="indent" > 5. Declare the character with LaTeX:
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-87">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-89">
\DeclareTextCompositeCommand{\.}{PU}{a}{\82\047}
\DeclareTextCompositeCommand{\d}{PU}{a}{\9036\241}
@@ -7549,11 +7756,11 @@
\end{document}
      
</pre>
-<!--l. 3391--><p class="nopar" >
-<!--l. 3393--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 3484--><p class="nopar" >
+<!--l. 3486--><p class="noindent" >
<h4 class="subsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">13.6 </span> <a
- id="x1-11500013.6"></a>Footnotes</h4>
-<!--l. 3395--><p class="noindent" >The footnote support is rather limited. It is beyond the scope to use <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+ id="x1-11700013.6"></a>Footnotes</h4>
+<!--l. 3488--><p class="noindent" >The footnote support is rather limited. It is beyond the scope to use <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\footnotemark</span></span></span> and <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\footnotetext</span></span></span>
out of order or reusing <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
@@ -7562,7 +7769,7 @@
class="ec-lmvtt-10">hyperfootnotes=false</span></span></span> or fiddle with internal macros, nasty examples:
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-88">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-90">
\documentclass{article}
\usepackage{hyperref}
\begin{document}
@@ -7611,12 +7818,12 @@
\end{document}
</pre>
-<!--l. 3449--><p class="nopar" >
+<!--l. 3542--><p class="nopar" >
-<!--l. 3451--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 3544--><p class="noindent" >
<h4 class="subsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">13.7 </span> <a
- id="x1-11600013.7"></a>Subordinate counters</h4>
-<!--l. 3453--><p class="noindent" >Some counters do not have unique values and require the value of other counters to be unique. For
+ id="x1-11800013.7"></a>Subordinate counters</h4>
+<!--l. 3546--><p class="noindent" >Some counters do not have unique values and require the value of other counters to be unique. For
example, sections or figures might be numbered within chapters or <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\newtheorem</span></span></span> is used with an
optional counter argument. Internally LaTeX uses <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
@@ -7625,40 +7832,40 @@
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\@addtoreset</span></span></span> to catch this situation. Also <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\numberwithin</span></span></span>
of package amsmath is caught by hyperref.
-<!--l. 3463--><p class="indent" > However, if the definition of subordinate counters take place before hyperref is loaded, the old
+<!--l. 3556--><p class="indent" > However, if the definition of subordinate counters take place before hyperref is loaded, the old
meaning of <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\@addtoreset</span></span></span> is called without hyperref’s additions. Then the companion counter macro
<span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\theH<counter></span></span></span> can be redefined accordingly. Or move the definition of subordinate counters after
hyperref is loaded.
-<!--l. 3469--><p class="indent" > Example for <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
+<!--l. 3562--><p class="indent" > Example for <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span
class="ec-lmvtt-10">\newtheorem</span></span></span>, problematic case:
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-89">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-91">
    \newtheorem{corA}{CorollaryA}[section]
    \usepackage{hyperref}
</pre>
-<!--l. 3473--><p class="nopar" > Solution a)
+<!--l. 3566--><p class="nopar" > Solution a)
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-90">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-92">
    \usepackage{hyperref}
    \newtheorem{corA}{CorollaryA}[section}
</pre>
-<!--l. 3478--><p class="nopar" > Solution b)
+<!--l. 3571--><p class="nopar" > Solution b)
- <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-91">
+ <pre class="verbatim" id="verbatim-93">
    \newtheorem{corA}{CorollaryA}[section]
    \usepackage{hyperref}
    \newcommand*{\theHcorA}{\theHsection.\number\value{corA}}
</pre>
-<!--l. 3484--><p class="nopar" >
-<!--l. 3486--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 3577--><p class="nopar" >
+<!--l. 3579--><p class="noindent" >
<h3 class="sectionHead"><span class="titlemark">14 </span> <a
- id="x1-11700014"></a>History and acknowledgments</h3>
-<!--l. 3488--><p class="noindent" >The original authors of <span
+ id="x1-11900014"></a>History and acknowledgments</h3>
+<!--l. 3581--><p class="noindent" >The original authors of <span
class="ec-lmss-10">hyperbasics.tex </span>and <span
class="ec-lmss-10">hypertex.sty</span>, from which this package descends, are
Tanmoy Bhattacharya and Thorsten Ohl. Package <span
@@ -7671,12 +7878,12 @@
get the package into its first useable state. Various other people are mentioned at the point
in the source where I had to change the code in later versions because of problems they
found.
-<!--l. 3501--><p class="indent" > Tanmoy found a great many of the bugs, and (even better) often provided fixes, which has
+<!--l. 3594--><p class="indent" > Tanmoy found a great many of the bugs, and (even better) often provided fixes, which has
made the package more robust. The days spent on RevTeX are entirely due to him! The
investigations of Bill Moss into the later versions including native PDF support uncovered a
good many bugs, and his testing is appreciated. Hans Hagen provided a lot of insight into
PDF.
-<!--l. 3509--><p class="indent" > Berthold Horn provided help, encouragement and sponsorship for the <span
+<!--l. 3602--><p class="indent" > Berthold Horn provided help, encouragement and sponsorship for the <span
class="ec-lmss-10">dvipsone </span>and <span
class="ec-lmss-10">dviwindo </span>drivers.
Sergey Lesenko provided the changes needed for <span
@@ -7690,14 +7897,14 @@
<span
class="ec-lmss-10">hyperref</span>) showed me solutions for some problems. Hopefully the two packages will combine one
day.
-<!--l. 3518--><p class="indent" > The forms creation section owes a great deal to: T. V. Raman, for encouragement, support and
+<!--l. 3611--><p class="indent" > The forms creation section owes a great deal to: T. V. Raman, for encouragement, support and
ideas; Thomas Merz, whose book <span
class="ec-lmri-10">Web Publishing with Acrobat/PDF </span>provided crucial insights;
D. P. Story, whose detailed article about pdfmarks and forms solved many practical problems; and Hans
Hagen, who explained how to do it in <span
class="ec-lmss-10">pdftex</span>.
-<!--l. 3524--><p class="indent" > Steve Peter recreated the manual source in July 2003 after it had been lost.
-<!--l. 3527--><p class="indent" > Especial extra thanks to David Carlisle for the <span
+<!--l. 3617--><p class="indent" > Steve Peter recreated the manual source in July 2003 after it had been lost.
+<!--l. 3620--><p class="indent" > Especial extra thanks to David Carlisle for the <span
class="ec-lmss-10">backref </span>module, the ps2pdf and dviwindo support,
frequent general rewrites of my bad code, and for working on changes to the <span
class="ec-lmss-10">xr </span>package to suit
@@ -7706,34 +7913,34 @@
<h3 class="sectionHead"><span class="titlemark">15 </span> <a
- id="x1-11800015"></a>GNU Free Documentation License</h3>
-<!--l. 3567--><p class="noindent" >Version 1.2, November 2002
-<!--l. 3570--><p class="indent" > Copyright <span
+ id="x1-12000015"></a>GNU Free Documentation License</h3>
+<!--l. 3660--><p class="noindent" >Version 1.2, November 2002
+<!--l. 3663--><p class="indent" > Copyright <span
class="ts1-lmr10-">\xA9</span> 2000,2001,2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.<br
class="newline" />59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA<br
class="newline" />Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim copies of this license document, but changing it is
not allowed.
-<!--l. 3576--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 3669--><p class="noindent" >
<h4 class="likesubsectionHead"><a
- id="x1-11900015"></a>Preamble</h4>
-<!--l. 3578--><p class="noindent" >The purpose of this License is to make a manual, textbook, or other functional and useful document
+ id="x1-121000"></a>Preamble</h4>
+<!--l. 3671--><p class="noindent" >The purpose of this License is to make a manual, textbook, or other functional and useful document
“free” in the sense of freedom: to assure everyone the effective freedom to copy and redistribute it, with
or without modifying it, either commercially or noncommercially. Secondarily, this License preserves for
the author and publisher a way to get credit for their work, while not being considered responsible for
modifications made by others.
-<!--l. 3586--><p class="indent" > This License is a kind of “copyleft”, which means that derivative works of the document must
+<!--l. 3679--><p class="indent" > This License is a kind of “copyleft”, which means that derivative works of the document must
themselves be free in the same sense. It complements the GNU General Public License, which is a
copyleft license designed for free software.
-<!--l. 3591--><p class="indent" > We have designed this License in order to use it for manuals for free software, because free software
+<!--l. 3684--><p class="indent" > We have designed this License in order to use it for manuals for free software, because free software
needs free documentation: a free program should come with manuals providing the same
freedoms that the software does. But this License is not limited to software manuals; it can
be used for any textual work, regardless of subject matter or whether it is published as a
printed book. We recommend this License principally for works whose purpose is instruction or
reference.
-<!--l. 3600--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 3693--><p class="noindent" >
<h4 class="subsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">15.1 </span> <a
- id="x1-12000015.1"></a>Applicability and definitions</h4>
-<!--l. 3603--><p class="noindent" >This License applies to any manual or other work, in any medium, that contains a notice placed by
+ id="x1-12200015.1"></a>Applicability and definitions</h4>
+<!--l. 3696--><p class="noindent" >This License applies to any manual or other work, in any medium, that contains a notice placed by
the copyright holder saying it can be distributed under the terms of this License. Such a
notice grants a world-wide, royalty-free license, unlimited in duration, to use that work under
the conditions stated herein. The “Document”, below, refers to any such manual or work.
@@ -7740,10 +7947,10 @@
Any member of the public is a licensee, and is addressed as “you”. You accept the license
if you copy, modify or distribute the work in a way requiring permission under copyright
law.
-<!--l. 3613--><p class="indent" > A “Modified Version” of the Document means any work containing the Document or a
+<!--l. 3706--><p class="indent" > A “Modified Version” of the Document means any work containing the Document or a
portion of it, either copied verbatim, or with modifications and/or translated into another
language.
-<!--l. 3617--><p class="indent" > A “Secondary Section” is a named appendix or a front-matter section of the Document that deals
+<!--l. 3710--><p class="indent" > A “Secondary Section” is a named appendix or a front-matter section of the Document that deals
exclusively with the relationship of the publishers or authors of the Document to the Document’s overall
subject (or to related matters) and contains nothing that could fall directly within that overall subject.
(Thus, if the Document is in part a textbook of mathematics, a Secondary Section may not explain any
@@ -7750,7 +7957,7 @@
mathematics.) The relationship could be a matter of historical connection with the subject or with
related matters, or of legal, commercial, philosophical, ethical or political position regarding
them.
-<!--l. 3628--><p class="indent" > The “Invariant Sections” are certain Secondary Sections whose titles are designated, as being those of
+<!--l. 3721--><p class="indent" > The “Invariant Sections” are certain Secondary Sections whose titles are designated, as being those of
Invariant Sections, in the notice that says that the Document is released under this License. If a section
does not fit the above definition of Secondary then it is not allowed to be designated as Invariant. The
Document may contain zero Invariant Sections. If the Document does not identify any Invariant Sections
@@ -7757,11 +7964,11 @@
then there are none.
-<!--l. 3636--><p class="indent" > The “Cover Texts” are certain short passages of text that are listed, as Front-Cover Texts or
+<!--l. 3729--><p class="indent" > The “Cover Texts” are certain short passages of text that are listed, as Front-Cover Texts or
Back-Cover Texts, in the notice that says that the Document is released under this License.
A Front-Cover Text may be at most 5 words, and a Back-Cover Text may be at most 25
words.
-<!--l. 3641--><p class="indent" > A “Transparent” copy of the Document means a machine-readable copy, represented in a format
+<!--l. 3734--><p class="indent" > A “Transparent” copy of the Document means a machine-readable copy, represented in a format
whose specification is available to the general public, that is suitable for revising the document
straightforwardly with generic text editors or (for images composed of pixels) generic paint programs or
(for drawings) some widely available drawing editor, and that is suitable for input to text formatters or
@@ -7770,7 +7977,7 @@
discourage subsequent modification by readers is not Transparent. An image format is not
Transparent if used for any substantial amount of text. A copy that is not “Transparent” is called
“Opaque”.
-<!--l. 3654--><p class="indent" > Examples of suitable formats for Transparent copies include plain ASCII without markup, Texinfo
+<!--l. 3747--><p class="indent" > Examples of suitable formats for Transparent copies include plain ASCII without markup, Texinfo
input format, LaTeX input format, SGML or XML using a publicly available DTD, and
standard-conforming simple HTML, PostScript or PDF designed for human modification.
Examples of transparent image formats include PNG, XCF and JPG. Opaque formats include
@@ -7778,41 +7985,41 @@
or XML for which the DTD and/or processing tools are not generally available, and the
machine-generated HTML, PostScript or PDF produced by some word processors for output purposes
only.
-<!--l. 3665--><p class="indent" > The “Title Page” means, for a printed book, the title page itself, plus such following pages as are
+<!--l. 3758--><p class="indent" > The “Title Page” means, for a printed book, the title page itself, plus such following pages as are
needed to hold, legibly, the material this License requires to appear in the title page. For works in
formats which do not have any title page as such, “Title Page” means the text near the
most prominent appearance of the work’s title, preceding the beginning of the body of the
text.
-<!--l. 3672--><p class="indent" > A section “Entitled XYZ” means a named subunit of the Document whose title either is precisely
+<!--l. 3765--><p class="indent" > A section “Entitled XYZ” means a named subunit of the Document whose title either is precisely
XYZ or contains XYZ in parentheses following text that translates XYZ in another language.
(Here XYZ stands for a specific section name mentioned below, such as “Acknowledgements”,
“Dedications”, “Endorsements”, or “History”.) To “Preserve the Title” of such a section when you
modify the Document means that it remains a section “Entitled XYZ” according to this
definition.
-<!--l. 3680--><p class="indent" > The Document may include Warranty Disclaimers next to the notice which states that this
+<!--l. 3773--><p class="indent" > The Document may include Warranty Disclaimers next to the notice which states that this
License applies to the Document. These Warranty Disclaimers are considered to be included by
reference in this License, but only as regards disclaiming warranties: any other implication
that these Warranty Disclaimers may have is void and has no effect on the meaning of this
License.
-<!--l. 3688--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 3781--><p class="noindent" >
<h4 class="subsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">15.2 </span> <a
- id="x1-12100015.2"></a>Verbatim copying</h4>
-<!--l. 3691--><p class="noindent" >You may copy and distribute the Document in any medium, either commercially or noncommercially,
+ id="x1-12300015.2"></a>Verbatim copying</h4>
+<!--l. 3784--><p class="noindent" >You may copy and distribute the Document in any medium, either commercially or noncommercially,
provided that this License, the copyright notices, and the license notice saying this License applies to the
Document are reproduced in all copies, and that you add no other conditions whatsoever to those of this
License. You may not use technical measures to obstruct or control the reading or further copying of the
-copies you make or distribute. However, you may accept compensation in exchange for copies.
-If you distribute a large enough number of copies you must also follow the conditions in
-section <a
-href="#x1-12200015.3">15.3<!--tex4ht:ref: copying --></a>.
-<!--l. 3702--><p class="indent" > You may also lend copies, under the same conditions stated above, and you may publicly display
+copies you make or distribute. However, you may accept compensation in exchange for copies. If you
+distribute a large enough number of copies you must also follow the conditions in section <a
+href="#x1-12400015.3">15.3<!--tex4ht:ref: copying --></a>
+.
+<!--l. 3795--><p class="indent" > You may also lend copies, under the same conditions stated above, and you may publicly display
copies.
-<!--l. 3706--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 3799--><p class="noindent" >
<h4 class="subsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">15.3 </span> <a
- id="x1-12200015.3"></a>Copying in quantity</h4>
-<!--l. 3709--><p class="noindent" >If you publish printed copies (or copies in media that commonly have printed covers) of the Document,
+ id="x1-12400015.3"></a>Copying in quantity</h4>
+<!--l. 3802--><p class="noindent" >If you publish printed copies (or copies in media that commonly have printed covers) of the Document,
numbering more than 100, and the Document’s license notice requires Cover Texts, you must enclose the
copies in covers that carry, clearly and legibly, all these Cover Texts: Front-Cover Texts on the front
cover, and Back-Cover Texts on the back cover. Both covers must also clearly and legibly
@@ -7821,10 +8028,10 @@
addition. Copying with changes limited to the covers, as long as they preserve the title of
the Document and satisfy these conditions, can be treated as verbatim copying in other
respects.
-<!--l. 3722--><p class="indent" > If the required texts for either cover are too voluminous to fit legibly, you should put the first ones
+<!--l. 3815--><p class="indent" > If the required texts for either cover are too voluminous to fit legibly, you should put the first ones
listed (as many as fit reasonably) on the actual cover, and continue the rest onto adjacent
pages.
-<!--l. 3727--><p class="indent" > If you publish or distribute Opaque copies of the Document numbering more than 100, you must
+<!--l. 3820--><p class="indent" > If you publish or distribute Opaque copies of the Document numbering more than 100, you must
either include a machine-readable Transparent copy along with each Opaque copy, or state in or with
each Opaque copy a computer-network location from which the general network-using public has access
to download using public-standard network protocols a complete Transparent copy of the Document, free
@@ -7833,31 +8040,31 @@
remain thus accessible at the stated location until at least one year after the last time you
distribute an Opaque copy (directly or through your agents or retailers) of that edition to the
public.
-<!--l. 3740--><p class="indent" > It is requested, but not required, that you contact the authors of the Document well before
+<!--l. 3833--><p class="indent" > It is requested, but not required, that you contact the authors of the Document well before
redistributing any large number of copies, to give them a chance to provide you with an updated version
of the Document.
-<!--l. 3745--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 3838--><p class="noindent" >
<h4 class="subsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">15.4 </span> <a
- id="x1-12300015.4"></a>Modifications</h4>
-<!--l. 3748--><p class="noindent" >You may copy and distribute a Modified Version of the Document under the conditions of sections <a
-href="#x1-12100015.2">15.2<!--tex4ht:ref: verbatim --></a>
+ id="x1-12500015.4"></a>Modifications</h4>
+<!--l. 3841--><p class="noindent" >You may copy and distribute a Modified Version of the Document under the conditions of sections <a
+href="#x1-12300015.2">15.2<!--tex4ht:ref: verbatim --></a>
and <a
-href="#x1-12200015.3">15.3<!--tex4ht:ref: copying --></a> above, provided that you release the Modified Version under precisely this License, with the
+href="#x1-12400015.3">15.3<!--tex4ht:ref: copying --></a> above, provided that you release the Modified Version under precisely this License, with the
Modified Version filling the role of the Document, thus licensing distribution and modification of the
Modified Version to whoever possesses a copy of it. In addition, you must do these things in the Modified
Version:
-<!--l. 3757--><p class="indent" >
+<!--l. 3850--><p class="indent" >
<ol class="enumerate1" >
<li
- class="enumerate" id="x1-123002x1">
- <!--l. 3758--><p class="noindent" >Use in the Title Page (and on the covers, if any) a title distinct from that of the Document,
+ class="enumerate" id="x1-125002x1">
+ <!--l. 3851--><p class="noindent" >Use in the Title Page (and on the covers, if any) a title distinct from that of the Document,
and from those of previous versions (which should, if there were any, be listed in the History
section of the Document). You may use the same title as a previous version if the original
publisher of that version gives permission.
</li>
<li
- class="enumerate" id="x1-123004x2">
- <!--l. 3763--><p class="noindent" >List on the Title Page, as authors, one or more persons or entities responsible for authorship
+ class="enumerate" id="x1-125004x2">
+ <!--l. 3856--><p class="noindent" >List on the Title Page, as authors, one or more persons or entities responsible for authorship
of the modifications in the Modified Version, together with at least five of the principal
authors of the Document (all of its principal authors, if it has fewer than five), unless they
release you from this requirement.
@@ -7864,36 +8071,36 @@
</li>
<li
- class="enumerate" id="x1-123006x3">
- <!--l. 3768--><p class="noindent" >State on the Title page the name of the publisher of the Modified Version, as the publisher.
+ class="enumerate" id="x1-125006x3">
+ <!--l. 3861--><p class="noindent" >State on the Title page the name of the publisher of the Modified Version, as the publisher.
</li>
<li
- class="enumerate" id="x1-123008x4">
- <!--l. 3770--><p class="noindent" >Preserve all the copyright notices of the Document.
+ class="enumerate" id="x1-125008x4">
+ <!--l. 3863--><p class="noindent" >Preserve all the copyright notices of the Document.
</li>
<li
- class="enumerate" id="x1-123010x5">
- <!--l. 3771--><p class="noindent" >Add an appropriate copyright notice for your modifications adjacent to the other copyright
+ class="enumerate" id="x1-125010x5">
+ <!--l. 3864--><p class="noindent" >Add an appropriate copyright notice for your modifications adjacent to the other copyright
notices.
</li>
<li
- class="enumerate" id="x1-123012x6">
- <!--l. 3773--><p class="noindent" >Include, immediately after the copyright notices, a license notice giving the public permission
+ class="enumerate" id="x1-125012x6">
+ <!--l. 3866--><p class="noindent" >Include, immediately after the copyright notices, a license notice giving the public permission
to use the Modified Version under the terms of this License, in the form shown in the
Addendum below.
</li>
<li
- class="enumerate" id="x1-123014x7">
- <!--l. 3776--><p class="noindent" >Preserve in that license notice the full lists of Invariant Sections and required Cover Texts
+ class="enumerate" id="x1-125014x7">
+ <!--l. 3869--><p class="noindent" >Preserve in that license notice the full lists of Invariant Sections and required Cover Texts
given in the Document’s license notice.
</li>
<li
- class="enumerate" id="x1-123016x8">
- <!--l. 3778--><p class="noindent" >Include an unaltered copy of this License.
+ class="enumerate" id="x1-125016x8">
+ <!--l. 3871--><p class="noindent" >Include an unaltered copy of this License.
</li>
<li
- class="enumerate" id="x1-123018x9">
- <!--l. 3779--><p class="noindent" >Preserve the section Entitled “History”, Preserve its Title, and add to it an item stating at
+ class="enumerate" id="x1-125018x9">
+ <!--l. 3872--><p class="noindent" >Preserve the section Entitled “History”, Preserve its Title, and add to it an item stating at
least the title, year, new authors, and publisher of the Modified Version as given on the Title
Page. If there is no section Entitled “History” in the Document, create one stating the title,
year, authors, and publisher of the Document as given on its Title Page, then add an item
@@ -7900,8 +8107,8 @@
describing the Modified Version as stated in the previous sentence.
</li>
<li
- class="enumerate" id="x1-123020x10">
- <!--l. 3786--><p class="noindent" >Preserve the network location, if any, given in the Document for public access to a
+ class="enumerate" id="x1-125020x10">
+ <!--l. 3879--><p class="noindent" >Preserve the network location, if any, given in the Document for public access to a
Transparent copy of the Document, and likewise the network locations given in the Document
for previous versions it was based on. These may be placed in the “History” section. You
may omit a network location for a work that was published at least four years before the
@@ -7910,39 +8117,39 @@
</li>
<li
- class="enumerate" id="x1-123022x11">
- <!--l. 3793--><p class="noindent" >For any section Entitled “Acknowledgements” or “Dedications”, Preserve the Title of the
+ class="enumerate" id="x1-125022x11">
+ <!--l. 3886--><p class="noindent" >For any section Entitled “Acknowledgements” or “Dedications”, Preserve the Title of the
section, and preserve in the section all the substance and tone of each of the contributor
acknowledgements and/or dedications given therein.
</li>
<li
- class="enumerate" id="x1-123024x12">
- <!--l. 3797--><p class="noindent" >Preserve all the Invariant Sections of the Document, unaltered in their text and in their
+ class="enumerate" id="x1-125024x12">
+ <!--l. 3890--><p class="noindent" >Preserve all the Invariant Sections of the Document, unaltered in their text and in their
titles. Section numbers or the equivalent are not considered part of the section titles.
</li>
<li
- class="enumerate" id="x1-123026x13">
- <!--l. 3800--><p class="noindent" >Delete any section Entitled “Endorsements”. Such a section may not be included in the
+ class="enumerate" id="x1-125026x13">
+ <!--l. 3893--><p class="noindent" >Delete any section Entitled “Endorsements”. Such a section may not be included in the
Modified Version.
</li>
<li
- class="enumerate" id="x1-123028x14">
- <!--l. 3802--><p class="noindent" >Do not retitle any existing section to be Entitled “Endorsements” or to conflict in title with
+ class="enumerate" id="x1-125028x14">
+ <!--l. 3895--><p class="noindent" >Do not retitle any existing section to be Entitled “Endorsements” or to conflict in title with
any Invariant Section.
</li>
<li
- class="enumerate" id="x1-123030x15">
- <!--l. 3804--><p class="noindent" >Preserve any Warranty Disclaimers.
+ class="enumerate" id="x1-125030x15">
+ <!--l. 3897--><p class="noindent" >Preserve any Warranty Disclaimers.
</li></ol>
-<!--l. 3808--><p class="indent" > If the Modified Version includes new front-matter sections or appendices that qualify as Secondary
+<!--l. 3901--><p class="indent" > If the Modified Version includes new front-matter sections or appendices that qualify as Secondary
Sections and contain no material copied from the Document, you may at your option designate some or
all of these sections as invariant. To do this, add their titles to the list of Invariant Sections in
the Modified Version’s license notice. These titles must be distinct from any other section
titles.
-<!--l. 3815--><p class="indent" > You may add a section Entitled “Endorsements”, provided it contains nothing but endorsements of
+<!--l. 3908--><p class="indent" > You may add a section Entitled “Endorsements”, provided it contains nothing but endorsements of
your Modified Version by various parties–for example, statements of peer review or that the text has
been approved by an organization as the authoritative definition of a standard.
-<!--l. 3821--><p class="indent" > You may add a passage of up to five words as a Front-Cover Text, and a passage of up to 25 words as
+<!--l. 3914--><p class="indent" > You may add a passage of up to five words as a Front-Cover Text, and a passage of up to 25 words as
a Back-Cover Text, to the end of the list of Cover Texts in the Modified Version. Only one passage of
Front-Cover Text and one of Back-Cover Text may be added by (or through arrangements made by) any
one entity. If the Document already includes a cover text for the same cover, previously added by you or
@@ -7949,60 +8156,60 @@
by arrangement made by the same entity you are acting on behalf of, you may not add another; but you
may replace the old one, on explicit permission from the previous publisher that added the old
one.
-<!--l. 3831--><p class="indent" > The author(s) and publisher(s) of the Document do not by this License give permission to use their
+<!--l. 3924--><p class="indent" > The author(s) and publisher(s) of the Document do not by this License give permission to use their
names for publicity for or to assert or imply endorsement of any Modified Version.
-<!--l. 3836--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 3929--><p class="noindent" >
<h4 class="subsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">15.5 </span> <a
- id="x1-12400015.5"></a>Combining documents</h4>
-<!--l. 3839--><p class="noindent" >You may combine the Document with other documents released under this License, under the terms
+ id="x1-12600015.5"></a>Combining documents</h4>
+<!--l. 3932--><p class="noindent" >You may combine the Document with other documents released under this License, under the terms
defined in section <a
-href="#x1-12300015.4">15.4<!--tex4ht:ref: modifications --></a> above for modified versions, provided that you include in the combination all of
+href="#x1-12500015.4">15.4<!--tex4ht:ref: modifications --></a> above for modified versions, provided that you include in the combination all of
the Invariant Sections of all of the original documents, unmodified, and list them all as Invariant
Sections of your combined work in its license notice, and that you preserve all their Warranty
Disclaimers.
-<!--l. 3847--><p class="indent" > The combined work need only contain one copy of this License, and multiple identical Invariant
+<!--l. 3940--><p class="indent" > The combined work need only contain one copy of this License, and multiple identical Invariant
Sections may be replaced with a single copy. If there are multiple Invariant Sections with the same name
but different contents, make the title of each such section unique by adding at the end of it, in
parentheses, the name of the original author or publisher of that section if known, or else a unique
number. Make the same adjustment to the section titles in the list of Invariant Sections in the license
notice of the combined work.
-<!--l. 3856--><p class="indent" > In the combination, you must combine any sections Entitled “History” in the various original
+<!--l. 3949--><p class="indent" > In the combination, you must combine any sections Entitled “History” in the various original
documents, forming one section Entitled “History”; likewise combine any sections Entitled
“Acknowledgements”, and any sections Entitled “Dedications”. You must delete all sections Entitled
“Endorsements”.
-<!--l. 3863--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 3956--><p class="noindent" >
<h4 class="subsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">15.6 </span> <a
- id="x1-12500015.6"></a>Collections of documents</h4>
-<!--l. 3866--><p class="noindent" >You may make a collection consisting of the Document and other documents released under this License,
+ id="x1-12700015.6"></a>Collections of documents</h4>
+<!--l. 3959--><p class="noindent" >You may make a collection consisting of the Document and other documents released under this License,
and replace the individual copies of this License in the various documents with a single copy that is
included in the collection, provided that you follow the rules of this License for verbatim copying of each
of the documents in all other respects.
-<!--l. 3872--><p class="indent" > You may extract a single document from such a collection, and distribute it individually under this
+<!--l. 3965--><p class="indent" > You may extract a single document from such a collection, and distribute it individually under this
License, provided you insert a copy of this License into the extracted document, and follow this License
in all other respects regarding verbatim copying of that document.
-<!--l. 3878--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 3971--><p class="noindent" >
<h4 class="subsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">15.7 </span> <a
- id="x1-12600015.7"></a>Aggregation with independent works</h4>
-<!--l. 3881--><p class="noindent" >A compilation of the Document or its derivatives with other separate and independent documents or
+ id="x1-12800015.7"></a>Aggregation with independent works</h4>
+<!--l. 3974--><p class="noindent" >A compilation of the Document or its derivatives with other separate and independent documents or
works, in or on a volume of a storage or distribution medium, is called an “aggregate” if the copyright
resulting from the compilation is not used to limit the legal rights of the compilation’s users beyond what
the individual works permit. When the Document is included in an aggregate, this License does not
apply to the other works in the aggregate which are not themselves derivative works of the
Document.
-<!--l. 3890--><p class="indent" > If the Cover Text requirement of section <a
-href="#x1-12200015.3">15.3<!--tex4ht:ref: copying --></a> is applicable to these copies of the Document, then if
+<!--l. 3983--><p class="indent" > If the Cover Text requirement of section <a
+href="#x1-12400015.3">15.3<!--tex4ht:ref: copying --></a> is applicable to these copies of the Document, then if
the Document is less than one half of the entire aggregate, the Document’s Cover Texts may be placed
on covers that bracket the Document within the aggregate, or the electronic equivalent of covers if the
Document is in electronic form. Otherwise they must appear on printed covers that bracket the whole
aggregate.
-<!--l. 3899--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 3992--><p class="noindent" >
<h4 class="subsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">15.8 </span> <a
- id="x1-12700015.8"></a>Translation</h4>
-<!--l. 3902--><p class="noindent" >Translation is considered a kind of modification, so you may distribute translations of the Document
+ id="x1-12900015.8"></a>Translation</h4>
+<!--l. 3995--><p class="noindent" >Translation is considered a kind of modification, so you may distribute translations of the Document
under the terms of section <a
-href="#x1-12300015.4">15.4<!--tex4ht:ref: modifications --></a>. Replacing Invariant Sections with translations requires special
+href="#x1-12500015.4">15.4<!--tex4ht:ref: modifications --></a> . Replacing Invariant Sections with translations requires special
permission from their copyright holders, but you may include translations of some or all Invariant
Sections in addition to the original versions of these Invariant Sections. You may include a translation of
@@ -8011,53 +8218,53 @@
versions of those notices and disclaimers. In case of a disagreement between the translation
and the original version of this License or a notice or disclaimer, the original version will
prevail.
-<!--l. 3916--><p class="indent" > If a section in the Document is Entitled “Acknowledgements”, “Dedications”, or “History”, the
+<!--l. 4009--><p class="indent" > If a section in the Document is Entitled “Acknowledgements”, “Dedications”, or “History”, the
requirement (section <a
-href="#x1-12300015.4">15.4<!--tex4ht:ref: modifications --></a>) to Preserve its Title (section <a
-href="#x1-12000015.1">15.1<!--tex4ht:ref: applicability --></a>) will typically require changing the actual
+href="#x1-12500015.4">15.4<!--tex4ht:ref: modifications --></a> ) to Preserve its Title (section <a
+href="#x1-12200015.1">15.1<!--tex4ht:ref: applicability --></a> ) will typically require changing the actual
title.
-<!--l. 3923--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 4016--><p class="noindent" >
<h4 class="subsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">15.9 </span> <a
- id="x1-12800015.9"></a>Termination</h4>
-<!--l. 3926--><p class="noindent" >You may not copy, modify, sublicense, or distribute the Document except as expressly provided for under
+ id="x1-13000015.9"></a>Termination</h4>
+<!--l. 4019--><p class="noindent" >You may not copy, modify, sublicense, or distribute the Document except as expressly provided for under
this License. Any other attempt to copy, modify, sublicense or distribute the Document is void, and will
automatically terminate your rights under this License. However, parties who have received copies, or
rights, from you under this License will not have their licenses terminated so long as such parties remain
in full compliance.
-<!--l. 3935--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 4028--><p class="noindent" >
<h4 class="subsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">15.10 </span> <a
- id="x1-12900015.10"></a>Future revisions of this license</h4>
-<!--l. 3938--><p class="noindent" >The Free Software Foundation may publish new, revised versions of the GNU Free Documentation
+ id="x1-13100015.10"></a>Future revisions of this license</h4>
+<!--l. 4031--><p class="noindent" >The Free Software Foundation may publish new, revised versions of the GNU Free Documentation
License from time to time. Such new versions will be similar in spirit to the present version, but may
differ in detail to address new problems or concerns. See http://www.gnu.org/copyleft/.
-<!--l. 3944--><p class="indent" > Each version of the License is given a distinguishing version number. If the Document specifies that a
+<!--l. 4037--><p class="indent" > Each version of the License is given a distinguishing version number. If the Document specifies that a
particular numbered version of this License “or any later version” applies to it, you have the option of
following the terms and conditions either of that specified version or of any later version that has been
published (not as a draft) by the Free Software Foundation. If the Document does not specify a version
number of this License, you may choose any version ever published (not as a draft) by the Free Software
Foundation.
-<!--l. 3954--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 4047--><p class="noindent" >
<h4 class="likesubsectionHead"><a
- id="x1-13000015.10"></a>Addendum: how to use this license for your documents</h4>
-<!--l. 3956--><p class="noindent" >To use this License in a document you have written, include a copy of the License in the document and
+ id="x1-132000"></a>Addendum: how to use this license for your documents</h4>
+<!--l. 4049--><p class="noindent" >To use this License in a document you have written, include a copy of the License in the document and
put the following copyright and license notices just after the title page:
-<!--l. 3960--><p class="indent" >
+<!--l. 4053--><p class="indent" >
<blockquote class="quote">
- <!--l. 3961--><p class="noindent" >Copyright <span
+ <!--l. 4054--><p class="noindent" >Copyright <span
class="ts1-lmr10-">\xA9</span> YEAR YOUR NAME. Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or
modify this document under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License,
Version 1.2 or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the
license is included in the section entitled “GNU Free Documentation License”.</blockquote>
-<!--l. 3970--><p class="indent" > If you have Invariant Sections, Front-Cover Texts and Back-Cover Texts, replace the “with...Texts.”
+<!--l. 4063--><p class="indent" > If you have Invariant Sections, Front-Cover Texts and Back-Cover Texts, replace the “with...Texts.”
line with this:
-<!--l. 3973--><p class="indent" > with the Invariant Sections being LIST THEIR TITLES, with the Front-Cover Texts being LIST, and
+<!--l. 4066--><p class="indent" > with the Invariant Sections being LIST THEIR TITLES, with the Front-Cover Texts being LIST, and
with the Back-Cover Texts being LIST.
-<!--l. 3976--><p class="indent" > If you have Invariant Sections without Cover Texts, or some other combination of the three, merge
+<!--l. 4069--><p class="indent" > If you have Invariant Sections without Cover Texts, or some other combination of the three, merge
those two alternatives to suit the situation.
-<!--l. 3980--><p class="indent" > If your document contains nontrivial examples of program code, we recommend releasing these
+<!--l. 4073--><p class="indent" > If your document contains nontrivial examples of program code, we recommend releasing these
examples in parallel under your choice of free software license, such as the GNU General Public License,
to permit their use in free software.
Modified: trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/hyperref/hyperref-doc.pdf
===================================================================
(Binary files differ)
Added: trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/hyperref/hyperref-doc.tex
===================================================================
--- trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/hyperref/hyperref-doc.tex (rev 0)
+++ trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/hyperref/hyperref-doc.tex 2022-05-14 20:32:17 UTC (rev 63298)
@@ -0,0 +1,4080 @@
+% This is the manual for the LaTeX hyperref package.
+%
+% Copyright (C) 1998-2003 Sebastian Rahtz.
+% Copyright (C) 2003 Steve Peter and Karl Berry
+% Copyright (C) 2006-2012 Heiko Oberdiek.
+% Copyright (C) 2017-2019 David Carlisle Ulrike Fischer
+% Copyright (C) 2019-2020 The LaTeX3 Project
+%
+% Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
+% under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
+% any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
+% Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no Back-Cover
+% Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled
+% ``GNU Free Documentation License.''
+%
+
+\def\mydate{January 2020}
+
+\RequirePackage{iftex}
+
+\documentclass{article}
+
+
+\usepackage{pifont}
+\usepackage{calc}
+
+\usepackage{hologo}
+
+\newcommand*{\cs}[1]{%
+ \texttt{\textbackslash #1}%
+}
+\newcommand*{\xpackage}[1]{\textsf{#1}}
+\newcommand*{\xoption}[1]{\textsf{#1}}
+
+% from doc.sty
+\makeatletter
+\ifx\l at nohyphenation\@undefined
+\newlanguage\l at nohyphenation
+\fi
+\ifx\l at nohyphenation\@undefined
+ \newlanguage\l at nohyphenation
+\fi
+\DeclareRobustCommand\meta[1]{%
+ \ensuremath\langle
+ \ifmmode \expandafter \nfss at text \fi
+ {%
+ \meta at font@select
+ \edef\meta at hyphen@restore
+ {\hyphenchar\the\font\the\hyphenchar\font}%
+ \hyphenchar\font\m at ne
+ \language\l at nohyphenation
+ #1\/%
+ \meta at hyphen@restore
+ }%
+ \ensuremath\rangle
+}
+\def\meta at font@select{\ttfamily\itshape}
+\makeatother
+
+% Page layout.
+\advance\textwidth by 1.1in
+\advance\oddsidemargin by -.55in
+\advance\evensidemargin by -.55in
+%
+\advance\textheight by 1in
+\advance\topmargin by -.5in
+\advance\footskip by -.5in
+%
+\pagestyle{headings}
+%
+% Avoid some overfull boxes.
+\emergencystretch=.1\hsize
+\hbadness = 3000
+
+% these are from lshort.sty, but lshort.sty pulls in so many other
+% packages it seems cleaner to just include them here.
+%
+\newcommand{\bs}{\symbol{'134}}%Print backslash
+\newcommand{\ci}[1]{\texttt{\bs#1}}
+
+\makeatletter
+\@ifpackageloaded{tex4ht}{%
+ % separate definition for HTML case to avoid
+ % nasty borders with double horizontal lines with
+ % large gaps.
+ \newsavebox{\cmdsyntaxbox}%
+ \newenvironment{cmdsyntax}{%
+ \par
+ % \small
+ \addvspace{3.2ex plus 0.8ex minus 0.2ex}%
+ \vskip -\parskip
+ \noindent
+ \begin{lrbox}{\cmdsyntaxbox}%
+ \begin{tabular}{l}%
+ \rule{0pt}{1em}%
+ \ignorespaces
+ }{%
+ \end{tabular}%
+ \end{lrbox}%
+ \fbox{\usebox{\cmdsyntaxbox}}%
+ \par
+ \nopagebreak
+ \addvspace{3.2ex plus 0.8ex minus 0.2ex}%
+ \vskip -\parskip
+ }%
+}{%
+ \newenvironment{cmdsyntax}{%
+ \par
+ \small
+ \addvspace{3.2ex plus 0.8ex minus 0.2ex}%
+ \vskip -\parskip
+ \noindent
+ \begin{tabular}{|l|}%
+ \hline
+ \rule{0pt}{1em}%
+ \ignorespaces
+ }{%
+ \\%
+ \hline
+ \end{tabular}%
+ \par
+ \nopagebreak
+ \addvspace{3.2ex plus 0.8ex minus 0.2ex}%
+ \vskip -\parskip
+ }%
+}
+\makeatother
+
+\usepackage{array,longtable}
+\ifTUTeX%
+ \usepackage{fontspec}%
+ \renewcommand*{\ttdefault}{lmvtt}%
+\else % not \XeTeX* nor \LuaTeX*
+ \usepackage[T1]{fontenc}%
+ \usepackage{lmodern}%
+ \renewcommand*{\ttdefault}{lmvtt}%
+\fi
+
+\newcommand*{\Quote}[1]{\textquotedblleft#1\textquotedblright}
+
+\ifpdf
+ \usepackage[%
+% pdftex,% might be luatex, just allow automatic default
+ colorlinks,%
+ hyperindex,%
+ plainpages=false,%
+ bookmarksopen,%
+ bookmarksnumbered,
+ pdfusetitle,%
+ ]{hyperref}
+ %%?? \def\pdfBorderAttrs{/Border [0 0 0] } % No border arround Links
+\else
+ \usepackage{hyperref}
+\fi
+
+\makeatletter
+\@ifpackageloaded{tex4ht}{%
+\author{Sebastian Rahtz (deceased)\and
+ Heiko Oberdiek (inactive)\and
+ The \LaTeX3 Project (\url{https://github.com/latex3/hyperref/issues})}
+}{%
+ \usepackage{bmhydoc}%
+\author{Sebastian Rahtz\thanks{deceased}\and
+ Heiko Oberdiek\thanks{inactive}\and
+ The \LaTeX3 Project\thanks{\url{https://github.com/latex3/hyperref/issues}}}
+}
+\makeatother
+\title{Hypertext marks in \hologo{LaTeX}: a manual for \xpackage{hyperref}}
+\date{2022-05-13 v7.00o}
+
+\begin{document}
+
+% comes out too close to the toc, and we know it's page one anyway.
+\thispagestyle{empty}
+\maketitle
+\tableofcontents
+\setcounter{tocdepth}{2}% for bookmark levels
+
+\section{Preface---February 2022}
+As can be already seen in the following introduction, \xpackage{hyperref}
+has a long history and has seen many changes over time. The introduction
+mentions workflows, drivers and problems which are no longer relevant,
+or only in edge cases. The documentation reflects this varied history: changes
+and extensions and explanations were and are spread over various papers and sources and
+only incorporated later and so are not always in a coherent order and in sync which each other.
+
+
+This history is continuing: If you are using the new \hologo{LaTeX} PDF management
+which is currently distributed as testphase package \xpackage{pdfmanagement-testphase}
+then \xpackage{hyperref} will for the PDF output use a new generic driver which
+contains a number of changes and new features. The documentation of this driver
+\texttt{hyperref-generic.pdf}
+is currently a part of the \xpackage{pdfmanagement-testphase} documentation.
+One important change of the new driver is
+that it removed the old \xpackage{hyperref} code for book marks and uses
+the \xpackage{bookmark} package instead. So to learn
+about options to extend the bookmarks you should consult the \xpackage{bookmark} documentation
+too.
+
+\subsection{Restoring removed patches}
+
+\xpackage{hyperref} has over time patched quite a number of packages to resolve clashes and incompabilities.
+Quite a number are either no longer needed or should be done by the original packages.
+Those patches are now slowly removed from \xpackage{hyperref}. It should normally not lead to problems, but
+in case that the patches should be restored they can be loaded through the package \xpackage{hyperref-patches} which
+is a part of this bundle.
+
+
+
+\section{Introduction}
+
+The package derives from, and builds on, the work of the Hyper\hologo{TeX}
+project, described at \nolinkurl{http://xxx.lanl.gov/hypertex/}\footnote{Now: \url{https://ctan.org/tex-archive/support/hypertex/hypertex}}. It extends
+the functionality of all the \hologo{LaTeX} cross-referencing commands
+(including the table of contents, bibliographies etc) to produce
+\cs{special} commands which a driver can turn into hypertext links;
+it also provides new commands to allow the user to write \emph{ad hoc}
+hypertext links, including those to external documents and URLs.
+
+The package is currently maintained at \url{https://github.com/latex3/hyperref/} and issues should
+be reported there.
+
+This manual provides a brief overview of the \xpackage{hyperref}
+package. For more details, you should read the additional documentation
+distributed with the package, as well as the complete documentation by
+processing \texttt{hyperref.dtx}. You should also read the chapter on
+\xpackage{hyperref} in \textit{The \hologo{LaTeX} Web Companion}, where you will
+find additional examples.
+
+The Hyper\hologo{TeX} specification\footnote{This is borrowed from an article
+by Arthur Smith.} says that conformant viewers/translators must
+recognize the following set of \cs{special} constructs:
+
+\begin{description}
+\item[href:] \verb|html:<a href = "href_string">|
+\item[name:] \verb|html:<a name = "name_string">|
+\item[end:] \verb|html:</a>|
+\item[image:] \verb|html:<img src = "href_string">|
+\item[base\_name:] \verb|html:<base href = "href_string">|
+\end{description}
+
+The \emph{href}, \emph{name} and \emph{end} commands are used to do the
+basic hypertext operations of establishing links between sections of
+documents. The \emph{image} command is intended (as with current HTML
+viewers) to place an image of arbitrary graphical format on the page in
+the current location. The \emph{base\_name} command is be used to
+communicate to the DVI viewer the full (URL) location of the current
+document so that files specified by relative URLs may be retrieved
+correctly.
+
+The \emph{href} and \emph{name} commands must be paired with an
+\emph{end} command later in the \TeX\ file---the \TeX\ commands between
+the two ends of a pair form an \emph{anchor} in the document. In the
+case of an \emph{href} command, the \emph{anchor} is to be highlighted
+in the \emph{DVI viewer}, and when clicked on will cause the scene to
+shift to the destination specified by \emph{href\_string}. The
+\emph{anchor} associated with a name command represents a possible
+location to which other hypertext links may refer, either as local
+references (of the form \verb|href="#name_string"| with the
+\emph{name\_string} identical to the one in the name command) or as part
+of a URL (of the form \emph{URL\#name\_string}). Here
+\emph{href\_string} is a valid URL or local identifier, while
+\emph{name\_string} could be any string at all: the only caveat is that
+`$\verb|"|$' characters should be escaped with a backslash
+($\backslash$), and if it looks like a URL name it may cause problems.
+
+However, the drivers intended to produce \emph{only} PDF use literal
+PostScript or PDF \verb|\special| commands. The commands are defined in
+configuration files for different drivers, selected by package options;
+at present, the following drivers are supported:
+
+\begin{description}
+\item[hypertex] DVI processors conforming to the Hyper\TeX\ guidelines (i.e.\ \textsf{xdvi}, \textsf{dvips} (with
+the \textsf{-z} option), \textsf{\hologo{OzTeX}}, and \textsf{Textures})
+\item[dvips] produces \verb|\special| commands tailored for \textsf{dvips}
+\item[dvipsone] produces \verb|\special| commands tailored for \textsf{dvipsone}
+\item[ps2pdf] a special case of output suitable for processing by earlier versions of Ghost\-script's
+PDF writer; this is basically the same as that for \textsf{dvips}, but a few variations remained before version 5.21
+\item[tex4ht] produces \verb|\special| commands for use with \textsf{\TeX4ht}
+\item[pdftex] pdf\TeX, \hologo{HanTheThanh}'s \TeX{} variant that writes PDF directly
+\item[luatex] lua\TeX, Unicode \TeX{} variant that writes PDF directly
+\item[dvipdfm] produces \verb|\special| commands for Mark Wicks' DVI to PDF driver \textsf{dvipdfm}
+\item[dvipdfmx] produces \verb|\special| commands for driver
+ \textsf{dvipdfmx}, a successor of \textsf{dvipdfm}
+\item[dviwindo] produces \verb|\special| commands that Y\&Y's Windows previewer interprets as hypertext jumps within the previewer
+\item[vtex] produces \verb|\special| commands that MicroPress' HTML and
+ PDF-producing \TeX\ variants interpret as hypertext jumps within the
+ previewer
+\item[textures] produces \verb|\special| commands that \textsf{Textures} interprets as hypertext jumps within the previewer
+\item[xetex] produces \verb|\special| commands for Xe\TeX{}
+\end{description}
+
+Output from \textsf{dvips} or \textsf{dvipsone} must be processed using
+Acrobat Distiller to obtain a PDF file.\footnote{Make sure you turn off
+the partial font downloading supported by \textsf{dvips} and
+\textsf{dvipsone} in favor of Distiller's own system.} The result is
+generally preferable to that produced by using the \textsf{hypertex}
+driver, and then processing with \textsf{dvips -z}, but the DVI file is
+not portable. The main advantage of using the Hyper\TeX\ \ci{special}
+commands is that you can also use the document in hypertext DVI viewers,
+such as \textsf{xdvi}.
+
+\begin{description}
+\item[driverfallback]
+ If a driver is not given and cannot be autodetected, then use
+ the driver option, given as value to this option \textsf{driverfallback}.
+ Example:
+ \begin{quote}
+ \texttt{driverfallback=dvipdfm}
+ \end{quote}
+ Autodetected drivers (\textsf{pdftex}, \textsf{xetex}, \textsf{vtex},
+ \textsf{vtexpdfmark}) are recognized from within \TeX\ and
+ therefore cannot be given as value to option \textsf{driverfallback}.
+ However a DVI driver program is run after the \TeX\ run is finished.
+ Thus it cannot be detected at \TeX\ macro level. Then package
+ \xpackage{hyperref}
+ uses the driver, given by \textsf{driverfallback}. If the driver
+ is already specified or can be autodetected, then option
+ \textsf{driverfallback} is ignored.
+\end{description}
+
+\section{Implicit behavior}
+
+This package can be used with more or less any normal \LaTeX\ document
+by specifying in the document preamble
+
+\begin{verbatim}
+\usepackage{hyperref}
+\end{verbatim}
+
+Make sure it comes \emph{last} of your loaded packages, to give it a
+fighting chance of not being over-written, since its job is to redefine
+many \LaTeX\ commands.\footnote{But work has started to reduce the
+number of redefinition and so the dependencies on the loading order.}
+Hopefully you will find that all cross-references
+work correctly as hypertext. For example, \ci{section} commands will
+produce a bookmark and a link, whereas \ci{section*} commands will only
+show links when paired with a corresponding \ci{addcontentsline}
+command.
+
+In addition, the \texttt{hyperindex} option (see below) attempts to make
+items in the index by hyperlinked back to the text, and the option
+\texttt{backref} inserts extra `back' links into the bibliography for
+each entry. Other options control the appearance of links, and give
+extra control over PDF output. For example, \texttt{colorlinks}, as its
+name well implies, colors the links instead of using boxes; this is the
+option used in this document.
+
+\section{Interfaces for class and package authors}
+
+hyperlink features are nowadays a common requirement. \xpackage{hyperref}
+patches quite a number of commands from the \LaTeX{} core and from packages
+to add such features. But this is rather fragile and it add dependencies
+on the loading order and can break if the external packages changes.
+It is therefore much better if packages add suitable support to their commands directly.
+Quite a lot packages actually did this, but due to missing documentation of the interface
+they often looked into the code and then used internal commands not meant as public command.
+
+The following tries to describe the existing variables and commands that
+can be viewed as public interfaces or which should or can be set by packages
+to stay compatible with the \xpackage{hyperref} command. Documented user commands
+are naturally interfaces too, they are not explicitly mentioned here again.
+
+This section is work in progress. Suggestions or comments are welcome.
+
+
+\subsection{Counters}
+Counters play an important part in the code. They are used to create destination names and
+to define hierarchies like the bookmarks. To work correctly often they require some additional
+setups.
+
+\begin{description}
+
+\item[\cs{theH<counter>}] \xpackage{hyperref} creates destination names for
+link anchor typically out of the name of the counter and the \cs{the<counter>} value.
+This can fail, e.g. if \cs{the<counter>} is not unique through the document,
+or if it is not expandable. In such cases \cs{theH<counter>} should be defined so that
+it gives a unique, expandable value. It doesn't harm to define it even if
+\xpackage{hyperref} is not loaded.
+
+\item[\cs{toclevel@<counter>}] This is a variable which should contain a number.
+It is used for the level in the bookmarks. It should be defined for all counters
+which are used in toc like lists and \cs{addcontentsline}. Typical values are
+
+\begin{verbatim}
+\def\toclevel at part{-1}
+\def\toclevel at chapter{0}
+\def\toclevel at section{1}
+\def\toclevel at subsection{2}
+\def\toclevel at subsubsection{3}
+\def\toclevel at paragraph{4}
+\def\toclevel at subparagraph{5}
+\def\toclevel at figure{0}
+\end{verbatim}
+
+\end{description}
+
+\subsection{Links commands}
+The following commands are provided by all drivers to create links.
+They can be used by packages if the user commands are not sufficient.
+New drivers must provide this commands with similar arguments.
+
+\begin{verbatim}
+ \hyper at anchor {destination name}
+ \hyper at anchorstart {destination name}
+ \hyper at anchorend
+ \hyper at link {context}{destination name}{link text} %GoTo
+ \hyper at linkstart {context} {destination name} %GoTo
+ \hyper at linkend %GoTo
+ \hyper at linkfile {link text} {filename} {destname} %GoToR
+ \hyper at linkurl {link text}{url} %URI
+ \hyper at linklaunch{filename} {link text} {Parameters} %Launch, only with new generic driver
+ \hyper at linknamed {action}{link text} %Named, only with new generic driver
+\end{verbatim}
+
+\subsection{Creating targets}
+
+Internal links and bookmarks need something they can jump to. In a PDF this is normally called
+a \emph{destination} (and the primitive is therefor called \cs{pdfdest}), in HTML it is more
+common to call this an \emph{anchor} (and the \xpackage{hyperref} uses therefor \cs{hyper at anchor}).
+History can not be undone but future commands and descriptions will use the generic
+\emph{target} unless the PDF specific destination is meant.
+
+Targets are created automatically when \cs{refstepcounter} is used and in many cases this
+does the right thing and nothing more is needed.
+But there are exceptions:
+\begin{itemize}
+\item A needed target can be missing for example
+if a sectioning command doesn't have a number as the starred version is used or due to the
+setting of \texttt{secnumdepth}.
+\item The target created by the \cs{refstepcounter} can be in the wrong place.
+\item The target created by the \cs{refstepcounter} can affect spacing.
+\item The target name created by the \cs{refstepcounter} is not usable, e.g. in
+\cs{bibitem} where you need a target name bases on the bib-key.
+\end{itemize}
+
+Package authors and users can use the following commands to create and manipulate
+targets. The commands are described in more detail in \texttt{hyperref-linktarget.pdf}.
+
+\begin{verbatim}
+ \MakeLinkTarget
+ \LinkTargetOff
+ \LinkTargetOn
+ \NextLinkTarget
+ \SetLinkTargetFilter
+\end{verbatim}
+
+The first four commands will be defined also in \LaTeX{} directly as no-op and so can be
+used even if \xpackage{hyperref} is not loaded.
+
+Until \LaTeX{} is updated package authors can also provide these definitions directly:
+
+\begin{verbatim}
+\ProvideDocumentCommand\MakeLinkTarget{sO{}m}{}
+\ProvideDocumentCommand\LinkTargetOn{}{}
+\ProvideDocumentCommand\LinkTargetOff{}{}
+\ProvideDocumentCommand\NextLinkTarget{m}{}
+\end{verbatim}
+
+\subsection{Patches and how to suppress them}
+
+The patches to external commands made by
+\xpackage{hyperref} can be avoided in toto by loading \xpackage{hyperref}
+with the option \texttt{implicit=false}.
+But suppressing everything is often too drastic.
+There is a work in progress to classify
+the patches and to offer interfaces to suppress them in a more granular way.
+
+\begin{description}
+\item[sectioning commands]
+\begin{itemize}
+\item hyperref patches \cs{@sect}, \cs{@ssect}, \cs{@chapter}, \cs{@schapter},
+\cs{@part}, \cs{@spart}.
+
+\item It adds to the starred commands a target for a link (with the
+prefix \texttt{chapter*} for chapters and \texttt{section*} otherwise).
+To the other commands it adds a target for a link
+if the sectioning is unnumbered, e.g. because of the \texttt{secnumdepth}
+setting or in the front matter.
+
+\item The patch can be suppressed by defining the command \cs{hyper at nopatch@sectioning}.
+This should normally be done only by a class or a package
+which provides sectioning commands and adds the targets itself.
+Targets have a location on the page and e.g. the section commands should take indents into
+account. Targets are needed for bookmarks and the table of contents,
+so \cs{@currentHref} should get the correct meaning before
+\cs{addcontentsline} is used.
+
+\item Note that the \xpackage{nameref} package patches these commands too
+to add commands to store the title text in \cs{@currentlabelname}.
+Check the \xpackage{nameref} documentation about a way to suppress these patches.
+\end{itemize}
+
+\item[footnotes] To enable (partly) the linking of footnotes hyperref redefines or patches various commands, in part package dependant.
+\begin{itemize}
+\item hyperref redefines \cs{@xfootnotenext}, \cs{@xfootnotemark}, \cs{@mpfootnotetext},
+ \cs{@footnotetext}, \cs{@footnotemark}.
+ If \xpackage{tabularx} is loaded it changes \cs{TX at endtabularx}. If \xpackage{longtable} is loaded it changes \cs{LT at p@ftntext}.
+ If \xpackage{fancyvfb} is loaded it redefines \cs{V@@footnotetext}. It also redefines \cs{footref} and \cs{maketitle}.
+
+\item \emph{All} those redefinitions can be suppressed by defining \cs{hyper at nopatch@footnote}. Be aware that this can suppress links but also make unwanted links appear.
+\end{itemize}
+
+\end{description}
+
+\section{Package options}
+
+All user-configurable aspects of \xpackage{hyperref} are set using a
+single `key=value' scheme (using the \xpackage{keyval} package) with the
+key \texttt{Hyp}. The options can be set either in the optional argument
+to the \cs{usepackage} command, or using the \cs{hypersetup}
+macro. When the package is loaded, a file \texttt{hyperref.cfg} is read
+if it can be found, and this is a convenient place to set options on a
+site-wide basis.
+
+Note however that some options (for example \texttt{unicode}) can only be used as
+package options, and not in \verb|\hypersetup| as the option settings are processed
+as the package is read. The following tabular lists (hopefully all) these options.
+Be aware that some of the option do nothing or have
+changed behaviour if the new pdfmanagement and so the new generic hyperref driver is used.
+
+\begin{tabular}{>{\ttfamily}l>{\raggedright\arraybackslash}p{5cm}}
+option & remark \\\hline
+all driver options, e.g. \texttt{pdftex} & often not needed, as detected automatically\\
+implicit \\
+pdfa & no-op with new pdfmanagement, set the standard in \cs{DeclareDocumentMetadata}.\\
+unicode & is the default now anyway\\
+pdfversion & no-op with new pdfmanagement, set the version in \cs{DeclareDocumentMetadata}.\\
+bookmarks & this will probably change at some time. \\
+backref &\\
+pagebackref & \\
+destlabel &\\
+pdfusetitle &\\
+pdfpagelabels &\\
+hyperfootnotes &\\
+hyperfigures&\\
+hyperindex &\\
+encap &\\
+typexml & \\
+CJKbookmarks & only with the new pdfmanagement, in other cases it can be used in \cs{hypersetup}\\
+psdextra & only with the new pdfmanagement, in other cases it can be used in \cs{hypersetup}\\
+nesting & only with the new pdfmanagement, in other cases it can be used in \cs{hypersetup} (but
+ is quite unclear if it has any use)\\
+
+\end{tabular}
+
+As an example, the behavior of a particular file could be controlled by:
+\begin{itemize}
+
+\item a site-wide \texttt{hyperref.cfg} setting up the look of links,
+adding backreferencing, and setting a PDF display default:
+
+\begin{verbatim}
+\hypersetup{backref,
+pdfpagemode=FullScreen,
+colorlinks=true}
+\end{verbatim}
+
+\item A global option in the file, which is passed down to
+\textsf{hyperref}:
+
+\begin{verbatim}
+\documentclass[dvips]{article}
+\end{verbatim}
+
+\item File-specific options in the \cs{usepackage} commands, which
+override the ones set in \texttt{hyperref.cfg}:
+
+\begin{verbatim}
+\usepackage[colorlinks=false]{hyperref}
+\hypersetup{pdftitle={A Perfect Day}}
+\end{verbatim}
+\end{itemize}
+
+As seen in the previous example, information entries
+(pdftitle, pdfauthor, \dots) should be set after the package is loaded.
+Otherwise \LaTeX\ expands the values of these options prematurely.
+Also \LaTeX\ strips spaces in options. Especially option `pdfborder'
+requires some care. Curly braces protect the value, if given
+as package option. They are not necessary in \verb|\hypersetup|.
+
+\begin{verbatim}
+\usepackage[pdfborder={0 0 0}]{hyperref}
+\hypersetup{pdfborder=0 0 0}
+\end{verbatim}
+
+Some options can be given at any time, but many are restricted: before
+\verb|\begin{document}|, only in \verb|\usepackage[...]{hyperref}|,
+before first use, etc.
+
+In the key descriptions that follow, many options do not need a value,
+as they default to the value true if used. These are the ones classed as
+`boolean'. The values true and false can always be specified, however.
+
+\subsection{General options}
+
+Firstly, the options to specify general behavior and page size.
+
+\medskip
+\begin{longtable}{>{\ttfamily}ll>{\itshape}ll}
+draft & boolean & false & all hypertext options are turned off \\
+final & boolean & true & all hypertext options are turned on \\
+debug & boolean & false & extra diagnostic messages are printed in \\
+ & & & the log file \\
+verbose & boolean & false & same as debug \\
+implicit & boolean & true & redefines \LaTeX\ internals \\
+setpagesize & boolean & true & sets page size by special driver commands
+\end{longtable}
+
+\subsection{Options for destination names}
+
+Destinations names (also anchor, target or link names) are internal
+names that identify a position on a page in the document. They
+are used in link targets for inner document links or the bookmarks,
+for example.
+
+Usually anchor are set, if \cs{refstepcounter} is called.
+Thus there is a counter name and value. Both are used to
+construct the destination name. By default the counter value
+follows the counter name separated by a dot. Example for
+the fourth chapter:
+\begin{quote}
+ \verb|chapter.4|
+\end{quote}
+This scheme is used by:
+\begin{description}
+\item[\cs{autoref}] displays the description label for the
+ reference depending on the counter name.
+\item[\cs{hyperpage}] is used by the index to get
+page links. Page anchor setting (\verb|pageanchor|) must not
+be turned off.
+\end{description}
+
+It is very important that the destination names are unique,
+because two destinations must not share the same name.
+The counter value \cs{the<counter>} is not always unique
+for the counter. For example, table and figures can be numbered
+inside the chapter without having the chapter number in their
+number. Therefore \xpackage{hyperref} has introduced \cs{theH<counter>}
+that allows a unique counter value without messing up with
+the appearance of the counter number. For example, the number
+of the second table in the third chapter might be printed
+as \texttt{2}, the result of \cs{thetable}. But the
+destination name \texttt{table.2.4} is unique because it
+has used \cs{theHtable} that gives \verb|2.4| in this case.
+
+Often the user do not need to set \cs{theH<counter>}. Defaults
+for standard cases (chapter, \dots) are provided. And after \xpackage{hyperref}
+is loaded, new counters with parent counters also define
+\cs{theH<counter>} automatically, if \cs{newcounter}, \cs{@addtoreset}
+or \cs{numberwithin} of package \xpackage{amsmath} are used.
+
+Usually problems with duplicate destination names can be solved
+by an appropriate definition of \cs{theH<counter>}. If option
+\texttt{hypertexnames} is disabled, then a unique artificial
+number is used instead of the counter value. In case of page
+anchors the absolute page anchor is used. With option \texttt{plainpages}
+the page anchors use the arabic form. In both latter cases \cs{hyperpage}
+for index links is affected and might not work properly.
+
+If an unnumbered entity gets an anchor (starred forms of
+chapters, sections, \dots) or \cs{phantomsection} is used,
+then the dummy counter name \texttt{section*} and an artificial
+unique number is used.
+
+If the final PDF file is going to be merged with another file, than
+the destination names might clash, because both documents might
+contain \texttt{chapter.1} or \texttt{page.1}. Also \xpackage{hyperref}
+sets anchor with name \texttt{Doc-Start} at the begin of the document.
+This can be resolved by redefining \cs{HyperDestNameFilter}.
+Package \xpackage{hyperref} calls this macro each time, it uses a
+destination name.
+The macro must be expandable and expects the destination name
+as only argument. As example, the macro is redefined to add
+a prefix to all destination names:
+\begin{quote}
+\begin{verbatim}
+\renewcommand*{\HyperDestNameFilter}[1]{\jobname-#1}
+\end{verbatim}
+\end{quote}
+In document \texttt{docA} the destination name \texttt{chapter.2}
+becomes \texttt{docA-chapter.2}.
+
+Destination names can also be used from the outside in URIs(, if the
+driver has not removed or changed them), for example:
+\begin{quote}
+\begin{verbatim}
+http://somewhere/path/file.pdf#nameddest=chapter.4
+\end{verbatim}
+\end{quote}
+However using a number seems unhappy. If another chapter is added
+before, the number changes. But it is very difficult to pass
+a new name for the destination to the anchor setting process that
+is usually deep hidden in the internals. The first name of
+\cs{label} after the anchor setting seems a good approximation:
+\begin{quote}
+\begin{verbatim}
+ \section{Introduction}
+ \label{intro}
+\end{verbatim}
+\end{quote}
+Option \texttt{destlabel} checks for each \cs{label}, if there is
+a new destination name active and replaces the destination
+name by the label name. Because the destination name is already in use
+because of the anchor setting, the new name is recorded in the \texttt{.aux}
+file and used in the subsequent \hologo{LaTeX} run. The renaming is done by
+a redefinition of \cs{HyperDestNameFilter}. That leaves the old
+destination names intact (e.g., they are needed for \cs{autoref}).
+This redefinition is also available as \cs{HyperDestLabelReplace},
+thus that an own redefinition can use it.
+The following example also adds a prefix for \emph{all} destination names:
+\begin{quote}
+\begin{verbatim}
+\renewcommand*{\HyperDestNameFilter}[1]{%
+ \jobname-\HyperDestLabelReplace{#1}%
+}
+\end{verbatim}
+\end{quote}
+The other case that only files prefixed that do not have a corresponding
+\cs{label} is more complicate, because \cs{HyperDestLabelReplace} needs
+the unmodified destination name as argument. This is solved by an
+expandable string test (\cs{pdfstrcmp} of \hologo{pdfTeX}
+or \cs{strcmp} of \hologo{XeTeX}, package \xpackage{pdftexcmds} also supports
+\hologo{LuaTeX}):
+\begin{quote}
+\begin{verbatim}
+\usepackage{pdftexcmds}
+\makeatletter
+\renewcommand*{\HyperDestNameFilter}[1]{%
+ \ifcase\pdf at strcmp{#1}{\HyperDestLabelReplace{#1}} %
+ \jobname-#1%
+ \else
+ \HyperDestLabelReplace{#1}%
+ \fi
+}
+\makeatother
+\end{verbatim}
+\end{quote}
+
+With option \texttt{destlabel} destinations can also named manually,
+if the destination is not yet renamed:
+\begin{quote}
+\verb|\HyperDestRename{|\meta{destination}\verb|}{|\meta{newname}\verb|}|
+\end{quote}
+
+Hint: Anchors can also be named and set by \cs{hypertarget}.
+
+\medskip
+\begin{longtable}{>{\ttfamily}ll>{\itshape}ll}
+destlabel & boolean & false & destinations are named by first \cs{label}\\
+ & & & after anchor creation\\
+hypertexnames & boolean & true & use guessable names for links \\
+naturalnames & boolean & false & use \LaTeX-computed names for links \\
+plainpages & boolean & false & Forces page anchors to be named by the Arabic form \\
+ & & & of the page number, rather than the formatted form. \\
+\end{longtable}
+
+\subsection{Configuration options}
+
+\begin{longtable}{>{\ttfamily}ll>{\itshape}lp{9cm}}
+raiselinks & boolean & true & In the hypertex driver, the height of links is normally calculated by the driver as
+ simply the base line of contained text; this options forces \verb|\special| commands to
+ reflect the real height of the link (which could contain a graphic) \\
+breaklinks & boolean & both & This option is in hyperref only used in the dviwindo driver, in all other cases it doesn't do anything sensible---it neither allows nor prevents links to be broken. The ocgx2 package
+checks the state of the boolean.\\
+pageanchor & boolean & true & Determines whether every page is given an implicit anchor at the top left corner. If this
+ is turned off, \verb|\printindex| will not contain
+ valid hyperlinks. \\
+nesting & boolean & false & Allows links to be nested; no drivers currently support this.
+\end{longtable}
+
+Note for option \verb|breaklinks|:
+The correct value is automatically set according to the driver features.
+It can be overwritten for drivers that do not support broken links.
+However, at any case, the link area will be wrong and displaced.
+
+\subsection{Backend drivers}
+
+If no driver is specified, the package tries to find a driver in
+the following order:
+\begin{enumerate}
+\item Autodetection, some \TeX\ processors can be detected at \TeX\ macro
+ level (pdf\TeX, Xe\TeX, V\TeX).
+\item Option \textsf{driverfallback}. If this option is set, its value
+ is taken as driver option.
+\item Macro \cs{Hy at defaultdriver}. The macro takes a driver file
+ name (without file extension).
+\item Package default is \textsf{hypertex}.
+\end{enumerate}
+Many distributions are using a driver file \texttt{hypertex.cfg} that
+define \cs{Hy at defaultdriver} with \texttt{hdvips}. This is recommended
+because driver \textsf{dvips} provides much more features than
+\textsf{hypertex} for PDF generation.
+
+\begin{longtable}{@{}>{\ttfamily}lp{.8\hsize}@{}}
+driverfallback & Its value is used as driver option\\
+ & if the driver is not given or autodetected.\\
+dvipdfm & Sets up \textsf{hyperref} for use with the \textsf{dvipdfm} driver.\\
+dvipdfmx & Sets up \textsf{hyperref} for use with the \textsf{dvipdfmx} driver.\\
+dvips & Sets up \textsf{hyperref} for use with the \textsf{dvips} driver. \\
+dvipsone & Sets up \textsf{hyperref} for use with the \textsf{dvipsone} driver. \\
+dviwindo & Sets up \textsf{hyperref} for use with the \textsf{dviwindo} Windows previewer. \\
+hypertex & Sets up \textsf{hyperref} for use with the Hyper\TeX-compliant drivers. \\
+latex2html & Redefines a few macros for compatibility with \textsf{latex2html}. \\
+nativepdf & An alias for \textsf{dvips} \\
+pdfmark & An alias for \textsf{dvips} \\
+pdftex & Sets up \textsf{hyperref} for use with the \textsf{pdftex} program.\\
+ps2pdf & Redefines a few macros for compatibility with
+ Ghostscript's PDF writer, otherwise identical to
+ \textsf{dvips}. \\
+tex4ht & For use with \textsf{\TeX4ht} \\
+textures & For use with \textsf{Textures} \\
+vtex & For use with MicroPress' \textsf{VTeX}; the PDF
+ and HTML backends are detected automatically. \\
+vtexpdfmark & For use with \textsf{VTeX}'s PostScript backend. \\
+xetex & For use with Xe\TeX\ (using backend for dvipdfm).
+\end{longtable}
+\smallskip
+
+If you use \textsf{dviwindo}, you may need to redefine the macro
+\ci{wwwbrowser} (the default is \verb|C:\netscape\netscape|) to tell
+\textsf{dviwindo} what program to launch. Thus, users of Internet
+Explorer might add something like this to hyperref.cfg:
+
+\begin{verbatim}
+\renewcommand{\wwwbrowser}{C:\string\Program\space
+ Files\string\Plus!\string\Microsoft\space
+ Internet\string\iexplore.exe}
+\end{verbatim}
+
+\subsection{Extension options}
+\begin{longtable}{@{}>{\ttfamily}ll>{\itshape}lp{8cm}@{}}
+extension & text & & Set the file extension (e.g.\ \textsf{dvi}) which will be appended to file links
+ created if you use the \xpackage{xr} package. \\
+hyperfigures & boolean & & \\
+backref & text & false & Adds `backlink' text to the end of each item in the bibliography, as a list of
+ section numbers. This can only work properly \emph{if} there is a blank line after
+ each \verb|\bibitem|. Supported values are \verb|section|, \verb|slide|, \verb|page|,
+ \verb|none|, or \verb|false|. If no value is given, \verb|section| is taken as default.\\
+pagebackref & boolean & false & Adds `backlink' text to the end of each item in the bibliography, as a list of page
+ numbers. \\
+hyperindex & boolean & true & Makes the page numbers of index entries into hyperlinks. Relays on unique
+ page anchors (\verb|pageanchor|, \ldots)
+ \verb|pageanchors| and \verb|plainpages=false|. \\
+hyperfootnotes & boolean & true & Makes the footnote marks into hyperlinks to the footnote text.
+ Easily broken \ldots\\
+encap & & & Sets encap character for hyperindex \\
+linktoc & text & section & make text (\verb|section|), page number (\verb|page|), both (\verb|all|) or nothing (\verb|none|) be link on TOC, LOF and LOT \\
+linktocpage & boolean & false & make page number, not text, be link on TOC, LOF and LOT \\
+breaklinks & boolean & false & allow links to break over lines by making links over multiple lines into PDF links to
+ the same target \\
+colorlinks & boolean & false & Colors the text of links and anchors. The colors chosen depend on the the type of
+ link. At present the only types of link distinguished are citations, page references,
+ URLs, local file references, and other links.
+ Unlike colored boxes, the colored
+ text remains when printing.\\
+linkcolor & color & red & Color for normal internal links. \\
+anchorcolor & color & black & Color for anchor text. Ignored by most drivers. \\
+citecolor & color & green & Color for bibliographical citations in text. \\
+filecolor & color & cyan & Color for URLs which open local files. \\
+menucolor & color & red & Color for Acrobat menu items. \\
+runcolor & color & filecolor & Color for run links (launch annotations). \\
+urlcolor & color & magenta & Color for linked URLs. \\
+allcolors & color & & Set all color options (without border and field options).\\
+frenchlinks & boolean & false & Use small caps instead of color for links.\\
+hidelinks & & & Hide links (removing color and border). \\
+\end{longtable} \smallskip
+
+Note that all color names must be defined before use, following the
+normal system of the standard \LaTeX\ \xpackage{color} package.
+
+\subsection{PDF-specific display options}
+\begin{longtable}{@{}>{\ttfamily}ll>{\itshape}lp{7.6cm}@{}}
+bookmarks & boolean & true & A set of Acrobat bookmarks are written, in a manner similar to the
+ table of contents, requiring two passes of \LaTeX. Some postprocessing
+ of the bookmark file (file extension \texttt{.out}) may be needed to
+ translate \LaTeX\ codes, since bookmarks must be written in PDFEncoding.
+ To aid this process, the \texttt{.out} file is not rewritten by \LaTeX\
+ if it is edited to contain a line \verb|\let\WriteBookmarks\relax| \\
+bookmarksopen & boolean & false & If Acrobat bookmarks are requested, show them with all the subtrees
+ expanded. \\
+bookmarksopenlevel & parameter & & level (\ci{maxdimen}) to which bookmarks are open \\
+bookmarksnumbered & boolean & false & If Acrobat bookmarks are requested, include section numbers. \\
+bookmarkstype & text & toc & to specify which `toc' file to mimic \\
+CJKbookmarks & boolean & false &
+ This option should be used to produce CJK bookmarks.
+ Package \verb|hyperref|
+ supports both normal and preprocessed mode of the \xpackage{CJK} package;
+ during the creation of bookmarks, it simply replaces CJK's macros
+ with special versions which expand to the corresponding character
+ codes. Note that without the `unicode' option of hyperref you get
+ PDF files which actually violate the PDF specification because
+ non-Unicode character codes are used -- some PDF readers localized
+ for CJK languages (most notably Acroread itself) support this.
+ Also note that option `CJKbookmarks' cannot be used together
+ with option `unicode'.
+
+ No mechanism is provided to translate non-Unicode bookmarks to
+ Unicode; for portable PDF documents only Unicode encoding should
+ be used.\\
+pdfhighlight & name & /I & How link buttons behave when selected; /I is for inverse (the default);
+ the other possibilities are /N (no effect), /O (outline), and /P (inset
+ highlighting). \\
+citebordercolor & RGB color & 0 1 0 & The color of the box around citations \\
+filebordercolor & RGB color & 0 .5 .5 & The color of the box around links to files \\
+linkbordercolor & RGB color & 1 0 0 & The color of the box around normal links \\
+menubordercolor & RGB color & 1 0 0 & The color of the box around Acrobat menu links \\
+urlbordercolor & RGB color & 0 1 1 & The color of the box around links to URLs \\
+runbordercolor & RGB color & 0 .7 .7 & Color of border around `run' links \\
+allbordercolors & & & Set all border color options \\
+pdfborder & & 0 0 1 & The style of box around links; defaults to a box with lines of 1pt thickness,
+ but the colorlinks option resets it to produce no border.
+\end{longtable}
+
+The color of link borders used to be specified \emph{only} as 3
+numbers in the range 0..1, giving an RGB color. Since version 6.76a, the usual
+color specifications of package \xpackage{(x)color} can be used if \xpackage{xcolor}
+has been loaded.
+For further information see description of package \xpackage{hycolor}.
+
+The bookmark commands are stored in a file called
+\textit{jobname}\texttt{.out}. The files is not processed by \LaTeX\ so
+any markup is passed through. You can postprocess this file as needed;
+as an aid for this, the \texttt{.out} file is not overwritten on the
+next \TeX\ run if it is edited to contain the line
+\begin{verbatim}
+\let\WriteBookmarks\relax
+\end{verbatim}
+
+\subsection{PDF display and information options}
+\begin{longtable}{@{}>{\ttfamily}l>{\raggedright}p{\widthof{key value}}>{\itshape}lp{7cm}@{}}
+baseurl & URL & & Sets the base URL of the PDF document \\
+pdfpagemode & name & empty & Determines how the file is opening in Acrobat; the possibilities are
+ \verb|UseNone|, \verb|UseThumbs| (show thumbnails), \verb|UseOutlines|
+ (show bookmarks), \verb|FullScreen|, \verb|UseOC| (PDF 1.5),
+ and \verb|UseAttachments| (PDF 1.6). If no mode if explicitly chosen, but the
+ bookmarks option is set, \verb|UseOutlines| is used. \\
+pdftitle & text & & Sets the document information Title field \\
+pdfauthor & text & & Sets the document information Author field \\
+pdfsubject & text & & Sets the document information Subject field \\
+pdfcreator & text & & Sets the document information Creator field \\
+addtopdfcreator & text & & Adds additional text to the document information Creator field \\
+pdfkeywords & text & & Sets the document information Keywords field \\
+pdftrapped & name & empty & Sets the document information Trapped entry. Possible values are \verb|True|, \verb|False| and \verb|Unknown|.
+ An empty value means, the entry is not set.\\
+%
+pdfinfo & key value list & empty & Alternative interface for setting the
+ document information.\\
+pdfview & name & XYZ & Sets the default PDF `view' for each link \\
+pdfstartpage & integer & 1 & Determines on which page the PDF file is opened. An empty value means, the entry is not set.\\
+pdfstartview & name & Fit & Set the startup page view \\
+pdfremotestartview & name & Fit & Set the startup page view of remote PDF files \\
+pdfpagescrop & n n n n & & Sets the default PDF crop box for pages. This should be a set of four numbers \\
+pdfcenterwindow & boolean & false & position the document window in the center of the screen \\
+pdfdirection & name & empty & direction setting. Possible values: \verb|L2R| (left to right) and
+ \verb|R2L| (right to left)\\
+pdfdisplaydoctitle & boolean & false & display document title instead of file name in title bar\\
+pdfduplex & name & empty & paper handling option for print dialog. Possible vatues are:
+ \verb|Simplex| (print single-sided),
+ \verb|DuplexFlipShortEdge| (duplex and flip on the short edge of the sheet),
+ \verb|DuplexFlipLongEdge| (duplex and flip on the long edge of the sheet)\\
+
+pdffitwindow & boolean & false & resize document window to fit document size \\
+pdflang & name & relax & PDF language identifier (RFC 3066)\\
+pdfmenubar & boolean & true & make PDF viewer's menu bar visible \\
+pdfnewwindow & boolean & false & make links that open another PDF file start a new window \\
+pdfnonfullscreenpagemode
+ & name & empty & page mode setting on exiting full-screen mode. Possible values are
+ \verb|UseNone|, \verb|UseOutlines|, \verb|UseThumbs|, and \verb|UseOC|\\
+pdfnumcopies & integer & empty & number of printed copies \\
+pdfpagelayout & name & empty & set layout of PDF pages. Possible values:
+ \verb|SinglePage|, \verb|OneColumn|,
+ \verb|TwoColumnLeft|, \verb|TwoColumnRight|,
+ \verb|TwoPageLeft|, and \verb|TwoPageRight| \\
+pdfpagelabels & boolean & true & set PDF page labels \\
+pdfpagetransition & name & empty & set PDF page transition style. Possible values are
+ \verb|Split|, \verb|Blinds|, \verb|Box|, \verb|Wipe|,
+ \verb|Dissolve|, \verb|Glitter|, \verb|R|,
+ \verb|Fly|, \verb|Push|,
+ \verb|Cover|, \verb|Uncover|,
+ \verb|Fade|.
+ The default according to the PDF~Reference is \verb|R|,
+ which simply replaces the old page with the new one. \\
+pdfpicktraybypdfsize
+ & boolean & false & specify whether PDF page size is used to select input paper tray in print dialog \\
+pdfprintarea & name & empty & set /PrintArea of viewer preferences. Possible values are
+ \verb|MediaBox|, \verb|CropBox|,
+ \verb|BleedBox|, \verb|TrimBox|, and \verb|ArtBox|.
+ The dafault according to the PDF~Refence is \verb|CropBox| \\
+pdfprintclip & name & empty & set /PrintClip of viewer preferences. Possible values are
+ \verb|MediaBox|, \verb|CropBox|,
+ \verb|BleedBox|, \verb|TrimBox|, and \verb|ArtBox|.
+ The dafault according to the PDF~Refence is \verb|CropBox| \\
+pdfprintpagerange & n n (n n)*
+ & empty & set /PrintPageRange of viewer preferences\\
+pdfprintscaling & name & empty & page scaling option for print dialog
+ (option /PrintScaling of viewer
+ preferences, PDF 1.6);
+ valid values are \verb|None| and
+ \verb|AppDefault| \\
+pdftoolbar & boolean & true & make PDF toolbar visible \\
+pdfviewarea & name & empty & set /ViewArea of viewer preferences. Possible values are
+ \verb|MediaBox|, \verb|CropBox|,
+ \verb|BleedBox|, \verb|TrimBox|, and \verb|ArtBox|.
+ The dafault according to the PDF~Refence is \verb|CropBox| \\
+pdfviewclip & name & empty & set /ViewClip of viewer preferences Possible values are
+ \verb|MediaBox|, \verb|CropBox|,
+ \verb|BleedBox|, \verb|TrimBox|, and \verb|ArtBox|.
+ The dafault according to the PDF~Refence is \verb|CropBox| \\
+pdfwindowui & boolean & true & make PDF user interface elements visible \\
+unicode & boolean & true & Unicode encoded PDF strings
+\end{longtable}
+
+Each link in Acrobat carries its own magnification level, which is set
+using PDF coordinate space, which is not the same as \TeX's. The unit
+is bp and the origin is in the lower left corner. See also
+\verb|\hypercalcbp| that is explained on page \pageref{hypercalcbp}.
+pdf\TeX\
+works by supplying default values for \texttt{XYZ} (horizontal $\times$
+vertical $\times$ zoom) and \texttt{FitBH}. However, drivers using
+\texttt{pdfmark} do not supply defaults, so \textsf{hyperref} passes in
+a value of -32768, which causes Acrobat to set (usually) sensible
+defaults. The following are possible values for the \texttt{pdfview},
+\texttt{pdfstartview} and \texttt{pdfremotestartview} parameters.
+
+\begin{longtable}{@{}>{\ttfamily}l>{\itshape}lp{7cm}@{}}
+XYZ & left top zoom & Sets a coordinate and a zoom factor. If any one is null, the source link value is used.
+ \textit{null null null} will give the same values as the current page. \\
+Fit & & Fits the page to the window. \\
+FitH & top & Fits the width of the page to the window. \\
+FitV & left & Fits the height of the page to the window. \\
+FitR & left bottom right top & Fits the rectangle specified by the four coordinates to the window. \\
+FitB & & Fits the page bounding box to the window. \\
+FitBH & top & Fits the width of the page bounding box to the window. \\
+FitBV & left & Fits the height of the page bounding box to the window. \\
+\end{longtable}
+
+The \texttt{pdfpagelayout} can be one of the following values.
+
+\begin{longtable}{@{}>{\ttfamily}lp{10cm}@{}}
+SinglePage & Displays a single page; advancing flips the page \\
+OneColumn & Displays the document in one column; continuous scrolling. \\
+TwoColumnLeft & Displays the document in two columns, odd-numbered pages to the left. \\
+TwoColumnRight & Displays the document in two columns, odd-numbered pages to the right.\\
+TwoPageLeft & Displays two pages, odd-numbered pages to the left (since PDF 1.5).\\
+TwoPageRight & Displays two pages, odd-numbered pages to the right (since PDF 1.5).
+\end{longtable}
+
+Finally, the \texttt{pdfpagetransition} can be one of the following
+values, where \textit{/Di} stands for direction of motion in degrees,
+generally in 90$^{\circ}$\ steps, \textit{/Dm} is a horizontal
+(\texttt{/H}) or vertical (\texttt{/V}) dimension (e.g.\ \texttt{Blinds
+/Dm /V}), and \textit{/M} is for motion, either in (\texttt{/I}) or out
+(\texttt{/O}).
+
+\begin{longtable}{@{}>{\ttfamily}llp{8.5cm}@{}}
+Blinds & /Dm & Multiple lines distributed evenly across the screen sweep in the same direction to reveal the new
+ page. \\
+Box & /M & A box sweeps in or out. \\
+Dissolve & & The page image dissolves in a piecemeal fashion to reveal the new page. \\
+Glitter & /Di & Similar to Dissolve, except the effect sweeps across the screen. \\
+Split & /Dm /M & Two lines sweep across the screen to reveal the new page. \\
+Wipe & /Di & A single line sweeps across the screen to reveal the new page. \\
+R & & Simply replaces the old page with the new one. \\
+Fly & /Di /M & Changes are flown out or in (as specified by /M), in the direction
+ specified by /Di, to or from a location that is
+ offscreen except when /Di is None. \\
+Push & /Di & The old page slides off the screen while the new page slides in,
+ pushing the old page out in the direction
+ specified by /Di. \\
+Cover & /Di & The new page slides on to the screen in the direction specified
+ by /Di, covering the old page. \\
+Uncover & /Di & The old page slides off the screen in the direction specified by
+ /Di, uncovering the new page in the direction
+ specified by /Di. \\
+Fade & & The new page gradually becomes visible through the old one.
+
+\end{longtable}
+
+\subsection{Option \texttt{pdfinfo}}
+
+The information entries can be set using \texttt{pdftitle},
+\texttt{pdfsubject}, \dots. Option \texttt{pdfinfo} provides an alternative
+interface. It takes a key value list. The key names are the names that
+appear in the PDF information dictionary directly. Known keys such as
+\texttt{Title}, \texttt{Subject}, \texttt{Trapped} and other are mapped to
+options \texttt{pdftitle}, \texttt{subject}, \texttt{trapped}, \dots
+Unknown keys are added to the information dictionary. Their values are text
+strings (see PDF specification).
+Example:
+\begin{quote}
+\begin{verbatim}
+\hypersetup{
+ pdfinfo={
+ Title={My Title},
+ Subject={My Subject},
+ NewKey={Foobar},
+ % ...
+ }
+}
+\end{verbatim}
+\end{quote}
+
+\subsection{Big alphabetical list}
+
+The following is a complete listing of available options for
+\textsf{hyperref}, arranged alphabetically.
+
+\begin{longtable}{@{}>{\ttfamily}llp{7cm}@{}}
+allbordercolors & & Set all border color options\\
+allcolors & & Set all color options (without border and field options)\\
+anchorcolor & \textit{black} & set color of anchors, ignored by most drivers. \\
+backref & \textit{false} & do bibliographical back references \\
+baseurl & \textit{empty} & set base URL for document \\
+bookmarks & \textit{true} & make bookmarks \\
+bookmarksnumbered & \textit{false} & put section numbers in bookmarks \\
+bookmarksopen & \textit{false} & open up bookmark tree \\
+bookmarksopenlevel & \ttfamily\ci{maxdimen} & level to which bookmarks are open \\
+bookmarkstype & \textit{toc} & to specify which `toc' file to mimic \\
+breaklinks & \textit{false} & allow links to break over lines \\
+CJKbookmarks & \textit{false} & to produce CJK bookmarks\\
+citebordercolor & \textit{0 1 0} & color of border around cites \\
+citecolor & \textit{green} & color of citation links \\
+colorlinks & \textit{false} & color links \\
+ & \textit{true} & (\textsf{tex4ht}, \textsf{dviwindo}) \\
+debug & \textit{false} & provide details of anchors defined; same as verbose \\
+destlabel & \textit{false} & destinations are named by the first \verb|\label| after the anchor creation \\
+draft & \textit{false} & do not do any hyperlinking \\
+driverfallback & & default if no driver specified or detected\\
+dvipdfm & & use \textsf{dvipdfm} backend \\
+dvipdfmx & & use \textsf{dvipdfmx} backend \\
+dvips & & use \textsf{dvips} backend \\
+dvipsone & & use \textsf{dvipsone} backend \\
+dviwindo & & use \textsf{dviwindo} backend \\
+encap & & to set encap character for hyperindex \\
+extension & \textit{dvi} & suffix of linked files \\
+filebordercolor & \textit{0 .5 .5} & color of border around file links \\
+filecolor & \textit{cyan} & color of file links \\
+final & \textit{true} & opposite of option draft \\
+frenchlinks & \textit{false} & use small caps instead of color for links \\
+hidelinks & & Hide links (removing color and border) \\
+hyperfigures & \textit{false} & make figures hyper links \\
+hyperfootnotes & \textit{true} & set up hyperlinked footnotes \\
+hyperindex & \textit{true} & set up hyperlinked indices \\
+hypertex & & use \textsf{Hyper\TeX} backend \\
+hypertexnames & \textit{true} & use guessable names for links \\
+implicit & \textit{true} & redefine \LaTeX\ internals \\
+latex2html & & use \textsf{\LaTeX2HTML} backend \\
+linkbordercolor & \textit{1 0 0} & color of border around links \\
+linkcolor & \textit{red} & color of links \\
+linktoc & \textit{section} & make text be link on TOC, LOF and LOT \\
+linktocpage & \textit{false} & make page number, not text, be link on TOC, LOF and LOT \\
+menubordercolor & \textit{1 0 0} & color of border around menu links \\
+menucolor & \textit{red} & color for menu links \\
+nativepdf & \textit{false} & an alias for \textsf{dvips} \\
+naturalnames & \textit{false} & use \LaTeX-computed names for links \\
+nesting & \textit{false} & allow nesting of links \\
+next-anchor & & allow to set the name of the next anchor\\
+pageanchor & \textit{true} & put an anchor on every page \\
+pagebackref & \textit{false} & backreference by page number \\
+pdfauthor & \textit{empty} & text for PDF Author field \\
+pdfborder & \textit{0 0 1} & width of PDF link border \\
+ & \textit{0 0 0} & (\texttt{colorlinks)} \\
+pdfborderstyle & & border style for links \\
+pdfcenterwindow & \textit{false} & position the document window in the center of the screen \\
+pdfcreator & \textit{LaTeX with} & text for PDF Creator field \\
+ & \textit{hyperref} & \\
+pdfdirection & \textit{empty} & direction setting \\
+pdfdisplaydoctitle & \textit{false} & display document title instead
+ of file name in title bar\\
+pdfduplex & \textit{empty} & paper handling option for
+ print dialog\\
+pdffitwindow & \textit{false} & resize document window to fit document size \\
+pdfhighlight & \textit{/I} & set highlighting of PDF links \\
+pdfinfo & \textit{empty} & alternative interface for setting document information\\
+pdfkeywords & \textit{empty} & text for PDF Keywords field \\
+pdflang & \textit{relax} & PDF language identifier (RFC 3066) \\
+pdfmark & \textit{false} & an alias for \textsf{dvips} \\
+pdfmenubar & \textit{true} & make PDF viewer's menu bar visible \\
+pdfnewwindow & \textit{false} & make links that open another PDF \\
+ & & file start a new window \\
+pdfnonfullscreenpagemode
+ & \textit{empty} & page mode setting on exiting
+ full-screen mode\\
+pdfnumcopies & \textit{empty} & number of printed copies\\
+pdfpagelabels & \textit{true} & set PDF page labels \\
+pdfpagelayout & \textit{empty} & set layout of PDF pages \\
+pdfpagemode & \textit{empty} & set default mode of PDF display \\
+pdfpagescrop & \textit{empty} & set crop size of PDF document \\
+pdfpagetransition & \textit{empty} & set PDF page transition style \\
+pdfpicktraybypdfsize
+ & \textit{empty} & set option for print dialog \\
+pdfprintarea & \textit{empty} & set /PrintArea of viewer preferences \\
+pdfprintclip & \textit{empty} & set /PrintClip of viewer preferences \\
+pdfprintpagerange & \textit{empty} & set /PrintPageRange of viewer preferences \\
+pdfprintscaling & \textit{empty} & page scaling option for print dialog \\
+pdfproducer & \textit{empty} & text for PDF Producer field \\
+pdfremotestartview & \textit{Fit} & starting view of remote PDF documents \\
+pdfstartpage & \textit{1} & page at which PDF document opens \\
+pdfstartview & \textit{Fit} & starting view of PDF document \\
+pdfsubject & \textit{empty} & text for PDF Subject field \\
+pdftex & & use \textsf{pdf\TeX} backend \\
+pdftitle & \textit{empty} & text for PDF Title field \\
+pdftoolbar & \textit{true} & make PDF toolbar visible \\
+pdftrapped & \textit{empty} & Sets the document information Trapped entry.
+ Possible values are \texttt{True}, \texttt{False} and \texttt{Unknown}.
+ An empty value means, the entry is not set.\\
+pdfview & \textit{XYZ} & PDF `view' when on link traversal \\
+pdfviewarea & \textit{empty} & set /ViewArea of viewer preferences \\
+pdfviewclip & \textit{empty} & set /ViewClip of viewer preferences \\
+pdfwindowui & \textit{true} & make PDF user interface elements visible \\
+plainpages & \textit{false} & do page number anchors as plain Arabic \\
+ps2pdf & & use \textsf{ps2pdf} backend \\
+psdextra & \textit{false} & define more short names for PDF string commands \\
+raiselinks & \textit{false} & raise up links (for \textsf{Hyper\TeX} backend) \\
+runbordercolor & \textit{0 .7 .7} & color of border around `run' links \\
+runcolor & \textit{filecolor} & color of `run' links\\
+setpagesize & \textit{true} & set page size by special driver commands \\
+tex4ht & & use \textsf{\TeX4ht} backend \\
+textures & & use \textsf{Textures} backend \\
+unicode & \textit{true} & Unicode encoded pdf strings, starting with version v7.00g set by default to true for all engines. It will load a number of definitions in puenc.def. It can be set to false for pdflatex, but this is not recommended.\\
+urlbordercolor & \textit{0 1 1} & color of border around URL links \\
+urlcolor & \textit{magenta} & color of URL links \\
+verbose & \textit{false} & be chatty \\
+vtex & & use \textsf{VTeX} backend\\
+xetex & & use \textsf{Xe\TeX} backend\\
+\end{longtable}
+
+\section{Additional user macros}
+
+If you need to make references to URLs, or write explicit links, the
+following low-level user macros are provided:
+
+\begin{cmdsyntax}
+\ci{href}\verb|[|\emph{options}\verb|]|\verb|{|\emph{URL}\verb|}{|\emph{text}\verb|}|
+\end{cmdsyntax}
+
+\noindent The \emph{text} is made a hyperlink to the \emph{URL}; this
+must be a full URL (relative to the base URL, if that is defined). The
+special characters \# and \~{} do \emph{not} need to be escaped in any
+way (unless the command is used in the argument of another command).
+
+The optional argument \emph{options} recognizes the hyperref options
+\texttt{pdfremotestartview}, \texttt{pdfnewwindow} and the following
+key value options:
+\begin{description}
+\item[\texttt{page}:] Specifies the start page number of remote
+PDF documents. First page is \verb|1|.
+\item[\texttt{ismap}:] Boolean key, if set to \verb|true|, the
+URL should appended by the coordinates as query parameters by
+the PDF viewer.
+\item[\texttt{nextactionraw}:] The value of key \verb|/Next| of
+action dictionaries, see PDF specification.
+\end{description}
+
+\begin{cmdsyntax}
+\ci{url}\verb|{|\emph{URL}\verb|}|
+\end{cmdsyntax}
+
+\noindent Similar to
+\ci{href}\verb|{|\emph{URL}\verb|}{|\ci{nolinkurl}\verb|{|\emph{URL}\verb|}}|.
+Depending on the driver \verb|\href| also tries to detect the link type.
+Thus the result can be a url link, file link, \dots
+
+\begin{cmdsyntax}
+\ci{nolinkurl}\verb|{|\emph{URL}\verb|}|
+\end{cmdsyntax}
+
+\noindent Write \emph{URL} in the same way as \verb|\url|,
+ without creating a hyperlink.
+
+\begin{cmdsyntax}
+\ci{hyperbaseurl}\verb|{|\emph{URL}\verb|}|
+\end{cmdsyntax}
+
+\noindent A base \emph{URL} is established, which is prepended to other
+specified URLs, to make it easier to write portable documents.
+
+\begin{cmdsyntax}
+\ci{hyperimage}\verb|{|\emph{imageURL}\verb|}{|\emph{text}\verb|}|
+\end{cmdsyntax}
+
+\noindent The link to the image referenced by the URL is inserted, using
+\emph{text} as the anchor.
+
+ For drivers that produce HTML, the image itself is inserted by the
+browser, with the \emph{text} being ignored completely.
+
+\begin{cmdsyntax}
+\ci{hyperdef}\verb|{|\emph{category}\verb|}{|\emph{name}\verb|}{|\emph{text}\verb|}|
+\end{cmdsyntax}
+
+\noindent A target area of the document (the \emph{text}) is marked, and
+given the name \emph{category.name}
+
+\begin{cmdsyntax}
+\ci{hyperref}\verb|{|\emph{URL}\verb|}{|\emph{category}\verb|}{|\emph{name}\verb|}{|\emph{text}\verb|}|
+\end{cmdsyntax}
+
+\noindent \emph{text} is made into a link to \emph{URL\#category.name}
+
+\begin{cmdsyntax}
+\ci{hyperref}\verb|[|\emph{label}\verb|]{|\emph{text}\verb|}|
+\end{cmdsyntax}
+
+\noindent
+\emph{text} is made into a link to the same place as
+\verb|\ref{|\emph{label}\verb|}| would be linked.
+
+\begin{cmdsyntax}
+\ci{hyperlink}\verb|{|\emph{name}\verb|}{|\emph{text}\verb|}|
+\end{cmdsyntax}
+\begin{cmdsyntax}
+\ci{hypertarget}\verb|{|\emph{name}\verb|}{|\emph{text}\verb|}|
+\end{cmdsyntax}
+
+\noindent A simple internal link is created with \verb|\hypertarget|,
+with two parameters of an anchor \emph{name}, and anchor
+\emph{text}. \verb|\hyperlink| has two arguments, the name of a
+hypertext object defined somewhere by \verb|\hypertarget|, and the
+\emph{text} which be used as the link on the page.
+
+Note that in HTML parlance, the \verb|\hyperlink| command inserts a
+notional \# in front of each link, making it relative to the current
+testdocument; \verb|\href| expects a full URL.
+
+\begin{cmdsyntax}
+\ci{phantomsection}
+\end{cmdsyntax}
+
+\noindent
+This sets an anchor at this location. It works similar to
+\verb|\hypertarget{}{}| with an automatically chosen anchor name.
+Often it is used in conjunction
+with \verb|\addcontentsline| for sectionlike things (index, bibliography,
+preface). \verb|\addcontentsline| refers to the latest previous location
+where an anchor is set. Example:
+\begin{quote}
+\begin{verbatim}
+\cleardoublepage
+\phantomsection
+\addcontentsline{toc}{chapter}{\indexname}
+\printindex
+\end{verbatim}
+\end{quote}
+Now the entry in the table of contents (and bookmarks) for the
+index points to the start of the index page, not to a location
+before this page.
+
+\begin{cmdsyntax}
+\ci{hyperget}\verb|{|\emph{anchor}\verb|}{|\emph{label}\verb|}|
+\ci{hyperget}\verb|{|\emph{pageanchor}\verb|}{|\emph{label}\verb|}|
+\end{cmdsyntax}
+
+This retrieves the anchor or the page anchor from a label in an expandable way.
+It takes \verb|\HyperDestNameFilter| into account. It can e.g. be used with the
+\verb|\bookmark| from the bookmark package to set a destination to a label:
+
+\begin{verbatim}
+\bookmark[dest=\hyperget{anchor}{sec}]{section}
+\end{verbatim}
+
+As \emph{pageanchor} retrieves the page number from the label it can't be use together with
+the option \texttt{plainpages}.
+
+\begin{cmdsyntax}
+\ci{hyperget}\verb|{|\emph{currentanchor}\verb|}{}|
+\end{cmdsyntax}
+
+This retrieves the last anchor that has been set. It too takes \verb|\HyperDestNameFilter| into account.
+
+
+
+\begin{cmdsyntax}
+\ci{autoref}\verb|{|\emph{label}\verb|}|
+\end{cmdsyntax}
+
+\noindent
+This is a replacement for the usual \verb|\ref| command that places a
+contextual label in front of the reference. This gives your users a
+bigger target to click for hyperlinks (e.g.\ `section 2' instead of
+merely the number `2').
+
+The label is worked out from the context of the original \verb|\label|
+command by \textsf{hyperref} by using the macros listed below (shown
+with their default values). The macros can be (re)defined in documents
+using \verb|\(re)newcommand|; note that some of these macros are already
+defined in the standard document classes. The mixture of lowercase and
+uppercase initial letters is deliberate and corresponds to the author's
+practice.
+
+For each macro below, \textsf{hyperref} checks \ci{*autorefname} before
+\ci{*name}. For instance, it looks for \ci{figureautorefname} before
+\ci{figurename}.
+
+\begin{longtable}{@{}lp{10cm}@{}}
+\textit{Macro} & \textit{Default} \\
+\ci{figurename} & Figure \\
+\ci{tablename} & Table \\
+\ci{partname} & Part \\
+\ci{appendixname} & Appendix \\
+\ci{equationname} & Equation \\
+\ci{Itemname} & item \\
+\ci{chaptername} & chapter \\
+\ci{sectionname} & section \\
+\ci{subsectionname} & subsection \\
+\ci{subsubsectionname} & subsubsection \\
+\ci{paragraphname} & paragraph \\
+\ci{Hfootnotename} & footnote \\
+\ci{AMSname} & Equation \\
+\ci{theoremname} & Theorem\\
+\ci{page} & page\\
+\end{longtable}
+
+Example for a redefinition if \textsf{babel} is used:
+\begin{quote}
+\begin{verbatim}
+\usepackage[ngerman]{babel}
+\addto\extrasngerman{%
+ \def\subsectionautorefname{Unterkapitel}%
+}
+\end{verbatim}
+\end{quote}
+
+Hint: \cs{autoref} works via the counter name that the reference
+is based on. Sometimes \cs{autoref} chooses the wrong name, if
+the counter is used for different things. For example, it happens
+with \cs{newtheorem} if a lemma shares a counter with theorems.
+Then package \xpackage{aliascnt} provides a method to generate a
+simulated second counter that allows the differentiation between
+theorems and lemmas:
+\begin{quote}
+\begin{verbatim}
+\documentclass{article}
+
+\usepackage{aliascnt}
+\usepackage{hyperref}
+
+\newtheorem{theorem}{Theorem}
+
+\newaliascnt{lemma}{theorem}
+\newtheorem{lemma}[lemma]{Lemma}
+\aliascntresetthe{lemma}
+
+\providecommand*{\lemmaautorefname}{Lemma}
+
+\begin{document}
+
+We will use \autoref{a} to prove \autoref{b}.
+
+\begin{lemma}\label{a}
+ Nobody knows.
+\end{lemma}
+
+\begin{theorem}\label{b}
+ Nobody is right.
+\end{theorem}.
+
+\end{document}
+\end{verbatim}
+\end{quote}
+
+\begin{cmdsyntax}
+\ci{autopageref}\verb|{|\emph{label}\verb|}|
+\end{cmdsyntax}
+
+\noindent
+It replaces \verb|\pageref| and adds the name for page in front of
+the page reference. First \ci{pageautorefname} is checked before
+\ci{pagename}.
+
+For instances where you want a reference to use the correct counter, but
+not to create a link, there are starred forms (these starred forms exist even if
+hyperref has been loaded with \verb|implicit=false|):
+
+\begin{cmdsyntax}
+\ci{ref*}\verb|{|\emph{label}\verb|}|
+\end{cmdsyntax}
+
+\begin{cmdsyntax}
+\ci{pageref*}\verb|{|\emph{label}\verb|}|
+\end{cmdsyntax}
+
+\begin{cmdsyntax}
+\ci{autoref*}\verb|{|\emph{label}\verb|}|
+\end{cmdsyntax}
+
+\begin{cmdsyntax}
+\ci{autopageref*}\verb|{|\emph{label}\verb|}|
+\end{cmdsyntax}
+
+A typical use would be to write
+\begin{verbatim}
+\hyperref[other]{that nice section (\ref*{other}) we read before}
+\end{verbatim}
+
+We want \verb|\ref*{other}| to generate the correct number, but not to
+form a link, since we do this ourselves with \ci{hyperref}.
+
+\begin{cmdsyntax}
+\ci{pdfstringdef}\verb|{|\emph{macroname}\verb|}{|\emph{\TeX string}\verb|}|
+\end{cmdsyntax}
+
+\ci{pdfstringdef} returns a macro containing the PDF string. (Currently
+this is done globally, but do not rely on it.) All the following tasks,
+definitions and redefinitions are made in a group to keep them local:
+
+\begin{itemize}
+\item Switching to PD1 or PU encoding
+\item Defining the \Quote{octal sequence commands} (\verb|\345|): \verb|\edef\3{\string\3}|
+\item Special glyphs of \TeX: \verb|\{|, \verb|\%|, \verb|\&|, \verb|\space|, \verb|\dots|, etc.
+\item National glyphs (\textsf{german.sty}, \textsf{french.sty}, etc.)
+\item Logos: \verb|\TeX|, \verb|\eTeX|, \verb|\MF|, etc.
+\item Disabling commands that do not provide useful functionality in bookmarks:
+\verb|\label|, \verb|\index|, \verb|\glossary|, \verb|\discretionary|, \verb|\def|, \verb|\let|, etc.
+\item \LaTeX's font commands like \verb|\textbf|, etc.
+\item Support for \verb|\xspace| provided by the \xpackage{xspace} package
+\end{itemize}
+
+In addition, parentheses are protected to avoid the danger of unsafe
+unbalanced parentheses in the PDF string. For further details, see Heiko
+Oberdiek's Euro\TeX\ paper distributed with \textsf{hyperref}.
+
+\begin{cmdsyntax}
+\ci{begin}\verb|{NoHyper}|\ldots\ci{end}\verb|{NoHyper}|
+\end{cmdsyntax}
+ Sometimes we just don't want the wretched package interfering
+ with us. Define an environment we can put in manually, or include
+ in a style file, which stops the hypertext functions doing anything.
+ This is used, for instance, in the Elsevier classes, to stop
+ \verb|hyperref| playing havoc in the front matter.
+
+\subsection{Bookmark macros}
+
+\subsubsection{Setting bookmarks}
+
+Usually \textsf{hyperref} automatically adds bookmarks for
+\verb|\section| and similar macros. But they can also set manually.
+
+\begin{cmdsyntax}
+\ci{pdfbookmark}\verb|[|\emph{level}\verb|]{|text\verb|}{|\emph{name}\verb|}|
+\end{cmdsyntax}
+creates a bookmark with the specified text and at the given level (default is
+0). As name for the internal anchor name is used (in conjunction with
+level). Therefore the name must be unique (similar to \verb|\label|).
+
+\begin{cmdsyntax}
+\ci{currentpdfbookmark}\verb|{|\emph{text}\verb|}{|\emph{name}\verb|}|
+\end{cmdsyntax}
+creates a bookmark at the current level.
+
+\begin{cmdsyntax}
+\ci{subpdfbookmark}\verb|{|\emph{text}\verb|}{|\emph{name}\verb|}|
+\end{cmdsyntax}
+creates a bookmark one step down in the bookmark hierarchy.
+Internally the current level is increased by one.
+
+\begin{cmdsyntax}
+\ci{belowpdfbookmark}\verb|{|\emph{text}\verb|}{|\emph{name}\verb|}|
+\end{cmdsyntax}
+creates a bookmark below the current bookmark level. However after the
+command the current bookmark level has not changed.
+
+\noindent \textbf{Hint:} Package \textsf{bookmark} replaces
+\textsf{hyperref}'s bookmark organization by a new algorithm:
+\begin{itemize}
+\item Usually only one \LaTeX\ run is needed.
+\item More control over the bookmark appearance (color, font).
+\item Different bookmark actions are supported (external file links,
+ URLs, \dots).
+\end{itemize}
+Therefore I recommend using this package.
+
+\subsubsection{Replacement macros}\label{sec:texorpdfstring}
+
+\textsf{hyperref} takes the text for bookmarks from the arguments of
+commands like \ci{section}, which can contain things like math, colors,
+or font changes, none of which will display in bookmarks as is.
+
+\begin{cmdsyntax}
+\ci{texorpdfstring}\verb|{|\emph{\TeX string}\verb|}{|\emph{PDFstring}\verb|}|
+\end{cmdsyntax}
+
+For example,
+\begin{verbatim}
+\section{Pythagoras:
+ \texorpdfstring{$ a^2 + b^2 = c^2 $}{%
+ a\texttwosuperior\ + b\texttwosuperior\ =
+ c\texttwosuperior
+ }%
+}
+\section{\texorpdfstring{\textcolor{red}}{}{Red} Mars}
+\end{verbatim}
+
+\ci{pdfstringdef} executes the hook \pdfstringdefPreHook before it
+expands the string. Therefore, you can use this hook to perform
+additional tasks or to disable additional commands.
+
+\begin{verbatim}
+\expandafter\def\expandafter\pdfstringdefPreHook
+\expandafter{%
+ \pdfstringdefPreHook
+ \renewcommand{\mycommand}[1]{}%
+}
+\end{verbatim}
+
+However, for disabling commands, an easier way is via
+\ci{pdfstringdefDisableCommands}, which adds its argument to the
+definition of \ci{pdfstringdefPreHook} (`@' can here be used as letter in
+command names):
+
+\begin{verbatim}
+\pdfstringdefDisableCommands{%
+ \let~\textasciitilde
+ \def\url{\pdfstringdefWarn\url}%
+ \let\textcolor\@gobble
+}
+\end{verbatim}
+
+\subsection{Pagelabels}
+\begin{cmdsyntax}
+\ci{thispdfpagelabel}\verb|{|\emph{page number format}\verb|}|
+\end{cmdsyntax}
+
+This allows to change format of the page number shown in the tool bar of
+a PDF viewer for a specific page, for example
+
+\verb+\thispdfpagelabel{Empty Page-\roman{page}}+
+
+The command affects the page on which it is executed, so asynchronous page breaking
+should be taken into account. It should be used in places where for example \verb+\thispagestyle+ can be use too.
+
+\subsection{Utility macros}
+
+\label{hypercalcbp}
+\begin{cmdsyntax}
+\ci{hypercalcbp}\verb|{|\emph{dimen specification}\verb|}|
+\end{cmdsyntax}
+\noindent
+\verb|\hypercalcbp| takes a \TeX\ dimen specification and
+converts it to bp and returns the number without the unit.
+This is useful for options \verb|pdfview|, \verb|pdfstartview|
+and \verb|pdfremotestartview|.
+Example:
+\begin{quote}
+\begin{verbatim}
+\hypersetup{
+ pdfstartview={FitBH \hypercalcbp{\paperheight-\topmargin-1in
+ -\headheight-\headsep}
+}
+\end{verbatim}
+\end{quote}
+The origin of the PDF coordinate system is the lower left corner.
+
+Note, for calculations you need either package \xpackage{calc} or
+\hologo{eTeX}. Nowadays the latter should automatically be enabled
+for \hologo{LaTeX} formats. Users without \hologo{eTeX}, please, look
+in the source documentation \verb|hyperref.dtx| for further
+limitations.
+
+Also \cs{hypercalcbp} cannot be used in option specifications
+of \cs{documentclass} and \cs{usepackage}, because
+\hologo{LaTeX} expands the option lists of these commands. However
+package \xpackage{hyperref} is not yet loaded and an undefined control
+sequence error would arise.
+
+\section[New Features]{New Features%
+\footnote{This section moved from the README file, needs more integration into the manual}}
+
+
+\subsection{Option `pdflinkmargin'}
+
+ Option `pdflinkmargin' is an experimental option for specifying
+ a link margin, if the driver supports this. Default is 1 pt for
+ supporting drivers.
+
+
+\begin{description}
+\item[pdfTeX]
+\begin{itemize}
+ \item The link area also depends on the surrounding box.
+ \item Settings have local effect.
+ \item When a page is shipped out, pdfTeX uses the current setting
+ of the link margin for all links on the page.
+\end{itemize}
+
+\item[pdfmark]
+\begin{itemize}
+ \item Settings have global effect.
+\end{itemize}
+
+\item[xetex]
+\begin{itemize}
+ \item Settings must be done in the preamble or the first page and then have global effect.
+ The key inserts the new (x)dvipdfmx special \verb|\special{dvipdfmx:config g #1}| (with the unit removed).
+\end{itemize}
+
+\item[Other drivers]
+ Unsupported.
+\end{description}
+
+
+\subsection{Field option `calculatesortkey'}
+
+ Fields with calculated values are calculated in document order
+ by default. If calculated field values depend on other calculated
+ fields that appear later in the document, then the correct calculation
+ order can be specified with option `calculatesortkey'. Its value is
+ used as key to lexicographically sort the calculated fields.
+ The sort key do not need to be unique. Fields that share the same
+ key are sorted in document order.
+
+
+
+ Currently the field option `calculatesortkey' is only supported by
+ the driver for pdfTeX.
+
+\subsection{Option `next-anchor'}
+This option allows to overwrite the anchor name of the next anchor.
+This makes it possible to give for example the heading of the table of contents
+an anchor name which can be referenced with a bookmark command.
+
+\begin{verbatim}
+\hypersetup{next-anchor=toc}
+\tableofcontents
+\bookmark[dest=\HyperDestNameFilter{toc},level=section]{\contentsname}
+\end{verbatim}
+
+\subsection{Option `localanchorname'}
+
+ When\marginpar{Deprecated 2022-04-27 v7.00o} an anchor is set (e.g. via \verb|\refstepcounter|, then the
+ anchor name is globally set to the current anchor name.
+
+
+ For example:
+\begin{verbatim}
+ \section{Foobar}
+ \begin{equation}\end{equation}
+ \label{sec:foobar}
+\end{verbatim}
+ With the default global setting (localanchorname=false)
+ a reference to `sec:foobar' jumps to the equation before.
+ With option `localanchorname' the anchor of the equation
+ is forgotten after the environment and the reference
+ `sec:foobar' jumps to the section title.
+
+
+ Option `localanchorname' is an experimental option, there
+ might be situations, where the anchor name is not available
+ as expected.
+
+ The option is deprecated: it makes it difficult for package authors
+ to add targets for links if it is unclear if \verb|\@currentHref| is
+ set locally or globally.
+
+\subsection{Option `customdriver'}
+
+ The value of option `customdriver' is the name of an external
+ driver file without extension `.def'. The file must have
+ \verb|\ProvidesFile| with a version date and number that match the
+ date and number of `hyperref', otherwise a warning is given.
+
+ Because the interface, what needs to be defined in the driver,
+ is not well defined and quite messy, the option is mainly intended
+ to ease developing, testing, debugging the driver part.
+
+
+\subsection{Option `psdextra'}
+
+ LaTeX's NFSS is used to assist the conversion of arbitrary
+ TeX strings to PDF strings (bookmarks, PDF information entries).
+ Many math command names (\verb|\geq|, \verb|\notin|, ...) are not in control
+ of NFSS, therefore they are defined with prefix `text'
+ (\verb|\textgeq|, \verb|\textnotin|, ...). They can be mapped to short names
+ during the processing to PDF strings. The disadvantage is that
+ they are many hundreds macros that need to be redefined for
+ each PDF string conversion. Therefore this can be enabled or
+ disabled as option `psdextra'. On default the option is turned
+ off (set to `false'). Turning the option on means
+ that the short names are available. Then \verb|\geq| can directly
+ be used instead of \verb|\textgeq|.
+
+
+\subsection{\textbackslash XeTeXLinkBox}
+
+ When XeTeX generates a link annotation, it does not look
+ at the boxes (as the other drivers), but only at the character
+ glyphs. If there are no glyphs (images, rules, ...), then
+ it does not generate a link annotation. Macro \verb|\XeTeXLinkBox|
+ puts its argument in a box and adds spaces at the lower left
+ and upper right corners. An additional margin can be specified
+ by setting it to the dimen register \verb|\XeTeXLinkMargin|. The default
+ is 2pt.
+
+ Example:
+
+
+\begin{verbatim}
+ % xelatex
+ \documentclass{article}
+ \usepackage{hyperref}
+ \setlength{\XeTeXLinkMargin}{1pt}
+ \begin{document}
+ \section{Hello World}
+ \newpage
+ \label{sec:hello}
+ \hyperref[sec:hello]{%
+ \XeTeXLinkBox{\rule{10mm}{10mm}}%
+ }
+ \end{document}
+\end{verbatim}
+
+\subsection{\textbackslash IfHyperBooleanExists and \textbackslash IfHyperBoolean}
+\begin{verbatim}
+ \IfHyperBooleanExists{OPTION}{YES}{NO}
+\end{verbatim}
+ If a hyperref OPTION is a boolean, that means it takes values
+ `true' or `false', then \verb|\IfHyperBooleanExists| calls YES, otherwise NO.
+
+
+\begin{verbatim}
+ \IfHyperBoolean{OPTION}{YES}{NO}
+\end{verbatim}
+ Macro \verb|\IfHyperBoolean| calls YES, if OPTION exists as boolean and is
+ enabled. Otherwise NO is executed.
+
+
+
+ Both macros are expandable. Additionally option `stoppedearly' is
+ available. It is enabled if \verb|\MaybeStopEarly| or \verb|\MaybeStopNow|
+ end hyperref prematurely.
+
+
+\subsection{\textbackslash unichar}
+
+ If a Unicode character is not supported by puenc.def, it can
+ be given by using \verb|\unichar|. Its name and syntax is inherited
+ from package `ucs'. However it is defined independently for
+ use in hyperref's \verb|\pdfstringdef| (that converts arbitrary
+ TeX code to PDF strings or tries to do this).
+
+
+
+ Macro \verb|\unichar| takes a TeX number as argument,
+ examples for U+263A (WHITE SMILING FACE):
+\begin{verbatim}
+ \unichar{"263A}% hexadecimal notation
+ \unichar{9786}% decimal notation
+\end{verbatim}
+ `"' must not be a babel shorthand character or otherwise
+ active. Otherwise prefix it with \verb|\string|:
+\begin{verbatim}
+ \unichar{\string"263A}% converts `"' to `"' with catcode 12 (other)
+\end{verbatim}
+ Users of (n)german packages or babel options may use \verb|\dq| instead:
+\begin{verbatim}
+ \unichar{\dq 263A}% \dq is double quote with catcode 12 (other)
+\end{verbatim}
+
+
+\subsection{\textbackslash ifpdfstringunicode}
+
+ Some features of the PDF specification needs PDF strings.
+ Examples are bookmarks or the entries in the information dictionary.
+ The PDF specification allows two encodings `PDFDocEncoding'
+ (8-bit encoding) and `Unicode' (UTF-16). The user can help
+ using \verb|\texorpdfstring| to replace complicate TeX constructs
+ by a representation for the PDF string. However \verb|\texorpdfstring|
+ does not distinguish the two encodings. This gap closes
+ \verb|\ifpdfstringunicode|. It is only allowed in the second argument
+ of \verb|\texorpdfstring| and takes two arguments, the first allows
+ the full range of Unicode. The second is limited to the
+ characters available in PDFDocEncoding.
+
+
+
+ As example we take a macro definition for the Vietnamese
+ name of \hologo{HanTheThanh}. Correctly written it needs some
+ accented characters, one character even with a double accent.
+ Class `tugboat.cls' defines a macro for the typesetted name:
+\begin{verbatim}
+ \def\Thanh{%
+ H\`an~%
+ Th\^e\llap{\raise 0.5ex\hbox{\'{}}}%
+ ~Th\`anh%
+ }
+\end{verbatim}
+ It's not entirely correct, the second accent over the `e' is not
+ an acute, but a hook. However standard LaTeX does not provide
+ such an accent.
+
+ Now we can extend the definition to support hyperref.
+ The first and the last word are already supported automatically.
+ Characters with two or more accents are a difficult business in
+ LaTeX, because the NFSS2 macros of the LaTeX kernel do not support
+ more than one accent. Therefore also puenc.def misses support for
+ them. But we can provide it using \verb|\unichar|. The character
+ in question is:
+\begin{verbatim}
+ % U+1EC3 LATIN SMALL LETTER E WITH CIRCUMFLEX AND HOOK ABOVE
+\end{verbatim}
+ Thus we can put this together:
+\begin{verbatim}
+ \def\Thanh{%
+ H\`an~%
+ \texorpdfstring{Th\^e\llap{\raise 0.5ex\hbox{\'{}}}}%
+ {\ifpdfstringunicode{Th\unichar{"1EC3}}{Th\^e}}%
+ ~Th\`anh%
+ }
+\end{verbatim}
+ For PDFDocEncoding (PD1) the variant above has dropped the
+ second accent. Alternatively we could provide a representation
+ without accents instead of wrong accents:
+\begin{verbatim}
+ \def\Thanh{%
+ \texorpdfstring{%
+ H\`an~%
+ Th\^e\llap{\raise 0.5ex\hbox{\'{}}}}%
+ ~Th\`anh%
+ }{%
+ \ifpdfstringunicode{%
+ H\`an Th\unichar{"1EC3} Th\`anh%
+ }{%
+ Han The Thanh%
+ }%
+ }%
+ }
+\end{verbatim}
+
+\subsection{Customizing index style file with \textbackslash nohyperpage}
+
+ Since version 2008/08/14~v6.78f.
+
+
+
+ For hyperlink support in the index, hyperref inserts \verb|\hyperpage|
+ into the index macros. After processing with Makeindex, \verb|\hyperpage|
+ analyzes its argument to detect page ranges and page comma lists.
+ However, only the standard settings are supported directly:
+\begin{verbatim}
+ delim_r "--"
+ delim_n ", "
+\end{verbatim}
+ (See manual page/documentation of Makeindex that explains
+ the keys that can be used in style files for Makeindex.)
+ Customized versions of
+ \verb|delim_r, delim_n, suffix_2p, suffix_3p, suffix_mp|
+ needs markup that \verb|\hyperpage| can detect and knows that
+ this stuff does not belong to a page number. Makro
+ \verb|\nohyperpage| serves as this markup. Put the customized
+ code for these keys inside \verb|\nohyperpage|, e.g.:
+\begin{verbatim}
+ suffix_2p "\\nohyperpage{f.}"
+ suffix_3p "\\nohyperpage{ff.}"
+\end{verbatim}
+ (Depending on the typesetting tradition some space ``\verb|\\|,'' or ``\verb|~|''
+ should be put before the first f inside \verb|\nohyperpage|.)
+
+
+\subsection{Experimental option `ocgcolorlinks'}
+
+ The idea are colored links, when viewed, but printed without colors.
+ This new experimental option `ocgcolorlinks' uses Optional Content
+ Groups, a feature introduced in PDF 1.5.
+
+ A better implementation which hasn't the disadvantage to prevent line breaks is
+ in the ocgx2 package. Check its documentation for details how to use it.
+\begin{itemize}
+ \item The option must be given for package loading:
+ \verb|\usepackage[ocgcolorlinks]{hyperref}|
+ \item Main disadvantage: Links cannot be broken across lines.
+ PDF reference 1.7: 4.10.2 ``Making Graphical Content Optional'':
+ Graphics state operations, such as setting the color, ...,
+ are still applied.
+ Therefore the link text is put in a box and set twice, with and
+ without color.
+ \item The feature can be switched of by \verb|\hypersetup{ocgcolorlinks=false}|
+ inside the document.
+ \item Supported drivers: pdftex, dvipdfm
+ \item The PDF version should be at least 1.5. It is automatically
+ set for pdfTeX, LuaTeX and dvipdfmx.
+\end{itemize}
+
+\subsection{Option `pdfa'}
+
+ The new option `pdfa' tries to avoid violations of PDF/A in code
+ generated by hyperref. However, the result is usually not in PDF/A,
+ because many features aren't controlled by hyperref (XMP metadata,
+ fonts, colors, driver dependend low level stuff, ...).
+
+
+
+ Currently, option `pdfa' sets and disables the following items:
+\begin{itemize}
+ \item Enabled annotation flags: Print, NoZoom, NoRotate [PDF/A 6.5.3].
+ \item Disabled annotation flags: Hidden, Invisible, NoView [PDF/A 6.5.3].
+ \item Disabled: Launch action (\href{run:...} [PDF/A 6.6.1].
+ \item Restricted: Named actions (\Acrobatmenu: NextPage, PrevPage,
+ FirstPage, LastPage) [PDF/A 6.6.1].
+ \item Many things are disabled in PDF formulars:
+ \begin{itemize}
+ \item JavaScript actions [PDF/A 6.6.1]
+ \item Trigger events (additional actions) [PDF/A 6.6.2]
+ \item Push button (because of JavaScript)
+ \item Interactive Forms: Flag NeedAppearances is the default `false'
+ (Because of this, hyperref's implementation of Forms looks ugly).
+ [PDF/A 6.9]
+ \end{itemize}
+\end{itemize}
+
+
+
+ The default value of the new option `pdfa' is `false'. It influences
+ the loading of the package and cannot be changed after hyperref is
+ loaded (\verb|\usepackage{hyperref}|).
+
+
+
+\subsection{Option `linktoc' added}
+
+ The new option `linktoc' allows more control which part
+ of an entry in the table of contents is made into a link:
+\begin{itemize}
+ \item `linktoc=none' (no links)
+ \item `linktoc=section' (default behaviour, same as `linktocpage=false')
+ \item `linktoc=page' (same as `linktocpage=true')
+ \item `linktoc=all' (both the section and page part are links)
+\end{itemize}
+
+\subsection{Option `pdfnewwindow' changed}
+
+ Before 6.77b:
+\begin{itemize}
+ \item pdfnewwindow=true $\rightarrow$ /NewWindow true
+ \item pdfnewwindow=false $\rightarrow$ (absent)
+ \item unused pdfnewwindow $\rightarrow$ (absent)
+\end{itemize}
+ Since 6.77b:
+\begin{itemize}
+ \item pdfnewwindow=true $\rightarrow$ /NewWindow true
+ \item pdfnewwindow=false $\rightarrow$ /NewWindow false
+ \item pdfnewwindow={} $\rightarrow$ (absent)
+ \item unused pdfnewwindow $\rightarrow$ (absent)
+\end{itemize}
+
+
+
+ Rationale: There is a difference between setting to `false'
+ and an absent entry. In the former case the new document
+ replaces the old one, in the latter case the PDF viewer
+ application should respect the user preference.
+
+
+\subsection{Flag options for PDF forms}
+
+ PDF form field macros (\verb|\TextField|, \verb|\CheckBox|, ...) support
+ boolean flag options. The option name is the lowercase
+ version of the names in the PDF specification (1.7):
+
+ \url{http://www.adobe.com/devnet/pdf/pdf_reference.html}
+
+ \url{http://www.adobe.com/devnet/acrobat/pdfs/pdf_reference.pdf}
+
+ Options (convert to lowercase) except flags in square brackets:
+
+\begin{itemize}
+ \item Table 8.16 Annotation flags (page 608):
+
+{\obeylines
+ 1 Invisible
+ 2 Hidden (PDF 1.2)
+ 3 Print (PDF 1.2)
+ 4 NoZoom (PDF 1.3)
+ 5 NoRotate (PDF 1.3)
+ 6 NoView (PDF 1.3)
+ [7 ReadOnly (PDF 1.3)] ignored for widget annotations, see table 8.70
+ 8 Locked (PDF 1.4)
+ 9 ToggleNoView (PDF 1.5)
+ 10 LockedContents (PDF 1.7)
+}
+ \item Table 8.70 Field flags common to all field types (page 676):
+
+{\obeylines
+ 1 ReadOnly
+ 2 Required
+ 3 NoExport
+}
+ \item Table 8.75 Field flags specific to button fields (page 686):
+
+{\obeylines
+ 15 NoToggleToOff (Radio buttons only)
+ 16 Radio (set: radio buttons, clear: check box, pushbutton: clear)
+ 17 Pushbutton
+ 26 RadiosInUniso (PDF 1.5)
+}
+ \item Table 8.77 Field flags specific to text fields (page 691):
+
+{\obeylines
+ 13 Multiline
+ 14 Password
+ 21 FileSelect (PDF 1.4)
+ 23 DoNotSpellCheck (PDF 1.4)
+ 24 DoNotScroll (PDF 1.4)
+ 25 Comb (PDF 1.5)
+ 26 RichText (PDF 1.5)
+}
+ \item Table 8.79 Field flags specific to choice fields (page 693):
+
+{\obeylines
+ 18 Combo (set: combo box, clear: list box)
+ 19 Edit (only useful if Combo is set)
+ 20 (Sort) for authoring tools, not PDF viewers
+ 22 MultiSelect (PDF 1.4)
+ 23 DoNotSpellCheck (PDF 1.4) (only useful if Combo and Edit are set)
+ 27 CommitOnSelChange (PDF 1.5)
+}
+ \item Table 8.86 Flags for submit-form actions (page 704):
+
+{\obeylines
+ [1 Include/Exclude] unsupported, use `noexport' (table 8.70) instead
+ 2 IncludeNoValueFields
+ [3 ExportFormat] handled by option `export'
+ 4 GetMethod
+ 5 SubmitCoordinates
+ [6 XFDF (PDF 1.4)] handled by option `export'
+ 7 IncludeAppendSaves (PDF 1.4)
+ 8 IncludeAnnotations (PDF 1.4)
+ [9 SubmitPDF (PDF 1.4)] handled by option `export'
+ 10 CanonicalFormat (PDF 1.4)
+ 11 ExclNonUserAnnots (PDF 1.4)
+ 12 ExclFKey (PDF 1.4)
+ 14 EmbedForm (PDF 1.5)
+}
+\end{itemize}
+
+ New option `export' sets the export format of a submit action.
+ Valid values are (upper- or lowercase):
+\begin{itemize}
+ \item FDF
+ \item HTML
+ \item XFDF
+ \item PDF (not supported by Acrobat Reader)
+\end{itemize}
+
+\subsection{Option `pdfversion'}
+
+ This is an experimental option. It notifies `hyperref' about
+ the intended PDF version. Currently this is used in code for
+ PDF forms (implementation notes 116 and 122 of PDF spec 1.7).
+
+
+
+ Values: 1.2, 1.3, 1.4, 1.5, 1.6, 1.7. Values below 1.2 are not
+ supported, because most drivers expect higher PDF versions.
+
+
+
+ The option must be used early, not after \verb|\usepackage{hyperref}|.
+
+
+ In theory this option should also set the PDF version,
+ but this is not generally supported.
+\begin{itemize}
+ \item pdfTeX below 1.10a: unsupported.
+ pdfTeX $\ge$ 1.10a and < 1.30: \verb|\pdfoptionpdfminorversion|
+ pdfTeX $\ge$ 1.30: \verb|\pdfminorversion|
+ \item dvipdfm: configuration file, example:
+ TeX Live 2007, texmf/dvipdfm/config/config, entry `V 2'.
+ \item dvipdfmx: configuration file, example:
+ TeX Live 2007, texmf/dvipdfm/dvipdfmx.cfg, entry `V 4'.
+ \item Ghostscript: option -dCompatibilityLevel (this is set in
+ `ps2pdf12', `ps2pdf13', `ps2pdf14').
+\end{itemize}
+
+
+ The current PDF version is used as default if this version
+ can be detected (only pdfTeX $\ge$ 1.10a). Otherwise the lowest
+ version 1.2 is assumed. Thus `hyperref' tries to avoid PDF code
+ that breaks this version, but is free to use ignorable higher PDF
+ features.
+
+
+\subsection{Field option `name'}
+
+ Many form objects uses the label argument
+ for several purposes:
+\begin{itemize}
+ \item Layouted label.
+ \item As name in HTML structures.
+\end{itemize}
+ Code that is suitable for layouting with TeX can
+ break in the structures of the output format.
+ If option `name' is given, then its value is used
+ as name in the different output structures. Thus
+ the value should consist of letters only.
+
+
+\subsection{Option `pdfencoding'}
+
+ The PDF format allows two encodings for bookmarks and entries
+ in the information dictionary: PDFDocEncoding and Unicode
+ as UTF-16BE. Option \xoption{pdfencoding} selects between these encodings:
+\begin{itemize}
+ \item \xoption{pdfdoc} uses PDFDocEncoding. It uses just one byte per character,
+ but the supported characters are limited (244 in PDF-1.7).
+ \item \xoption{unicode} sets Unicode. It is encoded as UTF-16BE. Two bytes
+ are used for most characters, surrogates need four bytes.
+ \item \xoption{auto} PDFDocEncoding if the string does not contain characters
+ outside the encoding (outside ascii if an unicode engine is used)
+ and Unicode otherwise. This option is not intended for the unicode engines.
+\end{itemize}
+
+ All drivers use \xoption{unicode} by default now. If another encoding should be forced,
+ it should be done in \verb|hypersetup|.
+
+\subsection{Color options/package hycolor}
+
+ See documentation of package `hycolor'.
+
+
+\subsection{Option pdfusetitle}
+
+ If option pdfusetitle is set then hyperref tries to
+ derive the values for pdftitle and pdfauthor from
+ \verb|\title| and \verb|\author|. An optional argument for \verb|\title| and
+ \verb|\author| is supported (class amsart).
+
+
+\subsection{Starred form of \textbackslash autoref}
+
+ \verb|\autoref*| generates a reference without link as \verb|\ref*| or \verb|\pageref*|.
+
+
+\subsection{Link border style}
+
+ Links can be underlined instead of the default rectangle or
+ options \xoption{colorlinks}, \xoption{frenchlinks}. This is done by option
+ \verb|pdfborderstyle={/S/U/W 1}|
+
+ Some remarks:
+
+\begin{itemize}
+ \item AR7/Linux seems to have a bug, that don't use the default
+ value \verb"1" for the width, but zero, thus that the underline
+ is not visible without \verb"/W 1". The same applies for
+ dashed boxes, eg.:
+ pdfborderstyle={/S/D/D[3 2]/W 1}
+
+ \item The syntax is described in the PDF specification, look for
+ ``border style'', eg.
+ Table 8.13 ``Entries in a border style dictionary''
+ (specification for version 1.6)
+
+ \item The border style is removed by
+ pdfborderstyle={}
+ This is automatically done if option colorlinks is enabled.
+
+ \item Be aware that not all PDF viewers support this feature, not
+ even Acrobat Reader itself:
+
+ Some support:
+ \begin{itemize}
+ \item AR7/Linux: \xoption{underline} and \xoption{dashed}, but the border width
+ must be given.
+ \item xpdf 3.00: \xoption{underline} and \xoption{dashed}
+ \end{itemize}
+
+ Unsupported:
+ \begin{itemize}
+ \item AR5/Linux
+ \item ghostscript 8.50
+ \end{itemize}
+\end{itemize}
+
+\subsection{Option \xoption{bookmarksdepth}}
+
+ The depth of the bookmarks can be controlled by the new
+ option \xoption{bookmarksdepth}. The option acts globally and
+ distinguishes three cases:
+\begin{itemize}
+ \item \xoption{bookmarksdepth} without value
+ Then hyperref uses the current value of counter \xoption{tocdepth}.
+ This is the compatible behaviour and the default.
+ \item \verb"bookmarksdepth=<number>", the value is number (also negative):
+ The depth for the bookmarks are set to this number.
+ \item \verb"bookmarksdepth=<name>"
+ The <name> is a document division name (part, chapter, ...).
+ It must not start with a digit or minus to avoid mixing up
+ with the number case. Internally hyperref uses the value
+ of macro \verb|\toclevel@<name>|.
+ Examples:
+\begin{verbatim}
+ \hypersetup{bookmarksdepth=paragraph}
+ \hypersetup{bookmarksdepth=4} % same as before
+ \hypersetup{bookmarksdepth} % counter "tocdepth" is used
+\end{verbatim}
+\end{itemize}
+
+\subsection{Option \xoption{pdfescapeform}}
+
+ There are many places where arbitrary strings end up as
+ PS or PDF strings. The PS/PDF strings in parentheses form
+ require the protection of some characters, e.g. unmatched
+ left or right parentheses need escaping or the escape
+ character itself (backslash).
+ Since 2006/02/12~v6.75a the PS/PDF driver should do
+ this automatically. However I assume a problem with
+ compatibility, especially regarding the form part where
+ larger amounts of JavaScript code can be present.
+ It would be a pain to remove all the escaping, because
+ an additional escaping layer can falsify the code.
+
+ Therefore a new option pdfescapeform was introduced:
+\begin{itemize}
+ \item pdfescapeform=false
+ Escaping for the formulars are disabled, this is
+ the compatibility behaviour, therefore this is the default.
+ \item pdfescapeform=true
+ Then the PS/PDF drivers do all the necessary escaping.
+ This is the logical choice and the recommended setting.
+ For example, the user writes JavaScript as JavaScript
+ and do not care about escaping characters for PS/PDF
+ output.
+\end{itemize}
+
+\subsection{Default driver setting}
+
+ (hyperref $\ge$ 6.72s)
+ If no driver is given, hyperref tries its best to guess the
+ most suitable driver. Thus it loads \xoption{hpdftex}, if pdfTeX is
+ detected running in PDF mode. Or it loads the corresponding
+ VTeX driver for VTeX's working modes.
+ Unhappily many driver programs run after the TeX compiler,
+ so hyperref does not have a chance (dvips, dvipdfm, ...).
+ In this case driver \xoption{hypertex} is loaded that supports the
+ HyperTeX features that are recognized by xdvi for example.
+ This behaviour, however, can easily be changed in the configuration
+ file \verb"hyperref.cfg":
+\begin{verbatim}
+ \providecommand*{\Hy at defaultdriver}{hdvips}
+\end{verbatim}
+ for dvips, or
+\begin{verbatim}
+ \providecommand*{\Hy at defaultdriver}{hypertex}
+\end{verbatim}
+ for the default behaviour of hyperref.
+
+ See also the new option `driverfallback'.
+
+\subsection{Backref entries}
+
+ Alternative interface for formatting of backref entries, example:
+
+\begin{verbatim}
+\documentclass[12pt,UKenglish]{article}
+
+\usepackage{babel}
+\usepackage[pagebackref]{hyperref}
+
+% Some language options are detected by package backref.
+% This affects the following macros:
+% \backrefpagesname
+% \backrefsectionsname
+% \backrefsep
+% \backreftwosep
+% \backreflastsep
+
+\renewcommand*{\backref}[1]{
+ % default interface
+ % #1: backref list
+ %
+ % We want to use the alternative interface,
+ % therefore the definition is empty here.
+}
+\renewcommand*{\backrefalt}[4]{%
+ % alternative interface
+ % #1: number of distinct back references
+ % #2: backref list with distinct entries
+ % #3: number of back references including duplicates
+ % #4: backref list including duplicates
+ \par
+ #3 citation(s) on #1 page(s): #2,\par
+ \ifnum#1=1 %
+ \ifnum#3=1 %
+ 1 citation on page %
+ \else
+ #3 citations on page %
+ \fi
+ \else
+ #3 citations on #1 pages %
+ \fi
+ #2,\par
+ \ifnum#3=1 %
+ 1 citation located at page %
+ \else
+ #3 citations located at pages %
+ \fi
+ #4.\par
+}
+
+% The list of distinct entries can be further refined:
+\renewcommand*{\backrefentrycount}[2]{%
+ % #1: the original backref entry
+ % #2: the count of citations of this entry,
+ % in case of duplicates greater than one
+ #1%
+ \ifnum#2>1 %
+ ~(#2)%
+ \fi
+}
+
+\begin{document}
+
+ \section{Hello}
+ \cite{ref1, ref2, ref3, ref4}
+ \section{World}
+ \cite{ref1, ref3}
+ \newpage
+
+ \section{Next section}
+ \cite{ref1}
+ \newpage
+
+ \section{Last section}
+ \cite{ref1, ref2}
+ \newpage
+
+ \pdfbookmark[1]{Bibliography}{bib}
+ \begin{thebibliography}{99}
+ \bibitem{ref1} Dummy entry one.
+
+ \bibitem{ref2} Dummy entry two.
+
+ \bibitem{ref3} Dummy entry three.
+
+ \bibitem{ref4} Dummy entry four.
+
+ \end{thebibliography}
+
+\end{document}
+\end{verbatim}
+
+\subsection{\textbackslash phantomsection}
+
+Set an anchor at this location. It is often used in conjunction
+with \verb|\addcontentsline| for sectionlike things (index, bibliography,
+preface). \verb|\addcontentsline| refers to the latest previous location
+where an anchor is set.
+
+\begin{verbatim}
+ \cleardoublepage
+ \phantomsection
+ \addcontentsline{toc}{chapter}{\indexname}
+ \printindex
+\end{verbatim}
+
+Now the entry in the table of contents (and bookmarks) for the
+index points to the start of the index page, not to a location
+before this page.
+
+\subsection{puenc encoding, puenc-greek.def and puenc-extra.def}
+
+The \texttt{unicode} option loads for the bookmarks \texttt{puenc.def} which contains
+quite a lot definitions of commands for the bookmarks.
+As \texttt{unicode} is now true for all engines, this file is now also loaded
+with pdflatex. Some of the definitions in \texttt{puenc.def} clash with other uses.
+To reduce the impact \xpackage{hyperref} uses two strategies.
+
+\begin{itemize}
+\item A number of command are only defined conditionally:
+The commands for the cyrillic block if \cs{CYRDZE} is defined,
+greek if \cs{textBeta} is defined, and hebrew if \cs{hebdalet} is defined.
+
+The greek block is in an extra file, \texttt{puenc-greek.def}, which can
+be loaded manually if needed.
+
+\item Other commands are moved to an extra file \texttt{puenc-extra.def}
+which is not loaded automatically, but can be loaded in the preamble if needed.
+Currently this file contains all definitions for the accent \cs{G}.
+\end{itemize}
+
+
+
+\section{Acrobat-specific behavior}
+If you want to access the menu options of Acrobat Reader or Exchange, the following
+macro is provided in the appropriate drivers:
+
+\begin{cmdsyntax}
+\ci{Acrobatmenu}\verb|{|\emph{menuoption}\verb|}{|\emph{text}\verb|}|
+\end{cmdsyntax}
+
+\noindent The \emph{text} is used to create a button which activates the appropriate \emph{menuoption}. The following table lists the option names you can use---comparison of this with the menus in Acrobat Reader or Exchange will show what they do. Obviously some are only appropriate to Exchange.
+
+\medskip
+\begin{longtable}{@{}l>{\raggedright\arraybackslash}p{9cm}@{}}
+File & Open, Close, Scan, Save, SaveAs, Optimizer:SaveAsOpt, Print, PageSetup, Quit \\
+File$\rightarrow$Import & ImportImage, ImportNotes, AcroForm:ImportFDF \\
+File$\rightarrow$Export & ExportNotes, AcroForm:ExportFDF \\
+File$\rightarrow$DocumentInfo & GeneralInfo, OpenInfo, FontsInfo, SecurityInfo, Weblink:Base, AutoIndex:DocInfo \\
+File$\rightarrow$Preferences & GeneralPrefs, NotePrefs, FullScreenPrefs, Weblink:Prefs, AcroSearch:Preferences(Windows)
+ or, AcroSearch:Prefs(Mac), Cpt:Capture \\
+Edit & Undo, Cut, Copy, Paste, Clear, SelectAll, Ole:CopyFile, TouchUp:TextAttributes,
+ TouchUp:FitTextToSelection, TouchUp:ShowLineMarkers, TouchUp:ShowCaptureSuspects,
+ TouchUp:FindSuspect, \\
+ & Properties \\
+Edit$\rightarrow$Fields & AcroForm:Duplicate, AcroForm:TabOrder \\
+Document & Cpt:CapturePages, AcroForm:Actions, CropPages, RotatePages, InsertPages, ExtractPages,
+ ReplacePages, DeletePages, NewBookmark, SetBookmarkDest, CreateAllThumbs,
+ DeleteAllThumbs \\
+View & ActualSize, FitVisible, FitWidth, FitPage, ZoomTo, FullScreen, FirstPage, PrevPage,
+ NextPage, LastPage, GoToPage, GoBack, GoForward, SinglePage, OneColumn, TwoColumns,
+ ArticleThreads, PageOnly, ShowBookmarks, ShowThumbs \\
+Tools & Hand, ZoomIn, ZoomOut, SelectText, SelectGraphics, Note, Link, Thread, AcroForm:Tool,
+ Acro\_Movie:MoviePlayer, TouchUp:TextTool, Find, FindAgain, FindNextNote,
+ CreateNotesFile \\
+Tools$\rightarrow$Search & AcroSrch:Query, AcroSrch:Indexes, AcroSrch:Results, AcroSrch:Assist, AcroSrch:PrevDoc,
+ AcroSrch:PrevHit, AcroSrch:NextHit, AcroSrch:NextDoc \\
+Window & ShowHideToolBar, ShowHideMenuBar, ShowHideClipboard, Cascade, TileHorizontal,
+ TileVertical, CloseAll \\
+Help & HelpUserGuide, HelpTutorial, HelpExchange, HelpScan, HelpCapture, HelpPDFWriter,
+ HelpDistiller, HelpSearch, HelpCatalog, HelpReader, Weblink:Home \\
+Help(Windows) & About
+\end{longtable}
+
+\section{PDF and HTML forms}
+You must put your fields inside a \texttt{Form} environment.
+The environment does some general setups, so should be used only once in a document.
+Using simply \cs{Form} at the begin of the document is possible too.
+
+There are six macros to prepare fields:
+
+\begin{cmdsyntax}
+\ci{TextField}\verb|[|\emph{parameters}\verb|]{|\emph{label}\verb|}|
+\end{cmdsyntax}
+
+\begin{cmdsyntax}
+\ci{CheckBox}\verb|[|\emph{parameters}\verb|]{|\emph{label}\verb|}|
+\end{cmdsyntax}
+
+\begin{cmdsyntax}
+\ci{ChoiceMenu}\verb|[|\emph{parameters}\verb|]{|\emph{label}\verb|}{|\emph{choices}\verb|}|
+\end{cmdsyntax}
+
+\begin{cmdsyntax}
+\ci{PushButton}\verb|[|\emph{parameters}\verb|]{|\emph{label}\verb|}|
+\end{cmdsyntax}
+
+\begin{cmdsyntax}
+\ci{Submit}\verb|[|\emph{parameters}\verb|]{|\emph{label}\verb|}|
+\end{cmdsyntax}
+
+\begin{cmdsyntax}
+\ci{Reset}\verb|[|\emph{parameters}\verb|]{|\emph{label}\verb|}|
+\end{cmdsyntax}
+
+The way forms and their labels are laid out is determined by:
+\begin{cmdsyntax}
+\ci{LayoutTextField}\verb|{|\emph{label}\verb|}{|\emph{field}\verb|}|
+\end{cmdsyntax}
+
+\begin{cmdsyntax}
+\ci{LayoutChoiceField}\verb|{|\emph{label}\verb|}{|\emph{field}\verb|}|
+\end{cmdsyntax}
+
+\begin{cmdsyntax}
+\ci{LayoutCheckField}\verb|{|\emph{label}\verb|}{|\emph{field}\verb|}|
+\end{cmdsyntax}
+
+These macros default to \#1 \#2
+
+What is actually shown in the field is determined by:
+\begin{cmdsyntax}
+\ci{MakeRadioField}\verb|{|\emph{width}\verb|}{|\emph{height}\verb|}|
+\end{cmdsyntax}
+
+\begin{cmdsyntax}
+\ci{MakeCheckField}\verb|{|\emph{width}\verb|}{|\emph{height}\verb|}|
+\end{cmdsyntax}
+\begin{cmdsyntax}
+\ci{MakeTextField}\verb|{|\emph{width}\verb|}{|\emph{height}\verb|}|
+\end{cmdsyntax}
+\begin{cmdsyntax}
+\ci{MakeChoiceField}\verb|{|\emph{width}\verb|}{|\emph{height}\verb|}|
+\end{cmdsyntax}
+
+\begin{cmdsyntax}
+\ci{MakeButtonField}\verb|{|\emph{text}\verb|}|
+\end{cmdsyntax}
+
+These macros default to \verb|\vbox to #2{\hbox to #1{\hfill}\vfill}|, except the
+last, which defaults to \#1; it is used for buttons, and the special \ci{Submit} and \ci{Reset}
+macros.
+
+You may also want to redefine the following macros:
+\begin{verbatim}
+\def\DefaultHeightofSubmit{12pt}
+\def\DefaultWidthofSubmit{2cm}
+\def\DefaultHeightofReset{12pt}
+\def\DefaultWidthofReset{2cm}
+\def\DefaultHeightofCheckBox{0.8\baselineskip}
+\def\DefaultWidthofCheckBox{0.8\baselineskip}
+\def\DefaultHeightofChoiceMenu{0.8\baselineskip}
+\def\DefaultWidthofChoiceMenu{0.8\baselineskip}
+\def\DefaultHeightofText{\baselineskip}
+\def\DefaultHeightofTextMultiline{4\baselineskip}
+\def\DefaultWidthofText{3cm}
+\end{verbatim}
+
+\subsection{Forms environment parameters}
+
+\smallskip
+\begin{longtable}{@{}>{\ttfamily}l>{\itshape}lp{9cm}@{}}
+action & URL & The URL that will receive the form data if a \textsf{Submit} button is included in the form \\
+encoding & name & The encoding for the string set to the URL; FDF-encoding is usual, and \texttt{html} is the only
+ valid value \\
+method & name & Used only when generating HTML; values can be \texttt{post} or \texttt{get} \\
+\end{longtable}
+
+\subsection{Forms optional parameters}
+Note that all colors must be expressed as RGB triples, in the range 0..1 (i.e.\ \texttt{color=0 0
+0.5})
+
+\smallskip
+\begin{longtable}{@{}>{\ttfamily}ll>{\itshape}ll@{}}
+accesskey & key & & (as per HTML) \\
+align & number & 0 & alignment within text field; 0 is left-aligned,\\*
+ & & & 1 is centered, 2 is right-aligned. \\
+altname & name & & alternative name,\\*
+ & & & the name shown in the user interface\\
+backgroundcolor & & & color of box \\
+bordercolor & & & color of border \\
+bordersep & & & box border gap \\
+borderstyle & char & S & box border style; S (Solid) is default, B is Beveled,\\
+ & & & D is Dashed, I is Inset and U is Underline \\
+borderwidth & & 1 & width of box border, the value is a dimension\\
+ & & & or a number with default unit bp\\
+calculate & & & JavaScript code to calculate the value of the field \\
+charsize & dimen & & font size of field text \\
+checkboxsymbol & char & 4 (\ding{\number`4}) & symbol used for check boxes (ZapfDingbats), \\
+&&& the value is a character or \cs{ding}\verb|{|\texttt{\itshape number}\verb|}|, \\
+&&& see package \xpackage{pifont} from bundle \xpackage{psnfss} \\
+checked & boolean & false & whether option selected by default \\
+color & & & color of text in box \\
+combo & boolean & false & choice list is `combo' style \\
+default & & & default value \\
+disabled & boolean & false & field disabled \\
+format & & & JavaScript code to format the field \\
+height & dimen & & height of field box \\
+hidden & boolean & false & field hidden \\
+keystroke & & & JavaScript code to control the keystrokes on entry \\
+mappingname & name & & the mapping name to be used when exporting\\*
+ & & & the field data\\
+maxlen & number & 0 & number of characters allowed in text field \\
+menulength & number & 4 & number of elements shown in list \\
+multiline & boolean & false & whether text box is multiline \\
+name & name & & name of field (defaults to label) \\
+onblur & & & JavaScript code \\
+onchange & & & JavaScript code \\
+onclick & & & JavaScript code \\
+ondblclick & & & JavaScript code \\
+onfocus & & & JavaScript code \\
+onkeydown & & & JavaScript code \\
+onkeypress & & & JavaScript code \\
+onkeyup & & & JavaScript code \\
+onmousedown & & & JavaScript code \\
+onmousemove & & & JavaScript code \\
+onmouseout & & & JavaScript code \\
+onmouseover & & & JavaScript code \\
+onmouseup & & & JavaScript code \\
+onselect & & & JavaScript code \\
+password & boolean & false & text field is `password' style \\
+popdown & boolean & false & choice list is `popdown' style \\
+radio & boolean & false & choice list is `radio' style \\
+radiosymbol & char & H (\ding{\number`H}) & symbol used for radio fields (ZapfDingbats), \\
+&&& the value is a character or \cs{ding}\verb|{|\texttt{\itshape number}\verb|}|, \\
+&&& see package \xpackage{pifont} from bundle \xpackage{psnfss} \\
+readonly & boolean & false & field is readonly \\
+rotation & number & 0 & rotation of the widget annotation \\*
+ & & & (degree, counterclockwise, multiple of 90)\\
+tabkey & & & (as per HTML) \\
+validate & & & JavaScript code to validate the entry \\
+value & & & initial value \\
+width & dimen & & width of field box
+\end{longtable}
+
+\section{Defining a new driver}
+A hyperref driver has to provide definitions for eight macros:
+
+\smallskip
+\noindent 1. \verb|\hyper at anchor|
+
+\noindent 2. \verb|\hyper at link|
+
+\noindent 3. \verb|\hyper at linkfile|
+
+\noindent 4. \verb|\hyper at linkurl|
+
+\noindent 5. \verb|\hyper at anchorstart|
+
+\noindent 6. \verb|\hyper at anchorend|
+
+\noindent 7. \verb|\hyper at linkstart|
+
+\noindent 8. \verb|\hyper at linkend|
+\smallskip
+
+The draft option defines the macros as follows
+\begin{verbatim}
+\let\hyper@@anchor\@gobble
+\gdef\hyper at link##1##2##3{##3}%
+\def\hyper at linkurl##1##2{##1}%
+\def\hyper at linkfile##1##2##3{##1}%
+\let\hyper at anchorstart\@gobble
+\let\hyper at anchorend\@empty
+\let\hyper at linkstart\@gobbletwo
+\let\hyper at linkend\@empty
+\end{verbatim}
+
+\section{Special support for other packages}
+
+Package \xpackage{hyperref} aims to cooperate with other packages, but there are
+several possible sources for conflict, such as
+
+\begin{itemize}
+
+\item Packages that manipulate the bibliographic mechanism. Peter
+William's \xpackage{harvard} package is supported. However, the
+recommended package is Patrick Daly's \xpackage{natbib} package that has
+specific \xpackage{hyperref} hooks to allow reliable interaction. This
+package covers a very wide variety of layouts and citation styles, all
+of which work with \xpackage{hyperref}.
+
+\item Packages that typeset the contents of the \ci{label} and \ci{ref}
+macros, such as \xpackage{showkeys}. Since the \xpackage{hyperref} package
+redefines these commands, you must set \texttt{implicit=false} for these
+packages to work.
+
+\item Packages that do anything serious with the index.
+\end{itemize}
+
+The \xpackage{hyperref} package is distributed with variants on two useful
+packages designed to work especially well with it. These are \xpackage{xr}
+and \xpackage{minitoc}, which support crossdocument links using \hologo{LaTeX}'s
+normal \cs{label}/\cs{ref} mechanisms and per-chapter tables of contents,
+respectively.
+
+
+\subsection{Package Compatibility}
+
+Currently only package loading orders are available:
+
+
+
+Note: hyperref loads package \xpackage{nameref} at \verb|\begin{document}|.
+Sometimes this is too late, thus this package must be loaded
+earlier.
+
+
+\subsubsection{algorithm}
+\begin{verbatim}
+ \usepackage{float}
+ \usepackage{hyperref}
+ \usepackage[chapter]{algorithm}% eg.
+\end{verbatim}
+
+\subsubsection{amsmath}
+
+ The environments equation and eqnarray are not supported too well.
+ For example, there might be spacing problems (eqnarray isn't recommended
+ anyway, see CTAN:info/l2tabu/, the situation for equation is unclear,
+ because nobody is interested in investigating). Consider using the
+ environments that package amsmath provide, e.g. gather for equation.
+ The environment equation can even redefined to use gather:
+
+\begin{verbatim}
+ \usepackage{amsmath}
+ \let\equation\gather
+ \let\endequation\endgather
+\end{verbatim}
+
+\subsubsection{amsrefs}
+
+ Package loading order:
+
+\begin{verbatim}
+ \usepackage{hyperref}
+ \usepackage{amsrefs}
+\end{verbatim}
+
+\subsubsection{arydshln, longtable}
+
+ Package longtable must be put before hyperref and arydshln,
+ hyperref after arydshln generates an error, thus the
+ resulting package order is then:
+
+\begin{verbatim}
+ \usepackage{longtable}
+ \usepackage{hyperref}
+ \usepackage{arydshln}
+\end{verbatim}
+
+\subsubsection{babel/magyar.ldf}
+
+ The old version 2005/03/30 v1.4j will not work.
+ You need at least version 1.5, maintained by P\'eter Szab\'o,
+ see CTAN:language/hungarian/babel/.
+
+
+\subsubsection{babel/spanish.ldf}
+
+ Babel's spanish.ldf redefines `\verb|\.|' to support `\verb|\...|'.
+ In bookmarks (\verb|\pdfstringdef|) only `\verb|\.|' is supported.
+ If `\verb|\...|' is needed,
+ \verb|\texorpdfstring{\...}{\dots}|
+ can be used instead.
+
+
+\subsubsection{bibentry}
+
+ Workaround:
+
+\begin{verbatim}
+ \makeatletter
+ \let\saved at bibitem\@bibitem
+ \makeatother
+
+ \usepackage{bibentry}
+ \usepackage{hyperref}
+
+ \begin{document}
+
+ \begingroup
+ \makeatletter
+ \let\@bibitem\saved at bibitem
+ \nobibliography{database}
+ \endgroup
+\end{verbatim}
+
+\subsubsection{bigfoot}
+
+ Hyperref does not support package `bigfoot'. And package
+ `bigfoot' does not support hyperref's footnotes and disables
+ them (hyperfootnotes=false).
+
+
+\subsubsection{chappg}
+
+ Package `chappg' uses \verb|\@addtoreset| that is redefined by `hyperref'.
+ The package order is therefore:
+
+\begin{verbatim}
+ \usepackage{hyperref}
+ \usepackage{chappg}
+\end{verbatim}
+
+\subsubsection{cite}
+
+ This is from Mike Shell:
+ cite.sty cannot currently be used with hyperref.
+ However, I can do a workaround via:
+
+\begin{verbatim}
+ \makeatletter
+ \def\NAT at parse{\typeout{This is a fake Natbib command to fool Hyperref.}}
+ \makeatother
+
+ \usepackage[hypertex]{hyperref}
+\end{verbatim}
+
+ so that hyperref will not redefine any of the biblabel stuff - so cite.sty
+ will work as normal - although the citations will not be hyperlinked, of
+ course (But this may not be an issue for many people).
+
+
+\subsubsection{count1to}
+
+ Package `count1to' adds several \verb|\@addtoreset| commands that confuse
+ `hyperref'. Therefore \verb|\theH<...>| has to be fixed:
+
+\begin{verbatim}
+ \usepackage{count1to}
+ \AtBeginDocument{% *after* \usepackage{count1to}
+ \renewcommand*{\theHsection}{\theHchapter.\arabic{section}}%
+ \renewcommand*{\theHsubsection}{\theHsection.\arabic{subsection}}%
+ \renewcommand*{\theHsubsubsection}{\theHsubsection.\arabic{subsubsection}}%
+ \renewcommand*{\theHparagraph}{\theHsubsubsection.\arabic{paragraph}}%
+ \renewcommand*{\theHsubparagraph}{\theHparagraph.\arabic{subparagraph}}%
+ }
+\end{verbatim}
+
+\subsubsection{dblaccnt}
+
+ pd1enc.def or puenc.def should be loaded before:
+\begin{verbatim}
+ \usepackage{hyperref}
+ \usepackage{dblaccnt}
+\end{verbatim}
+ or see entry for \xoption{vietnam}.
+
+
+\subsubsection{easyeqn}
+ Not compatible, breaks.
+
+
+\subsubsection{ellipsis}
+
+ This packages redefines \verb|\textellipsis|
+ after package hyperref (pd1enc.def/puenc.def should be loaded before):
+\begin{verbatim}
+ \usepackage{hyperref}
+ \usepackage{ellipsis}
+\end{verbatim}
+
+\subsubsection{float}
+\begin{verbatim}
+ \usepackage{float}
+ \usepackage{hyperref}
+\end{verbatim}
+\begin{itemize}
+ \item Several \verb|\caption| commands are not supported inside one float object.
+ \item Anchor are set at top of the float object, if its style is controlled
+ by float.sty.
+\end{itemize}
+
+\subsubsection{endnotes}
+ Unsupported.
+
+\subsubsection{foiltex}
+ Update to version 2008/01/28 v2.1.4b:
+ Since version 6.77a hyperref does not hack into \verb|\@begindvi|,
+ it uses package `atbegshi' instead, that hooks into \verb|\shipout|.
+ Thus the patch of `foils.cls' regarding hyperref is now obsolete
+ and causes an undefined error message about \verb|\@hyperfixhead|.
+ This is fixed in FoilTeX 2.1.4b.
+
+
+\subsubsection{footnote}
+
+ This package is not supported, you have to disable hyperref's footnote
+ support by using option \verb"hyperfootnotes=false".
+
+
+\subsubsection{geometry}
+
+ Driver `dvipdfm' and program `dvipdfm' might generate a warning:
+ Sorry. Too late to change page size
+ Then prefer the program `dvipdfmx' or use one of the following
+ workarounds to move the \verb|\special| of geometry to an earlier
+ location:
+
+\begin{verbatim}
+ \documentclass[dvipdfm]{article}% or other classes
+ \usepackage{atbegshi}
+ \AtBeginDocument{%
+ \let\OrgAtBeginDvi\AtBeginDvi
+ \let\AtBeginDvi\AtBeginShipoutFirst
+ }
+ \usepackage[
+ paperwidth=170mm,
+ paperheight=240mm
+ ]{geometry}
+ \AtBeginDocument{%
+ \let\AtBeginDvi\OrgAtBeginDvi
+ }
+ \usepackage{hyperref}
+
+ or
+
+ \documentclass[dvipdfm]{article}% or other classes
+ \usepackage{atbegshi}
+ \let\AtBeginDvi\AtBeginShipoutFirst
+ \usepackage[
+ paperwidth=170mm,
+ paperheight=240mm
+ ]{geometry}
+ \usepackage{hyperref}
+\end{verbatim}
+
+\subsubsection{IEEEtran.cls}
+
+ version $\ge$ V1.6b (because of \verb|\@makecaption|, see ChangeLog)
+
+
+\subsubsection{index}
+
+ version $\ge$ 1995/09/28 v4.1 (because of \verb|\addcontentsline| redefinition)
+
+
+\subsubsection{lastpage}
+
+ Compatible.
+
+
+\subsubsection{linguex}
+\begin{verbatim}
+ \usepackage{hyperref}
+ \usepackage{linguex}
+\end{verbatim}
+
+\subsubsection{ltabptch}
+\begin{verbatim}
+ \usepackage{longtable}
+ \usepackage{ltabptch}
+ \usepackage{hyperref}
+\end{verbatim}
+
+\subsubsection{mathenv}
+
+ Unsupported.
+
+
+
+ Both `mathenv' and `hyperref' messes around with
+ environment `eqnarray'. You can load `mathenv' after
+ `hyperref' to avoid an error message. But \verb|\label|
+ will not work inside environment `eqnarray' properly,
+ for example.
+
+
+\subsubsection{minitoc-hyper}
+
+ This package is obsolete, use the up-to-date original
+ package minitoc instead.
+
+
+
+\subsubsection{multind}
+\begin{verbatim}
+ \usepackage{multind}
+ \usepackage{hyperref}
+\end{verbatim}
+
+\subsubsection{natbib}
+\begin{verbatim}
+ \usepackage{natbib}
+ \usepackage{hyperref}
+\end{verbatim}
+
+\subsubsection{nomencl}
+Example for introducing links for the page numbers:
+\begin{verbatim}
+ \renewcommand*{\pagedeclaration}[1]{\unskip, \hyperpage{#1}}
+\end{verbatim}
+
+
+\subsubsection{ntheorem-hyper}
+ This package is obsolete, use the up-to-date original
+ package ntheorem instead.
+
+
+For equations the following might work:
+\begin{verbatim}
+ \renewcommand*{\eqdeclaration}[1]{%
+ \hyperlink{equation.#1}{(Equation~#1)}%
+ }
+ But the mapping from the equation number to the anchor name
+ is not available in general.
+\end{verbatim}
+
+\subsubsection{parskip}
+\begin{verbatim}
+ \usepackage{parskip}
+ \usepackage{hyperref}[2012/08/20]
+\end{verbatim}
+
+
+ Both packages want to redefine \verb|\@starttoc|.
+
+
+\subsubsection{prettyref}
+\begin{verbatim}
+%%% example for prettyref %%%
+\documentclass{article}
+\usepackage{prettyref}
+\usepackage[pdftex]{hyperref}
+
+%\newrefformat{FIG}{Figure~\ref{#1}}% without hyperref
+\newrefformat{FIG}{\hyperref[{#1}]{Figure~\ref*{#1}}}
+
+\begin{document}
+ This is a reference to \prettyref{FIG:ONE}.
+ \newpage
+ \begin{figure}
+ \caption{This is my figure}
+ \label{FIG:ONE}
+ \end{figure}
+\end{document}
+%%% example for prettyref %%%
+ \end{verbatim}
+
+
+\subsubsection{setspace}
+\begin{verbatim}
+ \usepackage{setspace}
+ \usepackage{hyperref}
+\end{verbatim}
+
+\subsubsection{sidecap}
+\begin{verbatim}
+ Before 2002/05/24 v1.5h:
+ \usepackage{nameref}
+ \usepackage{hyperref}
+ \usepackage{sidecap}
+\end{verbatim}
+
+\subsubsection{subfigure}
+\begin{verbatim}
+ 1995/03/06 v2.0:
+ \usepackage{subfigure}
+ \usepackage{hyperref}
+ % hypertexnames is set to false.
+ v2.1:
+ \usepackage{nameref}
+ \usepackage{subfigure}
+ \usepackage{hyperref}
+ or
+ \usepackage{hyperref}
+ \usepackage{subfigure}
+ v2.1.2:
+ please update
+ v2.1.3:
+ \usepackage{hyperref}
+ \usepackage{subfigure}
+ or vice versa?
+\end{verbatim}
+
+\subsubsection{titleref}
+\begin{verbatim}
+ \usepackage{nameref}
+ \usepackage{titleref}% without usetoc
+ \usepackage{hyperref}
+\end{verbatim}
+
+\subsubsection{tabularx}
+
+ Linked footnotes are not supported inside environment `tabularx',
+ because they uses the optional argument of \verb|\footnotetext|, see
+ section `Limitations'. Before version 2011/09/28 6.82i
+ hyperref had disabled footnotes entirely by `hyperfootnotes=false'.
+
+
+\subsubsection{titlesec}
+
+ \xpackage{nameref} supports titlesec, but hyperref does not
+ (unsolved is the anchor setting, missing with unnumbered
+ section, perhaps problems with page breaks with numbered ones).
+
+
+\subsubsection{ucs/utf8x.def}
+
+ The first time a multibyte UTF8 sequence is called, it
+ does some calculations and stores the result in a macro
+ for speeding up the next calls of that UTF8 sequence.
+ However this makes the first call non-expandable and
+ will break if used in information entries or bookmarks.
+ Package \xpackage{ucs} offers \verb|\PrerenderUnicode| or \verb|\PreloadUnicodePage|
+ to solve this:
+\begin{verbatim}
+ \usepackage{ucs}
+ \usepackage[utf8x]{inputenc}
+ \usepackage{hyperref}% or with option unicode
+ \PrerenderUnicode{^^c3^^b6}% or \PrerenderUnicodePage{1}
+ \hypersetup{pdftitle={Umlaut example: ^^c3^^b6}}
+\end{verbatim}
+ The notation with two carets avoids trouble with 8-bit bytes
+ for the README file, you can use the characters directly.
+
+
+\subsubsection{varioref}
+ There are too many problems with varioref. Nobody has time to
+ sort them out. Therefore this package is now unsupported.
+
+
+ Perhaps you are lucky and some of the features of varioref works
+ with the following loading order:
+\begin{verbatim}
+ \usepackage{nameref}
+ \usepackage{varioref}
+ \usepackage{hyperref}
+\end{verbatim}
+
+
+ Also some babel versions can be problematic. For example,
+ 2005/05/21 v3.8g contains a patch for varioref that breaks
+ the hyperref support for varioref.
+
+
+
+ Also unsupported:
+\begin{itemize}
+\item \verb|\Ref|, \verb|\Vref| do not uppercase the first letter.
+\item \verb|\vpageref[]{...}|
+ On the same page a previous space is not suppressed.
+\end{itemize}
+
+\subsubsection{verse}
+
+ Version 2005/08/22 v2.22 contains support for hyperref.
+
+ For older versions see example from
+ de.comp.text.tex (2005/08/11, slightly modified):
+
+\begin{verbatim}
+ \documentclass{article}
+
+ % package order does not matter
+ \usepackage{verse}
+ \usepackage{hyperref}
+
+ \makeatletter
+ % make unique poemline anchors
+ \newcounter{verse at env}
+ \setcounter{verse at env}{0}
+ \let\org at verse\verse
+ \def\verse{%
+ \stepcounter{verse at env}%
+ \org at verse
+ }
+ \def\theHpoemline{\arabic{verse at env}.\thepoemline}
+
+ % add anchor for before \addcontentsline in \@vsptitle
+ \let\org at vsptitle\@vsptitle
+ \def\@vsptitle{%
+ \phantomsection
+ \org at vsptitle
+ }
+ \makeatother
+
+ \begin{document}
+
+ \poemtitle{Poem 1}
+ \begin{verse}
+ An one-liner.
+ \end{verse}
+
+ \newpage
+
+ \poemtitle{Poem 2}
+ \begin{verse}
+ Another one-liner.
+ \end{verse}
+
+ \end{document}
+\end{verbatim}
+
+\subsubsection{vietnam}
+\begin{verbatim}
+ % pd1enc.def should be loaded before package dblaccnt:
+ \usepackage[PD1,OT1]{fontenc}
+ \usepackage{vietnam}
+ \usepackage{hyperref}
+\end{verbatim}
+
+\subsubsection{XeTeX}
+
+ Default for the encoding of bookmarks is \verb|pdfencoding=unicode|.
+ That means the strings are always treated as unicode strings.
+ If \verb|auto| or \verb|pdfdoc| is forced it applies only
+ if the string restricts to the printable ASCII set,
+ The reason is that the \verb|\special| does not support PDFDocEncoding.
+
+ In older versions hyperref contained special conversion code from
+ UTF-16BE back to UTF-8 in a number of places for
+ xetex to avoid the xdvipdfmx warning
+
+ \verb"Failed to convert input string to UTF16..."
+
+ This is no longer needed with a current xdvipdfmx, so this code has
+ been removed. \verb|\csname HyPsd at XeTeXBigCharstrue\endcsname| should no
+ longer be used.
+
+
+\section[Limitations]{Limitations%
+\footnote{This section moved from the README file, needs more integration into the manual}}
+\subsection{Wrapped/broken link support}
+
+ Only few drivers support automatically wrapped/broken links,
+ e.g. pdftex, dvipdfm, hypertex. Other drivers lack this
+ feature, e.g. dvips, dvipsone.
+
+ Workarounds:
+\begin{itemize}
+\item For long section or caption titles in the table of contents
+ or list of figures/tables option \xoption{linktocpage} can be used.
+ Then the page number will be a link, and the overlong section
+ title is not forced into an one line link with overfull \verb|\hbox|
+ warning.
+\item ``\verb|\url|''s are caught by package \xpackage{breakurl}.
+\item The option \xoption{breaklinks} is intended for internal use. But it
+ can be used to force link wrapping, e.g. when printing a
+ document. However, when such a document is converted to PDF
+ and viewed with a PDF viewer, the active link area will be
+ misplaced.
+
+ Another limitation: some penalties are ``optimized'' by TeX,
+ thus there are missing break points, especially within
+ \verb|\url|. (See thread ``hyperref.sty, breaklinks and url.sty 3.2''
+ in comp.text.tex 2005-09).
+\end{itemize}
+
+\subsection{Links across pages}
+
+ In general they have problems:
+\begin{itemize}
+ \item Some driver doesn't support them at all (see above).
+ \item The driver allows it, but the link result might include
+ the footer and/or header, or an error message can
+ occur sometimes.
+\end{itemize}
+
+\subsection{Footnotes}
+
+ LaTeX allows the separation of the footnote mark and the
+ footnote text (\verb|\footnotemark|, \verb|\footnotetext|). This interface
+ might be enough for visual typesetting. But the relation between
+ \verb|\footnotemark| to \verb|\footnotetext| is not as strong as \verb|\ref| to \verb|\label|.
+ Therefore it is not clear in general which \verb|\footnotemark| references
+ which \verb|\footnotetext|. But that is necessary to implement hyperlinking.
+ Thus the implementation of hyperref does not support the optional
+ argument of \verb|\footnotemark| and \verb|\footnotetext|.
+
+
+\section[Hints]{Hints%
+\footnote{This section moved from the README file, needs more integration into the manual}}
+
+\subsection{Spaces in option values}
+
+ Unhappily LaTeX strips spaces from options if they are given
+ in \verb|\documentclass| or \verb|\usepackage| (or \verb|\RequirePackage|), e.g.:
+\begin{verbatim}
+ \usepackage[pdfborder=0 0 1]{hyperref}
+\end{verbatim}
+ Package hyperref now gets
+\begin{verbatim}
+ pdfborder=001
+\end{verbatim}
+ and the result is an invalid PDF file.
+ As workaround braces can be used:
+\begin{verbatim}
+ \usepackage[pdfborder={0 0 1}]{hyperref}
+\end{verbatim}
+ Some options can also be given in \verb|\hypersetup|
+\begin{verbatim}
+ \hypersetup{pdfborder=0 0 1}
+\end{verbatim}
+ In \verb|\hypersetup| the options are directly processed as key value
+ options (see package keyval) without space stripping in the value part.
+
+
+
+ Alternatively, LaTeX's option handling system can be adapted
+ to key value options by one of the packages \xpackage{kvoptions-patch}
+ (from project \xpackage{kvoptions}) or \xpackage{xkvltxp} (from project \xpackage{xsetkeys}).
+
+
+\subsection{Index with makeindex}
+\begin{itemize}
+ \item Package hyperref adds \verb|\hyperpage| commands by the encap
+ mechanism (see documentation of Makeindex),
+ if option hyperindex is set (default).
+ \verb|\hyperpage| uses the page anchors that are set by
+ hyperref at each page (default). However in the
+ default case page numbers are used in anchor names
+ in arabic form. If the page numbers in other formats
+ are used (book class with \verb|\frontmatter|, \verb|\romannumbering|, ...),
+ then the page anchors are not unique. Therefore option
+ \verb"plainpages=false" is recommended.
+ \item The encap mechanism of Makeindex allows to use one command only
+ (see documentation of Makeindex).
+ If the user sets such a command, hyperref suppresses its
+ \verb|\hyperpage| command. With logical markup this situation
+ can easily be solved:
+\begin{verbatim}
+ \usepackage{makeidx}
+ \makeindex
+ \usepackage[hyperindex]{hyperref}
+ \newcommand*{\main}[1]{\textbf{\hyperpage{#1}}}
+ ...
+ \index{Some example|main}
+\end{verbatim}
+ \item Scientic Word/Scientific WorkPlace users can use
+ package robustindex with hyperindex=false.
+ \item Other encap characters can be set by option \xoption{encap}.
+ Example for use of ``?'':
+\begin{verbatim}
+ \usepackage[encap=?]{hyperref}
+\end{verbatim}
+ \item Another possibility is the insertion of \verb|\hyperpage| by
+ a style file for makeindex. For this case, hyperref's
+ insertion will be disabled by \verb"hyperindex=false".
+ \verb|\hyperpage| will be defined regardless of setting of hyperindex.
+\begin{verbatim}
+%%% cut %%% hyperindex.ist %%% cut %%%
+delim_0 ", \\hyperpage{"
+delim_1 ", \\hyperpage{"
+delim_2 ", \\hyperpage{"
+delim_n "}, \\hyperpage{"
+delim_t "}"
+encap_prefix "}\\"
+encap_infix "{\\hyperpage{"
+encap_suffix "}"
+%%% cut %%% hyperindex.ist %%% cut %%%
+\end{verbatim}
+\end{itemize}
+
+\subsection{Warning \texttt{"bookmark level for unknown <foobar> defaults to 0"}}
+
+ Getting rid of it:
+\begin{verbatim}
+\makeatletter
+\providecommand*{\toclevel@<foobar>}{0}
+\makeatother
+\end{verbatim}
+
+\subsection{Link anchors in figures}
+
+ The caption command increments the counter and here is the
+ place where hyperref set the corresponding anchor. Unhappily
+ the caption is set below the figure, so the figure is not
+ visible if a link jumps to a figure.
+ In this case, try package \xpackage{hypcap} that implements
+ a method to circumvent the problem.
+
+
+\subsection{Additional unicode characters in bookmarks and pdf information entries:}
+\begin{verbatim}
+\documentclass[pdftex]{article}
+\usepackage[unicode]{hyperref}
+\end{verbatim}
+
+Support for additional unicode characters:
+
+ Example: \verb|\.{a}| and \verb|\d{a}|
+
+ 1. Get a list with unicode data, eg:
+
+ http://www.unicode.org/Public/UNIDATA/UnicodeData.txt
+
+ 2. Identify the characters (\verb|\.{a}|, \verb|\d{a}|):
+\begin{verbatim}
+ 0227;LATIN SMALL LETTER A WITH DOT ABOVE;...
+ 1EA1;LATIN SMALL LETTER A WITH DOT BELOW;...
+\end{verbatim}
+
+ 3. Calculate the octal code:
+
+ The first characters of the line in the file are
+ hex values, convert each byte and prepend them
+ with a backslash. (This will go into the PDF file.)
+
+\begin{verbatim}
+ 0227 -> \002\047
+ 1EA1 -> \036\241
+\end{verbatim}
+
+ 4. Transform into a form understood by hyperref:
+
+ Hyperref must know where the first byte starts,
+ this is marked by \verb"9" (8 and 9 cannot occur in
+ octal numbers):
+
+\begin{verbatim}
+ \002\047 -> \9002\047
+ \036\241 -> \9036\241
+\end{verbatim}
+
+ Optional: \verb"8" is used for abbreviations:
+
+\begin{verbatim}
+ \900 = \80, \901 = \81, \902 = \82, ...
+
+ \9002\047 -> \82\047
+\end{verbatim}
+
+ 5. Declare the character with LaTeX:
+
+\begin{verbatim}
+\DeclareTextCompositeCommand{\.}{PU}{a}{\82\047}
+\DeclareTextCompositeCommand{\d}{PU}{a}{\9036\241}
+
+\begin{document}
+\section{\={a}, \d{a}, \'{a}, \.{a}}
+\end{document}
+ \end{verbatim}
+
+\subsection{Footnotes}
+
+ The footnote support is rather limited. It is beyond the scope
+ to use \verb|\footnotemark| and \verb|\footnotetext| out of order or reusing
+ \verb|\footnotemark|. Here you can either disable hyperref's footnote
+ support by \verb"hyperfootnotes=false" or fiddle with internal macros,
+ nasty examples:
+
+\begin{verbatim}
+\documentclass{article}
+\usepackage{hyperref}
+\begin{document}
+Hello%
+\footnote{The first footnote}
+World%
+\addtocounter{footnote}{-1}%
+\addtocounter{Hfootnote}{-1}%
+\footnotemark.
+\end{document}
+
+ or
+
+\documentclass{article}
+
+\usepackage{hyperref}
+
+\begin{document}
+
+\makeatletter
+
+A%
+ \footnotemark
+ \let\saved at Href@A\Hy at footnote@currentHref
+ % remember link name
+B%
+ \footnotemark
+ \let\saved at Href@B\Hy at footnote@currentHref
+b%
+ \addtocounter{footnote}{-1}%
+ \addtocounter{Hfootnote}{-1}% generate the same anchor
+ \footnotemark
+C%
+ \footnotemark
+ \let\saved at Href@C\Hy at footnote@currentHref
+
+ \addtocounter{footnote}{-2}%
+ \let\Hy at footnote@currentHref\saved at Href@A
+\footnotetext{AAAA}%
+ \addtocounter{footnote}{1}%
+ \let\Hy at footnote@currentHref\saved at Href@B
+\footnotetext{BBBBB}%
+ \addtocounter{footnote}{1}%
+ \let\Hy at footnote@currentHref\saved at Href@C
+\footnotetext{CCCC}%
+
+\end{document}
+\end{verbatim}
+
+\subsection{Subordinate counters}
+
+ Some counters do not have unique values and require the value
+ of other counters to be unique. For example, sections or figures
+ might be numbered within chapters or \verb|\newtheorem| is used with
+ an optional counter argument. Internally LaTeX uses \verb|\@addtoreset|
+ to reset a counter in dependency to another counter. Package
+ hyperref hooks into \verb|\@addtoreset| to catch this situation.
+ Also \verb|\numberwithin| of package amsmath is caught by hyperref.
+
+
+
+ However, if the definition of subordinate counters take place
+ before hyperref is loaded, the old meaning of \verb|\@addtoreset| is
+ called without hyperref's additions. Then the companion counter
+ macro \verb|\theH<counter>| can be redefined accordingly. Or move the
+ definition of subordinate counters after hyperref is loaded.
+
+ Example for \verb|\newtheorem|, problematic case:
+\begin{verbatim}
+ \newtheorem{corA}{CorollaryA}[section]
+ \usepackage{hyperref}
+\end{verbatim}
+ Solution a)
+\begin{verbatim}
+ \usepackage{hyperref}
+ \newtheorem{corA}{CorollaryA}[section}
+\end{verbatim}
+ Solution b)
+\begin{verbatim}
+ \newtheorem{corA}{CorollaryA}[section]
+ \usepackage{hyperref}
+ \newcommand*{\theHcorA}{\theHsection.\number\value{corA}}
+\end{verbatim}
+
+\section{History and acknowledgments}
+
+The original authors of \textsf{hyperbasics.tex} and
+\textsf{hypertex.sty}, from which this package descends, are Tanmoy
+Bhattacharya and Thorsten Ohl. Package \xpackage{hyperref}
+started as a simple port of their work to \hologo{LaTeXe} standards, but
+eventually I rewrote nearly everything, because I didn't understand a
+lot of the original, and was only interested in getting it to work with
+\hologo{LaTeX}. I would like to thank Arthur Smith, Tanmoy Bhattacharya, Mark
+Doyle, Paul Ginsparg, David Carlisle, T.\ V.\ Raman and Leslie Lamport
+for comments, requests, thoughts and code to get the package into its
+first useable state. Various other people are mentioned at the point in
+the source where I had to change the code in later versions because of
+problems they found.
+
+Tanmoy found a great many of the bugs, and (even better) often provided
+fixes, which has made the package more robust. The days spent on
+Rev\TeX\ are entirely due to him! The investigations of Bill Moss
+into the later versions including
+native PDF support uncovered a good many bugs, and his testing is
+appreciated. Hans Hagen provided a lot of
+insight into PDF.
+
+Berthold Horn provided help, encouragement and sponsorship for the
+\textsf{dvipsone} and \textsf{dviwindo} drivers. Sergey Lesenko provided
+the changes needed for \textsf{dvipdf}, and \Hologo{HanTheThanh} supplied all the
+information needed for \textsf{pdftex}. Patrick Daly kindly updated his
+\xpackage{natbib} package to allow easy integration with
+\xpackage{hyperref}. Michael Mehlich's \xpackage{hyper} package (developed
+in parallel with \textsf{hyperref}) showed me solutions for some
+problems. Hopefully the two packages will combine one day.
+
+The forms creation section owes a great deal to: T.\ V.\ Raman, for
+encouragement, support and ideas; Thomas Merz, whose book \emph{Web
+Publishing with Acrobat/PDF} provided crucial insights; D.\ P.\ Story,
+whose detailed article about pdfmarks and forms solved many practical
+problems; and Hans Hagen, who explained how to do it in \textsf{pdftex}.
+
+Steve Peter recreated the manual source in July 2003 after it had been
+lost.
+
+Especial extra thanks to David Carlisle for the \xpackage{backref} module,
+the ps2pdf and dviwindo support, frequent general rewrites of my bad
+code, and for working on changes to the \xpackage{xr} package to suit
+\xpackage{hyperref}.
+
+\begingroup
+ \makeatletter
+ \let\chapter=\section
+ % subsections goes into bookmarks but not toc
+ \hypersetup{bookmarksopenlevel=1}
+ \addtocontents{toc}{\protect\setcounter{tocdepth}{1}}
+ % The \section command acts as \subsection.
+ % Additionally the title is converted to lowercase except
+ % for the first letter.
+ \def\section{%
+ \let\section\lc at subsection
+ \lc at subsection
+ }
+ \def\lc at subsection{%
+ \@ifstar{\def\mystar{*}\lc at sec}%
+ {\let\mystar\@empty\lc at sec}%
+ }
+ \def\lc at sec#1{%
+ \lc@@sec#1\@nil
+ }
+ \def\lc@@sec#1#2\@nil{%
+ \begingroup
+ \def\a{#1}%
+ \lowercase{%
+ \edef\x{\endgroup
+ \noexpand\subsection\mystar{\a#2}%
+ }%
+ }%
+ \x
+ }
+\clearpage
+
+
+\chapter{GNU Free Documentation License}
+
+Version 1.2, November 2002
+
+
+ Copyright \copyright\ 2000,2001,2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.\\
+ 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA\\
+ Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim copies
+ of this license document, but changing it is not allowed.
+
+
+\section*{PREAMBLE}
+
+The purpose of this License is to make a manual, textbook, or other
+functional and useful document ``free'' in the sense of freedom: to
+assure everyone the effective freedom to copy and redistribute it,
+with or without modifying it, either commercially or noncommercially.
+Secondarily, this License preserves for the author and publisher a way
+to get credit for their work, while not being considered responsible
+for modifications made by others.
+
+This License is a kind of ``copyleft'', which means that derivative
+works of the document must themselves be free in the same sense. It
+complements the GNU General Public License, which is a copyleft
+license designed for free software.
+
+We have designed this License in order to use it for manuals for free
+software, because free software needs free documentation: a free
+program should come with manuals providing the same freedoms that the
+software does. But this License is not limited to software manuals;
+it can be used for any textual work, regardless of subject matter or
+whether it is published as a printed book. We recommend this License
+principally for works whose purpose is instruction or reference.
+
+
+\section{APPLICABILITY AND DEFINITIONS}
+\label{applicability}
+
+This License applies to any manual or other work, in any medium, that
+contains a notice placed by the copyright holder saying it can be
+distributed under the terms of this License. Such a notice grants a
+world-wide, royalty-free license, unlimited in duration, to use that
+work under the conditions stated herein. The ``Document'', below,
+refers to any such manual or work. Any member of the public is a
+licensee, and is addressed as ``you''. You accept the license if you
+copy, modify or distribute the work in a way requiring permission
+under copyright law.
+
+A ``Modified Version'' of the Document means any work containing the
+Document or a portion of it, either copied verbatim, or with
+modifications and/or translated into another language.
+
+A ``Secondary Section'' is a named appendix or a front-matter section of
+the Document that deals exclusively with the relationship of the
+publishers or authors of the Document to the Document's overall subject
+(or to related matters) and contains nothing that could fall directly
+within that overall subject. (Thus, if the Document is in part a
+textbook of mathematics, a Secondary Section may not explain any
+mathematics.) The relationship could be a matter of historical
+connection with the subject or with related matters, or of legal,
+commercial, philosophical, ethical or political position regarding
+them.
+
+The ``Invariant Sections'' are certain Secondary Sections whose titles
+are designated, as being those of Invariant Sections, in the notice
+that says that the Document is released under this License. If a
+section does not fit the above definition of Secondary then it is not
+allowed to be designated as Invariant. The Document may contain zero
+Invariant Sections. If the Document does not identify any Invariant
+Sections then there are none.
+
+The ``Cover Texts'' are certain short passages of text that are listed,
+as Front-Cover Texts or Back-Cover Texts, in the notice that says that
+the Document is released under this License. A Front-Cover Text may
+be at most 5 words, and a Back-Cover Text may be at most 25 words.
+
+A ``Transparent'' copy of the Document means a machine-readable copy,
+represented in a format whose specification is available to the
+general public, that is suitable for revising the document
+straightforwardly with generic text editors or (for images composed of
+pixels) generic paint programs or (for drawings) some widely available
+drawing editor, and that is suitable for input to text formatters or
+for automatic translation to a variety of formats suitable for input
+to text formatters. A copy made in an otherwise Transparent file
+format whose markup, or absence of markup, has been arranged to thwart
+or discourage subsequent modification by readers is not Transparent.
+An image format is not Transparent if used for any substantial amount
+of text. A copy that is not ``Transparent'' is called ``Opaque''.
+
+Examples of suitable formats for Transparent copies include plain
+ASCII without markup, Texinfo input format, \LaTeX\ input format, SGML
+or XML using a publicly available DTD, and standard-conforming simple
+HTML, PostScript or PDF designed for human modification. Examples of
+transparent image formats include PNG, XCF and JPG. Opaque formats
+include proprietary formats that can be read and edited only by
+proprietary word processors, SGML or XML for which the DTD and/or
+processing tools are not generally available, and the
+machine-generated HTML, PostScript or PDF produced by some word
+processors for output purposes only.
+
+The ``Title Page'' means, for a printed book, the title page itself,
+plus such following pages as are needed to hold, legibly, the material
+this License requires to appear in the title page. For works in
+formats which do not have any title page as such, ``Title Page'' means
+the text near the most prominent appearance of the work's title,
+preceding the beginning of the body of the text.
+
+A section ``Entitled XYZ'' means a named subunit of the Document whose
+title either is precisely XYZ or contains XYZ in parentheses following
+text that translates XYZ in another language. (Here XYZ stands for a
+specific section name mentioned below, such as ``Acknowledgements'',
+``Dedications'', ``Endorsements'', or ``History''.) To ``Preserve the Title''
+of such a section when you modify the Document means that it remains a
+section ``Entitled XYZ'' according to this definition.
+
+The Document may include Warranty Disclaimers next to the notice which
+states that this License applies to the Document. These Warranty
+Disclaimers are considered to be included by reference in this
+License, but only as regards disclaiming warranties: any other
+implication that these Warranty Disclaimers may have is void and has
+no effect on the meaning of this License.
+
+
+\section{VERBATIM COPYING}
+\label{verbatim}
+
+You may copy and distribute the Document in any medium, either
+commercially or noncommercially, provided that this License, the
+copyright notices, and the license notice saying this License applies
+to the Document are reproduced in all copies, and that you add no other
+conditions whatsoever to those of this License. You may not use
+technical measures to obstruct or control the reading or further
+copying of the copies you make or distribute. However, you may accept
+compensation in exchange for copies. If you distribute a large enough
+number of copies you must also follow the conditions in
+section~\ref{copying}.
+
+You may also lend copies, under the same conditions stated above, and
+you may publicly display copies.
+
+
+\section{COPYING IN QUANTITY}
+\label{copying}
+
+If you publish printed copies (or copies in media that commonly have
+printed covers) of the Document, numbering more than 100, and the
+Document's license notice requires Cover Texts, you must enclose the
+copies in covers that carry, clearly and legibly, all these Cover
+Texts: Front-Cover Texts on the front cover, and Back-Cover Texts on
+the back cover. Both covers must also clearly and legibly identify
+you as the publisher of these copies. The front cover must present
+the full title with all words of the title equally prominent and
+visible. You may add other material on the covers in addition.
+Copying with changes limited to the covers, as long as they preserve
+the title of the Document and satisfy these conditions, can be treated
+as verbatim copying in other respects.
+
+If the required texts for either cover are too voluminous to fit
+legibly, you should put the first ones listed (as many as fit
+reasonably) on the actual cover, and continue the rest onto adjacent
+pages.
+
+If you publish or distribute Opaque copies of the Document numbering
+more than 100, you must either include a machine-readable Transparent
+copy along with each Opaque copy, or state in or with each Opaque copy
+a computer-network location from which the general network-using
+public has access to download using public-standard network protocols
+a complete Transparent copy of the Document, free of added material.
+If you use the latter option, you must take reasonably prudent steps,
+when you begin distribution of Opaque copies in quantity, to ensure
+that this Transparent copy will remain thus accessible at the stated
+location until at least one year after the last time you distribute an
+Opaque copy (directly or through your agents or retailers) of that
+edition to the public.
+
+It is requested, but not required, that you contact the authors of the
+Document well before redistributing any large number of copies, to give
+them a chance to provide you with an updated version of the Document.
+
+
+\section{MODIFICATIONS}
+\label{modifications}
+
+You may copy and distribute a Modified Version of the Document under
+the conditions of sections~\ref{verbatim} and \ref{copying} above,
+provided that you release
+the Modified Version under precisely this License, with the Modified
+Version filling the role of the Document, thus licensing distribution
+and modification of the Modified Version to whoever possesses a copy
+of it. In addition, you must do these things in the Modified Version:
+
+\renewcommand{\labelenumi}{\Alph{enumi}.}
+\begin{enumerate}
+\item Use in the Title Page (and on the covers, if any) a title distinct
+ from that of the Document, and from those of previous versions
+ (which should, if there were any, be listed in the History section
+ of the Document). You may use the same title as a previous version
+ if the original publisher of that version gives permission.
+\item List on the Title Page, as authors, one or more persons or entities
+ responsible for authorship of the modifications in the Modified
+ Version, together with at least five of the principal authors of the
+ Document (all of its principal authors, if it has fewer than five),
+ unless they release you from this requirement.
+\item State on the Title page the name of the publisher of the
+ Modified Version, as the publisher.
+\item Preserve all the copyright notices of the Document.
+\item Add an appropriate copyright notice for your modifications
+ adjacent to the other copyright notices.
+\item Include, immediately after the copyright notices, a license notice
+ giving the public permission to use the Modified Version under the
+ terms of this License, in the form shown in the Addendum below.
+\item Preserve in that license notice the full lists of Invariant Sections
+ and required Cover Texts given in the Document's license notice.
+\item Include an unaltered copy of this License.
+\item Preserve the section Entitled ``History'', Preserve its Title, and add
+ to it an item stating at least the title, year, new authors, and
+ publisher of the Modified Version as given on the Title Page. If
+ there is no section Entitled ``History'' in the Document, create one
+ stating the title, year, authors, and publisher of the Document as
+ given on its Title Page, then add an item describing the Modified
+ Version as stated in the previous sentence.
+\item Preserve the network location, if any, given in the Document for
+ public access to a Transparent copy of the Document, and likewise
+ the network locations given in the Document for previous versions
+ it was based on. These may be placed in the ``History'' section.
+ You may omit a network location for a work that was published at
+ least four years before the Document itself, or if the original
+ publisher of the version it refers to gives permission.
+\item For any section Entitled ``Acknowledgements'' or ``Dedications'',
+ Preserve the Title of the section, and preserve in the section all
+ the substance and tone of each of the contributor acknowledgements
+ and/or dedications given therein.
+\item Preserve all the Invariant Sections of the Document,
+ unaltered in their text and in their titles. Section numbers
+ or the equivalent are not considered part of the section titles.
+\item Delete any section Entitled ``Endorsements''. Such a section
+ may not be included in the Modified Version.
+\item Do not retitle any existing section to be Entitled ``Endorsements''
+ or to conflict in title with any Invariant Section.
+\item Preserve any Warranty Disclaimers.
+
+\end{enumerate}
+
+If the Modified Version includes new front-matter sections or
+appendices that qualify as Secondary Sections and contain no material
+copied from the Document, you may at your option designate some or all
+of these sections as invariant. To do this, add their titles to the
+list of Invariant Sections in the Modified Version's license notice.
+These titles must be distinct from any other section titles.
+
+You may add a section Entitled ``Endorsements'', provided it contains
+nothing but endorsements of your Modified Version by various
+parties--for example, statements of peer review or that the text has
+been approved by an organization as the authoritative definition of a
+standard.
+
+You may add a passage of up to five words as a Front-Cover Text, and a
+passage of up to 25 words as a Back-Cover Text, to the end of the list
+of Cover Texts in the Modified Version. Only one passage of
+Front-Cover Text and one of Back-Cover Text may be added by (or
+through arrangements made by) any one entity. If the Document already
+includes a cover text for the same cover, previously added by you or
+by arrangement made by the same entity you are acting on behalf of,
+you may not add another; but you may replace the old one, on explicit
+permission from the previous publisher that added the old one.
+
+The author(s) and publisher(s) of the Document do not by this License
+give permission to use their names for publicity for or to assert or
+imply endorsement of any Modified Version.
+
+
+\section{COMBINING DOCUMENTS}
+\label{combining}
+
+You may combine the Document with other documents released under this
+License, under the terms defined in section~\ref{modifications}
+above for modified
+versions, provided that you include in the combination all of the
+Invariant Sections of all of the original documents, unmodified, and
+list them all as Invariant Sections of your combined work in its
+license notice, and that you preserve all their Warranty Disclaimers.
+
+The combined work need only contain one copy of this License, and
+multiple identical Invariant Sections may be replaced with a single
+copy. If there are multiple Invariant Sections with the same name but
+different contents, make the title of each such section unique by
+adding at the end of it, in parentheses, the name of the original
+author or publisher of that section if known, or else a unique number.
+Make the same adjustment to the section titles in the list of
+Invariant Sections in the license notice of the combined work.
+
+In the combination, you must combine any sections Entitled ``History''
+in the various original documents, forming one section Entitled
+``History''; likewise combine any sections Entitled ``Acknowledgements'',
+and any sections Entitled ``Dedications''. You must delete all sections
+Entitled ``Endorsements''.
+
+
+\section{COLLECTIONS OF DOCUMENTS}
+\label{collections}
+
+You may make a collection consisting of the Document and other documents
+released under this License, and replace the individual copies of this
+License in the various documents with a single copy that is included in
+the collection, provided that you follow the rules of this License for
+verbatim copying of each of the documents in all other respects.
+
+You may extract a single document from such a collection, and distribute
+it individually under this License, provided you insert a copy of this
+License into the extracted document, and follow this License in all
+other respects regarding verbatim copying of that document.
+
+
+\section{AGGREGATION WITH INDEPENDENT WORKS}
+\label{aggregation}
+
+A compilation of the Document or its derivatives with other separate
+and independent documents or works, in or on a volume of a storage or
+distribution medium, is called an ``aggregate'' if the copyright
+resulting from the compilation is not used to limit the legal rights
+of the compilation's users beyond what the individual works permit.
+When the Document is included in an aggregate, this License does not
+apply to the other works in the aggregate which are not themselves
+derivative works of the Document.
+
+If the Cover Text requirement of section~\ref{copying} is applicable to
+these copies of the Document, then if the Document is less than one half
+of the entire aggregate, the Document's Cover Texts may be placed on
+covers that bracket the Document within the aggregate, or the
+electronic equivalent of covers if the Document is in electronic form.
+Otherwise they must appear on printed covers that bracket the whole
+aggregate.
+
+
+\section{TRANSLATION}
+\label{translation}
+
+Translation is considered a kind of modification, so you may
+distribute translations of the Document under the terms of
+section~\ref{modifications}.
+Replacing Invariant Sections with translations requires special
+permission from their copyright holders, but you may include
+translations of some or all Invariant Sections in addition to the
+original versions of these Invariant Sections. You may include a
+translation of this License, and all the license notices in the
+Document, and any Warranty Disclaimers, provided that you also include
+the original English version of this License and the original versions
+of those notices and disclaimers. In case of a disagreement between
+the translation and the original version of this License or a notice
+or disclaimer, the original version will prevail.
+
+If a section in the Document is Entitled ``Acknowledgements'',
+``Dedications'', or ``History'', the requirement
+(section~\ref{modifications}) to Preserve
+its Title (section~\ref{applicability}) will typically require
+changing the actual title.
+
+
+\section{TERMINATION}
+\label{termination}
+
+You may not copy, modify, sublicense, or distribute the Document except
+as expressly provided for under this License. Any other attempt to
+copy, modify, sublicense or distribute the Document is void, and will
+automatically terminate your rights under this License. However,
+parties who have received copies, or rights, from you under this
+License will not have their licenses terminated so long as such
+parties remain in full compliance.
+
+
+\section{FUTURE REVISIONS OF THIS LICENSE}
+\label{future}
+
+The Free Software Foundation may publish new, revised versions
+of the GNU Free Documentation License from time to time. Such new
+versions will be similar in spirit to the present version, but may
+differ in detail to address new problems or concerns. See
+http://www.gnu.org/copyleft/.
+
+Each version of the License is given a distinguishing version number.
+If the Document specifies that a particular numbered version of this
+License ``or any later version'' applies to it, you have the option of
+following the terms and conditions either of that specified version or
+of any later version that has been published (not as a draft) by the
+Free Software Foundation. If the Document does not specify a version
+number of this License, you may choose any version ever published (not
+as a draft) by the Free Software Foundation.
+
+
+\section*{ADDENDUM: How to use this License for your documents}
+
+To use this License in a document you have written, include a copy of
+the License in the document and put the following copyright and
+license notices just after the title page:
+
+\begin{quote}
+ Copyright \copyright\ YEAR YOUR NAME.
+ Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
+ under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2
+ or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
+ with no Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover Texts.
+ A copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU
+ Free Documentation License''.
+\end{quote}
+
+If you have Invariant Sections, Front-Cover Texts and Back-Cover Texts,
+replace the ``with...Texts.'' line with this:
+
+ with the Invariant Sections being LIST THEIR TITLES, with the
+ Front-Cover Texts being LIST, and with the Back-Cover Texts being LIST.
+
+If you have Invariant Sections without Cover Texts, or some other
+combination of the three, merge those two alternatives to suit the
+situation.
+
+If your document contains nontrivial examples of program code, we
+recommend releasing these examples in parallel under your choice of
+free software license, such as the GNU General Public License,
+to permit their use in free software.
+
+\endgroup
+
+\end{document}
Property changes on: trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/hyperref/hyperref-doc.tex
___________________________________________________________________
Added: svn:eol-style
## -0,0 +1 ##
+native
\ No newline at end of property
Added: trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/hyperref/hyperref-linktarget.pdf
===================================================================
(Binary files differ)
Index: trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/hyperref/hyperref-linktarget.pdf
===================================================================
--- trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/hyperref/hyperref-linktarget.pdf 2022-05-14 20:31:45 UTC (rev 63297)
+++ trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/hyperref/hyperref-linktarget.pdf 2022-05-14 20:32:17 UTC (rev 63298)
Property changes on: trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/hyperref/hyperref-linktarget.pdf
___________________________________________________________________
Added: svn:mime-type
## -0,0 +1 ##
+application/pdf
\ No newline at end of property
Modified: trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/hyperref/hyperref.pdf
===================================================================
(Binary files differ)
Modified: trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/hyperref/manifest.txt
===================================================================
--- trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/hyperref/manifest.txt 2022-05-14 20:31:45 UTC (rev 63297)
+++ trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/hyperref/manifest.txt 2022-05-14 20:32:17 UTC (rev 63298)
@@ -9,8 +9,12 @@
Bibliographical back referencing.
nameref.dtx
Cross-referencing by name of section.
-
-hyperref.pdf, backref.pdf, nameref.pdf
+hyperref-linktarget.dtx
+ Module with commands to create targets
+hyperref-patches.dtx
+ outsourced older patches
+
+hyperref.pdf, backref.pdf, nameref.pdf, hyperref-linktarget.pdf
Source code documentation.
hyperref.ins
@@ -42,6 +46,7 @@
nameref.sty
hyperref.sty
nohyperref.sty
+hyperref-patches.sty
LaTeX package files.
hycheck.tex
Test file.
@@ -76,7 +81,7 @@
% Directory doc/
% =============
-hyperref-doc.pdf
+hyperref-doc.pdf, hyperref-linktarget.pdf
Hyperref manual
hyperref-doc.html, hyperref-doc[2-7].html, hyperref-doc.css,
HTML version of the manual.
Modified: trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/hyperref/nameref.pdf
===================================================================
(Binary files differ)
Modified: trunk/Master/texmf-dist/source/latex/hyperref/backref.dtx
===================================================================
--- trunk/Master/texmf-dist/source/latex/hyperref/backref.dtx 2022-05-14 20:31:45 UTC (rev 63297)
+++ trunk/Master/texmf-dist/source/latex/hyperref/backref.dtx 2022-05-14 20:32:17 UTC (rev 63298)
@@ -3,7 +3,7 @@
%% Copyright (C) 1995-2000 David Carlisle, Sebastian Rahtz, Heiko Oberdiek
%% 2001-2012 Heiko Oberdiek
%% 2016-2019 Oberdiek Package Suport Group
-%% 2019-2021 The LaTeX Project
+%% 2019-2022 The LaTeX Project
%% https://github.com/latex3/hyperref/issues
%%
%% This file is part of the `Hyperref Bundle'.
Deleted: trunk/Master/texmf-dist/source/latex/hyperref/doc/hyperref-doc.tex
===================================================================
--- trunk/Master/texmf-dist/source/latex/hyperref/doc/hyperref-doc.tex 2022-05-14 20:31:45 UTC (rev 63297)
+++ trunk/Master/texmf-dist/source/latex/hyperref/doc/hyperref-doc.tex 2022-05-14 20:32:17 UTC (rev 63298)
@@ -1,3987 +0,0 @@
-% This is the manual for the LaTeX hyperref package.
-%
-% Copyright (C) 1998-2003 Sebastian Rahtz.
-% Copyright (C) 2003 Steve Peter and Karl Berry
-% Copyright (C) 2006-2012 Heiko Oberdiek.
-% Copyright (C) 2017-2019 David Carlisle Ulrike Fischer
-% Copyright (C) 2019-2020 The LaTeX3 Project
-%
-% Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
-% under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
-% any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
-% Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no Back-Cover
-% Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled
-% ``GNU Free Documentation License.''
-%
-
-\def\mydate{January 2020}
-
-\RequirePackage{iftex}
-
-\documentclass{article}
-
-
-\usepackage{pifont}
-\usepackage{calc}
-
-\usepackage{hologo}
-
-\newcommand*{\cs}[1]{%
- \texttt{\textbackslash #1}%
-}
-\newcommand*{\xpackage}[1]{\textsf{#1}}
-\newcommand*{\xoption}[1]{\textsf{#1}}
-
-% from doc.sty
-\makeatletter
-\ifx\l at nohyphenation\@undefined
-\newlanguage\l at nohyphenation
-\fi
-\ifx\l at nohyphenation\@undefined
- \newlanguage\l at nohyphenation
-\fi
-\DeclareRobustCommand\meta[1]{%
- \ensuremath\langle
- \ifmmode \expandafter \nfss at text \fi
- {%
- \meta at font@select
- \edef\meta at hyphen@restore
- {\hyphenchar\the\font\the\hyphenchar\font}%
- \hyphenchar\font\m at ne
- \language\l at nohyphenation
- #1\/%
- \meta at hyphen@restore
- }%
- \ensuremath\rangle
-}
-\def\meta at font@select{\ttfamily\itshape}
-\makeatother
-
-% Page layout.
-\advance\textwidth by 1.1in
-\advance\oddsidemargin by -.55in
-\advance\evensidemargin by -.55in
-%
-\advance\textheight by 1in
-\advance\topmargin by -.5in
-\advance\footskip by -.5in
-%
-\pagestyle{headings}
-%
-% Avoid some overfull boxes.
-\emergencystretch=.1\hsize
-\hbadness = 3000
-
-% these are from lshort.sty, but lshort.sty pulls in so many other
-% packages it seems cleaner to just include them here.
-%
-\newcommand{\bs}{\symbol{'134}}%Print backslash
-\newcommand{\ci}[1]{\texttt{\bs#1}}
-
-\makeatletter
-\@ifpackageloaded{tex4ht}{%
- % separate definition for HTML case to avoid
- % nasty borders with double horizontal lines with
- % large gaps.
- \newsavebox{\cmdsyntaxbox}%
- \newenvironment{cmdsyntax}{%
- \par
- % \small
- \addvspace{3.2ex plus 0.8ex minus 0.2ex}%
- \vskip -\parskip
- \noindent
- \begin{lrbox}{\cmdsyntaxbox}%
- \begin{tabular}{l}%
- \rule{0pt}{1em}%
- \ignorespaces
- }{%
- \end{tabular}%
- \end{lrbox}%
- \fbox{\usebox{\cmdsyntaxbox}}%
- \par
- \nopagebreak
- \addvspace{3.2ex plus 0.8ex minus 0.2ex}%
- \vskip -\parskip
- }%
-}{%
- \newenvironment{cmdsyntax}{%
- \par
- \small
- \addvspace{3.2ex plus 0.8ex minus 0.2ex}%
- \vskip -\parskip
- \noindent
- \begin{tabular}{|l|}%
- \hline
- \rule{0pt}{1em}%
- \ignorespaces
- }{%
- \\%
- \hline
- \end{tabular}%
- \par
- \nopagebreak
- \addvspace{3.2ex plus 0.8ex minus 0.2ex}%
- \vskip -\parskip
- }%
-}
-\makeatother
-
-\usepackage{array,longtable}
-\ifTUTeX%
- \usepackage{fontspec}%
- \renewcommand*{\ttdefault}{lmvtt}%
-\else % not \XeTeX* nor \LuaTeX*
- \usepackage[T1]{fontenc}%
- \usepackage{lmodern}%
- \renewcommand*{\ttdefault}{lmvtt}%
-\fi
-
-\newcommand*{\Quote}[1]{\textquotedblleft#1\textquotedblright}
-
-\ifpdf
- \usepackage[%
-% pdftex,% might be luatex, just allow automatic default
- colorlinks,%
- hyperindex,%
- plainpages=false,%
- bookmarksopen,%
- bookmarksnumbered,
- pdfusetitle,%
- ]{hyperref}
- %%?? \def\pdfBorderAttrs{/Border [0 0 0] } % No border arround Links
-\else
- \usepackage{hyperref}
-\fi
-
-\makeatletter
-\@ifpackageloaded{tex4ht}{%
-\author{Sebastian Rahtz (deceased)\and
- Heiko Oberdiek (inactive)\and
- The \LaTeX3 Project (\url{https://github.com/latex3/hyperref/issues})}
-}{%
- \usepackage{bmhydoc}%
-\author{Sebastian Rahtz\thanks{deceased}\and
- Heiko Oberdiek\thanks{inactive}\and
- The \LaTeX3 Project\thanks{\url{https://github.com/latex3/hyperref/issues}}}
-}
-\makeatother
-\title{Hypertext marks in \hologo{LaTeX}: a manual for \xpackage{hyperref}}
-\date{2022-02-21 v7.00n}
-
-\begin{document}
-
-% comes out too close to the toc, and we know it's page one anyway.
-\thispagestyle{empty}
-\maketitle
-\tableofcontents
-\setcounter{tocdepth}{2}% for bookmark levels
-
-\section{Preface---February 2022}
-As can be already seen in the following introduction, \xpackage{hyperref}
-has a long history and has seen many changes over time. The introduction
-mentions workflows, drivers and problems which are no longer relevant,
-or only in edge cases. The documentation reflect this varied history: changes
-and extensions and explanations were and are spread over various papers and sources and
-only incorporated later and so are not always in a coherent order and in sync which each other.
-
-
-This history is continuing: If you are using the new \hologo{LaTeX} PDF management
-which is currently distributed as testphase package \xpackage{pdfmanagement-testphase}
-then \xpackage{hyperref} will for the PDF output use a new generic driver which
-contains a number of changes and new features. The documentation of this driver
-\texttt{hyperref-generic.pdf}
-is currently a part of the \xpackage{pdfmanagement-testphase} documentation.
-One important change of the new driver is
-that it removed the old \xpackage{hyperref} code for book marks and uses
-the \xpackage{bookmark} package instead. So to learn
-about options to extend the bookmarks you should consult the \xpackage{bookmark} documentation
-too.
-
-\subsection{Restoring removed patches}
-
-\xpackage{hyperref} has over time patched quite a number of packages to resolve clashes and incompabilities.
-Quite a number are either no longer needed or should be done by by the original packages.
-These patches are now slowly removed from \xpackage{hyperref}. It should normally not lead to problems, but
-in case that the patches should be restored they can be loaded through the package \xpackage{hyperref-patches} which
-is a part of this bundle.
-
-
-
-\section{Introduction}
-
-The package derives from, and builds on, the work of the Hyper\hologo{TeX}
-project, described at \nolinkurl{http://xxx.lanl.gov/hypertex/}\footnote{Now: \url{https://ctan.org/tex-archive/support/hypertex/hypertex}}. It extends
-the functionality of all the \hologo{LaTeX} cross-referencing commands
-(including the table of contents, bibliographies etc) to produce
-\cs{special} commands which a driver can turn into hypertext links;
-it also provides new commands to allow the user to write \emph{ad hoc}
-hypertext links, including those to external documents and URLs.
-
-The package is currently maintained at \url{https://github.com/latex3/hyperref/} and issues should
-be reported there.
-
-This manual provides a brief overview of the \xpackage{hyperref}
-package. For more details, you should read the additional documentation
-distributed with the package, as well as the complete documentation by
-processing \texttt{hyperref.dtx}. You should also read the chapter on
-\xpackage{hyperref} in \textit{The \hologo{LaTeX} Web Companion}, where you will
-find additional examples.
-
-The Hyper\hologo{TeX} specification\footnote{This is borrowed from an article
-by Arthur Smith.} says that conformant viewers/translators must
-recognize the following set of \cs{special} constructs:
-
-\begin{description}
-\item[href:] \verb|html:<a href = "href_string">|
-\item[name:] \verb|html:<a name = "name_string">|
-\item[end:] \verb|html:</a>|
-\item[image:] \verb|html:<img src = "href_string">|
-\item[base\_name:] \verb|html:<base href = "href_string">|
-\end{description}
-
-The \emph{href}, \emph{name} and \emph{end} commands are used to do the
-basic hypertext operations of establishing links between sections of
-documents. The \emph{image} command is intended (as with current HTML
-viewers) to place an image of arbitrary graphical format on the page in
-the current location. The \emph{base\_name} command is be used to
-communicate to the DVI viewer the full (URL) location of the current
-document so that files specified by relative URLs may be retrieved
-correctly.
-
-The \emph{href} and \emph{name} commands must be paired with an
-\emph{end} command later in the \TeX\ file---the \TeX\ commands between
-the two ends of a pair form an \emph{anchor} in the document. In the
-case of an \emph{href} command, the \emph{anchor} is to be highlighted
-in the \emph{DVI viewer}, and when clicked on will cause the scene to
-shift to the destination specified by \emph{href\_string}. The
-\emph{anchor} associated with a name command represents a possible
-location to which other hypertext links may refer, either as local
-references (of the form \verb|href="#name_string"| with the
-\emph{name\_string} identical to the one in the name command) or as part
-of a URL (of the form \emph{URL\#name\_string}). Here
-\emph{href\_string} is a valid URL or local identifier, while
-\emph{name\_string} could be any string at all: the only caveat is that
-`$\verb|"|$' characters should be escaped with a backslash
-($\backslash$), and if it looks like a URL name it may cause problems.
-
-However, the drivers intended to produce \emph{only} PDF use literal
-PostScript or PDF \verb|\special| commands. The commands are defined in
-configuration files for different drivers, selected by package options;
-at present, the following drivers are supported:
-
-\begin{description}
-\item[hypertex] DVI processors conforming to the Hyper\TeX\ guidelines (i.e.\ \textsf{xdvi}, \textsf{dvips} (with
-the \textsf{-z} option), \textsf{\hologo{OzTeX}}, and \textsf{Textures})
-\item[dvips] produces \verb|\special| commands tailored for \textsf{dvips}
-\item[dvipsone] produces \verb|\special| commands tailored for \textsf{dvipsone}
-\item[ps2pdf] a special case of output suitable for processing by earlier versions of Ghost\-script's
-PDF writer; this is basically the same as that for \textsf{dvips}, but a few variations remained before version 5.21
-\item[tex4ht] produces \verb|\special| commands for use with \textsf{\TeX4ht}
-\item[pdftex] pdf\TeX, \hologo{HanTheThanh}'s \TeX{} variant that writes PDF directly
-\item[luatex] lua\TeX, Unicode \TeX{} variant that writes PDF directly
-\item[dvipdfm] produces \verb|\special| commands for Mark Wicks' DVI to PDF driver \textsf{dvipdfm}
-\item[dvipdfmx] produces \verb|\special| commands for driver
- \textsf{dvipdfmx}, a successor of \textsf{dvipdfm}
-\item[dviwindo] produces \verb|\special| commands that Y\&Y's Windows previewer interprets as hypertext jumps within the previewer
-\item[vtex] produces \verb|\special| commands that MicroPress' HTML and
- PDF-producing \TeX\ variants interpret as hypertext jumps within the
- previewer
-\item[textures] produces \verb|\special| commands that \textsf{Textures} interprets as hypertext jumps within the previewer
-\item[xetex] produces \verb|\special| commands for Xe\TeX{}
-\end{description}
-
-Output from \textsf{dvips} or \textsf{dvipsone} must be processed using
-Acrobat Distiller to obtain a PDF file.\footnote{Make sure you turn off
-the partial font downloading supported by \textsf{dvips} and
-\textsf{dvipsone} in favor of Distiller's own system.} The result is
-generally preferable to that produced by using the \textsf{hypertex}
-driver, and then processing with \textsf{dvips -z}, but the DVI file is
-not portable. The main advantage of using the Hyper\TeX\ \ci{special}
-commands is that you can also use the document in hypertext DVI viewers,
-such as \textsf{xdvi}.
-
-\begin{description}
-\item[driverfallback]
- If a driver is not given and cannot be autodetected, then use
- the driver option, given as value to this option \textsf{driverfallback}.
- Example:
- \begin{quote}
- \texttt{driverfallback=dvipdfm}
- \end{quote}
- Autodetected drivers (\textsf{pdftex}, \textsf{xetex}, \textsf{vtex},
- \textsf{vtexpdfmark}) are recognized from within \TeX\ and
- therefore cannot be given as value to option \textsf{driverfallback}.
- However a DVI driver program is run after the \TeX\ run is finished.
- Thus it cannot be detected at \TeX\ macro level. Then package
- \xpackage{hyperref}
- uses the driver, given by \textsf{driverfallback}. If the driver
- is already specified or can be autodetected, then option
- \textsf{driverfallback} is ignored.
-\end{description}
-
-\section{Implicit behavior}
-
-This package can be used with more or less any normal \LaTeX\ document
-by specifying in the document preamble
-
-\begin{verbatim}
-\usepackage{hyperref}
-\end{verbatim}
-
-Make sure it comes \emph{last} of your loaded packages, to give it a
-fighting chance of not being over-written, since its job is to redefine
-many \LaTeX\ commands.\footnote{But work has started to reduce the
-number of redefinition and so the dependencies on the loading order.}
-Hopefully you will find that all cross-references
-work correctly as hypertext. For example, \ci{section} commands will
-produce a bookmark and a link, whereas \ci{section*} commands will only
-show links when paired with a corresponding \ci{addcontentsline}
-command.
-
-In addition, the \texttt{hyperindex} option (see below) attempts to make
-items in the index by hyperlinked back to the text, and the option
-\texttt{backref} inserts extra `back' links into the bibliography for
-each entry. Other options control the appearance of links, and give
-extra control over PDF output. For example, \texttt{colorlinks}, as its
-name well implies, colors the links instead of using boxes; this is the
-option used in this document.
-
-\section{Interfaces for class and package authors}
-
-hyperlink features are nowadays a common requirement. \xpackage{hyperref}
-patches quite a number of commands from the \LaTeX{} core and from packages
-to add such features. But this is rather fragile and it add dependencies
-on the loading order and can break if the external packages break.
-It is therefore much better if packages add suitable support to their commands directly.
-Quite a lot packages actually did this, but due to missing documentation of the interface
-they often looked into the code and then used internal commands not meant as public command.
-
-The following tries to describe the existing variables and commands that
-can be viewed as public interfaces or which should or can be set by packages
-to stay compatible with the \xpackage{hyperref} command. Documented user commands
-are naturally interfaces too, they are not explicitly mentioned here again.
-
-This section is work in progress. Suggestions or comments are welcome.
-
-\subsection{Counters}
-Counters play an important part in the code. They are used to create destination names and
-to define hierarchies like the bookmarks. To work correctly often they require some additional
-setups.
-
-\begin{description}
-
-\item[\cs{theH<counter>}] \xpackage{hyperref} creates destination names for
-link anchor typically out of the name of the counter and the \cs{the<counter>} value.
-This can fail, e.g. if \cs{the<counter>} is not unique through the document,
-or if it is not expandable. In such cases \cs{theH<counter>} should be defined so that
-it gives a unique, expandable value. It doesn't harm to define it even if
-\xpackage{hyperref} is not loaded.
-
-\item[\cs{toclevel@<counter>}] This is a variable which should contain a number.
-It is used for the level in the bookmarks. It should be defined for all counters
-which are used in toc like lists and \cs{addcontentsline}. Typical values are
-
-\begin{verbatim}
-\def\toclevel at part{-1}
-\def\toclevel at chapter{0}
-\def\toclevel at section{1}
-\def\toclevel at subsection{2}
-\def\toclevel at subsubsection{3}
-\def\toclevel at paragraph{4}
-\def\toclevel at subparagraph{5}
-\def\toclevel at figure{0}
-\end{verbatim}
-
-\end{description}
-
-\subsection{Links commands}
-The following commands are provided by all drivers to create links.
-They can be used by packages if the user commands are not sufficient.
-New drivers must provide this commands with similar arguments.
-
-\begin{verbatim}
- \hyper at anchor {destination name}
- \hyper at anchorstart {destination name}
- \hyper at anchorend
- \hyper at link {context}{destination name}{link text} %GoTo
- \hyper at linkstart {context} {destination name} %GoTo
- \hyper at linkend %GoTo
- \hyper at linkfile {link text} {filename} {destname} %GoToR
- \hyper at linkurl {link text}{url} %URI
- \hyper at linklaunch{filename} {link text} {Parameters} %Launch, only with new generic driver
- \hyper at linknamed {action}{link text} %Named, only with new generic driver
-\end{verbatim}
-
-
-\section{Package options}
-
-All user-configurable aspects of \xpackage{hyperref} are set using a
-single `key=value' scheme (using the \xpackage{keyval} package) with the
-key \texttt{Hyp}. The options can be set either in the optional argument
-to the \cs{usepackage} command, or using the \cs{hypersetup}
-macro. When the package is loaded, a file \texttt{hyperref.cfg} is read
-if it can be found, and this is a convenient place to set options on a
-site-wide basis.
-
-Note however that some options (for example \texttt{unicode}) can only be used as
-package options, and not in \verb|\hypersetup| as the option settings are processed
-as the package is read. The following tabular lists (hopefully all) these options.
-Be aware that some of the option do nothing or have
-changed behaviour if the new pdfmanagement and so the new generic hyperref driver is used.
-
-\begin{tabular}{>{\ttfamily}l>{\raggedright\arraybackslash}p{5cm}}
-option & remark \\\hline
-all driver options, e.g. \texttt{pdftex} & often not needed, as detected automatically\\
-implicit \\
-pdfa & no-op with new pdfmanagement, set the standard in \cs{DeclareDocumentMetadata}.\\
-unicode & is the default now anyway\\
-pdfversion & no-op with new pdfmanagement, set the version in \cs{DeclareDocumentMetadata}.\\
-bookmarks & this will probably change at some time. \\
-backref &\\
-pagebackref & \\
-destlabel &\\
-pdfusetitle &\\
-pdfpagelabels &\\
-hyperfootnotes &\\
-hyperfigures&\\
-hyperindex &\\
-encap &\\
-typexml & \\
-CJKbookmarks & only with the new pdfmanagement, in other cases it can be used in \cs{hypersetup}\\
-psdextra & only with the new pdfmanagement, in other cases it can be used in \cs{hypersetup}\\
-nesting & only with the new pdfmanagement, in other cases it can be used in \cs{hypersetup} (but
- is quite unclear if it has any use)\\
-
-\end{tabular}
-
-As an example, the behavior of a particular file could be controlled by:
-\begin{itemize}
-
-\item a site-wide \texttt{hyperref.cfg} setting up the look of links,
-adding backreferencing, and setting a PDF display default:
-
-\begin{verbatim}
-\hypersetup{backref,
-pdfpagemode=FullScreen,
-colorlinks=true}
-\end{verbatim}
-
-\item A global option in the file, which is passed down to
-\textsf{hyperref}:
-
-\begin{verbatim}
-\documentclass[dvips]{article}
-\end{verbatim}
-
-\item File-specific options in the \cs{usepackage} commands, which
-override the ones set in \texttt{hyperref.cfg}:
-
-\begin{verbatim}
-\usepackage[colorlinks=false]{hyperref}
-\hypersetup{pdftitle={A Perfect Day}}
-\end{verbatim}
-\end{itemize}
-
-As seen in the previous example, information entries
-(pdftitle, pdfauthor, \dots) should be set after the package is loaded.
-Otherwise \LaTeX\ expands the values of these options prematurely.
-Also \LaTeX\ strips spaces in options. Especially option `pdfborder'
-requires some care. Curly braces protect the value, if given
-as package option. They are not necessary in \verb|\hypersetup|.
-
-\begin{verbatim}
-\usepackage[pdfborder={0 0 0}]{hyperref}
-\hypersetup{pdfborder=0 0 0}
-\end{verbatim}
-
-Some options can be given at any time, but many are restricted: before
-\verb|\begin{document}|, only in \verb|\usepackage[...]{hyperref}|,
-before first use, etc.
-
-In the key descriptions that follow, many options do not need a value,
-as they default to the value true if used. These are the ones classed as
-`boolean'. The values true and false can always be specified, however.
-
-\subsection{General options}
-
-Firstly, the options to specify general behavior and page size.
-
-\medskip
-\begin{longtable}{>{\ttfamily}ll>{\itshape}ll}
-draft & boolean & false & all hypertext options are turned off \\
-final & boolean & true & all hypertext options are turned on \\
-debug & boolean & false & extra diagnostic messages are printed in \\
- & & & the log file \\
-verbose & boolean & false & same as debug \\
-implicit & boolean & true & redefines \LaTeX\ internals \\
-setpagesize & boolean & true & sets page size by special driver commands
-\end{longtable}
-
-\subsection{Options for destination names}
-
-Destinations names (also anchor, target or link names) are internal
-names that identify a position on a page in the document. They
-are used in link targets for inner document links or the bookmarks,
-for example.
-
-Usually anchor are set, if \cs{refstepcounter} is called.
-Thus there is a counter name and value. Both are used to
-construct the destination name. By default the counter value
-follows the counter name separated by a dot. Example for
-the fourth chapter:
-\begin{quote}
- \verb|chapter.4|
-\end{quote}
-This scheme is used by:
-\begin{description}
-\item[\cs{autoref}] displays the description label for the
- reference depending on the counter name.
-\item[\cs{hyperpage}] is used by the index to get
-page links. Page anchor setting (\verb|pageanchor|) must not
-be turned off.
-\end{description}
-
-It is very important that the destination names are unique,
-because two destinations must not share the same name.
-The counter value \cs{the<counter>} is not always unique
-for the counter. For example, table and figures can be numbered
-inside the chapter without having the chapter number in their
-number. Therefore \xpackage{hyperref} has introduced \cs{theH<counter>}
-that allows a unique counter value without messing up with
-the appearance of the counter number. For example, the number
-of the second table in the third chapter might be printed
-as \texttt{2}, the result of \cs{thetable}. But the
-destination name \texttt{table.2.4} is unique because it
-has used \cs{theHtable} that gives \verb|2.4| in this case.
-
-Often the user do not need to set \cs{theH<counter>}. Defaults
-for standard cases (chapter, \dots) are provided. And after \xpackage{hyperref}
-is loaded, new counters with parent counters also define
-\cs{theH<counter>} automatically, if \cs{newcounter}, \cs{@addtoreset}
-or \cs{numberwithin} of package \xpackage{amsmath} are used.
-
-Usually problems with duplicate destination names can be solved
-by an appropriate definition of \cs{theH<counter>}. If option
-\texttt{hypertexnames} is disabled, then a unique artificial
-number is used instead of the counter value. In case of page
-anchors the absolute page anchor is used. With option \texttt{plainpages}
-the page anchors use the arabic form. In both latter cases \cs{hyperpage}
-for index links is affected and might not work properly.
-
-If an unnumbered entity gets an anchor (starred forms of
-chapters, sections, \dots) or \cs{phantomsection} is used,
-then the dummy counter name \texttt{section*} and an artificial
-unique number is used.
-
-If the final PDF file is going to be merged with another file, than
-the destination names might clash, because both documents might
-contain \texttt{chapter.1} or \texttt{page.1}. Also \xpackage{hyperref}
-sets anchor with name \texttt{Doc-Start} at the begin of the document.
-This can be resolved by redefining \cs{HyperDestNameFilter}.
-Package \xpackage{hyperref} calls this macro each time, it uses a
-destination name.
-The macro must be expandable and expects the destination name
-as only argument. As example, the macro is redefined to add
-a prefix to all destination names:
-\begin{quote}
-\begin{verbatim}
-\renewcommand*{\HyperDestNameFilter}[1]{\jobname-#1}
-\end{verbatim}
-\end{quote}
-In document \texttt{docA} the destination name \texttt{chapter.2}
-becomes \texttt{docA-chapter.2}.
-
-Destination names can also be used from the outside in URIs(, if the
-driver has not removed or changed them), for example:
-\begin{quote}
-\begin{verbatim}
-http://somewhere/path/file.pdf#nameddest=chapter.4
-\end{verbatim}
-\end{quote}
-However using a number seems unhappy. If another chapter is added
-before, the number changes. But it is very difficult to pass
-a new name for the destination to the anchor setting process that
-is usually deep hidden in the internals. The first name of
-\cs{label} after the anchor setting seems a good approximation:
-\begin{quote}
-\begin{verbatim}
- \section{Introduction}
- \label{intro}
-\end{verbatim}
-\end{quote}
-Option \texttt{destlabel} checks for each \cs{label}, if there is
-a new destination name active and replaces the destination
-name by the label name. Because the destination name is already in use
-because of the anchor setting, the new name is recorded in the \texttt{.aux}
-file and used in the subsequent \hologo{LaTeX} run. The renaming is done by
-a redefinition of \cs{HyperDestNameFilter}. That leaves the old
-destination names intact (e.g., they are needed for \cs{autoref}).
-This redefinition is also available as \cs{HyperDestLabelReplace},
-thus that an own redefinition can use it.
-The following example also adds a prefix for \emph{all} destination names:
-\begin{quote}
-\begin{verbatim}
-\renewcommand*{\HyperDestNameFilter}[1]{%
- \jobname-\HyperDestLabelReplace{#1}%
-}
-\end{verbatim}
-\end{quote}
-The other case that only files prefixed that do not have a corresponding
-\cs{label} is more complicate, because \cs{HyperDestLabelReplace} needs
-the unmodified destination name as argument. This is solved by an
-expandable string test (\cs{pdfstrcmp} of \hologo{pdfTeX}
-or \cs{strcmp} of \hologo{XeTeX}, package \xpackage{pdftexcmds} also supports
-\hologo{LuaTeX}):
-\begin{quote}
-\begin{verbatim}
-\usepackage{pdftexcmds}
-\makeatletter
-\renewcommand*{\HyperDestNameFilter}[1]{%
- \ifcase\pdf at strcmp{#1}{\HyperDestLabelReplace{#1}} %
- \jobname-#1%
- \else
- \HyperDestLabelReplace{#1}%
- \fi
-}
-\makeatother
-\end{verbatim}
-\end{quote}
-
-With option \texttt{destlabel} destinations can also named manually,
-if the destination is not yet renamed:
-\begin{quote}
-\verb|\HyperDestRename{|\meta{destination}\verb|}{|\meta{newname}\verb|}|
-\end{quote}
-
-Hint: Anchors can also be named and set by \cs{hypertarget}.
-
-\medskip
-\begin{longtable}{>{\ttfamily}ll>{\itshape}ll}
-destlabel & boolean & false & destinations are named by first \cs{label}\\
- & & & after anchor creation\\
-hypertexnames & boolean & true & use guessable names for links \\
-naturalnames & boolean & false & use \LaTeX-computed names for links \\
-plainpages & boolean & false & Forces page anchors to be named by the Arabic form \\
- & & & of the page number, rather than the formatted form. \\
-\end{longtable}
-
-\subsection{Configuration options}
-
-\begin{longtable}{>{\ttfamily}ll>{\itshape}lp{9cm}}
-raiselinks & boolean & true & In the hypertex driver, the height of links is normally calculated by the driver as
- simply the base line of contained text; this options forces \verb|\special| commands to
- reflect the real height of the link (which could contain a graphic) \\
-breaklinks & boolean & both & This option is in hyperref only used in the dviwindo driver, in all other cases it doesn't do anything sensible---it neither allows nor prevents links to be broken. The ocgx2 package
-checks the state of the boolean.\\
-pageanchor & boolean & true & Determines whether every page is given an implicit anchor at the top left corner. If this
- is turned off, \verb|\printindex| will not contain
- valid hyperlinks. \\
-nesting & boolean & false & Allows links to be nested; no drivers currently support this.
-\end{longtable}
-
-Note for option \verb|breaklinks|:
-The correct value is automatically set according to the driver features.
-It can be overwritten for drivers that do not support broken links.
-However, at any case, the link area will be wrong and displaced.
-
-\subsection{Backend drivers}
-
-If no driver is specified, the package tries to find a driver in
-the following order:
-\begin{enumerate}
-\item Autodetection, some \TeX\ processors can be detected at \TeX\ macro
- level (pdf\TeX, Xe\TeX, V\TeX).
-\item Option \textsf{driverfallback}. If this option is set, its value
- is taken as driver option.
-\item Macro \cs{Hy at defaultdriver}. The macro takes a driver file
- name (without file extension).
-\item Package default is \textsf{hypertex}.
-\end{enumerate}
-Many distributions are using a driver file \texttt{hypertex.cfg} that
-define \cs{Hy at defaultdriver} with \texttt{hdvips}. This is recommended
-because driver \textsf{dvips} provides much more features than
-\textsf{hypertex} for PDF generation.
-
-\begin{longtable}{@{}>{\ttfamily}lp{.8\hsize}@{}}
-driverfallback & Its value is used as driver option\\
- & if the driver is not given or autodetected.\\
-dvipdfm & Sets up \textsf{hyperref} for use with the \textsf{dvipdfm} driver.\\
-dvipdfmx & Sets up \textsf{hyperref} for use with the \textsf{dvipdfmx} driver.\\
-dvips & Sets up \textsf{hyperref} for use with the \textsf{dvips} driver. \\
-dvipsone & Sets up \textsf{hyperref} for use with the \textsf{dvipsone} driver. \\
-dviwindo & Sets up \textsf{hyperref} for use with the \textsf{dviwindo} Windows previewer. \\
-hypertex & Sets up \textsf{hyperref} for use with the Hyper\TeX-compliant drivers. \\
-latex2html & Redefines a few macros for compatibility with \textsf{latex2html}. \\
-nativepdf & An alias for \textsf{dvips} \\
-pdfmark & An alias for \textsf{dvips} \\
-pdftex & Sets up \textsf{hyperref} for use with the \textsf{pdftex} program.\\
-ps2pdf & Redefines a few macros for compatibility with
- Ghostscript's PDF writer, otherwise identical to
- \textsf{dvips}. \\
-tex4ht & For use with \textsf{\TeX4ht} \\
-textures & For use with \textsf{Textures} \\
-vtex & For use with MicroPress' \textsf{VTeX}; the PDF
- and HTML backends are detected automatically. \\
-vtexpdfmark & For use with \textsf{VTeX}'s PostScript backend. \\
-xetex & For use with Xe\TeX\ (using backend for dvipdfm).
-\end{longtable}
-\smallskip
-
-If you use \textsf{dviwindo}, you may need to redefine the macro
-\ci{wwwbrowser} (the default is \verb|C:\netscape\netscape|) to tell
-\textsf{dviwindo} what program to launch. Thus, users of Internet
-Explorer might add something like this to hyperref.cfg:
-
-\begin{verbatim}
-\renewcommand{\wwwbrowser}{C:\string\Program\space
- Files\string\Plus!\string\Microsoft\space
- Internet\string\iexplore.exe}
-\end{verbatim}
-
-\subsection{Extension options}
-\begin{longtable}{@{}>{\ttfamily}ll>{\itshape}lp{8cm}@{}}
-extension & text & & Set the file extension (e.g.\ \textsf{dvi}) which will be appended to file links
- created if you use the \xpackage{xr} package. \\
-hyperfigures & boolean & & \\
-backref & text & false & Adds `backlink' text to the end of each item in the bibliography, as a list of
- section numbers. This can only work properly \emph{if} there is a blank line after
- each \verb|\bibitem|. Supported values are \verb|section|, \verb|slide|, \verb|page|,
- \verb|none|, or \verb|false|. If no value is given, \verb|section| is taken as default.\\
-pagebackref & boolean & false & Adds `backlink' text to the end of each item in the bibliography, as a list of page
- numbers. \\
-hyperindex & boolean & true & Makes the page numbers of index entries into hyperlinks. Relays on unique
- page anchors (\verb|pageanchor|, \ldots)
- \verb|pageanchors| and \verb|plainpages=false|. \\
-hyperfootnotes & boolean & true & Makes the footnote marks into hyperlinks to the footnote text.
- Easily broken \ldots\\
-encap & & & Sets encap character for hyperindex \\
-linktoc & text & section & make text (\verb|section|), page number (\verb|page|), both (\verb|all|) or nothing (\verb|none|) be link on TOC, LOF and LOT \\
-linktocpage & boolean & false & make page number, not text, be link on TOC, LOF and LOT \\
-breaklinks & boolean & false & allow links to break over lines by making links over multiple lines into PDF links to
- the same target \\
-colorlinks & boolean & false & Colors the text of links and anchors. The colors chosen depend on the the type of
- link. At present the only types of link distinguished are citations, page references,
- URLs, local file references, and other links.
- Unlike colored boxes, the colored
- text remains when printing.\\
-linkcolor & color & red & Color for normal internal links. \\
-anchorcolor & color & black & Color for anchor text. Ignored by most drivers. \\
-citecolor & color & green & Color for bibliographical citations in text. \\
-filecolor & color & cyan & Color for URLs which open local files. \\
-menucolor & color & red & Color for Acrobat menu items. \\
-runcolor & color & filecolor & Color for run links (launch annotations). \\
-urlcolor & color & magenta & Color for linked URLs. \\
-allcolors & color & & Set all color options (without border and field options).\\
-frenchlinks & boolean & false & Use small caps instead of color for links.\\
-hidelinks & & & Hide links (removing color and border). \\
-\end{longtable} \smallskip
-
-Note that all color names must be defined before use, following the
-normal system of the standard \LaTeX\ \xpackage{color} package.
-
-\subsection{PDF-specific display options}
-\begin{longtable}{@{}>{\ttfamily}ll>{\itshape}lp{7.6cm}@{}}
-bookmarks & boolean & true & A set of Acrobat bookmarks are written, in a manner similar to the
- table of contents, requiring two passes of \LaTeX. Some postprocessing
- of the bookmark file (file extension \texttt{.out}) may be needed to
- translate \LaTeX\ codes, since bookmarks must be written in PDFEncoding.
- To aid this process, the \texttt{.out} file is not rewritten by \LaTeX\
- if it is edited to contain a line \verb|\let\WriteBookmarks\relax| \\
-bookmarksopen & boolean & false & If Acrobat bookmarks are requested, show them with all the subtrees
- expanded. \\
-bookmarksopenlevel & parameter & & level (\ci{maxdimen}) to which bookmarks are open \\
-bookmarksnumbered & boolean & false & If Acrobat bookmarks are requested, include section numbers. \\
-bookmarkstype & text & toc & to specify which `toc' file to mimic \\
-CJKbookmarks & boolean & false &
- This option should be used to produce CJK bookmarks.
- Package \verb|hyperref|
- supports both normal and preprocessed mode of the \xpackage{CJK} package;
- during the creation of bookmarks, it simply replaces CJK's macros
- with special versions which expand to the corresponding character
- codes. Note that without the `unicode' option of hyperref you get
- PDF files which actually violate the PDF specification because
- non-Unicode character codes are used -- some PDF readers localized
- for CJK languages (most notably Acroread itself) support this.
- Also note that option `CJKbookmarks' cannot be used together
- with option `unicode'.
-
- No mechanism is provided to translate non-Unicode bookmarks to
- Unicode; for portable PDF documents only Unicode encoding should
- be used.\\
-pdfhighlight & name & /I & How link buttons behave when selected; /I is for inverse (the default);
- the other possibilities are /N (no effect), /O (outline), and /P (inset
- highlighting). \\
-citebordercolor & RGB color & 0 1 0 & The color of the box around citations \\
-filebordercolor & RGB color & 0 .5 .5 & The color of the box around links to files \\
-linkbordercolor & RGB color & 1 0 0 & The color of the box around normal links \\
-menubordercolor & RGB color & 1 0 0 & The color of the box around Acrobat menu links \\
-urlbordercolor & RGB color & 0 1 1 & The color of the box around links to URLs \\
-runbordercolor & RGB color & 0 .7 .7 & Color of border around `run' links \\
-allbordercolors & & & Set all border color options \\
-pdfborder & & 0 0 1 & The style of box around links; defaults to a box with lines of 1pt thickness,
- but the colorlinks option resets it to produce no border.
-\end{longtable}
-
-The color of link borders used to be specified \emph{only} as 3
-numbers in the range 0..1, giving an RGB color. Since version 6.76a, the usual
-color specifications of package \xpackage{(x)color} can be used if \xpackage{xcolor}
-has been loaded.
-For further information see description of package \xpackage{hycolor}.
-
-The bookmark commands are stored in a file called
-\textit{jobname}\texttt{.out}. The files is not processed by \LaTeX\ so
-any markup is passed through. You can postprocess this file as needed;
-as an aid for this, the \texttt{.out} file is not overwritten on the
-next \TeX\ run if it is edited to contain the line
-\begin{verbatim}
-\let\WriteBookmarks\relax
-\end{verbatim}
-
-\subsection{PDF display and information options}
-\begin{longtable}{@{}>{\ttfamily}l>{\raggedright}p{\widthof{key value}}>{\itshape}lp{7cm}@{}}
-baseurl & URL & & Sets the base URL of the PDF document \\
-pdfpagemode & name & empty & Determines how the file is opening in Acrobat; the possibilities are
- \verb|UseNone|, \verb|UseThumbs| (show thumbnails), \verb|UseOutlines|
- (show bookmarks), \verb|FullScreen|, \verb|UseOC| (PDF 1.5),
- and \verb|UseAttachments| (PDF 1.6). If no mode if explicitly chosen, but the
- bookmarks option is set, \verb|UseOutlines| is used. \\
-pdftitle & text & & Sets the document information Title field \\
-pdfauthor & text & & Sets the document information Author field \\
-pdfsubject & text & & Sets the document information Subject field \\
-pdfcreator & text & & Sets the document information Creator field \\
-addtopdfcreator & text & & Adds additional text to the document information Creator field \\
-pdfkeywords & text & & Sets the document information Keywords field \\
-pdftrapped & name & empty & Sets the document information Trapped entry. Possible values are \verb|True|, \verb|False| and \verb|Unknown|.
- An empty value means, the entry is not set.\\
-%
-pdfinfo & key value list & empty & Alternative interface for setting the
- document information.\\
-pdfview & name & XYZ & Sets the default PDF `view' for each link \\
-pdfstartpage & integer & 1 & Determines on which page the PDF file is opened. An empty value means, the entry is not set.\\
-pdfstartview & name & Fit & Set the startup page view \\
-pdfremotestartview & name & Fit & Set the startup page view of remote PDF files \\
-pdfpagescrop & n n n n & & Sets the default PDF crop box for pages. This should be a set of four numbers \\
-pdfcenterwindow & boolean & false & position the document window in the center of the screen \\
-pdfdirection & name & empty & direction setting. Possible values: \verb|L2R| (left to right) and
- \verb|R2L| (right to left)\\
-pdfdisplaydoctitle & boolean & false & display document title instead of file name in title bar\\
-pdfduplex & name & empty & paper handling option for print dialog. Possible vatues are:
- \verb|Simplex| (print single-sided),
- \verb|DuplexFlipShortEdge| (duplex and flip on the short edge of the sheet),
- \verb|DuplexFlipLongEdge| (duplex and flip on the long edge of the sheet)\\
-
-pdffitwindow & boolean & false & resize document window to fit document size \\
-pdflang & name & relax & PDF language identifier (RFC 3066)\\
-pdfmenubar & boolean & true & make PDF viewer's menu bar visible \\
-pdfnewwindow & boolean & false & make links that open another PDF file start a new window \\
-pdfnonfullscreenpagemode
- & name & empty & page mode setting on exiting full-screen mode. Possible values are
- \verb|UseNone|, \verb|UseOutlines|, \verb|UseThumbs|, and \verb|UseOC|\\
-pdfnumcopies & integer & empty & number of printed copies \\
-pdfpagelayout & name & empty & set layout of PDF pages. Possible values:
- \verb|SinglePage|, \verb|OneColumn|,
- \verb|TwoColumnLeft|, \verb|TwoColumnRight|,
- \verb|TwoPageLeft|, and \verb|TwoPageRight| \\
-pdfpagelabels & boolean & true & set PDF page labels \\
-pdfpagetransition & name & empty & set PDF page transition style. Possible values are
- \verb|Split|, \verb|Blinds|, \verb|Box|, \verb|Wipe|,
- \verb|Dissolve|, \verb|Glitter|, \verb|R|,
- \verb|Fly|, \verb|Push|,
- \verb|Cover|, \verb|Uncover|,
- \verb|Fade|.
- The default according to the PDF~Reference is \verb|R|,
- which simply replaces the old page with the new one. \\
-pdfpicktraybypdfsize
- & boolean & false & specify whether PDF page size is used to select input paper tray in print dialog \\
-pdfprintarea & name & empty & set /PrintArea of viewer preferences. Possible values are
- \verb|MediaBox|, \verb|CropBox|,
- \verb|BleedBox|, \verb|TrimBox|, and \verb|ArtBox|.
- The dafault according to the PDF~Refence is \verb|CropBox| \\
-pdfprintclip & name & empty & set /PrintClip of viewer preferences. Possible values are
- \verb|MediaBox|, \verb|CropBox|,
- \verb|BleedBox|, \verb|TrimBox|, and \verb|ArtBox|.
- The dafault according to the PDF~Refence is \verb|CropBox| \\
-pdfprintpagerange & n n (n n)*
- & empty & set /PrintPageRange of viewer preferences\\
-pdfprintscaling & name & empty & page scaling option for print dialog
- (option /PrintScaling of viewer
- preferences, PDF 1.6);
- valid values are \verb|None| and
- \verb|AppDefault| \\
-pdftoolbar & boolean & true & make PDF toolbar visible \\
-pdfviewarea & name & empty & set /ViewArea of viewer preferences. Possible values are
- \verb|MediaBox|, \verb|CropBox|,
- \verb|BleedBox|, \verb|TrimBox|, and \verb|ArtBox|.
- The dafault according to the PDF~Refence is \verb|CropBox| \\
-pdfviewclip & name & empty & set /ViewClip of viewer preferences Possible values are
- \verb|MediaBox|, \verb|CropBox|,
- \verb|BleedBox|, \verb|TrimBox|, and \verb|ArtBox|.
- The dafault according to the PDF~Refence is \verb|CropBox| \\
-pdfwindowui & boolean & true & make PDF user interface elements visible \\
-unicode & boolean & true & Unicode encoded PDF strings
-\end{longtable}
-
-Each link in Acrobat carries its own magnification level, which is set
-using PDF coordinate space, which is not the same as \TeX's. The unit
-is bp and the origin is in the lower left corner. See also
-\verb|\hypercalcbp| that is explained on page \pageref{hypercalcbp}.
-pdf\TeX\
-works by supplying default values for \texttt{XYZ} (horizontal $\times$
-vertical $\times$ zoom) and \texttt{FitBH}. However, drivers using
-\texttt{pdfmark} do not supply defaults, so \textsf{hyperref} passes in
-a value of -32768, which causes Acrobat to set (usually) sensible
-defaults. The following are possible values for the \texttt{pdfview},
-\texttt{pdfstartview} and \texttt{pdfremotestartview} parameters.
-
-\begin{longtable}{@{}>{\ttfamily}l>{\itshape}lp{7cm}@{}}
-XYZ & left top zoom & Sets a coordinate and a zoom factor. If any one is null, the source link value is used.
- \textit{null null null} will give the same values as the current page. \\
-Fit & & Fits the page to the window. \\
-FitH & top & Fits the width of the page to the window. \\
-FitV & left & Fits the height of the page to the window. \\
-FitR & left bottom right top & Fits the rectangle specified by the four coordinates to the window. \\
-FitB & & Fits the page bounding box to the window. \\
-FitBH & top & Fits the width of the page bounding box to the window. \\
-FitBV & left & Fits the height of the page bounding box to the window. \\
-\end{longtable}
-
-The \texttt{pdfpagelayout} can be one of the following values.
-
-\begin{longtable}{@{}>{\ttfamily}lp{10cm}@{}}
-SinglePage & Displays a single page; advancing flips the page \\
-OneColumn & Displays the document in one column; continuous scrolling. \\
-TwoColumnLeft & Displays the document in two columns, odd-numbered pages to the left. \\
-TwoColumnRight & Displays the document in two columns, odd-numbered pages to the right.\\
-TwoPageLeft & Displays two pages, odd-numbered pages to the left (since PDF 1.5).\\
-TwoPageRight & Displays two pages, odd-numbered pages to the right (since PDF 1.5).
-\end{longtable}
-
-Finally, the \texttt{pdfpagetransition} can be one of the following
-values, where \textit{/Di} stands for direction of motion in degrees,
-generally in 90$^{\circ}$\ steps, \textit{/Dm} is a horizontal
-(\texttt{/H}) or vertical (\texttt{/V}) dimension (e.g.\ \texttt{Blinds
-/Dm /V}), and \textit{/M} is for motion, either in (\texttt{/I}) or out
-(\texttt{/O}).
-
-\begin{longtable}{@{}>{\ttfamily}llp{8.5cm}@{}}
-Blinds & /Dm & Multiple lines distributed evenly across the screen sweep in the same direction to reveal the new
- page. \\
-Box & /M & A box sweeps in or out. \\
-Dissolve & & The page image dissolves in a piecemeal fashion to reveal the new page. \\
-Glitter & /Di & Similar to Dissolve, except the effect sweeps across the screen. \\
-Split & /Dm /M & Two lines sweep across the screen to reveal the new page. \\
-Wipe & /Di & A single line sweeps across the screen to reveal the new page. \\
-R & & Simply replaces the old page with the new one. \\
-Fly & /Di /M & Changes are flown out or in (as specified by /M), in the direction
- specified by /Di, to or from a location that is
- offscreen except when /Di is None. \\
-Push & /Di & The old page slides off the screen while the new page slides in,
- pushing the old page out in the direction
- specified by /Di. \\
-Cover & /Di & The new page slides on to the screen in the direction specified
- by /Di, covering the old page. \\
-Uncover & /Di & The old page slides off the screen in the direction specified by
- /Di, uncovering the new page in the direction
- specified by /Di. \\
-Fade & & The new page gradually becomes visible through the old one.
-
-\end{longtable}
-
-\subsection{Option \texttt{pdfinfo}}
-
-The information entries can be set using \texttt{pdftitle},
-\texttt{pdfsubject}, \dots. Option \texttt{pdfinfo} provides an alternative
-interface. It takes a key value list. The key names are the names that
-appear in the PDF information dictionary directly. Known keys such as
-\texttt{Title}, \texttt{Subject}, \texttt{Trapped} and other are mapped to
-options \texttt{pdftitle}, \texttt{subject}, \texttt{trapped}, \dots
-Unknown keys are added to the information dictionary. Their values are text
-strings (see PDF specification).
-Example:
-\begin{quote}
-\begin{verbatim}
-\hypersetup{
- pdfinfo={
- Title={My Title},
- Subject={My Subject},
- NewKey={Foobar},
- % ...
- }
-}
-\end{verbatim}
-\end{quote}
-
-\subsection{Big alphabetical list}
-
-The following is a complete listing of available options for
-\textsf{hyperref}, arranged alphabetically.
-
-\begin{longtable}{@{}>{\ttfamily}llp{7cm}@{}}
-allbordercolors & & Set all border color options\\
-allcolors & & Set all color options (without border and field options)\\
-anchorcolor & \textit{black} & set color of anchors, ignored by most drivers. \\
-backref & \textit{false} & do bibliographical back references \\
-baseurl & \textit{empty} & set base URL for document \\
-bookmarks & \textit{true} & make bookmarks \\
-bookmarksnumbered & \textit{false} & put section numbers in bookmarks \\
-bookmarksopen & \textit{false} & open up bookmark tree \\
-bookmarksopenlevel & \ttfamily\ci{maxdimen} & level to which bookmarks are open \\
-bookmarkstype & \textit{toc} & to specify which `toc' file to mimic \\
-breaklinks & \textit{false} & allow links to break over lines \\
-CJKbookmarks & \textit{false} & to produce CJK bookmarks\\
-citebordercolor & \textit{0 1 0} & color of border around cites \\
-citecolor & \textit{green} & color of citation links \\
-colorlinks & \textit{false} & color links \\
- & \textit{true} & (\textsf{tex4ht}, \textsf{dviwindo}) \\
-debug & \textit{false} & provide details of anchors defined; same as verbose \\
-destlabel & \textit{false} & destinations are named by the first \verb|\label| after the anchor creation \\
-draft & \textit{false} & do not do any hyperlinking \\
-driverfallback & & default if no driver specified or detected\\
-dvipdfm & & use \textsf{dvipdfm} backend \\
-dvipdfmx & & use \textsf{dvipdfmx} backend \\
-dvips & & use \textsf{dvips} backend \\
-dvipsone & & use \textsf{dvipsone} backend \\
-dviwindo & & use \textsf{dviwindo} backend \\
-encap & & to set encap character for hyperindex \\
-extension & \textit{dvi} & suffix of linked files \\
-filebordercolor & \textit{0 .5 .5} & color of border around file links \\
-filecolor & \textit{cyan} & color of file links \\
-final & \textit{true} & opposite of option draft \\
-frenchlinks & \textit{false} & use small caps instead of color for links \\
-hidelinks & & Hide links (removing color and border) \\
-hyperfigures & \textit{false} & make figures hyper links \\
-hyperfootnotes & \textit{true} & set up hyperlinked footnotes \\
-hyperindex & \textit{true} & set up hyperlinked indices \\
-hypertex & & use \textsf{Hyper\TeX} backend \\
-hypertexnames & \textit{true} & use guessable names for links \\
-implicit & \textit{true} & redefine \LaTeX\ internals \\
-latex2html & & use \textsf{\LaTeX2HTML} backend \\
-linkbordercolor & \textit{1 0 0} & color of border around links \\
-linkcolor & \textit{red} & color of links \\
-linktoc & \textit{section} & make text be link on TOC, LOF and LOT \\
-linktocpage & \textit{false} & make page number, not text, be link on TOC, LOF and LOT \\
-menubordercolor & \textit{1 0 0} & color of border around menu links \\
-menucolor & \textit{red} & color for menu links \\
-nativepdf & \textit{false} & an alias for \textsf{dvips} \\
-naturalnames & \textit{false} & use \LaTeX-computed names for links \\
-nesting & \textit{false} & allow nesting of links \\
-next-anchor & & allow to set the name of the next anchor\\
-pageanchor & \textit{true} & put an anchor on every page \\
-pagebackref & \textit{false} & backreference by page number \\
-pdfauthor & \textit{empty} & text for PDF Author field \\
-pdfborder & \textit{0 0 1} & width of PDF link border \\
- & \textit{0 0 0} & (\texttt{colorlinks)} \\
-pdfborderstyle & & border style for links \\
-pdfcenterwindow & \textit{false} & position the document window in the center of the screen \\
-pdfcreator & \textit{LaTeX with} & text for PDF Creator field \\
- & \textit{hyperref} & \\
-pdfdirection & \textit{empty} & direction setting \\
-pdfdisplaydoctitle & \textit{false} & display document title instead
- of file name in title bar\\
-pdfduplex & \textit{empty} & paper handling option for
- print dialog\\
-pdffitwindow & \textit{false} & resize document window to fit document size \\
-pdfhighlight & \textit{/I} & set highlighting of PDF links \\
-pdfinfo & \textit{empty} & alternative interface for setting document information\\
-pdfkeywords & \textit{empty} & text for PDF Keywords field \\
-pdflang & \textit{relax} & PDF language identifier (RFC 3066) \\
-pdfmark & \textit{false} & an alias for \textsf{dvips} \\
-pdfmenubar & \textit{true} & make PDF viewer's menu bar visible \\
-pdfnewwindow & \textit{false} & make links that open another PDF \\
- & & file start a new window \\
-pdfnonfullscreenpagemode
- & \textit{empty} & page mode setting on exiting
- full-screen mode\\
-pdfnumcopies & \textit{empty} & number of printed copies\\
-pdfpagelabels & \textit{true} & set PDF page labels \\
-pdfpagelayout & \textit{empty} & set layout of PDF pages \\
-pdfpagemode & \textit{empty} & set default mode of PDF display \\
-pdfpagescrop & \textit{empty} & set crop size of PDF document \\
-pdfpagetransition & \textit{empty} & set PDF page transition style \\
-pdfpicktraybypdfsize
- & \textit{empty} & set option for print dialog \\
-pdfprintarea & \textit{empty} & set /PrintArea of viewer preferences \\
-pdfprintclip & \textit{empty} & set /PrintClip of viewer preferences \\
-pdfprintpagerange & \textit{empty} & set /PrintPageRange of viewer preferences \\
-pdfprintscaling & \textit{empty} & page scaling option for print dialog \\
-pdfproducer & \textit{empty} & text for PDF Producer field \\
-pdfremotestartview & \textit{Fit} & starting view of remote PDF documents \\
-pdfstartpage & \textit{1} & page at which PDF document opens \\
-pdfstartview & \textit{Fit} & starting view of PDF document \\
-pdfsubject & \textit{empty} & text for PDF Subject field \\
-pdftex & & use \textsf{pdf\TeX} backend \\
-pdftitle & \textit{empty} & text for PDF Title field \\
-pdftoolbar & \textit{true} & make PDF toolbar visible \\
-pdftrapped & \textit{empty} & Sets the document information Trapped entry.
- Possible values are \texttt{True}, \texttt{False} and \texttt{Unknown}.
- An empty value means, the entry is not set.\\
-pdfview & \textit{XYZ} & PDF `view' when on link traversal \\
-pdfviewarea & \textit{empty} & set /ViewArea of viewer preferences \\
-pdfviewclip & \textit{empty} & set /ViewClip of viewer preferences \\
-pdfwindowui & \textit{true} & make PDF user interface elements visible \\
-plainpages & \textit{false} & do page number anchors as plain Arabic \\
-ps2pdf & & use \textsf{ps2pdf} backend \\
-psdextra & \textit{false} & define more short names for PDF string commands \\
-raiselinks & \textit{false} & raise up links (for \textsf{Hyper\TeX} backend) \\
-runbordercolor & \textit{0 .7 .7} & color of border around `run' links \\
-runcolor & \textit{filecolor} & color of `run' links\\
-setpagesize & \textit{true} & set page size by special driver commands \\
-tex4ht & & use \textsf{\TeX4ht} backend \\
-textures & & use \textsf{Textures} backend \\
-unicode & \textit{true} & Unicode encoded pdf strings, starting with version v7.00g set by default to true for all engines. It will load a number of definitions in puenc.def. It can be set to false for pdflatex, but this is not recommended.\\
-urlbordercolor & \textit{0 1 1} & color of border around URL links \\
-urlcolor & \textit{magenta} & color of URL links \\
-verbose & \textit{false} & be chatty \\
-vtex & & use \textsf{VTeX} backend\\
-xetex & & use \textsf{Xe\TeX} backend\\
-\end{longtable}
-
-\section{Additional user macros}
-
-If you need to make references to URLs, or write explicit links, the
-following low-level user macros are provided:
-
-\begin{cmdsyntax}
-\ci{href}\verb|[|\emph{options}\verb|]|\verb|{|\emph{URL}\verb|}{|\emph{text}\verb|}|
-\end{cmdsyntax}
-
-\noindent The \emph{text} is made a hyperlink to the \emph{URL}; this
-must be a full URL (relative to the base URL, if that is defined). The
-special characters \# and \~{} do \emph{not} need to be escaped in any
-way (unless the command is used in the argument of another command).
-
-The optional argument \emph{options} recognizes the hyperref options
-\texttt{pdfremotestartview}, \texttt{pdfnewwindow} and the following
-key value options:
-\begin{description}
-\item[\texttt{page}:] Specifies the start page number of remote
-PDF documents. First page is \verb|1|.
-\item[\texttt{ismap}:] Boolean key, if set to \verb|true|, the
-URL should appended by the coordinates as query parameters by
-the PDF viewer.
-\item[\texttt{nextactionraw}:] The value of key \verb|/Next| of
-action dictionaries, see PDF specification.
-\end{description}
-
-\begin{cmdsyntax}
-\ci{url}\verb|{|\emph{URL}\verb|}|
-\end{cmdsyntax}
-
-\noindent Similar to
-\ci{href}\verb|{|\emph{URL}\verb|}{|\ci{nolinkurl}\verb|{|\emph{URL}\verb|}}|.
-Depending on the driver \verb|\href| also tries to detect the link type.
-Thus the result can be a url link, file link, \dots
-
-\begin{cmdsyntax}
-\ci{nolinkurl}\verb|{|\emph{URL}\verb|}|
-\end{cmdsyntax}
-
-\noindent Write \emph{URL} in the same way as \verb|\url|,
- without creating a hyperlink.
-
-\begin{cmdsyntax}
-\ci{hyperbaseurl}\verb|{|\emph{URL}\verb|}|
-\end{cmdsyntax}
-
-\noindent A base \emph{URL} is established, which is prepended to other
-specified URLs, to make it easier to write portable documents.
-
-\begin{cmdsyntax}
-\ci{hyperimage}\verb|{|\emph{imageURL}\verb|}{|\emph{text}\verb|}|
-\end{cmdsyntax}
-
-\noindent The link to the image referenced by the URL is inserted, using
-\emph{text} as the anchor.
-
- For drivers that produce HTML, the image itself is inserted by the
-browser, with the \emph{text} being ignored completely.
-
-\begin{cmdsyntax}
-\ci{hyperdef}\verb|{|\emph{category}\verb|}{|\emph{name}\verb|}{|\emph{text}\verb|}|
-\end{cmdsyntax}
-
-\noindent A target area of the document (the \emph{text}) is marked, and
-given the name \emph{category.name}
-
-\begin{cmdsyntax}
-\ci{hyperref}\verb|{|\emph{URL}\verb|}{|\emph{category}\verb|}{|\emph{name}\verb|}{|\emph{text}\verb|}|
-\end{cmdsyntax}
-
-\noindent \emph{text} is made into a link to \emph{URL\#category.name}
-
-\begin{cmdsyntax}
-\ci{hyperref}\verb|[|\emph{label}\verb|]{|\emph{text}\verb|}|
-\end{cmdsyntax}
-
-\noindent
-\emph{text} is made into a link to the same place as
-\verb|\ref{|\emph{label}\verb|}| would be linked.
-
-\begin{cmdsyntax}
-\ci{hyperlink}\verb|{|\emph{name}\verb|}{|\emph{text}\verb|}|
-\end{cmdsyntax}
-\begin{cmdsyntax}
-\ci{hypertarget}\verb|{|\emph{name}\verb|}{|\emph{text}\verb|}|
-\end{cmdsyntax}
-
-\noindent A simple internal link is created with \verb|\hypertarget|,
-with two parameters of an anchor \emph{name}, and anchor
-\emph{text}. \verb|\hyperlink| has two arguments, the name of a
-hypertext object defined somewhere by \verb|\hypertarget|, and the
-\emph{text} which be used as the link on the page.
-
-Note that in HTML parlance, the \verb|\hyperlink| command inserts a
-notional \# in front of each link, making it relative to the current
-testdocument; \verb|\href| expects a full URL.
-
-\begin{cmdsyntax}
-\ci{phantomsection}
-\end{cmdsyntax}
-
-\noindent
-This sets an anchor at this location. It works similar to
-\verb|\hypertarget{}{}| with an automatically chosen anchor name.
-Often it is used in conjunction
-with \verb|\addcontentsline| for sectionlike things (index, bibliography,
-preface). \verb|\addcontentsline| refers to the latest previous location
-where an anchor is set. Example:
-\begin{quote}
-\begin{verbatim}
-\cleardoublepage
-\phantomsection
-\addcontentsline{toc}{chapter}{\indexname}
-\printindex
-\end{verbatim}
-\end{quote}
-Now the entry in the table of contents (and bookmarks) for the
-index points to the start of the index page, not to a location
-before this page.
-
-\begin{cmdsyntax}
-\ci{hyperget}\verb|{|\emph{anchor}\verb|}{|\emph{label}\verb|}|
-\ci{hyperget}\verb|{|\emph{pageanchor}\verb|}{|\emph{label}\verb|}|
-\end{cmdsyntax}
-
-This retrieves the anchor or the page anchor from a label in an expandable way.
-It takes \verb|\HyperDestNameFilter| into account. It can e.g. be used with the
-\verb|\bookmark| from the bookmark package to set a destination to a label:
-
-\begin{verbatim}
-\bookmark[dest=\hyperget{anchor}{sec}]{section}
-\end{verbatim}
-
-As \emph{pageanchor} retrieves the page number from the label it can't be use together with
-the option \texttt{plainpages}.
-
-\begin{cmdsyntax}
-\ci{hyperget}\verb|{|\emph{currentanchor}\verb|}{}|
-\end{cmdsyntax}
-
-This retrieves the last anchor that has been set. It too takes \verb|\HyperDestNameFilter| into account.
-
-
-
-\begin{cmdsyntax}
-\ci{autoref}\verb|{|\emph{label}\verb|}|
-\end{cmdsyntax}
-
-\noindent
-This is a replacement for the usual \verb|\ref| command that places a
-contextual label in front of the reference. This gives your users a
-bigger target to click for hyperlinks (e.g.\ `section 2' instead of
-merely the number `2').
-
-The label is worked out from the context of the original \verb|\label|
-command by \textsf{hyperref} by using the macros listed below (shown
-with their default values). The macros can be (re)defined in documents
-using \verb|\(re)newcommand|; note that some of these macros are already
-defined in the standard document classes. The mixture of lowercase and
-uppercase initial letters is deliberate and corresponds to the author's
-practice.
-
-For each macro below, \textsf{hyperref} checks \ci{*autorefname} before
-\ci{*name}. For instance, it looks for \ci{figureautorefname} before
-\ci{figurename}.
-
-\begin{longtable}{@{}lp{10cm}@{}}
-\textit{Macro} & \textit{Default} \\
-\ci{figurename} & Figure \\
-\ci{tablename} & Table \\
-\ci{partname} & Part \\
-\ci{appendixname} & Appendix \\
-\ci{equationname} & Equation \\
-\ci{Itemname} & item \\
-\ci{chaptername} & chapter \\
-\ci{sectionname} & section \\
-\ci{subsectionname} & subsection \\
-\ci{subsubsectionname} & subsubsection \\
-\ci{paragraphname} & paragraph \\
-\ci{Hfootnotename} & footnote \\
-\ci{AMSname} & Equation \\
-\ci{theoremname} & Theorem\\
-\ci{page} & page\\
-\end{longtable}
-
-Example for a redefinition if \textsf{babel} is used:
-\begin{quote}
-\begin{verbatim}
-\usepackage[ngerman]{babel}
-\addto\extrasngerman{%
- \def\subsectionautorefname{Unterkapitel}%
-}
-\end{verbatim}
-\end{quote}
-
-Hint: \cs{autoref} works via the counter name that the reference
-is based on. Sometimes \cs{autoref} chooses the wrong name, if
-the counter is used for different things. For example, it happens
-with \cs{newtheorem} if a lemma shares a counter with theorems.
-Then package \xpackage{aliascnt} provides a method to generate a
-simulated second counter that allows the differentiation between
-theorems and lemmas:
-\begin{quote}
-\begin{verbatim}
-\documentclass{article}
-
-\usepackage{aliascnt}
-\usepackage{hyperref}
-
-\newtheorem{theorem}{Theorem}
-
-\newaliascnt{lemma}{theorem}
-\newtheorem{lemma}[lemma]{Lemma}
-\aliascntresetthe{lemma}
-
-\providecommand*{\lemmaautorefname}{Lemma}
-
-\begin{document}
-
-We will use \autoref{a} to prove \autoref{b}.
-
-\begin{lemma}\label{a}
- Nobody knows.
-\end{lemma}
-
-\begin{theorem}\label{b}
- Nobody is right.
-\end{theorem}.
-
-\end{document}
-\end{verbatim}
-\end{quote}
-
-\begin{cmdsyntax}
-\ci{autopageref}\verb|{|\emph{label}\verb|}|
-\end{cmdsyntax}
-
-\noindent
-It replaces \verb|\pageref| and adds the name for page in front of
-the page reference. First \ci{pageautorefname} is checked before
-\ci{pagename}.
-
-For instances where you want a reference to use the correct counter, but
-not to create a link, there are starred forms (these starred forms exist even if
-hyperref has been loaded with \verb|implicit=false|):
-
-\begin{cmdsyntax}
-\ci{ref*}\verb|{|\emph{label}\verb|}|
-\end{cmdsyntax}
-
-\begin{cmdsyntax}
-\ci{pageref*}\verb|{|\emph{label}\verb|}|
-\end{cmdsyntax}
-
-\begin{cmdsyntax}
-\ci{autoref*}\verb|{|\emph{label}\verb|}|
-\end{cmdsyntax}
-
-\begin{cmdsyntax}
-\ci{autopageref*}\verb|{|\emph{label}\verb|}|
-\end{cmdsyntax}
-
-A typical use would be to write
-\begin{verbatim}
-\hyperref[other]{that nice section (\ref*{other}) we read before}
-\end{verbatim}
-
-We want \verb|\ref*{other}| to generate the correct number, but not to
-form a link, since we do this ourselves with \ci{hyperref}.
-
-\begin{cmdsyntax}
-\ci{pdfstringdef}\verb|{|\emph{macroname}\verb|}{|\emph{\TeX string}\verb|}|
-\end{cmdsyntax}
-
-\ci{pdfstringdef} returns a macro containing the PDF string. (Currently
-this is done globally, but do not rely on it.) All the following tasks,
-definitions and redefinitions are made in a group to keep them local:
-
-\begin{itemize}
-\item Switching to PD1 or PU encoding
-\item Defining the \Quote{octal sequence commands} (\verb|\345|): \verb|\edef\3{\string\3}|
-\item Special glyphs of \TeX: \verb|\{|, \verb|\%|, \verb|\&|, \verb|\space|, \verb|\dots|, etc.
-\item National glyphs (\textsf{german.sty}, \textsf{french.sty}, etc.)
-\item Logos: \verb|\TeX|, \verb|\eTeX|, \verb|\MF|, etc.
-\item Disabling commands that do not provide useful functionality in bookmarks:
-\verb|\label|, \verb|\index|, \verb|\glossary|, \verb|\discretionary|, \verb|\def|, \verb|\let|, etc.
-\item \LaTeX's font commands like \verb|\textbf|, etc.
-\item Support for \verb|\xspace| provided by the \xpackage{xspace} package
-\end{itemize}
-
-In addition, parentheses are protected to avoid the danger of unsafe
-unbalanced parentheses in the PDF string. For further details, see Heiko
-Oberdiek's Euro\TeX\ paper distributed with \textsf{hyperref}.
-
-\begin{cmdsyntax}
-\ci{begin}\verb|{NoHyper}|\ldots\ci{end}\verb|{NoHyper}|
-\end{cmdsyntax}
- Sometimes we just don't want the wretched package interfering
- with us. Define an environment we can put in manually, or include
- in a style file, which stops the hypertext functions doing anything.
- This is used, for instance, in the Elsevier classes, to stop
- \verb|hyperref| playing havoc in the front matter.
-
-\subsection{Bookmark macros}
-
-\subsubsection{Setting bookmarks}
-
-Usually \textsf{hyperref} automatically adds bookmarks for
-\verb|\section| and similar macros. But they can also set manually.
-
-\begin{cmdsyntax}
-\ci{pdfbookmark}\verb|[|\emph{level}\verb|]{|text\verb|}{|\emph{name}\verb|}|
-\end{cmdsyntax}
-creates a bookmark with the specified text and at the given level (default is
-0). As name for the internal anchor name is used (in conjunction with
-level). Therefore the name must be unique (similar to \verb|\label|).
-
-\begin{cmdsyntax}
-\ci{currentpdfbookmark}\verb|{|\emph{text}\verb|}{|\emph{name}\verb|}|
-\end{cmdsyntax}
-creates a bookmark at the current level.
-
-\begin{cmdsyntax}
-\ci{subpdfbookmark}\verb|{|\emph{text}\verb|}{|\emph{name}\verb|}|
-\end{cmdsyntax}
-creates a bookmark one step down in the bookmark hierarchy.
-Internally the current level is increased by one.
-
-\begin{cmdsyntax}
-\ci{belowpdfbookmark}\verb|{|\emph{text}\verb|}{|\emph{name}\verb|}|
-\end{cmdsyntax}
-creates a bookmark below the current bookmark level. However after the
-command the current bookmark level has not changed.
-
-\noindent \textbf{Hint:} Package \textsf{bookmark} replaces
-\textsf{hyperref}'s bookmark organization by a new algorithm:
-\begin{itemize}
-\item Usually only one \LaTeX\ run is needed.
-\item More control over the bookmark appearance (color, font).
-\item Different bookmark actions are supported (external file links,
- URLs, \dots).
-\end{itemize}
-Therefore I recommend using this package.
-
-\subsubsection{Replacement macros}\label{sec:texorpdfstring}
-
-\textsf{hyperref} takes the text for bookmarks from the arguments of
-commands like \ci{section}, which can contain things like math, colors,
-or font changes, none of which will display in bookmarks as is.
-
-\begin{cmdsyntax}
-\ci{texorpdfstring}\verb|{|\emph{\TeX string}\verb|}{|\emph{PDFstring}\verb|}|
-\end{cmdsyntax}
-
-For example,
-\begin{verbatim}
-\section{Pythagoras:
- \texorpdfstring{$ a^2 + b^2 = c^2 $}{%
- a\texttwosuperior\ + b\texttwosuperior\ =
- c\texttwosuperior
- }%
-}
-\section{\texorpdfstring{\textcolor{red}}{}{Red} Mars}
-\end{verbatim}
-
-\ci{pdfstringdef} executes the hook \pdfstringdefPreHook before it
-expands the string. Therefore, you can use this hook to perform
-additional tasks or to disable additional commands.
-
-\begin{verbatim}
-\expandafter\def\expandafter\pdfstringdefPreHook
-\expandafter{%
- \pdfstringdefPreHook
- \renewcommand{\mycommand}[1]{}%
-}
-\end{verbatim}
-
-However, for disabling commands, an easier way is via
-\ci{pdfstringdefDisableCommands}, which adds its argument to the
-definition of \ci{pdfstringdefPreHook} (`@' can here be used as letter in
-command names):
-
-\begin{verbatim}
-\pdfstringdefDisableCommands{%
- \let~\textasciitilde
- \def\url{\pdfstringdefWarn\url}%
- \let\textcolor\@gobble
-}
-\end{verbatim}
-
-\subsection{Pagelabels}
-\begin{cmdsyntax}
-\ci{thispdfpagelabel}\verb|{|\emph{page number format}\verb|}|
-\end{cmdsyntax}
-
-This allows to change format of the page number shown in the tool bar of
-a PDF viewer for a specific page, for example
-
-\verb+\thispdfpagelabel{Empty Page-\roman{page}}+
-
-The command affects the page on which it is executed, so asynchronous page breaking
-should be taken into account. It should be used in places where for example \verb+\thispagestyle+ can be use too.
-
-\subsection{Utility macros}
-
-\label{hypercalcbp}
-\begin{cmdsyntax}
-\ci{hypercalcbp}\verb|{|\emph{dimen specification}\verb|}|
-\end{cmdsyntax}
-\noindent
-\verb|\hypercalcbp| takes a \TeX\ dimen specification and
-converts it to bp and returns the number without the unit.
-This is useful for options \verb|pdfview|, \verb|pdfstartview|
-and \verb|pdfremotestartview|.
-Example:
-\begin{quote}
-\begin{verbatim}
-\hypersetup{
- pdfstartview={FitBH \hypercalcbp{\paperheight-\topmargin-1in
- -\headheight-\headsep}
-}
-\end{verbatim}
-\end{quote}
-The origin of the PDF coordinate system is the lower left corner.
-
-Note, for calculations you need either package \xpackage{calc} or
-\hologo{eTeX}. Nowadays the latter should automatically be enabled
-for \hologo{LaTeX} formats. Users without \hologo{eTeX}, please, look
-in the source documentation \verb|hyperref.dtx| for further
-limitations.
-
-Also \cs{hypercalcbp} cannot be used in option specifications
-of \cs{documentclass} and \cs{usepackage}, because
-\hologo{LaTeX} expands the option lists of these commands. However
-package \xpackage{hyperref} is not yet loaded and an undefined control
-sequence error would arise.
-
-\section[New Features]{New Features%
-\footnote{This section moved from the README file, needs more integration into the manual}}
-
-
-\subsection{Option `pdflinkmargin'}
-
- Option `pdflinkmargin' is an experimental option for specifying
- a link margin, if the driver supports this. Default is 1 pt for
- supporting drivers.
-
-
-\begin{description}
-\item[pdfTeX]
-\begin{itemize}
- \item The link area also depends on the surrounding box.
- \item Settings have local effect.
- \item When a page is shipped out, pdfTeX uses the current setting
- of the link margin for all links on the page.
-\end{itemize}
-
-\item[pdfmark]
-\begin{itemize}
- \item Settings have global effect.
-\end{itemize}
-
-\item[xetex]
-\begin{itemize}
- \item Settings must be done in the preamble or the first page and then have global effect.
- The key inserts the new (x)dvipdfmx special \verb|\special{dvipdfmx:config g #1}| (with the unit removed).
-\end{itemize}
-
-\item[Other drivers]
- Unsupported.
-\end{description}
-
-
-\subsection{Field option `calculatesortkey'}
-
- Fields with calculated values are calculated in document order
- by default. If calculated field values depend on other calculated
- fields that appear later in the document, then the correct calculation
- order can be specified with option `calculatesortkey'. Its value is
- used as key to lexicographically sort the calculated fields.
- The sort key do not need to be unique. Fields that share the same
- key are sorted in document order.
-
-
-
- Currently the field option `calculatesortkey' is only supported by
- the driver for pdfTeX.
-
-\subsection{Option `next-anchor'}
-This option allows to overwrite the anchor name of the next anchor.
-This makes it possible to give for example the heading of the table of contents
-an anchor name which can be referenced with a bookmark command.
-
-\begin{verbatim}
-\hypersetup{next-anchor=toc}
-\tableofcontents
-\bookmark[dest=\HyperDestNameFilter{toc},level=section]{\contentsname}
-\end{verbatim}
-
-\subsection{Option `localanchorname'}
-
- When an anchor is set (e.g. via \verb|\refstepcounter|, then the
- anchor name is globally set to the current anchor name.
-
-
- For example:
-\begin{verbatim}
- \section{Foobar}
- \begin{equation}\end{equation}
- \label{sec:foobar}
-\end{verbatim}
- With the default global setting (localanchorname=false)
- a reference to `sec:foobar' jumps to the equation before.
- With option `localanchorname' the anchor of the equation
- is forgotten after the environment and the reference
- `sec:foobar' jumps to the section title.
-
-
- Option `localanchorname' is an experimental option, there
- might be situations, where the anchor name is not available
- as expected.
-
-
-\subsection{Option `customdriver'}
-
- The value of option `customdriver' is the name of an external
- driver file without extension `.def'. The file must have
- \verb|\ProvidesFile| with a version date and number that match the
- date and number of `hyperref', otherwise a warning is given.
-
- Because the interface, what needs to be defined in the driver,
- is not well defined and quite messy, the option is mainly intended
- to ease developing, testing, debugging the driver part.
-
-
-\subsection{Option `psdextra'}
-
- LaTeX's NFSS is used to assist the conversion of arbitrary
- TeX strings to PDF strings (bookmarks, PDF information entries).
- Many math command names (\verb|\geq|, \verb|\notin|, ...) are not in control
- of NFSS, therefore they are defined with prefix `text'
- (\verb|\textgeq|, \verb|\textnotin|, ...). They can be mapped to short names
- during the processing to PDF strings. The disadvantage is that
- they are many hundreds macros that need to be redefined for
- each PDF string conversion. Therefore this can be enabled or
- disabled as option `psdextra'. On default the option is turned
- off (set to `false'). Turning the option on means
- that the short names are available. Then \verb|\geq| can directly
- be used instead of \verb|\textgeq|.
-
-
-\subsection{\textbackslash XeTeXLinkBox}
-
- When XeTeX generates a link annotation, it does not look
- at the boxes (as the other drivers), but only at the character
- glyphs. If there are no glyphs (images, rules, ...), then
- it does not generate a link annotation. Macro \verb|\XeTeXLinkBox|
- puts its argument in a box and adds spaces at the lower left
- and upper right corners. An additional margin can be specified
- by setting it to the dimen register \verb|\XeTeXLinkMargin|. The default
- is 2pt.
-
- Example:
-
-
-\begin{verbatim}
- % xelatex
- \documentclass{article}
- \usepackage{hyperref}
- \setlength{\XeTeXLinkMargin}{1pt}
- \begin{document}
- \section{Hello World}
- \newpage
- \label{sec:hello}
- \hyperref[sec:hello]{%
- \XeTeXLinkBox{\rule{10mm}{10mm}}%
- }
- \end{document}
-\end{verbatim}
-
-\subsection{\textbackslash IfHyperBooleanExists and \textbackslash IfHyperBoolean}
-\begin{verbatim}
- \IfHyperBooleanExists{OPTION}{YES}{NO}
-\end{verbatim}
- If a hyperref OPTION is a boolean, that means it takes values
- `true' or `false', then \verb|\IfHyperBooleanExists| calls YES, otherwise NO.
-
-
-\begin{verbatim}
- \IfHyperBoolean{OPTION}{YES}{NO}
-\end{verbatim}
- Macro \verb|\IfHyperBoolean| calls YES, if OPTION exists as boolean and is
- enabled. Otherwise NO is executed.
-
-
-
- Both macros are expandable. Additionally option `stoppedearly' is
- available. It is enabled if \verb|\MaybeStopEarly| or \verb|\MaybeStopNow|
- end hyperref prematurely.
-
-
-\subsection{\textbackslash unichar}
-
- If a Unicode character is not supported by puenc.def, it can
- be given by using \verb|\unichar|. Its name and syntax is inherited
- from package `ucs'. However it is defined independently for
- use in hyperref's \verb|\pdfstringdef| (that converts arbitrary
- TeX code to PDF strings or tries to do this).
-
-
-
- Macro \verb|\unichar| takes a TeX number as argument,
- examples for U+263A (WHITE SMILING FACE):
-\begin{verbatim}
- \unichar{"263A}% hexadecimal notation
- \unichar{9786}% decimal notation
-\end{verbatim}
- `"' must not be a babel shorthand character or otherwise
- active. Otherwise prefix it with \verb|\string|:
-\begin{verbatim}
- \unichar{\string"263A}% converts `"' to `"' with catcode 12 (other)
-\end{verbatim}
- Users of (n)german packages or babel options may use \verb|\dq| instead:
-\begin{verbatim}
- \unichar{\dq 263A}% \dq is double quote with catcode 12 (other)
-\end{verbatim}
-
-
-\subsection{\textbackslash ifpdfstringunicode}
-
- Some features of the PDF specification needs PDF strings.
- Examples are bookmarks or the entries in the information dictionary.
- The PDF specification allows two encodings `PDFDocEncoding'
- (8-bit encoding) and `Unicode' (UTF-16). The user can help
- using \verb|\texorpdfstring| to replace complicate TeX constructs
- by a representation for the PDF string. However \verb|\texorpdfstring|
- does not distinguish the two encodings. This gap closes
- \verb|\ifpdfstringunicode|. It is only allowed in the second argument
- of \verb|\texorpdfstring| and takes two arguments, the first allows
- the full range of Unicode. The second is limited to the
- characters available in PDFDocEncoding.
-
-
-
- As example we take a macro definition for the Vietnamese
- name of \hologo{HanTheThanh}. Correctly written it needs some
- accented characters, one character even with a double accent.
- Class `tugboat.cls' defines a macro for the typesetted name:
-\begin{verbatim}
- \def\Thanh{%
- H\`an~%
- Th\^e\llap{\raise 0.5ex\hbox{\'{}}}%
- ~Th\`anh%
- }
-\end{verbatim}
- It's not entirely correct, the second accent over the `e' is not
- an acute, but a hook. However standard LaTeX does not provide
- such an accent.
-
- Now we can extend the definition to support hyperref.
- The first and the last word are already supported automatically.
- Characters with two or more accents are a difficult business in
- LaTeX, because the NFSS2 macros of the LaTeX kernel do not support
- more than one accent. Therefore also puenc.def misses support for
- them. But we can provide it using \verb|\unichar|. The character
- in question is:
-\begin{verbatim}
- % U+1EC3 LATIN SMALL LETTER E WITH CIRCUMFLEX AND HOOK ABOVE
-\end{verbatim}
- Thus we can put this together:
-\begin{verbatim}
- \def\Thanh{%
- H\`an~%
- \texorpdfstring{Th\^e\llap{\raise 0.5ex\hbox{\'{}}}}%
- {\ifpdfstringunicode{Th\unichar{"1EC3}}{Th\^e}}%
- ~Th\`anh%
- }
-\end{verbatim}
- For PDFDocEncoding (PD1) the variant above has dropped the
- second accent. Alternatively we could provide a representation
- without accents instead of wrong accents:
-\begin{verbatim}
- \def\Thanh{%
- \texorpdfstring{%
- H\`an~%
- Th\^e\llap{\raise 0.5ex\hbox{\'{}}}}%
- ~Th\`anh%
- }{%
- \ifpdfstringunicode{%
- H\`an Th\unichar{"1EC3} Th\`anh%
- }{%
- Han The Thanh%
- }%
- }%
- }
-\end{verbatim}
-
-\subsection{Customizing index style file with \textbackslash nohyperpage}
-
- Since version 2008/08/14~v6.78f.
-
-
-
- For hyperlink support in the index, hyperref inserts \verb|\hyperpage|
- into the index macros. After processing with Makeindex, \verb|\hyperpage|
- analyzes its argument to detect page ranges and page comma lists.
- However, only the standard settings are supported directly:
-\begin{verbatim}
- delim_r "--"
- delim_n ", "
-\end{verbatim}
- (See manual page/documentation of Makeindex that explains
- the keys that can be used in style files for Makeindex.)
- Customized versions of
- \verb|delim_r, delim_n, suffix_2p, suffix_3p, suffix_mp|
- needs markup that \verb|\hyperpage| can detect and knows that
- this stuff does not belong to a page number. Makro
- \verb|\nohyperpage| serves as this markup. Put the customized
- code for these keys inside \verb|\nohyperpage|, e.g.:
-\begin{verbatim}
- suffix_2p "\\nohyperpage{f.}"
- suffix_3p "\\nohyperpage{ff.}"
-\end{verbatim}
- (Depending on the typesetting tradition some space ``\verb|\\|,'' or ``\verb|~|''
- should be put before the first f inside \verb|\nohyperpage|.)
-
-
-\subsection{Experimental option `ocgcolorlinks'}
-
- The idea are colored links, when viewed, but printed without colors.
- This new experimental option `ocgcolorlinks' uses Optional Content
- Groups, a feature introduced in PDF 1.5.
-
- A better implementation which hasn't the disadvantage to prevent line breaks is
- in the ocgx2 package. Check its documentation for details how to use it.
-\begin{itemize}
- \item The option must be given for package loading:
- \verb|\usepackage[ocgcolorlinks]{hyperref}|
- \item Main disadvantage: Links cannot be broken across lines.
- PDF reference 1.7: 4.10.2 ``Making Graphical Content Optional'':
- Graphics state operations, such as setting the color, ...,
- are still applied.
- Therefore the link text is put in a box and set twice, with and
- without color.
- \item The feature can be switched of by \verb|\hypersetup{ocgcolorlinks=false}|
- inside the document.
- \item Supported drivers: pdftex, dvipdfm
- \item The PDF version should be at least 1.5. It is automatically
- set for pdfTeX, LuaTeX and dvipdfmx.
-\end{itemize}
-
-\subsection{Option `pdfa'}
-
- The new option `pdfa' tries to avoid violations of PDF/A in code
- generated by hyperref. However, the result is usually not in PDF/A,
- because many features aren't controlled by hyperref (XMP metadata,
- fonts, colors, driver dependend low level stuff, ...).
-
-
-
- Currently, option `pdfa' sets and disables the following items:
-\begin{itemize}
- \item Enabled annotation flags: Print, NoZoom, NoRotate [PDF/A 6.5.3].
- \item Disabled annotation flags: Hidden, Invisible, NoView [PDF/A 6.5.3].
- \item Disabled: Launch action (\href{run:...} [PDF/A 6.6.1].
- \item Restricted: Named actions (\Acrobatmenu: NextPage, PrevPage,
- FirstPage, LastPage) [PDF/A 6.6.1].
- \item Many things are disabled in PDF formulars:
- \begin{itemize}
- \item JavaScript actions [PDF/A 6.6.1]
- \item Trigger events (additional actions) [PDF/A 6.6.2]
- \item Push button (because of JavaScript)
- \item Interactive Forms: Flag NeedAppearances is the default `false'
- (Because of this, hyperref's implementation of Forms looks ugly).
- [PDF/A 6.9]
- \end{itemize}
-\end{itemize}
-
-
-
- The default value of the new option `pdfa' is `false'. It influences
- the loading of the package and cannot be changed after hyperref is
- loaded (\verb|\usepackage{hyperref}|).
-
-
-
-\subsection{Option `linktoc' added}
-
- The new option `linktoc' allows more control which part
- of an entry in the table of contents is made into a link:
-\begin{itemize}
- \item `linktoc=none' (no links)
- \item `linktoc=section' (default behaviour, same as `linktocpage=false')
- \item `linktoc=page' (same as `linktocpage=true')
- \item `linktoc=all' (both the section and page part are links)
-\end{itemize}
-
-\subsection{Option `pdfnewwindow' changed}
-
- Before 6.77b:
-\begin{itemize}
- \item pdfnewwindow=true $\rightarrow$ /NewWindow true
- \item pdfnewwindow=false $\rightarrow$ (absent)
- \item unused pdfnewwindow $\rightarrow$ (absent)
-\end{itemize}
- Since 6.77b:
-\begin{itemize}
- \item pdfnewwindow=true $\rightarrow$ /NewWindow true
- \item pdfnewwindow=false $\rightarrow$ /NewWindow false
- \item pdfnewwindow={} $\rightarrow$ (absent)
- \item unused pdfnewwindow $\rightarrow$ (absent)
-\end{itemize}
-
-
-
- Rationale: There is a difference between setting to `false'
- and an absent entry. In the former case the new document
- replaces the old one, in the latter case the PDF viewer
- application should respect the user preference.
-
-
-\subsection{Flag options for PDF forms}
-
- PDF form field macros (\verb|\TextField|, \verb|\CheckBox|, ...) support
- boolean flag options. The option name is the lowercase
- version of the names in the PDF specification (1.7):
-
- \url{http://www.adobe.com/devnet/pdf/pdf_reference.html}
-
- \url{http://www.adobe.com/devnet/acrobat/pdfs/pdf_reference.pdf}
-
- Options (convert to lowercase) except flags in square brackets:
-
-\begin{itemize}
- \item Table 8.16 Annotation flags (page 608):
-
-{\obeylines
- 1 Invisible
- 2 Hidden (PDF 1.2)
- 3 Print (PDF 1.2)
- 4 NoZoom (PDF 1.3)
- 5 NoRotate (PDF 1.3)
- 6 NoView (PDF 1.3)
- [7 ReadOnly (PDF 1.3)] ignored for widget annotations, see table 8.70
- 8 Locked (PDF 1.4)
- 9 ToggleNoView (PDF 1.5)
- 10 LockedContents (PDF 1.7)
-}
- \item Table 8.70 Field flags common to all field types (page 676):
-
-{\obeylines
- 1 ReadOnly
- 2 Required
- 3 NoExport
-}
- \item Table 8.75 Field flags specific to button fields (page 686):
-
-{\obeylines
- 15 NoToggleToOff (Radio buttons only)
- 16 Radio (set: radio buttons, clear: check box, pushbutton: clear)
- 17 Pushbutton
- 26 RadiosInUniso (PDF 1.5)
-}
- \item Table 8.77 Field flags specific to text fields (page 691):
-
-{\obeylines
- 13 Multiline
- 14 Password
- 21 FileSelect (PDF 1.4)
- 23 DoNotSpellCheck (PDF 1.4)
- 24 DoNotScroll (PDF 1.4)
- 25 Comb (PDF 1.5)
- 26 RichText (PDF 1.5)
-}
- \item Table 8.79 Field flags specific to choice fields (page 693):
-
-{\obeylines
- 18 Combo (set: combo box, clear: list box)
- 19 Edit (only useful if Combo is set)
- 20 (Sort) for authoring tools, not PDF viewers
- 22 MultiSelect (PDF 1.4)
- 23 DoNotSpellCheck (PDF 1.4) (only useful if Combo and Edit are set)
- 27 CommitOnSelChange (PDF 1.5)
-}
- \item Table 8.86 Flags for submit-form actions (page 704):
-
-{\obeylines
- [1 Include/Exclude] unsupported, use `noexport' (table 8.70) instead
- 2 IncludeNoValueFields
- [3 ExportFormat] handled by option `export'
- 4 GetMethod
- 5 SubmitCoordinates
- [6 XFDF (PDF 1.4)] handled by option `export'
- 7 IncludeAppendSaves (PDF 1.4)
- 8 IncludeAnnotations (PDF 1.4)
- [9 SubmitPDF (PDF 1.4)] handled by option `export'
- 10 CanonicalFormat (PDF 1.4)
- 11 ExclNonUserAnnots (PDF 1.4)
- 12 ExclFKey (PDF 1.4)
- 14 EmbedForm (PDF 1.5)
-}
-\end{itemize}
-
- New option `export' sets the export format of a submit action.
- Valid values are (upper- or lowercase):
-\begin{itemize}
- \item FDF
- \item HTML
- \item XFDF
- \item PDF (not supported by Acrobat Reader)
-\end{itemize}
-
-\subsection{Option `pdfversion'}
-
- This is an experimental option. It notifies `hyperref' about
- the intended PDF version. Currently this is used in code for
- PDF forms (implementation notes 116 and 122 of PDF spec 1.7).
-
-
-
- Values: 1.2, 1.3, 1.4, 1.5, 1.6, 1.7. Values below 1.2 are not
- supported, because most drivers expect higher PDF versions.
-
-
-
- The option must be used early, not after \verb|\usepackage{hyperref}|.
-
-
- In theory this option should also set the PDF version,
- but this is not generally supported.
-\begin{itemize}
- \item pdfTeX below 1.10a: unsupported.
- pdfTeX $\ge$ 1.10a and < 1.30: \verb|\pdfoptionpdfminorversion|
- pdfTeX $\ge$ 1.30: \verb|\pdfminorversion|
- \item dvipdfm: configuration file, example:
- TeX Live 2007, texmf/dvipdfm/config/config, entry `V 2'.
- \item dvipdfmx: configuration file, example:
- TeX Live 2007, texmf/dvipdfm/dvipdfmx.cfg, entry `V 4'.
- \item Ghostscript: option -dCompatibilityLevel (this is set in
- `ps2pdf12', `ps2pdf13', `ps2pdf14').
-\end{itemize}
-
-
- The current PDF version is used as default if this version
- can be detected (only pdfTeX $\ge$ 1.10a). Otherwise the lowest
- version 1.2 is assumed. Thus `hyperref' tries to avoid PDF code
- that breaks this version, but is free to use ignorable higher PDF
- features.
-
-
-\subsection{Field option `name'}
-
- Many form objects uses the label argument
- for several purposes:
-\begin{itemize}
- \item Layouted label.
- \item As name in HTML structures.
-\end{itemize}
- Code that is suitable for layouting with TeX can
- break in the structures of the output format.
- If option `name' is given, then its value is used
- as name in the different output structures. Thus
- the value should consist of letters only.
-
-
-\subsection{Option `pdfencoding'}
-
- The PDF format allows two encodings for bookmarks and entries
- in the information dictionary: PDFDocEncoding and Unicode
- as UTF-16BE. Option \xoption{pdfencoding} selects between these encodings:
-\begin{itemize}
- \item \xoption{pdfdoc} uses PDFDocEncoding. It uses just one byte per character,
- but the supported characters are limited (244 in PDF-1.7).
- \item \xoption{unicode} sets Unicode. It is encoded as UTF-16BE. Two bytes
- are used for most characters, surrogates need four bytes.
- \item \xoption{auto} PDFDocEncoding if the string does not contain characters
- outside the encoding (outside ascii if an unicode engine is used)
- and Unicode otherwise. This option is not intended for the unicode engines.
-\end{itemize}
-
- All drivers use \xoption{unicode} by default now. If another encoding should be forced,
- it should be done in \verb|hypersetup|.
-
-\subsection{Color options/package hycolor}
-
- See documentation of package `hycolor'.
-
-
-\subsection{Option pdfusetitle}
-
- If option pdfusetitle is set then hyperref tries to
- derive the values for pdftitle and pdfauthor from
- \verb|\title| and \verb|\author|. An optional argument for \verb|\title| and
- \verb|\author| is supported (class amsart).
-
-
-\subsection{Starred form of \textbackslash autoref}
-
- \verb|\autoref*| generates a reference without link as \verb|\ref*| or \verb|\pageref*|.
-
-
-\subsection{Link border style}
-
- Links can be underlined instead of the default rectangle or
- options \xoption{colorlinks}, \xoption{frenchlinks}. This is done by option
- \verb|pdfborderstyle={/S/U/W 1}|
-
- Some remarks:
-
-\begin{itemize}
- \item AR7/Linux seems to have a bug, that don't use the default
- value \verb"1" for the width, but zero, thus that the underline
- is not visible without \verb"/W 1". The same applies for
- dashed boxes, eg.:
- pdfborderstyle={/S/D/D[3 2]/W 1}
-
- \item The syntax is described in the PDF specification, look for
- ``border style'', eg.
- Table 8.13 ``Entries in a border style dictionary''
- (specification for version 1.6)
-
- \item The border style is removed by
- pdfborderstyle={}
- This is automatically done if option colorlinks is enabled.
-
- \item Be aware that not all PDF viewers support this feature, not
- even Acrobat Reader itself:
-
- Some support:
- \begin{itemize}
- \item AR7/Linux: \xoption{underline} and \xoption{dashed}, but the border width
- must be given.
- \item xpdf 3.00: \xoption{underline} and \xoption{dashed}
- \end{itemize}
-
- Unsupported:
- \begin{itemize}
- \item AR5/Linux
- \item ghostscript 8.50
- \end{itemize}
-\end{itemize}
-
-\subsection{Option \xoption{bookmarksdepth}}
-
- The depth of the bookmarks can be controlled by the new
- option \xoption{bookmarksdepth}. The option acts globally and
- distinguishes three cases:
-\begin{itemize}
- \item \xoption{bookmarksdepth} without value
- Then hyperref uses the current value of counter \xoption{tocdepth}.
- This is the compatible behaviour and the default.
- \item \verb"bookmarksdepth=<number>", the value is number (also negative):
- The depth for the bookmarks are set to this number.
- \item \verb"bookmarksdepth=<name>"
- The <name> is a document division name (part, chapter, ...).
- It must not start with a digit or minus to avoid mixing up
- with the number case. Internally hyperref uses the value
- of macro \verb|\toclevel@<name>|.
- Examples:
-\begin{verbatim}
- \hypersetup{bookmarksdepth=paragraph}
- \hypersetup{bookmarksdepth=4} % same as before
- \hypersetup{bookmarksdepth} % counter "tocdepth" is used
-\end{verbatim}
-\end{itemize}
-
-\subsection{Option \xoption{pdfescapeform}}
-
- There are many places where arbitrary strings end up as
- PS or PDF strings. The PS/PDF strings in parentheses form
- require the protection of some characters, e.g. unmatched
- left or right parentheses need escaping or the escape
- character itself (backslash).
- Since 2006/02/12~v6.75a the PS/PDF driver should do
- this automatically. However I assume a problem with
- compatibility, especially regarding the form part where
- larger amounts of JavaScript code can be present.
- It would be a pain to remove all the escaping, because
- an additional escaping layer can falsify the code.
-
- Therefore a new option pdfescapeform was introduced:
-\begin{itemize}
- \item pdfescapeform=false
- Escaping for the formulars are disabled, this is
- the compatibility behaviour, therefore this is the default.
- \item pdfescapeform=true
- Then the PS/PDF drivers do all the necessary escaping.
- This is the logical choice and the recommended setting.
- For example, the user writes JavaScript as JavaScript
- and do not care about escaping characters for PS/PDF
- output.
-\end{itemize}
-
-\subsection{Default driver setting}
-
- (hyperref $\ge$ 6.72s)
- If no driver is given, hyperref tries its best to guess the
- most suitable driver. Thus it loads \xoption{hpdftex}, if pdfTeX is
- detected running in PDF mode. Or it loads the corresponding
- VTeX driver for VTeX's working modes.
- Unhappily many driver programs run after the TeX compiler,
- so hyperref does not have a chance (dvips, dvipdfm, ...).
- In this case driver \xoption{hypertex} is loaded that supports the
- HyperTeX features that are recognized by xdvi for example.
- This behaviour, however, can easily be changed in the configuration
- file \verb"hyperref.cfg":
-\begin{verbatim}
- \providecommand*{\Hy at defaultdriver}{hdvips}
-\end{verbatim}
- for dvips, or
-\begin{verbatim}
- \providecommand*{\Hy at defaultdriver}{hypertex}
-\end{verbatim}
- for the default behaviour of hyperref.
-
- See also the new option `driverfallback'.
-
-\subsection{Backref entries}
-
- Alternative interface for formatting of backref entries, example:
-
-\begin{verbatim}
-\documentclass[12pt,UKenglish]{article}
-
-\usepackage{babel}
-\usepackage[pagebackref]{hyperref}
-
-% Some language options are detected by package backref.
-% This affects the following macros:
-% \backrefpagesname
-% \backrefsectionsname
-% \backrefsep
-% \backreftwosep
-% \backreflastsep
-
-\renewcommand*{\backref}[1]{
- % default interface
- % #1: backref list
- %
- % We want to use the alternative interface,
- % therefore the definition is empty here.
-}
-\renewcommand*{\backrefalt}[4]{%
- % alternative interface
- % #1: number of distinct back references
- % #2: backref list with distinct entries
- % #3: number of back references including duplicates
- % #4: backref list including duplicates
- \par
- #3 citation(s) on #1 page(s): #2,\par
- \ifnum#1=1 %
- \ifnum#3=1 %
- 1 citation on page %
- \else
- #3 citations on page %
- \fi
- \else
- #3 citations on #1 pages %
- \fi
- #2,\par
- \ifnum#3=1 %
- 1 citation located at page %
- \else
- #3 citations located at pages %
- \fi
- #4.\par
-}
-
-% The list of distinct entries can be further refined:
-\renewcommand*{\backrefentrycount}[2]{%
- % #1: the original backref entry
- % #2: the count of citations of this entry,
- % in case of duplicates greater than one
- #1%
- \ifnum#2>1 %
- ~(#2)%
- \fi
-}
-
-\begin{document}
-
- \section{Hello}
- \cite{ref1, ref2, ref3, ref4}
- \section{World}
- \cite{ref1, ref3}
- \newpage
-
- \section{Next section}
- \cite{ref1}
- \newpage
-
- \section{Last section}
- \cite{ref1, ref2}
- \newpage
-
- \pdfbookmark[1]{Bibliography}{bib}
- \begin{thebibliography}{99}
- \bibitem{ref1} Dummy entry one.
-
- \bibitem{ref2} Dummy entry two.
-
- \bibitem{ref3} Dummy entry three.
-
- \bibitem{ref4} Dummy entry four.
-
- \end{thebibliography}
-
-\end{document}
-\end{verbatim}
-
-\subsection{\textbackslash phantomsection}
-
-Set an anchor at this location. It is often used in conjunction
-with \verb|\addcontentsline| for sectionlike things (index, bibliography,
-preface). \verb|\addcontentsline| refers to the latest previous location
-where an anchor is set.
-
-\begin{verbatim}
- \cleardoublepage
- \phantomsection
- \addcontentsline{toc}{chapter}{\indexname}
- \printindex
-\end{verbatim}
-
-Now the entry in the table of contents (and bookmarks) for the
-index points to the start of the index page, not to a location
-before this page.
-
-\subsection{puenc encoding, puenc-greek.def and puenc-extra.def}
-
-The \texttt{unicode} option loads for the bookmarks \texttt{puenc.def} which contains
-quite a lot definitions of commands for the bookmarks.
-As \texttt{unicode} is now true for all engines, this file is now also loaded
-with pdflatex. Some of the definitions in \texttt{puenc.def} clash with other uses.
-To reduce the impact \xpackage{hyperref} uses two strategies.
-
-\begin{itemize}
-\item A number of command are only defined conditionally:
-The commands for the cyrillic block if \cs{CYRDZE} is defined,
-greek if \cs{textBeta} is defined, and hebrew if \cs{hebdalet} is defined.
-
-The greek block is in an extra file, \texttt{puenc-greek.def}, which can
-be loaded manually if needed.
-
-\item Other commands are moved to an extra file \texttt{puenc-extra.def}
-which is not loaded automatically, but can be loaded in the preamble if needed.
-Currently this file contains all definitions for the accent \cs{G}.
-\end{itemize}
-
-
-
-\section{Acrobat-specific behavior}
-If you want to access the menu options of Acrobat Reader or Exchange, the following
-macro is provided in the appropriate drivers:
-
-\begin{cmdsyntax}
-\ci{Acrobatmenu}\verb|{|\emph{menuoption}\verb|}{|\emph{text}\verb|}|
-\end{cmdsyntax}
-
-\noindent The \emph{text} is used to create a button which activates the appropriate \emph{menuoption}. The following table lists the option names you can use---comparison of this with the menus in Acrobat Reader or Exchange will show what they do. Obviously some are only appropriate to Exchange.
-
-\medskip
-\begin{longtable}{@{}l>{\raggedright\arraybackslash}p{9cm}@{}}
-File & Open, Close, Scan, Save, SaveAs, Optimizer:SaveAsOpt, Print, PageSetup, Quit \\
-File$\rightarrow$Import & ImportImage, ImportNotes, AcroForm:ImportFDF \\
-File$\rightarrow$Export & ExportNotes, AcroForm:ExportFDF \\
-File$\rightarrow$DocumentInfo & GeneralInfo, OpenInfo, FontsInfo, SecurityInfo, Weblink:Base, AutoIndex:DocInfo \\
-File$\rightarrow$Preferences & GeneralPrefs, NotePrefs, FullScreenPrefs, Weblink:Prefs, AcroSearch:Preferences(Windows)
- or, AcroSearch:Prefs(Mac), Cpt:Capture \\
-Edit & Undo, Cut, Copy, Paste, Clear, SelectAll, Ole:CopyFile, TouchUp:TextAttributes,
- TouchUp:FitTextToSelection, TouchUp:ShowLineMarkers, TouchUp:ShowCaptureSuspects,
- TouchUp:FindSuspect, \\
- & Properties \\
-Edit$\rightarrow$Fields & AcroForm:Duplicate, AcroForm:TabOrder \\
-Document & Cpt:CapturePages, AcroForm:Actions, CropPages, RotatePages, InsertPages, ExtractPages,
- ReplacePages, DeletePages, NewBookmark, SetBookmarkDest, CreateAllThumbs,
- DeleteAllThumbs \\
-View & ActualSize, FitVisible, FitWidth, FitPage, ZoomTo, FullScreen, FirstPage, PrevPage,
- NextPage, LastPage, GoToPage, GoBack, GoForward, SinglePage, OneColumn, TwoColumns,
- ArticleThreads, PageOnly, ShowBookmarks, ShowThumbs \\
-Tools & Hand, ZoomIn, ZoomOut, SelectText, SelectGraphics, Note, Link, Thread, AcroForm:Tool,
- Acro\_Movie:MoviePlayer, TouchUp:TextTool, Find, FindAgain, FindNextNote,
- CreateNotesFile \\
-Tools$\rightarrow$Search & AcroSrch:Query, AcroSrch:Indexes, AcroSrch:Results, AcroSrch:Assist, AcroSrch:PrevDoc,
- AcroSrch:PrevHit, AcroSrch:NextHit, AcroSrch:NextDoc \\
-Window & ShowHideToolBar, ShowHideMenuBar, ShowHideClipboard, Cascade, TileHorizontal,
- TileVertical, CloseAll \\
-Help & HelpUserGuide, HelpTutorial, HelpExchange, HelpScan, HelpCapture, HelpPDFWriter,
- HelpDistiller, HelpSearch, HelpCatalog, HelpReader, Weblink:Home \\
-Help(Windows) & About
-\end{longtable}
-
-\section{PDF and HTML forms}
-You must put your fields inside a \texttt{Form} environment.
-The environment does some general setups, so should be used only once in a document.
-Using simply \cs{Form} at the begin of the document is possible too.
-
-There are six macros to prepare fields:
-
-\begin{cmdsyntax}
-\ci{TextField}\verb|[|\emph{parameters}\verb|]{|\emph{label}\verb|}|
-\end{cmdsyntax}
-
-\begin{cmdsyntax}
-\ci{CheckBox}\verb|[|\emph{parameters}\verb|]{|\emph{label}\verb|}|
-\end{cmdsyntax}
-
-\begin{cmdsyntax}
-\ci{ChoiceMenu}\verb|[|\emph{parameters}\verb|]{|\emph{label}\verb|}{|\emph{choices}\verb|}|
-\end{cmdsyntax}
-
-\begin{cmdsyntax}
-\ci{PushButton}\verb|[|\emph{parameters}\verb|]{|\emph{label}\verb|}|
-\end{cmdsyntax}
-
-\begin{cmdsyntax}
-\ci{Submit}\verb|[|\emph{parameters}\verb|]{|\emph{label}\verb|}|
-\end{cmdsyntax}
-
-\begin{cmdsyntax}
-\ci{Reset}\verb|[|\emph{parameters}\verb|]{|\emph{label}\verb|}|
-\end{cmdsyntax}
-
-The way forms and their labels are laid out is determined by:
-\begin{cmdsyntax}
-\ci{LayoutTextField}\verb|{|\emph{label}\verb|}{|\emph{field}\verb|}|
-\end{cmdsyntax}
-
-\begin{cmdsyntax}
-\ci{LayoutChoiceField}\verb|{|\emph{label}\verb|}{|\emph{field}\verb|}|
-\end{cmdsyntax}
-
-\begin{cmdsyntax}
-\ci{LayoutCheckField}\verb|{|\emph{label}\verb|}{|\emph{field}\verb|}|
-\end{cmdsyntax}
-
-These macros default to \#1 \#2
-
-What is actually shown in the field is determined by:
-\begin{cmdsyntax}
-\ci{MakeRadioField}\verb|{|\emph{width}\verb|}{|\emph{height}\verb|}|
-\end{cmdsyntax}
-
-\begin{cmdsyntax}
-\ci{MakeCheckField}\verb|{|\emph{width}\verb|}{|\emph{height}\verb|}|
-\end{cmdsyntax}
-\begin{cmdsyntax}
-\ci{MakeTextField}\verb|{|\emph{width}\verb|}{|\emph{height}\verb|}|
-\end{cmdsyntax}
-\begin{cmdsyntax}
-\ci{MakeChoiceField}\verb|{|\emph{width}\verb|}{|\emph{height}\verb|}|
-\end{cmdsyntax}
-
-\begin{cmdsyntax}
-\ci{MakeButtonField}\verb|{|\emph{text}\verb|}|
-\end{cmdsyntax}
-
-These macros default to \verb|\vbox to #2{\hbox to #1{\hfill}\vfill}|, except the
-last, which defaults to \#1; it is used for buttons, and the special \ci{Submit} and \ci{Reset}
-macros.
-
-You may also want to redefine the following macros:
-\begin{verbatim}
-\def\DefaultHeightofSubmit{12pt}
-\def\DefaultWidthofSubmit{2cm}
-\def\DefaultHeightofReset{12pt}
-\def\DefaultWidthofReset{2cm}
-\def\DefaultHeightofCheckBox{0.8\baselineskip}
-\def\DefaultWidthofCheckBox{0.8\baselineskip}
-\def\DefaultHeightofChoiceMenu{0.8\baselineskip}
-\def\DefaultWidthofChoiceMenu{0.8\baselineskip}
-\def\DefaultHeightofText{\baselineskip}
-\def\DefaultHeightofTextMultiline{4\baselineskip}
-\def\DefaultWidthofText{3cm}
-\end{verbatim}
-
-\subsection{Forms environment parameters}
-
-\smallskip
-\begin{longtable}{@{}>{\ttfamily}l>{\itshape}lp{9cm}@{}}
-action & URL & The URL that will receive the form data if a \textsf{Submit} button is included in the form \\
-encoding & name & The encoding for the string set to the URL; FDF-encoding is usual, and \texttt{html} is the only
- valid value \\
-method & name & Used only when generating HTML; values can be \texttt{post} or \texttt{get} \\
-\end{longtable}
-
-\subsection{Forms optional parameters}
-Note that all colors must be expressed as RGB triples, in the range 0..1 (i.e.\ \texttt{color=0 0
-0.5})
-
-\smallskip
-\begin{longtable}{@{}>{\ttfamily}ll>{\itshape}ll@{}}
-accesskey & key & & (as per HTML) \\
-align & number & 0 & alignment within text field; 0 is left-aligned,\\*
- & & & 1 is centered, 2 is right-aligned. \\
-altname & name & & alternative name,\\*
- & & & the name shown in the user interface\\
-backgroundcolor & & & color of box \\
-bordercolor & & & color of border \\
-bordersep & & & box border gap \\
-borderstyle & char & S & box border style; S (Solid) is default, B is Beveled,\\
- & & & D is Dashed, I is Inset and U is Underline \\
-borderwidth & & 1 & width of box border, the value is a dimension\\
- & & & or a number with default unit bp\\
-calculate & & & JavaScript code to calculate the value of the field \\
-charsize & dimen & & font size of field text \\
-checkboxsymbol & char & 4 (\ding{\number`4}) & symbol used for check boxes (ZapfDingbats), \\
-&&& the value is a character or \cs{ding}\verb|{|\texttt{\itshape number}\verb|}|, \\
-&&& see package \xpackage{pifont} from bundle \xpackage{psnfss} \\
-checked & boolean & false & whether option selected by default \\
-color & & & color of text in box \\
-combo & boolean & false & choice list is `combo' style \\
-default & & & default value \\
-disabled & boolean & false & field disabled \\
-format & & & JavaScript code to format the field \\
-height & dimen & & height of field box \\
-hidden & boolean & false & field hidden \\
-keystroke & & & JavaScript code to control the keystrokes on entry \\
-mappingname & name & & the mapping name to be used when exporting\\*
- & & & the field data\\
-maxlen & number & 0 & number of characters allowed in text field \\
-menulength & number & 4 & number of elements shown in list \\
-multiline & boolean & false & whether text box is multiline \\
-name & name & & name of field (defaults to label) \\
-onblur & & & JavaScript code \\
-onchange & & & JavaScript code \\
-onclick & & & JavaScript code \\
-ondblclick & & & JavaScript code \\
-onfocus & & & JavaScript code \\
-onkeydown & & & JavaScript code \\
-onkeypress & & & JavaScript code \\
-onkeyup & & & JavaScript code \\
-onmousedown & & & JavaScript code \\
-onmousemove & & & JavaScript code \\
-onmouseout & & & JavaScript code \\
-onmouseover & & & JavaScript code \\
-onmouseup & & & JavaScript code \\
-onselect & & & JavaScript code \\
-password & boolean & false & text field is `password' style \\
-popdown & boolean & false & choice list is `popdown' style \\
-radio & boolean & false & choice list is `radio' style \\
-radiosymbol & char & H (\ding{\number`H}) & symbol used for radio fields (ZapfDingbats), \\
-&&& the value is a character or \cs{ding}\verb|{|\texttt{\itshape number}\verb|}|, \\
-&&& see package \xpackage{pifont} from bundle \xpackage{psnfss} \\
-readonly & boolean & false & field is readonly \\
-rotation & number & 0 & rotation of the widget annotation \\*
- & & & (degree, counterclockwise, multiple of 90)\\
-tabkey & & & (as per HTML) \\
-validate & & & JavaScript code to validate the entry \\
-value & & & initial value \\
-width & dimen & & width of field box
-\end{longtable}
-
-\section{Defining a new driver}
-A hyperref driver has to provide definitions for eight macros:
-
-\smallskip
-\noindent 1. \verb|\hyper at anchor|
-
-\noindent 2. \verb|\hyper at link|
-
-\noindent 3. \verb|\hyper at linkfile|
-
-\noindent 4. \verb|\hyper at linkurl|
-
-\noindent 5. \verb|\hyper at anchorstart|
-
-\noindent 6. \verb|\hyper at anchorend|
-
-\noindent 7. \verb|\hyper at linkstart|
-
-\noindent 8. \verb|\hyper at linkend|
-\smallskip
-
-The draft option defines the macros as follows
-\begin{verbatim}
-\let\hyper@@anchor\@gobble
-\gdef\hyper at link##1##2##3{##3}%
-\def\hyper at linkurl##1##2{##1}%
-\def\hyper at linkfile##1##2##3{##1}%
-\let\hyper at anchorstart\@gobble
-\let\hyper at anchorend\@empty
-\let\hyper at linkstart\@gobbletwo
-\let\hyper at linkend\@empty
-\end{verbatim}
-
-\section{Special support for other packages}
-
-Package \xpackage{hyperref} aims to cooperate with other packages, but there are
-several possible sources for conflict, such as
-
-\begin{itemize}
-
-\item Packages that manipulate the bibliographic mechanism. Peter
-William's \xpackage{harvard} package is supported. However, the
-recommended package is Patrick Daly's \xpackage{natbib} package that has
-specific \xpackage{hyperref} hooks to allow reliable interaction. This
-package covers a very wide variety of layouts and citation styles, all
-of which work with \xpackage{hyperref}.
-
-\item Packages that typeset the contents of the \ci{label} and \ci{ref}
-macros, such as \xpackage{showkeys}. Since the \xpackage{hyperref} package
-redefines these commands, you must set \texttt{implicit=false} for these
-packages to work.
-
-\item Packages that do anything serious with the index.
-\end{itemize}
-
-The \xpackage{hyperref} package is distributed with variants on two useful
-packages designed to work especially well with it. These are \xpackage{xr}
-and \xpackage{minitoc}, which support crossdocument links using \hologo{LaTeX}'s
-normal \cs{label}/\cs{ref} mechanisms and per-chapter tables of contents,
-respectively.
-
-
-\subsection{Package Compatibility}
-
-Currently only package loading orders are available:
-
-
-
-Note: hyperref loads package \xpackage{nameref} at \verb|\begin{document}|.
-Sometimes this is too late, thus this package must be loaded
-earlier.
-
-
-\subsubsection{algorithm}
-\begin{verbatim}
- \usepackage{float}
- \usepackage{hyperref}
- \usepackage[chapter]{algorithm}% eg.
-\end{verbatim}
-
-\subsubsection{amsmath}
-
- The environments equation and eqnarray are not supported too well.
- For example, there might be spacing problems (eqnarray isn't recommended
- anyway, see CTAN:info/l2tabu/, the situation for equation is unclear,
- because nobody is interested in investigating). Consider using the
- environments that package amsmath provide, e.g. gather for equation.
- The environment equation can even redefined to use gather:
-
-\begin{verbatim}
- \usepackage{amsmath}
- \let\equation\gather
- \let\endequation\endgather
-\end{verbatim}
-
-\subsubsection{amsrefs}
-
- Package loading order:
-
-\begin{verbatim}
- \usepackage{hyperref}
- \usepackage{amsrefs}
-\end{verbatim}
-
-\subsubsection{arydshln, longtable}
-
- Package longtable must be put before hyperref and arydshln,
- hyperref after arydshln generates an error, thus the
- resulting package order is then:
-
-\begin{verbatim}
- \usepackage{longtable}
- \usepackage{hyperref}
- \usepackage{arydshln}
-\end{verbatim}
-
-\subsubsection{babel/magyar.ldf}
-
- The old version 2005/03/30 v1.4j will not work.
- You need at least version 1.5, maintained by P\'eter Szab\'o,
- see CTAN:language/hungarian/babel/.
-
-
-\subsubsection{babel/spanish.ldf}
-
- Babel's spanish.ldf redefines `\verb|\.|' to support `\verb|\...|'.
- In bookmarks (\verb|\pdfstringdef|) only `\verb|\.|' is supported.
- If `\verb|\...|' is needed,
- \verb|\texorpdfstring{\...}{\dots}|
- can be used instead.
-
-
-\subsubsection{bibentry}
-
- Workaround:
-
-\begin{verbatim}
- \makeatletter
- \let\saved at bibitem\@bibitem
- \makeatother
-
- \usepackage{bibentry}
- \usepackage{hyperref}
-
- \begin{document}
-
- \begingroup
- \makeatletter
- \let\@bibitem\saved at bibitem
- \nobibliography{database}
- \endgroup
-\end{verbatim}
-
-\subsubsection{bigfoot}
-
- Hyperref does not support package `bigfoot'. And package
- `bigfoot' does not support hyperref's footnotes and disables
- them (hyperfootnotes=false).
-
-
-\subsubsection{chappg}
-
- Package `chappg' uses \verb|\@addtoreset| that is redefined by `hyperref'.
- The package order is therefore:
-
-\begin{verbatim}
- \usepackage{hyperref}
- \usepackage{chappg}
-\end{verbatim}
-
-\subsubsection{cite}
-
- This is from Mike Shell:
- cite.sty cannot currently be used with hyperref.
- However, I can do a workaround via:
-
-\begin{verbatim}
- \makeatletter
- \def\NAT at parse{\typeout{This is a fake Natbib command to fool Hyperref.}}
- \makeatother
-
- \usepackage[hypertex]{hyperref}
-\end{verbatim}
-
- so that hyperref will not redefine any of the biblabel stuff - so cite.sty
- will work as normal - although the citations will not be hyperlinked, of
- course (But this may not be an issue for many people).
-
-
-\subsubsection{count1to}
-
- Package `count1to' adds several \verb|\@addtoreset| commands that confuse
- `hyperref'. Therefore \verb|\theH<...>| has to be fixed:
-
-\begin{verbatim}
- \usepackage{count1to}
- \AtBeginDocument{% *after* \usepackage{count1to}
- \renewcommand*{\theHsection}{\theHchapter.\arabic{section}}%
- \renewcommand*{\theHsubsection}{\theHsection.\arabic{subsection}}%
- \renewcommand*{\theHsubsubsection}{\theHsubsection.\arabic{subsubsection}}%
- \renewcommand*{\theHparagraph}{\theHsubsubsection.\arabic{paragraph}}%
- \renewcommand*{\theHsubparagraph}{\theHparagraph.\arabic{subparagraph}}%
- }
-\end{verbatim}
-
-\subsubsection{dblaccnt}
-
- pd1enc.def or puenc.def should be loaded before:
-\begin{verbatim}
- \usepackage{hyperref}
- \usepackage{dblaccnt}
-\end{verbatim}
- or see entry for \xoption{vietnam}.
-
-
-\subsubsection{easyeqn}
- Not compatible, breaks.
-
-
-\subsubsection{ellipsis}
-
- This packages redefines \verb|\textellipsis|
- after package hyperref (pd1enc.def/puenc.def should be loaded before):
-\begin{verbatim}
- \usepackage{hyperref}
- \usepackage{ellipsis}
-\end{verbatim}
-
-\subsubsection{float}
-\begin{verbatim}
- \usepackage{float}
- \usepackage{hyperref}
-\end{verbatim}
-\begin{itemize}
- \item Several \verb|\caption| commands are not supported inside one float object.
- \item Anchor are set at top of the float object, if its style is controlled
- by float.sty.
-\end{itemize}
-
-\subsubsection{endnotes}
- Unsupported.
-
-\subsubsection{foiltex}
- Update to version 2008/01/28 v2.1.4b:
- Since version 6.77a hyperref does not hack into \verb|\@begindvi|,
- it uses package `atbegshi' instead, that hooks into \verb|\shipout|.
- Thus the patch of `foils.cls' regarding hyperref is now obsolete
- and causes an undefined error message about \verb|\@hyperfixhead|.
- This is fixed in FoilTeX 2.1.4b.
-
-
-\subsubsection{footnote}
-
- This package is not supported, you have to disable hyperref's footnote
- support by using option \verb"hyperfootnotes=false".
-
-
-\subsubsection{geometry}
-
- Driver `dvipdfm' and program `dvipdfm' might generate a warning:
- Sorry. Too late to change page size
- Then prefer the program `dvipdfmx' or use one of the following
- workarounds to move the \verb|\special| of geometry to an earlier
- location:
-
-\begin{verbatim}
- \documentclass[dvipdfm]{article}% or other classes
- \usepackage{atbegshi}
- \AtBeginDocument{%
- \let\OrgAtBeginDvi\AtBeginDvi
- \let\AtBeginDvi\AtBeginShipoutFirst
- }
- \usepackage[
- paperwidth=170mm,
- paperheight=240mm
- ]{geometry}
- \AtBeginDocument{%
- \let\AtBeginDvi\OrgAtBeginDvi
- }
- \usepackage{hyperref}
-
- or
-
- \documentclass[dvipdfm]{article}% or other classes
- \usepackage{atbegshi}
- \let\AtBeginDvi\AtBeginShipoutFirst
- \usepackage[
- paperwidth=170mm,
- paperheight=240mm
- ]{geometry}
- \usepackage{hyperref}
-\end{verbatim}
-
-\subsubsection{IEEEtran.cls}
-
- version $\ge$ V1.6b (because of \verb|\@makecaption|, see ChangeLog)
-
-
-\subsubsection{index}
-
- version $\ge$ 1995/09/28 v4.1 (because of \verb|\addcontentsline| redefinition)
-
-
-\subsubsection{lastpage}
-
- Compatible.
-
-
-\subsubsection{linguex}
-\begin{verbatim}
- \usepackage{hyperref}
- \usepackage{linguex}
-\end{verbatim}
-
-\subsubsection{ltabptch}
-\begin{verbatim}
- \usepackage{longtable}
- \usepackage{ltabptch}
- \usepackage{hyperref}
-\end{verbatim}
-
-\subsubsection{mathenv}
-
- Unsupported.
-
-
-
- Both `mathenv' and `hyperref' messes around with
- environment `eqnarray'. You can load `mathenv' after
- `hyperref' to avoid an error message. But \verb|\label|
- will not work inside environment `eqnarray' properly,
- for example.
-
-
-\subsubsection{minitoc-hyper}
-
- This package is obsolete, use the up-to-date original
- package minitoc instead.
-
-
-
-\subsubsection{multind}
-\begin{verbatim}
- \usepackage{multind}
- \usepackage{hyperref}
-\end{verbatim}
-
-\subsubsection{natbib}
-\begin{verbatim}
- \usepackage{natbib}
- \usepackage{hyperref}
-\end{verbatim}
-
-\subsubsection{nomencl}
-Example for introducing links for the page numbers:
-\begin{verbatim}
- \renewcommand*{\pagedeclaration}[1]{\unskip, \hyperpage{#1}}
-\end{verbatim}
-
-
-\subsubsection{ntheorem-hyper}
- This package is obsolete, use the up-to-date original
- package ntheorem instead.
-
-
-For equations the following might work:
-\begin{verbatim}
- \renewcommand*{\eqdeclaration}[1]{%
- \hyperlink{equation.#1}{(Equation~#1)}%
- }
- But the mapping from the equation number to the anchor name
- is not available in general.
-\end{verbatim}
-
-\subsubsection{parskip}
-\begin{verbatim}
- \usepackage{parskip}
- \usepackage{hyperref}[2012/08/20]
-\end{verbatim}
-
-
- Both packages want to redefine \verb|\@starttoc|.
-
-
-\subsubsection{prettyref}
-\begin{verbatim}
-%%% example for prettyref %%%
-\documentclass{article}
-\usepackage{prettyref}
-\usepackage[pdftex]{hyperref}
-
-%\newrefformat{FIG}{Figure~\ref{#1}}% without hyperref
-\newrefformat{FIG}{\hyperref[{#1}]{Figure~\ref*{#1}}}
-
-\begin{document}
- This is a reference to \prettyref{FIG:ONE}.
- \newpage
- \begin{figure}
- \caption{This is my figure}
- \label{FIG:ONE}
- \end{figure}
-\end{document}
-%%% example for prettyref %%%
- \end{verbatim}
-
-
-\subsubsection{setspace}
-\begin{verbatim}
- \usepackage{setspace}
- \usepackage{hyperref}
-\end{verbatim}
-
-\subsubsection{sidecap}
-\begin{verbatim}
- Before 2002/05/24 v1.5h:
- \usepackage{nameref}
- \usepackage{hyperref}
- \usepackage{sidecap}
-\end{verbatim}
-
-\subsubsection{subfigure}
-\begin{verbatim}
- 1995/03/06 v2.0:
- \usepackage{subfigure}
- \usepackage{hyperref}
- % hypertexnames is set to false.
- v2.1:
- \usepackage{nameref}
- \usepackage{subfigure}
- \usepackage{hyperref}
- or
- \usepackage{hyperref}
- \usepackage{subfigure}
- v2.1.2:
- please update
- v2.1.3:
- \usepackage{hyperref}
- \usepackage{subfigure}
- or vice versa?
-\end{verbatim}
-
-\subsubsection{titleref}
-\begin{verbatim}
- \usepackage{nameref}
- \usepackage{titleref}% without usetoc
- \usepackage{hyperref}
-\end{verbatim}
-
-\subsubsection{tabularx}
-
- Linked footnotes are not supported inside environment `tabularx',
- because they uses the optional argument of \verb|\footnotetext|, see
- section `Limitations'. Before version 2011/09/28 6.82i
- hyperref had disabled footnotes entirely by `hyperfootnotes=false'.
-
-
-\subsubsection{titlesec}
-
- \xpackage{nameref} supports titlesec, but hyperref does not
- (unsolved is the anchor setting, missing with unnumbered
- section, perhaps problems with page breaks with numbered ones).
-
-
-\subsubsection{ucs/utf8x.def}
-
- The first time a multibyte UTF8 sequence is called, it
- does some calculations and stores the result in a macro
- for speeding up the next calls of that UTF8 sequence.
- However this makes the first call non-expandable and
- will break if used in information entries or bookmarks.
- Package \xpackage{ucs} offers \verb|\PrerenderUnicode| or \verb|\PreloadUnicodePage|
- to solve this:
-\begin{verbatim}
- \usepackage{ucs}
- \usepackage[utf8x]{inputenc}
- \usepackage{hyperref}% or with option unicode
- \PrerenderUnicode{^^c3^^b6}% or \PrerenderUnicodePage{1}
- \hypersetup{pdftitle={Umlaut example: ^^c3^^b6}}
-\end{verbatim}
- The notation with two carets avoids trouble with 8-bit bytes
- for the README file, you can use the characters directly.
-
-
-\subsubsection{varioref}
- There are too many problems with varioref. Nobody has time to
- sort them out. Therefore this package is now unsupported.
-
-
- Perhaps you are lucky and some of the features of varioref works
- with the following loading order:
-\begin{verbatim}
- \usepackage{nameref}
- \usepackage{varioref}
- \usepackage{hyperref}
-\end{verbatim}
-
-
- Also some babel versions can be problematic. For example,
- 2005/05/21 v3.8g contains a patch for varioref that breaks
- the hyperref support for varioref.
-
-
-
- Also unsupported:
-\begin{itemize}
-\item \verb|\Ref|, \verb|\Vref| do not uppercase the first letter.
-\item \verb|\vpageref[]{...}|
- On the same page a previous space is not suppressed.
-\end{itemize}
-
-\subsubsection{verse}
-
- Version 2005/08/22 v2.22 contains support for hyperref.
-
- For older versions see example from
- de.comp.text.tex (2005/08/11, slightly modified):
-
-\begin{verbatim}
- \documentclass{article}
-
- % package order does not matter
- \usepackage{verse}
- \usepackage{hyperref}
-
- \makeatletter
- % make unique poemline anchors
- \newcounter{verse at env}
- \setcounter{verse at env}{0}
- \let\org at verse\verse
- \def\verse{%
- \stepcounter{verse at env}%
- \org at verse
- }
- \def\theHpoemline{\arabic{verse at env}.\thepoemline}
-
- % add anchor for before \addcontentsline in \@vsptitle
- \let\org at vsptitle\@vsptitle
- \def\@vsptitle{%
- \phantomsection
- \org at vsptitle
- }
- \makeatother
-
- \begin{document}
-
- \poemtitle{Poem 1}
- \begin{verse}
- An one-liner.
- \end{verse}
-
- \newpage
-
- \poemtitle{Poem 2}
- \begin{verse}
- Another one-liner.
- \end{verse}
-
- \end{document}
-\end{verbatim}
-
-\subsubsection{vietnam}
-\begin{verbatim}
- % pd1enc.def should be loaded before package dblaccnt:
- \usepackage[PD1,OT1]{fontenc}
- \usepackage{vietnam}
- \usepackage{hyperref}
-\end{verbatim}
-
-\subsubsection{XeTeX}
-
- Default for the encoding of bookmarks is \verb|pdfencoding=unicode|.
- That means the strings are always treated as unicode strings.
- If \verb|auto| or \verb|pdfdoc| is forced it applies only
- if the string restricts to the printable ASCII set,
- The reason is that the \verb|\special| does not support PDFDocEncoding.
-
- In older versions hyperref contained special conversion code from
- UTF-16BE back to UTF-8 in a number of places for
- xetex to avoid the xdvipdfmx warning
-
- \verb"Failed to convert input string to UTF16..."
-
- This is no longer needed with a current xdvipdfmx, so this code has
- been removed. \verb|\csname HyPsd at XeTeXBigCharstrue\endcsname| should no
- longer be used.
-
-
-\section[Limitations]{Limitations%
-\footnote{This section moved from the README file, needs more integration into the manual}}
-\subsection{Wrapped/broken link support}
-
- Only few drivers support automatically wrapped/broken links,
- e.g. pdftex, dvipdfm, hypertex. Other drivers lack this
- feature, e.g. dvips, dvipsone.
-
- Workarounds:
-\begin{itemize}
-\item For long section or caption titles in the table of contents
- or list of figures/tables option \xoption{linktocpage} can be used.
- Then the page number will be a link, and the overlong section
- title is not forced into an one line link with overfull \verb|\hbox|
- warning.
-\item ``\verb|\url|''s are caught by package \xpackage{breakurl}.
-\item The option \xoption{breaklinks} is intended for internal use. But it
- can be used to force link wrapping, e.g. when printing a
- document. However, when such a document is converted to PDF
- and viewed with a PDF viewer, the active link area will be
- misplaced.
-
- Another limitation: some penalties are ``optimized'' by TeX,
- thus there are missing break points, especially within
- \verb|\url|. (See thread ``hyperref.sty, breaklinks and url.sty 3.2''
- in comp.text.tex 2005-09).
-\end{itemize}
-
-\subsection{Links across pages}
-
- In general they have problems:
-\begin{itemize}
- \item Some driver doesn't support them at all (see above).
- \item The driver allows it, but the link result might include
- the footer and/or header, or an error message can
- occur sometimes.
-\end{itemize}
-
-\subsection{Footnotes}
-
- LaTeX allows the separation of the footnote mark and the
- footnote text (\verb|\footnotemark|, \verb|\footnotetext|). This interface
- might be enough for visual typesetting. But the relation between
- \verb|\footnotemark| to \verb|\footnotetext| is not as strong as \verb|\ref| to \verb|\label|.
- Therefore it is not clear in general which \verb|\footnotemark| references
- which \verb|\footnotetext|. But that is necessary to implement hyperlinking.
- Thus the implementation of hyperref does not support the optional
- argument of \verb|\footnotemark| and \verb|\footnotetext|.
-
-
-\section[Hints]{Hints%
-\footnote{This section moved from the README file, needs more integration into the manual}}
-
-\subsection{Spaces in option values}
-
- Unhappily LaTeX strips spaces from options if they are given
- in \verb|\documentclass| or \verb|\usepackage| (or \verb|\RequirePackage|), e.g.:
-\begin{verbatim}
- \usepackage[pdfborder=0 0 1]{hyperref}
-\end{verbatim}
- Package hyperref now gets
-\begin{verbatim}
- pdfborder=001
-\end{verbatim}
- and the result is an invalid PDF file.
- As workaround braces can be used:
-\begin{verbatim}
- \usepackage[pdfborder={0 0 1}]{hyperref}
-\end{verbatim}
- Some options can also be given in \verb|\hypersetup|
-\begin{verbatim}
- \hypersetup{pdfborder=0 0 1}
-\end{verbatim}
- In \verb|\hypersetup| the options are directly processed as key value
- options (see package keyval) without space stripping in the value part.
-
-
-
- Alternatively, LaTeX's option handling system can be adapted
- to key value options by one of the packages \xpackage{kvoptions-patch}
- (from project \xpackage{kvoptions}) or \xpackage{xkvltxp} (from project \xpackage{xsetkeys}).
-
-
-\subsection{Index with makeindex}
-\begin{itemize}
- \item Package hyperref adds \verb|\hyperpage| commands by the encap
- mechanism (see documentation of Makeindex),
- if option hyperindex is set (default).
- \verb|\hyperpage| uses the page anchors that are set by
- hyperref at each page (default). However in the
- default case page numbers are used in anchor names
- in arabic form. If the page numbers in other formats
- are used (book class with \verb|\frontmatter|, \verb|\romannumbering|, ...),
- then the page anchors are not unique. Therefore option
- \verb"plainpages=false" is recommended.
- \item The encap mechanism of Makeindex allows to use one command only
- (see documentation of Makeindex).
- If the user sets such a command, hyperref suppresses its
- \verb|\hyperpage| command. With logical markup this situation
- can easily be solved:
-\begin{verbatim}
- \usepackage{makeidx}
- \makeindex
- \usepackage[hyperindex]{hyperref}
- \newcommand*{\main}[1]{\textbf{\hyperpage{#1}}}
- ...
- \index{Some example|main}
-\end{verbatim}
- \item Scientic Word/Scientific WorkPlace users can use
- package robustindex with hyperindex=false.
- \item Other encap characters can be set by option \xoption{encap}.
- Example for use of ``?'':
-\begin{verbatim}
- \usepackage[encap=?]{hyperref}
-\end{verbatim}
- \item Another possibility is the insertion of \verb|\hyperpage| by
- a style file for makeindex. For this case, hyperref's
- insertion will be disabled by \verb"hyperindex=false".
- \verb|\hyperpage| will be defined regardless of setting of hyperindex.
-\begin{verbatim}
-%%% cut %%% hyperindex.ist %%% cut %%%
-delim_0 ", \\hyperpage{"
-delim_1 ", \\hyperpage{"
-delim_2 ", \\hyperpage{"
-delim_n "}, \\hyperpage{"
-delim_t "}"
-encap_prefix "}\\"
-encap_infix "{\\hyperpage{"
-encap_suffix "}"
-%%% cut %%% hyperindex.ist %%% cut %%%
-\end{verbatim}
-\end{itemize}
-
-\subsection{Warning \texttt{"bookmark level for unknown <foobar> defaults to 0"}}
-
- Getting rid of it:
-\begin{verbatim}
-\makeatletter
-\providecommand*{\toclevel@<foobar>}{0}
-\makeatother
-\end{verbatim}
-
-\subsection{Link anchors in figures}
-
- The caption command increments the counter and here is the
- place where hyperref set the corresponding anchor. Unhappily
- the caption is set below the figure, so the figure is not
- visible if a link jumps to a figure.
- In this case, try package \xpackage{hypcap} that implements
- a method to circumvent the problem.
-
-
-\subsection{Additional unicode characters in bookmarks and pdf information entries:}
-\begin{verbatim}
-\documentclass[pdftex]{article}
-\usepackage[unicode]{hyperref}
-\end{verbatim}
-
-Support for additional unicode characters:
-
- Example: \verb|\.{a}| and \verb|\d{a}|
-
- 1. Get a list with unicode data, eg:
-
- http://www.unicode.org/Public/UNIDATA/UnicodeData.txt
-
- 2. Identify the characters (\verb|\.{a}|, \verb|\d{a}|):
-\begin{verbatim}
- 0227;LATIN SMALL LETTER A WITH DOT ABOVE;...
- 1EA1;LATIN SMALL LETTER A WITH DOT BELOW;...
-\end{verbatim}
-
- 3. Calculate the octal code:
-
- The first characters of the line in the file are
- hex values, convert each byte and prepend them
- with a backslash. (This will go into the PDF file.)
-
-\begin{verbatim}
- 0227 -> \002\047
- 1EA1 -> \036\241
-\end{verbatim}
-
- 4. Transform into a form understood by hyperref:
-
- Hyperref must know where the first byte starts,
- this is marked by \verb"9" (8 and 9 cannot occur in
- octal numbers):
-
-\begin{verbatim}
- \002\047 -> \9002\047
- \036\241 -> \9036\241
-\end{verbatim}
-
- Optional: \verb"8" is used for abbreviations:
-
-\begin{verbatim}
- \900 = \80, \901 = \81, \902 = \82, ...
-
- \9002\047 -> \82\047
-\end{verbatim}
-
- 5. Declare the character with LaTeX:
-
-\begin{verbatim}
-\DeclareTextCompositeCommand{\.}{PU}{a}{\82\047}
-\DeclareTextCompositeCommand{\d}{PU}{a}{\9036\241}
-
-\begin{document}
-\section{\={a}, \d{a}, \'{a}, \.{a}}
-\end{document}
- \end{verbatim}
-
-\subsection{Footnotes}
-
- The footnote support is rather limited. It is beyond the scope
- to use \verb|\footnotemark| and \verb|\footnotetext| out of order or reusing
- \verb|\footnotemark|. Here you can either disable hyperref's footnote
- support by \verb"hyperfootnotes=false" or fiddle with internal macros,
- nasty examples:
-
-\begin{verbatim}
-\documentclass{article}
-\usepackage{hyperref}
-\begin{document}
-Hello%
-\footnote{The first footnote}
-World%
-\addtocounter{footnote}{-1}%
-\addtocounter{Hfootnote}{-1}%
-\footnotemark.
-\end{document}
-
- or
-
-\documentclass{article}
-
-\usepackage{hyperref}
-
-\begin{document}
-
-\makeatletter
-
-A%
- \footnotemark
- \let\saved at Href@A\Hy at footnote@currentHref
- % remember link name
-B%
- \footnotemark
- \let\saved at Href@B\Hy at footnote@currentHref
-b%
- \addtocounter{footnote}{-1}%
- \addtocounter{Hfootnote}{-1}% generate the same anchor
- \footnotemark
-C%
- \footnotemark
- \let\saved at Href@C\Hy at footnote@currentHref
-
- \addtocounter{footnote}{-2}%
- \let\Hy at footnote@currentHref\saved at Href@A
-\footnotetext{AAAA}%
- \addtocounter{footnote}{1}%
- \let\Hy at footnote@currentHref\saved at Href@B
-\footnotetext{BBBBB}%
- \addtocounter{footnote}{1}%
- \let\Hy at footnote@currentHref\saved at Href@C
-\footnotetext{CCCC}%
-
-\end{document}
-\end{verbatim}
-
-\subsection{Subordinate counters}
-
- Some counters do not have unique values and require the value
- of other counters to be unique. For example, sections or figures
- might be numbered within chapters or \verb|\newtheorem| is used with
- an optional counter argument. Internally LaTeX uses \verb|\@addtoreset|
- to reset a counter in dependency to another counter. Package
- hyperref hooks into \verb|\@addtoreset| to catch this situation.
- Also \verb|\numberwithin| of package amsmath is caught by hyperref.
-
-
-
- However, if the definition of subordinate counters take place
- before hyperref is loaded, the old meaning of \verb|\@addtoreset| is
- called without hyperref's additions. Then the companion counter
- macro \verb|\theH<counter>| can be redefined accordingly. Or move the
- definition of subordinate counters after hyperref is loaded.
-
- Example for \verb|\newtheorem|, problematic case:
-\begin{verbatim}
- \newtheorem{corA}{CorollaryA}[section]
- \usepackage{hyperref}
-\end{verbatim}
- Solution a)
-\begin{verbatim}
- \usepackage{hyperref}
- \newtheorem{corA}{CorollaryA}[section}
-\end{verbatim}
- Solution b)
-\begin{verbatim}
- \newtheorem{corA}{CorollaryA}[section]
- \usepackage{hyperref}
- \newcommand*{\theHcorA}{\theHsection.\number\value{corA}}
-\end{verbatim}
-
-\section{History and acknowledgments}
-
-The original authors of \textsf{hyperbasics.tex} and
-\textsf{hypertex.sty}, from which this package descends, are Tanmoy
-Bhattacharya and Thorsten Ohl. Package \xpackage{hyperref}
-started as a simple port of their work to \hologo{LaTeXe} standards, but
-eventually I rewrote nearly everything, because I didn't understand a
-lot of the original, and was only interested in getting it to work with
-\hologo{LaTeX}. I would like to thank Arthur Smith, Tanmoy Bhattacharya, Mark
-Doyle, Paul Ginsparg, David Carlisle, T.\ V.\ Raman and Leslie Lamport
-for comments, requests, thoughts and code to get the package into its
-first useable state. Various other people are mentioned at the point in
-the source where I had to change the code in later versions because of
-problems they found.
-
-Tanmoy found a great many of the bugs, and (even better) often provided
-fixes, which has made the package more robust. The days spent on
-Rev\TeX\ are entirely due to him! The investigations of Bill Moss
-into the later versions including
-native PDF support uncovered a good many bugs, and his testing is
-appreciated. Hans Hagen provided a lot of
-insight into PDF.
-
-Berthold Horn provided help, encouragement and sponsorship for the
-\textsf{dvipsone} and \textsf{dviwindo} drivers. Sergey Lesenko provided
-the changes needed for \textsf{dvipdf}, and \Hologo{HanTheThanh} supplied all the
-information needed for \textsf{pdftex}. Patrick Daly kindly updated his
-\xpackage{natbib} package to allow easy integration with
-\xpackage{hyperref}. Michael Mehlich's \xpackage{hyper} package (developed
-in parallel with \textsf{hyperref}) showed me solutions for some
-problems. Hopefully the two packages will combine one day.
-
-The forms creation section owes a great deal to: T.\ V.\ Raman, for
-encouragement, support and ideas; Thomas Merz, whose book \emph{Web
-Publishing with Acrobat/PDF} provided crucial insights; D.\ P.\ Story,
-whose detailed article about pdfmarks and forms solved many practical
-problems; and Hans Hagen, who explained how to do it in \textsf{pdftex}.
-
-Steve Peter recreated the manual source in July 2003 after it had been
-lost.
-
-Especial extra thanks to David Carlisle for the \xpackage{backref} module,
-the ps2pdf and dviwindo support, frequent general rewrites of my bad
-code, and for working on changes to the \xpackage{xr} package to suit
-\xpackage{hyperref}.
-
-\begingroup
- \makeatletter
- \let\chapter=\section
- % subsections goes into bookmarks but not toc
- \hypersetup{bookmarksopenlevel=1}
- \addtocontents{toc}{\protect\setcounter{tocdepth}{1}}
- % The \section command acts as \subsection.
- % Additionally the title is converted to lowercase except
- % for the first letter.
- \def\section{%
- \let\section\lc at subsection
- \lc at subsection
- }
- \def\lc at subsection{%
- \@ifstar{\def\mystar{*}\lc at sec}%
- {\let\mystar\@empty\lc at sec}%
- }
- \def\lc at sec#1{%
- \lc@@sec#1\@nil
- }
- \def\lc@@sec#1#2\@nil{%
- \begingroup
- \def\a{#1}%
- \lowercase{%
- \edef\x{\endgroup
- \noexpand\subsection\mystar{\a#2}%
- }%
- }%
- \x
- }
-\clearpage
-
-
-\chapter{GNU Free Documentation License}
-
-Version 1.2, November 2002
-
-
- Copyright \copyright\ 2000,2001,2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.\\
- 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA\\
- Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim copies
- of this license document, but changing it is not allowed.
-
-
-\section*{PREAMBLE}
-
-The purpose of this License is to make a manual, textbook, or other
-functional and useful document ``free'' in the sense of freedom: to
-assure everyone the effective freedom to copy and redistribute it,
-with or without modifying it, either commercially or noncommercially.
-Secondarily, this License preserves for the author and publisher a way
-to get credit for their work, while not being considered responsible
-for modifications made by others.
-
-This License is a kind of ``copyleft'', which means that derivative
-works of the document must themselves be free in the same sense. It
-complements the GNU General Public License, which is a copyleft
-license designed for free software.
-
-We have designed this License in order to use it for manuals for free
-software, because free software needs free documentation: a free
-program should come with manuals providing the same freedoms that the
-software does. But this License is not limited to software manuals;
-it can be used for any textual work, regardless of subject matter or
-whether it is published as a printed book. We recommend this License
-principally for works whose purpose is instruction or reference.
-
-
-\section{APPLICABILITY AND DEFINITIONS}
-\label{applicability}
-
-This License applies to any manual or other work, in any medium, that
-contains a notice placed by the copyright holder saying it can be
-distributed under the terms of this License. Such a notice grants a
-world-wide, royalty-free license, unlimited in duration, to use that
-work under the conditions stated herein. The ``Document'', below,
-refers to any such manual or work. Any member of the public is a
-licensee, and is addressed as ``you''. You accept the license if you
-copy, modify or distribute the work in a way requiring permission
-under copyright law.
-
-A ``Modified Version'' of the Document means any work containing the
-Document or a portion of it, either copied verbatim, or with
-modifications and/or translated into another language.
-
-A ``Secondary Section'' is a named appendix or a front-matter section of
-the Document that deals exclusively with the relationship of the
-publishers or authors of the Document to the Document's overall subject
-(or to related matters) and contains nothing that could fall directly
-within that overall subject. (Thus, if the Document is in part a
-textbook of mathematics, a Secondary Section may not explain any
-mathematics.) The relationship could be a matter of historical
-connection with the subject or with related matters, or of legal,
-commercial, philosophical, ethical or political position regarding
-them.
-
-The ``Invariant Sections'' are certain Secondary Sections whose titles
-are designated, as being those of Invariant Sections, in the notice
-that says that the Document is released under this License. If a
-section does not fit the above definition of Secondary then it is not
-allowed to be designated as Invariant. The Document may contain zero
-Invariant Sections. If the Document does not identify any Invariant
-Sections then there are none.
-
-The ``Cover Texts'' are certain short passages of text that are listed,
-as Front-Cover Texts or Back-Cover Texts, in the notice that says that
-the Document is released under this License. A Front-Cover Text may
-be at most 5 words, and a Back-Cover Text may be at most 25 words.
-
-A ``Transparent'' copy of the Document means a machine-readable copy,
-represented in a format whose specification is available to the
-general public, that is suitable for revising the document
-straightforwardly with generic text editors or (for images composed of
-pixels) generic paint programs or (for drawings) some widely available
-drawing editor, and that is suitable for input to text formatters or
-for automatic translation to a variety of formats suitable for input
-to text formatters. A copy made in an otherwise Transparent file
-format whose markup, or absence of markup, has been arranged to thwart
-or discourage subsequent modification by readers is not Transparent.
-An image format is not Transparent if used for any substantial amount
-of text. A copy that is not ``Transparent'' is called ``Opaque''.
-
-Examples of suitable formats for Transparent copies include plain
-ASCII without markup, Texinfo input format, \LaTeX\ input format, SGML
-or XML using a publicly available DTD, and standard-conforming simple
-HTML, PostScript or PDF designed for human modification. Examples of
-transparent image formats include PNG, XCF and JPG. Opaque formats
-include proprietary formats that can be read and edited only by
-proprietary word processors, SGML or XML for which the DTD and/or
-processing tools are not generally available, and the
-machine-generated HTML, PostScript or PDF produced by some word
-processors for output purposes only.
-
-The ``Title Page'' means, for a printed book, the title page itself,
-plus such following pages as are needed to hold, legibly, the material
-this License requires to appear in the title page. For works in
-formats which do not have any title page as such, ``Title Page'' means
-the text near the most prominent appearance of the work's title,
-preceding the beginning of the body of the text.
-
-A section ``Entitled XYZ'' means a named subunit of the Document whose
-title either is precisely XYZ or contains XYZ in parentheses following
-text that translates XYZ in another language. (Here XYZ stands for a
-specific section name mentioned below, such as ``Acknowledgements'',
-``Dedications'', ``Endorsements'', or ``History''.) To ``Preserve the Title''
-of such a section when you modify the Document means that it remains a
-section ``Entitled XYZ'' according to this definition.
-
-The Document may include Warranty Disclaimers next to the notice which
-states that this License applies to the Document. These Warranty
-Disclaimers are considered to be included by reference in this
-License, but only as regards disclaiming warranties: any other
-implication that these Warranty Disclaimers may have is void and has
-no effect on the meaning of this License.
-
-
-\section{VERBATIM COPYING}
-\label{verbatim}
-
-You may copy and distribute the Document in any medium, either
-commercially or noncommercially, provided that this License, the
-copyright notices, and the license notice saying this License applies
-to the Document are reproduced in all copies, and that you add no other
-conditions whatsoever to those of this License. You may not use
-technical measures to obstruct or control the reading or further
-copying of the copies you make or distribute. However, you may accept
-compensation in exchange for copies. If you distribute a large enough
-number of copies you must also follow the conditions in
-section~\ref{copying}.
-
-You may also lend copies, under the same conditions stated above, and
-you may publicly display copies.
-
-
-\section{COPYING IN QUANTITY}
-\label{copying}
-
-If you publish printed copies (or copies in media that commonly have
-printed covers) of the Document, numbering more than 100, and the
-Document's license notice requires Cover Texts, you must enclose the
-copies in covers that carry, clearly and legibly, all these Cover
-Texts: Front-Cover Texts on the front cover, and Back-Cover Texts on
-the back cover. Both covers must also clearly and legibly identify
-you as the publisher of these copies. The front cover must present
-the full title with all words of the title equally prominent and
-visible. You may add other material on the covers in addition.
-Copying with changes limited to the covers, as long as they preserve
-the title of the Document and satisfy these conditions, can be treated
-as verbatim copying in other respects.
-
-If the required texts for either cover are too voluminous to fit
-legibly, you should put the first ones listed (as many as fit
-reasonably) on the actual cover, and continue the rest onto adjacent
-pages.
-
-If you publish or distribute Opaque copies of the Document numbering
-more than 100, you must either include a machine-readable Transparent
-copy along with each Opaque copy, or state in or with each Opaque copy
-a computer-network location from which the general network-using
-public has access to download using public-standard network protocols
-a complete Transparent copy of the Document, free of added material.
-If you use the latter option, you must take reasonably prudent steps,
-when you begin distribution of Opaque copies in quantity, to ensure
-that this Transparent copy will remain thus accessible at the stated
-location until at least one year after the last time you distribute an
-Opaque copy (directly or through your agents or retailers) of that
-edition to the public.
-
-It is requested, but not required, that you contact the authors of the
-Document well before redistributing any large number of copies, to give
-them a chance to provide you with an updated version of the Document.
-
-
-\section{MODIFICATIONS}
-\label{modifications}
-
-You may copy and distribute a Modified Version of the Document under
-the conditions of sections~\ref{verbatim} and \ref{copying} above,
-provided that you release
-the Modified Version under precisely this License, with the Modified
-Version filling the role of the Document, thus licensing distribution
-and modification of the Modified Version to whoever possesses a copy
-of it. In addition, you must do these things in the Modified Version:
-
-\renewcommand{\labelenumi}{\Alph{enumi}.}
-\begin{enumerate}
-\item Use in the Title Page (and on the covers, if any) a title distinct
- from that of the Document, and from those of previous versions
- (which should, if there were any, be listed in the History section
- of the Document). You may use the same title as a previous version
- if the original publisher of that version gives permission.
-\item List on the Title Page, as authors, one or more persons or entities
- responsible for authorship of the modifications in the Modified
- Version, together with at least five of the principal authors of the
- Document (all of its principal authors, if it has fewer than five),
- unless they release you from this requirement.
-\item State on the Title page the name of the publisher of the
- Modified Version, as the publisher.
-\item Preserve all the copyright notices of the Document.
-\item Add an appropriate copyright notice for your modifications
- adjacent to the other copyright notices.
-\item Include, immediately after the copyright notices, a license notice
- giving the public permission to use the Modified Version under the
- terms of this License, in the form shown in the Addendum below.
-\item Preserve in that license notice the full lists of Invariant Sections
- and required Cover Texts given in the Document's license notice.
-\item Include an unaltered copy of this License.
-\item Preserve the section Entitled ``History'', Preserve its Title, and add
- to it an item stating at least the title, year, new authors, and
- publisher of the Modified Version as given on the Title Page. If
- there is no section Entitled ``History'' in the Document, create one
- stating the title, year, authors, and publisher of the Document as
- given on its Title Page, then add an item describing the Modified
- Version as stated in the previous sentence.
-\item Preserve the network location, if any, given in the Document for
- public access to a Transparent copy of the Document, and likewise
- the network locations given in the Document for previous versions
- it was based on. These may be placed in the ``History'' section.
- You may omit a network location for a work that was published at
- least four years before the Document itself, or if the original
- publisher of the version it refers to gives permission.
-\item For any section Entitled ``Acknowledgements'' or ``Dedications'',
- Preserve the Title of the section, and preserve in the section all
- the substance and tone of each of the contributor acknowledgements
- and/or dedications given therein.
-\item Preserve all the Invariant Sections of the Document,
- unaltered in their text and in their titles. Section numbers
- or the equivalent are not considered part of the section titles.
-\item Delete any section Entitled ``Endorsements''. Such a section
- may not be included in the Modified Version.
-\item Do not retitle any existing section to be Entitled ``Endorsements''
- or to conflict in title with any Invariant Section.
-\item Preserve any Warranty Disclaimers.
-
-\end{enumerate}
-
-If the Modified Version includes new front-matter sections or
-appendices that qualify as Secondary Sections and contain no material
-copied from the Document, you may at your option designate some or all
-of these sections as invariant. To do this, add their titles to the
-list of Invariant Sections in the Modified Version's license notice.
-These titles must be distinct from any other section titles.
-
-You may add a section Entitled ``Endorsements'', provided it contains
-nothing but endorsements of your Modified Version by various
-parties--for example, statements of peer review or that the text has
-been approved by an organization as the authoritative definition of a
-standard.
-
-You may add a passage of up to five words as a Front-Cover Text, and a
-passage of up to 25 words as a Back-Cover Text, to the end of the list
-of Cover Texts in the Modified Version. Only one passage of
-Front-Cover Text and one of Back-Cover Text may be added by (or
-through arrangements made by) any one entity. If the Document already
-includes a cover text for the same cover, previously added by you or
-by arrangement made by the same entity you are acting on behalf of,
-you may not add another; but you may replace the old one, on explicit
-permission from the previous publisher that added the old one.
-
-The author(s) and publisher(s) of the Document do not by this License
-give permission to use their names for publicity for or to assert or
-imply endorsement of any Modified Version.
-
-
-\section{COMBINING DOCUMENTS}
-\label{combining}
-
-You may combine the Document with other documents released under this
-License, under the terms defined in section~\ref{modifications}
-above for modified
-versions, provided that you include in the combination all of the
-Invariant Sections of all of the original documents, unmodified, and
-list them all as Invariant Sections of your combined work in its
-license notice, and that you preserve all their Warranty Disclaimers.
-
-The combined work need only contain one copy of this License, and
-multiple identical Invariant Sections may be replaced with a single
-copy. If there are multiple Invariant Sections with the same name but
-different contents, make the title of each such section unique by
-adding at the end of it, in parentheses, the name of the original
-author or publisher of that section if known, or else a unique number.
-Make the same adjustment to the section titles in the list of
-Invariant Sections in the license notice of the combined work.
-
-In the combination, you must combine any sections Entitled ``History''
-in the various original documents, forming one section Entitled
-``History''; likewise combine any sections Entitled ``Acknowledgements'',
-and any sections Entitled ``Dedications''. You must delete all sections
-Entitled ``Endorsements''.
-
-
-\section{COLLECTIONS OF DOCUMENTS}
-\label{collections}
-
-You may make a collection consisting of the Document and other documents
-released under this License, and replace the individual copies of this
-License in the various documents with a single copy that is included in
-the collection, provided that you follow the rules of this License for
-verbatim copying of each of the documents in all other respects.
-
-You may extract a single document from such a collection, and distribute
-it individually under this License, provided you insert a copy of this
-License into the extracted document, and follow this License in all
-other respects regarding verbatim copying of that document.
-
-
-\section{AGGREGATION WITH INDEPENDENT WORKS}
-\label{aggregation}
-
-A compilation of the Document or its derivatives with other separate
-and independent documents or works, in or on a volume of a storage or
-distribution medium, is called an ``aggregate'' if the copyright
-resulting from the compilation is not used to limit the legal rights
-of the compilation's users beyond what the individual works permit.
-When the Document is included in an aggregate, this License does not
-apply to the other works in the aggregate which are not themselves
-derivative works of the Document.
-
-If the Cover Text requirement of section~\ref{copying} is applicable to
-these copies of the Document, then if the Document is less than one half
-of the entire aggregate, the Document's Cover Texts may be placed on
-covers that bracket the Document within the aggregate, or the
-electronic equivalent of covers if the Document is in electronic form.
-Otherwise they must appear on printed covers that bracket the whole
-aggregate.
-
-
-\section{TRANSLATION}
-\label{translation}
-
-Translation is considered a kind of modification, so you may
-distribute translations of the Document under the terms of
-section~\ref{modifications}.
-Replacing Invariant Sections with translations requires special
-permission from their copyright holders, but you may include
-translations of some or all Invariant Sections in addition to the
-original versions of these Invariant Sections. You may include a
-translation of this License, and all the license notices in the
-Document, and any Warranty Disclaimers, provided that you also include
-the original English version of this License and the original versions
-of those notices and disclaimers. In case of a disagreement between
-the translation and the original version of this License or a notice
-or disclaimer, the original version will prevail.
-
-If a section in the Document is Entitled ``Acknowledgements'',
-``Dedications'', or ``History'', the requirement
-(section~\ref{modifications}) to Preserve
-its Title (section~\ref{applicability}) will typically require
-changing the actual title.
-
-
-\section{TERMINATION}
-\label{termination}
-
-You may not copy, modify, sublicense, or distribute the Document except
-as expressly provided for under this License. Any other attempt to
-copy, modify, sublicense or distribute the Document is void, and will
-automatically terminate your rights under this License. However,
-parties who have received copies, or rights, from you under this
-License will not have their licenses terminated so long as such
-parties remain in full compliance.
-
-
-\section{FUTURE REVISIONS OF THIS LICENSE}
-\label{future}
-
-The Free Software Foundation may publish new, revised versions
-of the GNU Free Documentation License from time to time. Such new
-versions will be similar in spirit to the present version, but may
-differ in detail to address new problems or concerns. See
-http://www.gnu.org/copyleft/.
-
-Each version of the License is given a distinguishing version number.
-If the Document specifies that a particular numbered version of this
-License ``or any later version'' applies to it, you have the option of
-following the terms and conditions either of that specified version or
-of any later version that has been published (not as a draft) by the
-Free Software Foundation. If the Document does not specify a version
-number of this License, you may choose any version ever published (not
-as a draft) by the Free Software Foundation.
-
-
-\section*{ADDENDUM: How to use this License for your documents}
-
-To use this License in a document you have written, include a copy of
-the License in the document and put the following copyright and
-license notices just after the title page:
-
-\begin{quote}
- Copyright \copyright\ YEAR YOUR NAME.
- Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
- under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2
- or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
- with no Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover Texts.
- A copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU
- Free Documentation License''.
-\end{quote}
-
-If you have Invariant Sections, Front-Cover Texts and Back-Cover Texts,
-replace the ``with...Texts.'' line with this:
-
- with the Invariant Sections being LIST THEIR TITLES, with the
- Front-Cover Texts being LIST, and with the Back-Cover Texts being LIST.
-
-If you have Invariant Sections without Cover Texts, or some other
-combination of the three, merge those two alternatives to suit the
-situation.
-
-If your document contains nontrivial examples of program code, we
-recommend releasing these examples in parallel under your choice of
-free software license, such as the GNU General Public License,
-to permit their use in free software.
-
-\endgroup
-
-\end{document}
Modified: trunk/Master/texmf-dist/source/latex/hyperref/hluatex.dtx
===================================================================
--- trunk/Master/texmf-dist/source/latex/hyperref/hluatex.dtx 2022-05-14 20:31:45 UTC (rev 63297)
+++ trunk/Master/texmf-dist/source/latex/hyperref/hluatex.dtx 2022-05-14 20:32:17 UTC (rev 63298)
@@ -1,6 +1,6 @@
% \iffalse
% Source File: hluatex.dtx
-% 2022-02-21 v7.00n
+% 2022-05-13 v7.00o
%
% Copyright
% 2016-2019 Oberdiek Package Support Group
@@ -31,7 +31,7 @@
%
% \begin{macrocode}
%<*luatex>
-%% 2022-02-21 v7.00n
+%% 2022-05-13 v7.00o
%% force unicode encoding, see issue #101
%% code mostly copied from hxetex.def
\HyPsd at LoadUnicode
Added: trunk/Master/texmf-dist/source/latex/hyperref/hyperref-linktarget.dtx
===================================================================
--- trunk/Master/texmf-dist/source/latex/hyperref/hyperref-linktarget.dtx (rev 0)
+++ trunk/Master/texmf-dist/source/latex/hyperref/hyperref-linktarget.dtx 2022-05-14 20:32:17 UTC (rev 63298)
@@ -0,0 +1,584 @@
+% \iffalse meta-comment
+%
+%% File: hyperref-linktarget.dtx
+%
+% Copyright (C) 2022-2022 The LaTeX Project
+%
+% It may be distributed and/or modified under the conditions of the
+% LaTeX Project Public License (LPPL), either version 1.3c of this
+% license or (at your option) any later version. The latest version
+% of this license is in the file
+%
+% http://www.latex-project.org/lppl.txt
+%
+% This file is part of the "Hyperref bundle" (The Work in LPPL)
+% and all files in that bundle must be distributed together.
+%
+% -----------------------------------------------------------------------
+%
+% The development version of the bundle can be found at
+%
+% https://github.com/latex3/hyperref
+%
+% for those people who are interested.
+%
+%<*driver>
+\RequirePackage{pdfmanagement-testphase}
+\DocumentMetadata{pdfstandard=A-2b}
+\documentclass[full]{l3doc}
+\usepackage{array,booktabs,hyperxmp}
+\hypersetup{pdfauthor=The LaTeX Project,
+ pdftitle=Make link targets (hyperref bundle)}
+\usepackage[skins]{tcolorbox}
+\definecolor{myblue}{RGB}{00,33,99}
+\newtcolorbox{doccomment}[1][]{enhanced,frame hidden,colback=myblue!10,fontupper=\footnotesize,#1}
+%\newtcbox{smalldoccomment}{size=small,on line,enhanced,frame hidden,colback=myblue!10,fontupper=\footnotesize}
+\begin{document}
+ \DocInput{\jobname.dtx}
+\end{document}
+%</driver>
+% \fi
+% \title{^^A
+% Make link targets ^^A
+% \\
+% hyperref bundle
+% }
+%
+% \author{^^A
+% The \LaTeX{} Project\thanks
+% {^^A
+% E-mail:
+% \href{mailto:latex-team at latex-project.org}
+% {latex-team at latex-project.org}^^A
+% }^^A
+% }
+%
+% \date{Version v7.00o, released 2022-05-13}
+%
+% \maketitle
+% \begin{documentation}
+% \section{Commands to create and adapt targets}
+% This module provides commands to create targets.
+% Their goal is to unify and replace
+% a number of user and internal hyperref commands and to provide a clear
+% interface for package authors and users.
+% \subsection{The main command}
+% \begin{function}{\MakeLinkTarget}
+% \begin{syntax}
+% \cs{MakeLinkTarget}\oarg{prefix}\Arg{counter}\\
+% \cs{MakeLinkTarget}\oarg{prefix}\{\} \\
+% \cs{MakeLinkTarget}*\Arg{manual target}
+% \end{syntax}
+% \end{function}
+%
+% \cs{MakeLinkTarget} creates a target for an internal link, (called a destination
+% if a PDF is created). In vertical mode the target is created where the command is issued,
+% in horizontal mode it is typically (in a PDF) raised by the current \cs{normalbaselineskip}
+% (similar to the targets created by \cs{refstepcounter}).
+%
+% The arguments allow to control the name of the target/anchor/destination. While technically
+% any unique name (e.g. some number) would work, names related to the actual counter both
+% simplifies the debugging and referencing destinations from external documents. Also \cs{autoref}
+% makes use of the name to identify the type of a label: it splits off the part until the first period and
+% then looks up for a defined name. So if you create a target name \texttt{ABC.CDE.1.2}, \cs{autoref} tries
+% to use \cs{ABCautorefname}.
+%
+% The name is then stored \emph{globally}\footnote{This means that the deprecated \pkg{hyperref}
+% option \texttt{localanchorname} is ignored.} in \cs{@currentHref} and used for example in the
+% next \cs{label}.
+% A target name must be unique across a document. It is up to the users and package
+% authors to ensure this by following the advices given below.
+%
+% \begin{doccomment}
+% A global \cs{@currentHref} means that the target name and
+% the label name can get out of sync: if
+% for example a numbered equation is used between a section and a \cs{label},
+% a reference will show the section number but a link will jump to the equation.
+%
+% \pkg{hyperref} allows to switch to local assignment of \cs{@currentHref}
+% and so to align with the other \cs{label} values with the
+% (so-called experimental) option \texttt{localanchorname}. But while on a document
+% level this can work, it makes it difficult for package authors
+% to add reliable link targets that can be referenced if it is unclear
+% if the assignment is local or global.
+%
+% So the choice was made to set \cs{@currentHref} globally always
+% (and to deprecate \texttt{localanchorname}):
+% This is the default in \pkg{hyperref} since ever and it didn't lead to
+% major problems. It has the advantage to
+% allow to put an anchor in a box and move it around. E.g. in the following
+% example the two \cs{ref} commands
+% reference the section but the second jumps to the top of the rule:
+%
+% \begin{verbatim}
+% \section{An example}\label{sec:title}
+% \newpage \raisebox{3cm}[0pt][0pt]{\phantomsection}%
+% \rule{1cm}{3cm}\label{sec:page2}
+% page two
+% \newpage
+% \ref{sec:title}, \ref{sec:page2}
+% \end{verbatim}
+%
+% \end{doccomment}
+%
+%
+%
+% \subsection*{Target names from counters}
+% \begin{syntax}
+% \cs{MakeLinkTarget}\oarg{prefix}\Arg{counter}
+% \end{syntax}
+%
+% If the mandatory argument is not empty it is interpreted as a \LaTeX{} counter name.
+% The counter is not stepped by the command.
+% If the \meta{counter} doesn't exist, a warning is issued and no target is created.
+%
+% The target name is created as expansion of
+% \texttt{\meta{prefix}.\cs{theH\meta{counter}}} (and so both the prefix
+% and \cs{theH\meta{counter}} should be expandable).
+% The default prefix is the counter name \meta{counter}.
+%
+% For example:
+%
+% \medskip
+% \noindent
+% {\ttfamily
+% \begin{tabular}{@{}l@{}ll}
+% \cs{MakeLinkTarget}\{section\} &$\Rightarrow$ section.\cs{theHsection} & $\Rightarrow$ section.1.1\\
+% \cs{MakeLinkTarget}[sec]\{section\} &$\Rightarrow$ sec.\cs{theHsection}
+% \end{tabular}
+% }
+% \medskip
+%
+% \cs{theH\meta{counter}} must be defined:
+% \cs{MakeLinkTarget} does not try like other \pkg{hyperref} commands to
+% construct the command on-the-fly but warns and creates no
+% target if it doesn't exist.
+% Be aware that if \pkg{hyperref} is used with the option \texttt{implicit=false} it
+% does not predefine and create \cs{theH\meta{counter}} representations
+% so targets could be missing!\footnote{It is planed that \LaTeX{} directly defines
+% the \cs{theH\meta{counter}} for all counters created with \cs{newcounter}.}
+%
+%
+% Typically \cs{theH\meta{counter}} should expand to numbers
+% and periods and make use of parent counters to give a unique representation.
+% The prefix can be a more or less arbitrary string. Spaces are allowed (but not
+% really recommended).
+% A star at the end should be avoided to prevent clashes with
+% the names created when the internal counter is used.
+% The use of non-ASCII chars with pdflatex depends on the \LaTeX{} version: With newer
+% version many of them are safe and with a format 2022-06-01 or newer
+% it should be even possible to use chars in a target name which
+% are undeclared and can't be typeset in the document.
+% But despite the fact that it works, it is recommended to stick to ASCII
+% and to avoid spaces: It is unclear if all PDF viewers and editors can handle
+% them, also they give rather unreadable names in the PDF like |(\360\237\246\206)|
+% and so make debugging harder.
+%
+%
+% Using a special prefix can be useful if the actual counter
+% has an internal name like e.g. \texttt{tcb at cnt@example}.
+% \texttt{\cs{MakeLinkTarget}[tcbexample]\{tcb at cnt@example\}} then gives
+% a nicer looking target name. Care should be taken not to clash
+% with existing counter names and names for \cs{autoref}
+% should be adjusted if needed.
+%
+%
+% \subsection*{Targets using the internal counter}
+% \begin{syntax}
+% \cs{MakeLinkTarget}\oarg{prefix}\{\}
+% \end{syntax}
+%
+% If the mandatory argument is empty a target name based on
+% an internal absolute counter is created.
+% The counter is stepped at every call (and also by other \pkg{hyperref} commands).
+% The prefix is added with a star and a period (see above for
+% the allowed chars). The default prefix is \texttt{page}.
+%
+%
+% \begin{syntax}
+% \begin{tabular}{@{}ll}
+% \cs{MakeLinkTarget}\texttt{\{\}} &$\Rightarrow$ \texttt{page*.1}\\
+% \cs{MakeLinkTarget}\texttt{\{\}} &$\Rightarrow$ \texttt{page*.2}\\
+% \cs{MakeLinkTarget}[section]\texttt{\{\}} &$\Rightarrow$ \texttt{section*.3}\\
+% \end{tabular}
+% \end{syntax}
+%
+% As an example the
+% \pkg{hyperref} command \cs{phantomsection} is equivalent to
+% \texttt{\cs{MakeLinkTarget}[section]\{\}}.
+%
+% \subsection*{Manual target names}
+% \begin{syntax}
+% \cs{MakeLinkTarget}\texttt{*}\Arg{manual target name}
+% \end{syntax}
+%
+% If the starred variant is used a manual target name is created.
+%
+% \texttt{\cs{MakeLinkTarget}*\{destname\}} is roughly equivalent to
+% \texttt{\cs{hypertarget}\{destname\}\{\}} but unlike the
+% latter it also raises the destination in a PDF, there is no text argument,
+% and---most importantly--it updates \cs{@currentHref}, that means the target
+% name is stored by the next \cs{label}, something that \cs{hypertarget} doesn't do).
+% The target name is expanded, see the remarks about prefixes above regarding
+% the allowed chars.
+%
+% When creating manually targets care should be taken to avoid
+% clashes with automatic target names.
+% As all automatic targets contain at least one period,
+% names without a period are recommended.
+%
+% \begin{doccomment}
+% The second (text) argument of \cs{hypertarget} is only used
+% if the option \texttt{nesting} is set to true---but this option isn't used
+% anywhere (in PDF the idea of a text in the anchor or nesting of anchors
+% makes no sense anyway but also when html is produced e.g. with \texttt{make4ht}
+% it is not used). So probably the option will be deprecated and removed.
+% \end{doccomment}
+%
+% \subsection{Manipulate the next target name}
+%
+% Targets are sometimes created in places where it is difficult to inject
+% a label to retrieve the target name for use e.g. in a bookmark.
+% The next command allows to change the next target name:
+%
+% \begin{function}{\NextLinkTarget}
+% \begin{syntax}
+% \cs{NextLinkTarget}\Arg{manual target}
+% \end{syntax}
+%
+% The command changes the next target name to \meta{manual target}.
+% It does the same as the \cs{hypersetup} key
+% \texttt{next-anchor} and also affects targets created by \cs{refstepcounter}.
+%\end{function}
+%
+% A use case are bookmarks for the table of contents
+% where you know that the heading will create
+% a target:
+%
+% \begin{verbatim}
+% \documentclass{book}
+% \usepackage{bookmark}
+%
+% \begin{document}
+% \bookmark[dest=toc]{Table of Contents}
+% \NextLinkTarget{toc}
+% \tableofcontents
+% \chapter{A}
+% \end{document}
+% \end{verbatim}
+%
+%
+% \subsection*{Hooks}
+%
+% \begin{function}{makelinktarget}
+% The hook \texttt{makelinktarget}\footnote{The hook uses a plain name
+% without reference to the \pkg{hyperref} package in anticipation of the move
+% of this code into the \LaTeX{} kernel.}
+% is executed at the begin of the commands. It is inside a group and
+% so can be used to locally change settings. See below for an example.
+% \end{function}
+%
+%
+% \subsection*{Suppressing the target}
+%
+% \begin{function}{\LinkTargetOn,\LinkTargetOff}
+% \begin{syntax}
+% \cs{LinkTargetOn}\\
+% \cs{LinkTargetOff}
+% \end{syntax}
+% \end{function}
+%
+%
+% This commands allows to switch on and off locally the creation of a target with
+% \cs{MakeLinkTarget}.
+% The switches are also honored by \cs{refstepcounter}\footnote{currently
+% \cs{refstepcounter} doesn't use \cs{MakeLinkTarget} itself but this
+% will probably change.}.
+% This allows to suppress the target
+% from an internal \cs{refstepcounter} and replace it by some manual version
+% by using grouping:
+%
+% \begin{verbatim}
+% \LinkTargetOff %suppress anchor in internal refstepcounter
+% ...
+% \refstepcounter{...}
+% ...
+% {\LinkTargetOn\MakeLinkTarget*{mytarget}} %create manual anchor
+% ...
+% \LinkTargetOn
+% \end{verbatim}
+%
+%
+% \subsection*{Raising the target}
+%
+% In horizontal mode the target is raised by the current value of \cs{normalbaselineskip}.
+%
+% To change this the hook can be used e.g. to double the value everywhere:
+%
+% \begin{verbatim}
+% \AddToHook{cmd/MakeLinkTarget/before}
+% {\setlength\normalbaselineskip{2\normalbaselineskip}}
+% \leavevmode\MakeLinkTarget{section}
+% \end{verbatim}
+%
+%
+% \subsection{Changing all target names}
+%
+% \begin{function}{\SetLinkTargetFilter}
+% \begin{syntax}
+% \cs{SetLinkTargetFilter}\Arg{filter code using \#1}
+% \end{syntax}
+% \end{function}
+%
+% \pkg{hyperref} provides the command \cs{HyperDestNameFilter} to change all target names.
+% It is applied\footnote{In the backend code, so it depends actually on
+% the driver if it is honored or not}
+% to every target name and is also used in references,
+% but it doesn't change \cs{@currentHref} itself. So after
+%
+% \begin{verbatim}
+% \renewcommand*{\HyperDestNameFilter}[1]{docA-#1}
+% \end{verbatim}
+%
+% you would get in the PDF everywhere the prefix \texttt{docA}
+%
+% \begin{verbatim}
+% %destination names:
+% <<
+% /Names [(docA-Doc-Start) 7 0 R (docA-chapter.1) 8 0 R (docA-page.1) 6 0 R]
+% /Limits [(docA-Doc-Start) (docA-page.1)]
+% >>
+% %link to a chapter
+% /A << /S /GoTo /D (docA-chapter.1) >>
+% %link from the bookmark
+% << /S /GoTo /D (docA-chapter.1) >>
+% \end{verbatim}
+%
+% but the label info in the \texttt{.aux} would show only \texttt{chapter.1}:
+%
+% \begin{verbatim}
+% \newlabel{chap}{{1}{1}{Title}{chapter.1}{}}
+% \end{verbatim}
+%
+% and so \cs{autoref} is still able to extract the counter name.
+%
+% \cs{MakeLinkTarget} uses this filter too: it would break internal link
+% commands if it would ignore it.
+% To stay compatible with future development the filter should not be redefined
+% directly but be set with \cs{SetLinkTargetFilter}.
+% The command can only be used in the preamble.
+%
+% \begin{verbatim}
+% \SetLinkTargetFilter{docA-#1}
+% \end{verbatim}
+% \end{documentation}
+%
+% \begin{implementation}
+% \section{Implementation}
+% \begin{macrocode}
+%<@@=hyp>
+%<*header>
+\ProvidesExplPackage{hyperref-linktarget}{2022-05-13}{v7.00o}
+ {Making targets, destinations and anchors -- module of hyperref}
+%</header>
+% \end{macrocode}
+%<package-include>\ExplSyntaxOn
+% \subsection{Variables}
+% \begin{macrocode}
+%<*package>
+% \end{macrocode}
+% \begin{macro}{\l_@@_target_create_bool}
+% This boolean decides if a target is created at all.
+% (it will replace \cs{@skiphyperref} long term)
+% \begin{macrocode}
+\bool_new:N \l_@@_target_create_bool
+\bool_set_true:N \l_@@_target_create_bool
+% \end{macrocode}
+% \end{macro}
+% \begin{macro}{makelinktarget}
+% This hook is used to adapt for example the raising
+% \begin{macrocode}
+\hook_new:n {makelinktarget}
+% \end{macrocode}
+% \end{macro}
+% \subsection{Helper commands}
+% \begin{macro}{\_@@_target_raise:n}
+% We need a command to raise the targets.
+% It is mostly a copy from the hyperref command
+% but we removed the hooks and use \cs{normalbaselineskip}.
+% TODO: The code to save/restore the space factor should
+% be replaced by kernel methods.
+% \begin{macrocode}
+\cs_new_protected:Npn \@@_target_raise:n #1
+ {
+ \mode_if_vertical:TF
+ { #1 }
+ {
+ \Hy at SaveSpaceFactor
+ \penalty\@M
+ \smash
+ {
+ \box_move_up:nn
+ { \normalbaselineskip }
+ {
+ \hbox:n
+ {
+ \Hy at RestoreSpaceFactor
+ #1
+ \Hy at SaveSpaceFactor
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ \Hy at RestoreSpaceFactor
+ }
+ }
+% \end{macrocode}
+% \end{macro}
+% \subsection{Providing the commands}
+% In anticipation of the addition of the main commands to the
+% kernel as no-ops we provide them:
+% \begin{macrocode}
+\ProvideDocumentCommand\LinkTargetOn{}{}
+\ProvideDocumentCommand\LinkTargetOff{}{}
+\ProvideDocumentCommand\MakeLinkTarget{sO{}m}{}
+\ProvideDocumentCommand\NextLinkTarget{m}{}
+% \end{macrocode}
+%
+% \subsection{Target on and off switch}
+% \begin{macro}{\LinkTargetOn,\LinkTargetOff}
+% \begin{macrocode}
+\RenewDocumentCommand\LinkTargetOn {}
+ {
+ \bool_set_true:N \l_@@_target_create_bool
+ }
+
+
+\RenewDocumentCommand\LinkTargetOff {}
+ {
+ \bool_set_false:N \l_@@_target_create_bool
+ }
+% \end{macrocode}
+% \end{macro}
+%
+% \begin{macro}{\MakeLinkTarget}
+% This is the main command. To keep it simple
+% we allow an optional argument also for the manual
+% command but ignore it for now.
+% \begin{macrocode}
+\RenewDocumentCommand\MakeLinkTarget {s O{} m}
+ {
+ \bool_if:NT \l_@@_target_create_bool
+ {
+ \group_begin:
+ \hook_use:n { makelinktarget }
+ \IfBooleanTF {#1}
+ {
+ \@@_target_manual:nn {#2}{#3}
+ }
+ {
+ \@@_target_counter:nn {#2}{#3}
+ }
+ \group_end:
+ }
+ }
+% \end{macrocode}
+% \end{macro}
+% \begin{macro}{\@@_target_manual:nn}
+% This is the code for the manual target name. The prefix is simply ignored.
+% \begin{macrocode}
+\cs_new_protected:Npn \@@_target_manual:nn #1 #2 %#1 prefix, #2 name
+ {
+ \tl_gset:Nx \@currentHref {#2}
+ \hook_use:n {__hyp/target/setname}
+ \@onelevel at sanitize\@currentHref
+ \@@_target_raise:n {\hyper at anchorstart{\@currentHref}\hyper at anchorend}
+ }
+% \end{macrocode}
+% \end{macro}
+% \begin{macro}{\@@_target_counter:nn}
+% The code for counter related targets must be split into the case
+% where the internal counter is used, and where a user counter is used
+% \begin{macrocode}
+\cs_new_protected:Npn \@@_target_counter:nn #1 #2 %#1 prefix, #2 counter or empty
+ {
+ \tl_if_blank:nTF {#2}
+ {
+ \@@_target_counter_anon:n {#1}
+ }
+ {
+ \@@_target_counter_doc:nn {#1}{#2}
+ }
+ }
+
+% \end{macrocode}
+%\end{macro}
+%\begin{macro}{\@@_target_counter_anon:n}
+% This creates the target with the internal count.
+% We use the same (tex) count \cs{Hy at linkcounter} than the other
+% hyperref commands.
+% \begin{macrocode}
+\cs_new_protected:Npn \@@_target_counter_anon:n #1
+ {
+ \int_gincr:N\Hy at linkcounter
+ \tl_gset:Nx \@currentHref
+ {\tl_if_blank:nTF{#1}{page}{#1}*.\int_use:N\Hy at linkcounter}
+ \hook_use:n {__hyp/target/setname}
+ \@onelevel at sanitize\@currentHref
+ \@@_target_raise:n {\hyper at anchorstart{\@currentHref}\hyper at anchorend}
+ }
+% \end{macrocode}
+% \end{macro}
+
+% \begin{macro}{\@@_target_counter_doc:nn}
+% And now the target with the user counter. We warn if
+% the counter or the representation doesn't exist
+% \begin{macrocode}
+\cs_new_protected:Npn \@@_target_counter_doc:nn #1 #2
+ {
+ \bool_lazy_and:nnTF { \cs_if_free_p:c {c@#2} } { \cs_if_free_p:c {theH#2} }
+ {
+ \PackageWarning {hyperref}{Counter~'#2'~or~the~representation~'\string\theH#2`\MessageBreak
+ don't~exist.~No~target~created.}{}
+ }
+ {
+ \tl_gset:Nx \@currentHref {\tl_if_blank:nTF{#1}{#2}{#1}.\use:c{theH#2}}
+ \hook_use:n {@@/target/setname}
+ \@onelevel at sanitize\@currentHref
+ \@@_target_raise:n {\hyper at anchorstart{\@currentHref}\hyper at anchorend}
+ }
+ }
+% \end{macrocode}
+% \end{macro}
+%
+% \begin{macro}{\NextLinkTarget}
+% we rely on the internal hook to set the next target name:
+% \begin{macrocode}
+\RenewDocumentCommand\NextLinkTarget {m}
+ {
+ \hook_gput_next_code:nn {@@/target/setname}
+ {
+ \tl_gset:Nx \@currentHref {#1}
+ }
+ }
+
+% \end{macrocode}
+% \end{macro}
+% \begin{macro}{\SetLinkTargetFilter}
+% This is an interface to \cs{HyperDestNameFilter}
+% \begin{macrocode}
+\NewDocumentCommand\SetLinkTargetFilter {m}
+ {
+ \cs_set:Npn \HyperDestNameFilter ##1 {#1}
+ }
+\@onlypreamble \SetLinkTargetFilter
+% \end{macrocode}
+% \end{macro}
+%
+% \begin{macrocode}
+%</package>
+%<@@=>.
+% \end{macrocode}
+%<package-include>\ExplSyntaxOff
+%\end{implementation}
+% \Finale
+\endinput
Property changes on: trunk/Master/texmf-dist/source/latex/hyperref/hyperref-linktarget.dtx
___________________________________________________________________
Added: svn:eol-style
## -0,0 +1 ##
+native
\ No newline at end of property
Modified: trunk/Master/texmf-dist/source/latex/hyperref/hyperref-patches.dtx
===================================================================
--- trunk/Master/texmf-dist/source/latex/hyperref/hyperref-patches.dtx 2022-05-14 20:31:45 UTC (rev 63297)
+++ trunk/Master/texmf-dist/source/latex/hyperref/hyperref-patches.dtx 2022-05-14 20:32:17 UTC (rev 63298)
@@ -5,7 +5,7 @@
%% 1995-2001 Sebastian Rahtz, with portions written by David Carlisle and Heiko Oberdiek,
%% 2001-2015 Heiko Oberdiek.
%% 2016-2019 Oberdiek Package Support Group
-%% 2019-2021 LaTeX Project
+%% 2019-2022 LaTeX Project
%% https://github.com/latex3/hyperref/issues
%%
%% This file is part of the `Hyperref Bundle'.
Modified: trunk/Master/texmf-dist/source/latex/hyperref/hyperref.dtx
===================================================================
--- trunk/Master/texmf-dist/source/latex/hyperref/hyperref.dtx 2022-05-14 20:31:45 UTC (rev 63297)
+++ trunk/Master/texmf-dist/source/latex/hyperref/hyperref.dtx 2022-05-14 20:32:17 UTC (rev 63298)
@@ -1,31 +1,31 @@
% \iffalse
%% File: hyperref.dtx
-%% Copyright
-%% 1995-2001 Sebastian Rahtz, with portions written by David Carlisle and Heiko Oberdiek,
-%% 2001-2015 Heiko Oberdiek.
-%% 2016-2019 Oberdiek Package Support Group
-%% 2019-2021 LaTeX Project
-%% https://github.com/latex3/hyperref/issues
-%%
-%% This file is part of the `Hyperref Bundle'.
-%% -------------------------------------------
-%%
-%% This work may be distributed and/or modified under the
-%% conditions of the LaTeX Project Public License, either version 1.3
-%% of this license or (at your option) any later version.
-%% The latest version of this license is in
-%% http://www.latex-project.org/lppl.txt
-%% and version 1.3 or later is part of all distributions of LaTeX
-%% version 2005/12/01 or later.
-%%
-%% This work has the LPPL maintenance status `maintained'.
-%%
-%% The Current Maintainer of this work is the LaTeX Project.
-%%
-%% The list of all files belonging to the `Hyperref Bundle' is
-%% given in the file `manifest.txt'.
-%%
-%<package|nohyperref|driver|check>\NeedsTeXFormat{LaTeX2e}[1995/12/01]
+% Copyright
+% 1995-2001 Sebastian Rahtz, with portions written by David Carlisle and Heiko Oberdiek,
+% 2001-2015 Heiko Oberdiek.
+% 2016-2019 Oberdiek Package Support Group
+% 2019-2022 LaTeX Project
+% https://github.com/latex3/hyperref/issues
+%
+% This file is part of the `Hyperref Bundle'.
+% -------------------------------------------
+%
+% This work may be distributed and/or modified under the
+% conditions of the LaTeX Project Public License, either version 1.3
+% of this license or (at your option) any later version.
+% The latest version of this license is in
+% http://www.latex-project.org/lppl.txt
+% and version 1.3 or later is part of all distributions of LaTeX
+% version 2005/12/01 or later.
+%
+% This work has the LPPL maintenance status `maintained'.
+%
+% The Current Maintainer of this work is the LaTeX Project.
+%
+% The list of all files belonging to the `Hyperref Bundle' is
+% given in the file `manifest.txt'.
+%
+%<package|nohyperref|driver|check>\NeedsTeXFormat{LaTeX2e}[2020/10/01]
%<package>\ProvidesPackage{hyperref}
%<nohyperref>\ProvidesPackage{nohyperref}
%<driver>\ProvidesFile{hyperref.drv}
@@ -52,7 +52,7 @@
%<puvnenc>\ProvidesFile{puvnenc.def}
%<puarenc>\ProvidesFile{puarenc.def}
%<psdextra>\ProvidesFile{psdextra.def}
-%<!none> [2022-02-21 v7.00n %
+%<!none&!packageEnd> [2022-05-13 v7.00o %
%<package> Hypertext links for LaTeX]
%<nohyperref> Dummy hyperref (SR)]
%<driver> Hyperref documentation driver file]
@@ -1036,6 +1036,23 @@
% converted to the final form.
% \end{enumerate}
%
+% \cs{MakeUppercase} and \cs{MakeLowercase} do not work by expansion in
+% legacy code but if the expl3 code is available we can handle them.
+%
+% \begin{macro}{\MakeUppercaseUnsupportedInPdfStrings}
+% \begin{macro}{\MakeLowercaseUnsupportedInPdfStrings}
+% \begin{macrocode}
+\ExplSyntaxOn
+\@ifundefined{text_uppercase:n}{}
+ {
+ \def\MakeUppercaseUnsupportedInPdfStrings#1{\use:e {\text_uppercase:n {#1}}}
+ \def\MakeLowercaseUnsupportedInPdfStrings#1{\use:e {\text_lowercase:n {#1}}}
+ }
+\ExplSyntaxOff
+% \end{macrocode}
+% \end{macro}
+% \end{macro}
+%
% \begin{macro}{\pdfstringdef}
% \cs{pdfstringdef} works on the tokens in |#2| and converts them to
% a PDF string as far as possible:
@@ -4219,14 +4236,7 @@
%
% \section{Support of other packages}
%
-% \subsection{Class memoir}
%
-% \begin{macrocode}
-\@ifclassloaded{memoir}{%
- \Hy at AtEndOfPackage{\RequirePackage{memhfixc}}%
-}{}
-% \end{macrocode}
-%
% \subsection{Package subfigure}
% Added fix for version 2.1. Here \cmd{\sub at label} is defined.
% \begin{macrocode}
@@ -4258,10 +4268,6 @@
\fi
\@esphack
}%
- \@ifpackagelater{subfigure}{2002/03/26}{}{%
- \providecommand*{\toclevel at subfigure}{1}%
- \providecommand*{\toclevel at subtable}{1}%
- }%
}%
}{}
% \end{macrocode}
@@ -4712,6 +4718,9 @@
% \end{macrocode}
% \begin{macrocode}
\define at key{Hyp}{localanchorname}[true]{%
+ \Hy at WarningNoLine{%
+ Option `localanchorname' is deprecated%
+ }%
\Hy at boolkey{localanchorname}{#1}%
}
% \end{macrocode}
@@ -7288,23 +7297,6 @@
\Hy at DisableOption{colorlinks}%
\Hy at DisableOption{frenchlinks}%
\ifHy at texht
- \long\def\@firstoffive#1#2#3#4#5{#1}%
- \long\def\@secondoffive#1#2#3#4#5{#2}%
- \long\def\@thirdoffive#1#2#3#4#5{#3}%
- \long\def\@fourthoffive#1#2#3#4#5{#4}%
- \long\def\@fifthoffive#1#2#3#4#5{#5}%
- \providecommand*\@safe at activestrue{}%
- \providecommand*\@safe at activesfalse{}%
- \def\T at ref#1{%
- \Hy at safe@activestrue
- \expandafter\@setref\csname r@#1\endcsname\@firstoffive{#1}%
- \Hy at safe@activesfalse
- }%
- \def\T at pageref#1{%
- \Hy at safe@activestrue
- \expandafter\@setref\csname r@#1\endcsname\@secondoffive{#1}%
- \Hy at safe@activesfalse
- }%
\else
\ifHy at typexml
\else
@@ -7312,36 +7304,34 @@
\RequirePackage{nameref}[2012/07/28]%
}%
\fi
+% \end{macrocode}
+% With active links we have to redefine the starred versions
+% to avoid that they get links from the include |\@setref|:
+% \begin{macrocode}
+ \ifHy at implicit
+ \let \T at Ref\HyRef at Ref
+ \def\@refstar#1{%
+ \NR at ref@showkeys{#1}%
+ \HyRef at StarSetRef{#1}\@firstoffive
+ }
+ \def\@pagerefstar#1{%
+ \NR at ref@showkeys{#1}%
+ \HyRef at StarSetRef{#1}\@secondoffive
+ }
+ \def\@namerefstar#1{%
+ \NR at ref@showkeys{#1}%
+ \HyRef at StarSetRef{#1}\@thirdoffive
+ }
+ \def\@Refstar#1{%
+ \NR at ref@showkeys{#1}%
+ \HyRef at StarSetRef{#1}\HyRef at MakeUppercaseFirstOfFive
+ }%
+ \else
+ \fi
\fi
- \DeclareRobustCommand\ref{%
- \@ifstar\@refstar\T at ref
- }%
- \DeclareRobustCommand\pageref{%
- \@ifstar\@pagerefstar\T at pageref
- }%
-% \@ifclassloaded{memoir}{%
-% \ltx at IfUndefined{@mem at titlerefnolink}\ltx at secondoftwo{%
-% \ltx at IfUndefined{@mem at titleref}\ltx at secondoftwo\ltx at firstoftwo
-% }%
-% }\ltx at secondoftwo
-% {%
-% \DeclareRobustCommand*{\nameref}{%
-% \@ifstar\@mem at titlerefnolink\@mem at titleref
-% }%
-% }{%
- \DeclareRobustCommand*{\nameref}{%
- \@ifstar\@namerefstar\T at nameref
- }%
-% }%
- \ifHy at implicit
- \else
- \let \@pagerefstar\T at pageref
- \let \@refstar\T at ref
- \let \@namerefstar\T at nameref
- \fi
}
\Hy at AtBeginDocument{%
- \ifHy at texht
+ \ifx\ReadBookmarks\relax
\else
\Hy at CatcodeWrapper\ReadBookmarks
\fi
@@ -9384,15 +9374,18 @@
% \end{macrocode}
% Ignore star from referencing macros:
+% This is only needed if LaTeX doesn't define the starred
+% variants itself.
% \begin{macrocode}
-\LetLtxMacro\NoHy at OrgRef\ref
-\DeclareRobustCommand*{\ref}{%
+\@ifundefined{@kernel at ref}
+ {\LetLtxMacro\NoHy at OrgRef\ref
+ \DeclareRobustCommand*{\ref}{%
\@ifstar\NoHy at OrgRef\NoHy at OrgRef
-}
-\LetLtxMacro\NoHy at OrgPageRef\pageref
-\DeclareRobustCommand*{\pageref}{%
+ }
+ \LetLtxMacro\NoHy at OrgPageRef\pageref
+ \DeclareRobustCommand*{\pageref}{%
\@ifstar\NoHy at OrgPageRef\NoHy at OrgPageRef
-}
+ }}{}
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \section{Localized nullifying of package}
@@ -9482,16 +9475,21 @@
\long\def\@gobbleopt[#1]{}
\let\hyperpage\@empty
% \end{macrocode}
-% Ignore star from referencing macros:
+% Ignore star from referencing macros. This is only
+% needed in older formats.
% \begin{macrocode}
-\LetLtxMacro\NoHy at OrgRef\ref
-\DeclareRobustCommand*{\ref}{%
- \@ifstar\NoHy at OrgRef\NoHy at OrgRef
-}
-\LetLtxMacro\NoHy at OrgPageRef\pageref
-\DeclareRobustCommand*{\pageref}{%
- \@ifstar\NoHy at OrgPageRef\NoHy at OrgPageRef
-}
+\@ifl at t@r\fmtversion{2022-06-01}
+ {}%
+ {%
+ \LetLtxMacro\NoHy at OrgRef\ref
+ \DeclareRobustCommand*{\ref}{%
+ \@ifstar\NoHy at OrgRef\NoHy at OrgRef
+ }
+ \LetLtxMacro\NoHy at OrgPageRef\pageref
+ \DeclareRobustCommand*{\pageref}{%
+ \@ifstar\NoHy at OrgPageRef\NoHy at OrgPageRef
+ }%
+ }
%</nohyperref>
% \end{macrocode}
%
@@ -9508,8 +9506,10 @@
% a document.
%
% Write some stuff into the aux file so if the next run is done
-% without hyperref, then |\contentsline| and |\newlabel| are defined
+% without hyperref, then |\newlabel| is defined
% to cope with the extra arguments.
+% change 2022-03-28: removed the code for |\contentsline|, it is no
+% longer needed as |\contentsline| has now always four arguments.
% \begin{macrocode}
\if at filesw
\ifHy at typexml
@@ -9522,11 +9522,6 @@
\string\AtBeginDocument}^^J%
\string\HyperFirstAtBeginDocument{%
\string\ifx\string\hyper at anchor\string\@undefined^^J%
- \string\global\string\let\string\oldcontentsline\string\contentsline^^J%
- \string\gdef\string\contentsline%
- \string#1\string#2\string#3\string#4{%
- \string\oldcontentsline%
- {\string#1}{\string#2}{\string#3}}^^J%
\string\global\string\let\string\oldnewlabel\string\newlabel^^J%
\string\gdef\string\newlabel\string#1\string#2{%
\string\newlabelxx{\string#1}\string#2}^^J%
@@ -9540,7 +9535,6 @@
% \begin{macrocode}
\string\AtEndDocument{%
\string\ifx\string\hyper at anchor\string\@undefined^^J%
- \string\let\string\contentsline\string\oldcontentsline^^J%
\string\let\string\newlabel\string\oldnewlabel^^J%
\string\fi%
}^^J%
@@ -9561,28 +9555,12 @@
% Now the code to deal with adding the hyperref package to a document
% with aux and toc written the standard way.
%
-% If hyperref was used last time, do nothing. If it was not used,
-% or an old version of hyperref was used, don't use that TOC at all
-% but generate a warning. Not ideal, but better than failing
-% with pre-5.0 hyperref TOCs.
+% If hyperref was used last time, do nothing.
+% change 2022-03-28: removed the test for an old toc.
+% |\contentsline|
+% has now always four arguments.
% \begin{macrocode}
\ifx\hyper at last\@undefined
- \def\@starttoc#1{%
- \begingroup
- \makeatletter
- \ltx at ifpackageloaded{parskip}{\parskip\z@}{}%
- \IfFileExists{\jobname.#1}{%
- \Hy at WarningNoLine{%
- old #1 file detected, not used; run LaTeX again%
- }%
- }{}%
- \if at filesw
- \expandafter\newwrite\csname tf@#1\endcsname
- \immediate\openout\csname tf@#1\endcsname \jobname.#1\relax
- \fi
- \@nobreakfalse
- \endgroup
- }%
\def\newlabel#1#2{\@newl at bel r{#1}{#2{}{}{}{}}}%
\fi
}
@@ -10256,7 +10234,7 @@
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
-%<*package>
+%<*packageEnd>
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
@@ -10312,6 +10290,7 @@
\Hy at CounterExists{section}{%
\providecommand\theHequation{\theHsection.\arabic{equation}}%
}
+\providecommand\theHequation{\arabic{equation}}%
\Hy at CounterExists{part}{%
\providecommand\theHpart{\arabic{part}}%
}
@@ -10366,36 +10345,42 @@
% \begin{macrocode}
\let\H at refstepcounter\refstepcounter
\edef\name at of@eq{equation}%
-\edef\name at of@slide{slide}%
% \end{macrocode}
% We do not want the handler for |\refstepcounter| to cut in
% during the processing of |\item| (we handle that separately),
% so we provide a bypass conditional.
+% change 2022-04-22: removed test for the slide counter
+% and for the equation name.
+% change 2022-05-02: added the new boolean set by
+% |\LinkTargetOn/\LinkTargetOff|
+%
% \begin{macrocode}
\newif\if at hyper@item
\newif\if at skiphyperref
\@hyper at itemfalse
\@skiphyperreffalse
+\ExplSyntaxOn
\def\refstepcounter#1{%
- \ifHy at pdfstring
- \else
+ \legacy_if:nF {Hy at pdfstring}
+ {
\H at refstepcounter{#1}%
- \edef\This at name{#1}%
- \ifx\This at name\name at of@slide
- \else
- \if at skiphyperref
- \else
- \if at hyper@item
- \stepcounter{Item}%
- \hyper at refstepcounter{Item}%
- \@hyper at itemfalse
- \else
- \hyper at refstepcounter{#1}%
- \fi
- \fi
- \fi
- \fi
+ \bool_lazy_and:nnT
+ { \l__hyp_target_create_bool }
+ { ! \legacy_if_p:n{@skiphyperref} }
+ {
+ \legacy_if:nTF {@hyper at item}
+ {
+ \stepcounter{Item}%
+ \hyper at refstepcounter{Item}%
+ \@hyper at itemfalse
+ }
+ {
+ \hyper at refstepcounter{#1}%
+ }
+ }
+ }
}
+\ExplSyntaxOff
\let\Hy at saved@refstepcounter\refstepcounter
% \end{macrocode}
% AMS\LaTeX\ processes all equations twice; we want to make sure
@@ -10558,24 +10543,14 @@
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
-% \begin{macro}{\hyper at hook@dest at make}
% We define a hook to allow to overwrite the next destination name.
% \begin{macrocode}
-\@ifl at t@r\fmtversion{2020-10-01}
- {%
- \NewHook{__hyp/dest/make }
- \def\hyper at hook@dest at make
- {\UseHook{__hyp/dest/make}}
- \define at key{Hyp}{next-anchor}{%
- \AddToHookNext{__hyp/dest/make}%
+\NewHook{__hyp/target/setname }
+\define at key{Hyp}{next-anchor}{%
+ \AddToHookNext{__hyp/target/setname}%
{\Hy at MakeCurrentHref{#1}}%
}
- }
- {
- \def\hyper at hook@dest at make{}
- }
% \end{macrocode}
-% \end{macro}
% \begin{macro}{\hyper at makecurrent}
% Because of Babel mucking around, nullify |\textlatin| when making names.
% And |\@number| because of babel's lrbabel.def.
@@ -10627,7 +10602,7 @@
\else
\global\let\@currentHref\HyperGlobalCurrentHref
\fi
- \hyper at hook@dest at make
+ \UseHook{__hyp/target/setname}%
}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
@@ -10654,7 +10629,7 @@
\def\Hy at MakeCurrentHrefAuto#1{%
\Hy at GlobalStepCount\Hy at linkcounter
\Hy at MakeCurrentHref{#1.\the\Hy at linkcounter}%
- \hyper at hook@dest at make}
+ \UseHook{__hyp/target/setname}}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
@@ -10728,17 +10703,21 @@
% Fix provided by Felix Neubauer (\Email{felix.neubauer at gmx.net}).
% This fix will no longer be needed with latex 2021-11-15.
% \begin{macrocode}
-\AtBeginDocument{%
-\def\Hy at varioref@undefined{{??}{??}{}{}{}}
-\@ifpackageloaded{varioref}{%
- \def\vref at pagenum#1#2{%
- \@ifundefined{r@#2}{%
- \expandafter\let\csname r@#2\endcsname\Hy at varioref@undefined
- }{}%
- \edef#1{\getpagerefnumber{#2}}%
- }%
-}{}
-}
+\@ifl at t@r\fmtversion{2021-11-15}
+ {}%
+ {
+ \AtBeginDocument{%
+ \def\Hy at varioref@undefined{{??}{??}{}{}{}}
+ \@ifpackageloaded{varioref}{%
+ \def\vref at pagenum#1#2{%
+ \@ifundefined{r@#2}{%
+ \expandafter\let\csname r@#2\endcsname\Hy at varioref@undefined
+ }{}%
+ \edef#1{\getpagerefnumber{#2}}%
+ }%
+ }{}
+ }
+ }
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \section{Package longtable support}
@@ -10794,7 +10773,7 @@
% Overload equation, temporarily reverting to original
% |\refstepcounter|. If, however, it is in AMS math, we do not
% do anything, as the tag mechanism is used there (see section \ref{ams}).
-% The execption is that we move the equation incrementation inside
+% The exception is that we move the equation incrementation inside
% the math environment to avoid specials outside and a wrong vertical
% spacing of equation environments.
% \begin{macrocode}
@@ -11121,8 +11100,10 @@
% text, separately from whatever labels the text assigns. Too hard
% to keep track of markers otherwise. If the raw forms |\footnotemark|
% and |\footnotetext| are used, force them to use un-hyper original.
-%
+% If |\hyper at nopatch@footnote| is defined we don't patch but assume
+% that addings links to footnotes is handled elsewhere.
% \begin{macrocode}
+\@ifundefined{hyper at nopatch@footnote}{%
\ifHy at hyperfootnotes
\newcounter{Hfootnote}%
\let\H@@footnotetext\@footnotetext
@@ -11315,7 +11296,7 @@
}{}%
% \end{macrocode}
%
-% KOMA-Script defines \cs{footref} that uses both
+% KOMA-Script or newer LaTeX defines \cs{footref} that uses both
% \cs{ref} and \cs{@footnotemark} resulting in two links,
% one of them wrong.
% \begin{macrocode}
@@ -11368,8 +11349,8 @@
% Does anyone remember the function and purpose of \cmd{\realfootnote}?
% \begin{macrocode}
\def\realfootnote{%
- \@ifnextchar[\@xfootnote{%
- \stepcounter{\@mpfn}%
+ \@ifnextchar[\@xfootnote%]
+ {\stepcounter{\@mpfn}%
\protected at xdef\@thefnmark{\thempfn}%
\H@@footnotemark\H@@footnotetext
}%
@@ -11377,12 +11358,13 @@
% \end{macrocode}
% \begin{macrocode}
\fi
+}{}
\Hy at DisableOption{hyperfootnotes}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
-%</package>
+%</packageEnd>
%<*check>
\checklatex
\checkcommand\def\@xfootnotenext[#1]{%
@@ -11407,7 +11389,7 @@
\relax
}
%</check>
-%<*package>
+%<*packageEnd>
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \section{Float captions}\label{captions}
@@ -11518,7 +11500,7 @@
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
-%</package>
+%</packageEnd>
%<*check>
\checklatex[1999/06/01 - 2000/06/01]
\checkcommand\def\caption{%
@@ -11546,7 +11528,7 @@
\endgroup
}
%</check>
-%<*package>
+%<*packageEnd>
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \section{Bibliographic references}\label{bib}
@@ -11559,7 +11541,7 @@
% and \emph{drftcite} may break.
%
% However, lets make an attempt to get \emph{natbib} right, because
-% thats a powerful, important package.
+% that's a powerful, important package.
% Patrick Daly (\Email{daly at linmpi.mpg.de}) has
% provided hooks for us, so all we need to do is activate them.
% \begin{macrocode}
@@ -11660,7 +11642,7 @@
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
-%</package>
+%</packageEnd>
%<*check>
\checklatex
\checkcommand\def\@lbibitem[#1]#2{%
@@ -11685,7 +11667,7 @@
\ignorespaces
}
%</check>
-%<*package>
+%<*packageEnd>
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \subsection{Package harvard}
@@ -12065,7 +12047,7 @@
% \end{macro}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
-%</package>
+%</packageEnd>
%<*check>
\checklatex
\checkcommand\def\addcontentsline#1#2#3{%
@@ -12073,7 +12055,7 @@
}
\checkcommand\def\contentsline#1{\csname l@#1\endcsname}
%</check>
-%<*package>
+%<*packageEnd>
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \section{New counters}\label{counters}
@@ -12179,10 +12161,10 @@
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \begin{macro}{\numberwithin}
-% A appropiate definition of hyperref's companion counter
+% A appropriate definition of hyperref's companion counter
% (\cmd{\theH...}) is added for correct link names.
% \begin{macrocode}
-%</package>
+%</packageEnd>
%<*check>
\checkpackage{amsmath}[1999/12/14 - 2000/06/06]
\checkcommand\newcommand{\numberwithin}[3][\arabic]{%
@@ -12196,30 +12178,22 @@
}%
}%
%</check>
-%<*package>
+%<*packageEnd>
\@ifpackageloaded{amsmath}{%
- \@ifpackagelater{amsmath}{1999/12/14}{%
- \renewcommand*{\numberwithin}[3][\arabic]{%
- \@ifundefined{c@#2}{\@nocounterr{#2}}{%
- \@ifundefined{c@#3}{\@nocnterr{#3}}{%
- \HyOrg at addtoreset{#2}{#3}%
- \@xp\xdef\csname the#2\endcsname{%
- \@xp\@nx\csname the#3\endcsname .\@nx#1{#2}%
- }%
- \@xp\xdef\csname theH#2\endcsname{%
- \@xp\@nx
- \csname the\@ifundefined{theH#3}{}H#3\endcsname
- .\@nx#1{#2}%
- }%
+ \renewcommand*{\numberwithin}[3][\arabic]{%
+ \@ifundefined{c@#2}{\@nocounterr{#2}}{%
+ \@ifundefined{c@#3}{\@nocnterr{#3}}{%
+ \HyOrg at addtoreset{#2}{#3}%
+ \@xp\xdef\csname the#2\endcsname{%
+ \@xp\@nx\csname the#3\endcsname .\@nx#1{#2}%
}%
+ \@xp\xdef\csname theH#2\endcsname{%
+ \@xp\@nx
+ \csname the\@ifundefined{theH#3}{}H#3\endcsname
+ .\@nx#1{#2}%
+ }%
}%
}%
- }{%
- \Hy at WarningNoLine{%
- \string\numberwithin\space of package `amsmath' %
- only fixed\MessageBreak
- for version 2000/06/06 v2.12 or newer%
- }%
}%
}{}
% \end{macrocode}
@@ -12501,7 +12475,7 @@
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
-%</package>
+%</packageEnd>
%<*check>
\checklatex
\checkcommand\def\@setref#1#2#3{%
@@ -12516,7 +12490,7 @@
\fi
}
%</check>
-%<*package>
+%<*packageEnd>
% \end{macrocode}
%
% Now some extended referencing. |\ref*| and |\pageref*| are not linked,
@@ -12549,26 +12523,25 @@
\def\@namerefstar#1{%
\HyRef at StarSetRef{#1}\@thirdoffive
}
-
+\def\@Refstar#1{%
+ \HyRef at StarSetRef{#1}\HyRef at MakeUppercaseFirstOfFive
+}%
+\def\HyRef at MakeUppercaseFirstOfFive#1#2#3#4#5{%
+ \MakeUppercase#1%
+}%
+\def\HyRef at Ref#1{%
+ \hyperref[{#1}]{\Ref*{#1}}%
+}%
\Hy at AtBeginDocument{%
\@ifpackageloaded{varioref}{%
- \def\@Refstar#1{%
- \HyRef at StarSetRef{#1}\HyRef at MakeUppercaseFirstOfFive
- }%
- \def\HyRef at MakeUppercaseFirstOfFive#1#2#3#4#5{%
- \MakeUppercase#1%
- }%
- \DeclareRobustCommand*{\Ref}{%
- \@ifstar\@Refstar\HyRef at Ref
- }%
- \def\HyRef at Ref#1{%
- \hyperref[{#1}]{\Ref*{#1}}%
- }%
% \end{macrocode}
-% Test if we are running new 2019 varioref or old one:
+% This are the patches for a varioref newer after 2019-09
+% Older versions are no longer supported.
+% If |\hyper at nopatch@varioref| is defined we don't patch but assume
+% that varioref handles the hyperlinks.
% \begin{macrocode}
-%FMi
- \ifdefined\vp at gerefstar
+ \@ifundefined{hyper at nopatch@varioref}
+ {
\renewcommand\Vref at star[2][]{%
\begingroup
\let\T at pageref\@pagerefstar
@@ -12601,33 +12574,11 @@
\vpageref[#1]{#2}%
\endgroup
}%
+ }{}%
+ }{}%
+}
% \end{macrocode}
-% old varioref:
% \begin{macrocode}
- \else
- \def\Vr at f#1{%
- \leavevmode\unskip\vref at space
- \hyperref[{#1}]{%
- \Ref*{#1}%
- \let\vref at space\nobreakspace
- \@vpageref[\unskip]{#1}%
- }%
- }%
- \def\vr at f#1{%
- \leavevmode\unskip\vref at space
- \begingroup
- \let\T at pageref\@pagerefstar
- \hyperref[{#1}]{%
- \ref*{#1}%
- \vpageref[\unskip]{#1}%
- }%
- \endgroup
- }%
- \fi
-%FMi -end mod
- }{}%
-}
-
\DeclareRobustCommand*{\autopageref}{%
\@ifstar{%
\HyRef at autopagerefname\pageref*%
@@ -12651,10 +12602,9 @@
% \cs{leavevmode} is added to make package wrapfigure happy, if
% \cs{autoref} starts a paragraph.
% \begin{macrocode}
-\DeclareRobustCommand*{\autoref}{%
- \leavevmode
- \@ifstar{\HyRef at autoref\@gobbletwo}{\HyRef at autoref\hyper@@link}%
-}
+\NewDocumentCommand\autoref{s}
+ {\leavevmode
+ \IfBooleanTF{#1}{\HyRef at autoref\@gobbletwo}{\HyRef at autoref\hyper@@link}}
\def\HyRef at autoref#1#2{%
\begingroup
\Hy at safe@activestrue
@@ -12737,9 +12687,7 @@
% \begin{macrocode}
\let\HyRef at ShowKeysRef\@gobble
\def\HyRef at ShowKeysInit{%
- \begingroup\expandafter\expandafter\expandafter\endgroup
- \expandafter\ifx\csname SK@@label\endcsname\relax
- \else
+ \ifcsname SK@@label\endcsname
\ifx\SK at ref\@empty
\else
\def\HyRef at ShowKeysRef{%
@@ -12785,7 +12733,7 @@
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
-%</package>
+%</packageEnd>
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \section{Configuration files}
@@ -13096,15 +13044,7 @@
\expandafter\endgroup
\expandafter\pdflinkmargin\the\dimen@\relax
}
-\ifx\pdfstartlink\@undefined% less than version 14
- \let\pdfstartlink\pdfannotlink
- \let\pdflinkmargin\@tempdima
- \let\pdfxform\pdfform
- \let\pdflastxform\pdflastform
- \let\pdfrefxform\pdfrefform
-\else
- \pdflinkmargin1pt %
-\fi
+\pdflinkmargin1pt %
% \end{macrocode}
% First set up the default linking
% \begin{macrocode}
@@ -15463,7 +15403,7 @@
% is used by writing some clipped text.
% \begin{macrocode}
%<dviwindo>\def\literalps at out#1{\special{ps:#1}}%
-%<package>\providecommand*{\Hy at DistillerDestFix}{}
+%<packageEnd>\providecommand*{\Hy at DistillerDestFix}{}
%<*pdfmark|dviwindo>
\def\Hy at DistillerDestFix{%
\begingroup
@@ -19334,7 +19274,7 @@
% \end{macro}
% \begin{macrocode}
%</pdfform>
-%<*package>
+%<*packageEnd>
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \section{Bookmarks in the PDF file}
@@ -19354,7 +19294,7 @@
\Hy at MakeCurrentHrefAuto{section*}%
\Hy at raisedlink{\hyper at anchorstart{\@currentHref}\hyper at anchorend}%
}
-%</package>
+%</packageEnd>
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \subsection{Bookmarks}
@@ -19827,6 +19767,8 @@
\hss
}%
}
+\@ifundefined{hyper at nopatch@sectioning}
+{
\let\H at old@ssect\@ssect
\def\@ssect#1#2#3#4#5{%
\Hy at MakeCurrentHrefAuto{section*}%
@@ -19922,6 +19864,7 @@
\H at old@sect{#1}{#2}{#3}{#4}{#5}{#6}[{#7}]{#8}%
}%
}
+}{}
% \end{macrocode}
% \begin{macrocode}
%</outlines|hypertex>
@@ -19944,61 +19887,6 @@
%</outlines>
% \end{macrocode}
%
-% \section{Compatibility with koma-script classes}
-%
-% \begin{macrocode}
-%<*outlines|hypertex>
-% \end{macrocode}
-%
-% Hard-wire in an unpleasant over-ride of komascript `scrbook' class
-% for Tobias Isenberg (\Email{Tobias.Isenberg at gmx.de}).
-% With version 6.71b the hack is also applied to `scrreprt' class
-% and is removed for koma-script versions since 2001/01/01,
-% because Markus Kohm supports hyperref in komascript.
-% \begin{macrocode}
-\def\Hy at tempa{%
- \def\@addchap[##1]##2{%
- \typeout{##2}%
- \if at twoside
- \@mkboth{##1}{}%
- \else
- \@mkboth{}{##1}%
- \fi
- \addtocontents{lof}{\protect\addvspace{10\p@}}%
- \addtocontents{lot}{\protect\addvspace{10\p@}}%
- \Hy at MakeCurrentHrefAuto{\Hy at chapapp*}%
- \Hy at raisedlink{%
- \hyper at anchorstart{\@currentHref}\hyper at anchorend
- }%
- \if at twocolumn
- \@topnewpage[\@makeschapterhead{##2}]%
- \else
- \@makeschapterhead{##2}%
- \@afterheading
- \fi
- \addcontentsline{toc}{chapter}{##1}%
- }%
-}
-\@ifclassloaded{scrbook}{%
- \@ifclasslater{scrbook}{2001/01/01}{%
- \let\Hy at tempa\@empty
- }{}%
-}{%
- \@ifclassloaded{scrreprt}{%
- \@ifclasslater{scrreprt}{2001/01/01}{%
- \let\Hy at tempa\@empty
- }{}%
- }{%
- \let\Hy at tempa\@empty
- }%
-}%
-\Hy at tempa
-% \end{macrocode}
-%
-% \begin{macrocode}
-%</outlines|hypertex>
-% \end{macrocode}
-%
% \section{Encoding definition files for encodings of PDF strings}
% This was contributed by
% Heiko Oberdiek.
Modified: trunk/Master/texmf-dist/source/latex/hyperref/hyperref.ins
===================================================================
--- trunk/Master/texmf-dist/source/latex/hyperref/hyperref.ins 2022-05-14 20:31:45 UTC (rev 63297)
+++ trunk/Master/texmf-dist/source/latex/hyperref/hyperref.ins 2022-05-14 20:32:17 UTC (rev 63298)
@@ -7,7 +7,7 @@
%% 1995-2001 Sebastian Rahtz, with portions written by David Carlisle and Heiko Oberdiek
%% 2001-2015 Heiko Oberdiek
%% 2016-2019 Oberdiek Package Support Group
-%% 2019-2021 LaTeX Project
+%% 2019-2022 LaTeX Project
%% https://github.com/latex3/hyperref/issues
%%
%% This file is part of the `Hyperref Bundle'.
@@ -55,6 +55,32 @@
%\askonceonly
%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
\preamble
+
+Copyright
+1995-2001 Sebastian Rahtz, with portions written by David Carlisle and Heiko Oberdiek,
+2001-2015 Heiko Oberdiek.
+2016-2019 Oberdiek Package Support Group
+2019-2022 LaTeX Project
+ https://github.com/latex3/hyperref/issues
+
+This file is part of the `Hyperref Bundle'.
+-------------------------------------------
+
+This work may be distributed and/or modified under the
+conditions of the LaTeX Project Public License, either version 1.3
+of this license or (at your option) any later version.
+The latest version of this license is in
+ http://www.latex-project.org/lppl.txt
+and version 1.3 or later is part of all distributions of LaTeX
+version 2005/12/01 or later.
+
+This work has the LPPL maintenance status `maintained'.
+
+The Current Maintainer of this work is the LaTeX Project.
+
+The list of all files belonging to the `Hyperref Bundle' is
+given in the file `manifest.txt'.
+
\endpreamble
\generate{%
@@ -65,7 +91,12 @@
\usedir{tex/latex/hyperref}
\file{backref.sty}{\from{backref.dtx}{package}}
\file{nameref.sty}{\from{nameref.dtx}{package}}
- \file{hyperref.sty}{\from{hyperref.dtx}{package}}
+ \file{hyperref.sty}
+ {
+ \from{hyperref.dtx}{package}
+ \from{hyperref-linktarget.dtx}{package,package-include}
+ \from{hyperref.dtx}{packageEnd}
+ }
\file{hypertex.def}{\from{hyperref.dtx}{hypertex}}
\file{pdfmark.def}{\from{hyperref.dtx}{pdfmark,pdfmarkbase,pdfform,outlines}}
\file{hvtexmrk.def}{\from{hyperref.dtx}{vtexpdfmark}}
Modified: trunk/Master/texmf-dist/source/latex/hyperref/nameref.dtx
===================================================================
--- trunk/Master/texmf-dist/source/latex/hyperref/nameref.dtx 2022-05-14 20:31:45 UTC (rev 63297)
+++ trunk/Master/texmf-dist/source/latex/hyperref/nameref.dtx 2022-05-14 20:32:17 UTC (rev 63298)
@@ -4,7 +4,7 @@
%% 2000 Sebastian Rahtz, Heiko Oberdiek
%% 2001-2012 Heiko Oberdiek
%% 2016-2019 Oberdiek Package Suport Group
-%% 2019-2021 The LaTeX Project
+%% 2019-2022 The LaTeX Project
%% https://github.com/latex3/hyperref/issues
%%
%% This file is part of the `Hyperref Bundle'.
@@ -33,7 +33,7 @@
%<driver>\ProvidesFile{nameref.drv}
% \fi
% \ProvidesFile{nameref.dtx}
- [2021-04-02 v2.47 Cross-referencing by name of section]%
+ [2022-05-13 v2.48 Cross-referencing by name of section]%
%
%
% \iffalse
@@ -78,6 +78,101 @@
% Cross-referencing to include the \emph{name} of the section, rather than
% just the number or page. This works by redefining some of the inside
% \LaTeX\ macros, so it is vulnerable to future changes.
+%
+% \section{Background and advice for package and class authors}
+% The package redefines the \cs{label} command to write additionally
+% \cs{@currentlabelname} to the \texttt{.aux} file. This can then be referenced with
+% \cs{nameref}. Package authors who want to support \textsf{nameref} should
+% define this command (locally) in a suitable way.
+% The content should be so that it can be safely written
+% to the \texttt{.aux} file. \textsf{nameref} itself uses the package
+% \textsf{gettitlestring} but this is not required.
+%
+% \textsf{nameref} patches a number of commands (mostly sectioning
+% commands) and environments so that they
+% store \cs{@currentlabelname}. A class or a package that want to provide native
+% support instead can suppress this patches by defining commands described below.
+% The commands must be defined before the patch is made, in most cases before
+% \textsf{nameref} is loaded, sometimes only before begin document.
+%
+% \begin{description}
+% \item[sectioning commands] Redefined are
+% \begin{itemize}
+% \item
+% \cs{@sect}: beside adding a command that stores the
+% title of a sectioning command (if present the optional argument is used)
+% \textsf{nameref} also stores the level number in a counter \texttt{section at level}
+% (reason is unknown, only two packages, \textsf{e-french} and \textsf{pdfscreen}
+% seem to use it), and surrounds the text with \cs{Sectionformat} (only used by
+% \textsf{acmart}, \textsf{memoir}, \textsf{pdfscreen}, \textsf{pdfslide}), a
+% command which takes two argument: the first the text, the second the level.
+%
+% \item \cs{@ssect}: command to store the title added,
+% \cs{Sectionformat} is added.
+%
+% \item \cs{M at sect} (memoir class): command to store the title added
+%
+% \item \cs{@part}, \cs{@spart}, \cs{@chapter}, \cs{@schapter}:
+% command to store the title added
+% \item \cs{ttl at sect@i} (from the \textsf{titlesec} package):
+% command to store the title added
+% \end{itemize}
+%
+% All the patches excepted the last are disabled if the command
+% \cs{NR at nopatch@sectioning} is defined (the actual definition is irrelevant, only
+% existence is tested. The titlesec patch is disabled if
+% \cs{NR at nopatch@titlesec} is defined.
+% This currently only suppress the actual patches, the counter,
+% \cs{Sectionformat} and also the internal copies \cs{NR at sect} etc are still
+% defined.
+%
+% \item[captions] The following commands are patched
+% \begin{itemize}
+% \item \cs{@caption}: command to store the title added. This is done at begin
+% document, but only if \textsf{hyperref} is not detected. With \textsf{hyperref}
+% the patch is done there (and must be disabled in \textsf{hyperref}).
+%
+% This patch can be disabled by defining \cs{NR at nopatch@caption}
+%
+% \item \cs{LT at c@ption} (from the \textsf{longtable} package):
+% command to store the title added.
+%
+% This patch can be disabled by defining \cs{NR at nopatch@longtable}
+%
+% \item \cs{lst at MakeCaption} (from the \textsf{listings} package)
+%
+% This patch can be disabled by defining \cs{NR at nopatch@listings}
+% \end{itemize}
+%
+% \item[lists] The following command is patched
+% \begin{itemize}
+% \item \cs{descriptionlabel}: command to store the label text added. To
+% reference this text the \cs{label} must be put \emph{inside} the label.
+% This is not compatible with the \textsf{enumitem} package as internal
+% formatting commands are written to the \texttt{.aux} file too.
+%
+% This patch can be disabled by defining \cs{NR at nopatch@lists}
+% \end{itemize}
+%
+% \item[theorems]
+%
+% \begin{itemize}
+% \item \cs{@opargbegintheorem}: command to store the title added.
+%
+% This patch can be disabled by defining \cs{NR at nopatch@theorem}
+%
+% \item \cs{@begintheorem} (if amsthm is loaded and if
+% the command has a tested meaning): command to store the title added.
+%
+% This patch can be disabled by defining \cs{NR at nopatch@amsthm}
+%
+% \end{itemize}
+% \item[beamer] In the \textsf{beamer} class the following commands are
+% patched: \cs{beamer at section}, \cs{beamer at subsection}, \cs{beamer at subsubsection},
+% \cs{beamer at descriptionitem} and the template \texttt{theorem begin}. If
+% \cs{NR at nopatch@beamer} is defined nothing is done.
+% \end{description}
+%
% \section{History}
% Sebastian Rahtz, for Lou Burnard, March 15th 1994;\\
% SPQR CERN July 1994;\\
@@ -304,11 +399,12 @@
% \end{macrocode}
% \begin{macro}{\@sect}
% \begin{macrocode}
-\def\@sect#1#2#3#4#5#6[#7]#8{%
- \setcounter{section at level}{#2}%
- \NR at gettitle{#7}%
- \NR at sect{#1}{#2}{#3}{#4}{#5}{#6}[{#7}]{\Sectionformat{#8}{#2}}%
-}
+\@ifundefined{NR at nopatch@sectioning}
+ {\def\@sect#1#2#3#4#5#6[#7]#8{%
+ \setcounter{section at level}{#2}%
+ \NR at gettitle{#7}%
+ \NR at sect{#1}{#2}{#3}{#4}{#5}{#6}[{#7}]{\Sectionformat{#8}{#2}}%
+ }}{}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
% and now the unnumbered ones
@@ -317,12 +413,13 @@
\let\NR at ssect\@ssect
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
-% \begin{macro}{\NR at ssect}
+% \begin{macro}{\@ssect}
% \begin{macrocode}
-\def\@ssect#1#2#3#4#5{%
- \NR at gettitle{#5}%
- \NR at ssect{#1}{#2}{#3}{#4}{\Sectionformat{#5}{#1}}%
-}
+\@ifundefined{NR at nopatch@sectioning}
+ {\def\@ssect#1#2#3#4#5{%
+ \NR at gettitle{#5}%
+ \NR at ssect{#1}{#2}{#3}{#4}{\Sectionformat{#5}{#1}}%
+ }}{}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
%
@@ -329,21 +426,22 @@
% Support for class memoir.
%
% \begin{macrocode}
-\ltx at IfUndefined{ifheadnameref}{%
-}{%
- \ltx at IfUndefined{M at sect}{%
+\@ifundefined{NR at nopatch@sectioning}
+ {\ltx at IfUndefined{ifheadnameref}{%
}{%
- \let\NRorg at M@sect\M at sect
- \def\M at sect#1#2#3#4#5#6[#7][#8]{%
- \ifheadnameref
- \NR at gettitle{#8}%
- \else
- \NR at gettitle{#7}%
- \fi
- \NRorg at M@sect{#1}{#2}{#3}{#4}{#5}{#6}[{#7}][{#8}]%
+ \ltx at IfUndefined{M at sect}{%
+ }{%
+ \let\NRorg at M@sect\M at sect
+ \def\M at sect#1#2#3#4#5#6[#7][#8]{%
+ \ifheadnameref
+ \NR at gettitle{#8}%
+ \else
+ \NR at gettitle{#7}%
+ \fi
+ \NRorg at M@sect{#1}{#2}{#3}{#4}{#5}{#6}[{#7}][{#8}]%
+ }%
}%
- }%
-}
+ }}{}
% \end{macrocode}
%
% Parts and chapters are treated differently. sigh.
@@ -351,51 +449,53 @@
%
% \begin{macrocode}
\let\NR at part\@part
-\long\def\@part[#1]#2{%
- \NR at gettitle{#1}%
- \NR at part[{#1}]{#2}%
-}
\let\NR at spart\@spart
-\long\def\@spart#1{%
- \NR at gettitle{#1}%
- \NR at spart{#1}%
-}
\let\NR at chapter\@chapter
-\def\@chapter[#1]#2{%
- \NR at gettitle{#1}%
- \NR at chapter[{#1}]{#2}%
-}
-\@ifclassloaded{memoir}{%
- \ltx at IfUndefined{ifheadnameref}{%
- }{%
- \def\@chapter[#1]#2{%
- \ltx at IfUndefined{ch at pt@c}{%
- \NR at gettitle{#1}%
- }{%
- \ifx\ch at pt@c\ltx at empty
- \NR at gettitle{#2}%
- \else
- \def\NR at temp{#1}%
- \ifx\NR at temp\ltx at empty
- \expandafter\NR at gettitle\expandafter{\ch at pt@c}%
+\let\NR at schapter\@schapter
+\@ifundefined{NR at nopatch@sectioning}
+ {%
+ \long\def\@part[#1]#2{%
+ \NR at gettitle{#1}%
+ \NR at part[{#1}]{#2}%
+ }
+ \long\def\@spart#1{%
+ \NR at gettitle{#1}%
+ \NR at spart{#1}%
+ }
+ \def\@chapter[#1]#2{%
+ \NR at gettitle{#1}%
+ \NR at chapter[{#1}]{#2}%
+ }
+ \@ifclassloaded{memoir}{%
+ \ltx at IfUndefined{ifheadnameref}{%
+ }{%
+ \def\@chapter[#1]#2{%
+ \ltx at IfUndefined{ch at pt@c}{%
+ \NR at gettitle{#1}%
+ }{%
+ \ifx\ch at pt@c\ltx at empty
+ \NR at gettitle{#2}%
\else
- \ifheadnameref
- \NR at gettitle{#1}%
+ \def\NR at temp{#1}%
+ \ifx\NR at temp\ltx at empty
+ \expandafter\NR at gettitle\expandafter{\ch at pt@c}%
\else
- \expandafter\NR at gettitle\expandafter{\ch at pt@c}%
+ \ifheadnameref
+ \NR at gettitle{#1}%
+ \else
+ \expandafter\NR at gettitle\expandafter{\ch at pt@c}%
+ \fi
\fi
\fi
- \fi
+ }%
+ \NR at chapter[{#1}]{#2}%
}%
- \NR at chapter[{#1}]{#2}%
}%
- }%
-}{}
-\let\NR at schapter\@schapter
-\def\@schapter#1{%
- \NR at gettitle{#1}%
- \NR at schapter{#1}%
-}
+ }{}
+ \def\@schapter#1{%
+ \NR at gettitle{#1}%
+ \NR at schapter{#1}%
+ }}{}
% \end{macrocode}
%
% Captions
@@ -402,29 +502,32 @@
%
% \begin{macrocode}
\AtBeginDocument{%
- \@ifpackageloaded{hyperref}{%
- \@ifpackagelater{hyperref}{2009/12/05}\@gobble\@firstofone
- }\@firstofone
+ \@ifpackageloaded{hyperref}{}
{%
- \let\NR@@caption\@caption
- \long\def\@caption#1[#2]{%
+ \@ifundefined{NR at nopatch@caption}
+ {\let\NR@@caption\@caption
+ \long\def\@caption#1[#2]{%
\NR at gettitle{#2}%
\NR@@caption{#1}[{#2}]%
- }%
+ }}%
+ {}%
}%
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \begin{macrocode}
\@ifpackageloaded{longtable}{%
- \let\NRorg at LT@c at ption\LT at c@ption
- \def\LT at c@ption#1[#2]#3{%
- \NRorg at LT@c at ption{#1}[{#2}]{#3}%
- \def\@tempa{#2}%
- \ifx\@tempa\@empty
- \else
+ \@ifundefined{NR at nopatch@longtable}
+ {%
+ \let\NRorg at LT@c at ption\LT at c@ption
+ \def\LT at c@ption#1[#2]#3{%
+ \NRorg at LT@c at ption{#1}[{#2}]{#3}%
+ \def\@tempa{#2}%
+ \ifx\@tempa\@empty
+ \else
\NR at gettitle{#2}%
- \fi
- }%
+ \fi
+ }%
+ }{}%
}{}%
% \end{macrocode}
%
@@ -432,11 +535,13 @@
% \begin{macrocode}
\ltx at IfUndefined{descriptionlabel}{%
}{%
- \let\NRorg at descriptionlabel\descriptionlabel
- \def\descriptionlabel#1{%
- \NR at gettitle{#1}%
- \NRorg at descriptionlabel{#1}%
- }%
+ \@ifundefined{NR at nopatch@longtable}
+ {\let\NRorg at descriptionlabel\descriptionlabel
+ \def\descriptionlabel#1{%
+ \NR at gettitle{#1}%
+ \NRorg at descriptionlabel{#1}%
+ }%
+ }{}%
}%
}
% \end{macrocode}
@@ -446,10 +551,13 @@
\AtBeginDocument{%
\@ifpackageloaded{titlesec}{%
\let\NRorg at ttl@sect at i\ttl at sect@i
- \def\ttl at sect@i#1#2[#3]#4{%
- \NR at gettitle{#4}%
- \NRorg at ttl@sect at i{#1}{#2}[{#3}]{#4}%
- }%
+ \@ifundefined{NR at nopatch@titlesec}
+ {%
+ \def\ttl at sect@i#1#2[#3]#4{%
+ \NR at gettitle{#4}%
+ \NRorg at ttl@sect at i{#1}{#2}[{#3}]{#4}%
+ }%
+ }{}%
}{}%
}
% \end{macrocode}
@@ -458,39 +566,42 @@
%
% \begin{macrocode}
\@ifclassloaded{beamer}{%
- \def\NR at PatchBeamer#1{%
- \expandafter\let\csname NRorg at beamer@#1\expandafter\endcsname
- \csname beamer@#1\endcsname
- \begingroup
- \edef\x{\endgroup
- \long\def\expandafter\noexpand\csname beamer@#1\endcsname
- [####1]{% hash-ok
- \noexpand\NR at gettitle{####1}%
- \expandafter\noexpand\csname NRorg at beamer@#1\endcsname
- [{####1}]%
+ \@ifundefined{NR at nopatch@beamer}
+ {%
+ \def\NR at PatchBeamer#1{%
+ \expandafter\let\csname NRorg at beamer@#1\expandafter\endcsname
+ \csname beamer@#1\endcsname
+ \begingroup
+ \edef\x{\endgroup
+ \long\def\expandafter\noexpand\csname beamer@#1\endcsname
+ [####1]{% hash-ok
+ \noexpand\NR at gettitle{####1}%
+ \expandafter\noexpand\csname NRorg at beamer@#1\endcsname
+ [{####1}]%
+ }%
}%
- }%
- \x
- }%
- \NR at PatchBeamer{section}%
- \NR at PatchBeamer{subsection}%
- \NR at PatchBeamer{subsubsection}%
+ \x
+ }%
+ \NR at PatchBeamer{section}%
+ \NR at PatchBeamer{subsection}%
+ \NR at PatchBeamer{subsubsection}%
% \end{macrocode}
%
% Theorem names.
% \begin{macrocode}
- \addtobeamertemplate{theorem begin}{%
- \expandafter\NR at gettitle\expandafter{\inserttheoremaddition}%
- }{}%
+ \addtobeamertemplate{theorem begin}{%
+ \expandafter\NR at gettitle\expandafter{\inserttheoremaddition}%
+ }{}%
% \end{macrocode}
% \begin{macrocode}
- \@ifdefinable{\NRorg at beamer@descriptionitem}{%
- \let\NRorg at beamer@descriptionitem\beamer at descriptionitem
- \renewcommand{\beamer at descriptionitem}[1]{%
- \NR at gettitle{#1}%
- \NRorg at beamer@descriptionitem{#1}%
+ \@ifdefinable{\NRorg at beamer@descriptionitem}{%
+ \let\NRorg at beamer@descriptionitem\beamer at descriptionitem
+ \renewcommand{\beamer at descriptionitem}[1]{%
+ \NR at gettitle{#1}%
+ \NRorg at beamer@descriptionitem{#1}%
+ }%
}%
- }%
+ }{}%
}{}
% \end{macrocode}
%
@@ -554,13 +665,15 @@
\long\def\@fourthoffive#1#2#3#4#5{#4}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
-% \begin{macro}{\@offive}
+% \begin{macro}{\@fifthoffive}
% \begin{macrocode}
\long\def\@fifthoffive#1#2#3#4#5{#5}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
-% We have to redefine |\ref| and |\pageref| to know about extra
+% We have to redefine |\ref|, |\Ref| and |\pageref| to know about extra
% reference elements. Make them robust, and compatible with Babel.
+% We also define starred versions so that it doesn't depend on hyperref
+% if they are defined or not. We use the same internal names as hyperref.
% The Babel switch is mimicked if not already defined.
% Some support for package \xpackage{showkeys} is implemented. If
% option |notref| of that package is set, |\SK at ref| has the
@@ -575,6 +688,11 @@
\providecommand*\@safe at activesfalse{}%
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
+% \begin{macro}{\NR at ref@showkeys}
+% \begin{macrocode}
+\newcommand\NR at ref@showkeys[1]{}%
+% \end{macrocode}
+% \end{macro}
% \begin{macro}{\NR at setref}
% \begin{macrocode}
\def\NR at setref#1{%
@@ -599,118 +717,140 @@
% \begin{macro}{\T at ref}
% \begin{macrocode}
\def\T at ref#1{%
+ \NR at ref@showkeys{#1}%
\NR at setref{#1}\@firstoffive{#1}%
}%
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
+% \begin{macro}{\@refstar}
+% \begin{macrocode}
+\def\@refstar#1{%
+ \NR at ref@showkeys{#1}%
+ \NR at setref{#1}\@firstoffive{#1}%
+}%
+% \end{macrocode}
+% \end{macro}
% \begin{macro}{\T at pageref}
% \begin{macrocode}
\def\T at pageref#1{%
+ \NR at ref@showkeys{#1}%
\NR at setref{#1}\@secondoffive{#1}%
}%
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
+% \begin{macro}{\@pagerefstar}
% \begin{macrocode}
-\ifNR at showkeys
- \ifx\SK at ref\@empty
- \else
+\def\@pagerefstar#1{%
+ \NR at ref@showkeys{#1}%
+ \NR at setref{#1}\@secondoffive{#1}%
+}%
% \end{macrocode}
-% \begin{macro}{\T at ref}
+% \end{macro}%
+% \begin{macro}{\T at Ref}
% \begin{macrocode}
- \def\T at ref#1{%
- \@safe at activestrue
- \SK@\SK@@ref{#1}%
- \@safe at activesfalse
- \NR at setref{#1}\@firstoffive{#1}%
- }%
+\def\T at Ref#1{%
+ \NR at ref@showkeys{#1}%
+ \NR at setref{#1}\NR at MakeUppercaseFirstOfFive{#1}%
+ }%
+\def\NR at MakeUppercaseFirstOfFive#1#2#3#4#5{%
+ \MakeUppercase#1%
+ }%
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
-% \begin{macro}{\T at pageref}
+% \begin{macro}{\@Refstar}
% \begin{macrocode}
- \def\T at pageref#1{%
- \@safe at activestrue
- \SK@\SK@@ref{#1}%
- \@safe at activesfalse
- \NR at setref{#1}\@secondoffive{#1}%
- }%
+\def\@Refstar#1{%
+ \NR at ref@showkeys{#1}%
+ \NR at setref{#1}\NR at MakeUppercaseFirstOfFive{#1}%
+ }%
% \end{macrocode}
-% \end{macro}
+% \end{macro}%
% \begin{macrocode}
+\ifNR at showkeys
+ \ifx\SK at ref\@empty
+ \else
+ \renewcommand\NR at ref@showkeys[1]{%
+ \@safe at activestrue
+ \SK@\SK@@ref{#1}%
+ \@safe at activesfalse}
\fi
\fi
% \end{macrocode}
-% Package \xpackage{hyperref} uses its own definitions of |\ref| and
-% |\pageref| because it extends the syntax by the star form.
+% Package \xpackage{hyperref} uses the same
+% definitions of |\ref|, |\Ref| and
+% |\pageref| but has to redefine the non-starred command to
+% add the hyperlink support.
% |\DeclareRobustCommand| is used by \xpackage{hyperref}.
% Package |nameref| can be loaded before, after
% \xpackage{hyperref} or after
% \xpackage{hyperref}'s definitions in |\AtBeginDocument|.
+% We have to postpone the definition to |\AtBeginDocument| to
+% avoid that showkeys overwrites them again.
% \begin{macrocode}
-\@ifpackageloaded{hyperref}{%
-}{%
+\AddToHook{begindocument}{%
% \end{macrocode}
% \begin{macro}{\ref}
% \begin{macrocode}
- \DeclareRobustCommand{\ref}{\T at ref}%
+ \DeclareDocumentCommand\ref{s}
+ {\IfBooleanTF{#1}{\@refstar}{\T at ref}}%
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
% \begin{macro}{\pageref}
% \begin{macrocode}
- \DeclareRobustCommand{\pageref}{\T at pageref}%
+ \DeclareDocumentCommand\pageref{s}
+ {\IfBooleanTF{#1}{\@pagerefstar}{\T at pageref}}%
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
+% \begin{macro}{\Ref}
% \begin{macrocode}
+ \DeclareDocumentCommand\Ref{s}
+ {\IfBooleanTF{#1}{\@Refstar}{\T at Ref}}%
+% \end{macrocode}
+% \end{macro}
+% \begin{macrocode}
}
% \end{macrocode}
+% \begin{macrocode}
+\DeclareHookRule{begindocument}{showkeys}{before}{nameref}
+% \end{macrocode}
%
+%
% \subsection{Usage and frontend}
% Access the (third) name part with |\nameref|;
% \begin{macro}{\T at nameref}
% \begin{macrocode}
\def\T at nameref#1{%
+ \NR at ref@showkeys{#1}%
\begingroup
\let\label\@gobble
\NR at setref{#1}\@thirdoffive{#1}%
\endgroup
}%
-\ifNR at showkeys
- \ifx\SK at ref\@empty
- \else
- \def\T at nameref#1{%
- \@safe at activestrue
- \SK@\SK@@ref{#1}%
- \@safe at activesfalse
- \begingroup
- \let\label\@gobble
- \NR at setref{#1}\@thirdoffive{#1}%
- \endgroup
- }%
- \fi
-\fi
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
+% \begin{macro}{\@namerefstar}
% \begin{macrocode}
-%\@ifclassloaded{memoir}{%
-% \ltx at IfUndefined{@mem at titlerefnolink}\ltx at secondoftwo{%
-% \ltx at IfUndefined{@mem at titleref}\ltx at secondoftwo\ltx at firstoftwo
-% }%
-%}\ltx at secondoftwo
-%{%
-% \DeclareRobustCommand*{\nameref}{%
-% \@ifstar\@mem at titlerefnolink\@mem at titleref
-% }%
-%}{%
+\def\@namerefstar#1{%
+ \NR at ref@showkeys{#1}%
+ \begingroup
+ \let\label\@gobble
+ \NR at setref{#1}\@thirdoffive{#1}%
+ \endgroup
+}%
% \end{macrocode}
+% \end{macro}
+% \begin{macrocode}
+% \end{macrocode}
% \begin{macro}{\nameref}
% \begin{macrocode}
- \DeclareRobustCommand*{\nameref}{%
- \@ifstar\T at nameref\T at nameref
- }%
-%}
+\NewDocumentCommand\nameref{s}
+ {\IfBooleanTF{#1}{\@namerefstar}{\T at nameref}}
% \end{macrocode}
% \end{macro}
% \begin{macro}{\Nameref}
% An extended form which gives title and page number.
+% Not really useful, quotes are english, and no starred version.
+% varioref can do that better. Remove??
% \begin{macrocode}
\def\Nameref#1{`\nameref{#1}' on page~\pageref{#1}}
% \end{macrocode}
@@ -733,21 +873,24 @@
% to provide expandable versions without link of \cmd{\ref}
% and \cmd{\pageref}. As possible target I could only find
% \cmd{\begingroup}:
+% Changed/disabled 2022-04-13: ifthen takes care itself to
+% change \cmd{\pageref} to an expandable version.
% \begin{macrocode}
-\@ifpackageloaded{ifthen}{%
- \let\NROrg at ifthenelse\ifthenelse
- \def\ifthenelse{%
- \let\begingroup\NR at TE@begingroup
- \NROrg at ifthenelse
- }%
- \let\NROrg at begingroup\begingroup
- \def\NR at TE@begingroup{%
- \let\begingroup\NROrg at begingroup
- \begingroup
- \def\ref##1{\getrefbykeydefault{##1}{}{??}}%
- \def\pageref##1{\getrefbykeydefault{##1}{page}{0}}%
- }%
-}{}
+\@ifundefined{@kernel at pageref@exp}
+ {\@ifpackageloaded{ifthen}{%
+ \let\NROrg at ifthenelse\ifthenelse
+ \def\ifthenelse{%
+ \let\begingroup\NR at TE@begingroup
+ \NROrg at ifthenelse
+ }%
+ \let\NROrg at begingroup\begingroup
+ \def\NR at TE@begingroup{%
+ \let\begingroup\NROrg at begingroup
+ \begingroup
+ \def\ref##1{\getrefbykeydefault{##1}{}{??}}%
+ \def\pageref##1{\getrefbykeydefault{##1}{page}{0}}%
+ }%
+ }{}}{}
% \end{macrocode}
%
% \subsection{Compatibility with varioref}
@@ -760,101 +903,11 @@
\AtBeginDocument{%
\ifx\csname @@vpageref\endcsname\relax
\else
-%FMi
% \end{macrocode}
-% Test if we are using the new varioref ...
+% This requires a varioref newer than 2019-09-12
% \begin{macrocode}
- \ifdefined\vp at gerefstar
\let\NR@@vpageref\@@vpageref
-% \end{macrocode}
-% if not then old patching code
-% \begin{macrocode}
- \else
- \def\NR@@vpageref#1[#2]#3{%
- \leavevmode\unskip
- \global\advance\c at vrcnt\@ne
- \@ifundefined{r@\the\c at vrcnt @vr}%
- {\@namedef{r@\the\c at vrcnt @vr}{{??}{??}{}{}{}}}{}%
- \edef\@tempa{%
- \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter
- \@secondoffive\csname r@\the\c at vrcnt @vr\endcsname
- }%
- \@ifundefined{r@\the\c at vrcnt @xvr}%
- {\@namedef{r@\the\c at vrcnt @xvr}{{??}{??}{}{}{}}}{}%
- \edef\@tempb{%
- \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter
- \@secondoffive\csname r@\the\c at vrcnt @xvr\endcsname
- }%
- {%
- \let\@currentlabel\@empty
- \expandafter\label\expandafter{\the\c at vrcnt @xvr}%
- }%
- \ifx\@tempa\@tempb
- \else
- \vref at err{%
- \noexpand\vref at page boundary %
- \@tempb-\@tempa\space (may loop)%
- }%
- \fi
- \@ifundefined{r@#3}{\@namedef{r@#3}{{??}{??}{}{}{}}}{}%
- \edef\thevpagerefnum{%
- \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter
- \@secondoffive\csname r@#3\endcsname
- }%
- \ifx\vref at space\@undefined
- \space
- \else
- \vref at space
- \fi
- \ifx\@tempa\thevpagerefnum
- #1%
- \else
- #2%
- \is at pos@number\thevpagerefnum{%
- \is at pos@number\@tempa{%
- \@tempcnta\@tempa
- \advance\@tempcnta\@ne
- }{%
- \@tempcnta\maxdimen
- }%
- \ifnum \thevpagerefnum =\@tempcnta
- \ifodd\@tempcnta
- \if at twoside
- \reftextfaceafter
- \else
- \reftextafter
- \fi
- \else
- \reftextafter
- \fi
- \else
- \advance\@tempcnta-2 %
- \ifnum \thevpagerefnum =\@tempcnta
- \ifodd\@tempcnta
- \reftextbefore
- \else
- \if at twoside
- \reftextfacebefore
- \else
- \reftextbefore
- \fi
- \fi
- \else
- \reftextfaraway{#3}%
- \fi
- \fi
- }{%
- \reftextfaraway{#3}%
- }%
- \fi
- {%
- \let\@currentlabel\@empty
- \expandafter\label\expandafter{\the\c at vrcnt @vr}%
- }%
- }%
- \fi
-%FM - end mod
- \def\@@vpageref#1[#2]#3{%
+ \def\@@vpageref#1[#2]#3{%
\begingroup
\csname @safe at activestrue\endcsname
\edef\x{#3}%
@@ -868,31 +921,12 @@
\x
}%
\DeclareRobustCommand\vnameref[1]{%
- \unskip~\nameref{#1}%
+ \unskip~\nameref{#1} %
\@vpageref[\unskip]{#1}%
}%
\fi
}
% \end{macrocode}
-% \begin{macrocode}
-\@ifundefined{@Refstar}{%
- \def\T at Ref#1{%
- \NR at setref{#1}\NR at MakeUppercaseFirstOfFive{#1}%
- }%
- \def\NR at MakeUppercaseFirstOfFive#1#2#3#4#5{%
- \MakeUppercase#1%
- }%
-}{}%
-\AtBeginDocument{%
- \@ifpackageloaded{varioref}{%
- \@ifundefined{@Refstar}{%
- \DeclareRobustCommand*{\Ref}[1]{%
- \T at Ref{#1}%
- }%
- }{}%
- }{}%
-}%
-% \end{macrocode}
%
% \subsection{Support for package \xpackage{listings}}
%
@@ -899,14 +933,17 @@
% \begin{macrocode}
\AtBeginDocument{%
\@ifpackageloaded{listings}{%
- \let\NROrg at lst@MakeCaption\lst at MakeCaption
- \def\lst at MakeCaption{%
- \ifx\lst at label\@empty
- \else
- \let\@currentlabelname\lst@@caption
- \fi
- \NROrg at lst@MakeCaption
- }%
+ \@ifundefined{NR at nopatch@listings}
+ {%
+ \let\NROrg at lst@MakeCaption\lst at MakeCaption
+ \def\lst at MakeCaption{%
+ \ifx\lst at label\@empty
+ \else
+ \let\@currentlabelname\lst@@caption
+ \fi
+ \NROrg at lst@MakeCaption
+ }%
+ }{}%
}{}%
}
% \end{macrocode}
Modified: trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/backref.sty
===================================================================
--- trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/backref.sty 2022-05-14 20:31:45 UTC (rev 63297)
+++ trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/backref.sty 2022-05-14 20:32:17 UTC (rev 63298)
@@ -6,11 +6,36 @@
%%
%% backref.dtx (with options: `package')
%%
+%% Copyright
+%% 1995-2001 Sebastian Rahtz, with portions written by David Carlisle and Heiko Oberdiek,
+%% 2001-2015 Heiko Oberdiek.
+%% 2016-2019 Oberdiek Package Support Group
+%% 2019-2022 LaTeX Project
+%% https://github.com/latex3/hyperref/issues
+%%
+%% This file is part of the `Hyperref Bundle'.
+%% -------------------------------------------
+%%
+%% This work may be distributed and/or modified under the
+%% conditions of the LaTeX Project Public License, either version 1.3
+%% of this license or (at your option) any later version.
+%% The latest version of this license is in
+%% http://www.latex-project.org/lppl.txt
+%% and version 1.3 or later is part of all distributions of LaTeX
+%% version 2005/12/01 or later.
+%%
+%% This work has the LPPL maintenance status `maintained'.
+%%
+%% The Current Maintainer of this work is the LaTeX Project.
+%%
+%% The list of all files belonging to the `Hyperref Bundle' is
+%% given in the file `manifest.txt'.
+%%
%% File: backref.dtx
%% Copyright (C) 1995-2000 David Carlisle, Sebastian Rahtz, Heiko Oberdiek
%% 2001-2012 Heiko Oberdiek
%% 2016-2019 Oberdiek Package Suport Group
-%% 2019-2021 The LaTeX Project
+%% 2019-2022 The LaTeX Project
%% https://github.com/latex3/hyperref/issues
%%
%% This file is part of the `Hyperref Bundle'.
Modified: trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/hdvipdfm.def
===================================================================
--- trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/hdvipdfm.def 2022-05-14 20:31:45 UTC (rev 63297)
+++ trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/hdvipdfm.def 2022-05-14 20:32:17 UTC (rev 63298)
@@ -6,17 +6,16 @@
%%
%% hyperref.dtx (with options: `dvipdfm,pdfform,outlines')
%%
-%% File: hyperref.dtx
%% Copyright
%% 1995-2001 Sebastian Rahtz, with portions written by David Carlisle and Heiko Oberdiek,
%% 2001-2015 Heiko Oberdiek.
%% 2016-2019 Oberdiek Package Support Group
-%% 2019-2021 LaTeX Project
+%% 2019-2022 LaTeX Project
%% https://github.com/latex3/hyperref/issues
-%%
+%%
%% This file is part of the `Hyperref Bundle'.
%% -------------------------------------------
-%%
+%%
%% This work may be distributed and/or modified under the
%% conditions of the LaTeX Project Public License, either version 1.3
%% of this license or (at your option) any later version.
@@ -24,16 +23,17 @@
%% http://www.latex-project.org/lppl.txt
%% and version 1.3 or later is part of all distributions of LaTeX
%% version 2005/12/01 or later.
-%%
+%%
%% This work has the LPPL maintenance status `maintained'.
-%%
+%%
%% The Current Maintainer of this work is the LaTeX Project.
-%%
+%%
%% The list of all files belonging to the `Hyperref Bundle' is
%% given in the file `manifest.txt'.
-%%
+%%
+%% File: hyperref.dtx
\ProvidesFile{hdvipdfm.def}
- [2022-02-21 v7.00n %
+ [2022-05-13 v7.00o %
Hyperref driver for dvipdfm]
\Hy at VersionCheck{hdvipdfm.def}
\special{pdf:majorversion \Hy at pdf@majorversion}
@@ -1637,6 +1637,8 @@
\hss
}%
}
+\@ifundefined{hyper at nopatch@sectioning}
+{
\let\H at old@ssect\@ssect
\def\@ssect#1#2#3#4#5{%
\Hy at MakeCurrentHrefAuto{section*}%
@@ -1722,6 +1724,7 @@
\H at old@sect{#1}{#2}{#3}{#4}{#5}{#6}[{#7}]{#8}%
}%
}
+}{}
\expandafter\def\csname Parent-4\endcsname{}
\expandafter\def\csname Parent-3\endcsname{}
\expandafter\def\csname Parent-2\endcsname{}
@@ -1731,43 +1734,6 @@
\expandafter\def\csname Parent2\endcsname{}
\expandafter\def\csname Parent3\endcsname{}
\expandafter\def\csname Parent4\endcsname{}
-\def\Hy at tempa{%
- \def\@addchap[##1]##2{%
- \typeout{##2}%
- \if at twoside
- \@mkboth{##1}{}%
- \else
- \@mkboth{}{##1}%
- \fi
- \addtocontents{lof}{\protect\addvspace{10\p@}}%
- \addtocontents{lot}{\protect\addvspace{10\p@}}%
- \Hy at MakeCurrentHrefAuto{\Hy at chapapp*}%
- \Hy at raisedlink{%
- \hyper at anchorstart{\@currentHref}\hyper at anchorend
- }%
- \if at twocolumn
- \@topnewpage[\@makeschapterhead{##2}]%
- \else
- \@makeschapterhead{##2}%
- \@afterheading
- \fi
- \addcontentsline{toc}{chapter}{##1}%
- }%
-}
-\@ifclassloaded{scrbook}{%
- \@ifclasslater{scrbook}{2001/01/01}{%
- \let\Hy at tempa\@empty
- }{}%
-}{%
- \@ifclassloaded{scrreprt}{%
- \@ifclasslater{scrreprt}{2001/01/01}{%
- \let\Hy at tempa\@empty
- }{}%
- }{%
- \let\Hy at tempa\@empty
- }%
-}%
-\Hy at tempa
\endinput
%%
%% End of file `hdvipdfm.def'.
Modified: trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/hdvips.def
===================================================================
--- trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/hdvips.def 2022-05-14 20:31:45 UTC (rev 63297)
+++ trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/hdvips.def 2022-05-14 20:32:17 UTC (rev 63298)
@@ -6,17 +6,16 @@
%%
%% hyperref.dtx (with options: `dvips')
%%
-%% File: hyperref.dtx
%% Copyright
%% 1995-2001 Sebastian Rahtz, with portions written by David Carlisle and Heiko Oberdiek,
%% 2001-2015 Heiko Oberdiek.
%% 2016-2019 Oberdiek Package Support Group
-%% 2019-2021 LaTeX Project
+%% 2019-2022 LaTeX Project
%% https://github.com/latex3/hyperref/issues
-%%
+%%
%% This file is part of the `Hyperref Bundle'.
%% -------------------------------------------
-%%
+%%
%% This work may be distributed and/or modified under the
%% conditions of the LaTeX Project Public License, either version 1.3
%% of this license or (at your option) any later version.
@@ -24,16 +23,17 @@
%% http://www.latex-project.org/lppl.txt
%% and version 1.3 or later is part of all distributions of LaTeX
%% version 2005/12/01 or later.
-%%
+%%
%% This work has the LPPL maintenance status `maintained'.
-%%
+%%
%% The Current Maintainer of this work is the LaTeX Project.
-%%
+%%
%% The list of all files belonging to the `Hyperref Bundle' is
%% given in the file `manifest.txt'.
-%%
+%%
+%% File: hyperref.dtx
\ProvidesFile{hdvips.def}
- [2022-02-21 v7.00n %
+ [2022-05-13 v7.00o %
Hyperref driver for dvips]
\Hy at VersionCheck{hdvips.def}
\providecommand*{\XR at ext}{pdf}
Modified: trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/hdvipson.def
===================================================================
--- trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/hdvipson.def 2022-05-14 20:31:45 UTC (rev 63297)
+++ trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/hdvipson.def 2022-05-14 20:32:17 UTC (rev 63298)
@@ -6,17 +6,16 @@
%%
%% hyperref.dtx (with options: `dvipsone')
%%
-%% File: hyperref.dtx
%% Copyright
%% 1995-2001 Sebastian Rahtz, with portions written by David Carlisle and Heiko Oberdiek,
%% 2001-2015 Heiko Oberdiek.
%% 2016-2019 Oberdiek Package Support Group
-%% 2019-2021 LaTeX Project
+%% 2019-2022 LaTeX Project
%% https://github.com/latex3/hyperref/issues
-%%
+%%
%% This file is part of the `Hyperref Bundle'.
%% -------------------------------------------
-%%
+%%
%% This work may be distributed and/or modified under the
%% conditions of the LaTeX Project Public License, either version 1.3
%% of this license or (at your option) any later version.
@@ -24,16 +23,17 @@
%% http://www.latex-project.org/lppl.txt
%% and version 1.3 or later is part of all distributions of LaTeX
%% version 2005/12/01 or later.
-%%
+%%
%% This work has the LPPL maintenance status `maintained'.
-%%
+%%
%% The Current Maintainer of this work is the LaTeX Project.
-%%
+%%
%% The list of all files belonging to the `Hyperref Bundle' is
%% given in the file `manifest.txt'.
-%%
+%%
+%% File: hyperref.dtx
\ProvidesFile{hdvipson.def}
- [2022-02-21 v7.00n %
+ [2022-05-13 v7.00o %
Hyperref driver for dvipsone]
\Hy at VersionCheck{hdvipson.def}
\providecommand*{\XR at ext}{pdf}
Modified: trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/hdviwind.def
===================================================================
--- trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/hdviwind.def 2022-05-14 20:31:45 UTC (rev 63297)
+++ trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/hdviwind.def 2022-05-14 20:32:17 UTC (rev 63298)
@@ -6,17 +6,16 @@
%%
%% hyperref.dtx (with options: `dviwindo,pdfmarkbase')
%%
-%% File: hyperref.dtx
%% Copyright
%% 1995-2001 Sebastian Rahtz, with portions written by David Carlisle and Heiko Oberdiek,
%% 2001-2015 Heiko Oberdiek.
%% 2016-2019 Oberdiek Package Support Group
-%% 2019-2021 LaTeX Project
+%% 2019-2022 LaTeX Project
%% https://github.com/latex3/hyperref/issues
-%%
+%%
%% This file is part of the `Hyperref Bundle'.
%% -------------------------------------------
-%%
+%%
%% This work may be distributed and/or modified under the
%% conditions of the LaTeX Project Public License, either version 1.3
%% of this license or (at your option) any later version.
@@ -24,16 +23,17 @@
%% http://www.latex-project.org/lppl.txt
%% and version 1.3 or later is part of all distributions of LaTeX
%% version 2005/12/01 or later.
-%%
+%%
%% This work has the LPPL maintenance status `maintained'.
-%%
+%%
%% The Current Maintainer of this work is the LaTeX Project.
-%%
+%%
%% The list of all files belonging to the `Hyperref Bundle' is
%% given in the file `manifest.txt'.
-%%
+%%
+%% File: hyperref.dtx
\ProvidesFile{hdviwind.def}
- [2022-02-21 v7.00n %
+ [2022-05-13 v7.00o %
Hyperref driver for dviwindo]
\Hy at VersionCheck{hdviwind.def}
\begingroup
Modified: trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/hluatex.def
===================================================================
--- trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/hluatex.def 2022-05-14 20:31:45 UTC (rev 63297)
+++ trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/hluatex.def 2022-05-14 20:32:17 UTC (rev 63298)
@@ -7,17 +7,16 @@
%% hyperref.dtx (with options: `luatex')
%% hluatex.dtx (with options: `luatex')
%%
-%% File: hyperref.dtx
%% Copyright
%% 1995-2001 Sebastian Rahtz, with portions written by David Carlisle and Heiko Oberdiek,
%% 2001-2015 Heiko Oberdiek.
%% 2016-2019 Oberdiek Package Support Group
-%% 2019-2021 LaTeX Project
+%% 2019-2022 LaTeX Project
%% https://github.com/latex3/hyperref/issues
-%%
+%%
%% This file is part of the `Hyperref Bundle'.
%% -------------------------------------------
-%%
+%%
%% This work may be distributed and/or modified under the
%% conditions of the LaTeX Project Public License, either version 1.3
%% of this license or (at your option) any later version.
@@ -25,19 +24,20 @@
%% http://www.latex-project.org/lppl.txt
%% and version 1.3 or later is part of all distributions of LaTeX
%% version 2005/12/01 or later.
-%%
+%%
%% This work has the LPPL maintenance status `maintained'.
-%%
+%%
%% The Current Maintainer of this work is the LaTeX Project.
-%%
+%%
%% The list of all files belonging to the `Hyperref Bundle' is
%% given in the file `manifest.txt'.
-%%
+%%
+%% File: hyperref.dtx
\ProvidesFile{hluatex.def}
- [2022-02-21 v7.00n %
+ [2022-05-13 v7.00o %
Hyperref driver for luaTeX]
\Hy at VersionCheck{hluatex.def}
-%% 2022-02-21 v7.00n
+%% 2022-05-13 v7.00o
%% force unicode encoding, see issue #101
%% code mostly copied from hxetex.def
\HyPsd at LoadUnicode
Modified: trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/hpdftex.def
===================================================================
--- trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/hpdftex.def 2022-05-14 20:31:45 UTC (rev 63297)
+++ trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/hpdftex.def 2022-05-14 20:32:17 UTC (rev 63298)
@@ -6,17 +6,16 @@
%%
%% hyperref.dtx (with options: `pdftex,pdfform,outlines')
%%
-%% File: hyperref.dtx
%% Copyright
%% 1995-2001 Sebastian Rahtz, with portions written by David Carlisle and Heiko Oberdiek,
%% 2001-2015 Heiko Oberdiek.
%% 2016-2019 Oberdiek Package Support Group
-%% 2019-2021 LaTeX Project
+%% 2019-2022 LaTeX Project
%% https://github.com/latex3/hyperref/issues
-%%
+%%
%% This file is part of the `Hyperref Bundle'.
%% -------------------------------------------
-%%
+%%
%% This work may be distributed and/or modified under the
%% conditions of the LaTeX Project Public License, either version 1.3
%% of this license or (at your option) any later version.
@@ -24,16 +23,17 @@
%% http://www.latex-project.org/lppl.txt
%% and version 1.3 or later is part of all distributions of LaTeX
%% version 2005/12/01 or later.
-%%
+%%
%% This work has the LPPL maintenance status `maintained'.
-%%
+%%
%% The Current Maintainer of this work is the LaTeX Project.
-%%
+%%
%% The list of all files belonging to the `Hyperref Bundle' is
%% given in the file `manifest.txt'.
-%%
+%%
+%% File: hyperref.dtx
\ProvidesFile{hpdftex.def}
- [2022-02-21 v7.00n %
+ [2022-05-13 v7.00o %
Hyperref driver for pdfTeX]
\Hy at VersionCheck{hpdftex.def}
\pdf at ifdraftmode{%
@@ -318,15 +318,7 @@
\expandafter\endgroup
\expandafter\pdflinkmargin\the\dimen@\relax
}
-\ifx\pdfstartlink\@undefined% less than version 14
- \let\pdfstartlink\pdfannotlink
- \let\pdflinkmargin\@tempdima
- \let\pdfxform\pdfform
- \let\pdflastxform\pdflastform
- \let\pdfrefxform\pdfrefform
-\else
- \pdflinkmargin1pt %
-\fi
+\pdflinkmargin1pt %
\providecommand*\@pdfview{XYZ}
\Hy at WrapperDef\new at pdflink#1{%
\ifhmode
@@ -1845,6 +1837,8 @@
\hss
}%
}
+\@ifundefined{hyper at nopatch@sectioning}
+{
\let\H at old@ssect\@ssect
\def\@ssect#1#2#3#4#5{%
\Hy at MakeCurrentHrefAuto{section*}%
@@ -1930,6 +1924,7 @@
\H at old@sect{#1}{#2}{#3}{#4}{#5}{#6}[{#7}]{#8}%
}%
}
+}{}
\expandafter\def\csname Parent-4\endcsname{}
\expandafter\def\csname Parent-3\endcsname{}
\expandafter\def\csname Parent-2\endcsname{}
@@ -1939,43 +1934,6 @@
\expandafter\def\csname Parent2\endcsname{}
\expandafter\def\csname Parent3\endcsname{}
\expandafter\def\csname Parent4\endcsname{}
-\def\Hy at tempa{%
- \def\@addchap[##1]##2{%
- \typeout{##2}%
- \if at twoside
- \@mkboth{##1}{}%
- \else
- \@mkboth{}{##1}%
- \fi
- \addtocontents{lof}{\protect\addvspace{10\p@}}%
- \addtocontents{lot}{\protect\addvspace{10\p@}}%
- \Hy at MakeCurrentHrefAuto{\Hy at chapapp*}%
- \Hy at raisedlink{%
- \hyper at anchorstart{\@currentHref}\hyper at anchorend
- }%
- \if at twocolumn
- \@topnewpage[\@makeschapterhead{##2}]%
- \else
- \@makeschapterhead{##2}%
- \@afterheading
- \fi
- \addcontentsline{toc}{chapter}{##1}%
- }%
-}
-\@ifclassloaded{scrbook}{%
- \@ifclasslater{scrbook}{2001/01/01}{%
- \let\Hy at tempa\@empty
- }{}%
-}{%
- \@ifclassloaded{scrreprt}{%
- \@ifclasslater{scrreprt}{2001/01/01}{%
- \let\Hy at tempa\@empty
- }{}%
- }{%
- \let\Hy at tempa\@empty
- }%
-}%
-\Hy at tempa
\endinput
%%
%% End of file `hpdftex.def'.
Modified: trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/htex4ht.cfg
===================================================================
--- trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/htex4ht.cfg 2022-05-14 20:31:45 UTC (rev 63297)
+++ trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/htex4ht.cfg 2022-05-14 20:32:17 UTC (rev 63298)
@@ -6,17 +6,16 @@
%%
%% hyperref.dtx (with options: `tex4htcfg')
%%
-%% File: hyperref.dtx
%% Copyright
%% 1995-2001 Sebastian Rahtz, with portions written by David Carlisle and Heiko Oberdiek,
%% 2001-2015 Heiko Oberdiek.
%% 2016-2019 Oberdiek Package Support Group
-%% 2019-2021 LaTeX Project
+%% 2019-2022 LaTeX Project
%% https://github.com/latex3/hyperref/issues
-%%
+%%
%% This file is part of the `Hyperref Bundle'.
%% -------------------------------------------
-%%
+%%
%% This work may be distributed and/or modified under the
%% conditions of the LaTeX Project Public License, either version 1.3
%% of this license or (at your option) any later version.
@@ -24,16 +23,17 @@
%% http://www.latex-project.org/lppl.txt
%% and version 1.3 or later is part of all distributions of LaTeX
%% version 2005/12/01 or later.
-%%
+%%
%% This work has the LPPL maintenance status `maintained'.
-%%
+%%
%% The Current Maintainer of this work is the LaTeX Project.
-%%
+%%
%% The list of all files belonging to the `Hyperref Bundle' is
%% given in the file `manifest.txt'.
-%%
+%%
+%% File: hyperref.dtx
\ProvidesFile{htex4ht.cfg}
- [2022-02-21 v7.00n %
+ [2022-05-13 v7.00o %
Hyperref configuration file for TeX4ht]
\IfFileExists{\jobname.cfg}{\endinput}{}
\Preamble{html}
Modified: trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/htex4ht.def
===================================================================
--- trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/htex4ht.def 2022-05-14 20:31:45 UTC (rev 63297)
+++ trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/htex4ht.def 2022-05-14 20:32:17 UTC (rev 63298)
@@ -6,17 +6,16 @@
%%
%% hyperref.dtx (with options: `tex4ht')
%%
-%% File: hyperref.dtx
%% Copyright
%% 1995-2001 Sebastian Rahtz, with portions written by David Carlisle and Heiko Oberdiek,
%% 2001-2015 Heiko Oberdiek.
%% 2016-2019 Oberdiek Package Support Group
-%% 2019-2021 LaTeX Project
+%% 2019-2022 LaTeX Project
%% https://github.com/latex3/hyperref/issues
-%%
+%%
%% This file is part of the `Hyperref Bundle'.
%% -------------------------------------------
-%%
+%%
%% This work may be distributed and/or modified under the
%% conditions of the LaTeX Project Public License, either version 1.3
%% of this license or (at your option) any later version.
@@ -24,16 +23,17 @@
%% http://www.latex-project.org/lppl.txt
%% and version 1.3 or later is part of all distributions of LaTeX
%% version 2005/12/01 or later.
-%%
+%%
%% This work has the LPPL maintenance status `maintained'.
-%%
+%%
%% The Current Maintainer of this work is the LaTeX Project.
-%%
+%%
%% The list of all files belonging to the `Hyperref Bundle' is
%% given in the file `manifest.txt'.
-%%
+%%
+%% File: hyperref.dtx
\ProvidesFile{htex4ht.def}
- [2022-02-21 v7.00n %
+ [2022-05-13 v7.00o %
Hyperref driver for TeX4ht]
\Hy at VersionCheck{htex4ht.def}
\providecommand*{\XR at ext}{html}
Modified: trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/htexture.def
===================================================================
--- trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/htexture.def 2022-05-14 20:31:45 UTC (rev 63297)
+++ trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/htexture.def 2022-05-14 20:32:17 UTC (rev 63298)
@@ -6,17 +6,16 @@
%%
%% hyperref.dtx (with options: `textures')
%%
-%% File: hyperref.dtx
%% Copyright
%% 1995-2001 Sebastian Rahtz, with portions written by David Carlisle and Heiko Oberdiek,
%% 2001-2015 Heiko Oberdiek.
%% 2016-2019 Oberdiek Package Support Group
-%% 2019-2021 LaTeX Project
+%% 2019-2022 LaTeX Project
%% https://github.com/latex3/hyperref/issues
-%%
+%%
%% This file is part of the `Hyperref Bundle'.
%% -------------------------------------------
-%%
+%%
%% This work may be distributed and/or modified under the
%% conditions of the LaTeX Project Public License, either version 1.3
%% of this license or (at your option) any later version.
@@ -24,16 +23,17 @@
%% http://www.latex-project.org/lppl.txt
%% and version 1.3 or later is part of all distributions of LaTeX
%% version 2005/12/01 or later.
-%%
+%%
%% This work has the LPPL maintenance status `maintained'.
-%%
+%%
%% The Current Maintainer of this work is the LaTeX Project.
-%%
+%%
%% The list of all files belonging to the `Hyperref Bundle' is
%% given in the file `manifest.txt'.
-%%
+%%
+%% File: hyperref.dtx
\ProvidesFile{htexture.def}
- [2022-02-21 v7.00n %
+ [2022-05-13 v7.00o %
Hyperref driver for Textures]
\Hy at VersionCheck{htexture.def}
\providecommand*{\XR at ext}{pdf}
Modified: trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/hvtex.def
===================================================================
--- trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/hvtex.def 2022-05-14 20:31:45 UTC (rev 63297)
+++ trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/hvtex.def 2022-05-14 20:32:17 UTC (rev 63298)
@@ -6,17 +6,16 @@
%%
%% hyperref.dtx (with options: `vtex,outlines')
%%
-%% File: hyperref.dtx
%% Copyright
%% 1995-2001 Sebastian Rahtz, with portions written by David Carlisle and Heiko Oberdiek,
%% 2001-2015 Heiko Oberdiek.
%% 2016-2019 Oberdiek Package Support Group
-%% 2019-2021 LaTeX Project
+%% 2019-2022 LaTeX Project
%% https://github.com/latex3/hyperref/issues
-%%
+%%
%% This file is part of the `Hyperref Bundle'.
%% -------------------------------------------
-%%
+%%
%% This work may be distributed and/or modified under the
%% conditions of the LaTeX Project Public License, either version 1.3
%% of this license or (at your option) any later version.
@@ -24,16 +23,17 @@
%% http://www.latex-project.org/lppl.txt
%% and version 1.3 or later is part of all distributions of LaTeX
%% version 2005/12/01 or later.
-%%
+%%
%% This work has the LPPL maintenance status `maintained'.
-%%
+%%
%% The Current Maintainer of this work is the LaTeX Project.
-%%
+%%
%% The list of all files belonging to the `Hyperref Bundle' is
%% given in the file `manifest.txt'.
-%%
+%%
+%% File: hyperref.dtx
\ProvidesFile{hvtex.def}
- [2022-02-21 v7.00n %
+ [2022-05-13 v7.00o %
Hyperref driver for VTeX in PDF/PS mode]
\Hy at VersionCheck{hvtex.def}
\providecommand*{\XR at ext}{pdf}
@@ -911,6 +911,8 @@
\hss
}%
}
+\@ifundefined{hyper at nopatch@sectioning}
+{
\let\H at old@ssect\@ssect
\def\@ssect#1#2#3#4#5{%
\Hy at MakeCurrentHrefAuto{section*}%
@@ -996,6 +998,7 @@
\H at old@sect{#1}{#2}{#3}{#4}{#5}{#6}[{#7}]{#8}%
}%
}
+}{}
\expandafter\def\csname Parent-4\endcsname{}
\expandafter\def\csname Parent-3\endcsname{}
\expandafter\def\csname Parent-2\endcsname{}
@@ -1005,43 +1008,6 @@
\expandafter\def\csname Parent2\endcsname{}
\expandafter\def\csname Parent3\endcsname{}
\expandafter\def\csname Parent4\endcsname{}
-\def\Hy at tempa{%
- \def\@addchap[##1]##2{%
- \typeout{##2}%
- \if at twoside
- \@mkboth{##1}{}%
- \else
- \@mkboth{}{##1}%
- \fi
- \addtocontents{lof}{\protect\addvspace{10\p@}}%
- \addtocontents{lot}{\protect\addvspace{10\p@}}%
- \Hy at MakeCurrentHrefAuto{\Hy at chapapp*}%
- \Hy at raisedlink{%
- \hyper at anchorstart{\@currentHref}\hyper at anchorend
- }%
- \if at twocolumn
- \@topnewpage[\@makeschapterhead{##2}]%
- \else
- \@makeschapterhead{##2}%
- \@afterheading
- \fi
- \addcontentsline{toc}{chapter}{##1}%
- }%
-}
-\@ifclassloaded{scrbook}{%
- \@ifclasslater{scrbook}{2001/01/01}{%
- \let\Hy at tempa\@empty
- }{}%
-}{%
- \@ifclassloaded{scrreprt}{%
- \@ifclasslater{scrreprt}{2001/01/01}{%
- \let\Hy at tempa\@empty
- }{}%
- }{%
- \let\Hy at tempa\@empty
- }%
-}%
-\Hy at tempa
\endinput
%%
%% End of file `hvtex.def'.
Modified: trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/hvtexhtm.def
===================================================================
--- trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/hvtexhtm.def 2022-05-14 20:31:45 UTC (rev 63297)
+++ trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/hvtexhtm.def 2022-05-14 20:32:17 UTC (rev 63298)
@@ -6,17 +6,16 @@
%%
%% hyperref.dtx (with options: `vtexhtml')
%%
-%% File: hyperref.dtx
%% Copyright
%% 1995-2001 Sebastian Rahtz, with portions written by David Carlisle and Heiko Oberdiek,
%% 2001-2015 Heiko Oberdiek.
%% 2016-2019 Oberdiek Package Support Group
-%% 2019-2021 LaTeX Project
+%% 2019-2022 LaTeX Project
%% https://github.com/latex3/hyperref/issues
-%%
+%%
%% This file is part of the `Hyperref Bundle'.
%% -------------------------------------------
-%%
+%%
%% This work may be distributed and/or modified under the
%% conditions of the LaTeX Project Public License, either version 1.3
%% of this license or (at your option) any later version.
@@ -24,16 +23,17 @@
%% http://www.latex-project.org/lppl.txt
%% and version 1.3 or later is part of all distributions of LaTeX
%% version 2005/12/01 or later.
-%%
+%%
%% This work has the LPPL maintenance status `maintained'.
-%%
+%%
%% The Current Maintainer of this work is the LaTeX Project.
-%%
+%%
%% The list of all files belonging to the `Hyperref Bundle' is
%% given in the file `manifest.txt'.
-%%
+%%
+%% File: hyperref.dtx
\ProvidesFile{hvtexhtml.def}
- [2022-02-21 v7.00n %
+ [2022-05-13 v7.00o %
Hyperref driver for VTeX in HTML mode]
\Hy at VersionCheck{hvtexhtm.def}
\providecommand*{\XR at ext}{htm}
Modified: trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/hvtexmrk.def
===================================================================
--- trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/hvtexmrk.def 2022-05-14 20:31:45 UTC (rev 63297)
+++ trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/hvtexmrk.def 2022-05-14 20:32:17 UTC (rev 63298)
@@ -6,17 +6,16 @@
%%
%% hyperref.dtx (with options: `vtexpdfmark')
%%
-%% File: hyperref.dtx
%% Copyright
%% 1995-2001 Sebastian Rahtz, with portions written by David Carlisle and Heiko Oberdiek,
%% 2001-2015 Heiko Oberdiek.
%% 2016-2019 Oberdiek Package Support Group
-%% 2019-2021 LaTeX Project
+%% 2019-2022 LaTeX Project
%% https://github.com/latex3/hyperref/issues
-%%
+%%
%% This file is part of the `Hyperref Bundle'.
%% -------------------------------------------
-%%
+%%
%% This work may be distributed and/or modified under the
%% conditions of the LaTeX Project Public License, either version 1.3
%% of this license or (at your option) any later version.
@@ -24,16 +23,17 @@
%% http://www.latex-project.org/lppl.txt
%% and version 1.3 or later is part of all distributions of LaTeX
%% version 2005/12/01 or later.
-%%
+%%
%% This work has the LPPL maintenance status `maintained'.
-%%
+%%
%% The Current Maintainer of this work is the LaTeX Project.
-%%
+%%
%% The list of all files belonging to the `Hyperref Bundle' is
%% given in the file `manifest.txt'.
-%%
+%%
+%% File: hyperref.dtx
\ProvidesFile{hvtexmrk.def}
- [2022-02-21 v7.00n %
+ [2022-05-13 v7.00o %
Hyperref driver for VTeX in PDF/PS mode (pdfmark specials)]
\Hy at VersionCheck{hvtexmrk.def}
\providecommand*{\XR at ext}{pdf}
Modified: trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/hxetex.def
===================================================================
--- trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/hxetex.def 2022-05-14 20:31:45 UTC (rev 63297)
+++ trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/hxetex.def 2022-05-14 20:32:17 UTC (rev 63298)
@@ -6,17 +6,16 @@
%%
%% hyperref.dtx (with options: `xetex,pdfform,outlines')
%%
-%% File: hyperref.dtx
%% Copyright
%% 1995-2001 Sebastian Rahtz, with portions written by David Carlisle and Heiko Oberdiek,
%% 2001-2015 Heiko Oberdiek.
%% 2016-2019 Oberdiek Package Support Group
-%% 2019-2021 LaTeX Project
+%% 2019-2022 LaTeX Project
%% https://github.com/latex3/hyperref/issues
-%%
+%%
%% This file is part of the `Hyperref Bundle'.
%% -------------------------------------------
-%%
+%%
%% This work may be distributed and/or modified under the
%% conditions of the LaTeX Project Public License, either version 1.3
%% of this license or (at your option) any later version.
@@ -24,16 +23,17 @@
%% http://www.latex-project.org/lppl.txt
%% and version 1.3 or later is part of all distributions of LaTeX
%% version 2005/12/01 or later.
-%%
+%%
%% This work has the LPPL maintenance status `maintained'.
-%%
+%%
%% The Current Maintainer of this work is the LaTeX Project.
-%%
+%%
%% The list of all files belonging to the `Hyperref Bundle' is
%% given in the file `manifest.txt'.
-%%
+%%
+%% File: hyperref.dtx
\ProvidesFile{hxetex.def}
- [2022-02-21 v7.00n %
+ [2022-05-13 v7.00o %
Hyperref driver for XeTeX]
\Hy at VersionCheck{hxetex.def}
\HyPsd at LoadUnicode
@@ -1704,6 +1704,8 @@
\hss
}%
}
+\@ifundefined{hyper at nopatch@sectioning}
+{
\let\H at old@ssect\@ssect
\def\@ssect#1#2#3#4#5{%
\Hy at MakeCurrentHrefAuto{section*}%
@@ -1789,6 +1791,7 @@
\H at old@sect{#1}{#2}{#3}{#4}{#5}{#6}[{#7}]{#8}%
}%
}
+}{}
\expandafter\def\csname Parent-4\endcsname{}
\expandafter\def\csname Parent-3\endcsname{}
\expandafter\def\csname Parent-2\endcsname{}
@@ -1798,43 +1801,6 @@
\expandafter\def\csname Parent2\endcsname{}
\expandafter\def\csname Parent3\endcsname{}
\expandafter\def\csname Parent4\endcsname{}
-\def\Hy at tempa{%
- \def\@addchap[##1]##2{%
- \typeout{##2}%
- \if at twoside
- \@mkboth{##1}{}%
- \else
- \@mkboth{}{##1}%
- \fi
- \addtocontents{lof}{\protect\addvspace{10\p@}}%
- \addtocontents{lot}{\protect\addvspace{10\p@}}%
- \Hy at MakeCurrentHrefAuto{\Hy at chapapp*}%
- \Hy at raisedlink{%
- \hyper at anchorstart{\@currentHref}\hyper at anchorend
- }%
- \if at twocolumn
- \@topnewpage[\@makeschapterhead{##2}]%
- \else
- \@makeschapterhead{##2}%
- \@afterheading
- \fi
- \addcontentsline{toc}{chapter}{##1}%
- }%
-}
-\@ifclassloaded{scrbook}{%
- \@ifclasslater{scrbook}{2001/01/01}{%
- \let\Hy at tempa\@empty
- }{}%
-}{%
- \@ifclassloaded{scrreprt}{%
- \@ifclasslater{scrreprt}{2001/01/01}{%
- \let\Hy at tempa\@empty
- }{}%
- }{%
- \let\Hy at tempa\@empty
- }%
-}%
-\Hy at tempa
\endinput
%%
%% End of file `hxetex.def'.
Modified: trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/hyperref-patches.sty
===================================================================
--- trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/hyperref-patches.sty 2022-05-14 20:31:45 UTC (rev 63297)
+++ trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/hyperref-patches.sty 2022-05-14 20:32:17 UTC (rev 63298)
@@ -6,12 +6,37 @@
%%
%% hyperref-patches.dtx (with options: `package')
%%
+%% Copyright
+%% 1995-2001 Sebastian Rahtz, with portions written by David Carlisle and Heiko Oberdiek,
+%% 2001-2015 Heiko Oberdiek.
+%% 2016-2019 Oberdiek Package Support Group
+%% 2019-2022 LaTeX Project
+%% https://github.com/latex3/hyperref/issues
+%%
+%% This file is part of the `Hyperref Bundle'.
+%% -------------------------------------------
+%%
+%% This work may be distributed and/or modified under the
+%% conditions of the LaTeX Project Public License, either version 1.3
+%% of this license or (at your option) any later version.
+%% The latest version of this license is in
+%% http://www.latex-project.org/lppl.txt
+%% and version 1.3 or later is part of all distributions of LaTeX
+%% version 2005/12/01 or later.
+%%
+%% This work has the LPPL maintenance status `maintained'.
+%%
+%% The Current Maintainer of this work is the LaTeX Project.
+%%
+%% The list of all files belonging to the `Hyperref Bundle' is
+%% given in the file `manifest.txt'.
+%%
%% File: hyperref-patches.dtx
%% Copyright
%% 1995-2001 Sebastian Rahtz, with portions written by David Carlisle and Heiko Oberdiek,
%% 2001-2015 Heiko Oberdiek.
%% 2016-2019 Oberdiek Package Support Group
-%% 2019-2021 LaTeX Project
+%% 2019-2022 LaTeX Project
%% https://github.com/latex3/hyperref/issues
%%
%% This file is part of the `Hyperref Bundle'.
Modified: trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/hyperref.sty
===================================================================
--- trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/hyperref.sty 2022-05-14 20:31:45 UTC (rev 63297)
+++ trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/hyperref.sty 2022-05-14 20:32:17 UTC (rev 63298)
@@ -5,18 +5,19 @@
%% The original source files were:
%%
%% hyperref.dtx (with options: `package')
+%% hyperref-linktarget.dtx (with options: `package,package-include')
+%% hyperref.dtx (with options: `packageEnd')
%%
-%% File: hyperref.dtx
%% Copyright
%% 1995-2001 Sebastian Rahtz, with portions written by David Carlisle and Heiko Oberdiek,
%% 2001-2015 Heiko Oberdiek.
%% 2016-2019 Oberdiek Package Support Group
-%% 2019-2021 LaTeX Project
+%% 2019-2022 LaTeX Project
%% https://github.com/latex3/hyperref/issues
-%%
+%%
%% This file is part of the `Hyperref Bundle'.
%% -------------------------------------------
-%%
+%%
%% This work may be distributed and/or modified under the
%% conditions of the LaTeX Project Public License, either version 1.3
%% of this license or (at your option) any later version.
@@ -24,17 +25,18 @@
%% http://www.latex-project.org/lppl.txt
%% and version 1.3 or later is part of all distributions of LaTeX
%% version 2005/12/01 or later.
-%%
+%%
%% This work has the LPPL maintenance status `maintained'.
-%%
+%%
%% The Current Maintainer of this work is the LaTeX Project.
-%%
+%%
%% The list of all files belonging to the `Hyperref Bundle' is
%% given in the file `manifest.txt'.
-%%
-\NeedsTeXFormat{LaTeX2e}[1995/12/01]
+%%
+%% File: hyperref.dtx
+\NeedsTeXFormat{LaTeX2e}[2020/10/01]
\ProvidesPackage{hyperref}
- [2022-02-21 v7.00n %
+ [2022-05-13 v7.00o %
Hypertext links for LaTeX]
\begingroup
\@makeother\`%
@@ -343,6 +345,13 @@
\strip at pt\dimexpr 0.99626401\dimexpr(#1)\relax\relax
}%
\def\hypercalcbpdef{\def}%
+\ExplSyntaxOn
+\@ifundefined{text_uppercase:n}{}
+ {
+ \def\MakeUppercaseUnsupportedInPdfStrings#1{\use:e {\text_uppercase:n {#1}}}
+ \def\MakeLowercaseUnsupportedInPdfStrings#1{\use:e {\text_lowercase:n {#1}}}
+ }
+\ExplSyntaxOff
\def\pdfstringdef#1#2{%
\begingroup
\escapechar`\\%
@@ -2030,9 +2039,6 @@
\@namedef{HyPsd at ding@214}{\textleftrightarrow}%
\@namedef{HyPsd at ding@215}{\textupdownarrow}%
\@namedef{HyPsd at ding@240}{\HyPsd at UnicodeReplacementCharacter}
-\@ifclassloaded{memoir}{%
- \Hy at AtEndOfPackage{\RequirePackage{memhfixc}}%
-}{}
\@ifpackageloaded{subfigure}{%
\ltx at IfUndefined{sub at label}{%
\Hy at hypertexnamesfalse
@@ -2061,10 +2067,6 @@
\fi
\@esphack
}%
- \@ifpackagelater{subfigure}{2002/03/26}{}{%
- \providecommand*{\toclevel at subfigure}{1}%
- \providecommand*{\toclevel at subtable}{1}%
- }%
}%
}{}
\ltx at IfUndefined{XR at addURL}{%
@@ -2373,6 +2375,9 @@
\let\Hy at setbreaklinks\@gobble
}
\define at key{Hyp}{localanchorname}[true]{%
+ \Hy at WarningNoLine{%
+ Option `localanchorname' is deprecated%
+ }%
\Hy at boolkey{localanchorname}{#1}%
}
\define at key{Hyp}{pageanchor}[true]{%
@@ -4486,23 +4491,6 @@
\Hy at DisableOption{colorlinks}%
\Hy at DisableOption{frenchlinks}%
\ifHy at texht
- \long\def\@firstoffive#1#2#3#4#5{#1}%
- \long\def\@secondoffive#1#2#3#4#5{#2}%
- \long\def\@thirdoffive#1#2#3#4#5{#3}%
- \long\def\@fourthoffive#1#2#3#4#5{#4}%
- \long\def\@fifthoffive#1#2#3#4#5{#5}%
- \providecommand*\@safe at activestrue{}%
- \providecommand*\@safe at activesfalse{}%
- \def\T at ref#1{%
- \Hy at safe@activestrue
- \expandafter\@setref\csname r@#1\endcsname\@firstoffive{#1}%
- \Hy at safe@activesfalse
- }%
- \def\T at pageref#1{%
- \Hy at safe@activestrue
- \expandafter\@setref\csname r@#1\endcsname\@secondoffive{#1}%
- \Hy at safe@activesfalse
- }%
\else
\ifHy at typexml
\else
@@ -4510,25 +4498,30 @@
\RequirePackage{nameref}[2012/07/28]%
}%
\fi
+ \ifHy at implicit
+ \let \T at Ref\HyRef at Ref
+ \def\@refstar#1{%
+ \NR at ref@showkeys{#1}%
+ \HyRef at StarSetRef{#1}\@firstoffive
+ }
+ \def\@pagerefstar#1{%
+ \NR at ref@showkeys{#1}%
+ \HyRef at StarSetRef{#1}\@secondoffive
+ }
+ \def\@namerefstar#1{%
+ \NR at ref@showkeys{#1}%
+ \HyRef at StarSetRef{#1}\@thirdoffive
+ }
+ \def\@Refstar#1{%
+ \NR at ref@showkeys{#1}%
+ \HyRef at StarSetRef{#1}\HyRef at MakeUppercaseFirstOfFive
+ }%
+ \else
+ \fi
\fi
- \DeclareRobustCommand\ref{%
- \@ifstar\@refstar\T at ref
- }%
- \DeclareRobustCommand\pageref{%
- \@ifstar\@pagerefstar\T at pageref
- }%
- \DeclareRobustCommand*{\nameref}{%
- \@ifstar\@namerefstar\T at nameref
- }%
- \ifHy at implicit
- \else
- \let \@pagerefstar\T at pageref
- \let \@refstar\T at ref
- \let \@namerefstar\T at nameref
- \fi
}
\Hy at AtBeginDocument{%
- \ifHy at texht
+ \ifx\ReadBookmarks\relax
\else
\Hy at CatcodeWrapper\ReadBookmarks
\fi
@@ -6093,14 +6086,15 @@
\Hy at pdfstringfalse
}
-\LetLtxMacro\NoHy at OrgRef\ref
-\DeclareRobustCommand*{\ref}{%
+\@ifundefined{@kernel at ref}
+ {\LetLtxMacro\NoHy at OrgRef\ref
+ \DeclareRobustCommand*{\ref}{%
\@ifstar\NoHy at OrgRef\NoHy at OrgRef
-}
-\LetLtxMacro\NoHy at OrgPageRef\pageref
-\DeclareRobustCommand*{\pageref}{%
+ }
+ \LetLtxMacro\NoHy at OrgPageRef\pageref
+ \DeclareRobustCommand*{\pageref}{%
\@ifstar\NoHy at OrgPageRef\NoHy at OrgPageRef
-}
+ }}{}
\def\NoHyper{%
\def\hyper at link@[##1]##2##3##4{##4\Hy at xspace@end}%
\def\hyper@@anchor##1##2{##2\Hy at xspace@end}%
@@ -6143,11 +6137,6 @@
\string\AtBeginDocument}^^J%
\string\HyperFirstAtBeginDocument{%
\string\ifx\string\hyper at anchor\string\@undefined^^J%
- \string\global\string\let\string\oldcontentsline\string\contentsline^^J%
- \string\gdef\string\contentsline%
- \string#1\string#2\string#3\string#4{%
- \string\oldcontentsline%
- {\string#1}{\string#2}{\string#3}}^^J%
\string\global\string\let\string\oldnewlabel\string\newlabel^^J%
\string\gdef\string\newlabel\string#1\string#2{%
\string\newlabelxx{\string#1}\string#2}^^J%
@@ -6156,7 +6145,6 @@
\string\oldnewlabel{\string#1}{{\string#2}{\string#3}}}^^J%
\string\AtEndDocument{%
\string\ifx\string\hyper at anchor\string\@undefined^^J%
- \string\let\string\contentsline\string\oldcontentsline^^J%
\string\let\string\newlabel\string\oldnewlabel^^J%
\string\fi%
}^^J%
@@ -6168,22 +6156,6 @@
\fi
\let\HyperFirstAtBeginDocument\ltx at firstofone
\ifx\hyper at last\@undefined
- \def\@starttoc#1{%
- \begingroup
- \makeatletter
- \ltx at ifpackageloaded{parskip}{\parskip\z@}{}%
- \IfFileExists{\jobname.#1}{%
- \Hy at WarningNoLine{%
- old #1 file detected, not used; run LaTeX again%
- }%
- }{}%
- \if at filesw
- \expandafter\newwrite\csname tf@#1\endcsname
- \immediate\openout\csname tf@#1\endcsname \jobname.#1\relax
- \fi
- \@nobreakfalse
- \endgroup
- }%
\def\newlabel#1#2{\@newl at bel r{#1}{#2{}{}{}{}}}%
\fi
}
@@ -6451,6 +6423,120 @@
\g at addto@macro\Hy at EveryPageHook{\HyPL at EveryPage}%
\fi
\Hy at DisableOption{pdfpagelabels}
+%% File: hyperref-linktarget.dtx
+\ExplSyntaxOn
+\bool_new:N \l__hyp_target_create_bool
+\bool_set_true:N \l__hyp_target_create_bool
+\hook_new:n {makelinktarget}
+\cs_new_protected:Npn \__hyp_target_raise:n #1
+ {
+ \mode_if_vertical:TF
+ { #1 }
+ {
+ \Hy at SaveSpaceFactor
+ \penalty\@M
+ \smash
+ {
+ \box_move_up:nn
+ { \normalbaselineskip }
+ {
+ \hbox:n
+ {
+ \Hy at RestoreSpaceFactor
+ #1
+ \Hy at SaveSpaceFactor
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ \Hy at RestoreSpaceFactor
+ }
+ }
+\ProvideDocumentCommand\LinkTargetOn{}{}
+\ProvideDocumentCommand\LinkTargetOff{}{}
+\ProvideDocumentCommand\MakeLinkTarget{sO{}m}{}
+\ProvideDocumentCommand\NextLinkTarget{m}{}
+\RenewDocumentCommand\LinkTargetOn {}
+ {
+ \bool_set_true:N \l__hyp_target_create_bool
+ }
+
+\RenewDocumentCommand\LinkTargetOff {}
+ {
+ \bool_set_false:N \l__hyp_target_create_bool
+ }
+\RenewDocumentCommand\MakeLinkTarget {s O{} m}
+ {
+ \bool_if:NT \l__hyp_target_create_bool
+ {
+ \group_begin:
+ \hook_use:n { makelinktarget }
+ \IfBooleanTF {#1}
+ {
+ \__hyp_target_manual:nn {#2}{#3}
+ }
+ {
+ \__hyp_target_counter:nn {#2}{#3}
+ }
+ \group_end:
+ }
+ }
+\cs_new_protected:Npn \__hyp_target_manual:nn #1 #2 %#1 prefix, #2 name
+ {
+ \tl_gset:Nx \@currentHref {#2}
+ \hook_use:n {__hyp/target/setname}
+ \@onelevel at sanitize\@currentHref
+ \__hyp_target_raise:n {\hyper at anchorstart{\@currentHref}\hyper at anchorend}
+ }
+\cs_new_protected:Npn \__hyp_target_counter:nn #1 #2 %#1 prefix, #2 counter or empty
+ {
+ \tl_if_blank:nTF {#2}
+ {
+ \__hyp_target_counter_anon:n {#1}
+ }
+ {
+ \__hyp_target_counter_doc:nn {#1}{#2}
+ }
+ }
+
+\cs_new_protected:Npn \__hyp_target_counter_anon:n #1
+ {
+ \int_gincr:N\Hy at linkcounter
+ \tl_gset:Nx \@currentHref
+ {\tl_if_blank:nTF{#1}{page}{#1}*.\int_use:N\Hy at linkcounter}
+ \hook_use:n {__hyp/target/setname}
+ \@onelevel at sanitize\@currentHref
+ \__hyp_target_raise:n {\hyper at anchorstart{\@currentHref}\hyper at anchorend}
+ }
+
+\cs_new_protected:Npn \__hyp_target_counter_doc:nn #1 #2
+ {
+ \bool_lazy_and:nnTF { \cs_if_free_p:c {c@#2} } { \cs_if_free_p:c {theH#2} }
+ {
+ \PackageWarning {hyperref}{Counter~'#2'~or~the~representation~'\string\theH#2`\MessageBreak
+ don't~exist.~No~target~created.}{}
+ }
+ {
+ \tl_gset:Nx \@currentHref {\tl_if_blank:nTF{#1}{#2}{#1}.\use:c{theH#2}}
+ \hook_use:n {__hyp/target/setname}
+ \@onelevel at sanitize\@currentHref
+ \__hyp_target_raise:n {\hyper at anchorstart{\@currentHref}\hyper at anchorend}
+ }
+ }
+\RenewDocumentCommand\NextLinkTarget {m}
+ {
+ \hook_gput_next_code:nn {__hyp/target/setname}
+ {
+ \tl_gset:Nx \@currentHref {#1}
+ }
+ }
+
+\NewDocumentCommand\SetLinkTargetFilter {m}
+ {
+ \cs_set:Npn \HyperDestNameFilter ##1 {#1}
+ }
+\@onlypreamble \SetLinkTargetFilter
+\ExplSyntaxOff
+%% File: hyperref.dtx
\ifx\MaybeStopEarly\relax
\else
\Hy at stoppedearlytrue
@@ -6473,6 +6559,7 @@
\Hy at CounterExists{section}{%
\providecommand\theHequation{\theHsection.\arabic{equation}}%
}
+\providecommand\theHequation{\arabic{equation}}%
\Hy at CounterExists{part}{%
\providecommand\theHpart{\arabic{part}}%
}
@@ -6511,31 +6598,32 @@
}{}
\let\H at refstepcounter\refstepcounter
\edef\name at of@eq{equation}%
-\edef\name at of@slide{slide}%
\newif\if at hyper@item
\newif\if at skiphyperref
\@hyper at itemfalse
\@skiphyperreffalse
+\ExplSyntaxOn
\def\refstepcounter#1{%
- \ifHy at pdfstring
- \else
+ \legacy_if:nF {Hy at pdfstring}
+ {
\H at refstepcounter{#1}%
- \edef\This at name{#1}%
- \ifx\This at name\name at of@slide
- \else
- \if at skiphyperref
- \else
- \if at hyper@item
- \stepcounter{Item}%
- \hyper at refstepcounter{Item}%
- \@hyper at itemfalse
- \else
- \hyper at refstepcounter{#1}%
- \fi
- \fi
- \fi
- \fi
+ \bool_lazy_and:nnT
+ { \l__hyp_target_create_bool }
+ { ! \legacy_if_p:n{@skiphyperref} }
+ {
+ \legacy_if:nTF {@hyper at item}
+ {
+ \stepcounter{Item}%
+ \hyper at refstepcounter{Item}%
+ \@hyper at itemfalse
+ }
+ {
+ \hyper at refstepcounter{#1}%
+ }
+ }
+ }
}
+\ExplSyntaxOff
\let\Hy at saved@refstepcounter\refstepcounter
\@ifpackageloaded{amsmath}{}{\newif\ifmeasuring@\measuring at false}
\def\hyper at refstepcounter#1{%
@@ -6647,19 +6735,11 @@
\@ctrerr
\fi
}
-\@ifl at t@r\fmtversion{2020-10-01}
- {%
- \NewHook{__hyp/dest/make }
- \def\hyper at hook@dest at make
- {\UseHook{__hyp/dest/make}}
- \define at key{Hyp}{next-anchor}{%
- \AddToHookNext{__hyp/dest/make}%
+\NewHook{__hyp/target/setname }
+\define at key{Hyp}{next-anchor}{%
+ \AddToHookNext{__hyp/target/setname}%
{\Hy at MakeCurrentHref{#1}}%
}
- }
- {
- \def\hyper at hook@dest at make{}
- }
\def\hyper at makecurrent#1{%
\begingroup
\Hy at safe@activestrue
@@ -6705,7 +6785,7 @@
\else
\global\let\@currentHref\HyperGlobalCurrentHref
\fi
- \hyper at hook@dest at make
+ \UseHook{__hyp/target/setname}%
}
\def\Hy at MakeCurrentHref#1{%
\edef\HyperLocalCurrentHref{#1}%
@@ -6721,7 +6801,7 @@
\def\Hy at MakeCurrentHrefAuto#1{%
\Hy at GlobalStepCount\Hy at linkcounter
\Hy at MakeCurrentHref{#1.\the\Hy at linkcounter}%
- \hyper at hook@dest at make}
+ \UseHook{__hyp/target/setname}}
\def\@currentHlabel{\@currentHref}
\def\hypergetref#1{\getrefbykeydefault{#1}{}{??}}
\def\hypergetpageref#1{\getrefbykeydefault{#1}{page}{0}}
@@ -6758,17 +6838,21 @@
\let\Hy at raisedlink\ttl at b
}%
}{}
-\AtBeginDocument{%
-\def\Hy at varioref@undefined{{??}{??}{}{}{}}
-\@ifpackageloaded{varioref}{%
- \def\vref at pagenum#1#2{%
- \@ifundefined{r@#2}{%
- \expandafter\let\csname r@#2\endcsname\Hy at varioref@undefined
- }{}%
- \edef#1{\getpagerefnumber{#2}}%
- }%
-}{}
-}
+\@ifl at t@r\fmtversion{2021-11-15}
+ {}%
+ {
+ \AtBeginDocument{%
+ \def\Hy at varioref@undefined{{??}{??}{}{}{}}
+ \@ifpackageloaded{varioref}{%
+ \def\vref at pagenum#1#2{%
+ \@ifundefined{r@#2}{%
+ \expandafter\let\csname r@#2\endcsname\Hy at varioref@undefined
+ }{}%
+ \edef#1{\getpagerefnumber{#2}}%
+ }%
+ }{}
+ }
+ }
\@ifpackageloaded{longtable}{%
\begingroup
\def\y{\LT at array}%
@@ -7062,6 +7146,7 @@
}%
}%
}
+\@ifundefined{hyper at nopatch@footnote}{%
\ifHy at hyperfootnotes
\newcounter{Hfootnote}%
\let\H@@footnotetext\@footnotetext
@@ -7263,13 +7348,14 @@
\fi
}%
\def\realfootnote{%
- \@ifnextchar[\@xfootnote{%
- \stepcounter{\@mpfn}%
+ \@ifnextchar[\@xfootnote%]
+ {\stepcounter{\@mpfn}%
\protected at xdef\@thefnmark{\thempfn}%
\H@@footnotemark\H@@footnotetext
}%
}%
\fi
+}{}
\Hy at DisableOption{hyperfootnotes}
\def\caption{%
\ifx\@captype\@undefined
@@ -7780,28 +7866,20 @@
}%
}
\@ifpackageloaded{amsmath}{%
- \@ifpackagelater{amsmath}{1999/12/14}{%
- \renewcommand*{\numberwithin}[3][\arabic]{%
- \@ifundefined{c@#2}{\@nocounterr{#2}}{%
- \@ifundefined{c@#3}{\@nocnterr{#3}}{%
- \HyOrg at addtoreset{#2}{#3}%
- \@xp\xdef\csname the#2\endcsname{%
- \@xp\@nx\csname the#3\endcsname .\@nx#1{#2}%
- }%
- \@xp\xdef\csname theH#2\endcsname{%
- \@xp\@nx
- \csname the\@ifundefined{theH#3}{}H#3\endcsname
- .\@nx#1{#2}%
- }%
+ \renewcommand*{\numberwithin}[3][\arabic]{%
+ \@ifundefined{c@#2}{\@nocounterr{#2}}{%
+ \@ifundefined{c@#3}{\@nocnterr{#3}}{%
+ \HyOrg at addtoreset{#2}{#3}%
+ \@xp\xdef\csname the#2\endcsname{%
+ \@xp\@nx\csname the#3\endcsname .\@nx#1{#2}%
}%
+ \@xp\xdef\csname theH#2\endcsname{%
+ \@xp\@nx
+ \csname the\@ifundefined{theH#3}{}H#3\endcsname
+ .\@nx#1{#2}%
+ }%
}%
}%
- }{%
- \Hy at WarningNoLine{%
- \string\numberwithin\space of package `amsmath' %
- only fixed\MessageBreak
- for version 2000/06/06 v2.12 or newer%
- }%
}%
}{}
\ifHy at hyperfigures
@@ -8053,22 +8131,19 @@
\def\@namerefstar#1{%
\HyRef at StarSetRef{#1}\@thirdoffive
}
-
+\def\@Refstar#1{%
+ \HyRef at StarSetRef{#1}\HyRef at MakeUppercaseFirstOfFive
+}%
+\def\HyRef at MakeUppercaseFirstOfFive#1#2#3#4#5{%
+ \MakeUppercase#1%
+}%
+\def\HyRef at Ref#1{%
+ \hyperref[{#1}]{\Ref*{#1}}%
+}%
\Hy at AtBeginDocument{%
\@ifpackageloaded{varioref}{%
- \def\@Refstar#1{%
- \HyRef at StarSetRef{#1}\HyRef at MakeUppercaseFirstOfFive
- }%
- \def\HyRef at MakeUppercaseFirstOfFive#1#2#3#4#5{%
- \MakeUppercase#1%
- }%
- \DeclareRobustCommand*{\Ref}{%
- \@ifstar\@Refstar\HyRef at Ref
- }%
- \def\HyRef at Ref#1{%
- \hyperref[{#1}]{\Ref*{#1}}%
- }%
- \ifdefined\vp at gerefstar
+ \@ifundefined{hyper at nopatch@varioref}
+ {
\renewcommand\Vref at star[2][]{%
\begingroup
\let\T at pageref\@pagerefstar
@@ -8101,29 +8176,9 @@
\vpageref[#1]{#2}%
\endgroup
}%
- \else
- \def\Vr at f#1{%
- \leavevmode\unskip\vref at space
- \hyperref[{#1}]{%
- \Ref*{#1}%
- \let\vref at space\nobreakspace
- \@vpageref[\unskip]{#1}%
- }%
- }%
- \def\vr at f#1{%
- \leavevmode\unskip\vref at space
- \begingroup
- \let\T at pageref\@pagerefstar
- \hyperref[{#1}]{%
- \ref*{#1}%
- \vpageref[\unskip]{#1}%
- }%
- \endgroup
- }%
- \fi
+ }{}%
}{}%
}
-
\DeclareRobustCommand*{\autopageref}{%
\@ifstar{%
\HyRef at autopagerefname\pageref*%
@@ -8143,10 +8198,9 @@
\pageautorefname\nobreakspace
}%
}
-\DeclareRobustCommand*{\autoref}{%
- \leavevmode
- \@ifstar{\HyRef at autoref\@gobbletwo}{\HyRef at autoref\hyper@@link}%
-}
+\NewDocumentCommand\autoref{s}
+ {\leavevmode
+ \IfBooleanTF{#1}{\HyRef at autoref\@gobbletwo}{\HyRef at autoref\hyper@@link}}
\def\HyRef at autoref#1#2{%
\begingroup
\Hy at safe@activestrue
@@ -8224,9 +8278,7 @@
\def\HyRef at currentHtag{}
\let\HyRef at ShowKeysRef\@gobble
\def\HyRef at ShowKeysInit{%
- \begingroup\expandafter\expandafter\expandafter\endgroup
- \expandafter\ifx\csname SK@@label\endcsname\relax
- \else
+ \ifcsname SK@@label\endcsname
\ifx\SK at ref\@empty
\else
\def\HyRef at ShowKeysRef{%
Modified: trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/hypertex.def
===================================================================
--- trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/hypertex.def 2022-05-14 20:31:45 UTC (rev 63297)
+++ trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/hypertex.def 2022-05-14 20:32:17 UTC (rev 63298)
@@ -6,17 +6,16 @@
%%
%% hyperref.dtx (with options: `hypertex')
%%
-%% File: hyperref.dtx
%% Copyright
%% 1995-2001 Sebastian Rahtz, with portions written by David Carlisle and Heiko Oberdiek,
%% 2001-2015 Heiko Oberdiek.
%% 2016-2019 Oberdiek Package Support Group
-%% 2019-2021 LaTeX Project
+%% 2019-2022 LaTeX Project
%% https://github.com/latex3/hyperref/issues
-%%
+%%
%% This file is part of the `Hyperref Bundle'.
%% -------------------------------------------
-%%
+%%
%% This work may be distributed and/or modified under the
%% conditions of the LaTeX Project Public License, either version 1.3
%% of this license or (at your option) any later version.
@@ -24,16 +23,17 @@
%% http://www.latex-project.org/lppl.txt
%% and version 1.3 or later is part of all distributions of LaTeX
%% version 2005/12/01 or later.
-%%
+%%
%% This work has the LPPL maintenance status `maintained'.
-%%
+%%
%% The Current Maintainer of this work is the LaTeX Project.
-%%
+%%
%% The list of all files belonging to the `Hyperref Bundle' is
%% given in the file `manifest.txt'.
-%%
+%%
+%% File: hyperref.dtx
\ProvidesFile{hypertex.def}
- [2022-02-21 v7.00n %
+ [2022-05-13 v7.00o %
Hyperref driver for HyperTeX specials]
\Hy at VersionCheck{hypertex.def}
\providecommand*{\XR at ext}{dvi}
@@ -178,6 +178,8 @@
\hss
}%
}
+\@ifundefined{hyper at nopatch@sectioning}
+{
\let\H at old@ssect\@ssect
\def\@ssect#1#2#3#4#5{%
\Hy at MakeCurrentHrefAuto{section*}%
@@ -263,43 +265,7 @@
\H at old@sect{#1}{#2}{#3}{#4}{#5}{#6}[{#7}]{#8}%
}%
}
-\def\Hy at tempa{%
- \def\@addchap[##1]##2{%
- \typeout{##2}%
- \if at twoside
- \@mkboth{##1}{}%
- \else
- \@mkboth{}{##1}%
- \fi
- \addtocontents{lof}{\protect\addvspace{10\p@}}%
- \addtocontents{lot}{\protect\addvspace{10\p@}}%
- \Hy at MakeCurrentHrefAuto{\Hy at chapapp*}%
- \Hy at raisedlink{%
- \hyper at anchorstart{\@currentHref}\hyper at anchorend
- }%
- \if at twocolumn
- \@topnewpage[\@makeschapterhead{##2}]%
- \else
- \@makeschapterhead{##2}%
- \@afterheading
- \fi
- \addcontentsline{toc}{chapter}{##1}%
- }%
-}
-\@ifclassloaded{scrbook}{%
- \@ifclasslater{scrbook}{2001/01/01}{%
- \let\Hy at tempa\@empty
- }{}%
-}{%
- \@ifclassloaded{scrreprt}{%
- \@ifclasslater{scrreprt}{2001/01/01}{%
- \let\Hy at tempa\@empty
- }{}%
- }{%
- \let\Hy at tempa\@empty
- }%
-}%
-\Hy at tempa
+}{}
\endinput
%%
%% End of file `hypertex.def'.
Modified: trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/nameref.sty
===================================================================
--- trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/nameref.sty 2022-05-14 20:31:45 UTC (rev 63297)
+++ trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/nameref.sty 2022-05-14 20:32:17 UTC (rev 63298)
@@ -6,12 +6,37 @@
%%
%% nameref.dtx (with options: `package')
%%
+%% Copyright
+%% 1995-2001 Sebastian Rahtz, with portions written by David Carlisle and Heiko Oberdiek,
+%% 2001-2015 Heiko Oberdiek.
+%% 2016-2019 Oberdiek Package Support Group
+%% 2019-2022 LaTeX Project
+%% https://github.com/latex3/hyperref/issues
+%%
+%% This file is part of the `Hyperref Bundle'.
+%% -------------------------------------------
+%%
+%% This work may be distributed and/or modified under the
+%% conditions of the LaTeX Project Public License, either version 1.3
+%% of this license or (at your option) any later version.
+%% The latest version of this license is in
+%% http://www.latex-project.org/lppl.txt
+%% and version 1.3 or later is part of all distributions of LaTeX
+%% version 2005/12/01 or later.
+%%
+%% This work has the LPPL maintenance status `maintained'.
+%%
+%% The Current Maintainer of this work is the LaTeX Project.
+%%
+%% The list of all files belonging to the `Hyperref Bundle' is
+%% given in the file `manifest.txt'.
+%%
%% File: nameref.dtx
%% Copyright (C) 1995-1999 Sebastian Rahtz
%% 2000 Sebastian Rahtz, Heiko Oberdiek
%% 2001-2012 Heiko Oberdiek
%% 2016-2019 Oberdiek Package Suport Group
-%% 2019-2021 The LaTeX Project
+%% 2019-2022 The LaTeX Project
%% https://github.com/latex3/hyperref/issues
%%
%% This file is part of the `Hyperref Bundle'.
@@ -33,7 +58,7 @@
%% given in the file `manifest.txt'.
\NeedsTeXFormat{LaTeX2e}
\ProvidesPackage{nameref}
- [2021-04-02 v2.47 Cross-referencing by name of section]%
+ [2022-05-13 v2.48 Cross-referencing by name of section]%
\RequirePackage{refcount}[2006/02/12]
\RequirePackage{gettitlestring}[2009/12/18]
\RequirePackage{ltxcmds}[2009/12/12]
@@ -139,145 +164,161 @@
}
\let\NR at sect\@sect
\newcounter{section at level}
-\def\@sect#1#2#3#4#5#6[#7]#8{%
- \setcounter{section at level}{#2}%
- \NR at gettitle{#7}%
- \NR at sect{#1}{#2}{#3}{#4}{#5}{#6}[{#7}]{\Sectionformat{#8}{#2}}%
-}
+\@ifundefined{NR at nopatch@sectioning}
+ {\def\@sect#1#2#3#4#5#6[#7]#8{%
+ \setcounter{section at level}{#2}%
+ \NR at gettitle{#7}%
+ \NR at sect{#1}{#2}{#3}{#4}{#5}{#6}[{#7}]{\Sectionformat{#8}{#2}}%
+ }}{}
\let\NR at ssect\@ssect
-\def\@ssect#1#2#3#4#5{%
- \NR at gettitle{#5}%
- \NR at ssect{#1}{#2}{#3}{#4}{\Sectionformat{#5}{#1}}%
-}
-\ltx at IfUndefined{ifheadnameref}{%
-}{%
- \ltx at IfUndefined{M at sect}{%
+\@ifundefined{NR at nopatch@sectioning}
+ {\def\@ssect#1#2#3#4#5{%
+ \NR at gettitle{#5}%
+ \NR at ssect{#1}{#2}{#3}{#4}{\Sectionformat{#5}{#1}}%
+ }}{}
+\@ifundefined{NR at nopatch@sectioning}
+ {\ltx at IfUndefined{ifheadnameref}{%
}{%
- \let\NRorg at M@sect\M at sect
- \def\M at sect#1#2#3#4#5#6[#7][#8]{%
- \ifheadnameref
- \NR at gettitle{#8}%
- \else
- \NR at gettitle{#7}%
- \fi
- \NRorg at M@sect{#1}{#2}{#3}{#4}{#5}{#6}[{#7}][{#8}]%
+ \ltx at IfUndefined{M at sect}{%
+ }{%
+ \let\NRorg at M@sect\M at sect
+ \def\M at sect#1#2#3#4#5#6[#7][#8]{%
+ \ifheadnameref
+ \NR at gettitle{#8}%
+ \else
+ \NR at gettitle{#7}%
+ \fi
+ \NRorg at M@sect{#1}{#2}{#3}{#4}{#5}{#6}[{#7}][{#8}]%
+ }%
}%
- }%
-}
+ }}{}
\let\NR at part\@part
-\long\def\@part[#1]#2{%
- \NR at gettitle{#1}%
- \NR at part[{#1}]{#2}%
-}
\let\NR at spart\@spart
-\long\def\@spart#1{%
- \NR at gettitle{#1}%
- \NR at spart{#1}%
-}
\let\NR at chapter\@chapter
-\def\@chapter[#1]#2{%
- \NR at gettitle{#1}%
- \NR at chapter[{#1}]{#2}%
-}
-\@ifclassloaded{memoir}{%
- \ltx at IfUndefined{ifheadnameref}{%
- }{%
- \def\@chapter[#1]#2{%
- \ltx at IfUndefined{ch at pt@c}{%
- \NR at gettitle{#1}%
- }{%
- \ifx\ch at pt@c\ltx at empty
- \NR at gettitle{#2}%
- \else
- \def\NR at temp{#1}%
- \ifx\NR at temp\ltx at empty
- \expandafter\NR at gettitle\expandafter{\ch at pt@c}%
+\let\NR at schapter\@schapter
+\@ifundefined{NR at nopatch@sectioning}
+ {%
+ \long\def\@part[#1]#2{%
+ \NR at gettitle{#1}%
+ \NR at part[{#1}]{#2}%
+ }
+ \long\def\@spart#1{%
+ \NR at gettitle{#1}%
+ \NR at spart{#1}%
+ }
+ \def\@chapter[#1]#2{%
+ \NR at gettitle{#1}%
+ \NR at chapter[{#1}]{#2}%
+ }
+ \@ifclassloaded{memoir}{%
+ \ltx at IfUndefined{ifheadnameref}{%
+ }{%
+ \def\@chapter[#1]#2{%
+ \ltx at IfUndefined{ch at pt@c}{%
+ \NR at gettitle{#1}%
+ }{%
+ \ifx\ch at pt@c\ltx at empty
+ \NR at gettitle{#2}%
\else
- \ifheadnameref
- \NR at gettitle{#1}%
+ \def\NR at temp{#1}%
+ \ifx\NR at temp\ltx at empty
+ \expandafter\NR at gettitle\expandafter{\ch at pt@c}%
\else
- \expandafter\NR at gettitle\expandafter{\ch at pt@c}%
+ \ifheadnameref
+ \NR at gettitle{#1}%
+ \else
+ \expandafter\NR at gettitle\expandafter{\ch at pt@c}%
+ \fi
\fi
\fi
- \fi
+ }%
+ \NR at chapter[{#1}]{#2}%
}%
- \NR at chapter[{#1}]{#2}%
}%
- }%
-}{}
-\let\NR at schapter\@schapter
-\def\@schapter#1{%
- \NR at gettitle{#1}%
- \NR at schapter{#1}%
-}
+ }{}
+ \def\@schapter#1{%
+ \NR at gettitle{#1}%
+ \NR at schapter{#1}%
+ }}{}
\AtBeginDocument{%
- \@ifpackageloaded{hyperref}{%
- \@ifpackagelater{hyperref}{2009/12/05}\@gobble\@firstofone
- }\@firstofone
+ \@ifpackageloaded{hyperref}{}
{%
- \let\NR@@caption\@caption
- \long\def\@caption#1[#2]{%
+ \@ifundefined{NR at nopatch@caption}
+ {\let\NR@@caption\@caption
+ \long\def\@caption#1[#2]{%
\NR at gettitle{#2}%
\NR@@caption{#1}[{#2}]%
- }%
+ }}%
+ {}%
}%
\@ifpackageloaded{longtable}{%
- \let\NRorg at LT@c at ption\LT at c@ption
- \def\LT at c@ption#1[#2]#3{%
- \NRorg at LT@c at ption{#1}[{#2}]{#3}%
- \def\@tempa{#2}%
- \ifx\@tempa\@empty
- \else
+ \@ifundefined{NR at nopatch@longtable}
+ {%
+ \let\NRorg at LT@c at ption\LT at c@ption
+ \def\LT at c@ption#1[#2]#3{%
+ \NRorg at LT@c at ption{#1}[{#2}]{#3}%
+ \def\@tempa{#2}%
+ \ifx\@tempa\@empty
+ \else
\NR at gettitle{#2}%
- \fi
- }%
+ \fi
+ }%
+ }{}%
}{}%
\ltx at IfUndefined{descriptionlabel}{%
}{%
- \let\NRorg at descriptionlabel\descriptionlabel
- \def\descriptionlabel#1{%
- \NR at gettitle{#1}%
- \NRorg at descriptionlabel{#1}%
- }%
+ \@ifundefined{NR at nopatch@longtable}
+ {\let\NRorg at descriptionlabel\descriptionlabel
+ \def\descriptionlabel#1{%
+ \NR at gettitle{#1}%
+ \NRorg at descriptionlabel{#1}%
+ }%
+ }{}%
}%
}
\AtBeginDocument{%
\@ifpackageloaded{titlesec}{%
\let\NRorg at ttl@sect at i\ttl at sect@i
- \def\ttl at sect@i#1#2[#3]#4{%
- \NR at gettitle{#4}%
- \NRorg at ttl@sect at i{#1}{#2}[{#3}]{#4}%
- }%
+ \@ifundefined{NR at nopatch@titlesec}
+ {%
+ \def\ttl at sect@i#1#2[#3]#4{%
+ \NR at gettitle{#4}%
+ \NRorg at ttl@sect at i{#1}{#2}[{#3}]{#4}%
+ }%
+ }{}%
}{}%
}
\@ifclassloaded{beamer}{%
- \def\NR at PatchBeamer#1{%
- \expandafter\let\csname NRorg at beamer@#1\expandafter\endcsname
- \csname beamer@#1\endcsname
- \begingroup
- \edef\x{\endgroup
- \long\def\expandafter\noexpand\csname beamer@#1\endcsname
- [####1]{% hash-ok
- \noexpand\NR at gettitle{####1}%
- \expandafter\noexpand\csname NRorg at beamer@#1\endcsname
- [{####1}]%
+ \@ifundefined{NR at nopatch@beamer}
+ {%
+ \def\NR at PatchBeamer#1{%
+ \expandafter\let\csname NRorg at beamer@#1\expandafter\endcsname
+ \csname beamer@#1\endcsname
+ \begingroup
+ \edef\x{\endgroup
+ \long\def\expandafter\noexpand\csname beamer@#1\endcsname
+ [####1]{% hash-ok
+ \noexpand\NR at gettitle{####1}%
+ \expandafter\noexpand\csname NRorg at beamer@#1\endcsname
+ [{####1}]%
+ }%
}%
+ \x
+ }%
+ \NR at PatchBeamer{section}%
+ \NR at PatchBeamer{subsection}%
+ \NR at PatchBeamer{subsubsection}%
+ \addtobeamertemplate{theorem begin}{%
+ \expandafter\NR at gettitle\expandafter{\inserttheoremaddition}%
+ }{}%
+ \@ifdefinable{\NRorg at beamer@descriptionitem}{%
+ \let\NRorg at beamer@descriptionitem\beamer at descriptionitem
+ \renewcommand{\beamer at descriptionitem}[1]{%
+ \NR at gettitle{#1}%
+ \NRorg at beamer@descriptionitem{#1}%
}%
- \x
- }%
- \NR at PatchBeamer{section}%
- \NR at PatchBeamer{subsection}%
- \NR at PatchBeamer{subsubsection}%
- \addtobeamertemplate{theorem begin}{%
- \expandafter\NR at gettitle\expandafter{\inserttheoremaddition}%
- }{}%
- \@ifdefinable{\NRorg at beamer@descriptionitem}{%
- \let\NRorg at beamer@descriptionitem\beamer at descriptionitem
- \renewcommand{\beamer at descriptionitem}[1]{%
- \NR at gettitle{#1}%
- \NRorg at beamer@descriptionitem{#1}%
}%
- }%
+ }{}%
}{}
\ltx at IfUndefined{@opargbegintheorem}{}{%
\let\NRorg at opargbegintheorem\@opargbegintheorem
@@ -313,6 +354,7 @@
\long\def\@fifthoffive#1#2#3#4#5{#5}
\providecommand*\@safe at activestrue{}%
\providecommand*\@safe at activesfalse{}%
+\newcommand\NR at ref@showkeys[1]{}%
\def\NR at setref#1{%
\begingroup
\@safe at activestrue
@@ -327,162 +369,88 @@
\@setref#1%
}
\def\T at ref#1{%
+ \NR at ref@showkeys{#1}%
\NR at setref{#1}\@firstoffive{#1}%
}%
+\def\@refstar#1{%
+ \NR at ref@showkeys{#1}%
+ \NR at setref{#1}\@firstoffive{#1}%
+}%
\def\T at pageref#1{%
+ \NR at ref@showkeys{#1}%
\NR at setref{#1}\@secondoffive{#1}%
}%
+\def\@pagerefstar#1{%
+ \NR at ref@showkeys{#1}%
+ \NR at setref{#1}\@secondoffive{#1}%
+}%
+\def\T at Ref#1{%
+ \NR at ref@showkeys{#1}%
+ \NR at setref{#1}\NR at MakeUppercaseFirstOfFive{#1}%
+ }%
+\def\NR at MakeUppercaseFirstOfFive#1#2#3#4#5{%
+ \MakeUppercase#1%
+ }%
+\def\@Refstar#1{%
+ \NR at ref@showkeys{#1}%
+ \NR at setref{#1}\NR at MakeUppercaseFirstOfFive{#1}%
+ }%
\ifNR at showkeys
\ifx\SK at ref\@empty
\else
- \def\T at ref#1{%
- \@safe at activestrue
- \SK@\SK@@ref{#1}%
- \@safe at activesfalse
- \NR at setref{#1}\@firstoffive{#1}%
- }%
- \def\T at pageref#1{%
- \@safe at activestrue
- \SK@\SK@@ref{#1}%
- \@safe at activesfalse
- \NR at setref{#1}\@secondoffive{#1}%
- }%
+ \renewcommand\NR at ref@showkeys[1]{%
+ \@safe at activestrue
+ \SK@\SK@@ref{#1}%
+ \@safe at activesfalse}
\fi
\fi
-\@ifpackageloaded{hyperref}{%
-}{%
- \DeclareRobustCommand{\ref}{\T at ref}%
- \DeclareRobustCommand{\pageref}{\T at pageref}%
+\AddToHook{begindocument}{%
+ \DeclareDocumentCommand\ref{s}
+ {\IfBooleanTF{#1}{\@refstar}{\T at ref}}%
+ \DeclareDocumentCommand\pageref{s}
+ {\IfBooleanTF{#1}{\@pagerefstar}{\T at pageref}}%
+ \DeclareDocumentCommand\Ref{s}
+ {\IfBooleanTF{#1}{\@Refstar}{\T at Ref}}%
}
+\DeclareHookRule{begindocument}{showkeys}{before}{nameref}
\def\T at nameref#1{%
+ \NR at ref@showkeys{#1}%
\begingroup
\let\label\@gobble
\NR at setref{#1}\@thirdoffive{#1}%
\endgroup
}%
-\ifNR at showkeys
- \ifx\SK at ref\@empty
- \else
- \def\T at nameref#1{%
- \@safe at activestrue
- \SK@\SK@@ref{#1}%
- \@safe at activesfalse
- \begingroup
- \let\label\@gobble
- \NR at setref{#1}\@thirdoffive{#1}%
- \endgroup
- }%
- \fi
-\fi
- \DeclareRobustCommand*{\nameref}{%
- \@ifstar\T at nameref\T at nameref
- }%
+\def\@namerefstar#1{%
+ \NR at ref@showkeys{#1}%
+ \begingroup
+ \let\label\@gobble
+ \NR at setref{#1}\@thirdoffive{#1}%
+ \endgroup
+}%
+\NewDocumentCommand\nameref{s}
+ {\IfBooleanTF{#1}{\@namerefstar}{\T at nameref}}
\def\Nameref#1{`\nameref{#1}' on page~\pageref{#1}}
\providecommand\Sectionformat[2]{#1}
-\@ifpackageloaded{ifthen}{%
- \let\NROrg at ifthenelse\ifthenelse
- \def\ifthenelse{%
- \let\begingroup\NR at TE@begingroup
- \NROrg at ifthenelse
- }%
- \let\NROrg at begingroup\begingroup
- \def\NR at TE@begingroup{%
- \let\begingroup\NROrg at begingroup
- \begingroup
- \def\ref##1{\getrefbykeydefault{##1}{}{??}}%
- \def\pageref##1{\getrefbykeydefault{##1}{page}{0}}%
- }%
-}{}
+\@ifundefined{@kernel at pageref@exp}
+ {\@ifpackageloaded{ifthen}{%
+ \let\NROrg at ifthenelse\ifthenelse
+ \def\ifthenelse{%
+ \let\begingroup\NR at TE@begingroup
+ \NROrg at ifthenelse
+ }%
+ \let\NROrg at begingroup\begingroup
+ \def\NR at TE@begingroup{%
+ \let\begingroup\NROrg at begingroup
+ \begingroup
+ \def\ref##1{\getrefbykeydefault{##1}{}{??}}%
+ \def\pageref##1{\getrefbykeydefault{##1}{page}{0}}%
+ }%
+ }{}}{}
\AtBeginDocument{%
\ifx\csname @@vpageref\endcsname\relax
\else
- \ifdefined\vp at gerefstar
\let\NR@@vpageref\@@vpageref
- \else
- \def\NR@@vpageref#1[#2]#3{%
- \leavevmode\unskip
- \global\advance\c at vrcnt\@ne
- \@ifundefined{r@\the\c at vrcnt @vr}%
- {\@namedef{r@\the\c at vrcnt @vr}{{??}{??}{}{}{}}}{}%
- \edef\@tempa{%
- \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter
- \@secondoffive\csname r@\the\c at vrcnt @vr\endcsname
- }%
- \@ifundefined{r@\the\c at vrcnt @xvr}%
- {\@namedef{r@\the\c at vrcnt @xvr}{{??}{??}{}{}{}}}{}%
- \edef\@tempb{%
- \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter
- \@secondoffive\csname r@\the\c at vrcnt @xvr\endcsname
- }%
- {%
- \let\@currentlabel\@empty
- \expandafter\label\expandafter{\the\c at vrcnt @xvr}%
- }%
- \ifx\@tempa\@tempb
- \else
- \vref at err{%
- \noexpand\vref at page boundary %
- \@tempb-\@tempa\space (may loop)%
- }%
- \fi
- \@ifundefined{r@#3}{\@namedef{r@#3}{{??}{??}{}{}{}}}{}%
- \edef\thevpagerefnum{%
- \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter
- \@secondoffive\csname r@#3\endcsname
- }%
- \ifx\vref at space\@undefined
- \space
- \else
- \vref at space
- \fi
- \ifx\@tempa\thevpagerefnum
- #1%
- \else
- #2%
- \is at pos@number\thevpagerefnum{%
- \is at pos@number\@tempa{%
- \@tempcnta\@tempa
- \advance\@tempcnta\@ne
- }{%
- \@tempcnta\maxdimen
- }%
- \ifnum \thevpagerefnum =\@tempcnta
- \ifodd\@tempcnta
- \if at twoside
- \reftextfaceafter
- \else
- \reftextafter
- \fi
- \else
- \reftextafter
- \fi
- \else
- \advance\@tempcnta-2 %
- \ifnum \thevpagerefnum =\@tempcnta
- \ifodd\@tempcnta
- \reftextbefore
- \else
- \if at twoside
- \reftextfacebefore
- \else
- \reftextbefore
- \fi
- \fi
- \else
- \reftextfaraway{#3}%
- \fi
- \fi
- }{%
- \reftextfaraway{#3}%
- }%
- \fi
- {%
- \let\@currentlabel\@empty
- \expandafter\label\expandafter{\the\c at vrcnt @vr}%
- }%
- }%
- \fi
- \def\@@vpageref#1[#2]#3{%
+ \def\@@vpageref#1[#2]#3{%
\begingroup
\csname @safe at activestrue\endcsname
\edef\x{#3}%
@@ -496,38 +464,24 @@
\x
}%
\DeclareRobustCommand\vnameref[1]{%
- \unskip~\nameref{#1}%
+ \unskip~\nameref{#1} %
\@vpageref[\unskip]{#1}%
}%
\fi
}
-\@ifundefined{@Refstar}{%
- \def\T at Ref#1{%
- \NR at setref{#1}\NR at MakeUppercaseFirstOfFive{#1}%
- }%
- \def\NR at MakeUppercaseFirstOfFive#1#2#3#4#5{%
- \MakeUppercase#1%
- }%
-}{}%
\AtBeginDocument{%
- \@ifpackageloaded{varioref}{%
- \@ifundefined{@Refstar}{%
- \DeclareRobustCommand*{\Ref}[1]{%
- \T at Ref{#1}%
- }%
- }{}%
- }{}%
-}%
-\AtBeginDocument{%
\@ifpackageloaded{listings}{%
- \let\NROrg at lst@MakeCaption\lst at MakeCaption
- \def\lst at MakeCaption{%
- \ifx\lst at label\@empty
- \else
- \let\@currentlabelname\lst@@caption
- \fi
- \NROrg at lst@MakeCaption
- }%
+ \@ifundefined{NR at nopatch@listings}
+ {%
+ \let\NROrg at lst@MakeCaption\lst at MakeCaption
+ \def\lst at MakeCaption{%
+ \ifx\lst at label\@empty
+ \else
+ \let\@currentlabelname\lst@@caption
+ \fi
+ \NROrg at lst@MakeCaption
+ }%
+ }{}%
}{}%
}
\endinput
Modified: trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/nohyperref.sty
===================================================================
--- trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/nohyperref.sty 2022-05-14 20:31:45 UTC (rev 63297)
+++ trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/nohyperref.sty 2022-05-14 20:32:17 UTC (rev 63298)
@@ -6,17 +6,16 @@
%%
%% hyperref.dtx (with options: `nohyperref')
%%
-%% File: hyperref.dtx
%% Copyright
%% 1995-2001 Sebastian Rahtz, with portions written by David Carlisle and Heiko Oberdiek,
%% 2001-2015 Heiko Oberdiek.
%% 2016-2019 Oberdiek Package Support Group
-%% 2019-2021 LaTeX Project
+%% 2019-2022 LaTeX Project
%% https://github.com/latex3/hyperref/issues
-%%
+%%
%% This file is part of the `Hyperref Bundle'.
%% -------------------------------------------
-%%
+%%
%% This work may be distributed and/or modified under the
%% conditions of the LaTeX Project Public License, either version 1.3
%% of this license or (at your option) any later version.
@@ -24,17 +23,18 @@
%% http://www.latex-project.org/lppl.txt
%% and version 1.3 or later is part of all distributions of LaTeX
%% version 2005/12/01 or later.
-%%
+%%
%% This work has the LPPL maintenance status `maintained'.
-%%
+%%
%% The Current Maintainer of this work is the LaTeX Project.
-%%
+%%
%% The list of all files belonging to the `Hyperref Bundle' is
%% given in the file `manifest.txt'.
-%%
-\NeedsTeXFormat{LaTeX2e}[1995/12/01]
+%%
+%% File: hyperref.dtx
+\NeedsTeXFormat{LaTeX2e}[2020/10/01]
\ProvidesPackage{nohyperref}
- [2022-02-21 v7.00n %
+ [2022-05-13 v7.00o %
Dummy hyperref (SR)]
\RequirePackage{letltxmacro}[2008/06/13]
\let\hyper@@anchor\@gobble
@@ -66,14 +66,18 @@
}
\long\def\@gobbleopt[#1]{}
\let\hyperpage\@empty
-\LetLtxMacro\NoHy at OrgRef\ref
-\DeclareRobustCommand*{\ref}{%
- \@ifstar\NoHy at OrgRef\NoHy at OrgRef
-}
-\LetLtxMacro\NoHy at OrgPageRef\pageref
-\DeclareRobustCommand*{\pageref}{%
- \@ifstar\NoHy at OrgPageRef\NoHy at OrgPageRef
-}
+\@ifl at t@r\fmtversion{2022-06-01}
+ {}%
+ {%
+ \LetLtxMacro\NoHy at OrgRef\ref
+ \DeclareRobustCommand*{\ref}{%
+ \@ifstar\NoHy at OrgRef\NoHy at OrgRef
+ }
+ \LetLtxMacro\NoHy at OrgPageRef\pageref
+ \DeclareRobustCommand*{\pageref}{%
+ \@ifstar\NoHy at OrgPageRef\NoHy at OrgPageRef
+ }%
+ }
\endinput
%%
%% End of file `nohyperref.sty'.
Modified: trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/pd1enc.def
===================================================================
--- trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/pd1enc.def 2022-05-14 20:31:45 UTC (rev 63297)
+++ trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/pd1enc.def 2022-05-14 20:32:17 UTC (rev 63298)
@@ -6,17 +6,16 @@
%%
%% hyperref.dtx (with options: `pd1enc')
%%
-%% File: hyperref.dtx
%% Copyright
%% 1995-2001 Sebastian Rahtz, with portions written by David Carlisle and Heiko Oberdiek,
%% 2001-2015 Heiko Oberdiek.
%% 2016-2019 Oberdiek Package Support Group
-%% 2019-2021 LaTeX Project
+%% 2019-2022 LaTeX Project
%% https://github.com/latex3/hyperref/issues
-%%
+%%
%% This file is part of the `Hyperref Bundle'.
%% -------------------------------------------
-%%
+%%
%% This work may be distributed and/or modified under the
%% conditions of the LaTeX Project Public License, either version 1.3
%% of this license or (at your option) any later version.
@@ -24,16 +23,17 @@
%% http://www.latex-project.org/lppl.txt
%% and version 1.3 or later is part of all distributions of LaTeX
%% version 2005/12/01 or later.
-%%
+%%
%% This work has the LPPL maintenance status `maintained'.
-%%
+%%
%% The Current Maintainer of this work is the LaTeX Project.
-%%
+%%
%% The list of all files belonging to the `Hyperref Bundle' is
%% given in the file `manifest.txt'.
-%%
+%%
+%% File: hyperref.dtx
\ProvidesFile{pd1enc.def}
- [2022-02-21 v7.00n %
+ [2022-05-13 v7.00o %
Hyperref: PDFDocEncoding definition (HO)]
\DeclareFontEncoding{PD1}{}{}
\DeclareTextAccent{\`}{PD1}{\textasciigrave}
Modified: trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/pdfmark.def
===================================================================
--- trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/pdfmark.def 2022-05-14 20:31:45 UTC (rev 63297)
+++ trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/pdfmark.def 2022-05-14 20:32:17 UTC (rev 63298)
@@ -6,17 +6,16 @@
%%
%% hyperref.dtx (with options: `pdfmark,pdfmarkbase,pdfform,outlines')
%%
-%% File: hyperref.dtx
%% Copyright
%% 1995-2001 Sebastian Rahtz, with portions written by David Carlisle and Heiko Oberdiek,
%% 2001-2015 Heiko Oberdiek.
%% 2016-2019 Oberdiek Package Support Group
-%% 2019-2021 LaTeX Project
+%% 2019-2022 LaTeX Project
%% https://github.com/latex3/hyperref/issues
-%%
+%%
%% This file is part of the `Hyperref Bundle'.
%% -------------------------------------------
-%%
+%%
%% This work may be distributed and/or modified under the
%% conditions of the LaTeX Project Public License, either version 1.3
%% of this license or (at your option) any later version.
@@ -24,16 +23,17 @@
%% http://www.latex-project.org/lppl.txt
%% and version 1.3 or later is part of all distributions of LaTeX
%% version 2005/12/01 or later.
-%%
+%%
%% This work has the LPPL maintenance status `maintained'.
-%%
+%%
%% The Current Maintainer of this work is the LaTeX Project.
-%%
+%%
%% The list of all files belonging to the `Hyperref Bundle' is
%% given in the file `manifest.txt'.
-%%
+%%
+%% File: hyperref.dtx
\ProvidesFile{pdfmark.def}
- [2022-02-21 v7.00n %
+ [2022-05-13 v7.00o %
Hyperref definitions for pdfmark specials]
\Hy at VersionCheck{pdfmark.def}
\begingroup
@@ -1895,6 +1895,8 @@
\hss
}%
}
+\@ifundefined{hyper at nopatch@sectioning}
+{
\let\H at old@ssect\@ssect
\def\@ssect#1#2#3#4#5{%
\Hy at MakeCurrentHrefAuto{section*}%
@@ -1980,6 +1982,7 @@
\H at old@sect{#1}{#2}{#3}{#4}{#5}{#6}[{#7}]{#8}%
}%
}
+}{}
\expandafter\def\csname Parent-4\endcsname{}
\expandafter\def\csname Parent-3\endcsname{}
\expandafter\def\csname Parent-2\endcsname{}
@@ -1989,43 +1992,6 @@
\expandafter\def\csname Parent2\endcsname{}
\expandafter\def\csname Parent3\endcsname{}
\expandafter\def\csname Parent4\endcsname{}
-\def\Hy at tempa{%
- \def\@addchap[##1]##2{%
- \typeout{##2}%
- \if at twoside
- \@mkboth{##1}{}%
- \else
- \@mkboth{}{##1}%
- \fi
- \addtocontents{lof}{\protect\addvspace{10\p@}}%
- \addtocontents{lot}{\protect\addvspace{10\p@}}%
- \Hy at MakeCurrentHrefAuto{\Hy at chapapp*}%
- \Hy at raisedlink{%
- \hyper at anchorstart{\@currentHref}\hyper at anchorend
- }%
- \if at twocolumn
- \@topnewpage[\@makeschapterhead{##2}]%
- \else
- \@makeschapterhead{##2}%
- \@afterheading
- \fi
- \addcontentsline{toc}{chapter}{##1}%
- }%
-}
-\@ifclassloaded{scrbook}{%
- \@ifclasslater{scrbook}{2001/01/01}{%
- \let\Hy at tempa\@empty
- }{}%
-}{%
- \@ifclassloaded{scrreprt}{%
- \@ifclasslater{scrreprt}{2001/01/01}{%
- \let\Hy at tempa\@empty
- }{}%
- }{%
- \let\Hy at tempa\@empty
- }%
-}%
-\Hy at tempa
\endinput
%%
%% End of file `pdfmark.def'.
Modified: trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/psdextra.def
===================================================================
--- trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/psdextra.def 2022-05-14 20:31:45 UTC (rev 63297)
+++ trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/psdextra.def 2022-05-14 20:32:17 UTC (rev 63298)
@@ -6,17 +6,16 @@
%%
%% hyperref.dtx (with options: `psdextra')
%%
-%% File: hyperref.dtx
%% Copyright
%% 1995-2001 Sebastian Rahtz, with portions written by David Carlisle and Heiko Oberdiek,
%% 2001-2015 Heiko Oberdiek.
%% 2016-2019 Oberdiek Package Support Group
-%% 2019-2021 LaTeX Project
+%% 2019-2022 LaTeX Project
%% https://github.com/latex3/hyperref/issues
-%%
+%%
%% This file is part of the `Hyperref Bundle'.
%% -------------------------------------------
-%%
+%%
%% This work may be distributed and/or modified under the
%% conditions of the LaTeX Project Public License, either version 1.3
%% of this license or (at your option) any later version.
@@ -24,16 +23,17 @@
%% http://www.latex-project.org/lppl.txt
%% and version 1.3 or later is part of all distributions of LaTeX
%% version 2005/12/01 or later.
-%%
+%%
%% This work has the LPPL maintenance status `maintained'.
-%%
+%%
%% The Current Maintainer of this work is the LaTeX Project.
-%%
+%%
%% The list of all files belonging to the `Hyperref Bundle' is
%% given in the file `manifest.txt'.
-%%
+%%
+%% File: hyperref.dtx
\ProvidesFile{psdextra.def}
- [2022-02-21 v7.00n %
+ [2022-05-13 v7.00o %
Hyperref: Additions to PDF string support]
\Hy at VersionCheck{psdextra.def}
\newcommand*{\psdmapshortnames}{%
Modified: trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/puarenc.def
===================================================================
--- trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/puarenc.def 2022-05-14 20:31:45 UTC (rev 63297)
+++ trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/puarenc.def 2022-05-14 20:32:17 UTC (rev 63298)
@@ -6,17 +6,16 @@
%%
%% hyperref.dtx (with options: `puarenc')
%%
-%% File: hyperref.dtx
%% Copyright
%% 1995-2001 Sebastian Rahtz, with portions written by David Carlisle and Heiko Oberdiek,
%% 2001-2015 Heiko Oberdiek.
%% 2016-2019 Oberdiek Package Support Group
-%% 2019-2021 LaTeX Project
+%% 2019-2022 LaTeX Project
%% https://github.com/latex3/hyperref/issues
-%%
+%%
%% This file is part of the `Hyperref Bundle'.
%% -------------------------------------------
-%%
+%%
%% This work may be distributed and/or modified under the
%% conditions of the LaTeX Project Public License, either version 1.3
%% of this license or (at your option) any later version.
@@ -24,16 +23,17 @@
%% http://www.latex-project.org/lppl.txt
%% and version 1.3 or later is part of all distributions of LaTeX
%% version 2005/12/01 or later.
-%%
+%%
%% This work has the LPPL maintenance status `maintained'.
-%%
+%%
%% The Current Maintainer of this work is the LaTeX Project.
-%%
+%%
%% The list of all files belonging to the `Hyperref Bundle' is
%% given in the file `manifest.txt'.
-%%
+%%
+%% File: hyperref.dtx
\ProvidesFile{puarenc.def}
- [2022-02-21 v7.00n %
+ [2022-05-13 v7.00o %
Hyperref: Additions to puenc.def for Arabi]
\DeclareTextCommand{\hamza}{PU}{\86\041}% U+0621
\DeclareTextCommand{\alefmadda}{PU}{\86\042}% U+0622
Modified: trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/puenc-extra.def
===================================================================
--- trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/puenc-extra.def 2022-05-14 20:31:45 UTC (rev 63297)
+++ trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/puenc-extra.def 2022-05-14 20:32:17 UTC (rev 63298)
@@ -6,17 +6,16 @@
%%
%% hyperref.dtx (with options: `puextra')
%%
-%% File: hyperref.dtx
%% Copyright
%% 1995-2001 Sebastian Rahtz, with portions written by David Carlisle and Heiko Oberdiek,
%% 2001-2015 Heiko Oberdiek.
%% 2016-2019 Oberdiek Package Support Group
-%% 2019-2021 LaTeX Project
+%% 2019-2022 LaTeX Project
%% https://github.com/latex3/hyperref/issues
-%%
+%%
%% This file is part of the `Hyperref Bundle'.
%% -------------------------------------------
-%%
+%%
%% This work may be distributed and/or modified under the
%% conditions of the LaTeX Project Public License, either version 1.3
%% of this license or (at your option) any later version.
@@ -24,16 +23,17 @@
%% http://www.latex-project.org/lppl.txt
%% and version 1.3 or later is part of all distributions of LaTeX
%% version 2005/12/01 or later.
-%%
+%%
%% This work has the LPPL maintenance status `maintained'.
-%%
+%%
%% The Current Maintainer of this work is the LaTeX Project.
-%%
+%%
%% The list of all files belonging to the `Hyperref Bundle' is
%% given in the file `manifest.txt'.
-%%
+%%
+%% File: hyperref.dtx
\ProvidesFile{puenc-extra.def}
- [2022-02-21 v7.00n %
+ [2022-05-13 v7.00o %
Hyperref: PDF Unicode extra definition (HO)]
\DeclareTextCommand{\G}{PU}[1]{#1\83\017}% U+030F
\DeclareTextCompositeCommand{\G}{PU}{\@empty}{\textdoublegrave}%
Modified: trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/puenc-greekbasic.def
===================================================================
--- trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/puenc-greekbasic.def 2022-05-14 20:31:45 UTC (rev 63297)
+++ trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/puenc-greekbasic.def 2022-05-14 20:32:17 UTC (rev 63298)
@@ -6,17 +6,16 @@
%%
%% hyperref.dtx (with options: `pugreek')
%%
-%% File: hyperref.dtx
%% Copyright
%% 1995-2001 Sebastian Rahtz, with portions written by David Carlisle and Heiko Oberdiek,
%% 2001-2015 Heiko Oberdiek.
%% 2016-2019 Oberdiek Package Support Group
-%% 2019-2021 LaTeX Project
+%% 2019-2022 LaTeX Project
%% https://github.com/latex3/hyperref/issues
-%%
+%%
%% This file is part of the `Hyperref Bundle'.
%% -------------------------------------------
-%%
+%%
%% This work may be distributed and/or modified under the
%% conditions of the LaTeX Project Public License, either version 1.3
%% of this license or (at your option) any later version.
@@ -24,16 +23,17 @@
%% http://www.latex-project.org/lppl.txt
%% and version 1.3 or later is part of all distributions of LaTeX
%% version 2005/12/01 or later.
-%%
+%%
%% This work has the LPPL maintenance status `maintained'.
-%%
+%%
%% The Current Maintainer of this work is the LaTeX Project.
-%%
+%%
%% The list of all files belonging to the `Hyperref Bundle' is
%% given in the file `manifest.txt'.
-%%
+%%
+%% File: hyperref.dtx
\ProvidesFile{puenc-greekbasic.def}
- [2022-02-21 v7.00n %
+ [2022-05-13 v7.00o %
Hyperref: PDF Unicode definition (greek block) (HO)]
\DeclareTextCommand{\textnumeralsigngreek}{PU}{\83\164}% U+0374
\DeclareTextCommand{\textdexiakeraia}{PU}{\83\164}% U+0374
Modified: trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/puenc.def
===================================================================
--- trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/puenc.def 2022-05-14 20:31:45 UTC (rev 63297)
+++ trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/puenc.def 2022-05-14 20:32:17 UTC (rev 63298)
@@ -6,17 +6,16 @@
%%
%% hyperref.dtx (with options: `puenc')
%%
-%% File: hyperref.dtx
%% Copyright
%% 1995-2001 Sebastian Rahtz, with portions written by David Carlisle and Heiko Oberdiek,
%% 2001-2015 Heiko Oberdiek.
%% 2016-2019 Oberdiek Package Support Group
-%% 2019-2021 LaTeX Project
+%% 2019-2022 LaTeX Project
%% https://github.com/latex3/hyperref/issues
-%%
+%%
%% This file is part of the `Hyperref Bundle'.
%% -------------------------------------------
-%%
+%%
%% This work may be distributed and/or modified under the
%% conditions of the LaTeX Project Public License, either version 1.3
%% of this license or (at your option) any later version.
@@ -24,16 +23,17 @@
%% http://www.latex-project.org/lppl.txt
%% and version 1.3 or later is part of all distributions of LaTeX
%% version 2005/12/01 or later.
-%%
+%%
%% This work has the LPPL maintenance status `maintained'.
-%%
+%%
%% The Current Maintainer of this work is the LaTeX Project.
-%%
+%%
%% The list of all files belonging to the `Hyperref Bundle' is
%% given in the file `manifest.txt'.
-%%
+%%
+%% File: hyperref.dtx
\ProvidesFile{puenc.def}
- [2022-02-21 v7.00n %
+ [2022-05-13 v7.00o %
Hyperref: PDF Unicode definition (HO)]
\DeclareFontEncoding{PU}{}{}
\DeclareTextCommand{\`}{PU}[1]{#1\83\000}% U+0300
Modified: trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/puvnenc.def
===================================================================
--- trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/puvnenc.def 2022-05-14 20:31:45 UTC (rev 63297)
+++ trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/puvnenc.def 2022-05-14 20:32:17 UTC (rev 63298)
@@ -6,17 +6,16 @@
%%
%% hyperref.dtx (with options: `puvnenc')
%%
-%% File: hyperref.dtx
%% Copyright
%% 1995-2001 Sebastian Rahtz, with portions written by David Carlisle and Heiko Oberdiek,
%% 2001-2015 Heiko Oberdiek.
%% 2016-2019 Oberdiek Package Support Group
-%% 2019-2021 LaTeX Project
+%% 2019-2022 LaTeX Project
%% https://github.com/latex3/hyperref/issues
-%%
+%%
%% This file is part of the `Hyperref Bundle'.
%% -------------------------------------------
-%%
+%%
%% This work may be distributed and/or modified under the
%% conditions of the LaTeX Project Public License, either version 1.3
%% of this license or (at your option) any later version.
@@ -24,16 +23,17 @@
%% http://www.latex-project.org/lppl.txt
%% and version 1.3 or later is part of all distributions of LaTeX
%% version 2005/12/01 or later.
-%%
+%%
%% This work has the LPPL maintenance status `maintained'.
-%%
+%%
%% The Current Maintainer of this work is the LaTeX Project.
-%%
+%%
%% The list of all files belonging to the `Hyperref Bundle' is
%% given in the file `manifest.txt'.
-%%
+%%
+%% File: hyperref.dtx
\ProvidesFile{puvnenc.def}
- [2022-02-21 v7.00n %
+ [2022-05-13 v7.00o %
Hyperref: Additions to puenc.def for VnTeX]
\DeclareTextCommand{\abreve}{PU}{\81\003}% U+0103
\DeclareTextCommand{\acircumflex}{PU}{\80\342}% U+00E2
Modified: trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/xr-hyper.sty
===================================================================
--- trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/xr-hyper.sty 2022-05-14 20:31:45 UTC (rev 63297)
+++ trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/hyperref/xr-hyper.sty 2022-05-14 20:32:17 UTC (rev 63298)
@@ -1,6 +1,6 @@
%% xr-hyper package (beta release)
-%% Copyright (C) 1993-2021 David Carlisle
+%% Copyright (C) 1993-2022 David Carlisle
%% This is a modified version of the xr package from the Standard LaTeX
%% tools distribution. It has some internal changes to cooperate with
@@ -61,7 +61,7 @@
%%
\NeedsTeXFormat{LaTeX2e}
\ProvidesPackage{xr-hyper}
- [2022-02-21 v7.00n eXternal References (DPC)]
+ [2022-05-13 v7.00o eXternal References (DPC)]
\def\externaldocument{\@testopt\XR at cite{}}
\let\externalcitedocument\externaldocument
More information about the tex-live-commits
mailing list.